Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Dodge
Model
Ram 2500 4wd
Engine and year
Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Component ID: 211
Component : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Connector:
Name : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 IGNITION SWITCH SENSE G20 20VT/BR
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 GROUND Z109 20BK/GY
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
6 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
7 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
8-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 211
Component : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Connector:
Name : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 IGNITION SWITCH SENSE G20 20VT/BR
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 GROUND Z109 20BK/GY
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
6 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
7 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
8-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 11
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 12
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation Module-Remote Keyless Entry
Description
DESCRIPTION
When an RKE lock message is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster actuates the
door locks, the interior lighting is turned off, the horn chirps (if this feature is enabled), the park
lamps flash (if this feature is enabled) and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS) is armed. When an RKE unlock message is sent to the instrument cluster, the
instrument cluster actuates the driver side front door (or all doors if this feature is enabled) unlock,
the interior lighting is turned on and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the VTSS is disarmed.
When an RKE panic message is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster actuates the
driver side front door (or all doors if this feature is enabled) unlock, the interior lighting is turned on
and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the VTSS is disarmed. The panic message will also cause the
exterior lamps (including the headlights) to flash, and the horn to sound for about three minutes, or
until a second panic message is sent to the instrument cluster. A vehicle speed of about 25.7
Km/h(15 mph) will also cancel the panic event.
Operation
OPERATION
Whenever the vehicle battery power is interrupted, the Remote Keyless Module (RKE) Module will
retain all vehicle access codes in its memory. When replacing or adding a key fob transmitter
(maximum of 4) a scan tool is required to program the RKE Module to accept the new Vehicle
Access Code if a customer owned transmitter is not available.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry > Page 16
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation Sentry Key Remote Entry Module
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (1) is sometimes referred to as the Wireless
Control Module (WCM). The SKREEM is the primary component of the Sentry Key Immobilizer
System (SKIS). It is also the receiver for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system. The SKREEM is
located on the right side of the steering column, near the ignition lock cylinder housing and is
concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The molded black plastic housing for the
SKREEM has an integral molded plastic halo-like antenna ring (4) that extends from the bottom.
When the SKREEM is properly installed on the steering column, the antenna ring is oriented
around the circumference of the ignition lock cylinder housing.
A single integral connector receptacle (3) is located just behind the antenna ring on the bottom of
the SKREEM housing. An integral molded plastic mounting tab (2) on the rear corner of the
SKREEM housing has a hole in the center through which a screw passes to secure the unit to the
steering column. The SKREEM is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a single take
out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
Two SKREEM modules are used: one for vehicles equipped with RKE only, and one for vehicles
equipped with RKE and SKIS. The SKREEM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or
damaged, the entire SKREEM unit must be replaced.
Operation
OPERATION
The Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the Wireless Control
Module/WCM) contains a Radio Frequency (RF) transceiver and a microprocessor. The SKREEM
transmits RF signals to, and receives RF signals from the Sentry Key transponder through a tuned
antenna enclosed within the molded plastic antenna ring integral to the SKREEM housing. If this
antenna ring is not mounted properly around the ignition lock cylinder housing, communication
problems between the SKREEM and the transponder may arise. These communication problems
will result in Sentry Key transponder-related faults.
The SKREEM also serves as the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) RF receiver. The SKREEM
communicates over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus with the ElectroMechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM)/Engine Control Module (ECM) or the diagnostic scan tool.
The SKREEM and the PCM/ECM both use software that includes a rolling code algorithm strategy,
which helps to reduce the possibility of unauthorized Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS)
disarming. The rolling code algorithm ensures security by preventing an override of the SKIS
through the unauthorized substitution of the SKREEM or the PCM/ECM. However, the use of this
strategy also means that replacement of either the SKREEM or the PCM/ECM units will require a
system initialization procedure to restore system operation.
The SKREEM retains in memory the ID numbers of any Sentry Key transponder that is
programmed into it. A maximum of eight Sentry Key transponders can be programmed into the
SKREEM. For added system security, each SKREEM is programmed with a unique Secret Key
code. This code is stored in memory, sent over the CAN data bus to the PCM or ECM, and is
encoded to the transponder of every Sentry Key that is programmed into the SKREEM. Therefore,
the Secret Key code is a common element that is found in every component of the SKIS.
Another security code called a PIN, is used to gain access to the SKREEM Secured Access Mode.
The Secured Access Mode is required during service to perform the SKIS initialization and Sentry
Key transponder programming procedures. The SKREEM also stores the Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) in its memory, which it learns through a CAN data bus message from the PCM or
ECM during SKIS initialization.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry > Page 17
In the event that a SKREEM replacement is required, the Secret Key code can be transferred to
the new SKREEM from the PCM or ECM using a diagnostic scan tool and the SKIS initialization
procedure. Proper completion of the SKIS initialization will allow the existing Sentry Keys to be
programmed into the new SKREEM so that new keys will not be required. In the event that the
original Secret Key code cannot be recovered, SKREEM replacement will also require new Sentry
Keys. The diagnostic scan tool will alert the technician during the SKIS initialization procedure if
new Sentry Keys are required.
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the SKREEM transmits an RF signal to excite
the transponder in the ignition key. The SKREEM then waits for an RF signal response from the
transponder. If the response received identifies the key as valid, the SKREEM sends an electronic
valid key message to the PCM/ECM over the CAN bus. If the response received identifies the key
as invalid or if no response is received from the key transponder, the SKREEM sends an invalid
key message to the PCM/ECM. The PCM/ECM will enable or disable engine operation based upon
the status of the SKREEM messages. It is important to note that the default condition in the PCM or
ECM is an invalid key; therefore, if no message is received from the SKREEM by the PCM or ECM,
the engine will be disabled and the vehicle immobilized after two seconds of running.
The SKREEM also sends security indicator request messages to the EMIC over the CAN data bus
to tell the EMIC how to operate the security indicator. The security indicator request message from
the SKREEM tells the EMIC to turn the indicator ON for about three seconds each time the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position as a bulb test. After completion of the bulb test, the SKREEM
sends security indicator request messages to the EMIC to turn the indicator OFF, turn the indicator
ON, or to flash the indicator ON and OFF. If the security indicator flashes or stays ON solid after
the bulb test, it signifies a SKIS fault. If the SKREEM detects a system malfunction or the SKIS has
become ineffective, the security indicator will stay ON solid. If the SKREEM detects an invalid key
or if a key transponder-related fault exists, the security indicator will flash. If the vehicle is equipped
with the Customer Learn transponder programming feature, the SKREEM will also send messages
to the EMIC to flash the security indicator whenever the Customer Learn programming mode is
being utilized.
The SKIS performs a self-test each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, and will
store fault information in the form of a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in SKREEM memory if a
system malfunction is detected. The hard wired circuits of the SKREEM may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
SKREEM or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that
provide some features of the SKIS. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose
the SKREEM or the electronic controls and communication related to SKREEM operation requires
the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 18
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the power lock system requires the
use of a scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the screw (2) that secures the tilt steering column knob (1) and remove it from the tilt
actuator (3) on the left side of the column.
3. From below the steering column, remove the two outboard screws that secure the upper column
shroud (1) to the lower shroud (3).
4. Using hand pressure, push inward on both sides of the upper shroud above the parting line of
the lower shroud to release the snap features that
secure the two shroud halves to each other.
5. Remove the upper shroud from the lower shroud and the steering column.
6. Remove the one center screw that secures the lower shroud to the steering column (4).
7. Remove the lower shroud from the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 21
8. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the Sentry Key REmote Entry Module
(SKREEM) (1).
9. Remove the screw (3) that secures the SKREEM (1) to the steering column (2).
10. Disengage the antenna ring from around the ignition lock cylinder housing and remove the
SKREEM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 22
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Position the Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (1) onto the steering column (2) with
the antenna ring oriented around the ignition lock
cylinder housing.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the SKREEM to the steering column housing.
Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the wire harness connector (2) to the SKREEM (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Keyless
Entry Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 23
4. Position the lower shroud (3) onto the steering column (4).
5. From below the steering column, install and tighten the one center screw that secures the lower
shroud to the steering column. Tighten the screw to
2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
6. Position the upper shroud (1) onto the steering column over the lower shroud. On vehicles
equipped with an automatic transmission, be certain to
engage the gearshift lever gap hider into the opening in the right side of both shroud halves.
7. Align the snap features on the upper shroud with the receptacles in the lower shroud and apply
hand pressure to snap them together.
8. Install and tighten the two outboard screws that secure the upper shroud to the lower shroud.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Position the tilt steering column knob (1) onto the tilt adjuster actuator (3) on the left side of the
steering column, then install and tighten the screw
(2) to secure the knob to the actuator. Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with the optional Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) if the
SKREEM is replaced with a new unit, a diagnostic scan tool MUST be used to initialize the new
SKREEM and to program at least two Sentry Key transponders before the vehicle can be operated.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations
Voice Activation Module: Locations
Component ID: 206
Component : MODULE-HANDS FREE
Connector:
Name : MODULE-HANDS FREE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
2-3-4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5 MICROPHONE 2 IN (+) X722 20LB/DG
6-7--
8 LEFT AUDIO OUTPUT X716 20GY/TN
9 RIGHT AUDIO OUTPUT X776 20TN/GY
10 COMMON AUDIO OUTPUT X795 20DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
15 VOICE RECOGNITION/PHONE SWITCH SIGNAL X730 20GY/YL
16 MICROPHONE 1 IN (+) X712 20DG/LB
17 MICROPHONE IN (-) X792 20LB/DG
18 - 19 - 20 MICROPHONE FEED X793 20DG/YL
21 SENSOR GROUND X835 20OR/GY
22 GROUND Z970 18BK
Component Location - 46
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 27
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 28
Voice Activation Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 206
Component : MODULE-HANDS FREE
Connector:
Name : MODULE-HANDS FREE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
2-3-4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5 MICROPHONE 2 IN (+) X722 20LB/DG
6-7--
8 LEFT AUDIO OUTPUT X716 20GY/TN
9 RIGHT AUDIO OUTPUT X776 20TN/GY
10 COMMON AUDIO OUTPUT X795 20DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
15 VOICE RECOGNITION/PHONE SWITCH SIGNAL X730 20GY/YL
16 MICROPHONE 1 IN (+) X712 20DG/LB
17 MICROPHONE IN (-) X792 20LB/DG
18 - 19 - 20 MICROPHONE FEED X793 20DG/YL
21 SENSOR GROUND X835 20OR/GY
22 GROUND Z970 18BK
Component Location - 46
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Voice
Activation Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation
Winch Relay: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
RELAY PACK
Electrical operation of the control assembly consists of four heavy duty relays, a thermal-switch
located on the motor armature brush holder and a Low Voltage Interrupt (LVI) located in the control
assembly. The thermal-switch interrupts the power-in function and the LVI affects both the power-in
and power-out functions and must be reset by allowing the charging circuit voltage to rise above 10
volts for more than 30 seconds. The thermal switch is reset only by allowing the winch motor to
cool adequately (about 30 minutes). Relay number 1 and 3 control current flow through the field
windings and relay number 2 and 4 supply current to the motor armature.
Operation
In the power-out mode, relay number 2 and 3 are energized by the remote control switch. Current
flows from the positive battery terminal through relay number 3 then through the black motor cable
to the number 2 and number 1 field windings. From the black motor cable current then flows
through solenoid number 2 to the motor armature to ground.
In power-in mode, relay number 1 and 4 are energized. Current again flows from the battery
positive cable, but this time current flows through solenoid number 1 then through field winding
number 1. Current flowing in the reverse direction through the field windings cause the motor to
turn in the opposite direction. From the red motor cable current then flows through relay number 4
to the black cable going to the motor armature to ground.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay
Winch Relay: Service and Repair Relay
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the relay pack (1).
2. Remove the nuts (2 & 3), disconnect the cables and remove the bus straps (4).
NOTE: Relay #4 shown, all others similar.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 35
3. Remove the nuts (1) and disconnect the control wires (2).
4. Slide the relay (1) out of the retaining tab (2) and remove.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Relay #4 shown, all others similar.
1. Slide the relay (1) into the retaining tab (2).
2. Install the control wires (2) and install the nuts (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 36
3. Tighten the nuts to 3 Nm (25 in. lbs.).
4. Install the bus straps (4) and connect the cables.
5. Install the nuts (2 & 3) and tighten to 9.5 Nm (85 in. lbs.).
6. Install the relay pack (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 37
Winch Relay: Service and Repair Relay Pack
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate battery negative cable (3).
2. Remove the winch assembly (2).
3. Remove the nut and disconnect the red battery positive cable (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 38
NOTE: Relay #4 shown, all others similar.
4. Remove the control wire nuts (1) and disconnect the control wires (2) from each relay.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Relay #4 shown, all others similar.
1. Install the control wires (2) to all the relays and install the nuts (1).
2. Tighten the nuts to 3 Nm (25 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 39
3. Install the red battery positive cable (1) and install the switch wire.
4. Install the nut and tighten to 10 Nm (85 in. lbs.).
5. Install the relay pack cover (1) and install the three screws (2).
6. Install the winch assembly (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Winch
Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Relay > Page 40
7. Connect the battery negative cable (3) and verify winch operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations
Keyless Entry Module: Locations
Component ID: 211
Component : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Connector:
Name : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 IGNITION SWITCH SENSE G20 20VT/BR
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 GROUND Z109 20BK/GY
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
6 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
7 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
8-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 45
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 46
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 48
Keyless Entry Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 211
Component : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Connector:
Name : MODULE-SENTRY KEY REMOTE ENTRY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 IGNITION SWITCH SENSE G20 20VT/BR
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 GROUND Z109 20BK/GY
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
6 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
7 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
8-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 49
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 50
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 51
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation Module-Remote Keyless Entry
Description
DESCRIPTION
When an RKE lock message is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster actuates the
door locks, the interior lighting is turned off, the horn chirps (if this feature is enabled), the park
lamps flash (if this feature is enabled) and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS) is armed. When an RKE unlock message is sent to the instrument cluster, the
instrument cluster actuates the driver side front door (or all doors if this feature is enabled) unlock,
the interior lighting is turned on and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the VTSS is disarmed.
When an RKE panic message is sent to the instrument cluster, the instrument cluster actuates the
driver side front door (or all doors if this feature is enabled) unlock, the interior lighting is turned on
and, if the vehicle is so equipped, the VTSS is disarmed. The panic message will also cause the
exterior lamps (including the headlights) to flash, and the horn to sound for about three minutes, or
until a second panic message is sent to the instrument cluster. A vehicle speed of about 25.7
Km/h(15 mph) will also cancel the panic event.
Operation
OPERATION
Whenever the vehicle battery power is interrupted, the Remote Keyless Module (RKE) Module will
retain all vehicle access codes in its memory. When replacing or adding a key fob transmitter
(maximum of 4) a scan tool is required to program the RKE Module to accept the new Vehicle
Access Code if a customer owned transmitter is not available.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry > Page 54
Keyless Entry Module: Description and Operation Sentry Key Remote Entry Module
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (1) is sometimes referred to as the Wireless
Control Module (WCM). The SKREEM is the primary component of the Sentry Key Immobilizer
System (SKIS). It is also the receiver for the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system. The SKREEM is
located on the right side of the steering column, near the ignition lock cylinder housing and is
concealed beneath the steering column shrouds. The molded black plastic housing for the
SKREEM has an integral molded plastic halo-like antenna ring (4) that extends from the bottom.
When the SKREEM is properly installed on the steering column, the antenna ring is oriented
around the circumference of the ignition lock cylinder housing.
A single integral connector receptacle (3) is located just behind the antenna ring on the bottom of
the SKREEM housing. An integral molded plastic mounting tab (2) on the rear corner of the
SKREEM housing has a hole in the center through which a screw passes to secure the unit to the
steering column. The SKREEM is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a single take
out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
Two SKREEM modules are used: one for vehicles equipped with RKE only, and one for vehicles
equipped with RKE and SKIS. The SKREEM cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or
damaged, the entire SKREEM unit must be replaced.
Operation
OPERATION
The Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the Wireless Control
Module/WCM) contains a Radio Frequency (RF) transceiver and a microprocessor. The SKREEM
transmits RF signals to, and receives RF signals from the Sentry Key transponder through a tuned
antenna enclosed within the molded plastic antenna ring integral to the SKREEM housing. If this
antenna ring is not mounted properly around the ignition lock cylinder housing, communication
problems between the SKREEM and the transponder may arise. These communication problems
will result in Sentry Key transponder-related faults.
The SKREEM also serves as the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) RF receiver. The SKREEM
communicates over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus with the ElectroMechanical
Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN), the Powertrain
Control Module (PCM)/Engine Control Module (ECM) or the diagnostic scan tool.
The SKREEM and the PCM/ECM both use software that includes a rolling code algorithm strategy,
which helps to reduce the possibility of unauthorized Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS)
disarming. The rolling code algorithm ensures security by preventing an override of the SKIS
through the unauthorized substitution of the SKREEM or the PCM/ECM. However, the use of this
strategy also means that replacement of either the SKREEM or the PCM/ECM units will require a
system initialization procedure to restore system operation.
The SKREEM retains in memory the ID numbers of any Sentry Key transponder that is
programmed into it. A maximum of eight Sentry Key transponders can be programmed into the
SKREEM. For added system security, each SKREEM is programmed with a unique Secret Key
code. This code is stored in memory, sent over the CAN data bus to the PCM or ECM, and is
encoded to the transponder of every Sentry Key that is programmed into the SKREEM. Therefore,
the Secret Key code is a common element that is found in every component of the SKIS.
Another security code called a PIN, is used to gain access to the SKREEM Secured Access Mode.
The Secured Access Mode is required during service to perform the SKIS initialization and Sentry
Key transponder programming procedures. The SKREEM also stores the Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) in its memory, which it learns through a CAN data bus message from the PCM or
ECM during SKIS initialization.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Module-Remote Keyless Entry > Page 55
In the event that a SKREEM replacement is required, the Secret Key code can be transferred to
the new SKREEM from the PCM or ECM using a diagnostic scan tool and the SKIS initialization
procedure. Proper completion of the SKIS initialization will allow the existing Sentry Keys to be
programmed into the new SKREEM so that new keys will not be required. In the event that the
original Secret Key code cannot be recovered, SKREEM replacement will also require new Sentry
Keys. The diagnostic scan tool will alert the technician during the SKIS initialization procedure if
new Sentry Keys are required.
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the SKREEM transmits an RF signal to excite
the transponder in the ignition key. The SKREEM then waits for an RF signal response from the
transponder. If the response received identifies the key as valid, the SKREEM sends an electronic
valid key message to the PCM/ECM over the CAN bus. If the response received identifies the key
as invalid or if no response is received from the key transponder, the SKREEM sends an invalid
key message to the PCM/ECM. The PCM/ECM will enable or disable engine operation based upon
the status of the SKREEM messages. It is important to note that the default condition in the PCM or
ECM is an invalid key; therefore, if no message is received from the SKREEM by the PCM or ECM,
the engine will be disabled and the vehicle immobilized after two seconds of running.
The SKREEM also sends security indicator request messages to the EMIC over the CAN data bus
to tell the EMIC how to operate the security indicator. The security indicator request message from
the SKREEM tells the EMIC to turn the indicator ON for about three seconds each time the ignition
switch is turned to the ON position as a bulb test. After completion of the bulb test, the SKREEM
sends security indicator request messages to the EMIC to turn the indicator OFF, turn the indicator
ON, or to flash the indicator ON and OFF. If the security indicator flashes or stays ON solid after
the bulb test, it signifies a SKIS fault. If the SKREEM detects a system malfunction or the SKIS has
become ineffective, the security indicator will stay ON solid. If the SKREEM detects an invalid key
or if a key transponder-related fault exists, the security indicator will flash. If the vehicle is equipped
with the Customer Learn transponder programming feature, the SKREEM will also send messages
to the EMIC to flash the security indicator whenever the Customer Learn programming mode is
being utilized.
The SKIS performs a self-test each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, and will
store fault information in the form of a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in SKREEM memory if a
system malfunction is detected. The hard wired circuits of the SKREEM may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the
SKREEM or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that
provide some features of the SKIS. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose
the SKREEM or the electronic controls and communication related to SKREEM operation requires
the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 56
Keyless Entry Module: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY MODULE
The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the power lock system requires the
use of a scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures information.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the screw (2) that secures the tilt steering column knob (1) and remove it from the tilt
actuator (3) on the left side of the column.
3. From below the steering column, remove the two outboard screws that secure the upper column
shroud (1) to the lower shroud (3).
4. Using hand pressure, push inward on both sides of the upper shroud above the parting line of
the lower shroud to release the snap features that
secure the two shroud halves to each other.
5. Remove the upper shroud from the lower shroud and the steering column.
6. Remove the one center screw that secures the lower shroud to the steering column (4).
7. Remove the lower shroud from the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 59
8. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the Sentry Key REmote Entry Module
(SKREEM) (1).
9. Remove the screw (3) that secures the SKREEM (1) to the steering column (2).
10. Disengage the antenna ring from around the ignition lock cylinder housing and remove the
SKREEM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 60
Keyless Entry Module: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Position the Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) (1) onto the steering column (2) with
the antenna ring oriented around the ignition lock
cylinder housing.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the SKREEM to the steering column housing.
Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the wire harness connector (2) to the SKREEM (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Keyless Entry Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 61
4. Position the lower shroud (3) onto the steering column (4).
5. From below the steering column, install and tighten the one center screw that secures the lower
shroud to the steering column. Tighten the screw to
2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
6. Position the upper shroud (1) onto the steering column over the lower shroud. On vehicles
equipped with an automatic transmission, be certain to
engage the gearshift lever gap hider into the opening in the right side of both shroud halves.
7. Align the snap features on the upper shroud with the receptacles in the lower shroud and apply
hand pressure to snap them together.
8. Install and tighten the two outboard screws that secure the upper shroud to the lower shroud.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
9. Position the tilt steering column knob (1) onto the tilt adjuster actuator (3) on the left side of the
steering column, then install and tighten the screw
(2) to secure the knob to the actuator. Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
10. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with the optional Sentry Key Immobilizer System (SKIS) if the
SKREEM is replaced with a new unit, a diagnostic scan tool MUST be used to initialize the new
SKREEM and to program at least two Sentry Key transponders before the vehicle can be operated.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Momentary contact push button switch/modules mounted in the instrument panel center bezel
operate the heated seat system. Each heated seat switch/module has two Light-Emitting Diode
(LED) indicator lamps, which indicate the selected level (Low or High) of the seat heater. Pressing
the switch/module button initiates heat. Heat remains on until switched off or until the ignition is
turned off. If switched off by the ignition, a switch/module button must be pressed to restart heating.
The switch/modules contain the solid state electronic control and diagnostic logic circuitry for the
heated seat system. If any of the heated seat elements are inoperative or damaged one or more of
the LED lamps in the switch/module for the effected seat will flash.
The LED indicator lamps in each heated seat switch/module cannot be repaired. If the LED lamps
are faulty or damaged, or the switch/module is inoperative or damaged the individual heated seat
switch/module assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 66
Seat Heater Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
A Heated Seat Switch/Module is used to control the heated seat system. The heated seat
switch/modules receive battery current through a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit when the
ignition switch is in the On position. The switch/module responds to heated seat switch/module
button input and ignition switch status inputs by controlling the 12v output to the front seat heating
elements through integral solid-state relays.
When either of the heated seat switch/module buttons are depressed the heating element for the
selected seat is energized. Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDS) on the side of each switch/module
indicate the level of heat in use: Two LEDs are illuminated for high, one for low, and none for off.
Pressing the switch/module button once will select high-level heating. Pressing the button a second
time will select low-level heating. Pressing the button a third time will shut the heating elements off.
The heated seat switch/module energizes an integral solid-state relay, which supplies battery
current to the heating elements. When high-temperature heating is selected, the heaters provide a
boosted heat level during the first four minutes of operation after heating is activated. The heat
output then drops to the normal high-temperature level. If high-level heating is selected, the control
system will automatically switch to the low level after two hours of continuous operation. At that
time, the number of illuminated LEDs changes from two to one, indicating the change. Operation
on the low setting will continue indefinitely until the switch/module button is pushed to turn the
system off.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
3. Disconnect the switch/module electrical connectors.
4. Using an appropriate flat bladed tool, remove the heated seat switch/module from the bezel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 69
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Align the tabs of the switch/module to the instrument panel center bezel and gently push
together until the tabs are securely in place.
2. Connect the switch/module electrical connectors.
3. Install the instrument panel center bezel.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
5. Verify heated seat system operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 199
Component : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Color : # of pins :
46
Qualifier : (AWAL)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
3 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
4-5-6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
7-8-9-10 - 11 - 12 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 20DG/LG
13 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 20DG/TN
14 - 15 - 16 GROUND Z107 16BK/DG
17 - 18 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
19 - 20 - 21 - 22 - 23 - 24 - 25 - 26 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B7 20DG/VT
27 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B6 20DG/WT
28 - 29 - 30 - 31 FUSED B(+) A107 12TN/RD
32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
33 - 34 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 74
35 - 36 - 37 - 38 - 39 - 40 - 41 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 20DG/YL
42 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 20DG/WT
43 - 44 - 45 GROUND Z127 12BK/DG
46 - Component Location - 32
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 75
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 14
Qualifier : (RWAL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 18DG/WT
2 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
3 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 76
5 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 18DG/LG
6 GROUND Z107 16BK/DG
7 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
8 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 18DG/YL
9 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
10 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 18DG/TN
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - Component Location - 32
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 77
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 78
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 199
Component : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Color : # of pins :
46
Qualifier : (AWAL)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
3 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
4-5-6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
7-8-9-10 - 11 - 12 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 20DG/LG
13 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 20DG/TN
14 - 15 - 16 GROUND Z107 16BK/DG
17 - 18 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
19 - 20 - 21 - 22 - 23 - 24 - 25 - 26 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B7 20DG/VT
27 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B6 20DG/WT
28 - 29 - 30 - 31 FUSED B(+) A107 12TN/RD
32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
33 - 34 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 79
35 - 36 - 37 - 38 - 39 - 40 - 41 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 20DG/YL
42 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 20DG/WT
43 - 44 - 45 GROUND Z127 12BK/DG
46 - Component Location - 32
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 80
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ANTI-LOCK BRAKES
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 14
Qualifier : (RWAL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 18DG/WT
2 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
3 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 81
5 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 18DG/LG
6 GROUND Z107 16BK/DG
7 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
8 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 18DG/YL
9 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
10 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 18DG/TN
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - Component Location - 32
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 82
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Antilock Brake Module (ABM) (2) is mounted to the Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU) (3) and
operates the ABS system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 85
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The ABM voltage source is through the ignition switch in the RUN position. The ABM contains a
self check program that illuminates the ABS warning light when a system fault is detected. Faults
are stored in a diagnostic program memory and are accessible with the scan tool. ABS faults
remain in memory until cleared, or until after the vehicle is started approximately 50 times. Stored
faults are not erased if the battery is disconnected.
NOTE: If the ABM is being replaced with a new ABM is must be reprogrammed with the use of a
scan tool.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the negative battery cable from the battery.
2. Pull up on the ABM harness connector release and remove connector.
3. Remove the ABM mounting bolts .
4. Remove the pump connector from the ABM.
5. Remove the ABM from the HCU .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 88
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: If the ABM is being replaced with a new ABM is must be reprogrammed with the use of a
scan tool.
1. Install ABM to the HCU.
2. Install the pump connector to the ABM.
3. Install mounting bolts. Tighten to 2 Nm (16 in. lbs.).
4. Install the wiring harness connector to the ABM and push down on the release to secure the
connector.
5. Install negative battery cable to the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Trailer Brake Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 201
Component : MODULE-BRAKE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-BRAKE PROVISION
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z998 18BK
2 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 18WT/TN
3 TRAILER TOW BRAKE B(+) B40 14DG
4 FUSED B(+) A400 14TN/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 92
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 93
Trailer Brake Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 201
Component : MODULE-BRAKE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-BRAKE PROVISION
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z998 18BK
2 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 18WT/TN
3 TRAILER TOW BRAKE B(+) B40 14DG
4 FUSED B(+) A400 14TN/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 94
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 99
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 100
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 101
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 102
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 103
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram Trucks from 2006 to 2009, do not use a horn relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 108
Horn Relay: Description and Operation
Dodge Ram Trucks from 2006 to 2009, do not use a horn relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Parking Lamp Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram Trucks, 2006-2009 all, do not use a parking lamp relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 112
Parking Lamp Relay: Description and Operation
Dodge Ram Trucks, 2006-2009 all, do not use a parking lamp relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Trailer Lighting Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram Trucks, 2006-2009 all,Trailer Tow lamp relay is not serviceable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 116
Trailer Lighting Relay: Diagrams
Dodge Ram Trucks, 2006-2009 all, do not use a trailer tow relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Power Distribution Module: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 126
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 127
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 128
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 129
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition
Power Distribution Module: Customer Interest Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start
Condition
NUMBER: 08-007-08 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: July 04,2008
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-007-08, DATED MARCH
04, 2008. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO
HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
DO NOT ORDER PART NUMBER 05026070AP UNTIL JULY 21, 2008. ALL OTHER PART
NUMBERS ARE AVAILABLE NOW.
SUBJECT: No Engine Crank Or No Engine Start Due To Electronic Lockup Of The WCM /
SKREEM
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the replacement of the Wireless Control Module (WCM), and if
equipped, the replacement of the Electric Steering Column Lock (ELV). The WCM is also referred
to as the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM).
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DR/DH/D1/DC/DM) Ram Truck (1500/2500/3500/4500/5500)
2007 - 2008 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2008 (J1) Sebring (China)
2007 - 2008 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro
2008 (KK) Liberty/Cherokee
2007 - 2008 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2007 - 2008 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2008 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built on or before May 05, 2008 (MDH 0505XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customer will experience a no engine crank AND a no engine start
condition. Also, the remote keyless entry (RKE) system will not operate. This condition may be due
to an electrostatic discharge (ESD) from the ignition key into the Wireless Control Module (WCM),
causing the WCM to electronically lockup. This condition may occur more frequently in dry and/or
cold weather conditions where a sufficient electrostatic charge is more easily produced. This
condition is corrected by the replacement of the WCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. With the condition present (i.e. the vehicle in the no crank / no start condition), connect the
StarSCAN(R) scan tool to the vehicle.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON position, and power up the StarSCAN(R).
3. If the WCM is electronically locked up, the StarSCAN(R) will display the WCM as being "off bus".
4. If the no crank / no start condition is present, and the WCM is "off bus", then reset the WCM by
temporarily removing the IOD fuse (with the key out of the ignition switch), wait for 10 seconds and
then reinstall the IOD fuse.
5. With the IOD fuse reset having been performed, verify that the vehicle will now crank, start, and
run.
6. If the condition is temporarily corrected by performing the above steps, and if the part number of
the WCM is earlier than the part number of the WCM listed in the part reference table in the
Service Bulletin Parts Required Section below, then perform the Repair Procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 134
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
The part numbers listed in the following part reference table are to be used as A GUIDE to help
determine if the WCM, that is currently in the vehicle, may require replacement. If it is determined
that the WCM requires replacement, then ALWAYS REFER TO THE PARTS MANUAL to
determine the correct WCM for the specific vehicle in question. In some earlier model years, the
WCM may rule (supersede) to one of the part numbers listed in the table. ALWAYS REFER TO
THE PARTS MANUAL (not the part reference table) to determine the correct part number ruling
(supercedence / substitution). MAKE CERTAIN THAT THE CORRECT WCM IS ORDERED THE
FIRST TIME FOR THE SPECIFIC VEHICLE IN QUESTION.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 135
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If the vehicle (a JS model vehicle in certain International markets) is equipped with an Electric
Steering Column Lock (ELV), then the WCM and the ELV must be replaced. Replace the WCM
and then the ELV. Next program the WCM and at least one (1) ignition key BEFORE programming
the ELV. IMPORTANT: Not following this repair process correctly will cause the new ELV to fail.
NOTE:
Insert the ignition key into the ignition lock cylinder. This will move the shaft lock module locking
bolt to the unlocked position. LEAVE the key in the lock cylinder while the shaft lock module is
being removed.
1. If vehicle is equipped with a Steering Shaft Lock Module (JS - Avenger I Stratus - some
International Markets), then the Shaft Lock Module will require replacement. From the Service Info
tab select: 8 - Electrical > Vehicle Theft Security - Security Information > Module, Shaft Lock >
Removal and Installation.
NOTE:
The shaft lock module cannot be removed from the steering column while the locking bolt is in the
locked position without irreversibly damaging the column. Before attempting service, the ignition
key must have been inserted into the ignition lock cylinder. Then rotate the steering wheel from
side to side. If the steering wheel can be rotated, the locking bolt is in the unlocked position. Leave
the key in the ignition lock cylinder until shaft lock module removal has been completed. If the
steering wheel cannot be rotated, test and repair the wiring circuits between the module and the
ignition switch as required. If no problem is found in these circuits, the module has failed with the
locking bolt in the locked position and both the module and the steering column must be replaced
with new units.
2. Replace the WCM/SKREEM. Refer to TechCONNECT for detailed service information. From the
Service Info tab select: 8 - Electrical > Vehicle Theft Security - Service Information > Module,
Sentry Key Remote Entry > Removal and Installation.
NOTE:
Obtain the vehicle PIN number prior to programming WCM/SKREEM or ELV.
NOTE:
If during the following steps the PIN number is properly entered but is rejected, then reenter the
PIN number again until it is accepted.
3. After both the WCM/SKREEM and the ELV (if equipped) have been replaced, Program the
WCM/SKREEM as follows:
a. Turn the ignition key to the ON position, (Engine Off)
b. Connect the scan tool (StarSCAN(R)) to the data link connector and turn the ignition to the RUN
position, (engine off).
c. Select "ECU View."
d. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "Misc. Functions."
f. Scroll to "WCM Replaced."
g. Press "Start".
h. Press "Next".
i. Select "Show Keyboard".
j. Enter the vehicle PIN number.
k. Select "Next".
l. Verify PIN is correct.
m. Select "Next".
n. Follow on-screen prompts to complete WCM function programing for Tire Pressure Monitoring
(TPM) and so on.
0. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. Wait 30 seconds.
p. Turn the ignition key to the ON position, (Engine Off)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 136
q. Select "ECU View".
r. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
s. Select "Misc. Functions."
t. Select "Program Ign. Keys" and follow on-screen prompts.
u. Select "Complete".
v. Verify ignition key will start vehicle and the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions operate.
CAUTION:
If the vehicle is equipped with a Shaft Lock Module (used in some International Markets on JS
model vehicles), then at least one (1 ignition key must have been programmed to the new WCM
BEFORE the new Shaft Lock Module is "married" to the new WCM.
4. Is the vehicle equipped with Steering Shaft Lock Module (ELV)?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 5.
b. No >>Repair is complete.
5. Program the ELV as follows;
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll to "ELV Replaced."
e. Press "Start".
f. When complete, verify steering shaft lock mechanism is operating. Remove and insert key from
the ignition lock cylinder and listen for solenoid "click at lower end of column.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Distribution
Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 137
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Power Distribution Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 143
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 144
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 145
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 146
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition
Power Distribution Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No
Start Condition
NUMBER: 08-007-08 REV. A
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: July 04,2008
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-007-08, DATED MARCH
04, 2008. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO
HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
DO NOT ORDER PART NUMBER 05026070AP UNTIL JULY 21, 2008. ALL OTHER PART
NUMBERS ARE AVAILABLE NOW.
SUBJECT: No Engine Crank Or No Engine Start Due To Electronic Lockup Of The WCM /
SKREEM
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the replacement of the Wireless Control Module (WCM), and if
equipped, the replacement of the Electric Steering Column Lock (ELV). The WCM is also referred
to as the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM).
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DR/DH/D1/DC/DM) Ram Truck (1500/2500/3500/4500/5500)
2007 - 2008 (JK) Wrangler
2007 - 2008 (J1) Sebring (China)
2007 - 2008 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro
2008 (KK) Liberty/Cherokee
2007 - 2008 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2007 - 2008 (PM) Caliber
2006 - 2008 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles built on or before May 05, 2008 (MDH 0505XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customer will experience a no engine crank AND a no engine start
condition. Also, the remote keyless entry (RKE) system will not operate. This condition may be due
to an electrostatic discharge (ESD) from the ignition key into the Wireless Control Module (WCM),
causing the WCM to electronically lockup. This condition may occur more frequently in dry and/or
cold weather conditions where a sufficient electrostatic charge is more easily produced. This
condition is corrected by the replacement of the WCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. With the condition present (i.e. the vehicle in the no crank / no start condition), connect the
StarSCAN(R) scan tool to the vehicle.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the "ON position, and power up the StarSCAN(R).
3. If the WCM is electronically locked up, the StarSCAN(R) will display the WCM as being "off bus".
4. If the no crank / no start condition is present, and the WCM is "off bus", then reset the WCM by
temporarily removing the IOD fuse (with the key out of the ignition switch), wait for 10 seconds and
then reinstall the IOD fuse.
5. With the IOD fuse reset having been performed, verify that the vehicle will now crank, start, and
run.
6. If the condition is temporarily corrected by performing the above steps, and if the part number of
the WCM is earlier than the part number of the WCM listed in the part reference table in the
Service Bulletin Parts Required Section below, then perform the Repair Procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 151
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
The part numbers listed in the following part reference table are to be used as A GUIDE to help
determine if the WCM, that is currently in the vehicle, may require replacement. If it is determined
that the WCM requires replacement, then ALWAYS REFER TO THE PARTS MANUAL to
determine the correct WCM for the specific vehicle in question. In some earlier model years, the
WCM may rule (supersede) to one of the part numbers listed in the table. ALWAYS REFER TO
THE PARTS MANUAL (not the part reference table) to determine the correct part number ruling
(supercedence / substitution). MAKE CERTAIN THAT THE CORRECT WCM IS ORDERED THE
FIRST TIME FOR THE SPECIFIC VEHICLE IN QUESTION.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 152
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
If the vehicle (a JS model vehicle in certain International markets) is equipped with an Electric
Steering Column Lock (ELV), then the WCM and the ELV must be replaced. Replace the WCM
and then the ELV. Next program the WCM and at least one (1) ignition key BEFORE programming
the ELV. IMPORTANT: Not following this repair process correctly will cause the new ELV to fail.
NOTE:
Insert the ignition key into the ignition lock cylinder. This will move the shaft lock module locking
bolt to the unlocked position. LEAVE the key in the lock cylinder while the shaft lock module is
being removed.
1. If vehicle is equipped with a Steering Shaft Lock Module (JS - Avenger I Stratus - some
International Markets), then the Shaft Lock Module will require replacement. From the Service Info
tab select: 8 - Electrical > Vehicle Theft Security - Security Information > Module, Shaft Lock >
Removal and Installation.
NOTE:
The shaft lock module cannot be removed from the steering column while the locking bolt is in the
locked position without irreversibly damaging the column. Before attempting service, the ignition
key must have been inserted into the ignition lock cylinder. Then rotate the steering wheel from
side to side. If the steering wheel can be rotated, the locking bolt is in the unlocked position. Leave
the key in the ignition lock cylinder until shaft lock module removal has been completed. If the
steering wheel cannot be rotated, test and repair the wiring circuits between the module and the
ignition switch as required. If no problem is found in these circuits, the module has failed with the
locking bolt in the locked position and both the module and the steering column must be replaced
with new units.
2. Replace the WCM/SKREEM. Refer to TechCONNECT for detailed service information. From the
Service Info tab select: 8 - Electrical > Vehicle Theft Security - Service Information > Module,
Sentry Key Remote Entry > Removal and Installation.
NOTE:
Obtain the vehicle PIN number prior to programming WCM/SKREEM or ELV.
NOTE:
If during the following steps the PIN number is properly entered but is rejected, then reenter the
PIN number again until it is accepted.
3. After both the WCM/SKREEM and the ELV (if equipped) have been replaced, Program the
WCM/SKREEM as follows:
a. Turn the ignition key to the ON position, (Engine Off)
b. Connect the scan tool (StarSCAN(R)) to the data link connector and turn the ignition to the RUN
position, (engine off).
c. Select "ECU View."
d. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
e. Select "Misc. Functions."
f. Scroll to "WCM Replaced."
g. Press "Start".
h. Press "Next".
i. Select "Show Keyboard".
j. Enter the vehicle PIN number.
k. Select "Next".
l. Verify PIN is correct.
m. Select "Next".
n. Follow on-screen prompts to complete WCM function programing for Tire Pressure Monitoring
(TPM) and so on.
0. Turn the ignition key to the OFF position. Wait 30 seconds.
p. Turn the ignition key to the ON position, (Engine Off)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 153
q. Select "ECU View".
r. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
s. Select "Misc. Functions."
t. Select "Program Ign. Keys" and follow on-screen prompts.
u. Select "Complete".
v. Verify ignition key will start vehicle and the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) functions operate.
CAUTION:
If the vehicle is equipped with a Shaft Lock Module (used in some International Markets on JS
model vehicles), then at least one (1 ignition key must have been programmed to the new WCM
BEFORE the new Shaft Lock Module is "married" to the new WCM.
4. Is the vehicle equipped with Steering Shaft Lock Module (ELV)?
a. Yes >> Proceed to Step # 5.
b. No >>Repair is complete.
5. Program the ELV as follows;
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Scroll down and select "WCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "Misc. Functions".
d. Scroll to "ELV Replaced."
e. Press "Start".
f. When complete, verify steering shaft lock mechanism is operating. Remove and insert key from
the ignition lock cylinder and listen for solenoid "click at lower end of column.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power
Distribution Module: > 08-007-08A > Jul > 08 > Antitheft System - Engine No Crank/No Start Condition > Page 154
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead
Power Distribution Module: Locations Module-Electronic Overhead
Component ID: 202
Component : MODULE-ELECTRONIC OVERHEAD
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ELECTRONIC OVERHEAD
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5 GROUND Z13 20BK/WT
6--
Component Location - 53
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 157
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 158
Power Distribution Module: Locations Module-Totally Integrated Power
Component ID: 213
Component : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C1
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 14
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
2 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
2 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
2 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
3-4 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
5 WIPER PARK SWITCH SENSE W7 20BR/GY
6-7-8 WASHER FLUID SWITCH RETURN G932 20VT/TN
9 WASHER FLUID SWITCH SENSE W1 20BR/TN
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
11 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
12 - 13 - 14 - Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 159
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 160
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C10
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
2 FUSED B(+) A405 18RD/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A941 18RD
4-5 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 161
6 FUSED B(+) A310 16RD/LB
7 REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER CONTROL OUTPUT C15 14DB/WT
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F12 14PK/RD
9 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
10 - 11 HORN CONTROL OUTPUT X22 18GY/LB
12 WIPER LOW SPEED CONTROL OUTPUT W3 18BR/WT
13 GROUND Z971 18BK
14 HEATED MIRROR CONTROL OUTPUT C16 18DB/GY
15 FUSED B(+) A212 20RD/OR
16 - -
17 FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
18 FUEL PUMP CONTROL OUTPUT A109 16OR/RD
19 HORN CONTROL OUTPUT X21 18GY/YL
20 GROUND Z953 20BK
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 FUSED B(+) A400 14TN/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 162
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 13
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 WASHER PUMP MOTOR CONTROL W10 20BR
3 IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 20RD/OR
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 163
6-7-8-9 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
10 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB
10 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
11 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
12 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SWITCH SENSE B20 20DG/OR
13 GROUND Z117 20BK/WT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 164
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A209 10RD
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F984 18PK/YL
4-5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F983 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 165
6 FUSED B(+) A205 18RD/OR
7-8 FUSED B(+) A944 20RD
9 FUSED B(+) A116 16YL/RD
10 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
11 - 12 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
12 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
13 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F921 20PK/LB
14 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
15 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
16 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
17 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F942 10PK/LG
18 TRAILER TOW LEFT TURN RELAY OUTPUTL673 18YL
19 TRAILER TOW RIGHT TURN RELAY OUTPUT L674 18LG
20 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
21 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
22 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F12 14PK/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 166
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C4
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 13
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z118 16BK/YL
2 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
3 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
4-5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 167
6-7-8 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
9 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
10 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
11 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
12 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
13 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 168
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C5
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT TURN LAMP DRIVER L61 20WT/LG
2 RIGHT FRONT TURN LAMP DRIVER L60 20WT/TN
3 RIGHT HIGH BEAM DRIVER L34 20WT/GY
4 LEFT LOW BEAM DRIVER L43 20WT/DB
5 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 169
6-7-8 AAT SIGNAL G31 20VT/LG
9 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
10 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 170
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C6
Color : BROWN
# of pins : 16
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
2 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (+) D52 20WT/LB
3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 LEFT REAR TURN LAMP DRIVER L63 20WT/DG
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 171
6 RIGHT REAR TURN LAMP DRIVER L62 20WT/YL
7 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 20WT/TN
8-9 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
10 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (-) D51 20WT/BR
11 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
12 - 13 - 14 - 15 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
16 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 172
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C7
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 14
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 RIGHT LOW BEAM DRIVER L44 20WT/TN
4 LEFT HIGH BEAM DRIVER L33 20WT/LG
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 173
6-7 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 20LB/OR
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
9-10 - 11 - 12 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 20LB/BR
13 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 20BK/LB
14 IGNITION START T751 20YL
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 174
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C8
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A919 20RD
3 FUSED B(+) A106 20LB/RD
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F100 20PK/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 175
6 FUSED B(+) A100 14RD/VT
7 FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
8 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
9 FUSED B(+) A103 18GY/RD
10 FOG LAMP CONTROL OUTPUT L89 18WT/YL
11 BACKUP LAMP FEED L1 18WT/LG
12 FUEL HEATER CONTROL OUTPUT A961 14RD
12 CONDENSER FAN CONTROL OUTPUT C123 12LB/WT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 176
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C9
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
2 STARTER MOTOR CONTROL OUTPUT T750 14YL/GY
3 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL OUTPUT C3 20DB/YL
4 WIPER MOTOR HIGH SPEED FEED W4 16BR/OR
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 177
6 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 10PK/YL
7-8 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L7 20WT/YL
9 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L678 18BR
10 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L70 20WT/GY
11 - 12 FUSED B(+) A107 12TN/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 178
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER-EYELET
Color : # of pins :
1
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A0 6RD
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 179
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 180
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER-EYELET
Color : # of pins :
1
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A11 8LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A0 6RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 181
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 182
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 183
Power Distribution Module: Locations Auxiliary PDC Box
Component ID: 22
Component : AUXILIARY PDC BOX
Connector:
Name : AUXILIARY PDC BOX
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (UPFITTER PACKAGE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
2
3 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
4 FUSED B(+) A422 14RD
5 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
6 FUSED B(+) A423 14PK
7
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F922 16PK/RD
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
10 GROUND Z912 20BK
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 184
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Module-Electronic Overhead
Component ID: 202
Component : MODULE-ELECTRONIC OVERHEAD
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ELECTRONIC OVERHEAD
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5 GROUND Z13 20BK/WT
6--
Component Location - 53
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 187
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 188
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Module-Totally Integrated Power
Component ID: 213
Component : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C1
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 14
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
2 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
2 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
2 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
3-4 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
5 WIPER PARK SWITCH SENSE W7 20BR/GY
6-7-8 WASHER FLUID SWITCH RETURN G932 20VT/TN
9 WASHER FLUID SWITCH SENSE W1 20BR/TN
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
11 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
12 - 13 - 14 - Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 189
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 190
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C10
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
2 FUSED B(+) A405 18RD/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A941 18RD
4-5 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 191
6 FUSED B(+) A310 16RD/LB
7 REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER CONTROL OUTPUT C15 14DB/WT
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F12 14PK/RD
9 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
10 - 11 HORN CONTROL OUTPUT X22 18GY/LB
12 WIPER LOW SPEED CONTROL OUTPUT W3 18BR/WT
13 GROUND Z971 18BK
14 HEATED MIRROR CONTROL OUTPUT C16 18DB/GY
15 FUSED B(+) A212 20RD/OR
16 - -
17 FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
18 FUEL PUMP CONTROL OUTPUT A109 16OR/RD
19 HORN CONTROL OUTPUT X21 18GY/YL
20 GROUND Z953 20BK
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 FUSED B(+) A400 14TN/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 192
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 13
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 WASHER PUMP MOTOR CONTROL W10 20BR
3 IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F20 20PK/WT
4 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 20RD/OR
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 193
6-7-8-9 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
10 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB
10 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
11 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
12 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SWITCH SENSE B20 20DG/OR
13 GROUND Z117 20BK/WT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 194
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 22
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A209 10RD
2-3 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F984 18PK/YL
4-5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F983 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 195
6 FUSED B(+) A205 18RD/OR
7-8 FUSED B(+) A944 20RD
9 FUSED B(+) A116 16YL/RD
10 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
11 - 12 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
12 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
13 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F921 20PK/LB
14 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
15 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
16 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
17 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F942 10PK/LG
18 TRAILER TOW LEFT TURN RELAY OUTPUTL673 18YL
19 TRAILER TOW RIGHT TURN RELAY OUTPUT L674 18LG
20 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
21 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
22 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F12 14PK/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 196
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C4
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 13
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z118 16BK/YL
2 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
3 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
4-5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 197
6-7-8 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
9 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
10 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
11 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
12 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
13 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 198
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C5
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT TURN LAMP DRIVER L61 20WT/LG
2 RIGHT FRONT TURN LAMP DRIVER L60 20WT/TN
3 RIGHT HIGH BEAM DRIVER L34 20WT/GY
4 LEFT LOW BEAM DRIVER L43 20WT/DB
5 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 199
6-7-8 AAT SIGNAL G31 20VT/LG
9 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
10 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 200
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C6
Color : BROWN
# of pins : 16
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
2 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (+) D52 20WT/LB
3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 LEFT REAR TURN LAMP DRIVER L63 20WT/DG
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 201
6 RIGHT REAR TURN LAMP DRIVER L62 20WT/YL
7 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 20WT/TN
8-9 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
10 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (-) D51 20WT/BR
11 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
12 - 13 - 14 - 15 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
16 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 202
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C7
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 14
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 RIGHT LOW BEAM DRIVER L44 20WT/TN
4 LEFT HIGH BEAM DRIVER L33 20WT/LG
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 203
6-7 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 20LB/OR
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
9-10 - 11 - 12 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 20LB/BR
13 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 20BK/LB
14 IGNITION START T751 20YL
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 204
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C8
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 FUSED B(+) A919 20RD
3 FUSED B(+) A106 20LB/RD
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F100 20PK/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 205
6 FUSED B(+) A100 14RD/VT
7 FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
8 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
9 FUSED B(+) A103 18GY/RD
10 FOG LAMP CONTROL OUTPUT L89 18WT/YL
11 BACKUP LAMP FEED L1 18WT/LG
12 FUEL HEATER CONTROL OUTPUT A961 14RD
12 CONDENSER FAN CONTROL OUTPUT C123 12LB/WT
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 206
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER C9
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A111 16DG/RD
2 STARTER MOTOR CONTROL OUTPUT T750 14YL/GY
3 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL OUTPUT C3 20DB/YL
4 WIPER MOTOR HIGH SPEED FEED W4 16BR/OR
5 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 207
6 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 10PK/YL
7-8 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L7 20WT/YL
9 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L678 18BR
10 FUSED PARK LAMP FEED L70 20WT/GY
11 - 12 FUSED B(+) A107 12TN/RD
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 208
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER-EYELET
Color : # of pins :
1
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A0 6RD
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 209
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 210
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TOTALLY INTEGRATED POWER-EYELET
Color : # of pins :
1
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A11 8LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 B(+) A0 6RD
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 211
Component Location - 33
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 212
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 213
Power Distribution Module: Diagrams Auxiliary PDC Box
Component ID: 22
Component : AUXILIARY PDC BOX
Connector:
Name : AUXILIARY PDC BOX
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (UPFITTER PACKAGE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
2
3 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
4 FUSED B(+) A422 14RD
5 FUSED B(+) A420 10RD
6 FUSED B(+) A423 14PK
7
8 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F922 16PK/RD
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
10 GROUND Z912 20BK
Component Location - 34
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Electronic Overhead > Page 214
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Totally Integrated Power Module (2)(TIPM) is a combination unit that performs the functions of
the Power Distribution Center (PDC) and the Front Control Module. The TIPM is a printed circuit
board based module that contains fuses, internal relays and a microprocessor that performs the
functions previously executed by the FCM. The TIPM (2) is located in the engine compartment,
next to the battery (1) and connects directly to the B+ cable (5) via a stud located on top of the unit.
The ground connection is via electrical connectors. The TIPM provides the primary means of
voltage distribution and protection for the entire vehicle.
The molded plastic TIPM housing includes a base and cover. The TIPM cover is easily opened or
removed for service and has a fuse and relay layout map integral to the inside surface of the cover.
The TIPM housing base and cover are secured in place via mounting tabs. The mounting tabs
secure the TIPM (2) to the battery tray mounting bracket (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 217
Power Distribution Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
All of the current from the battery and the generator output enters the Totally Integrated Power
Module (TIPM) via a stud on the top of the module. The TIPM cover is removed to access the fuses
or relays. Internal connections of all of the power distribution center circuits is accomplished by a
combination of bus bars and a printed circuit board.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the B+ terminal nut (6) from the Totally Integrated Power Module (2)(TIPM) B+ terminal.
Remove the B+ cable (5) from the TIPM (2).
3. Using a suitable flat blade tool, disengage the TIPM (2) upper retaining tabs from the battery tray
bracket (3).
4. Grasp the TIPM (1) and rotate the assembly up to free it from its mounting bracket (3). Position
the assembly upside down to access the electrical
connectors located on the bottom of the unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 220
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors (2) by depressing the locking tab and rotating the connector
arm outboard, until the connector is free from the
TIPM assembly (1). Be certain to pull the connectors straight off.
6. Remove the TIPM (1) from the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 221
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the Totally Integrated Power Module (1)(TIPM) into the vehicle.
NOTE: Totally Integrated power module electrical connectors are color coded to ease location
reference.
2. Connect the electrical connectors (2) by pushing straight on and rotating the connector arm
inboard, until the connector is firmly locked in place
on the TIPM assembly (1).
3. Turn the TIPM (1) so that the connector side is facing down. Install the assembly onto the TIPM
battery tray bracket (3) making sure to line up the
lower retaining tab with the retaining slot in the tray (1).
4. Push the TIPM (1) downward to lock the upper retaining clips into the bracket (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 222
5. Install the B+ terminal cable (5) and nut (6) on the B+ terminal of the TIPM (2).
6. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Relay Box: Locations Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 227
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 228
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 229
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 232
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 233
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 234
Relay Box: Application and ID Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 241
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 242
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 243
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 244
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 245
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 246
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 247
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 248
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 249
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 250
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 251
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 252
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 253
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 254
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 255
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 256
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 257
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 258
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 267
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 268
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 269
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 270
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 271
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 272
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 273
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 279
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 284
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 285
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 286
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 287
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page
293
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 298
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 299
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 300
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 301
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 306
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 307
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 308
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 309
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 310
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 311
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 312
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 322
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 327
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 328
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 329
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 330
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed Limit
Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 340
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 341
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 342
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 343
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 344
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 345
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 346
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 353
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 354
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 355
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 356
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 357
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 358
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 359
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 360
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 361
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 362
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 363
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 364
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 365
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 366
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 367
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 368
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 369
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
123456-
789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 32 -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 370
33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 371
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 372
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 373
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 374
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 375
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 376
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 377
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 378
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 379
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 380
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 381
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 382
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 383
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 384
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 385
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 386
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 389
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 390
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 391
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 392
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 393
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 394
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 395
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 396
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 397
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 398
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 399
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 400
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 401
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 402
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 403
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 404
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 405
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 406
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 407
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 408
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 409
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 410
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 411
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 412
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 413
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 414
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 415
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 416
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 417
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 418
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 419
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 420
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 421
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 422
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 423
Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 424
Pin Description Circuit
123456789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 -
32 33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 425
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 426
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 427
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 428
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 429
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 430
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 431
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 432
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 433
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 434
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 435
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 436
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 437
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 438
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 439
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 440
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 441
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
CUMMINS FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 444
The Engine Control Module (ECM) for the 5.9L diesel engine (16) is bolted to the left side of the
engine below the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 445
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The main function of the Engine Control Module (ECM) is to electrically control the fuel system.
The ECM also controls certain transmission and other functions previously controlled by the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
The ECM receives input signals from various switches and sensors. Based on these inputs, the
ECM regulates various engine and vehicle operations through different system components. These
components are referred to as ECM Outputs. The sensors and switches that provide inputs to the
ECM are considered ECM Inputs.
NOTE: ECM Inputs:
- Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) Signals #1 and #2
- AC system pressure
- Auto shutdown (ASD) sense
- Battery temperature
- Battery temperature sensor
- Battery voltage
- Brake switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP)
- Data link connection for a scan tool
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
- EATX module (if equipped)
- Fuel level
- Fuel pressure sensor
- Fan speed (engine cooling fan)
- Generator (battery voltage) output
- Governor pressure (Auto. trans.)
- Ground circuits
- Inlet air temperature sensor/pressure sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor/MAP sensor
- CAN C BUS (+) circuits
- CAN C BUS (-) circuits
- Key switch (ignition)
- Oil Pressure switch
- Overdrive switch (automatic transmission only)
- Park/neutral switch (auto. trans. only)
- Power ground
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Sensor return
- Signal ground
- Speed control multiplexed single wire input
- Transfer case switch (4WD range position)
- Transmission governor psi (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission OSS (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil pressure (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil temperature (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve position (automatic transmission only)
- Vehicle speed signal
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor
NOTE: ECM Outputs:
After inputs are received by the ECM, certain sensors, switches and components are controlled or
regulated by the ECM. These are considered ECM Outputs. These outputs are for:
- A/C clutch relay
- Auto shutdown (ASD) relay
- Data link connection for diagnostic scan tool
- Fan clutch PWM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 446
- Five volt sensor supply (primary)
- Five volt sensor supply (secondary)
- Fuel control actuator
- Fuel injector driver circuits
- Fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Generator field driver (-)
- Generator field driver (+)
- Governor pressure (VFS solenoid)
- Intake manifold air heater relays #1 and #2 control circuits
- CAN C BUS (+/-) circuits for: speedometer, voltmeter, fuel gauge, oil pressure gauge/lamp,
engine temp. gauge and speed control warn. lamp
- Malfunction indicator lamp (Check engine lamp). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- Oil pressure switch/warning lamp (databus)
- Overdrive/3-4 shift solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- SC source
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Speed control vacuum solenoid
- Speed control vent solenoid
- Tachometer (if equipped). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- TCC solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission battery relay (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve actuator (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission governor solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Wait-to-start warning lamp (databus)
- Turbo wastegate solenoid
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) warning lamp (databus)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection PCM/ECM Programming
PCM/ECM REPROGRAMMING
MODULE REPROGRAMING
Replacement PCM's will require programming utilizing the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. The PCM
will not operate the engine until it is programmed. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will be set "not programmed".
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a calibration is selected and programmed, the controller
cannot be reprogrammed to a different calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a
more recent version of that calibration.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT OR EQUIVALENT REQUIRED:
**REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity.
However, in order to take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent for your dealership's network.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
5. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
6. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM. 7. Program the PCM as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen, Select "ECU View" b. Touch the
screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 449
f. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 5.
g. Select "Download to Scantool". h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select
"Back". i.
Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK". l.
Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part number.
8. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 9. b. No >> go to STEP 10.
9. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM).
a. Highlight the WCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c. Highlight "PCM Replaced". d. Select "Start" e.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step. f.
When complete proceed to STEP 11.
10. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
11. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 13. b. No >> go to STEP 12.
12. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select ECU View b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select Misc.
Function. d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select Next after each step . Select Finish after completing the
last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the Home screen select System View. Then select All DTCs. Press Clear All
Stored DTCs if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM and/or TCM.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
REPAIR PROCEDURE USING SOFTWARE UPDATE CD TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 450
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
3. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
5. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM.
6. Insert the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software Update CD into the Techconnect or equivalent
PC. The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software
Update CD will start automatically. Select "Download Flash Updates".
7. At the "Select a method for looking up controller flash updates." screen:
a. Select "Enter part number". Enter the "Part Number" recorded in STEP 4 when prompted to do
so. b. Using the mouse highlight the appropriate "Calibration". Select "Next". c. Follow the on
screen instructions. d. When completed, proceed to STEP 8.
8. With the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent powered OFF, connect the USB Key and Gender Changer
to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent USB port .
9. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent to the vehicle (if not already connected).
10. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
11. Download the flash file from the USB key to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. Using the
StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "Flash Download", then select "Retrieve files from the USB storage device" b. Highlight
the appropriate calibration. Select "Download to Scan Tool" c. When the download is complete,
select "Close" and "Back".
12. Reprogram the ECU. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View". b. Select More Options". c. Select "ECU Flash". d. Highlight the appropriate
calibration. e. Select "Update Controller". Follow the on screen instructions. f.
When the update is complete, select "OK".
g. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part
number.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 451
13. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 14. b. No >> go to STEP 15.
14. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM). Using the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the WCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "PCM Replaced". e. Select "Start". f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
g. When complete proceed to STEP 16.
15. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
16. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 18. b. No >> go to STEP 17.
17. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
Check all modules using "ECU View" from the Home screen, record the DTC's, and erase these
DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all
other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE: The following step is required by law.
18. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 452
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection SKREEM Programming
SKREEM PROGRAMMING
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) for a gasoline engine, or an Engine Control Module
(ECM) for a diesel engine and the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the
Wireless Control Module/WCM) on vehicles equipped with the Sentry Key Immobilizer System
(SKIS) are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new PCM/ECM.
2. Program the new SKREEM/WCM.
3. Replace all ignition keys and program them into the new SKREEM/WCM.
PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKREEM/WCM. This code is
programmed and stored in the SKREEM/WCM, the PCM/ECM, and each ignition key transponder
chip. When the PCM/ECM or SKREEM/WCM is replaced, it is necessary to program the Secret
Key into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool. Follow the programming steps outlined in
the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, ECM REPLACED, WCM REPLACED, or
GATEWAY REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL
MODULE/WCM menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Be certain to enter the correct country code for the SKREEM/WCM. If the incorrect country
code is programmed into the SKREEM, it cannot be changed and the SKREEM must be replaced.
NOTE: In addition, the SKREEM/WCM must be configured for certain optional equipment in the
vehicle, including Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM), Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) and Remote Start.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool under MISCELLANEOUS
FUNCTIONS for the WCM/WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: A replacement SKREEM/WCM is supplied with TPM enabled by default; therefore, if the
vehicle is not equipped with TPM, the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) will incorrectly
learn that the vehicle has TPM after the replacement SKREEM is installed. The TPM indicator in
the EMIC will illuminate to show a TPM fault condition after TPM has been disabled in the
SKREEM. The EMIC must unlearn TPM to correct this false TPM indication. Follow the
programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for CLEAR LEARNED FEATURES under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the INSTRUMENT CLUSTER menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: If the PCM/ECM and the SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle ignition
keys will need to be replaced and the new keys programmed into the new SKREEM/WCM.
NOTE: Programming the PCM/ECM or SKREEM is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to
enter secure access mode. If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an
incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn
the ignition to the RUN position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all
accessories are turned OFF. Also monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if
necessary.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKREEM
Each ignition key transponder also has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is
manufactured. When a key is programmed into the SKREEM/WCM, the transponder ID code is
learned by the module and the transponder acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the
SKREEM/WCM. To program ignition keys into the SKREEM/WCM, follow the programming steps
outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS OR KEY FOBS under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE/WCM menu item.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKREEM. Once a key is learned to a
SKREEM, that key has acquired the Secret Key for that SKREEM and cannot be transferred to any
other SKREEM or vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the scan tool will display one of the following error
messages:
- PROGRAMMING NOT ATTEMPTED - The scan tool attempts to read the programmed key status
and there are no keys programmed into SKREEM memory.
- PROGRAMMING KEY FAILED (POSSIBLE USED KEY FROM WRONG VEHICLE) - SKREEM is
unable to program an ignition key transponder due to one of the following:
- The ignition key transponder is ineffective.
- The ignition key transponder is or has been already programmed to another vehicle.
- 8 KEYS ALREADY LEARNED, PROGRAMMING NOT DONE - The SKREEM transponder ID
memory is full.
- LEARNED KEY IN IGNITION - The ID for the ignition key transponder currently in the ignition lock
cylinder is already programmed into SKREEM memory.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 453
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Programming The SKREEM/WCM Using The Scan
Tool
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM/WCM USING THE SCAN TOOL
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle.
2. Connect the scan tool.
CAUTION: If the ECM/PCM and SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, the ECM/PCM
MUST be programmed before the SKREEM/WCM.
3. Select "ECU View".
4. Select "WCM Wireless Control Module".
5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions".
6. Select WCM replaced.
7. Enter the PIN when prompted.
8. Verify the correct information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL
The Engine Control Module (ECM) (5) is located on the left side of the engine. A support bracket
mounts to the block with four capscrews and vibration isolators. A ground wire is fastened to the
bracket. The other end of the wire is fastened to the engine block.
1. Record any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) found in the ECM.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to the ECM, ignition key must be off, and both negative
battery cables must be disconnected before unplugging ECM connectors.
2. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Access to the ECM is easier by working through the left front wheel opening.
3. Remove left front wheel.
4. Remove plastic left front fender splash shield.
5. Remove electrical connector bolts at ECM. Note: As each bolt is being removed, very carefully
remove connectors from the ECM.
6. Remove three ECM mounting bolts (6) and remove ECM from engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 456
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
6.7L DIESEL
Do not apply paint to ECM or a poor ground will result.
1. Position ECM (5) to the ECM support bracket and install mounting bolts. Tighten bolts to 24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.).
2. Check pins in electrical connectors for corrosion, damage or dirt intrusion. Also check all pins for
being bent. Repair as necessary. Damaged,
dirty, bent or corroded pins could result in poor conductivity, causing intermittent electrical issues or
DTC's.
3. Clean pins in electrical connectors with an electrical contact cleaner.
4. Install connectors to ECM. Tighten connector bolts to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.).
5. Install splash shield.
6. Install left front wheel.
7. Connect both negative battery cables.
8. Use a diagnostic scan tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) from ECM.
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 457
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 461
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 462
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 463
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 464
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 465
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor Relay: Diagrams
2007-2009 Ram truck, 6.7L, use an O2 module for oxygen sensor heater control.
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 473
8w-30-17
Connector C1 pin 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 476
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 477
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 478
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 479
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 480
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 481
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 482
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 483
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 484
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 485
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 486
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 487
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 488
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 489
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 490
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 491
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 492
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 493
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 494
Fuel Pump Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 495
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel transfer pump (fuel lift pump) is part of the fuel pump module. The fuel pump module is
located in the fuel tank. The 12-volt electric pump is operated and controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM). The ECM controls a relay in the intelligent Power Module (IPM) for transfer pump
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Heater Relay: Locations
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 499
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 500
Intake Air Heater Relay: Diagrams
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 501
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 502
Intake Air Heater Relay: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Engine Control Module (ECM) operates the heating element through the intake manifold air
heater relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Disconnect relay trigger wires (4) at relays. Note position of wiring before removing.
3. Remove nuts (2) at cable connectors and disconnect cables (1) from mounting studs. Note
position of cables before removing.
4. Remove two relay mounting bracket screws (6) and remove relay assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
505
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Position relay and install two relay mounting bracket screws (6).
2. Position cables (1) to mounting studs and install nuts (2).
3. Connect relay trigger wires (4) at relays.
4. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 509
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 510
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 511
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 512
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 513
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 208
Component : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER
Connector:
Name : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER C1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 24
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5-6 PASSENGER AIRBAG INDICATOR DRIVER G104 20VT/GY
7 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH RETURN R104 20LB/LG
8 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH SENSE R106 20LG/LB
9 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R81 20LB/WT
10 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R79 20LB/VT
11 RIGHT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R82 20WT/LB
12 RIGHT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R80 20VT/LB
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R43 20LG/BR
18 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R45 20LG/OR
19 PASSENGER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R44 20LB/OR
20 PASSENGER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R42 20LB/BR
21 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R61 20LG/VT
22 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R63 20LG/WT
23 PASSENGER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R64 20LB/WT
24 PASSENGER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R62 20LB/VT
Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 518
Component Location - 63
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 519
Component Location - 51
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 520
Connector:
Name : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER C2
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 32
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R2 20WT/LB
2 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R4 20OR/LB
3 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R3 20LB/OR
4 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R1 20LB/WT
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 521
6-7-8-9 DRIVER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 2 R53 20LG/YL
10 DRIVER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 1 R55 20LG/DG
11 PASSENGER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 1R56 20LB/DG
12 PASSENGER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 2R54 20LB/YL
13 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R1 20LB/WT
14 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R3 20LB/OR
15 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R4 20OR/LB
16 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R2 20WT/LB
17 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
18 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F100 20PK/VT
19 - 20 GROUND Z104 18BK/LG
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 - 25 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR DATA R261 20LB/TN
26 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR VOLTAGER263 20LB/GY
27 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R14 20TN/LG
28 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R16 20BR/LG
29 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R15 20LG/BR
30 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R13 20LG/TN
31 - 32 - Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 522
Component Location - 63
Component Location - 51
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 523
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 524
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 208
Component : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER
Connector:
Name : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER C1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 24
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 CAN B BUS (+) D55 20WT/OR
4 CAN B BUS (-) D54 20WT
5-6 PASSENGER AIRBAG INDICATOR DRIVER G104 20VT/GY
7 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH RETURN R104 20LB/LG
8 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH SENSE R106 20LG/LB
9 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R81 20LB/WT
10 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R79 20LB/VT
11 RIGHT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R82 20WT/LB
12 RIGHT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R80 20VT/LB
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R43 20LG/BR
18 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R45 20LG/OR
19 PASSENGER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R44 20LB/OR
20 PASSENGER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R42 20LB/BR
21 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R61 20LG/VT
22 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R63 20LG/WT
23 PASSENGER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R64 20LB/WT
24 PASSENGER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R62 20LB/VT
Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 525
Component Location - 63
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 526
Component Location - 51
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 527
Connector:
Name : MODULE-OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER C2
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 32
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R2 20WT/LB
2 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R4 20OR/LB
3 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R3 20LB/OR
4 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R1 20LB/WT
5--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 528
6-7-8-9 DRIVER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 2 R53 20LG/YL
10 DRIVER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 1 R55 20LG/DG
11 PASSENGER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 1R56 20LB/DG
12 PASSENGER SEAT BELT TENSIONER LINE 2R54 20LB/YL
13 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R1 20LB/WT
14 LEFT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R3 20LB/OR
15 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R4 20OR/LB
16 RIGHT CURTAIN SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R2 20WT/LB
17 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
18 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F100 20PK/VT
19 - 20 GROUND Z104 18BK/LG
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 - 25 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR DATA R261 20LB/TN
26 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR VOLTAGER263 20LB/GY
27 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R14 20TN/LG
28 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R16 20BR/LG
29 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R15 20LG/BR
30 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R13 20LG/TN
31 - 32 - Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 529
Component Location - 63
Component Location - 51
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 530
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1) is located in the passenger compartment of the
vehicle, where it is secured by three nuts to three studs on a stamped steel mounting bracket
welded onto the top of the floor panel transmission tunnel under the center front seat or the center
floor console, as the vehicle is equipped. Concealed within a hollow in the center of the die cast
aluminum ORC housing is the electronic circuitry of the ORC which includes a microprocessor, an
electronic impact sensor, an electronic safing sensor, and an energy storage capacitor. A stamped
metal cover plate is secured to the bottom of the ORC housing with screws to enclose and protect
the internal electronic circuitry and components.
An arrow (2) printed on the label (3) on the top of the ORC housing provides a visual verification of
the proper orientation of the unit, and should always be pointed toward the front of the vehicle. The
ORC housing has integral mounting flanges on three corners. The mounting flange to the right of
the connector receptacles (4) has an integral locating pin on its lower surface. Both right side
flanges have round mounting holes, while the flange on the left side has a slotted mounting hole. A
molded plastic electrical connector (4) with 2 receptacles, one containing 24 terminal pins and the
other containing 32 terminal pins, exits the forward facing side of the ORC housing. These terminal
pins connect the ORC to the vehicle electrical system through two dedicated take outs and
connectors, one each from the instrument panel and the body wire harnesses.
A molded plastic protective cover is installed over the ORC to provide additional moisture
contamination protection to the unit. Integral latch features on each side of the cover engage a slot
(5) on each side of the base of the ORC housing to secure the cover to the ORC. This protective
cover must be reinstalled following any service requiring its removal.
The impact sensor and safing sensor internal to the ORC are calibrated for the specific vehicle, and
are only serviced as a unit with the ORC. In addition, there are unique versions of the ORC for light
and heavy-duty vehicles, and for vehicles with or without the optional side curtain airbags. The
ORC cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 533
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) contains the supplemental
restraint system logic circuits and controls all of the supplemental restraint system components.
The ORC uses On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) and can communicate with other electronic modules
in the vehicle as well as with the diagnostic scan tool using the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus. This method of communication is used for control of the airbag indicator in the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN)
and for supplemental restraint system diagnosis and testing through the 16-way Data Link
Connector (DLC) located on the driver side lower edge of the instrument panel.
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the supplemental restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets an
active and stored Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and sends electronic messages to the EMIC
over the CAN data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator. An active fault only remains for the duration
of the fault, or in some cases for the duration of the current ignition switch cycle, while a stored fault
causes a DTC to be stored in memory by the ORC. For some DTCs, if a fault does not recur for a
number of ignition cycles, the ORC will automatically erase the stored DTC. For other internal
faults, the stored DTC is latched forever.
In standard cab vehicles, the ORC also monitors a resistor multiplexed input from the passenger
airbag on/off switch. If the passenger airbag on/off switch is set to the OFF position, the ORC turns
ON the passenger airbag on/off indicator and will internally disable the passenger airbag and seat
belt tensioner from being deployed.
The ORC receives battery current through two circuits; a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit
through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM), and a fused ignition switch output
(run-start) circuit through a second fuse in the TIPM. The ORC receives ground through a ground
circuit and take out of the instrument panel wire harness. This take out has a single eyelet terminal
connector that is secured by a ground screw to the instrument panel structural support. These
connections allow the ORC to be operational whenever the ignition switch is in the START or ON
positions.
The ORC also contains an energy-storage capacitor. When the ignition switch is in the START or
ON positions, this capacitor is continually being charged with enough electrical energy to deploy
the supplemental restraint components for up to one second following a battery disconnect or
failure. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide backup supplemental restraint system protection
in case there is a loss of battery current supply to the ORC during an impact.
Two sensors are contained within the ORC, an electronic impact sensor and a safing sensor. The
ORC also monitors inputs from two remote front impact sensors located on the back of the right
and left ends of the lower radiator crossmember near the front of the vehicle. The electronic impact
sensors are accelerometers that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provide verification
of the direction and severity of an impact. On vehicles equipped with optional side curtain airbags
the ORC also monitors inputs from two additional remote impact sensors located within both the
left and right B-pillars to control deployment of the side curtain airbag units.
The safing sensor is an electronic accelerometer sensor within the ORC that provides an additional
logic input to the ORC microprocessor. The safing sensor is used to verify the need for a
supplemental restraint deployment by detecting impact energy of a lesser magnitude than that of
the primary electronic impact sensors, and must exceed a safing threshold in order for the airbags
to deploy. Vehicles equipped with optional side curtain airbags feature a second safing sensor
within the ORC to provide confirmation to the ORC microprocessor of side impact forces. This
second safing sensor is a bi-directional unit that detects impact forces from either side of the
vehicle.
Pre-programmed decision algorithms in the ORC microprocessor determine when the deceleration
rate as signaled by the impact sensors and the safing sensors indicate an impact that is severe
enough to require supplemental restraint system protection and, based upon the severity of the
monitored impact, determines the level of front airbag deployment force required for each front
seating position. When the programmed conditions are met, the ORC sends the proper electrical
signals to deploy the dual multistage front airbags at the programmed force levels, the front seat
belt tensioners and, if the vehicle is so equipped, either side curtain airbag unit. On standard cab
vehicles, the passenger front airbag and seat belt tensioner will be deployed by the ORC only if
enabled by the passenger airbag on/off switch at the time of the impact.
The hard wired inputs and outputs for the ORC may be diagnosed using conventional diagnostic
tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information. However, conventional
diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the ORC or the electronic controls
or communication between other modules and devices that provide features of the supplemental
restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the ORC or the
electronic controls and communication related to ORC operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
Module
MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the occupant restraint controller, as
it can damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The occupant restraint controller contains
the impact sensor, which enables the system to deploy the supplemental restraints. If an occupant
restraint controller is accidentally dropped during service, the module must be scrapped and
replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or
improper supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. Remove the protective cover from the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1).
3. Unlatch and disconnect the two wire harness connectors (3) for the ORC from the ORC
connector receptacles (2 and 4) located on the forward
facing side of the module. To disconnect the wire harness connectors from the ORC, depress the
release tab and lift the lever arm on each connector.
4. Remove the three nuts (2) that secure the ORC (1) to the studs on the ORC mounting bracket
(3) on the floor panel transmission tunnel.
5. Remove the ORC from the floor panel transmission tunnel.
Cover
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 536
COVER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
NOTE: The front seat assembly must be unfastened from the floor panel, but need not be removed
from the vehicle for access to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) cover for service.
2. Remove the front seat from the vehicle.
3. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the latch feature on either
side of the ORC cover (1) away from the base of
the ORC (2) far enough to disengage the cover from the module.
4. Remove the ORC cover from over the ORC.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 537
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
Module
MODULE
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the occupant restraint controller, as
it can damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The occupant restraint controller contains
the impact sensor, which enables the system to deploy the supplemental restraints. If an occupant
restraint controller is accidentally dropped during service, the module must be scrapped and
replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result in accidental, incomplete, or
improper supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Position the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (1) over the three studs of the ORC mounting
bracket (3) on the floor panel transmission tunnel,
then engage the locating pin on the bottom of the right ORC mounting flange into the locating hole
in the bracket. When the ORC is correctly positioned, the arrow on the ORC label will be pointed
forward in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the three nuts (2) that secure the ORC to the bracket on the floor panel
transmission tunnel. Tighten the nuts to 10 Nm (7 ft.
lbs.).
3. Reconnect the two wire harness connectors (3) for the ORC (1) to the ORC connector
receptacles (2 and 4) located on the forward facing side of
the module. Be certain that the latches on the connectors are each fully engaged.
4. Reinstall the ORC cover onto the ORC.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 538
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Cover
COVER
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Position the ORC cover (1) over the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) (2).
2. Align the latch feature on each side of the ORC cover with the notch in each side at the base of
the ORC housing.
3. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly downward on the ORC cover until each latch
feature is fully engaged with the ORC housing.
4. Reinstall the front seat into the vehicle.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams
Relay - Starter Motor (Except SRT)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Locations
Component ID: 212
Component : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C1
Color : WHITE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z909 20BK
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 20GY/WT
3 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
4 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
5 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
6 HORN SWITCH SENSE X3 20DG/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 548
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 549
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 550
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (PREMIUM)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SWITCH MUX RETURN G902 22WT/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SWITCH MUX RETURN G902 22WT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 551
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 22GY/WT
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 22GY/WT
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 552
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 553
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
4
Pin Description Circuit
1 HORN SWITCH SENSE X3 20DG/VT
2 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 22DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 22DB/DG
3 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 22VT
4 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 22VT/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 554
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 555
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 556
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C4
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R61 20LG/VT
2 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R63 20LG/WT
3 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R43 20LG/BR
4 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R45 20LG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 557
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 558
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 559
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 560
Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 212
Component : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C1
Color : WHITE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z909 20BK
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 20GY/WT
3 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
4 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
5 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
6 HORN SWITCH SENSE X3 20DG/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 561
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 562
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 563
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (PREMIUM)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SWITCH MUX RETURN G902 22WT/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SWITCH MUX RETURN G902 22WT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 564
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 22GY/WT
2 RADIO CONTROL MUX X20 22GY/WT
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 565
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 566
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
4
Pin Description Circuit
1 HORN SWITCH SENSE X3 20DG/VT
2 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 22DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 22DB/DG
3 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 22VT
4 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 22VT/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 567
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 568
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 569
Connector:
Name : MODULE-STEERING CONTROL C4
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 1 R61 20LG/VT
2 DRIVER SQUIB 2 LINE 2 R63 20LG/WT
3 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 1 R43 20LG/BR
4 DRIVER SQUIB 1 LINE 2 R45 20LG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 570
Component Location - 47
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 571
Component Location - 43
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules
- Steering > Steering Mounted Controls Communication Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 572
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 583
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 584
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 589
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 590
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 591
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 592
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 598
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 599
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 604
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 605
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 606
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 607
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 608
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 609
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 610
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 611
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 612
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 613
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 614
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 615
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 616
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 617
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
On gasoline vehicles the Transmission Control Module (TCM) (2) may be sub-module within the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) (3).
68RFE TCM LOCATION
Vehicles equipped 68RFE transmission and a 6.7L Diesel engine, the TCM is housed in the NGC4
controller utilizing only the C1 and C4 connectors (TCM only). The controller is located at the rear
of the engine compartment, near the right inner fender.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 620
AS68RC TCM LOCATION
On Cab Chassis models equipped with the AS68RC transmission the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) has three electrical connectors and is located in the passenger compartment underneath of
the left side of the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 621
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
RLE and RFE TRANSMISSIONS
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) (if equipped)
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Line Pressure Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids
- Torque Reduction Request
Some examples of TCM indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool)
NOTE: If the TCM has been replaced, the "Quick Learn Procedure" must be performed.
BATTERY FEED
A fused, direct battery feed to the TCM is used for continuous power. This battery voltage is
necessary to retain memory in the TCM. When the battery (B+) is disconnected, this memory is
lost. When the battery (B+) is restored, this memory loss is detected by the TCM and a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) is set.
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEXES (CVI)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 622
An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transmission gear position. This is important
to the CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the input clutch assembly can cause inadequate or
out-of-range element volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following charts identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 623
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 624
SHIFT SCHEDULES
As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules.
Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 625
AISIN AS68RC TRANSMISSION
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Speed Sensor
- Output Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Engine/Body Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 626
- Manifold Pressure
- Throttle position
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Brake Status (if equipped)
- PTO Request (if equipped)
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Exhaust Brake Cut Request (if equipped).
- Solenoids.
- Torque Reduction Request.
Some examples of TCM .indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM).
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN).
- PTO Status.
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI).
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules.
- System self-diagnostics.
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool).
Clutch filling time is continuously maintained when the vehicle is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 631
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 632
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 633
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 634
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 635
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 636
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 637
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 638
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 639
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 640
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 641
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 642
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 643
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 644
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 645
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 646
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 647
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 648
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 649
Transmission Control System Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Due to different power control configurations, the Transmission Control Relay (if equipped)
may be referred to as a PCM relay.
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TIPM, and is used to supply power to the
TCM when the transmission is in normal operating mode.
Operation
OPERATION
The TIPM energizes the transmission control relay. When the relay is "off", no power is supplied to
the TCM and the transmission will not operate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 656
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 657
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 658
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 659
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 660
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality now resides in the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM), refer to the TIPM information for location. The TIPM controls the 4X4
transfer case shift functions via the actuation of a shift motor and utilizing the feedback of a mode
sensor assembly. Communication is via the CAN bus. Inputs include user selectable 4X4 modes
that include 2WD, AWD, 4HI, 4LO, and Neutral (selections vary with the specific transfer case).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 663
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality in the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM) utilizes the input from the transfer case mounted mode sensor, the instrument panel
mounted selector switch, and the following information from the vehicle's CAN bus to determine if a
shift is allowed.
- Engine RPM and Vehicle Speed
- Diagnostic Requests
- Manual Transmission and Brake Applied
- PRNDL
- Ignition Status
- ABS Messages
Once the TIP determines that a requested shift is allowed, it actuates the bi-directional shift motor
as necessary to achieve the desired transfer case operating mode. The TIPM also monitors the
mode sensor while controlling the shift motor to determine the status of the shift attempt.
Several items can cause the requested shift not to be completed. If the TIPM has recognized a
fault (DTC) of some variety, it will begin operation in one of four Functionality Levels. These levels
are:
- Level Zero - Normal Operation.
- Level One - Only Mode Shifts Are Allowed.
- Level Two - Only Mode Shifts and Shifts Into LOW Are Allowed (No Neutral Shifts Are Allowed).
- Level Three - No Shifts Are Allowed
The TIPM can also be operating in one of three possible power modes. These power modes are:
- Full Power Mode is the normal operational mode of the module. This mode is achieved by normal
CAN bus traffic being present and the ignition being in the RUN position.
Reduced Power Mode will be entered when the ignition has been powered off. In this state, the
module will shut down power supplied to external devices, and to electronic interface inputs and
outputs. From this state the module can enter either Sleep Mode or Full Power Mode. To enter this
mode, the module must receive an ignition message denoting that the ignition is off, or not receive
any messages for 5 ± 0.5 seconds. To exit this mode, the module must receive one ignition
message that denotes that the ignition is in the RUN position.
- Sleep Mode will be entered, from the Reduced Power Mode, when no CAN traffic has been
sensed for 20 ± 1 seconds. If during Sleep Mode the module detects CAN bus traffic, it will revert
to the Reduced Power mode while monitoring for ignition messages. It will remain in this state as
long as there is traffic other than run or start messages, and will return to Sleep mode if the bus
goes without traffic for 20 ± 1 seconds.
SHIFT REQUIREMENTS
If the TIPM is in full power mode and at functionality level zero, it uses the following criteria to
determine if a shift is allowed.
If any of the driver controllable conditions are not met once the shift request is recognized, the
TIPM will solidly illuminate the source position's LED and flash the desired position's LED for all
shifts except NEUTRAL. The NEUTRAL shift LED strategy will be discussed later.
Mode shifts will be allowed regardless of transmission gear or vehicle speed, whenever the
following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector switch state indicates that a mode shift has been requested.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
Range shifts will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector Switch state indicating a range shift has been requested.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal must be recognized for at least 1.5 seconds ± 100 msec.
(Automatic transmissions only)
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Clutch signal is recognized for 500 msec ± 50 msec (Manual transmissions only).
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 664
A shift into transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 4.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus. (Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position, engine off.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
A shift out of transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 1.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus.(Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
SHIFT SEQUENCES
Once all the driver controllable conditions for the requested shift have been met, the TIPM begins a
shift timer with a maximum duration of 1 second per 'D' channel transition. If the shift timer expires
before the TIPM recognizes to correct mode sensor code, the shift is considered to have been
blocked. The blocked shift will increment the blocked shift counter by one. The TIPM strategy for
handling blocked shifts will be described later. The process the TIPM performs for the various shifts
will be described first.
RANGE AND MODE SHIFTS
The process for performing all the range and mode shifts are the same. The following steps
describe the process.
- Allow time for Selector Switch debounce; 250 msec ± 50 msec.
- Extinguish the source gear's LED while flashing desired transfer case position's LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel transition in the
destination gear's direction while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Solidly illuminate the selected gear's LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds ± 100 msec. per 'D'
channel. The TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired
position.
The exception to the preceding sequence is when a shift from 4L to 2WD/AWD is requested. If
2WD/AWD is requested from the 4L position, the transfer case is first driven to the 4H position. If
the 4H position is reached, the transfer case is then driven back to the 2WD/AWD position and the
shift is considered complete. If the transfer case does not reach any the 4H position, but is in the
2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the 2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the
shift is also considered complete.
SHIFT OUT OF NEUTRAL
The following steps describe the process for a shift out of NEUTRAL.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec toward the transfer case 4H mode
position while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds 100 msec. The
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 665
TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired position.
- When the Neutral button is released, if the 4H position is the desired position, the shift is
complete. Illuminate the 4H LED.
- Otherwise when the Neutral button is released, if all of the shift requirements are being met then
engage the shift motor towards the desired position for 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel. (if
requirements for shifting are not met, illuminate the 4H LED and flash the destination LED as an
indication to the driver that all of the driver controllable shift conditions are not being met). If this
requires another range or mode shift, begin the range/mode shift process.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (i.e. a blocked or other
condition exists), refer to Blocked Shift Strategy.
BLOCKED SHIFT STRATEGY
When a shift is commanded, the shift motor will be driven towards its destination position, except in
the case of shifting out of Neutral if 4L was selected (the transfer case will shift to the 4H position
first, before proceeding to 4L). If the shift is blocked on the way to the destination, the TIPM may
attempt to drive the motor back to the original position. This process will be allowed to occur 5
times. If the transfer case has reached a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel during the shift re-attempts,
the LED for the achieved gear position is illuminated and the shift attempts are stopped. To
re-attempt the desired shift, the selector switch will need to be rotated to the current position until
the switch debounce timer expires then a shift will need to be requested again.
At the end of the 5th blocked attempt, the shift motor is driven towards the last known 'D' channel
position. If this motor drive allows the transfer case to reach the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the
2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the shift is considered complete
and the shift attempts are ended.
If the mode sensor is in the NEUTRAL region at the expiration of the shift timer, the TIPM will
continue to make the shift attempts according to the blocked shift strategy independent of whether
or not the driver controlled conditions are met.
For shifts from NEUTRAL, if all 5 attempts fail to reach the desired position (which by default is
4H), the motor will be driven to stall in the direction of 4H or 4L, depending on the achieved
position. If the transfer case has reached the 2WD/AWD or 4L between gear position nearest the
NEUTRAL positions and the shift conditions are no longer being met, the transfer case will be
driven toward the corresponding 'D' channel. Otherwise, the transfer case will be driven in the
direction opposite the last attempt with the desired target being 4H or 4L.
If the transfer case reaches the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel when being driven in the 4H direction, then
one final 1.0 second drive toward 4H is attempted. If the transfer case then reaches any of the 4H
positions, the shift is considered complete and the 4H LED is illuminated. If the transfer case is still
the 2WD/AWD position, the shift is considered complete and the 2WD/AWD LED is illuminated.
NOTE: If after the 5th blocked shift and reversal attempt, if the transfer case position is in the
NEUTRAL region, shift attempts will continue until a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel is reached.
SHIFT REVERSAL TARGETS
If the shift timer expires (1 second per 'D' channel) and the transfer case has not reached the
desired position, all shifts will attempt to return to their original position with the exceptions of:
- If the intended shift is going to the High rail from Low and can't make it, but it can make the
2WD/AWD position, the motor stops at that position. The TIPM will not attempt to cross back over
NEUTRAL if it does not have to. This means that there was a block on the first attempt to go to 4H
and the transfer case has made it through NEUTRAL to a known good position, then the motor will
go back only to the 2WD/4WD position and execute the remainder of the attempts from there.
- For shifts out of NEUTRAL, any time a shift is commanded out of NEUTRAL, the system needs to
get out. The TIPM should never go to NEUTRAL unless the driver is commanding it and all
required conditions are being met
ENCODER DRIFT CORRECTION
Whenever a shift is completed, the TIPM stores the position in memory as the transfer case's
intended position. The TIPM continuously monitors the mode sensor and if the mode sensor drifts
toward into a NEUTRAL region sensor position for 2.0 seconds, the TIPM will perform a motor
drive to correct the drift. The transfer case will be driven toward the intended position for 1.0
seconds ± 100 msec. The TIPM will wait for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeat the attempt to shift
to the desired position. This will continue until the intended position is reached.
SHIFT MOTOR BRAKING
Two modes of shift motor braking are employed to improve shift performance, static and dynamic.
Static shift motor braking is utilized under the following conditions:
- Whenever the transfer case is in the 2WD/AWD or 4L 'D' channel position.
- Whenever an invalid mode sensor code is present.
Static motor braking is achieved by applying +12V on both shift motor wires.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 666
NOTE: Static Shift Motor Braking is independent of ignition key position.
SHIFT ATTEMPT LIMIT
To protect the transfer case system, the TIPM will impose a limit on the number of shifts that can
occur over a calibrated time period. The system will monitor the number of 'D' channel segment
transitions that occur in any 30 second time period. If the number of segment transitions is 30 or
greater, the system will go into a default mode. The default mode of operation for shifting is that the
number of allowed 'D' channel transitions permitted to occur will be 3 over each 15 second ± 100
msec calibrated window of time. After 5 minutes ± 100 msec, the motor can be assumed to have
cooled down and the system will revert to normal operation. The following rules also apply to the
shift limit:
- The attempt limit will not prevent shifts coming out of NEUTRAL, they will be allowed regardless
of the counter/timer.
- Any shift that is in progress when the counter reaches a maximum count in time will be allowed to
complete before the default mode is entered. D-channel transitions during this period will not be
counted towards the default mode limit.
- A block, regardless of the direction, whether towards destination or back towards reversal target
(shift timer expiring), will count as a value of 2 transitions towards the 30 segment transitions to go
into default mode as defined above. Current attempt limit values are 30 transitions in 30 seconds
and default mode values are 3 transitions every 15 seconds for 5 minutes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Heated Glass Element Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram Trucks 2006-2009, do not use a heated window relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 671
Heated Glass Element Relay: Description and Operation
Dodge Ram Trucks 2006-2009, do not use a heated window relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Defogger Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram Trucks 2006-2009, do not use a heated window relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Rear Defogger Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 675
Rear Defogger Relay: Description and Operation
Dodge Ram Trucks 2006-2009, do not use a heated window relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Wiper Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram 2006-2008, 1500-5500 all, do not use a wiper relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 680
Wiper Relay: Description and Operation
Dodge Ram 2006-2009, does not use a wiper relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Component ID: 469
Component : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 686
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 687
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Component ID: 469
Component : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 688
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Alarm (VTA) system for sale in certain export markets
where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used only on
domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the inboard side of the right front fender load beam within the engine
compartment. A molded plastic striker secured to the underside of the hood panel inner
reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit. The hood ajar switch
striker is not intended for reuse. If the striker is removed from the hood inner reinforcement for any
reason, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 691
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the striker on the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and
latched. When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body
and the switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilo ohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the striker on the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is
depressed, the plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward,
ratcheting through the switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on
the retainer ring are engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Removal
Striker
STRIKER
NOTE: The hood ajar switch striker is not intended for reuse. If the striker is removed from the
hood inner reinforcement for any reason, it must be replaced.
1. Unlatch and open the hood.
2. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, pry the rearward end of the hood ajar
switch striker (2) away from the inner hood panel
reinforcement (1) far enough to disengage the integral retainers from their mounting holes.
3. Remove the striker from the inner hood panel reinforcement and discard.
Bracket
BRACKET
1. Remove the hood ajar switch (2) from the mounting bracket (3).
2. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the hood ajar switch bracket to the two rivet nuts (1) in
the right front load beam (6).
3. Remove the hood ajar switch mounting bracket from the inboard side of the right front load
beam.
Switch
SWITCH
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 694
1. Unlatch and open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
3. From the top of the mounting bracket (3) on the right front load beam (6), squeeze the two hood
ajar switch (2) latch tabs together and pull the
switch upward.
4. Pull the hood ajar switch up through the hole in the mounting bracket far enough to access and
disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (5)
from the switch connector receptacle.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 695
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Installation
Striker
STRIKER
NOTE: The hood ajar switch striker cap is not intended for reuse. If the striker cap is removed from
the hood inner reinforcement for any reason, it must be replaced.
1. Position the new hood ajar switch striker (2) to the mounting holes in the inner hood panel
reinforcement (1) over the hood ajar switch (3).
2. Using hand pressure, press the hood ajar switch striker upward into the mounting holes in the
inner hood panel reinforcement until both integral
retainers are fully engaged.
3. Close and latch the hood.
Bracket
BRACKET
1. Check to be certain that the two rivet nuts (1) on the inboard side of the right front load beam (6)
are in good condition and properly secured.
2. Position the hood ajar switch mounting bracket (3) onto the right front load beam.
3. Install and tighten the two screws (4) that secure the mounting bracket to the load beam.
Beginning with the rearward screw, tighten both screws to
8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
4. Reinstall the hood ajar switch (2) into the mounting bracket.
Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Hood
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 696
SWITCH
1. Position the hood ajar switch (2) near the hole in the mounting bracket (3) on the right front load
beam (6).
2. Route the jumper wire harness connector (5) through the switch mounting bracket and reconnect
it to the switch connector receptacle.
3. From the top of the mounting bracket, press the switch downward into the mounting hole until
the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
5. Close and latch the hood.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Component ID: 457
Component : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR REARWARDP206 18LG/LB
2 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 18RD/OR
3-4 GROUND Z146 18BK
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
6 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR FORWARD P205 18LG/WT
Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 700
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 701
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 702
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 457
Component : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR REARWARDP206 18LG/LB
2 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 18RD/OR
3-4 GROUND Z146 18BK
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
6 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR FORWARD P205 18LG/WT
Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 703
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 704
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pedal Positioning Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the lower drivers side bezel (4). 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the
adjustable pedal switch (2). 3. Remove the switch (2) from the lower drivers side bezel (4) by
squeezing the retaining clips together and pushing the switch outwards.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 707
Pedal Positioning Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch (2) to the lower drivers side bezel (4) by pushing the switch inwards seating the
retaining clips to the lower drivers side bezel (4). 2. Reconnect the electrical connector (3) to the
adjustable pedal switch (2). 3. Install the lower drivers side bezel (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Remote Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two rocker-type switches (if equipped) are mounted on the back (instrument panel side) of the
steering wheel spokes. The switch on the left spoke is the seek switch and has seek up, seek
down, and preset station advance functions. The switch on the right spoke is the volume control
switch and has volume up, and volume down functions. The switch on the right spoke also includes
a "mode" control that allows the driver to sequentially select AM radio, FM radio, cassette player,
CD player or CD changer (if equipped).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 712
Remote Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The six switches in the two remote radio switch units are normally open, resistor multiplexed
momentary switches that are hard wired to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) through the
clockspring. The TIPM sends a five volt reference signal to both switch units on one circuit, and
senses the status of all of the switches by reading the voltage drop on a second circuit.
When the TIPM senses an input (voltage drop) from any one of the remote radio switches, it sends
the proper switch status messages on the Programmable Communication Interface (PCI) data bus
network to the radio receiver. The electronic circuitry within the radio receiver is programmed to
respond to these remote radio switch status messages by adjusting the radio settings as
requested. For diagnosis of the TIPM or the PCI data bus, the use of a scan tool and the proper
Diagnostic Procedures information is recommended.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 713
Remote Switch: Testing and Inspection
REMOTE SWITCHES
Any diagnosis of the Audio system should begin with the use of scan tool.
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment
and possible personal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the remote radio switch(es) from the steering wheel.
3. Use an ohmmeter to check the switch resistances as shown in the Remote Radio Switch Test
chart. If the remote radio switch resistances check
OK, go to STEP 4. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
4. Connect the battery negative cable. Turn the ignition switch to the On position. Check for 5 volts
at the radio control mux circuit cavities of the
steering wheel wire harness connectors for both remote radio switches. If OK, go to STEP 5. If not
OK, repair the open or shorted radio control mux circuit to the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM) as required.
5. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the 22-way instrument panel wire
harness connector from the TIPM. Check for
continuity between the remote radio switch ground circuit cavities of the steering wheel wire
harness connectors for both remote radio switches and a good ground. There should be no
continuity. If OK, go to STEP 6. If not OK, repair the shorted remote radio switch ground circuit to
the TIPM as required.
6. Check for continuity between the remote radio switch ground circuit cavities of the steering
wheel wire harness connectors for both remote radio
switches and the 22-way instrument panel wire harness connector for the TIPM. There should be
continuity. If OK, refer to the proper Diagnostic
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 714
Procedures to test the TIPM and the PCI data bus. If not OK, repair the open remote radio switch
ground circuit as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment
and possible personal injury.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the driver airbag.
3. Remove the speed control switches (2).
4. Unplug the wire harness connector from the remote radio switch (1).
5. Depress the tabs on each side of each switch and push the switch through the rear steering
wheel cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 717
Remote Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, seat
belt tensioner, side airbag, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
airbag system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment
and possible personal injury.
1. Install remote radio switch (1) to the steering wheel.
2. Connect the wire harness to the remote radio switch.
3. Install the speed control switches (2).
4. Install the driver airbag.
5. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Component ID: 469
Component : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 723
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 724
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagrams
Component ID: 469
Component : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HOOD AJAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 HOOD AJAR SWITCH SENSE G70 20VT/LB
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations > Page 725
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The hood ajar switch is a normally closed, single pole, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch. This
switch has two unique versions that are used in two different applications. One switch is used only
on vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Alarm (VTA) system for sale in certain export markets
where protection of the underhood area is required equipment. The second switch is used only on
domestic vehicles equipped with an optional remote starter system.
The molded plastic switch body (5) has an integral molded connector receptacle (1) on the lower
end containing two terminal pins. The switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out of the headlamp and dash wire harness. Two integral latches (2) lock the switch
into a keyed mounting hole in the stamped steel switch mounting bracket. The mounting bracket is
secured with screws to the inboard side of the right front fender load beam within the engine
compartment. A molded plastic striker secured to the underside of the hood panel inner
reinforcement actuates the switch plunger as the hood panel is closed.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) and a sleeve-like retainer ring on the
upper end of the switch body. The retainer ring has a one time, self-adjustment feature that is
activated after the switch is installed by closing the hood. The retainer ring is also color-coded to
aid in identifying the switch application. A dark brown retainer ring identifies the underhood security
switch application, while a white retainer ring identifies the remote starter system application.
An installed hood ajar switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or requires readjustment, it must be replaced with a new unit. The hood ajar switch
striker is not intended for reuse. If the striker is removed from the hood inner reinforcement for any
reason, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 728
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The hood ajar switches are interchangeable physically, but not functionally. In each case, the hood
ajar switch is a normally closed switch that is held open as the spring-loaded switch plunger is
depressed by the striker on the inner hood panel reinforcement when the hood panel is closed and
latched. When the hood is opened, the spring-loaded switch plunger extends from the switch body
and the switch contacts are closed.
In the underhood security application (export vehicles only - dark brown retainer ring), the switch is
connected in series between ground and the hood ajar switch sense input of the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM). The TIPM uses an internal resistor pull up to monitor the state of the hood
ajar switch contacts.
In the remote starter system application (domestic vehicles only - white retainer ring) the switch has
a 1 kilo ohm diagnostic resistor connected in parallel to the switch contacts between the two switch
terminals. The switch is connected in series between an output of the TIPM and the hood ajar
switch sense input of the TIPM. The TIPM continually monitors this circuit and will store a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that it detects.
The components of the switch self-adjustment feature include an integral stop on the shaft of the
plunger and a ribbed, ratcheting sleeve-like retainer ring at the top of the switch body from which
the plunger extends. With the switch mounting collar secured in its mounting bracket, the plunger is
depressed by the striker on the hood inner reinforcement as the hood is closed. As the plunger is
depressed, the plunger stop contacts the top of the retainer ring and it is driven downward,
ratcheting through the switch mounting collar until the hood is fully closed and latched. The ribs on
the retainer ring are engaged within the mounting collar to maintain this adjusted position.
The hood ajar switch as well as the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the electronic controls or communication between modules and other devices related to hood ajar
switch operation that provide some features of the export vehicle theft or domestic remote starter
systems. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the electronic controls and
communication related to hood ajar switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Removal
Striker
STRIKER
NOTE: The hood ajar switch striker is not intended for reuse. If the striker is removed from the
hood inner reinforcement for any reason, it must be replaced.
1. Unlatch and open the hood.
2. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, pry the rearward end of the hood ajar
switch striker (2) away from the inner hood panel
reinforcement (1) far enough to disengage the integral retainers from their mounting holes.
3. Remove the striker from the inner hood panel reinforcement and discard.
Bracket
BRACKET
1. Remove the hood ajar switch (2) from the mounting bracket (3).
2. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the hood ajar switch bracket to the two rivet nuts (1) in
the right front load beam (6).
3. Remove the hood ajar switch mounting bracket from the inboard side of the right front load
beam.
Switch
SWITCH
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 731
1. Unlatch and open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
3. From the top of the mounting bracket (3) on the right front load beam (6), squeeze the two hood
ajar switch (2) latch tabs together and pull the
switch upward.
4. Pull the hood ajar switch up through the hole in the mounting bracket far enough to access and
disconnect the jumper wire harness connector (5)
from the switch connector receptacle.
5. Remove the hood ajar switch from the mounting bracket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 732
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair Installation
Striker
STRIKER
NOTE: The hood ajar switch striker cap is not intended for reuse. If the striker cap is removed from
the hood inner reinforcement for any reason, it must be replaced.
1. Position the new hood ajar switch striker (2) to the mounting holes in the inner hood panel
reinforcement (1) over the hood ajar switch (3).
2. Using hand pressure, press the hood ajar switch striker upward into the mounting holes in the
inner hood panel reinforcement until both integral
retainers are fully engaged.
3. Close and latch the hood.
Bracket
BRACKET
1. Check to be certain that the two rivet nuts (1) on the inboard side of the right front load beam (6)
are in good condition and properly secured.
2. Position the hood ajar switch mounting bracket (3) onto the right front load beam.
3. Install and tighten the two screws (4) that secure the mounting bracket to the load beam.
Beginning with the rearward screw, tighten both screws to
8 Nm (71 in. lbs.).
4. Reinstall the hood ajar switch (2) into the mounting bracket.
Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Hood Switch / Sensor >
Hood Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 733
SWITCH
1. Position the hood ajar switch (2) near the hole in the mounting bracket (3) on the right front load
beam (6).
2. Route the jumper wire harness connector (5) through the switch mounting bracket and reconnect
it to the switch connector receptacle.
3. From the top of the mounting bracket, press the switch downward into the mounting hole until
the integral switch latch tabs lock it into place.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
5. Close and latch the hood.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Pedal Positioning Switch: Locations
Component ID: 457
Component : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR REARWARDP206 18LG/LB
2 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 18RD/OR
3-4 GROUND Z146 18BK
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
6 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR FORWARD P205 18LG/WT
Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 737
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 738
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 739
Pedal Positioning Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 457
Component : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ADJUSTABLE PEDALS
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR REARWARDP206 18LG/LB
2 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS OUTPUT A72 18RD/OR
3-4 GROUND Z146 18BK
5 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) F504 20GY/PK
6 ADJUSTABLE PEDALS MOTOR FORWARD P205 18LG/WT
Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 740
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 741
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pedal Positioning Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the lower drivers side bezel (4). 2. Disconnect the electrical connector (3) from the
adjustable pedal switch (2). 3. Remove the switch (2) from the lower drivers side bezel (4) by
squeezing the retaining clips together and pushing the switch outwards.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 744
Pedal Positioning Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch (2) to the lower drivers side bezel (4) by pushing the switch inwards seating the
retaining clips to the lower drivers side bezel (4). 2. Reconnect the electrical connector (3) to the
adjustable pedal switch (2). 3. Install the lower drivers side bezel (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Switch-Door Lock-Passenger
Component ID: 462
Component : SWITCH-DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G160 20VT/LG
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
3-4-5 GROUND Z917 20BK
6-Component Location - 56
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 749
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 750
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Switch-Window/Door Lock-Driver
Component ID: 494
Component : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C1
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/DB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/LB
3 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q11 14OR/LG
6 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
7 DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G161 20VT/DG
8 GROUND Z939 12BK
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
10 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
11 GROUND Z939 18BK
12 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q21 14OR/WT
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 751
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C2
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT MIRROR UP DRIVER P71 20TN/DG
2 LEFT MIRROR COMMON DRIVER (RIGHT/DOWN) P195 18LG/YL
3 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
4 RIGHT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P74 18TN/OR
5 GROUND Z939 18BK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 752
6 LEFT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P75 20TN/LG
7 RIGHT MIRROR UP DRIVER P72 18TN/GY
8 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Switch-Door Lock-Passenger
Component ID: 462
Component : SWITCH-DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-DOOR LOCK-PASSENGER
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G160 20VT/LG
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
3-4-5 GROUND Z917 20BK
6-Component Location - 56
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 755
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 756
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagrams Switch-Window/Door Lock-Driver
Component ID: 494
Component : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C1
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/DB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/LB
3 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q11 14OR/LG
6 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
7 DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G161 20VT/DG
8 GROUND Z939 12BK
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
10 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
11 GROUND Z939 18BK
12 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q21 14OR/WT
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 757
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C2
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT MIRROR UP DRIVER P71 20TN/DG
2 LEFT MIRROR COMMON DRIVER (RIGHT/DOWN) P195 18LG/YL
3 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
4 RIGHT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P74 18TN/OR
5 GROUND Z939 18BK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Door Lock-Passenger > Page 758
6 LEFT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P75 20TN/LG
7 RIGHT MIRROR UP DRIVER P72 18TN/GY
8 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A window/lock switch is used on all models equipped with power locks, power windows, and power
mirrors. The window/lock switch houses the following switches:
- Power Lock Switch - A two-way, momentary, resistor multiplexed switch to control the power lock
system.
- Power Mirror Selector Switch - A three-position rocker switch selects the right or left power mirror
for adjustment, or turns the power mirror system Off.
- Power Mirror Adjustment Switches - Four momentary, arrowhead shaped, directional switches
allow the driver to adjust the selected power mirror in the Up, Down, Right, or Left directions.
- Power Window Lockout Switch - A two-way, latching, push-button switch allows the vehicle
operator to lock out the power window switches on each passenger door so that the passenger
door power windows may be operated only from the master switches.
- Power Window Switches - A two-way, momentary power window switch for the driver side front
door. This switch also has a second detent in the Down direction and internal circuitry to provide an
Auto-Down feature for the driver side front door power window. In addition to the power window
switch for its own door, there are individual master switches for each passenger door power
window.
The window/lock switch also incorporates several green Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) that
illuminate the power lock and power window switch paddles, and the power mirror switch
directional buttons to improve switch visibility.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 761
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The window/lock switch combines a power lock switch, a driver power window switch with an
Auto-down feature, master switches for each passenger door power window, a power window
lockout switch, a power mirror selector switch, and four power mirror adjustment switches in a
single unit.
Power Lock Switch
The power lock switch circuitry is connected in series between ground and the driver door switch
mux input of the instrument cluster. Each power lock switch position (Lock, Unlock, and Neutral)
provides a different resistance value to the instrument cluster input, which allows the instrument
cluster to sense the switch position. Based upon the power lock switch input, the instrument cluster
controls the battery and ground feed outputs to the individual power lock motors to lock or unlock
the door latches. The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the power lock switch is connected to battery
current through the power window circuit breaker in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on
a fused ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit. The switch will be illuminated whenever the ignition
switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Power Window Switches
The power window switch circuitry is connected to battery current through a circuit breaker in the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a fused ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit so that
the power windows will operate whenever the ignition switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Each two-way, momentary master passenger power window switch provides battery current and
ground to the individual power window switches on each passenger door so that the power window
switch controls the battery current and ground feeds to its respective power window motor. The
switch for the driver side front door power window is labeled "Auto" and includes an auto-down
feature. When this switch is depressed to a second momentary detent position and released, the
driver door power window is automatically operated through an internal circuit and relay to its fully
lowered position. The Auto-down event is cancelled if the switch paddle is depressed a second
time in either the Up or Down direction. When the two position window lockout switch is depressed
and latched in the lockout position, the battery current feed to each of the individual passenger
power window switches is interrupted so that the passenger door power windows can only be
operated from the master switches. The window lockout switch also controls the battery current
feed for the LED in each passenger power window switch so that the switch will not be illuminated
when it is locked out.
Power Mirror Switches
The power mirror switch circuitry is connected to battery current through a fuse in the TIPM on a
fused B(+) circuit so that the power mirrors remain operational regardless of the ignition switch
position. A rocker type selector switch has three positions, one to select the right mirror, one to
select the left mirror, and a neutral Off position. After the right or left mirror is selected, one of four
directional buttons is depressed to move the selected mirror Up, Down, Right or Left. The power
mirror switch circuitry controls the battery current and ground feeds to each of the four (two in each
mirror head) power mirror motors. The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the power mirror switch is
connected to battery current through the power window circuit breaker in the TIPM on a fused
ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit so that the switch directional buttons will be illuminated
whenever the ignition switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Lock Switch
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Lock Switch
POWER LOCK SWITCH
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamp of the power lock switch receives battery current
through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a fused ignition switch output
(run) circuit. The power lock switch on the driver side front door trim panel is integral to the
window/lock switch. If the power lock switch operates, but the LED is inoperative, check for battery
current at the switch with the ignition switch in the On position. If OK, replace the faulty switch.
Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the power lock switch from the door
trim panel. Disconnect the door wire harness
connector for the power lock switch from the switch connector receptacle.
2. Test the power lock switch resistance. See the Power Lock Switch Test chart to determine if the
resistance is correct for the switch in each switch
position. If not OK, replace the faulty power lock switch as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Lock Switch > Page 764
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection Window/Lock Switch
WINDOW/LOCK SWITCH
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamps for all of the Driver Door Module (DDM) power
window, power lock, and power mirror switches receive battery current through the power window
circuit breaker in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). If all of the LED's are inoperative in
the DDM, be certain to diagnose the power window system before replacing the switch unit. If only
one LED in the DDM is inoperative, replace the faulty DDM. If the driver side front door power
window operates in a normal manner, but the Auto-Down feature is inoperative, replace the faulty
DDM. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the DDM from the door trim panel.
Disconnect the door wire harness connectors for the
DDM from the DDM connector receptacles.
2. Test the DDM switch continuity. See the Driver Door Module Switch Tests chart to determine if
the continuity is correct for the suspect switches
in each switch position. If not OK, replace the faulty DDM as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Lock Switch > Page 765
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Lock Switch > Page 766
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the door trim panel.
3. Remove the switch from the trim panel bezel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 769
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install switch to trim panel bezel.
2. Install door trim panel.
3. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
The power mirror switch is included with the window/lock switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Seat-Driver
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Switch-Seat-Driver
Component ID: 484
Component : SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (HD)
A FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
B GROUND Z939 14BK
C-E DRIVER SEAT REAR UP DRIVER P11 12LG/YL
F-G GROUND Z939 14BK
H FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
J DRIVER SEAT REAR DOWN DRIVER P13 12LG/OR
K DRIVER SEAT HORIZONTAL REARWARD DRIVER P17 12LG/DG
L DRIVER SEAT HORIZONTAL FORWARD DRIVER P15 12LG/BR
M DRIVER SEAT FRONT UP DRIVER P19 12LG/LB
N DRIVER SEAT FRONT DOWN DRIVER P21 12LG/TN
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT-DRIVER
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (LD)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Seat-Driver > Page 777
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER SEAT FRONT UP DRIVER P19 12LG/LB
2 GROUND Z939 14BK
3 DRIVER SEAT HORIZONTAL FORWARD DRIVER P15 12LG/WT
4 FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
5 DRIVER SEAT REAR UP DRIVER P11 12LG/YL
6 DRIVER SEAT HORIZONTAL REARWARD DRIVER P17 12LG/DG
7 DRIVER SEAT REAR DOWN DRIVER P13 12LG/OR
8 DRIVER SEAT FRONT DOWN DRIVER P21 12LG/TN
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Seat-Driver > Page 778
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Switch-Seat-Passenger
Component ID: 485
Component : SWITCH-SEAT-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT-PASSENGER
Color : # of pins :
12
A FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
B GROUND Z939 14BK
C-E PASSENGER SEAT REAR UP DRIVER P12 12LG/YL
F-G GROUND Z939 14BK
H FUSED B(+) A210 12OR/RD
J PASSENGER SEAT REAR DOWN DRIVER P10 12LG/TN
K PASSENGER SEAT HORIZONTAL REARWARD DRIVER P16 12LG/BR
L PASSENGER SEAT HORIZONTAL FORWARD DRIVER P14 12LG/OR
M PASSENGER SEAT FRONT UP DRIVER P20 12LG/LB
N PASSENGER SEAT FRONT DOWN DRIVER P18 12LG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The power seats on this vehicle can be adjusted in eight different directions, up, down, front up,
front down, rear up, rear down, rearward and forward. The power seat switch is located on the
outboard side of the seat cushion on the seat cushion side shield.
The individual switches in the power seat switch assembly cannot be repaired. If one switch is
damaged or inoperative, the entire power seat switch assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 781
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When a power switch control knob or knobs are actuated, a battery feed and a ground path are
applied through the switch contacts to the power seat track adjuster motor. The selected adjuster
motor operates to move the seat track or recliner through its drive unit in the selected direction until
the switch is released, or until the travel limit of the adjuster is reached. When the switch is moved
in the opposite direction, the battery feed and ground path to the motor are reversed through the
switch contacts. This causes the adjuster motor to run in the opposite direction.
No power seat switch should be held applied in any direction after the adjuster has reached its
travel limit. The power seat adjuster motors each contain a self-resetting circuit breaker to protect
them from overload. However, consecutive or frequent resetting of the circuit breaker must not be
allowed to continue, or the motor may be damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 782
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
POWER SEAT SWITCH
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the power seat switch from the power seat.
3. Using an ohmmeter to test the continuity of the power seat switches in each position. If OK Refer
to Power Seat Track Testing. If not OK, replace
the inoperative power seat switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the seat cushion side shield from the seat.
3. Pull the switch bezel or side shield unit (1) out from the seat far enough to access the switch wire
harness connector. Gently pry the locking tabs of
the switch away from the wire harness connector and carefully unplug the connector from the
power seat switch module (2).
4. Remove the screws (3) that secure the power seat switch (2) to the side shield unit (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 785
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the power seat switch (2) on the seat cushion side shield (1) and install the screws (3).
2. Connect the electrical connector.
3. Install the seat cushion side shield on the seat.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Switch-Heated Seat-Driver
Component ID: 467
Component : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-DRIVER
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z301 20TN/BK
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
3 DRIVER SEAT HEATER SUPPLY P693 18LG/WT
4 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
5-6 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 790
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 791
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 792
Seat Heater Switch: Locations Switch-Heated Seat-Passenger
Component ID: 468
Component : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-PASSENGER
Color : GREEN
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z302 20LG/BK
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
3 PASSENGER SEAT HEATER SUPPLY P95 18LG/WT
4 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
5-6 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 793
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 794
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver
Seat Heater Switch: Diagrams Switch-Heated Seat-Driver
Component ID: 467
Component : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-DRIVER
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z301 20TN/BK
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
3 DRIVER SEAT HEATER SUPPLY P693 18LG/WT
4 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
5-6 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 797
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 798
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 799
Seat Heater Switch: Diagrams Switch-Heated Seat-Passenger
Component ID: 468
Component : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEATED SEAT-PASSENGER
Color : GREEN
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z302 20LG/BK
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
3 PASSENGER SEAT HEATER SUPPLY P95 18LG/WT
4 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
5-6 FUSED B(+) A930 16RD
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 800
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Heated Seat-Driver > Page 801
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Momentary contact push button switch/modules mounted in the instrument panel center bezel
operate the heated seat system. Each heated seat switch/module has two Light-Emitting Diode
(LED) indicator lamps, which indicate the selected level (Low or High) of the seat heater. Pressing
the switch/module button initiates heat. Heat remains on until switched off or until the ignition is
turned off. If switched off by the ignition, a switch/module button must be pressed to restart heating.
The switch/modules contain the solid state electronic control and diagnostic logic circuitry for the
heated seat system. If any of the heated seat elements are inoperative or damaged one or more of
the LED lamps in the switch/module for the effected seat will flash.
The LED indicator lamps in each heated seat switch/module cannot be repaired. If the LED lamps
are faulty or damaged, or the switch/module is inoperative or damaged the individual heated seat
switch/module assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 804
Seat Heater Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
A Heated Seat Switch/Module is used to control the heated seat system. The heated seat
switch/modules receive battery current through a fused ignition switch output (run) circuit when the
ignition switch is in the On position. The switch/module responds to heated seat switch/module
button input and ignition switch status inputs by controlling the 12v output to the front seat heating
elements through integral solid-state relays.
When either of the heated seat switch/module buttons are depressed the heating element for the
selected seat is energized. Amber Light Emitting Diodes (LEDS) on the side of each switch/module
indicate the level of heat in use: Two LEDs are illuminated for high, one for low, and none for off.
Pressing the switch/module button once will select high-level heating. Pressing the button a second
time will select low-level heating. Pressing the button a third time will shut the heating elements off.
The heated seat switch/module energizes an integral solid-state relay, which supplies battery
current to the heating elements. When high-temperature heating is selected, the heaters provide a
boosted heat level during the first four minutes of operation after heating is activated. The heat
output then drops to the normal high-temperature level. If high-level heating is selected, the control
system will automatically switch to the low level after two hours of continuous operation. At that
time, the number of illuminated LEDs changes from two to one, indicating the change. Operation
on the low setting will continue indefinitely until the switch/module button is pushed to turn the
system off.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the instrument panel center bezel.
3. Disconnect the switch/module electrical connectors.
4. Using an appropriate flat bladed tool, remove the heated seat switch/module from the bezel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 807
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Align the tabs of the switch/module to the instrument panel center bezel and gently push
together until the tabs are securely in place.
2. Connect the switch/module electrical connectors.
3. Install the instrument panel center bezel.
4. Connect the battery negative cable.
5. Verify heated seat system operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Locations
Component ID: 489
Component : SWITCH-SUNROOF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SUNROOF
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
A SUNROOF VENT SWITCH SENSE Q4 20OR/YL
B SUNROOF SWITCH SUPPLY Q6 20OR/LG
C SUNROOF OPEN SWITCH SENSE Q3 20OR/TN
D SUNROOF CLOSE SWITCH SENSE Q5 20OR/LB
Component Location - 53
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 811
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 812
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 489
Component : SWITCH-SUNROOF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SUNROOF
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
A SUNROOF VENT SWITCH SENSE Q4 20OR/YL
B SUNROOF SWITCH SUPPLY Q6 20OR/LG
C SUNROOF OPEN SWITCH SENSE Q3 20OR/TN
D SUNROOF CLOSE SWITCH SENSE Q5 20OR/LB
Component Location - 53
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 813
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The power sunroof switch (3) is a combination push-button and rocker switch module mounted in
the overhead console. The sunroof switch is a direct contact unit that is directly wired to the sunroof
motor/module assembly. The sunroof switch performs the following functions:
- Power sunroof open (back of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof closed (front of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof vent (switch center button pushed)
The power sunroof switch is part of the overhead console assembly and cannot be replaced
separately. If the switch is damaged or inoperative the overhead console must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 816
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The power sunroof switch is hard wired to the sunroof motor/module assembly. The switch
receives battery current from the motor/module when the ignition switch is in the RUN and
ACCESSORY positions. When one of the switch positions is pressed it sends battery current back
to the motor/module, signaling it to move the power sunroof to the appropriate position. The
motor/module will perform one of the following functions:
- Power sunroof open (back of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof closed (front of switch pushed)
- Power sunroof vent (switch center button pushed)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 817
Sunroof / Moonroof Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH - POWER SUNROOF
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds. If completing the appropriate diagnostic information results in the
sunroof switch being inoperative, perform the following test prior to switch replacement.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the overhead console.
3. Disconnect the power sunroof switch wire harness connector.
4. Using an ohmmeter, test the continuity of the power sunroof switch in each switch position. Refer
to the POWER SUNROOF SWITCH
CONTINUITY TABLE. If OK, inspect the wiring harness and connectors for damage. Use a scan
tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures Information to complete diagnosis of the power sunroof
system. If not OK, replace the overhead console.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 389
Component : SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SWITCH SENSE B20 20DG/OR
2 GROUND Z420 20BK/OR
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 822
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 823
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 389
Component : SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SWITCH SENSE B20 20DG/OR
2 GROUND Z420 20BK/OR
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 824
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations
Lateral Accelerometer: Locations
Component ID: 393
Component : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
2 DYNAMICS SENSOR HIGH DATA LINK D465 20WT/GY
3 DYNAMICS SENSOR LOW DATA LINK D464 20WT/OR
4-5-6 GROUND Z608 20BK/LG
Component Location - 52
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 828
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 829
Lateral Accelerometer: Diagrams
Component ID: 393
Component : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
2 DYNAMICS SENSOR HIGH DATA LINK D465 20WT/GY
3 DYNAMICS SENSOR LOW DATA LINK D464 20WT/OR
4-5-6 GROUND Z608 20BK/LG
Component Location - 52
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 830
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Locations > Page 831
Lateral Accelerometer: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor. The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational sensing
(how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the center bezel lower trim panel. 2. Remove the cup holder. 3. Disconnect the
electrical connector (3) for the dynamics sensor (2). 4. Remove the 3 mounting nuts (1) for the
sensor (2). 5. Remove the sensor (2) from the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 834
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor on the mounting studs (2). 2. Install the mounting nuts (1) Tighten to
24 Nm (200 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the electrical connector (3). 4. Install the cup holder. 5. Install
the center bezel lower trim panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Component ID: 474
Component : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 1
Pin Description Circuit
1 PARK BRAKE SWITCH SENSE B25 20DG/WT
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 838
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 839
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 474
Component : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 1
Pin Description Circuit
1 PARK BRAKE SWITCH SENSE B25 20DG/WT
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 840
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl side inner
panel below the instrument panel, to the left of the steering column. This switch includes a
spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, it must be
replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 843
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The park brake switch is a normally closed, mechanically actuated leaf contact switch that is
operated by the park brake lever mechanism. The switch is grounded through its mounting to the
park brake lever mechanism and provides a ground input to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense
circuit whenever the park brake is applied, and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is
released. The park brake switch sense input to the EMIC is used for control of the brake indicator
and may also be used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 844
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving, the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to
performing the following tests. If no brake system problem is found, the following procedures will
help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to STEP 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park
brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C1) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to STEP 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
4. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C1) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the body wire
harness connector (2) from the terminal of the park brake
switch (4) located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism.
5. Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 847
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (4) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 3 Nm (24 in. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the terminal of the park brake switch.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with
the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Locations
Steering Angle Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 425
Component : SENSOR-STEERING ANGLE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-STEERING ANGLE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
2 GROUND Z455 20BK/PK
3 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 851
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 852
Steering Angle Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 425
Component : SENSOR-STEERING ANGLE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-STEERING ANGLE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
2 GROUND Z455 20BK/PK
3 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 853
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
Traction Control Switch: Locations
Component ID: 463
Component : SWITCH-ESP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ESP
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z936 20BK/DG
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER E11 20OR/DB
3 ESP ON/OFF SENSE B46 20DG/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND G94 20VT/DB
5-6-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 857
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 858
Traction Control Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 463
Component : SWITCH-ESP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-ESP
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z936 20BK/DG
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER E11 20OR/DB
3 ESP ON/OFF SENSE B46 20DG/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND G94 20VT/DB
5-6-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 859
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 860
Traction Control Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ESP switch is located just below the heater and air conditioner controls in the center stack
area of the instrument panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the radio trim panel (1).
2. Disconnect the electrical connectors from the radio trim panel. 3. Remove the ESP switch (1)
from the switch bank (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 863
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the new switch (1) in the switch bank (2). 2. Reconnect the electrical connectors for the
radio trim panel.
3. Install the radio trim panel (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front
Component ID: 434
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 20DG/LG
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 18DG/LG
2 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 20DG/TN
2 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 18DG/TN
Component Location - 38
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 868
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 869
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Rear
Component ID: 436
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (EXCEPT ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 18DG/YL
2 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 18DG/WT
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 870
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 871
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Rear
Component ID: 435
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B3 18DG/YL
2 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B4 18DG/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 872
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 873
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Right Front
Component ID: 437
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B7 20DG/VT
2 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B6 20DG/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 874
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 875
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Right Rear
Component ID: 438
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B1 18DG/OR
2 RIGHT REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B2 18DG/LB
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 876
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front
Component ID: 434
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 20DG/LG
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B9 18DG/LG
2 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 20DG/TN
2 LEFT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B8 18DG/TN
Component Location - 38
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 879
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 880
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Rear
Component ID: 436
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (EXCEPT ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B22 18DG/YL
2 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B222 18DG/WT
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 881
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 882
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Rear
Component ID: 435
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-LEFT REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B3 18DG/YL
2 REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B4 18DG/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 883
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 884
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Right Front
Component ID: 437
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B7 20DG/VT
2 RIGHT FRONT WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B6 20DG/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 885
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 886
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Right Rear
Component ID: 438
Component : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WHEEL SPEED-ABS-RIGHT REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (ESP)
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (-) B1 18DG/OR
2 RIGHT REAR WHEEL SPEED SENSOR (+) B2 18DG/LB
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Left Front > Page 887
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The ABS brake system uses 3 wheel speed sensors. A sensor is mounted to each front
hub/bearings. The third sensor is mounted on top of the rear axle differential housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 890
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Wheel Speed Sensor consists of a magnet (1) surrounded by windings from a single strand of
wire (5). The sensor sends a small AC signal to the ABM. This signal is generated by magnetic
induction. The magnetic induction is created when a toothed sensor ring (exciter ring or tone
wheel) (4) passes the stationary magnetic WSS.
When the ring gear is rotated, the exciter ring (4) passes the tip of the WSS. As the exciter ring
tooth approaches the tip of the WSS, the magnetic lines of force expand, causing the magnetic
field to cut across the sensor's windings (5). This, in turn causes current to flow through the WSS
circuit in one direction. When the exciter ring tooth moves away from the sensor tip, the magnetic
lines of force collapse cutting the winding in the opposite direction. This causes the current to flow
in the opposite direction. Every time a tooth of the exciter ring passes the tip of the WSS, an AC
signal is generated current. Each AC signal (positive to negative signal or squarewave) is
interpreted by the ABM. It then compares the frequency of the sinewave to a time value to calculate
vehicle speed. The ABM continues to monitor the frequency to determine a deceleration rate that
would indicate a possible wheel-locking tendency.
The signal strength of any magnetic induction sensor is directly affected by:
- Magnetic field strength; the stronger the magnetic field, the stronger the signal
- Number of windings in the sensor; more windings provide a stronger signal
- Exciter ring speed; the faster the exciter ring/tone wheel rotates, the stronger the signal will be
- Distance (3) "air gap" between the exciter ring teeth and WSS; the closer the WSS is to the
exciter ring/tone wheel, the stronger the signal will be.
The WSS is not adjustable. A clearance specification has been established for manufacturing
tolerances. If the clearance is not within these specifications, then either the WSS or other
components may be damaged. The clearance between the WSS and the exciter ring is 0.005 0.050 in.
The assembly plant performs a "Rolls Test" on every vehicle that leaves the assembly plant. One
of the test performed is a test of the WSS. To properly test the sensor, the assembly plant connects
test equipment to the Data Link Connector (DLC). This connector is located to the right of the
steering column and attached to the lower portion of the instrument panel. The rolls test terminal is
spliced to the WSS circuit. The vehicle is then driven on a set of rollers and the WSS output is
monitored for proper operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 891
Wheel Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
REAR WHEEL ANTILOCK
Diagnosis of base brake conditions which are mechanical in nature should be performed first. This
includes brake noise, lack of power assist, parking brake, or vehicle vibration during normal
braking.
The RWAL brake system performs several self-tests every time the ignition switch is turned on and
the vehicle is driven. The CAB monitors the system inputs and outputs circuits to verify the system
is operating properly. If the CAB senses a malfunction in the system it will set a DTC into memory
and trigger the warning lamp.
NOTE: A scan tool is used to diagnose the RWAL system. For test procedures refer to the ABS
Electrical Diagnostic. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor- Wheel Speed-ABS-Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor- Wheel Speed-ABS-Front
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the front rotor. 2. Remove the wheel speed sensor mounting bolt (1) from the hub (3). 3.
Remove the wheel speed sensor (2) from the hub (3). 4. Remove the wiring from the clips and
disconnect the electrical connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the wiring to the clips and Reconnect the electrical connector. 2. Install the wheel speed
sensor (2) to the hub (3). 3. Install the wheel speed sensor mounting bolt (1) to the hub (3). Tighten
the bolt to 21 Nm (190 in. lbs.). 4. Install the front rotor and brake caliper assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor- Wheel Speed-ABS-Front > Page 894
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Wheel Speed-ABS-Rear
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Remove the brake line mounting nut and remove the brake line
from the sensor stud. 3. Remove the mounting stud (2) from the sensor and shield. 4. Remove the
sensor (1) and shield from the differential housing (3). 5. Disconnect the sensor wire harness and
remove the sensor (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the harness to the sensor. Be sure the seal is securely in place between the sensor and
the wiring connector. 2. Install the O-ring on the sensor (if removed). 3. Insert the sensor (1) in the
differential housing (3). 4. Install the sensor shield. 5. Install the sensor mounting stud (2) and
tighten to 24 Nm (200 in. lbs.). 6. Install the brake line on the sensor stud (2)and install the nut. 7.
Lower the vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor- Wheel Speed-ABS-Front > Page 895
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector (3). 3.
Remove the mounting bolt (1) from the sensor (4). 4. Remove the sensor (4) from the brake caliper
adapter (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the wheel speed sensor (4) in the brake caliper adapter (2). 2. Install the sensor mounting
bolt (1) and tighten to 24 Nm (200 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the electrical wiring connector (3) to the
sensor (4). 4. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Yaw Rate Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 393
Component : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
2 DYNAMICS SENSOR HIGH DATA LINK D465 20WT/GY
3 DYNAMICS SENSOR LOW DATA LINK D464 20WT/OR
4-5-6 GROUND Z608 20BK/LG
Component Location - 52
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 899
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 900
Yaw Rate Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 393
Component : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-DYNAMICS
Color : # of pins :
6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
2 DYNAMICS SENSOR HIGH DATA LINK D465 20WT/GY
3 DYNAMICS SENSOR LOW DATA LINK D464 20WT/OR
4-5-6 GROUND Z608 20BK/LG
Component Location - 52
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 901
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 902
Yaw Rate Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Yaw Rate and Lateral Acceleration Sensors are housed into one unit known as the Dynamics
Sensor. The sensor is used to measure side-to-side (Lateral) motion and vehicle rotational sensing
(how fast the vehicle is turning - Yaw).
Yaw and Lateral Acceleration Sensors cannot be serviced separately. The entire Dynamics Sensor
must be replaced when necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the center bezel lower trim panel. 2. Remove the cup holder. 3. Disconnect the
electrical connector (3) for the dynamics sensor (2). 4. Remove the 3 mounting nuts (1) for the
sensor (2). 5. Remove the sensor (2) from the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 905
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the dynamics sensor on the mounting studs (2). 2. Install the mounting nuts (1) Tighten to
24 Nm (200 in. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the electrical connector (3). 4. Install the cup holder. 5. Install
the center bezel lower trim panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description > Page 912
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 915
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Speed Control-Left
Cruise Control Switch: Diagrams Switch-Speed Control-Left
Component ID: 486
Component : SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL-LEFT
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL-LEFT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
A S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 22VT/OR
B S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 22DB/DG
B SENSOR GROUND K900 22DB/DG
C S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 22VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Speed Control-Left > Page 921
Cruise Control Switch: Diagrams Switch-Speed Control-Right
Component ID: 487
Component : SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL-RIGHT
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SPEED CONTROL-RIGHT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
A S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 22VT/OR
B S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 22DB/DG
B SENSOR GROUND K900 22DB/DG
C S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 22VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two separate switch pods operate the speed control system. The steering-wheel-mounted
switches use multiplexed circuits to provide inputs to the PCM (to the ECM for diesel) for ON, OFF,
RESUME, ACCELERATE, SET, DECEL and CANCEL modes. Refer to the Owner's Manual for
speed control switch functions and setting procedures.
The individual switches cannot be repaired. If one switch fails, the entire switch module must be
replaced.
Depending on engine control computer (JTEC having a 3- plug connector or NGC having a 4- plug
connector), 2 types of switches are used. Both types of switches are internally and externally
different. The switch used with the NGC system has an attached pigtail lead. The switch used with
the JTEC system does not have an attached pigtail lead.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 924
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When speed control is selected by depressing the ON, OFF switch, the PCM (ECM for diesel)
allows a set speed to be stored in its RAM for speed control. To store a set speed, depress the
SET switch while the vehicle is moving at a speed between approximately 35 (56.2kph) and 85
mph (136.8kph). In order for the speed control to engage, the brakes cannot be applied, nor can
the gear selector be indicating the transmission is in Park or Neutral.
The speed control can be disengaged manually by:
- Stepping on the brake pedal
- Depressing the OFF switch
- Depressing the CANCEL switch.
The speed control can be disengaged also by any of the following conditions:
- An indication of Park or Neutral (auto. trans.)
- The VSS signal increases at a rate of 10 mph (16 kph) per second (indicates that the co-efficient
of friction between the road surface and tires is extremely low)
- Depressing the clutch pedal (manual trans.).
- Excessive engine rpm (indicates that the transmission may be in a low gear)
- The VSS signal decreases at a rate of 10 mph (16 kph) per second (indicates that the vehicle
may have decelerated at an extremely high rate)
- If the actual speed is not within 20 mph (32.1 kph) of the set speed
- The previous disengagement conditions are programmed for added safety.
Once the speed control has been disengaged, depressing the ACCEL switch restores the vehicle
to the target speed that was stored in the PCM's RAM (ECM for diesel).
NOTE: Depressing the OFF switch will erase the set speed stored in the PCM's/ECM's RAM.
If, while the speed control is engaged, the driver wishes to increase vehicle speed, the PCM (ECM
for diesel) is programmed for an acceleration feature. With the ACCEL switch held closed, the
vehicle accelerates slowly to the desired speed. The new target speed is stored in the
PCM's/ECM's RAM when the ACCEL switch is released. The PCM/ECM also has a "tap-up"
feature in which vehicle speed increases at a rate of approximately 2 mph (3.2 kph) for each
momentary switch activation of the ACCEL switch.
The PCM/ECM also provides a means to decelerate without disengaging speed control. To
decelerate from an existing recorded target speed, depress and hold the COAST switch until the
desired speed is reached. Then release the switch. The ON, OFF switch operates two
components: the PCM's/ECM's ON, OFF input, and the battery voltage to the brake switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Depending on engine control computer (JTEC having a 3-plug connector or 5.7L V-8 NGC having a
4-plug connector), 2 types of switches are used. Both types of switches are internally and
externally different. The switches used with the NGC system have attached pigtail leads . The
switch used with the JTEC system does not have an attached pigtail lead.
1. Remove switch mounting screw (2).
2. Pull switch (2) from steering wheel.
3. Unplug electrical connector from switch, or, if equipped, switch pigtail wire harness from steering
wheel wire harness (4) and remove switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 927
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Plug electrical connector into switch, or, if equipped, connect pigtail wire harness to steering
wheel wire harness. Be sure wires are not pinched.
2. Position switch to steering wheel.
3. Install switch mounting screw and tighten 15 in. lbs. ( 1.7 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 932
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 933
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 934
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 935
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 936
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 937
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 938
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 939
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 940
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When installing a new oil pressure switch, the kit will include a special 90° fitting that must
be installed. Clock the fitting and switch assembly between the 1:00 o'clock and 2:00 o'clock
position. Torque the fitting bolt to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs)
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector. 3.
Using a suitable socket, remove the oil pressure switch from the block (counter-clockwise). 4.
Remove the banjo screw from the oil pressure switch mounting block.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 943
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install banjo screw through the oil pressure switch mounting block. The switch mounting block
port (oil switch port) should point to the 2 o'clock
position. Torque the banjo screw to 24 Nm or 18 ft lbs.
2. If the switch is not being replaced, replace and lubricate the o-ring. 3. Install the oil pressure
switch and tighten to 18 Nm (159 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect oil pressure switch connector. 5.
Connect the battery negative cables. 6. Start engine and check for oil leaks at the switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 948
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 949
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 950
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 951
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 952
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 953
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 954
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 955
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 956
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 957
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 958
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 959
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 960
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 961
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 962
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 963
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 964
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 965
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 971
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 972
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 973
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 974
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 975
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 976
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 979
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 980
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 981
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 982
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 983
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 984
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 989
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 990
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 991
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 992
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 993
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 994
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 995
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 996
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 999
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1000
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1001
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1002
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1003
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1004
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1005
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1006
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1009
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1012
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Component ID: 387
Component : SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 AAT SIGNAL G31 20VT/LG
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1017
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1018
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams
Component ID: 387
Component : SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 AAT SIGNAL G31 20VT/LG
2 AAT RETURN G930 20VT/TN
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1019
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor mounted to a bracket that is secured with a
screw to the left side of the radiator yoke, behind the radiator grille and in front of the engine
compartment.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if inoperative or damaged, it
must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1022
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a five-volt reference signal
sent by the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). The resistance in the sensor changes as
temperature changes, changing the temperature sensor signal circuit voltage to the TIPM. Based
upon the resistance in the sensor, the TIPM senses a specific voltage on the temperature sensor
signal circuit. The TIPM then translates the voltage into a temperature reading that it sent over the
Programmable Communications Interface (PCI) data bus circuit to other modules utilizing
temperature information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1023
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The temperature function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor, a wiring circuit, and the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). When the sensor is exposed to temperatures above 60°
C (140° F), or if the sensor circuit is shorted, 60° C (130/140° F) will appear in the display in place
of the temperature. When the sensor is exposed to temperatures below - 40° C (- 40° F) or if the
sensor circuit is open, - 40° C (- 40° F) will appear in the display for Compass Mini - Trip Computer
(CMTC) equipped vehicles and - -° C (- -° F) will be displayed on Electronic Vehicle Information
Center (EVIC) equipped vehicles.
The ambient temperature sensor circuit can be diagnosed using the following Temperature System
Test, and Sensor Test. If the temperature sensor and circuit are confirmed to be OK, but the
temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, test the Compass Mini - Trip Computer (CMTC) or
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) as applicable.
TEMPERATURE SYSTEM TEST
For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information. The wiring information
includes wiring diagrams, proper wire and connector repair procedures, details of wire harness
routing and retention, connector pin-out information and location views for the various wire harness
connectors, splices and grounds.
NOTE: Temperature readings do not update immediately. Allow up to 60 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned to the On position for readings to meet test specifications.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the
ambient temperature sensor.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the On position. The CMTC display should now read - 40° C (- 40° F)
or the EVIC display should now read - -° C (- ° F). If OK, go to STEP 3. If not OK, repair the shorted sensor return circuit or ambient temperature
sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature sensor as required.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Taking care not to damage the wire terminals,
connect a jumper wire between the two terminals in the
body half of the ambient temperature sensor harness connector.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the On position. The CMTC or EVIC display should now read 60° C
(130/140° F). If OK, go to STEP 5. If not OK,
repair the open sensor return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient
temperature sensor as required.
5. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes that may have been set while performing the test. Perform
further diagnosis of the Compass Mini - Trip
Computer (CMTC) or Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) as applicable.
SENSOR TEST
1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor harness
connector.
2. Measure the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor. At - 40° C (- 40° F), the sensor
resistance is 336 kilohms. At 55° C (130° F), the sensor
resistance is 2.488 kilohms. The sensor resistance should read between these two values. If OK,
perform further diagnosis of the Compass Mini - Trip Computer (CMTC) or Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC) as applicable. If not OK, replace the inoperative ambient temperature
sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
3. Working on the underside of the hood, remove screw holding sensor to hood panel.
4. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector and remove sensor from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1026
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Connect the sensor electrical connector.
2. Working on the underside of the hood, install screw holding sensor to hood panel.
3. Connect the battery negative cable.
4. Close the hood.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
Component ID: 396
Component : SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND C121 20DB/DG
2 EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL C21 20DB/LG
Component Location - 40
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1030
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1031
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 396
Component : SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND C121 20DB/DG
2 EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL C21 20DB/LG
Component Location - 40
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1032
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Cutaway of HVAC housing shown for clarity.
The evaporator temperature sensor (1) is an electrical thermistor located within a molded plastic
case that is inserted into the top of the HVAC housing (2) to measure the temperature of the
conditioned air downstream of the A/C evaporator (3). Two terminals within the connector
receptacle connect the sensor to the vehicle electrical system through a wire lead and connector of
the HVAC wire harness.
The external location of the evaporator temperature sensor allows the sensor to be removed or
installed without disturbing the refrigerant in the A/C system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1035
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The evaporator temperature sensor monitors the temperature of the conditioned air downstream of
the A/C evaporator and supplies an input signal to the A/C-heater control. The A/C-heater control
uses the evaporator temperature sensor input signal to optimize A/C system performance and to
protect the A/C system from evaporator freezing. The evaporator temperature sensor will change
its internal resistance in response to the temperatures it monitors and is connected to the
A/C-heater control through sensor ground circuit and a 5-volt reference signal circuit. As the
temperature of the A/C evaporator decreases, the internal resistance of the evaporator temperature
sensor decreases.
The A/C-heater control uses the monitored voltage reading as an indication of evaporator
temperature. The A/C-heater control is programmed to respond to this input by requesting the
powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control module (ECM) (depending on engine
application) to cycle the A/C compressor clutch as necessary to optimize A/C system performance
and to protect the A/C system from evaporator freezing.
The evaporator temperature sensor is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The evaporator temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if found
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the glove box from the instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the HVAC wire harness (1) from the evaporator temperature sensor (2) located on
the top of the HVAC housing (3).
4. Remove the evaporator temperature sensor from the HVAC housing by pulling the sensor
upward while tipping it forward.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1038
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Illustration shown with instrument panel removed for clarity.
1. Install the evaporator temperature sensor (2) into the opening in the top of the HVAC housing
(3). Make sure the sensor is fully engage to the
housing.
2. Connect the HVAC wire harness (1) to the evaporator temperature sensor.
3. Install the glove box.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Component ID: 496
Component : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 18BK/LB
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 18LB/OR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 18LB/BR
4-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1042
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1043
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1044
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1045
Connector:
Name : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (6.7L/GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 18BK/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 20BK/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1046
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 18LB/OR
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 20LB/OR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 18LB/BR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 20LB/BR
4-Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1047
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1048
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1049
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1050
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 496
Component : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 18BK/LB
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 18LB/OR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 18LB/BR
4-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1051
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1052
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1053
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1054
Connector:
Name : TRANSDUCER-A/C PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (6.7L/GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 18BK/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 A/C PRESSURE GROUND C918 20BK/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1055
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 18LB/OR
2 A/C PRESSURE 5 VOLT SUPPLY C818 20LB/OR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 18LB/BR
3 A/C PRESSURE SIGNAL C18 20LB/BR
4-Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1056
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1057
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1058
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C pressure transducer (1) is a switch that is installed on a fitting located on the A/C
discharge line. An internally threaded fitting on the A/C pressure transducer connects it to the
externally threaded Schrader-type fitting on the A/C discharge line. A rubber O-ring seals the
connection between the A/C pressure transducer and the discharge line fitting. The A/C pressure
transducer is connected to the vehicle electrical system by a molded plastic connector with three
terminals.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1061
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The A/C pressure transducer monitors the pressures in the high side of the refrigerant system
through its connection to a fitting on the A/C discharge line and its internal resistance changes in
response to the pressures it monitors. The powertrain control module (PCM) or the engine control
module (ECM) (depending on engine application) provides a five volt reference signal and a sensor
ground to the A/C pressure transducer, then monitors the output voltage of the transducer on a
sensor return circuit to determine refrigerant pressure. The PCM/ECM is programmed to respond
to this and other sensor inputs by controlling the operation of the A/C compressor clutch and the
radiator cooling fan to help optimize A/C system performance and to protect the system
components from damage. The PCM/ECM will disengage the A/C compressor clutch when high
side pressure rises above 3172 kPa (460 psi) and re-engage the clutch when high side pressure
drops below 1999 kPa (290 psi). The A/C pressure transducer will also disengage the A/C
compressor clutch if the high side pressure drops below 193 kPa (28 psi) and will re-engage the
clutch when the high side pressure rises above 234 kPa (34 psi). If the refrigerant pressure rises
above 1655 kPa (240 psi), the PCM will actuate the cooling fan. The A/C pressure transducer
signal to the PCM/ECM also prevents the A/C compressor clutch from engaging when ambient
temperatures are below about 10° C (50° F) due to the pressure/temperature relationship of the
refrigerant.
A Schrader-type valve in the A/C discharge line fitting permits the A/C pressure transducer to be
removed or installed without disturbing the refrigerant in the A/C system.
The A/C pressure transducer is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The A/C pressure transducer cannot be adjusted or repaired and must be replaced if found
inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: It is not necessary to discharge the refrigerant system to replace the A/C pressure
transducer.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer and refrigerant line shown.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the A/C pressure transducer (2) located on the
A/C discharge line (3).
3. Remove the A/C pressure transducer from the fitting on the A/C discharge line and remove and
discard the O-ring seal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1064
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Use only the specified O-ring as it is made of special material for R-134a. Use only
refrigerant oil of the type required for the A/C compressor.
NOTE: Typical A/C pressure transducer and refrigerant line shown.
1. Lubricate a new rubber O-ring seal (4) with clean refrigerant oil and install it onto the discharge
line fitting (3).
2. Install the A/C pressure transducer (2) onto the A/C discharge line. Tighten the A/C pressure
transducer securely.
3. Connect the wire harness connector (1) to the A/C pressure transducer.
4. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Door Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle has up to four door ajar switches, one for each door. Each switch is concealed within
and integral to its respective door latch unit. The switches are momentary leaf contact-type units
that are actuated by the mechanisms internal to the door latch. A short pigtail wire and connector
on each door latch connects the door ajar switch to the vehicle electrical system through its
respective door wire harness.
The door ajar switches cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the door latch
unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1070
Door Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The door ajar switches are actuated by the mechanisms internal to the door latch. When a door is
closed and properly latched, its door ajar switch is an open circuit. When a door is open or only
partially latched, the door ajar switch is a closed circuit. The door ajar switches are hard wired in
series between a body ground and the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known
as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The EMIC reads the hard wired door ajar switch inputs through internal pull-ups, then uses these
inputs to control many electronic functions and features of the vehicle. The EMIC also sends the
proper electronic door ajar switch status messages to other electronic modules in the vehicle over
the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The door ajar switches as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switches may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1075
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1076
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1077
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1078
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1079
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1080
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1081
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1082
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1083
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1084
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1085
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1086
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1087
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1088
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1089
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1090
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1091
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1092
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1093
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1096
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Locations
Component ID: 474
Component : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 1
Pin Description Circuit
1 PARK BRAKE SWITCH SENSE B25 20DG/WT
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1100
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1101
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 474
Component : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PARKING BRAKE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 1
Pin Description Circuit
1 PARK BRAKE SWITCH SENSE B25 20DG/WT
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1102
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The park brake switch (1) is located on the park brake lever mechanism on the cowl side inner
panel below the instrument panel, to the left of the steering column. This switch includes a
spade-type output terminal (3) that connects the switch to the vehicle electrical system through a
dedicated take out and connector of the body wire harness. The output terminal is integral to the
stationary contact within a molded plastic insulator.
A locating tab on the insulator engages a slot in the park brake lever mechanism for positive switch
location. External to the insulator is a movable leaf contact with an integral grounding lug (4) on
one end and an integral actuating lever and follower (2) on the opposite end. The switch is secured
to and grounded by a single screw to the park brake lever mechanism.
The park brake switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, it must be
replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1105
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The park brake switch is a normally closed, mechanically actuated leaf contact switch that is
operated by the park brake lever mechanism. The switch is grounded through its mounting to the
park brake lever mechanism and provides a ground input to the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) on a park brake switch sense
circuit whenever the park brake is applied, and opens this circuit whenever the park brake is
released. The park brake switch sense input to the EMIC is used for control of the brake indicator
and may also be used as a logic input for other electronic features in the vehicle.
The park brake switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1106
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
PARK BRAKE SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
NOTE: If the brake indicator stays ON with the ignition switch in the ON position and the park brake
released, or comes ON while driving, the brake system must be diagnosed and repaired prior to
performing the following tests. If no brake system problem is found, the following procedures will
help to locate a shorted or open park brake switch sense circuit, or an ineffective park brake switch.
INDICATOR ILLUMINATES DURING BULB TEST, BUT DOES NOT WHEN PARK BRAKE
APPLIED
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Apply the parking brake. Check for continuity between the park brake switch terminal and a good
ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to STEP 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park
brake switch.
2. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C1) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavities of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and the instrument panel wire harness connector for the instrument
cluster. There should be continuity. If not OK, repair the open park brake switch sense circuit
between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster as required.
INDICATOR REMAINS ILLUMINATED - BRAKE SYSTEM CHECKS OKAY
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch from the switch terminal.
Check for continuity between the terminal of the park brake switch and a good ground. There
should be no continuity with the park brake released, and continuity with the park brake applied. If
OK, go to STEP 2. If not OK, replace the ineffective park brake switch.
4. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector (Connector C1) for the instrument
cluster from the cluster connector receptacle. Check for
continuity between the park brake switch sense circuit cavity of the body wire harness connector
for the park brake switch and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If not OK, repair the
shorted park brake switch sense circuit between the park brake switch and the instrument cluster
as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to access and disconnect the body wire
harness connector (2) from the terminal of the park brake
switch (4) located on the park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side inner panel.
4. Remove the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever mechanism.
5. Remove the switch from the park brake lever mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1109
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the left end of the instrument panel to position the park brake switch (4) onto the
park brake lever mechanism (1) on the left cowl side
inner panel. Be certain to engage the locating pin on the back of the switch insulator into the
locating slot in the lever mechanism bracket.
2. Install and tighten the screw (3) that secures the park brake switch to the park brake lever
mechanism. Tighten the screw to 3 Nm (24 in. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the terminal of the park brake switch.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position and check for proper brake indicator operation with
the parking brake applied, then release the parking
brake and check that the brake indicator extinguishes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel
Water In Fuel Sensor: Locations Sensor-Water In Fuel
Component ID: 433
Component : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
B WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel > Page 1114
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel > Page 1115
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel > Page 1116
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel > Page 1117
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Water In Fuel > Page 1118
Water In Fuel Sensor: Locations Water - In - Fuel Sensor
The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the fuel filter housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1119
Water In Fuel Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 433
Component : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
B WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1120
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1121
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-WATER IN FUEL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1122
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1123
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Water In Fuel Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the fuel filter/water separator
canister (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1126
Water In Fuel Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The sensor sends an input to the Engine Control Module (ECM) when it senses water in the fuel
filter/water separator. As the water level in the filter/separator increases, the resistance across the
WIF sensor decreases. This decrease in resistance is sent as a signal to the ECM and compared
to a high water standard value. Once the value reaches 30 to 40 kilohms, the ECM will activate the
water-in-fuel warning lamp through CCD bus circuits. This all takes place when the ignition key is
initially put in the ON position. The ECM continues to monitor the input while the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1127
Water In Fuel Sensor: Service and Repair
Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement:
The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Locations
Component ID: 458
Component : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (3.7L M/T/4.7L M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z965 20BK
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1132
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1133
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1134
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (M/T 5.7L HD/DIESEL M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z965 20BK
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1135
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1136
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1137
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1138
Backup Lamp Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 458
Component : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (3.7L M/T/4.7L M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z965 20BK
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1139
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1140
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1141
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-BACKUP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (M/T 5.7L HD/DIESEL M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z965 20BK
2 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN) L10 20WT/GY
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1142
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1143
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1144
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Vehicles equipped with a manual transmission have a normally open, spring-loaded plunger type
backup lamp switch (2). Vehicles with an optional electronic automatic transmission have a
Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) that is used to perform several functions, including that of the
backup lamp switch. Refer to the service and diagnostic information for the automatic transmission
type installed in the vehicle.
The backup lamp switch is located in a threaded hole on the side of the manual transmission
housing. The switch has a threaded body and a hex formation near the plunger end of the switch.
An integral connector receptacle at the end of the switch opposite the plunger connects the switch
to the vehicle electrical system through a take out and connector of the engine wire harness. When
installed, only the switch connector and the hex formation are visible on the outside of the
transmission housing.
The backup lamp switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the entire
switch unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1147
Backup Lamp Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The backup lamp switch controls the flow of battery voltage to the backup lamp bulbs through an
output on the backup lamp feed circuit. The switch plunger is mechanically actuated by the
gearshift mechanism within the transmission, which will depress the switch plunger and close the
switch contacts whenever the REVERSE gear has been selected. The switch receives battery
voltage through a fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a fused ignition switch
output (run) circuit whenever the ignition switch is in the ON position.
The backup lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1148
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
BACKUP LAMP SWITCH
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Raise and support the vehicle.
3. Locate and disconnect the engine wire harness connector for the backup lamp switch.
4. Check for continuity between the two terminal pins in the backup lamp switch connector
receptacle.
a. With the gear selector lever in the REVERSE position, there should be continuity. b. With the
gear selector lever in any position other than REVERSE, there should be no continuity.
5. If the switch fails either of these two continuity tests, replace the ineffective backup lamp switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Brake Light Switch: Locations
Component ID: 488
Component : SWITCH-STOP LAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-STOP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A103 18GY/RD
2 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 18WT/TN
3 S/C BRAKE SWITCH OUTPUT V30 20VT/WT
4 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
5 GROUND Z429 20BK/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1152
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1153
Brake Light Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 488
Component : SWITCH-STOP LAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-STOP LAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A103 18GY/RD
2 BRAKE LAMP SWITCH OUTPUT L50 18WT/TN
3 S/C BRAKE SWITCH OUTPUT V30 20VT/WT
4 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
5 GROUND Z429 20BK/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
Component Location - 41
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1154
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The brake lamp switch (2) is a three circuit, spring-loaded plunger actuated switch that is secured
to the steering column support bracket under the instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle.
The molded plastic switch housing has an integral connector receptacle (1) containing six terminal
pins and featuring a Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock. The switch is connected to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out of the instrument panel wire harness.
The switch plunger (3) extends through a mounting collar (4) on one end of the switch housing. The
plunger has a one time telescoping self-adjustment feature that is activated after the switch is
installed by moving an adjustment release lever (5) on the opposite end of the switch housing
clockwise, until it locks into a position that is horizontal and parallel to the connector receptacle.
An installed brake lamp switch cannot be readjusted or repaired. If the switch is damaged,
ineffective, or removed from its mounting position for any reason, it must be replaced with a new
unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1157
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The brake lamp switch controls three independent circuits. These circuits are described as follows:
- Brake Lamp Switch Circuit - A normally open brake lamp switch circuit receives a battery voltage
input, and supplies this battery voltage to the brake lamps and the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
on a brake lamp switch output circuit only when the brake pedal is depressed (brake lamp switch
plunger released).
- Brake Lamp Switch Signal Circuit - A normally closed brake lamp switch signal circuit receives a
direct path to ground, and supplies this ground input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on a
brake lamp switch sense circuit only when the brake pedal is released (brake lamp switch plunger
is depressed).
- Speed Control Circuit - A normally closed speed control circuit receives a battery voltage input
from the Powertrain Control Module on a speed control supply circuit, and supplies this battery
voltage to the speed control servo solenoids (dump, vacuum, and vent) on a speed control brake
switch output circuit only when the speed control system is turned ON and the brake pedal is
released (brake lamp switch plunger is depressed).
The components of the self-adjusting brake switch plunger consist of a two-piece telescoping
plunger, a split plunger locking collar, and a release wedge. The release lever has a shaft with a
wedge that spreads the plunger locking collar to an open or released position. After the switch is
installed and the brake pedal is released, the plunger telescopes to the correct adjustment position.
When the release lever is moved to the release position, the wedge is disengaged from the locking
collar causing the collar to apply a clamping pressure to the two plunger halves, fixing the plunger
length.
The brake lamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1158
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE LAMP SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
CAUTION: Do not remove the brake lamp switch from the mounting bracket. The self-adjusting
switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it
MUST be replaced with a new switch.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the brake lamp switch.
3. Using an ohmmeter, perform the continuity tests at the terminal pins (1) in the brake lamp switch
connector receptacle as shown in the Brake Lamp
Switch Tests table.
4. If the switch fails any of the continuity tests, replace the ineffective brake lamp switch as
required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Locate the brake lamp switch (2) near the support bracket on the lower steering column (1).
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the brake lamp switch.
4. Rotate the brake lamp switch housing clockwise about 30 degrees to align the tabs on the switch
locking collar with the keyed hole in the switch
mounting bracket.
5. Pull the switch straight back from the keyed hole to remove it from the bracket.
CAUTION: The brake lamp switch self-adjusting switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the
switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
6. Discard the removed brake lamp switch .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1161
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
CAUTION: The brake lamp switch self-adjusting switch plunger is a one time only feature. If the
switch is removed from the mounting bracket, it MUST be replaced with a new switch.
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal in the depressed position.
2. Align the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar with the keyed hole in the switch mounting
bracket on the lower steering column (1).
3. Insert the tabs on the brake lamp switch locking collar through the keyed hole in the switch
mounting bracket until the switch housing (2) is firmly
seated against the bracket.
4. Rotate the switch housing counterclockwise about 30 degrees to engage the tabs on the locking
collar with the switch mounting bracket.
CAUTION: Do not release or pull up on the brake pedal before the switch plunger adjustment has
been completed.
5. Release the brake pedal, but do not pull it upward.
6. Rotate the plunger adjustment release lever (4) clockwise until it locks into place. The lever
should be parallel to the brake lamp switch connector
receptacle. This action will set the switch plunger length to a final adjustment position and cannot
be undone. If not performed properly the first time, a new brake lamp switch must be installed.
7. Reconnect the wire harness connector (3) to the brake lamp switch.
8. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Combination Switch: Locations
Component ID: 472
Component : SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASH/BEAM SELECT SWITCH SIGNAL G194 20VT/LG
2 WIPER/TURN/BEAM SELECT SWITCH RETURN L900 20WT/YL
3 TURN LAMPS SWITCH SIGNAL L12 20WT/OR
4 INTERMITTENT WIPER SWITCH SIGNAL W52 20BR/YL
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1165
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1166
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1167
Combination Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 472
Component : SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-MULTIFUNCTION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASH/BEAM SELECT SWITCH SIGNAL G194 20VT/LG
2 WIPER/TURN/BEAM SELECT SWITCH RETURN L900 20WT/YL
3 TURN LAMPS SWITCH SIGNAL L12 20WT/OR
4 INTERMITTENT WIPER SWITCH SIGNAL W52 20BR/YL
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1168
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1169
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The multi-function switch (3) is located on the steering column, just below the steering wheel. The
only visible components of the multi-function switch are the control stalk (2) and control knob (1)
that extend through the steering column shrouds on the left side of the column, and the hazard
warning push button (4) that extends through the shroud on the top of the column. The remainder
of the switch including its mounting provisions, its electrical connection, and the turn signal cancel
actuator (5) are concealed beneath the shrouds.
The switch housing and controls are constructed of molded black plastic. Each of the switch
controls has white International Control and Display Symbol graphics applied to it, which clearly
identify its many functions. Three integral locating posts on the switch housing, one on the top and
two on the bottom, slide into channels in a receptacle on the left side of the multi-function switch
mounting housing near the top of the steering column to ensure proper positioning of the switch.
Then two screws secure the switch to the mounting housing. A single integral connector receptacle
containing four terminal pins on the back of the switch housing connects the switch to the vehicle
electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness.
The multi-function switch provides the vehicle operator with a control interface for the following
functions:
- Hazard Warning Control - The multi-function switch hazard warning push button provides two
detent positions (ON and OFF) to control the hazard warning lamps.
Headlamp Beam Selection - The multi-function switch control stalk provides detent switching for
selection of the headlamp HIGH or LOW beams. There is also an intermediate momentary position
that allows the headlamp high beam circuits to be momentarily flashed to provide an optical horn
feature (sometimes referred to as flash-to-pass) as an optical signalling device.
- Turn Signal Control - The multi-function switch control stalk provides momentary non-detent (lane
change) switching or detent switching with automatic cancellation for both the left and right turn
signal lamps.
- Washer Control - The multi-function switch control knob provides a momentary WASH position for
washer system operation.
- Wiper Control - The multi-function switch control knob provides two continuous wipe switch
positions, LOW speed or HIGH speed; and an intermittent wipe mode with five delay interval
positions.
The multi-function switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If any function of the switch is ineffective,
or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch must be replaced as a unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1172
Combination Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The multi-function switch uses resistor multiplexing to control the many functions and features it
provides using only three hard wired output circuits. The switch receives a clean ground from the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN)
on a multi-function switch return circuit. It then provides outputs to the EMIC on a wash/beam
select switch signal circuit to control washer and headlamp beam selection, on an intermittent wiper
switch signal circuit to control wipers, and on a turn lamps switch signal circuit to control turn signal
and hazard warning functions.
The multi-function switch operates as follows:
- Hazard Warning Control - The hazard warning push button of the multi-function switch is
depressed to activate the hazard warning system, and depressed again to turn the system OFF.
When the push button is actuated, the multi-function switch provides an output to the EMIC, and
the EMIC responds by sending electronic hazard switch status messages to the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus. The TIPM then energizes
and flashes or de-energizes both the left and right turn signal circuits to provide the visual hazard
warning.
- Headlamp Beam Selection - The control stalk of the multi-function switch is pulled towards the
steering wheel past a detent to actuate the integral beam select switch circuitry, or to an
intermediate, momentary position before the detent to actuate the optical horn feature. Each time
the control stalk is actuated to a detent position, the opposite headlamp beam from what is
currently selected will be energized. Each time the control stalk is actuated to the momentary
position with the headlamps turned OFF, the headlamp high beams will be illuminated for as long
as the control stalk is held in this position. The multi-function switch provides an output to the
EMIC, and the EMIC responds by sending electronic beam select switch status messages to the
TIPM over the CAN data bus. The TIPM energizes or de-energizes the selected LOW or HIGH
beam circuits.
- Turn Signal Control - The control stalk of the multi-function switch is moved upward to activate the
RIGHT turn signal circuitry, and, downward to activate the LEFT turn signal circuitry. The turn
signal switch has a detent position in each direction that provides turn signals with automatic
cancellation, and an intermediate, momentary position in each direction that automatically provides
three turn signal blinks as a LANE CHANGE feature when the control stalk is tapped or will
energize the turn signals for as long as the control stalk is held in the momentary position. When
the control stalk is moved to a detent turn signal switch position, the cancel actuator extends
toward the center of the steering column. A turn signal cancel cam that is integral to the clockspring
rotates with the steering wheel and the cam lobes contact the cancel actuator when it is extended
from the multi-function switch. When the steering wheel is rotated during a turning maneuver, one
of the two turn signal cancel cam lobes will contact the turn signal cancel actuator. The cancel
actuator latches against the cancel cam rotation in the direction opposite that which is signaled. If
the LEFT turn signal detent is selected, the lobes of the cancel cam will ratchet past the cancel
actuator when the steering wheel is rotated to the left, but will unlatch the cancel actuator as the
steering wheel rotates to the right and returns to center, which will cancel the turn signal event and
release the control stalk from the detent so it returns to the neutral OFF position. When a turn
signal is activated, the multi-function switch provides an output to the EMIC, and the EMIC
responds by sending electronic turn signal switch status messages to the TIPM over the CAN data
bus. The TIPM energizes and flashes or de-energizes the selected left or right turn signal circuits.
- Washer Control - The control knob on the end of the multi-function switch control stalk is
depressed towards the steering column to momentarily activate the washer pump in the WASH
mode. The washer pump will continue to operate in the washer mode until the control knob is
released. The multi-function switch provides an output to the EMIC, and the EMIC responds by
sending electronic washer switch status messages to the TIPM over the CAN data bus. The TIPM
responds by energizing or de-energizing the washer pump in the washer mode.
- Wiper Control - The control knob on the end of the multi-function switch control stalk is rotated to
one of the continuous wiper detents, to one of five intermittent wiper detents, or to the OFF position
to select the wiper mode. The multi-function switch provides an output to the EMIC, and the EMIC
responds by sending electronic wiper switch status messages to the TIPM over the CAN data bus.
The TIPM responds by energizing or de-energizing the wiper motor. The TIPM is programmed to
operate the wiper motor at the selected low or high continuous wipe speed, and to provide the
selected electronically controlled speed-sensitive intermittent wipe or wipe-after-wash mode
features.
The multi-function switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1173
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Remove the multi-function switch from the switch mounting housing on the steering column.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the back of the multi-function switch.
3. Using an ohmmeter, test the resistance between the terminals of the switch as shown in the
Multi-Function Switch Tests table.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1174
4. If the switch fails any of the tests, replace the ineffective multi-function switch as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the driver airbag from the steering wheel.
3. Disconnect the steering wheel wire harness connectors from the upper clockspring connector
receptacles.
CAUTION: Be certain that the screws that secure the steering wheel puller to the steering wheel
are fully engaged in the steering wheel armature without passing through the steering wheel and
damaging the clockspring.
4. Remove the steering wheel from the steering column.
5. Remove the screw (2) that secures the tilt steering column knob (1) and remove it from the tilt
actuator (3) on the left side of the column.
6. From below the steering column, remove the two outboard screws that secure the upper column
shroud (1) to the lower shroud (3).
7. Using hand pressure, press inward on both sides of the upper shroud above the parting line of
the lower shroud to release the snap features that
secure the two shroud halves to each other.
8. Remove the upper shroud from the lower shroud and the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1177
9. Remove the one center screw that secures the lower shroud to the steering column (4).
10. Remove the lower shroud from the steering column.
11. Disconnect the wire harness connector (2) from the back of the multi-function switch housing
(1).
12. Remove the two screws (4) that secure the switch to the multi-function switch mounting
housing (3).
13. Grasp the switch control stalk and pull it toward the left side of the vehicle to remove the switch
from the mounting housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1178
Combination Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Slide the multi-function switch (1) into the multi-function switch mounting housing (3) from the left
side. Be certain that the alignment pins on the
top and bottom of the switch are properly engaged in the channels of the mounting housing.
2. Install and tighten the two screws (4) that secure the switch to the mounting housing. Tighten the
screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
3. Reconnect the wire harness connector (2) to the back of the switch housing.
4. Position the lower shroud (3) onto the steering column (4).
5. From below the steering column, install and tighten the one center screw that secures the lower
shroud to the steering column. Tighten the screw to
2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
6. Position the upper shroud (1) onto the steering column over the lower shroud. On vehicles
equipped with an automatic transmission, be certain to
engage the gearshift lever gap hider into the opening in the right side of both shroud halves.
7. Align the snap features on the upper shroud with the receptacles in the lower shroud and apply
hand pressure to snap them together.
8. Install and tighten the two outboard screws that secure the upper shroud to the lower shroud.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Combination Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1179
9. Position the tilt steering column knob (1) onto the tilt adjuster actuator (3) on the left side of the
steering column, then install and tighten the screw
(2) to secure the knob to the actuator. Tighten the screw to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
NOTE: When reinstalling the steering wheel, be certain to index the yellow rubber booted
engagement dowel on the upper surface of the clockspring rotor between the two fins cast into the
lower surface of the steering wheel armature hub.
10. Reinstall the steering wheel onto the steering column.
11. Reconnect the steering wheel wire harness connectors to the upper clockspring connector
receptacles. Be certain that the steering wheel wire
harness is routed between the steering wheel back trim cover and the steering wheel armature.
12. Reinstall the driver airbag onto the steering wheel.
13. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Door Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This vehicle has up to four door ajar switches, one for each door. Each switch is concealed within
and integral to its respective door latch unit. The switches are momentary leaf contact-type units
that are actuated by the mechanisms internal to the door latch. A short pigtail wire and connector
on each door latch connects the door ajar switch to the vehicle electrical system through its
respective door wire harness.
The door ajar switches cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the door latch
unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1184
Door Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The door ajar switches are actuated by the mechanisms internal to the door latch. When a door is
closed and properly latched, its door ajar switch is an open circuit. When a door is open or only
partially latched, the door ajar switch is a closed circuit. The door ajar switches are hard wired in
series between a body ground and the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known
as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The EMIC reads the hard wired door ajar switch inputs through internal pull-ups, then uses these
inputs to control many electronic functions and features of the vehicle. The EMIC also sends the
proper electronic door ajar switch status messages to other electronic modules in the vehicle over
the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The door ajar switches as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switches may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Removal
LAMP/SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Open the glove box door.
3. Reach through the window in the instrument panel (2) glove box opening behind the switch to
access and depress the retaining latch on either side
of the glove box lamp and switch unit (3).
4. While holding the retaining latch depressed, push the glove box lamp and switch unit out through
the mounting hole in the face of the instrument
panel.
5. Disconnect the wire harness connector (1) from the glove box lamp and switch.
6. Remove the lamp and switch unit from the instrument panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1189
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair Installation
LAMP/SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Position the glove box lamp and switch unit (3) to the instrument panel (2) glove box opening.
2. Reconnect the wire harness connector (1) to the lamp and switch unit.
3. Feed the wire harness back through the switch mounting hole.
4. Align the lamp and switch unit with the mounting hole in the instrument panel.
5. Using hand pressure, push the lamp and switch unit firmly and evenly into the mounting hole
until it is fully seated.
6. Close the glove box door.
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Switch: Locations
Component ID: 466
Component : SWITCH-HEADLAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEADLAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Pin Description Circuit
1 HEADLAMP/FOG LAMP SWITCH SIGNAL L116 20WT/LG
2 PANEL LAMPS DIMMER SIGNAL E2 20OR/BR
3 HEADLAMP SWITCH RETURN L115 20WT/YL
4 HEADLAMP SWITCH DIMMER SIGNAL E19 20OR/BR
5 GROUND Z407 20BK/OR
6 CARGO LAMP SWITCH SIGNAL L914 20WT/LG
7--
8-9-10 - Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1193
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1194
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1195
Headlamp Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 466
Component : SWITCH-HEADLAMP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HEADLAMP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Pin Description Circuit
1 HEADLAMP/FOG LAMP SWITCH SIGNAL L116 20WT/LG
2 PANEL LAMPS DIMMER SIGNAL E2 20OR/BR
3 HEADLAMP SWITCH RETURN L115 20WT/YL
4 HEADLAMP SWITCH DIMMER SIGNAL E19 20OR/BR
5 GROUND Z407 20BK/OR
6 CARGO LAMP SWITCH SIGNAL L914 20WT/LG
7--
8-9-10 - Component Location - 44
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1196
Component Location - 50
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1197
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The headlamp switch (1) is located on the instrument panel, to the left of the steering column. Two
different switches are used. The standard switch features a three-position rotary knob (4) for
exterior lighting control, a thumbwheel (2) for panel lamps dimming and interior lighting control, and
a momentary push button (3) for cargo lamp control. An optional switch has a momentary PUSH
function added to the rotary knob for front fog lamp control.
Each of these switches is constructed of molded plastic. The rotary knob is molded plastic and
knurled around its circumference to ease operator control. The thumbwheel is also plastic and
knurled. On vehicles with optional fog lamps the rotary knob also has the text PUSH and an
International Control and Display Symbol icon for Front Fog Light applied to it. The cargo lamp
push button is plastic with a smooth finish and the text CARGO applied to it. The switch face plate
is also labeled with graphics and icons to clearly identify the many functions of the rotary knob and
thumbwheel.
Three screws secure the switch to the back of the cluster bezel through integral mounting flanges
that are molded to each side of the switch housing. The back of the switch housing has an integral
connector receptacle containing terminal pins that connect the switch to the vehicle electrical
system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire harness. A panel
dimmer controlled incandescent bulb soldered to the circuit board within the switch provides back
lighting for visibility at night, but is not serviceable.
The headlamp switch cannot be repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1200
Headlamp Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The headlamp switch uses two resistor multiplexed outputs and one conventional output to control
the many functions and features it provides. The switch receives a clean ground from the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN)
on a headlamp switch return circuit. It then provides outputs to the EMIC on a headlamp switch
signal circuit to control exterior lighting functions, on a panel lamps dimmer signal circuit to control
panel dimmer and interior lighting functions, and on a cargo lamp return circuit to control the cargo
lamps.
The switch illumination circuit receives a path to ground at all times through the left instrument
panel ground circuit. The illumination level is controlled by a Pulse-Width Modulated (PWM) output
received from the EMIC on a headlamp switch illumination control circuit. The EMIC controls this
output based upon the dimmer signal select mux input from the headlamp switch.
The headlamp switch operates as follows:
- Cargo Lamps Control - The cargo lamp push button on the headlamp switch is depressed to
activate or deactivate the cargo lamps. The headlamp switch provides an output to the EMIC, and
the EMIC responds by providing the appropriate cargo lighting control outputs through its internal
cargo lamp driver circuit.
Front Fog Lamps Control - For vehicles so equipped, the rotary knob on the headlamp switch is
depressed to activate or deactivate the optional front fog lamps. The headlamp switch provides an
output to the EMIC, and the EMIC responds by sending electronic fog lamp switch status
messages to the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN)
data bus. The TIPM responds by energizing or de-energizing the front fog lamps and by sending an
electronic message back to the EMIC to control the front fog lamp indicator.
- Exterior Lighting Control - The rotary knob on the headlamp switch is rotated to a detent position
to activate or deactivate the exterior lighting. The headlamp switch provides an output to the EMIC,
and the EMIC responds by sending electronic exterior lighting switch status messages to the TIPM
over the CAN data bus. The TIPM responds by energizing or de-energizing the park lamp and the
high or low beam headlamp circuits, and by sending an electronic message back to the EMIC to
control the high beam indicator. The TIPM also remembers which headlamp beams were last
selected with the multi-function switch, and energizes those beams by default the next time the
headlamps are turned ON.
- Interior Lighting Control - The thumbwheel on the headlamp switch is rotated to the dome
DEFEAT, dome ON, PARADE mode, or one of the six panel dimmer detent positions to control the
interior courtesy/dome and panel lamps. The headlamp switch provides an output to the EMIC, and
the EMIC responds by providing the appropriate interior lighting control outputs through its internal
courtesy lamp driver circuits, electronic dimming level messages to other modules over the CAN
data bus, and the proper PWM outputs to control dimming levels through several panel dimmer
illumination control driver circuits.
The headlamp switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1201
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
HEADLAMP SWITCH
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Remove the cluster bezel from the instrument panel.
2. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the back of the headlamp switch.
3. Using an ohmmeter, test the resistance or continuity between the terminals of the switch as
shown in the Headlamp Switch Tests table.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1202
4. If the switch fails any of the tests, replace the ineffective headlamp switch as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the cluster bezel (1) from the instrument panel.
3. Disconnect the wire harness connector (3) from the back of the headlamp switch (4).
4. Place the cluster bezel face down on a suitable work surface. Be certain to take the proper
precautions to protect the face of the bezel from
cosmetic damage.
5. Remove the three screws (2) that secure the headlamp switch to the back of the cluster bezel.
6. Remove the headlamp switch from the cluster bezel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1205
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Position the headlamp switch (4) to the back of the cluster bezel (1).
2. Install and tighten the three screws (2) that secure the headlamp switch to the cluster bezel.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (20 in. lbs.).
3. Position the cluster bezel close enough to the instrument panel to reconnect the wire harness
connector (3) to the back of the headlamp switch.
4. Reinstall the cluster bezel onto the instrument panel.
5. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
Horn Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 470
Component : SWITCH-HORN
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-HORN
Color : WHITE
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 HORN SWITCH SENSE X3 20DG/VT
2--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1209
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The horn switch is serviced as a unit with the driver airbag trim cover. The horn switch can not be
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1215
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1216
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1217
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description > Page 1220
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1223
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1227
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1228
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1229
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1230
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1233
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 1239
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor (3) into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (2).
4. Install electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1243
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1244
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1245
Battery Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1246
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1247
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Battery Temperature Sensor (BTS) is used only on the diesel engine. It is attached to the
battery tray located under the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 1250
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The BTS is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery charging rate. This
temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the PCM (ECM Diesel) to
vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The PCM sends 5 volts to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As
temperature increases, resistance in the sensor decreases and the detection voltage at the PCM
increases.
The BTS is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II monitors are either enabled
or disabled, depending upon BTS input (for example, disable purge and enable Leak Detection
Pump (LDP) and O2 sensor heater tests). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20° F.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped
into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4) .
1. Remove battery.
2. Pry sensor (1) straight up from battery tray mounting hole to gain access to electrical connector
(3) .
3. Disconnect sensor from engine wire harness electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 1253
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached
(snapped into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4).
1. Pull electrical connector (3) up through mounting hole in top of battery tray.
2. Connect sensor.
3. Snap sensor into battery tray.
4. Install battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1257
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1258
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1259
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1260
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1261
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1262
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1263
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1264
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1265
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1266
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1267
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1268
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1269
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1272
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1275
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1280
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1283
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1287
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1288
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1289
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1290
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1291
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1292
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1293
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1294
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1295
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1296
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1297
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1298
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1299
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1300
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1301
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1302
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1303
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1304
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1305
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1306
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1307
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1308
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1309
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1310
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1311
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1312
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1313
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1314
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1315
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1316
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1317
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1318
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1319
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1322
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1325
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1329
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1330
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1331
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1332
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 1335
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1340
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1341
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1342
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1343
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1344
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1345
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1346
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1347
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1350
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1351
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1352
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1353
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1354
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1355
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1356
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1357
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1360
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 1363
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1368
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1369
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1370
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1371
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1372
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1373
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1376
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1377
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1378
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1379
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1380
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 1381
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 1387
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1391
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1392
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1393
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1398
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1399
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1400
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1401
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1402
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1403
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Pick Up Models
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1404
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1405
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1406
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1407
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1408
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1409
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1410
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 1411
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1414
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1415
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1416
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1417
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1418
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1419
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1420
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1421
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1422
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1423
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1424
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1425
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1426
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1427
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1428
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 1429
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake > Page 1432
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 1435
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 1436
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 1437
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 1438
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 1443
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1448
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1449
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1450
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1451
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1452
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1453
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1454
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1455
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1456
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1457
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1458
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1461
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1462
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1463
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1464
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1465
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1466
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1467
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1468
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1469
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1470
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1471
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1472
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 1473
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Sensor-MAP
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-MAP
DESCRIPTION
A combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is used.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Sensor-MAP > Page 1476
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1479
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1480
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1481
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1486
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1487
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1488
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1489
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1490
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1491
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1492
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1493
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1494
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1495
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1496
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1497
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1498
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1499
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1500
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1501
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1502
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1503
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1512
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1513
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1514
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1515
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1516
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1517
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 1518
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1524
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1525
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1526
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1536
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1537
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1538
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1543
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1544
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1545
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1546
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1547
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1548
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 1549
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1559
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1560
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 1561
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1571
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1572
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1573
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1574
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1575
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1576
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 1577
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1580
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1581
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1582
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1583
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1584
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1585
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1586
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1587
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1588
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1589
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1590
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1591
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1592
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1593
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1594
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1595
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1596
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1597
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1598
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1599
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1600
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1601
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1602
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1603
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1604
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1605
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1606
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1607
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1608
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 1609
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Module-O2 Sensor
Component ID: 207
Component : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1612
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1613
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1614
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1615
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1616
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1617
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1618
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1619
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1620
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1621
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1622
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1623
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1624
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1625
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1626
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1627
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1628
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1629
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1630
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1631
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1632
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1633
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1634
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1635
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1636
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1637
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1638
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1639
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1640
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1641
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 1642
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors (1) and (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models > Page 1645
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream (1), and 1/2
downstream (2).
A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models > Page 1646
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Module
Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream, and 1/2
downstream. A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Oxygen Sensor Module
Removal - Pick Up Models
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at module (1).
3. Remove four bolts (3).
4. Remove module from frame rail.
Installation - Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Position module (1) to frame rail (4).
2. Install four bolts (3).
3. Tighten bolts (3) to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to module (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 1649
5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 1650
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
CAUTION: Never apply any type of grease to the oxygen sensor electrical connector, or attempt
any soldering of the sensor wiring harness.
WARNING: The exhaust manifold, exhaust pipes and catalytic converters become very hot during
engine operation. Allow engine to cool before removing oxygen sensor.
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect main wire connector from O2S sensor pigtail harness.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wire going into
sensor.
3. Remove O2S sensor with an oxygen sensor removal and installation tool.
4. Clean threads in catalytic convertor using appropriate tap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 1651
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Threads of NEW oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal.
DO NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new oxygen sensor. Be careful
not to get anti-seize compound on sensor tip.
1. Install O2S sensor. Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
2. Connect O2S sensor pigtail harness to main wire harness connector.
3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A pressure sensing switch is used in the power steering system. It is mounted on the high-pressure
steering hose. This switch will only be used on HD vehicles with the 5.7L engines. There is no
pressure switch used for the 3.7L, 4.7L, 5.9LDiesel engine or the 5.7L LD vehicle pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1656
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The switch is used on the 5.7L V-8 engines HD vehicles only.
The power steering pressure switch provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
This input is provided during periods of high steering pump load and low engine rpm; such as
during parking maneuvers. The PCM increases the idle speed through the Idle Air Control (IAC)
motor. This is done to prevent the engine from stalling under the increased load.
When steering pump pressure exceeds 3275 kPa ± 690 kPa (475 psi ± 100 psi), the Normally
Closed (NC) switch will open and the PCM will increase the engine idle speed. This will prevent the
engine from stalling.
When pump pressure drops to approximately 1379 kPa (200 psi), the switch circuit will re-close
and engine idle speed will return to its previous setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1661
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1666
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1667
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1668
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1669
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1670
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1671
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1672
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1673
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1674
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1675
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1676
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1679
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1680
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1681
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1682
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1683
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1684
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1685
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1686
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1687
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1688
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 1689
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 1692
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 1693
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 1694
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 1695
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 1696
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 1699
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 1700
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 1701
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 1702
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 1703
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1707
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1708
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1709
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1714
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1715
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1716
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1717
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1718
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1719
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1720
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1721
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1722
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1723
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1724
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1725
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1726
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1727
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1728
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1729
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1730
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1731
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1737
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1738
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1739
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1740
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1741
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1742
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1743
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1744
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1747
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1748
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1749
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1750
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1751
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1752
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1753
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 1754
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1757
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1760
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1764
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1765
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1766
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1767
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1770
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
EGR Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 394
Component : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH/D1)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
OPERATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models > Page 1776
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Pick Up Models
OPERATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
A temperature probe (1) is located at the end of the sensor assembly (3).
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near EGR valve.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
2. Remove sensor (1) from EGR tube (6).
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1779
1. If equipped, remove four cover bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
2. If equipped, remove EGR valve cover (2).
3. A pigtail wiring harness connects sensor to engine wiring harness.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1780
4. Unscrew nut (2) at intake manifold.
5. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness electrical connector from engine wiring harness and remove
sensor assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1781
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
1. Clean EGR crossover tube at sensor mounting point.
2. Check condition of the sensors metal gasket and replace if necessary.
3. Install sensor (1) to EGR tube (6). Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1782
1. A pigtail wiring harness (3) connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Position sensor probe (1) into intake manifold.
3. Screw and tighten nut (2) into intake manifold.
4. Connect electrical connector (4) to engine wiring harness.
5. Install EGR valve cover (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1783
6. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Differential Pressure Sensor is remotely mounted on the transmission housing. Two
pressure tubes measure pressure before and after the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)/Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC). The sensor is critical for fail-safe of regeneration strategy, because it
interprets high pressure drops as possible high soot loads.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at pressure
differential pressure sensor. 4. Remove mounting bolt and differential pressure sensor. 5. Remove
mounting bolts (1).
6. Remove pressure differential pressure tubing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1789
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install differential pressure tubing, if removed. Tighten fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
2. Position differential pressure sensor (1). 3. Install mounting nuts (5) and bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 4. Install hose (2) to the rear DPF tubing. 5. Install hose (3) to the front DPF tubing. 6.
Connect electrical connector (6). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1794
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1799
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1800
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1801
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 1804
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 1807
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1811
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1812
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1813
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1814
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1817
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 1822
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 1823
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 1824
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Pressure
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
1825
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
1826
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
1827
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
1828
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel pressure sensor monitors actual high-pressure within the fuel rail. An output signal from
this sensor (relating to fuel pressure) is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
1. Remove two bolts (3) and bracket (4) at rear of cylinder head.
2. Remove engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1831
3. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
4. Remove sensor (1) from fuel rail.
5. Inspect sensor sealing surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 1832
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect fuel pressure sensor sealing surface.
2. Lubricate sensor threads with clean diesel fuel.
3. Install sensor (1) into fuel rail.
4. To prevent leaks, sensor must be tightened to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
6. Install rear engine lift bracket (4) and bolts (3). Tighten to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.).
7. Install engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
8. Start engine and check for fuel leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1836
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1837
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1838
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models >
Page 1843
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1844
Turbo Boost Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 1847
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 1848
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 1849
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Turbocharger Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove
turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt (1). 4. Remove turbocharger speed sensor (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install turbocharger speed sensor. 2. Install turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt. 3. Tighten
bolt to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1853
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1854
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1855
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1860
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1861
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1862
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1863
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1864
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1865
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1866
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1867
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1868
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1869
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1870
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1871
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1872
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 1875
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
1878
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1882
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1883
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1884
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1885
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1886
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1887
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1888
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1889
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1890
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1891
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1892
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1893
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1894
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1895
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1896
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1897
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1898
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1899
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1900
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1901
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1902
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1903
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1904
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1905
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1906
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1907
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1908
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1909
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1910
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1911
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1912
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1913
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1914
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 1917
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
1920
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (1) for cylinder removal.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from
steering column. 3. Place shifter in PARK position. 4. A retaining pin is located at the underside of
the key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder (1) from
ignition switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 1926
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (3) for cylinder installation.
1. Install the key cylinder into the housing using care to align the end of the key cylinder (3) with the
ignition switch (1). 2. Push the key cylinder (3) in until it clicks. 3. Replace the upper and lower
shrouds. 4. Reconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page
1931
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Locations
Component ID: 475
Component : SWITCH-PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH SENSE R106 20LG/LB
2 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH RETURN R104 20LB/LG
3 PASSENGER AIRBAG INDICATOR DRIVER G104 20VT/GY
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
5-6-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1936
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1937
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1938
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 475
Component : SWITCH-PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH SENSE R106 20LG/LB
2 PASSENGER AIRBAG MUX SWITCH RETURN R104 20LB/LG
3 PASSENGER AIRBAG INDICATOR DRIVER G104 20VT/GY
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F201 20PK/OR
5-6-Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1939
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1940
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The passenger airbag on/off switch (1) is standard equipment on all standard cab versions of this
vehicle equipped with the dual front airbag system. This switch is a two-position, resistor
multiplexed switch with a single integral amber Light-Emitting Diode (LED), and a non-coded key
cylinder-type actuator. The switch is located in the lower right corner of the instrument panel center
bezel, near the center of the instrument panel.
When the switch is in its installed position, the only components visible through the dedicated
opening of the center bezel are the switch bezel (2) and lens, the nomenclature imprinted on the
lens, and the key cylinder actuator (3). The OFF position nomenclature of the switch is illuminated
and visible only when that switch position is selected. The ON position of the switch is neither
visible or illuminated but can be determined by the orientation of the slot of the key cylinder
actuator. The remainder of the switch is concealed behind the switch bezel and the instrument
panel center bezel.
The passenger airbag on/off switch housing is constructed of molded plastic and has three integral
mounting tabs. These mounting tabs are used to secure the switch to the back of the molded
plastic switch bezel with three small screws. The molded plastic switch bezel also has three
integral mounting tabs that are used to secure the switch and bezel unit to the instrument panel
center bezel with three additional screws.
A molded plastic connector receptacle on the back of the switch housing connects the switch to the
vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and connector of the instrument panel wire
harness. The molded plastic harness connector insulator is keyed and latched to ensure proper
and secure switch electrical connections.
The passenger airbag on/off switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged,
the switch must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1943
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The passenger airbag on/off switch allows the customer to turn the passenger airbag function ON
or OFF to accommodate certain uses of the right front seating position where airbag protection may
not be desired. See the owner's manual in the vehicle glove box for specific recommendations on
when to enable or disable the passenger airbag. The OFF indicator of the switch will be illuminated
whenever the switch is turned to the OFF position and the ignition switch is in the ON position.
The ignition key is the only key or object that should ever be inserted into the key cylinder actuator
of the switch. The on/off switch requires only a partial key insertion to fully depress a spring-loaded
locking plunger. The spring-loaded locking plunger prevents the user from leaving the key in the
switch. The key will be automatically ejected when force is not applied. To actuate the passenger
airbag on/off switch, insert the ignition key into the switch key actuator far enough to fully depress
the plunger, then rotate the actuator to the desired switch position.
When the switch key actuator is rotated to its clockwise stop (the key actuator slot will be aligned
with the OFF nomenclature), the OFF indicator is illuminated and the passenger airbag is disabled.
When the switch is rotated to its counterclockwise stop (the key actuator slot will be in a vertical
position) the OFF indicator will be extinguished and the passenger airbag is enabled. The OFF
indicator and the enabling or disabling of the passenger airbag is controlled electronically by the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) based upon inputs it receives from the on/off switch.
The passenger airbag on/off switch connects one of two internal resistors in series between the
passenger airbag MUX switch sense and passenger airbag mux switch return circuits of the ORC.
The ORC continually monitors the resistance in these circuits to determine the switch position that
has been selected. When the switch is in the OFF position, the ORC provides a ground input to the
OFF indicator through the passenger airbag indicator driver circuit, which energizes the
Light-Emitting Diode (LED) that illuminates the indicator. The ORC will store a Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) for any fault it detects in the passenger airbag on/off switch or OFF indicator circuits,
and will illuminate the airbag indicator in the instrument cluster if a fault is detected.
The hard wired circuits between the passenger airbag on/off switch and the ORC may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. However, conventional diagnostic
methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the passenger airbag on/off switch or the
electronic controls and communication between other modules and devices that provide some
features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to
diagnose the passenger airbag on/off switch or the electronic controls and communication related
to passenger airbag on/off switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
NOTE: A passenger airbag on/off switch is used only on standard cab vehicles equipped with dual
front airbags. Quad cab and mega cab vehicles have a cubby bin installed in the instrument panel
center bezel in place of the on/off switch.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. Remove the center bezel (1) from the instrument panel.
3. From the back of the center bezel, remove the three screws (2) that secure the passenger airbag
on/off switch and bezel unit (3) to the back of the
center bezel.
4. Remove the passenger airbag on/off switch and bezel from the center bezel as a unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1946
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
NOTE: A passenger airbag on/off switch is used only on standard cab vehicles equipped with dual
front airbags. Quad cab and mega cab vehicles have a cubby bin installed in the instrument panel
center bezel in place of the on/off switch.
1. Position the passenger airbag on/off switch and bezel unit (3) to the back of the center bezel (1).
2. Install and tighten the three screws (2) that secure the passenger airbag on/off switch bezel to
the back of the center bezel. Tighten the screws to 2
Nm (17 in. lbs.).
3. Reinstall the center bezel onto the instrument panel.
4. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left
Impact Sensor: Locations Sensor-Front Impact-Left
Component ID: 402
Component : SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R81 20LB/WT
2 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R79 20LB/VT
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1951
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1952
Impact Sensor: Locations Sensor-Side Impact-Left 1
Component ID: 423
Component : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R13 20LG/TN
2 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R15 20LG/BR
3-4-Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1953
Component Location - 63
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1954
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1955
Impact Sensor: Locations Sensor-Side Impact-Right 1
Component ID: 424
Component : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R14 20TN/LG
2 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R16 20BR/LG
3-4-Component Location - 61
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1956
Component Location - 64
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1957
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Front Impact-Left
Component ID: 402
Component : SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FRONT IMPACT-LEFT
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR GROUND R81 20LB/WT
2 LEFT FRONT IMPACT SENSOR SIGNAL R79 20LB/VT
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1960
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1961
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Side Impact-Left 1
Component ID: 423
Component : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-LEFT 1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R13 20LG/TN
2 LEFT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R15 20LG/BR
3-4-Component Location - 58
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1962
Component Location - 63
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1963
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1964
Impact Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Side Impact-Right 1
Component ID: 424
Component : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SIDE IMPACT-RIGHT 1
Color : YELLOW
# of pins : 4
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 SIGNAL R14 20TN/LG
2 RIGHT SIDE IMPACT SENSOR 1 GROUND R16 20BR/LG
3-4-Component Location - 61
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1965
Component Location - 64
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Front Impact-Left > Page 1966
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Description
Front
FRONT
Two front impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle, one each for the left and right sides of the
vehicle. These sensors are mounted remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each front impact sensor is secured with a screw to the back
of the right or left end of the lower radiator crossmember within the engine compartment. The
sensor housing has an integral connector receptacle (4), an integral anti-rotation pin (3), and an
integral mounting hole (2) with a metal sleeve to provide crush protection.
The right and left front impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. A cavity in the
center of the molded black plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the
sensor which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. Potting
material fills the cavity to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components. The
front impact sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the headlamp and dash wire harness.
The front impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, they must
be replaced.
Side
SIDE
Two side impact sensors (1) are used on this vehicle when it is equipped with the optional side
curtain airbags, one each for the left and right sides of the vehicle. These sensors are mounted
remotely from the impact sensor that is internal to the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). Each
side sensor is secured with a nut within the right or left B-pillar just above the front seat belt
retractors and behind the lower B-pillar trim within the passenger compartment. The sensor
housing has an integral connector receptacle (2), an integral mounting stud (3), and an integral
anti-rotation pin.
The right and left side impact sensors are identical in construction and calibration. A cavity in the
center of the molded plastic impact sensor housing contains the electronic circuitry of the sensor
which includes an electronic communication chip and an electronic impact sensor. Potting material
fills the cavity to seal and protect the internal electronic circuitry and components. The side impact
sensors are each connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take out and
connector of the body wire harness.
The side impact sensors cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or ineffective, they must
be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1969
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
Front
FRONT
The front impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration,
which provides verification of the direction and severity of an impact. Each sensor also contains an
electronic communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the sensor status as well as
sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through dedicated left and right sensor plus and
minus circuits from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating the
voltage in the sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the front impact sensors and the ORC may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the impact
sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that
provide features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls and communication related to
front impact sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Side
SIDE
The side impact sensors are electronic accelerometers that sense the rate of vehicle deceleration,
which provides verification of the direction and severity of an impact. Each sensor also contains an
electronic communication chip that allows the unit to communicate the sensor status as well as
sensor fault information to the microprocessor in the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC).
The ORC microprocessor continuously monitors all of the side passive restraint system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ORC detects a monitored system fault, it sets a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) and controls the airbag indicator operation accordingly. The impact
sensors each receive battery current and ground through left or right sensor plus and minus circuits
from the ORC. The impact sensors and the ORC communicate by modulating the voltage in the
sensor plus circuit.
The hard wired circuits between the side impact sensors and the ORC may be diagnosed using
conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the impact
sensors or the electronic controls or communication between other modules and devices that
provide features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and accurate
means to diagnose the impact sensors or the electronic controls and communication related to side
impact sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan tool. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the front supplemental restraints. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service,
the sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could
result in accidental, incomplete, or improper front supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. Remove the screw (4) that secures the right or left front impact sensor (3) to the back of the right
or left end of the lower radiator crossmember (1).
3. Disconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector (2) from the sensor connector
receptacle.
4. Remove the right or left front impact sensor from the engine compartment.
Side - Mega Cab
SIDE - MEGA CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1972
1. Adjust the front seat to its most forward position for easiest access to the B-pillar trim.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
3. Remove the nut (3) that secures the stud of the side impact sensor (4) to the inner B-pillar (2).
4. Reach through the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the inner B-pillar to access
the side impact sensor and disengage the
anti-rotation pin and mounting stud from the holes in the inner B-pillar.
5. Pull the side impact sensor out through the large hole in the B-pillar far enough to access and
disconnect the body wire harness connector (1) from
the sensor connector receptacle.
6. Remove the side impact sensor from the B-pillar.
Side - Quad Cab
SIDE - QUAD CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1973
1. Adjust the front seat to its most forward position for easiest access to the B-pillar trim.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
3. Remove the nut (3) that secures the stud of the side impact sensor (2) to the inner B-pillar (1).
4. Reach through the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the inner B-pillar to access
the side impact sensor and disengage the
anti-rotation pin and mounting stud from the holes in the inner B-pillar.
5. Pull the side impact sensor out through the large hole in the B-pillar far enough to access and
disconnect the body wire harness connector (4) from
the sensor connector receptacle.
6. Remove the side impact sensor from the B-pillar.
Side - Standard Cab
SIDE - STANDARD CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Adjust the driver or passenger side front seat to its most forward position for easiest access to
the B-pillar trim.
2. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
3. Remove the front outboard seat belt and retractor from the inside of the B-pillar.
4. Remove the nut (4) that secures the stud of the side impact sensor (1) to the inner B-pillar.
5. Reach through the retractor mounting hole (3) in the inner B-pillar to access the side impact
sensor and disengage the anti-rotation pin and
mounting stud from the holes in the inner B-pillar.
6. Pull the side impact sensor out of the B-pillar far enough to access and disconnect the body wire
harness connector (2) from the sensor connector
receptacle.
7. Remove the sensor from the B-pillar.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1974
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Front
FRONT
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the front impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The front impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the front supplemental restraints. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service,
the sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could
result in accidental, incomplete, or improper front supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Position the right or left front impact sensor (3) into the engine compartment.
2. Reconnect the headlamp and dash wire harness connector (2) to the sensor connector
receptacle.
3. Carefully position the sensor onto the back of the right or left end of the lower radiator
crossmember (1). Be certain that the anti-rotation pin on
the back of the sensor is engaged in the clearance hole of the crossmember.
4. Install and tighten the screw (4) that secures the sensor to the back of the crossmember. Tighten
the screw to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.).
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Side - Mega Cab
SIDE - MEGA CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1975
1. Position the side impact sensor (4) to the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the
inner B-pillar (2).
2. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (1) to the sensor connector receptacle.
3. Reach through the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the inner B-pillar to position
and engage the anti-rotation pin and the stud on the
side impact sensor to the locating slot and mounting hole from the inside of the B-pillar.
4. Install and tighten the nut (3) that secures the side impact sensor stud to the inner B-pillar.
Tighten the nut to 8 Nm (70 in. lbs.).
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Side - Quad Cab
SIDE - QUAD CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Position the side impact sensor (2) to the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the
inner B-pillar (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1976
2. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (4) to the sensor connector receptacle.
3. Reach through the large hole above the retractor mounting hole in the inner B-pillar to position
and engage the anti-rotation pin and the stud on the
side impact sensor to the locating slot and mounting hole from the inside of the B-pillar.
4. Install and tighten the nut (3) that secures the side impact sensor stud to the inner B-pillar.
Tighten the nut to 8 Nm (70 in. lbs.).
5. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Side - Standard Cab
SIDE - STANDARD CAB
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury, never strike or drop the side impact sensor, as it can
damage the impact sensor or affect its calibration. The side impact sensor enables the system to
deploy the side curtain airbags. If an impact sensor is accidentally dropped during service, the
sensor must be scrapped and replaced with a new unit. Failure to observe this warning could result
in accidental, incomplete, or improper supplemental restraint deployment.
1. Position the side impact sensor (1) to the retractor mounting hole (3) in the inner B-pillar.
2. Reconnect the body wire harness connector (2) to the sensor connector receptacle.
3. Reach through the retractor mounting hole in the inner B-pillar to position and engage the
anti-rotation pin and the stud on the side impact sensor
to the locating slot and mounting hole from the inside of the B-pillar.
4. Install and tighten the nut (4) that secures the side impact sensor stud to the inner B-pillar.
Tighten the nut to 8 Nm (70 in. lbs.).
5. Reinstall the front outboard seat belt and retractor to the inside of the B-pillar.
6. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 483
Component : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z951 18BK
2 SEAT BELT SWITCH SENSE G10 20VT/LG
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1980
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z917 20BK
2 DRIVER SEAT BELT SWITCH SENSE R57 20LG/GY
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1981
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1982
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 483
Component : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z951 18BK
2 SEAT BELT SWITCH SENSE G10 20VT/LG
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1983
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-SEAT BELT-DRIVER
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z917 20BK
2 DRIVER SEAT BELT SWITCH SENSE R57 20LG/GY
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 1984
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles are equipped with a driver side seat belt switch that is a small, normally open, single
pole, single throw, leaf contact, momentary switch. The driver side seat belt switch is integral to the
buckle (1) of the driver side front seat belt buckle, which is located on a stamped steel stanchion
secured by a screw (3) to the inboard side of the driver side front seat cushion frame.
The seat belt switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a two-lead pigtail wire
and connector (4) on the seat belt buckle-half, which is connected to a wire harness connector and
take out of the seat wire harness routed beneath the driver side front seat cushion in the passenger
compartment.
The seat belt switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the entire driver side
front seat belt buckle-half unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1987
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The driver side seat belt switch is designed to control a path to ground for the seat belt switch
sense input of the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab
Compartment Node/CCN). When the driver side front seat belt tip-half is inserted into the seat belt
buckle, the switch closes the path to ground; and, when the driver side front seat belt tip-half is
removed from the seat belt buckle, the switch opens the ground path. The switch is actuated by the
latch mechanism within the seat belt buckle.
The seat belt switch is connected in series between ground and the seat belt switch sense input of
the instrument cluster. The seat belt switch receives ground at all times through its pigtail wire
connection to the seat wire harness from a take out of the body wire harness. An eyelet terminal
connector on the body wire harness ground take out is secured beneath a ground screw on the left
cowl side inner panel, beneath the instrument panel.
The seat belt switch as well as the hard wired inputs and outputs of the switch may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The seat track position sensor (2) is a Hall Effect-type sensor used on some vehicles. This sensor
consists of a Hall Effect Integrated Circuit (IC) chip encased in potting material within a cavity of the
molded plastic sensor housing.
The sensor housing has a mounting slot containing an integral latch feature (1) and slides and
latches onto a stamped metal blade-type bracket located on the inboard side of the upper inboard
seat adjuster track near the rear of the driver side front seat. A molded connector receptacle (3)
integral to the sensor housing is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a connector
and take out of the driver seat wire harness beneath the front seat cushion frame.
The seat track position sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if ineffective or damaged, the
entire sensor must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 1992
Seat Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The seat track position sensor is designed to provide a seat position data input to the Occupant
Restraint Controller (ORC) indicating whether the driver side front seat is in a full forward or a not
full forward position. The ORC uses this data as an additional logic input for use in determining the
appropriate deployment force to be used when deploying the multistage driver side front airbag.
The seat track position sensor receives a nominal five volt supply from the ORC. The sensor
communicates the seat position by modulating the voltage returned to the ORC on a sensor data
circuit. The ORC also monitors the condition of the sensor circuits and will store a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) for any fault that is detected, and sends messages over the Controller Area
Network (CAN) data bus to illuminate the airbag indicator in the ElectroMechanical Instrument
Cluster (EMIC) (also known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN).
The hard wired circuits between the seat track position sensor and the ORC may be diagnosed
using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the seat
track position sensor or the electronic controls and communication between other modules and
devices that provide features of the supplemental restraint system. The most reliable, efficient, and
accurate means to diagnose the seat track position sensor or the electronic controls and
communication related to seat track position sensor operation requires the use of a diagnostic scan
tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. Reach under the front seat cushion to access the seat track position sensor (2) on a bracket (1)
located on the inboard side near the rear of the
upper inboard driver seat track (4).
3. Using a small screwdriver, hold the latch feature (3) depressed while sliding the connector end of
the sensor off of the bracket.
4. Disconnect the seat wire harness connector (5) from the sensor connector receptacle.
5. Remove the sensor from under the front seat.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 1995
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: To avoid serious or fatal injury on vehicles equipped with airbags, disable the
supplemental restraint system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, airbag, seat
belt tensioner, impact sensor, or instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and
isolate the battery negative (ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the
supplemental restraint system. Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental
airbag deployment.
1. Reach under the driver side front seat cushion to reconnect the seat wire harness connector (5)
to the seat track position sensor (2) connector
receptacle. Be certain that the latch on the connector is fully engaged.
2. Align the open end of the sensor to the slide tab of the sensor bracket (1) located on the inboard
side near the rear of the upper inboard driver seat
track (4).
3. Push the sensor firmly onto the bracket until the latch feature (3) snaps into place with an
audible click.
4. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. The supplemental restraint system
verification test procedure should be performed
following service of any supplemental restraint system component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Seat Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 422
Component : SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (EXCEPT HEATED SEATS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR DATA R261 20LB/TN
2 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR VOLTAGER263 20LB/GY
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1999
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2000
Seat Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 422
Component : SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-SEAT TRACK POSITION-DRIVER
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (EXCEPT HEATED SEATS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR DATA R261 20LB/TN
2 DRIVER SEAT POSITION SENSOR VOLTAGER263 20LB/GY
Component Location - 66
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2001
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2006
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2007
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2008
Battery Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2009
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2010
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Battery Temperature Sensor (BTS) is used only on the diesel engine. It is attached to the
battery tray located under the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 2013
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The BTS is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery charging rate. This
temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the PCM (ECM Diesel) to
vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The PCM sends 5 volts to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As
temperature increases, resistance in the sensor decreases and the detection voltage at the PCM
increases.
The BTS is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II monitors are either enabled
or disabled, depending upon BTS input (for example, disable purge and enable Leak Detection
Pump (LDP) and O2 sensor heater tests). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20° F.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped
into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4) .
1. Remove battery.
2. Pry sensor (1) straight up from battery tray mounting hole to gain access to electrical connector
(3) .
3. Disconnect sensor from engine wire harness electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 2016
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached
(snapped into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4).
1. Pull electrical connector (3) up through mounting hole in top of battery tray.
2. Connect sensor.
3. Snap sensor into battery tray.
4. Install battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (1) for cylinder removal.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from
steering column. 3. Place shifter in PARK position. 4. A retaining pin is located at the underside of
the key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder (1) from
ignition switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2022
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (3) for cylinder installation.
1. Install the key cylinder into the housing using care to align the end of the key cylinder (3) with the
ignition switch (1). 2. Push the key cylinder (3) in until it clicks. 3. Replace the upper and lower
shrouds. 4. Reconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Switch-Clutch Interlock
Neutral Safety Switch: Locations Switch-Clutch Interlock
Component ID: 459
Component : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK
Color : GREEN
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
2 GROUND Z911 20BK
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2027
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2028
Neutral Safety Switch: Locations Switch-Clutch Interlock/Upstop
Component ID: 460
Component : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
4 GROUND Z993 18BK
5-6--
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2029
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Clutch Interlock
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagrams Switch-Clutch Interlock
Component ID: 459
Component : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK
Color : GREEN
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (M/T)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
2 GROUND Z911 20BK
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2032
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2033
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagrams Switch-Clutch Interlock/Upstop
Component ID: 460
Component : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
4 GROUND Z993 18BK
5-6--
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Clutch Interlock > Page 2034
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A pressure sensing switch is used in the power steering system. It is mounted on the high-pressure
steering hose. This switch will only be used on HD vehicles with the 5.7L engines. There is no
pressure switch used for the 3.7L, 4.7L, 5.9LDiesel engine or the 5.7L LD vehicle pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
> Page 2041
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The switch is used on the 5.7L V-8 engines HD vehicles only.
The power steering pressure switch provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
This input is provided during periods of high steering pump load and low engine rpm; such as
during parking maneuvers. The PCM increases the idle speed through the Idle Air Control (IAC)
motor. This is done to prevent the engine from stalling under the increased load.
When steering pump pressure exceeds 3275 kPa ± 690 kPa (475 psi ± 100 psi), the Normally
Closed (NC) switch will open and the PCM will increase the engine idle speed. This will prevent the
engine from stalling.
When pump pressure drops to approximately 1379 kPa (200 psi), the switch circuit will re-close
and engine idle speed will return to its previous setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Suspension Mode Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
Suspension Mode Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 461
Component : SWITCH-DISCONNECTING STABILIZER BAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-DISCONNECTING STABILIZER BAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
2 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
3 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
4 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
5 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
6 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
7 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
8 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
9 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
10 - 11 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER E11 20OR/DB
12 GROUND Z952 20BK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2051
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2052
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2053
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The TCM utilizes a closed-loop system to control transmission line pressure. The system contains
a variable force style solenoid, the Pressure Control Solenoid, which is part of the pressure switch
assembly. The solenoid is duty cycle controlled by the TCM to vent the unnecessary line pressure
supplied by the oil pump back to the pump inlet. The system contains a Line Pressure Sensor,
which is a direct input to the TCM. The line pressure sensor monitors the transmission line
pressure and completes the feedback loop to the TCM. The TCM uses this information to adjust its
control of the pressure control solenoid to achieve the desired line pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 2056
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The TCM calculates the desired line pressure based upon inputs from the transmission and engine.
The TCM calculates the torque input to the transmission and uses that information as the primary
input to the calculation. The line pressure is set to a predetermined value during shifts, to ensure
consistent shift quality. During all other operation, the desired line pressure value is adjusted based
on torque level and other transmission requirements.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Remove the bolt holding the line pressure sensor
(2) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the line pressure sensor (2) from the transmission case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
2059
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the line
pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Overdrive Switch: Locations
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2063
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2064
Overdrive Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2065
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2066
Overdrive Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - OVERDRIVE ELECTRICAL CONTROLS
The tow/haul overdrive off switch, valve body solenoid, case connectors and related wiring can all
be tested with a 12 volt test lamp or a volt/ohmmeter. Check continuity of each component when
diagnosis indicates this is necessary.
Switch and solenoid continuity should be checked whenever the transmission fails to shift into
fourth gear range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2069
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2070
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2071
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2072
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2073
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2074
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission >
Page 2075
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2080
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2081
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2082
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2083
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2084
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2085
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2086
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2087
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2088
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2089
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2090
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2093
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2094
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2095
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2096
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2097
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2098
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2099
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2100
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2101
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2102
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission
Range > Page 2103
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 2106
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 2107
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 2108
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 2109
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
2110
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 2113
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 2114
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 2115
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 2116
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 2117
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2122
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2123
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2124
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2125
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2126
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2127
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2128
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2129
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2130
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2131
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2132
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2133
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2134
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2135
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2136
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2137
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2138
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2139
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2140
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2143
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2144
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2145
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2146
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2147
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2148
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2149
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2150
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2151
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2152
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2153
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2154
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2155
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2156
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2157
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2158
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2159
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2160
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
2161
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor (1) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the park
gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed.
Operation
OPERATION
Speed sensor signals are triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup
face. Input signals from the sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing.
Signals from this sensor are shared with the powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 2164
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 2165
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
INPUT AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSORS
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate DC
square wave signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case
and are considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the "teeth"
of the gear pass by the sensor coil, an DC square wave is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an DC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the rear planetary carrier lugs. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the input speed sensor (3). 4. Remove the bolt holding the input speed sensor to
the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor (3) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the input speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the input
speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid as
necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 2168
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the output speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the bolt holding the output speed sensor
(1) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor (1) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the output speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the output
speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor (1). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 2169
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3.
Remove the wiring connector from the output speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the output
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 2170
3. Remove the wiring connector from the input speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the input
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the output
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission fluid
level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF as necessary.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 2171
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the input
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
electrical wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission
fluid level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2175
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2176
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 2177
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - M/T > Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH-CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION
1. Disconnect switch 2-wire connector (2) attached to pedal support bracket (1), under instrument
panel to left of clutch pedal. 2. Check switch continuity with an ohmmeter while operating clutch
pedal.
- Pedal Depressed - Continuity
- Pedal Released - No Continuity
3. If continuity is not present or always present, replace clutch master cylinder. Switch is not
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This Engine Control Module (ECM) input is used only on models equipped with aftermarket Power
Take Off (PTO) units.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 2187
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
This input is used only to tell the ECM that the aftermarket PTO (Power Take Off) unit has been
engaged. The ECM will disable (temporarily shut down) certain OBD II diagnostic trouble codes
when the PTO unit is engaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2192
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2193
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2194
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2195
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2196
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2197
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2198
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2201
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere, is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2202
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2203
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2204
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2205
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2206
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 2207
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2212
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2213
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2214
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2215
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2216
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2217
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2218
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2219
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2220
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2223
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2224
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2225
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2226
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2227
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2228
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2229
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2230
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 2231
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2234
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2235
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The FCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and monitor
the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is mechanically
linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode sensor draws less
than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Front Control Module (FCM) monitors the mode sensor
outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to for the relative angles of the transfer case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case
gear operating mode. Refer to for the sensor codes returned to the FCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angle Vs. Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2236
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2237
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV271 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case position sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the transfer case's current operating mode. The sensor consists of a five position, resistive
multiplexed circuit which returns a specific resistance value to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) for each transfer case operating mode. The sensor is located on the top of the transfer
case, just left of the transfer case centerline and rides against the sector plate roostercomb. The
PCM supplies 5VDC (+/- 0.5V) to the sensor and monitors the return voltage to determine the
sector plate, and therefore the transfer case, position.
Operation
OPERATION
Operating Mode Versus Resistance
Position Sensor Linear Movement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2238
During normal vehicle operation, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) monitors the transfer case
position sensor return voltage to determine the operating mode of the transfer case. Refer to the
Operating Mode Versus Resistance table for the correct resistance for each position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2239
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2240
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2241
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2242
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Disengage the transfer case position sensor connector from
the position sensor. 3. Remove the position sensor from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2245
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring seal on the transfer case position sensor. Replace the O-ring if necessary. 2.
Install the transfer case position sensor into the transfer case. Torque the sensor to 27 Nm (20
ft.lbs.). 3. Engage the transfer case position sensor connector to the position sensor. 4. Lower
vehicle. 5. Verify proper sensor operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2250
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2251
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2252
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2255
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2256
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 2257
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Output
Shaft Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the front output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the front output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the front output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the front output shaft speed sensor. 3.
Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Output
Shaft Speed-Front > Page 2260
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Rear
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the rear output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the rear output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the rear output shaft speed sensor. 3. Lower
the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The switch for the rear window defogger (EBL) system (1) is integrated into the A/C-heater control
(2), which is located in the center of the instrument panel. When the rear window defogger switch is
pressed to ON, a request signal is sent on the CAN-B Bus to the totally integrated power module
(TIPM) to operate the EBL system.
When the high side driver in the totally integrated power module (TIPM) is energized, current is
directed to the rear defogger grid lines and to the heated side view mirrors. The grid lines heat the
glass to help clear the surface of fog or frost.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2266
Heated Glass Element Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
An amber indicator will illuminate when the rear window defogger switch is activated. When
activated, the switch sends a request signal to the to the totally integrated power module (TIPM) to
energize the internal EBL high side driver to provide battery current to the rear window defogger
grid lines and to the heated side view mirrors.
NOTE: The EBL system turns off automatically after 15 minutes of initial operation. Each following
activation cycle of the EBL system will last 10 minutes.
The EBL system will be automatically turned off after an initial programmed time interval of about
15 minutes, as long as the ignition switch is in RUN. After the initial time interval has expired, if the
rear window defogger switch is pressed to ON again during the same ignition cycle, the EBL
system will automatically turn off after about 10 minutes. The EBL system will automatically shut off
if the ignition switch is turned to any position other than RUN, or it can be turned off manually by
pressing the rear window defogger switch a second time.
The rear window defogger switch is diagnosed using a scan tool.
The rear window defogger switch and the rear window defogger indicator cannot be repaired and
the A/C-heater control must be replaced if found inoperative or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite
Power Window Switch: Locations Switch-Power Sliding Backlite
Component ID: 476
Component : SWITCH-POWER SLIDING BACKLITE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER SLIDING BACKLITE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (QUAD CAB/EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 GROUND Z794 12BK
3 GROUND Z975 12BK
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
5 POWER BACKLITE OPEN (+) Q950 12OR/LG
6 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
7 GROUND Z976 20BK
8 POWER BACKLITE OPEN (-) Q951 12OR/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2271
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2272
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2273
Power Window Switch: Locations Switch-Power Window-Left Rear
Component ID: 477
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q111 14TN/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q211 14TN/LB
2 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
3-4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q211 14TN/LB
5 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q111 14TN/YL
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 14OR/LB
Component Location - 57
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2274
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2275
Power Window Switch: Locations Switch-Power Window-Passenger
Component ID: 478
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-PASSENGER
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q12 12OR/BR
2 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
3-4 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
5 RIGHT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q22 12OR/VT
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 56
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2276
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2277
Power Window Switch: Locations Switch-Power Window-Right Rear
Component ID: 479
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q112 14TN/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q212 14TN/LB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/GY
3-4 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/WT
5 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q212 14TN/LB
5 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q112 14TN/YL
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 14TN/LG
Component Location - 57
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2278
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2279
Power Window Switch: Locations Switch-Window/Door Lock-Driver
Component ID: 494
Component : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C1
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/DB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/LB
3 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q11 14OR/LG
6 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
7 DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G161 20VT/DG
8 GROUND Z939 12BK
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
10 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
11 GROUND Z939 18BK
12 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q21 14OR/WT
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2280
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C2
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT MIRROR UP DRIVER P71 20TN/DG
2 LEFT MIRROR COMMON DRIVER (RIGHT/DOWN) P195 18LG/YL
3 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
4 RIGHT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P74 18TN/OR
5 GROUND Z939 18BK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2281
6 LEFT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P75 20TN/LG
7 RIGHT MIRROR UP DRIVER P72 18TN/GY
8 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Switch-Power Sliding Backlite
Component ID: 476
Component : SWITCH-POWER SLIDING BACKLITE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER SLIDING BACKLITE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (QUAD CAB/EXCEPT BASE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 GROUND Z794 12BK
3 GROUND Z975 12BK
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
5 POWER BACKLITE OPEN (+) Q950 12OR/LG
6 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER P301 20LG/OR
7 GROUND Z976 20BK
8 POWER BACKLITE OPEN (-) Q951 12OR/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2284
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2285
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2286
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Switch-Power Window-Left Rear
Component ID: 477
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-LEFT REAR
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q111 14TN/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q211 14TN/LB
2 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
3-4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q211 14TN/LB
5 DRIVER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q111 14TN/YL
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 14OR/LB
Component Location - 57
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2287
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2288
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Switch-Power Window-Passenger
Component ID: 478
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-PASSENGER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-PASSENGER
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q12 12OR/BR
2 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
3-4 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
5 RIGHT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q22 12OR/VT
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 56
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2289
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2290
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Switch-Power Window-Right Rear
Component ID: 479
Component : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-POWER WINDOW-RIGHT REAR
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q112 14TN/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q212 14TN/LB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/GY
3-4 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/WT
5 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q212 14TN/LB
5 PASSENGER REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q112 14TN/YL
6 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 14TN/LG
Component Location - 57
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2291
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2292
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Switch-Window/Door Lock-Driver
Component ID: 494
Component : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C1
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 12
Pin Description Circuit
1 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q612 14OR/DB
2 RIGHT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q412 14OR/LB
3 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (UP) Q16 12OR/TN
4 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q411 14OR/WT
5 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (UP) Q11 14OR/LG
6 MASTER WINDOW SWITCH RIGHT FRONT (DOWN) Q26 12OR/GY
7 DRIVER DOOR LOCK SWITCH MUX G161 20VT/DG
8 GROUND Z939 12BK
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-ACC) F30 12PK/YL
10 LEFT REAR WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q611 14OR/GY
11 GROUND Z939 18BK
12 LEFT FRONT WINDOW DRIVER (DOWN) Q21 14OR/WT
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2293
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WINDOW/DOOR LOCK-DRIVER C2
Color : BLUE
# of pins : 8
Pin Description Circuit
1 LEFT MIRROR UP DRIVER P71 20TN/DG
2 LEFT MIRROR COMMON DRIVER (RIGHT/DOWN) P195 18LG/YL
3 FUSED B(+) A940 18RD
4 RIGHT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P74 18TN/OR
5 GROUND Z939 18BK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Switch-Power Sliding Backlite > Page 2294
6 LEFT MIRROR LEFT DRIVER P75 20TN/LG
7 RIGHT MIRROR UP DRIVER P72 18TN/GY
8 POWER WINDOW SWITCH FEED Q15 12OR/LB
Component Location - 55
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A window/lock switch is used on all models equipped with power locks, power windows, and power
mirrors. The window/lock switch houses the following switches:
- Power Lock Switch - A two-way, momentary, resistor multiplexed switch to control the power lock
system.
- Power Mirror Selector Switch - A three-position rocker switch selects the right or left power mirror
for adjustment, or turns the power mirror system Off.
- Power Mirror Adjustment Switches - Four momentary, arrowhead shaped, directional switches
allow the driver to adjust the selected power mirror in the Up, Down, Right, or Left directions.
- Power Window Lockout Switch - A two-way, latching, push-button switch allows the vehicle
operator to lock out the power window switches on each passenger door so that the passenger
door power windows may be operated only from the master switches.
- Power Window Switches - A two-way, momentary power window switch for the driver side front
door. This switch also has a second detent in the Down direction and internal circuitry to provide an
Auto-Down feature for the driver side front door power window. In addition to the power window
switch for its own door, there are individual master switches for each passenger door power
window.
The window/lock switch also incorporates several green Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) that
illuminate the power lock and power window switch paddles, and the power mirror switch
directional buttons to improve switch visibility.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2297
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The window/lock switch combines a power lock switch, a driver power window switch with an
Auto-down feature, master switches for each passenger door power window, a power window
lockout switch, a power mirror selector switch, and four power mirror adjustment switches in a
single unit.
Power Lock Switch
The power lock switch circuitry is connected in series between ground and the driver door switch
mux input of the instrument cluster. Each power lock switch position (Lock, Unlock, and Neutral)
provides a different resistance value to the instrument cluster input, which allows the instrument
cluster to sense the switch position. Based upon the power lock switch input, the instrument cluster
controls the battery and ground feed outputs to the individual power lock motors to lock or unlock
the door latches. The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the power lock switch is connected to battery
current through the power window circuit breaker in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on
a fused ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit. The switch will be illuminated whenever the ignition
switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Power Window Switches
The power window switch circuitry is connected to battery current through a circuit breaker in the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) on a fused ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit so that
the power windows will operate whenever the ignition switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Each two-way, momentary master passenger power window switch provides battery current and
ground to the individual power window switches on each passenger door so that the power window
switch controls the battery current and ground feeds to its respective power window motor. The
switch for the driver side front door power window is labeled "Auto" and includes an auto-down
feature. When this switch is depressed to a second momentary detent position and released, the
driver door power window is automatically operated through an internal circuit and relay to its fully
lowered position. The Auto-down event is cancelled if the switch paddle is depressed a second
time in either the Up or Down direction. When the two position window lockout switch is depressed
and latched in the lockout position, the battery current feed to each of the individual passenger
power window switches is interrupted so that the passenger door power windows can only be
operated from the master switches. The window lockout switch also controls the battery current
feed for the LED in each passenger power window switch so that the switch will not be illuminated
when it is locked out.
Power Mirror Switches
The power mirror switch circuitry is connected to battery current through a fuse in the TIPM on a
fused B(+) circuit so that the power mirrors remain operational regardless of the ignition switch
position. A rocker type selector switch has three positions, one to select the right mirror, one to
select the left mirror, and a neutral Off position. After the right or left mirror is selected, one of four
directional buttons is depressed to move the selected mirror Up, Down, Right or Left. The power
mirror switch circuitry controls the battery current and ground feeds to each of the four (two in each
mirror head) power mirror motors. The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the power mirror switch is
connected to battery current through the power window circuit breaker in the TIPM on a fused
ignition switch output (run-acc) circuit so that the switch directional buttons will be illuminated
whenever the ignition switch is in the On or Accessory positions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Window/Lock Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window/Lock Switch
WINDOW/LOCK SWITCH
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamps for all of the Driver Door Module (DDM) power
window, power lock, and power mirror switches receive battery current through the power window
circuit breaker in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM). If all of the LED's are inoperative in
the DDM, be certain to diagnose the power window system before replacing the switch unit. If only
one LED in the DDM is inoperative, replace the faulty DDM. If the driver side front door power
window operates in a normal manner, but the Auto-Down feature is inoperative, replace the faulty
DDM. Refer to the appropriate wiring information.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the DDM from the door trim panel.
Disconnect the door wire harness connectors for the
DDM from the DDM connector receptacles.
2. Test the DDM switch continuity. See the Driver Door Module Switch Tests chart to determine if
the continuity is correct for the suspect switches
in each switch position. If not OK, replace the faulty DDM as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Window/Lock Switch > Page 2300
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Window/Lock Switch > Page 2301
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Window/Lock Switch > Page 2302
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Switch
WINDOW SWITCH
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamps for all of the power window and lock switch and
bezel unit switch paddles receive battery current through the power window circuit breaker in the
junction block. If all of the LEDs are inoperative in both the power window and lock switch units and
the power windows are inoperative. If the power windows operate, but any or all of the LEDs are
inoperative, the power window and lock switch units with the inoperative LED(s) is faulty and must
be replaced. For complete circuit diagrams, refer to the appropriate wiring information.
1. Check the fuse in the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) and the circuit breaker located
near the park brake pedal. If OK, go to STEP 2. If
not OK, replace the faulty fuse or circuit breaker.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the On position. Check for battery voltage at the fuse in the Totally
Integrated Power Module (TIPM). If OK, turn the
ignition switch to the Off position and go to STEP 3. If not OK, check circuit breaker and repair the
circuit to the ignition switch as required.
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the power window switch unit from
the door trim panel (passenger doors). The drivers
door switch is included with the window/lock switch. Unplug the wire harness connector from the
switch unit.
4. Test the power window switch continuity. See the Power Window Switch Continuity charts to
determine if the continuity is correct in the Off, Up
and Down switch positions . If OK, Refer to POWER WINDOWS TESTING. If not OK, replace the
faulty switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
FRONT PASSENGER
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the door trim panel
3. Remove the switch from the trim panel bezel.
REAR PASSENGER
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Remove the door trim panel.
3. Gently pry switch from door trim panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2305
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
FRONT PASSENGER
1. Insert switch to trim panel bezel.
2. Install door trim panel.
3. Connect battery negative cable.
REAR PASSENGER
1. Install switch to door trim panel
2. Install door trim panel.
3. Connect battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Locations
Component ID: 492
Component : SWITCH-WASHER FLUID LEVEL
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WASHER FLUID LEVEL
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASHER FLUID SWITCH RETURN G932 20VT/TN
2 WASHER FLUID SWITCH SENSE W1 20BR/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2310
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2311
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 492
Component : SWITCH-WASHER FLUID LEVEL
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-WASHER FLUID LEVEL
Color : LT. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASHER FLUID SWITCH RETURN G932 20VT/TN
2 WASHER FLUID SWITCH SENSE W1 20BR/TN
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2312
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The washer fluid level switch (3) is a two-pin conductivity sensor with no moving parts mounted on
the rearward facing side of the washer reservoir adjacent to the washer pump/motor unit in the
engine compartment. Only the molded plastic switch mounting flange and the integral connector
receptacle (4) are visible when the switch is installed in the reservoir. A short nipple formation (1)
extends from the inner surface of the switch mounting flange, and a barb on the nipple is pressed
through a rubber grommet seal installed in the mounting hole of the reservoir. Two over-molded
pins or electrodes (2) extend from the back of the nipple formation.
The washer fluid level switch cannot be adjusted or repaired. If ineffective or damaged, the switch
must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2315
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The washer fluid level switch uses fluid conductivity to monitor the level of the washer fluid in the
washer reservoir. Electricity is conducted between the two switch pins or electrodes only when they
are immersed in the washer fluid, which closes the switch circuit. When the fluid level in the washer
reservoir falls below the pins, electrical current cannot be conducted and the switch becomes an
open circuit, which signals a low fluid condition.
In order to prevent an electrical charge from accumulating in the electrical leads of the switch, the
switch receives current that is pulsed from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) located in
the engine compartment near the battery. The TIPM monitors the switch return signal and is
programmed to respond to three consecutive open switch readings by sending an electronic
washer fluid indicator lamp-ON message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) (also
known as the Cab Compartment Node/CCN) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The EMIC responds to this message by illuminating the washer fluid indicator and by sounding an
audible chime tone warning.
The washer fluid level switch is connected to the vehicle electrical system through a dedicated take
out and connector of the right (gasoline engines) or left (diesel engines) headlamp and dash wire
harness. The switch is connected in series between a sensor return circuit and the washer fluid
switch sense input to the TIPM.
The washer fluid level switch and the hard wired circuits between the switch and the TIPM may be
diagnosed using conventional diagnostic tools and procedures. Refer to the appropriate wiring
information. However, conventional diagnostic methods will not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of
the washer fluid level switch or the electronic controls or communication between other modules
and devices that provide some features of the wiper and washer systems. The most reliable,
efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the washer fluid level switch or the electronic controls
and communication related to washer fluid level switch operation requires the use of a diagnostic
scan tool. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Removal
DIESEL ENGINE
NOTE: The washer fluid level switch can be removed from the washer reservoir without removing
the reservoir from the vehicle.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
2. Disconnect the washer hose (4) from the barbed outlet nipple of the washer pump/motor unit (3)
and allow the washer fluid to drain into a clean
container for reuse.
3. Disconnect the left headlamp and dash wire harness (1) connector for the washer fluid level
switch (5) from the switch connector receptacle.
4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the barbed nipple of the
washer fluid level switch out of the rubber grommet
seal in the washer reservoir sump (2). Care must be taken not to damage the reservoir.
5. Remove the switch from the reservoir.
6. Remove the rubber grommet seal from the mounting hole in the washer reservoir and discard.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2318
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair Installation
DIESEL ENGINE
1. Install a new rubber grommet seal into the washer fluid level switch mounting hole in the washer
reservoir (2). Always use a new rubber grommet
seal on the reservoir.
2. Insert the nipple formation of the switch (5) through the rubber grommet seal and in the
reservoir.
3. Using hand pressure, press firmly and evenly on the switch mounting flange until the barbed
nipple is fully seated in the rubber grommet seal in
the reservoir. The flat edge of the switch mounting flange should be pointed upward.
4. Reconnect the left headlamp and dash wire harness (1) connector for the switch to the switch
connector receptacle.
5. Reconnect the removed washer hose (4) to the barbed outlet nipple of the washer pump/motor
unit (3).
6. Refill the washer reservoir with the washer fluid drained from the reservoir during the removal
procedure.
7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Description
Alignment: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: Suspension components with rubber/urethane bushings should be tightened with the
vehicle at normal ride height. It is important to have the springs supporting the weight of the vehicle
when the fasteners are torqued. If springs are not at their normal ride position, vehicle ride comfort
could be affected and premature bushing wear may occur.
Wheel alignment involves the correct positioning of the wheels in relation to the vehicle. The
positioning is accomplished through suspension and steering linkage adjustments. An alignment is
considered essential for efficient steering, good directional stability and to minimize tire wear. The
most important measurements of an alignment are caster, camber and toe.
CAUTION: Never attempt to modify suspension or steering components by heating or bending.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 2325
Alignment: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
- CASTER is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle from vertical. Tilting the top of the
knuckle forward provides less positive caster. Tilting the top of the knuckle rearward provides more
positive caster. Positive caster promotes directional stability. This angle enables the front wheels to
return to a straight ahead position after turns
- CAMBER is the inward or outward tilt of the wheel relative to the center of the vehicle. Tilting the
top of the wheel inward provides negative camber. Tilting the top of the wheel outward provides
positive camber. Incorrect camber will cause wear on the inside or outside edge of the tire
- TOE is the difference between the leading inside edges and trailing inside edges of the front tires.
Wheel toe position out of specification cause's unstable steering, uneven tire wear and steering
wheel off- center. The wheel toe position is the final front wheel alignment adjustment
- THRUST ANGLE is the angle of the rear axle relative to the centerline of the vehicle. Incorrect
thrust angle can cause off-center steering and excessive tire wear. This angle is not adjustable,
damaged component(s) must be replaced to correct the thrust angle
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 2326
Alignment: Testing and Inspection
PRE-ALIGNMENT INSPECTION
Before starting wheel alignment, the following inspection and necessary corrections must be
completed. Refer to Suspension and Steering System Diagnosis Chart below for additional
information. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
1. Inspect tires for size, air pressure and tread wear. 2. Inspect front wheel bearings for wear. 3.
Inspect front wheels for excessive radial or lateral runout and balance. 4. Inspect ball studs, linkage
pivot points and steering gear for looseness, roughness or binding. 5. Inspect suspension
components for wear and noise. 6. Road test the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 2327
Suspension And Steering System Diagnosis (Part 1)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Description and Operation > Page 2328
Suspension And Steering System Diagnosis (Part 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber And Caster Adjustment
CAMBER AND CASTER ADJUSTMENT
Camber and caster angle adjustments involve changing the position of the lower control arm (2) in
conjunction with the slotted holes in the frame brackets (1). Vehicle should be at normal ride height.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2331
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment
TOE ADJUSTMENT
The wheel toe position adjustment is the final adjustment.
1. Start the engine and turn wheels both ways before straightening the wheels. Secure the steering
wheel with the front wheels in the straight-ahead
position.
2. Loosen the tie rod jam nuts (1).
NOTE: Each front wheel should be adjusted for one-half of the total toe position specification. This
will ensure the steering wheel will be centered when the wheels are positioned straight-ahead.
3. Adjust the wheel toe position by turning the inner tie rod (2) as necessary. 4. Tighten the tie rod
jam nut (1) to 127 Nm (94 ft. lbs.). 5. Verify the specifications 6. Turn off engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2332
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber, Caster And Toe Adjustment
CAMBER, CASTER AND TOE ADJUSTMENT
Camber and caster angle adjustments involve changing the position of the lower control arm with
the slots in the frame brackets (1).
CASTER
Moving the front or rear position of the lower control arm in or out, will change the caster angle and
camber angle significantly. To maintain the camber angle while adjusting caster, move one pivot
bolt of the lower control arm in or out. Then move the other pivot bolt of the lower control arm in the
opposite direction.
To increase positive caster angle, move the rear position of the lower control arm inward (toward
the engine). Move the front of the lower control arm outward (away from the engine) slightly until
the desired camber angle is obtained.
CAMBER
Move both pivot bolts of the lower control arm together in or out. This will change the camber angle
significantly and little effect on the caster angle.
After adjustment is made tighten the lower control arm nuts to proper torque specification.
TOE ADJUSTMENT
The wheel toe position adjustment is the final adjustment.
1. Start the engine and turn wheels both ways before straightening the wheels. Secure the steering
wheel with the front wheels in the straight-ahead
position.
2. Loosen the tie rod jam nuts (1).
NOTE: Each front wheel should be adjusted for one-half of the total toe position specification. This
will ensure the steering wheel will be centered when the wheels are positioned straight-ahead.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2333
3. Adjust the wheel toe position by turning the inner tie rod (2) as necessary. 4. Tighten the tie rod
jam nut (1) to 127 Nm (94 ft. lbs.). 5. Verify the specifications 6. Turn off engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2334
Alignment: Service and Repair Alignment Link/Coil Suspension
ALIGNMENT LINK/COIL SUSPENSION
Before each alignment reading the vehicle should be jounced (rear first, then front). Grasp each
bumper at the center and jounce the vehicle up and down several times. Always release the
bumper in the down position. Set the front end alignment to specifications while the vehicle is in its
NORMALLY LOADED CONDITION.
CAMBER: The wheel camber angle is preset and is not adjustable.
CASTER: Check the caster of the front axle for correct angle. Be sure the axle is not bent or
twisted. Road test the vehicle and make left and right turn. Observe the steering wheel
return-to-center position. Low caster will cause poor steering wheel returnability.
Caster can be adjusted by rotating the cams (3) on the lower suspension arm.
TOE POSITION: The wheel toe position adjustment should be the final adjustment.
1. Start the engine and turn wheels both ways before straightening the wheels. Center and Secure
the steering wheel and turn off engine. 2. Loosen the adjustment sleeve clamp bolts. 3. Adjust the
right wheel toe position with the drag link. Turn the sleeve until the right wheel is at the correct
TOE-IN position. Position clamp bolts
to their original position and tighten to specifications. Make sure the toe setting does not change
during clamp tightening.
4. Adjust left wheel toe position with tie rod at left knuckle. Turn the sleeve until the left wheel is at
the correct TOE-IN position. Position clamp
bolts to their original position and tighten to specifications. Make sure the toe setting does not
change during clamp tightening.
NOTE: Toe setting will change during tightening, Make sure to verify reading after tightening.
5. Verify the right toe setting and a straight steering wheel. 6. Road test the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2335
Alignment: Service and Repair Curb Height Measurement (HD)
CURB HEIGHT MEASUREMENT (HD)
The wheel alignment is to be checked and all alignment adjustments made with the vehicle at its
required curb height specification.
Vehicle height is to be checked with the vehicle on a flat, level surface, preferably a vehicle
alignment rack. The tires are to be inflated to the recommended pressure. All tires are to be the
same size as standard equipment. Vehicle height is checked with the fuel tank full of fuel, and no
passenger or luggage compartment load.
Inspect the vehicle for bent or weak suspension components. Compare the parts tag on the
suspect coil spring(s) to the parts book and the vehicle sales code, checking for a match. Once
removed from the vehicle, compare the coil spring height to a correct new or known good coil
spring. The heights should vary if the suspect spring is weak.
1. Front 4X2 On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance from the top of the jounce bumper
flange (2) to the bottom of the frame rail (1).
2. Front 4X4 On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance from the top of the axle (2) to the
bottom of the jounce bumper flange (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2336
3. Rear ALL - On each side of the vehicle, measure the distance at the top of the axle tube (2) to
the bottom of the frame rail (1). 4. Compare the measurements to the specifications listed in the
following Curb Height Specifications chart.
Front Curb Height Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber And Caster
Adjustment > Page 2337
Rear Curb Height Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURES
Fuel Pump/Gear Pump (low pressure)
................................................................................................................................ 551.5 - 1241 KPA
(80 - 180 psi)
Injection Pump .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 200 - 1800 bar (2900 - 26107 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
*FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
1. FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
Using the scan tool, idle the engine and measure the rail pressure and determine if the rail
pressure is excessive (above 185,00 kpa/26,831 psi). If it is, troubleshoot for excessive rail
pressure first.
Remove the banjo bolt from the pressure-limiting valve on the fuel rail.
Install fuel system test fitting 9013 into the pressure-limiting valve.
Attach one end of a fuel hose to the fuel fitting and put the other end of the fuel hose into a
container
Perform the tests listed below to determine if the pressure-limiting valve is leaking.
a. Operate the engine at idle and watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
b. Operate the engine at idle and actuate the high pressure safety valve test with the scan tool.
Watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
If fuel flows into the fuel container, replace the pressure-limiting valve. If fuel does not leak from the
pressure-limiting valve, the test is complete.
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with any portion of this test kit installed
Operate the engine until the engine is at operating temperature.
Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing
Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and put the open end into the graduated cylinder .
Start the engine and let it idle for one minute.
Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
If the flow is less than 1000ml/minute at idle, the test has successfully passed.
If the flow is greater than 1000ml/minute at idle, replace the fuel injection pump.
Retest to confirm repair.
View Repair
Repair
- Test Complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 2344
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection High Pressure Fuel Pump Performance Test
*HIGH PRESSURE FUEL PUMP PERFORMANCE TEST
If the engine will run do the following:
1. Monitor rail pressure with scan tool while the engine is at idle.
2. Compare the fuel pressure set point with the actual fuel pressure reading.
3. If actual fuel pressure reading fluctuates more than ± 500 psi from the set point, then replace the
Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
NOTE: After the actuator is removed, check for debris or corrosion on the FCA. If debris or
corrosion is found, replace the entire Fuel Injection Pump.
4. Turn off engine.
5. Disconnect the FCA harness
6. Disconnect high pressure fuel line from fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
8. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 second intervals (Note: This will give you 30 total seconds of
flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals to prevent damage to the starter). Fuel flow
specification s based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of fuel in 30
seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
If the engine is a no start do the following:
1. Remove fuel pump to rail high pressure fuel line.
2. Inspect the fuel pump outlet port for rust, debris, or other signs of contamination.
3. Replace pump if any contamination is found. Check for source of water in fuel or debris in fuel to
prevent future complaints. If no contamination is found continue to step 4.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
5. Disconnect the high pressure fuel line from the fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line to a
graduated cylinder.
6. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
7. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 seconds intervals.
NOTE: This will give you 30 total seconds of flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals
to prevent damage to the starter.
Fuel flow specification's based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of
fuel in 30 seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 2345
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection In-Tank Fuel Lift Pump Flow/Diagnostic Test Procedure
*IN-TANK FUEL LIFT PUMP FLOW/DIAGNOSTIC TEST PROCEDURE
1. Using the Scan tool, check for DTCs. Troubleshoot any active DTCs before performing this test.
2. Disconnect the wiring harness from the lift pump at the fuel tank module connector and inspect
the pins for damage. Fix or replace any damaged component.
3. Connect a voltmeter between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module
connector.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Use the Scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump, record the
voltage on the voltmeter.
5. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 14. If the voltage is less than 11.5 volts, go to
step 6
6. Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage to determine that the voltage is greater than 11.5
volts. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 7. If the voltage is not greater than 11.5
volts, troubleshoot for low battery voltage.
7. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage at the fuel
lift pump relay voltage supply pin in the PDC. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 8.
If the voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, fix or replace the harness.
8. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Install a spare relay in place of the fuel lift pump
relay. Using the Scan tool, actuate the fuel lift pump. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage
between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module connector while the fuel
lift pump is actuated. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, replace the fuel lift pump relay. If the
voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 9.
9. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the lift pump relay from the
PDC. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the resistance of the fuel lift pump power supply wire between
the PDC relay output pin and the fuel tank module connector. If the resistance is less than 10
ohms, go to step 10. If it is greater than 10 ohms, fix or replace the harness.
10. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between battery negative and the fuel lift pump
power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the voltage is less than 1 volt, go to step 11. If
the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between battery negative and the fuel lift
pump power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, fix or
replace the harness. If the resistance is greater than 10 ohms, go to step 12.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the
resistance of the fuel lift pump ground wire between the fuel tank module connector and battery
negative. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, go to step 13. If the resistance is greater than 10
ohms, fix or replace the harness.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using a voltmeter, measure the
voltage between the fuel lift pump ground wire and battery negative. If the voltage is less than 1
volt, go to step 14. If the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
14. Reconnect the lift pump connector.
FLOW TEST.
1. Remove the fuel pump supply banjo fitting from the fuel injection pump.
2. Install fuel system test fitting 9863 onto the end of the quick connect line going to the fuel
injection pump.
3. Connect one end of a section of fuel hose to the test fitting.
4. Put the other end of the fuel hose into an empty fuel container.
5. Use the scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump.
6. While the lift pump is running, move the fuel hose from the fuel canister into a 1000ml graduated
cylinder for 10 seconds.
7. Read and record the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds.
8. If you have more than 570ml in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds, the test has
successfully passed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 2346
9. If you have less than 570ml of fuel in the graduated cylinder, inspect the fuel supply line from the
fuel tank to the fuel filter housing and the fuel supply line between the fuel filter housing and the
high pressure fuel pump for signs of damage, replace as necessary. If no damage is found, replace
the fuel filter and retest.
10.Verify the Screened Banjo Bolt at the outlet of the fuel filter is free of debris. If debris is found,
rinse screen with water, blow dry and reinstall. Retest vehicle. If flow meets specification then trace
back the source of debris, if flow is still below spec repair damaged component.
11. If reading is still less than 570ml in 10 seconds, remove the fuel tank and fuel tank module.
Inspect for damage and/or debris in and around the fuel tank module. If module is damaged,
replace and retest.
12. If the module is not damaged, replace the fuel lift pump and retest to confirm fix.
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by manufacturer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Testing Air Cleaner Element using Filter Minder(TM)
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove top of air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
The air cleaner (filter) housing (5) is equipped with an air Filter Minder(TM) gauge (3). This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
The Filter Minder(TM) (5) consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic
housing. A yellow colored disc (2) attached to diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on side of
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within Filter Minder will
hold yellow disc at highest restriction that air cleaner element has experienced. A drop in air
pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves diaphragm and yellow disc will indicate
size of air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage plastic housing of Filter
Minder. Cover and tape Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be used.
To test, turn engine off. If yellow disc (2) has reached red colored zone (3) on graduated scale, air
cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to Removal / Installation.
Resetting Filter Minder: After air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press rubber button on
top of Filter Minder. This will allow yellow
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2355
colored disc to reset. After button has been pressed, yellow disc should spring back to UP position.
If Filter Minder gauge has reached red colored zone, and after an examination of air cleaner (filter)
element, element appears to be clean, high reading may be due to a temporary condition such as
snow build-up at air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also occur if air cleaner (filter) element
has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow element to dry out during
normal engine operation. Reset rubber button on top of Filter Minder and retest after element has
dried.
Filter Removal
1. The housing cover is equipped with spring clips and is hinged with plastic tabs. Unlatch clips
from top of air cleaner housing and tilt housing cover
up for cover removal.
2. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2356
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing new air cleaner element (filter), clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position
air cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch spring clips to seal cover to housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 2361
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 2362
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Severe Duty Filtration Kit Availability
NUMBER: 14-001-09
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: January 24, 2009
SUBJECT: Severe Duty Fuel Filtration Mopar Add On Kit Available
MODELS:
2005 - 2009 (D1/DH) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2009 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2005
model year and D1/DH/DC vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins engine built from 2007 model
year.
DISCUSSION: A frame mounted supplemental filter kit is now available for the vehicles listed
above. This kit includes complete instructions (K6855569AC) with all necessary components and
wiring to upgrade fuel filtering to a severe duty rating.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filters (on engine filter and added chassis mounted severe
duty fuel filtration kit filter) are 15,000 miles.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2365
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2368
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2369
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2370
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2371
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2372
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
DESCRIPTION
The cylinder block is constructed of cast iron. The casting is a skirted design which incorporates
longitudal ribs for superior strength and noise reduction. The block incorporates metric straight
thread o-ring fittings at lubrication oil access points. The engine is manufactured with the cylinders
being a non-sleeved type cylinder.
The cylinders are numbered front to rear ; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > System
Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing is not adjustable on any engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure (Minimum) ......................................................................................................
...................................................................... 350 psi.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 2382
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION/LEAKAGE TESTS
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure batteries are completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise, the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnostic
purposes.
1. Disconnect the fuel inlet line to the fuel filter housing. Plug the fuel line from the fuel tank.
NOTE: Failure to plug fuel line will result in fuel leak.
2. Remove fuel transfer pump relay from PDC. 3. Start the engine and idle until the engine stalls
(runs out of fuel). 4. Remove the cylinder head cover. 5. Remove the cylinder head cover carrier
gasket. 6. Remove the high pressure fuel line between the cylinder head and fuel rail for the
cylinder to be tested. Use tool 9864 to cap this fuel rail on the
cylinder being tested.
7. Remove the fuel connector tube nut and fuel connector tube. 8. Remove the exhaust rocker
lever. 9. Use Tool 9010 to remove the injector and copper sealing washer.
10. Install the exhaust rocker lever and torque to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 11. Cover the remaining rocker
levers with clean shop towels to prevent any oil splatter under the hood. 12. Place a rag over the
compression test tool fitting. Crank the engine for 2-3 seconds to purge any fuel that may have
drained into the cylinder when
the injector was removed.
13. Connect the compression test gauge. 14. Crank the engine for 5 seconds and record the
pressure reading. Repeat this step three times and calculate the average of the three readings.
NOTE: The minimum cylinder pressure is 350 psi. Cylinder pressure should be within 20% from
cylinder to cylinder.
15. Combustion pressure leakage can be checked if cylinder pressure is below the specification.
Perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder
according to the tester manufacturer instructions.
16. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related fault codes.
CYLINDER COMBUSTION PRESSURE LEAKAGE
The combustion pressure leakage test provides an accurate means for determining engine
condition.
Combustion pressure leakage testing will detect:
- Exhaust and intake valve leaks (improper seating).
- Leaks between adjacent cylinders or into water jacket.
- Any causes for combustion/compression pressure loss
1. Start and operate the engine until it attains normal operating temperature. 2. Disconnect injector
harness connectors. 3. Disconnect CCV tube and breather drain tube from valve cover. 4. Remove
the cylinder head cover. 5. Disconnect harness from injectors. 6. Remove the cylinder head cover
carrier gasket. 7. Bring the cylinder to be tested to TDC. 8. Remove the high pressure fuel line
between the cylinder head and the fuel rail for the cylinder to be tested. 9. Install capping Tool 9864
onto the rail.
10. Remove the high pressure connector nut and high pressure connector with Tool 9015. 11.
Remove the exhaust and intake rocker lever. 12. Use Tool # 9010 to remove the injector and
copper sealing washer. 13. Install compression test Tool # 9007 into the injector bore. 14. Connect
the leakage tester and perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder according to the tester
manufacturer's instructions. 15. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related
fault codes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Adjustments
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE LASH ADJUSTMENT AND VERIFICATION
NOTE: To obtain accurate readings, valve lash measurements AND adjustments should only be
performed when the engine coolant temperature is less than 60°C (140°F).
The 24-valve overhead system is a "low-maintenance" design. Routine adjustments are no longer
necessary, however, measurement should still take place when troubleshooting performance
problems, or upon completion of a repair that includes removal and installation of the valve train
components or injectors.
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Using the crankshaft
barring tool #7471-B, rotate crankshaft to align damper TDC mark to 12:00 o'clock position.
a. If both number one cylinder rocker levers are loose, continue to next step. b. If both number one
cylinder rocker levers are not loose, rotate crankshaft 360 degrees.
4. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be measured at the following rocker arms:
INTAKE 1-2-4 / EXHAUST 1-3-5. Measure the valve
lash by inserting a feeler gauge between the rocker arm socket and crosshead. Refer to VALVE
LASH LIMIT CHART for the correct specifications. If the measurement falls within the limits,
adjustment/resetting is not necessary. If measurement finds the lash outside of the limits,
adjustment/resetting is required.
Valve Lash Limit Chart
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Adjustments > Page 2386
5. If adjustment/resetting is required, loosen the lock nut on rocker arms and turn the adjusting
screw until the desired lash is obtained:
- INTAKE 0.254 mm (0.010 in.)
- EXHAUST 0.660 mm (0.026 in.) Tighten the lock nut to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) and recheck the valve
lash.
6. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the crankshaft one revolution (360°) to align the damper
TDC mark to the 12 o'clock position. 7. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be
measured at the remaining rocker arms: INTAKE 3-5-6 / EXHAUST 2-4-6. Use the same
method as above for determining whether adjustment is necessary, and adjust those that are found
to be outside of the limits.
8. Install the cylinder head cover. 9. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Timing Component Alignment Marks > Component Information > Locations
Timing Component Alignment Marks: Locations
Install the camshaft. Align the crankshaft and camshaft gear marks as shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt: Diagrams
With A/C
1- Idler Pulley 2- Accessory Drive Belt 3- Power Steering Pulley 4- Radiator Fan Pulley 5Crankshaft Pulley 6- A/C Compressor Pulley 7- Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner 8- Generator 9Water Pump Pulley
Without A/C
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2393
1- Idler Pulley 2- Accessory Drive Belt 3- Power Steering Pulley 4- Radiator Fan Pulley 5Crankshaft Pulley 6- Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner 7- Generator 8- Water Pump
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2394
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The accessory drive belt is a serpentine type belt. Satisfactory performance of these belts depends
on belt condition and proper belt tension.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2395
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
VISUAL DIAGNOSIS
NOTE: Diesel Engine - If a belt is broken or frayed, inspect engine speed sensor (located near the
crankshaft damper) for damage.
When diagnosing serpentine accessory drive belts, small cracks that run across the ribbed surface
of the belt from rib to rib , are considered normal. These are not a reason to replace the belt.
However, cracks running along a rib (not across) are not normal. Any belt with cracks running
along a rib must be replaced. Also replace the belt if it has excessive wear, frayed cords or severe
glazing.
Refer to ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT DIAGNOSIS CHART for further belt diagnosis.
NOISE DIAGNOSIS
Noises generated by the accessory drive belt are most noticeable at idle. Before replacing a belt to
resolve a noise condition, inspect all of the accessory drive pulleys for alignment, glazing, or
excessive end play.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2396
Accessory Drive Belt Diagnosis Chart (Part 1)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2397
Accessory Drive Belt Diagnosis Chart (Part 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Drive Belt: Procedures
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 2400
Drive Belt: Removal and Replacement
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
Belt Routing-Diesel Engine Without A/C
1. A 1/2 inch square hole is provided in the automatic belt tensioner. Attach a 1/2 inch drive-long
handle ratchet to this hole.
BELT ROUTING-DIESEL WITH A/C
2. Rotate ratchet and tensioner assembly clockwise (as viewed from front) until tension has been
relieved from belt. 3. Remove belt from water pump pulley first. 4. Remove belt from vehicle.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures >
Page 2401
Belt Routing - DIESEL WITH A/C
CAUTION: When installing the accessory drive belt, the belt must be routed correctly. If not, engine
may overheat due to water pump rotating in wrong direction.
1. Position drive belt over all pulleys except water pump pulley. 2. Attach a 1/2 inch ratchet to
tensioner.
Belt Routing - DIESEL WITHOUT A/C
3. Rotate ratchet and belt tensioner clockwise. Place belt over water pump pulley. Let tensioner
rotate back into place. Remove ratchet. Be sure belt
is properly seated on all pulleys.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Testing Air Cleaner Element using Filter Minder(TM)
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove top of air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
The air cleaner (filter) housing (5) is equipped with an air Filter Minder(TM) gauge (3). This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
The Filter Minder(TM) (5) consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic
housing. A yellow colored disc (2) attached to diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on side of
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within Filter Minder will
hold yellow disc at highest restriction that air cleaner element has experienced. A drop in air
pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves diaphragm and yellow disc will indicate
size of air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage plastic housing of Filter
Minder. Cover and tape Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be used.
To test, turn engine off. If yellow disc (2) has reached red colored zone (3) on graduated scale, air
cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to Removal / Installation.
Resetting Filter Minder: After air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press rubber button on
top of Filter Minder. This will allow yellow
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2408
colored disc to reset. After button has been pressed, yellow disc should spring back to UP position.
If Filter Minder gauge has reached red colored zone, and after an examination of air cleaner (filter)
element, element appears to be clean, high reading may be due to a temporary condition such as
snow build-up at air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also occur if air cleaner (filter) element
has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow element to dry out during
normal engine operation. Reset rubber button on top of Filter Minder and retest after element has
dried.
Filter Removal
1. The housing cover is equipped with spring clips and is hinged with plastic tabs. Unlatch clips
from top of air cleaner housing and tilt housing cover
up for cover removal.
2. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2409
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing new air cleaner element (filter), clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position
air cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch spring clips to seal cover to housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
Chrysler provides no information on a Cabin Air Filter for this vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Crankcase Filter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Closed Crankcase Ventilation System (CCV) consists of several parts to make it functional.
One part is the filter. The filter is serviceable and prevents oil mist from entering the discharge tube
of the CCV system. It is not cleaned, but replaced at 60,000 mile intervals.
The crankcase breather assembly is integrated into the cylinder head cover (3) and is serviced
separately. The external fittings (2) to the breather tube and breather drain tube are serviceable.
The crankcase breather assembly is integrated into the cylinder head cover and corresponding
breather cover. Crankcase gasses travel into the breather cavity under the breather cover where
they pass through a filtering media (serviceable maintenance component) which separates the oil
from the crankcase gasses. The oil drains back into the engine block through two hoses (2) on the
left side of the engine.
The crankcase gasses are directed through the Crankcase Depression Regulator (CDR) valve
which allows the system to maintain a constant positive pressure in the crankcase. The CDR valve
is a non-serviceable component located on the underside of the breather cover. Clean crankcase
gasses flow from the CDR valve into the fresh air side of the turbocharger compressor.
The closed crankcase ventilation valve is used to vent the crankcase gases back into the intake of
engine. If the crankcase ventilation filter becomes too restrictive, under high intake vacuum
situations, the closed crankcase ventilation prevents the engine from syphoning crankcase
gases/oil from the crankcase of the engine. The closed crankcase ventilation valve is located under
the crankcase ventilation filter cover at the top of the engine.
TESTING
1. If troubleshooting high crankcase pressure, the following items can be causing the closed
crankcase ventilation valve to close during engine
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2416
operation: High air intake restriction. Check for high intake restriction
- A restricted crankcase ventilation filter. Change the filter
- A malfunctioning or misassembled closed crankcase ventilation valve. Check the valve operation
and change if necessary
2. The closed crankcase ventilation valve should allow crankcases gases to flow when the engine
is not running and/or removed from the engine.
NOTE: Application of air can be applied either to the inlet or outlet of the closed crankcase
ventilation valve.
3. A small amount of air can be blown through the closed crankcase ventilation valve (less than 34
kPa [5 psi]) to check the closed crankcase
ventilation valve.
4. If air does not go through the closed crankcase ventilation valve, replace the valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using hose clamp pliers, loosen the breather plumbing from the breather cover connections. 2.
Carefully remove the breather hoses (2) from the breather cover assembly (3). 3. Remove the
capscrews surrounding the parameter of the breather cover (3). 4. Separate the breather cover (3)
assembly from the cylinder head cover (1).
FILTER ELEMENT REMOVAL
1. With the breather cover removed, remove the filter element from the cylinder head cover cavity
by lifting the element straight up from its sealing
surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 2419
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair Installation
FILTER ELEMENT INSPECTION
1. Inspect the crankcase breather assembly by ensuring the oil drain hoses are not kinked or
cracked. 2. Inspect all external hose connections for signs of leakage, repair where necessary.
Inspect the breather for cracks or damage. 3. Inspect the filter element sealing surface for gouges
or cracks; this surface should be smooth and free of abrasions.
FILTER ELEMENT INSTALLATION
1. Clean the filter sealing surface on the cylinder head cover with a clean shop towel. 2. Install the
new filter element, lubrication of the new sealing surface is not recommended. 3. Press the new
filter into the cylinder head cover cavity until fully seated. 4. Install the breather cover assembly.
BREATHER COVER INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the filter element for proper installation. The filter should be completely seated around
the circumference of the sealing surface. 2. Install the breather cover to the cylinder head cover. 3.
Install the capscrews surrounding the breather cover. 4. Install the breather drain hoses onto the
hose barbs. Do not damage or hose connection during installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan. 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission. 4. Loosen
bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan away from transmission
allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and remove remaining bolts holding pan to
transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid
in pan into drain pan.
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
9. Remove the screw holding the primary oil filter (1) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and oil pump and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Inspect
the oil filter seal in the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is not installed completely in the oil pump,
or is otherwise damaged, then remove
and discard the oil filter seal from the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is installed correctly and is
in good condition, it can be reused.
12. If replacing the cooler return filter (2), use Oil Filter Wrench 8321 to remove the filter from the
transmission. 13. Dispose of used trans fluid and filter(s) properly.
INSPECTION
Inspect bottom of pan and magnet for excessive amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material
on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition
or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the
diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2424
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
CAUTION: The primary oil filter seal MUST be fully installed flush against the oil pump body. DO
NOT install the seal onto the filter neck and attempt to install the filter and seal as an assembly.
Damage to the transmission will result.
1. If necessary, install a new primary oil filter seal in the oil pump inlet bore. Seat the seal in the
bore with Installer 6960-A or another suitable tool
(appropriately sized drift or socket, the butt end of a hammer etc.).
2. Place replacement filter in position on valve body and into the oil pump. 3. Install screw to hold
the primary oil filter (1) to valve body. Tighten screw to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Install new
cooler return filter (2) onto the transmission, if necessary. Torque the filter to 9.5 Nm (84 in.lbs.). 5.
Place bead of Mopar(R) RTV sealant onto the transmission case sealing surface. 6. Place pan in
position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to transmission. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.) torque. 8. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) ATF +4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2425
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
The service fluid fill after a filter change is approximately 3.8 liters (4.0 quarts).
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan (3). 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission (1). 4.
Loosen bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan and reusable
gasket (2) away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and
remove remaining bolt holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan and
gasket away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
9. Remove screws holding filter (2) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Dispose of used trans
fluid and filter properly.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2426
1. Position a new transmission oil filter (2) onto the valve body. 2. Install the screws to hold the filter
to the valve body. Tighten the screws to 4 Nm (35 in.lbs.).
3. Clean the gasket surfaces of the transmission oil pan (3) and transmission pan rail.
NOTE: The transmission pan oil gasket (2) is reusable. Inspect the sealing surfaces of the gasket.
If the sealing ribs on both surfaces appear to be in good condition, clean the gasket of any foreign
material and reinstall.
4. Position the oil pan gasket (2) onto the oil pan (3). 5. Position the oil pan and gasket onto the
transmission and install several bolts to hold the pan and gasket to the transmission. 6. Install the
remainder of the oil pan bolts. Tighten the bolts to 13.6 Nm (125 in.lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle and fill
transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2427
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
DRAIN PLUG
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a large diameter drain pan beneath the transmission pan. 3. Remove the
drain plug bolt (1) and allow the oil to drain from the transmission pan. 4. Remove the drain pan
bolts from the transmission case. 5. Remove the drain pan.
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2428
6. Remove the transmission oil filter bolts (3). 7. Remove the transmission oil filter and O-ring seal
from the valve body (1).
INSPECTION
OIL PAN MAGNETS
Inspect bottom of pan, pick-up magnets (1) and magnetic drain plug (2) and fluid filter for excessive
amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a
problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated
with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2429
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
1. Lubricate the transmission oil filter seal with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the new
transmission oil filter (2) in position on valve body (1) and into the oil pump. 3. Install the
transmission oil filter bolts (3). 4. Tighten bolts to 10 Nm ( 88 in.lbs. ) torque. 5. Install a new
transmission oil pan gasket. 6. Place pan in position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to
transmission. Tighten bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) torque.
DRAIN PLUG
8. Install transmission drain plug bolt (1). 9. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm ( 20 ft.lbs) torque.
10. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 2434
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 2435
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Severe Duty Filtration Kit Availability
NUMBER: 14-001-09
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: January 24, 2009
SUBJECT: Severe Duty Fuel Filtration Mopar Add On Kit Available
MODELS:
2005 - 2009 (D1/DH) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2009 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2005
model year and D1/DH/DC vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins engine built from 2007 model
year.
DISCUSSION: A frame mounted supplemental filter kit is now available for the vehicles listed
above. This kit includes complete instructions (K6855569AC) with all necessary components and
wiring to upgrade fuel filtering to a severe duty rating.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filters (on engine filter and added chassis mounted severe
duty fuel filtration kit filter) are 15,000 miles.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 2438
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2441
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2442
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2443
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2444
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 2445
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Clean the area around the oil filter head. Remove the filter from below using a cap-style filter
wrench. 2. Clean the gasket surface of the filter head. The filter canister O-Ring seal can stick on
the filter head. Make sure it is removed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 2450
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Fill the oil filter element with clean oil before installation. Use the same type oil that will be used
in the engine. 2. Apply a light film of lubricating oil to the sealing surface before installing the filter.
CAUTION: Mechanical over-tightening may distort the threads or damage the filter element seal.
3. Install the filter until it contacts the sealing surface of the oil filter adapter. Tighten filter an
additional 1/2 turn.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Warning
Hose/Line HVAC: Service Precautions Warning
WARNING
WARNING: The A/C system contains refrigerant under high pressure. Repairs should only be
performed by qualified service personnel. Serious or fatal injury may result from improper service
procedures.
WARNING: Avoid breathing the refrigerant and refrigerant oil vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate
the eyes, nose, and/or throat. Wear eye protection when servicing the A/C refrigerant system.
Serious eye injury can result from direct contact with the refrigerant. If eye contact occurs, seek
medical attention immediately.
WARNING: Do not expose the refrigerant to open flame. Poisonous gas is created when refrigerant
is burned. An electronic leak detector is recommended. Serious or fatal injury may result from
improper service procedures.
WARNING: If accidental A/C system discharge occurs, ventilate the work area before resuming
service. Large amounts of refrigerant released in a closed work area will displace the oxygen and
cause suffocation and serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The evaporation rate of R-134a refrigerant at average temperature and altitude is
extremely high. As a result, anything that comes in contact with the refrigerant will freeze. Always
protect the skin or delicate objects from direct contact with the refrigerant.
WARNING: The R-134a service equipment or the vehicle refrigerant system should not be
pressure tested or leak tested with compressed air. Some mixtures of air and R-134a have been
shown to be combustible at elevated pressures. These mixtures are potentially dangerous, and
may result in fire or explosion causing property damage and serious or fatal injury.
WARNING: The engine cooling system is designed to develop internal pressures up to 145 kilo
pascals (21 pounds per square inch). Do not remove or loosen the coolant pressure cap, cylinder
block drain plugs, radiator drain, radiator hoses, heater hoses, or hose clamps while the engine
cooling system is hot and under pressure. Allow the vehicle to cool for a minimum of 15 minutes
before opening the cooling system for service. Failure to observe this warning can result in serious
burns from the heated engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service Precautions >
Warning > Page 2456
Hose/Line HVAC: Service Precautions Caution
CAUTION
CAUTION: Never add R-12 to a refrigerant system designed to use R-134a. Do not use R-12
equipment or parts on an R-134a A/C system. These refrigerants are not compatible and damage
to the A/C system will result.
CAUTION: Never use R-12 refrigerant oil in an A/C system designed to use R-134a refrigerant oil.
These refrigerant oils are not compatible and damage to the A/C system will result.
CAUTION: The use of A/C system sealers may result in damage to A/C refrigerant
recovery/evacuation/recharging equipment and/or A/C system. Many federal, state/provincial and
local regulations prohibit the recharge of A/C systems with known leaks. DaimlerChrysler
recommends the detection of A/C system leaks through the use of approved leak detectors and
fluorescent leak detection dyes. Vehicles found with A/C system sealers should be treated as
contaminated and replacement of the entire A/C refrigerant system is recommended. A/C systems
found to be contaminated with A/C system sealers, A/C stop-leak products or seal conditioners
voids the warranty for the A/C system.
CAUTION: Recover the refrigerant before opening any fitting or connection. Open the fittings with
caution, even after the system has been discharged. Never open or loosen a connection before
recovering the refrigerant.
CAUTION: If equipped, do not remove the secondary retention clip from any spring-lock coupler
connection while the refrigerant system is under pressure. Recover the refrigerant before removing
the secondary retention clip. Open the fittings with caution, even after the system has been
discharged. Never open or loosen a connection before recovering the refrigerant.
CAUTION: The internal parts of the A/C system will remain stable as long as moisture-free
refrigerant and refrigerant oil is used. Abnormal amounts of dirt, moisture or air can upset the
chemical stability. This may cause operational troubles or even serious damage if present in more
than very small quantities. Before disconnecting a component, clean the outside of the fittings
thoroughly to prevent contamination from entering the refrigerant system. Keep service tools and
the work area clean. Do not open the refrigerant system or uncap a replacement component until
you are ready to service the system. Immediately after disconnecting a component from the
refrigerant system, seal the open fittings with a cap or plug. This will prevent contamination from
entering the A/C system.
CAUTION: Refrigerant oil will absorb moisture from the atmosphere if left uncapped. Do not open a
container of refrigerant oil until you are ready to use it. Replace the cap on the oil container
immediately after using. Store refrigerant oil only in a clean, airtight, and moisture-free container.
CAUTION: Do not overcharge the refrigerant system. Overcharging will cause excessive
compressor head pressure and can cause compressor noise and A/C system failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Discharge Line
DESCRIPTION
The A/C discharge line is the refrigerant line that goes from the A/C compressor to the A/C
condenser and has an integral fitting for the A/C pressure transducer. The A/C discharge line is
made from light-weight aluminum tubing with braze-less and crimp type fittings and nylon tubes
with rubber barrier hose.
The A/C discharge line for the 5.9L and 6.7L diesel engines is serviced as an assembly with the
A/C suction line.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C discharge line has no serviceable parts except the O-ring seals and gaskets. The O-ring
seals used on the connections are made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a
refrigerant. The O-ring seals and gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C discharge line is
removed.
The A/C discharge line cannot be repaired and must be replaced if found to be leaking or
damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line > Page 2459
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Liquid Line
DESCRIPTION
The A/C liquid line is the refrigerant line that carries refrigerant from the A/C condenser to the A/C
evaporator. The A/C liquid line consists of two separate lines that connect to each other using a
spring-lock type refrigerant line coupler. The A/C liquid line is made from light-weight aluminum
tubing with braze-less and crimp type fittings and nylon tubes with rubber barrier hose.
NOTE: A/C orifice tube size is different between gasoline and diesel engines. Be sure to use the
correct A/C liquid line when replacement of the A/C orifice tube is required.
The front section of the A/C liquid line includes the high-side service port and the rear section of the
A/C liquid line includes the A/C fixed orifice tube.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C liquid line has no serviceable parts except for the O-ring seals and gaskets, high-side
service port valve, cap and secondary retaining clip. The O-ring seals used on the connections are
made from a special type of rubber not affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals and
gaskets must be replaced whenever the A/C liquid line is removed.
The A/C liquid line cannot be repaired and must be replaced if found to be leaking or damaged, or
if the fixed orifice tube is inoperative.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line > Page 2460
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation A/C Suction Line
DESCRIPTION
The A/C suction line is the refrigerant line that goes from the A/C evaporator to the A/C
compressor. The A/C suction line is made from light-weight aluminum tubing with braze-less and
crimp type fittings and nylon tubes with rubber barrier hose.
The A/C suction line for the 5.9L and 6.7L diesel engines is serviced as an assembly with the A/C
discharge line.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
The A/C suction line has no serviceable parts except for the O-ring seals and the secondary
retaining clip. The O-ring seals used on the connections are made from a special type of rubber not
affected by R-134a refrigerant. The O-ring seals must be replaced whenever the A/C suction line is
removed.
The A/C suction line cannot be repaired and must be replaced if found to be leaking or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation > A/C Discharge Line > Page 2461
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation Plumbing
Description
DESCRIPTION
The A/C refrigerant lines and hoses are used to carry the refrigerant between the various A/C
system components. The refrigerant lines and hoses for the R-134a A/C system consist of a
barrier-hose design with a nylon tube sandwiched between rubber layers. The nylon tube helps to
contain the R-134a refrigerant, which has a small molecular structure. The ends of the refrigerant
lines are made from lightweight aluminum and braze-less fittings.
Any kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant lines and hoses will reduce the capacity of the entire
A/C system and can reduce the flow of refrigerant within the system.
Operation
OPERATION
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the A/C compressor is operating.
Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system connections is
pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible refrigerant hoses at least
once a year to make sure they are in good condition.
The refrigerant lines and hoses are coupled to other A/C system components with block-type
fittings. An O-ring seal, or a flat steel gasket with an integral O-ring (dual plane seal), is used to
mate the refrigerant line fittings with A/C system components to ensure the integrity of the
refrigerant system.
The refrigerant lines and hoses cannot be repaired and must be replaced if leaking or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Line-A/C Discharge
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible personal
injury or death.
NOTE: The A/C discharge line for the 5.9L and the 6.7L diesel engine is serviced as an assembly
with the A/C suction line.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cables.
2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system.
3. Remove the air filter housing cover.
4. Remove the secondary retaining clip (7) from the spring-lock coupler (1) that secures the A/C
suction line (6) to the A/C accumulator (5).
5. Using the proper A/C line disconnect tool, disconnect the A/C suction line from the A/C
accumulator and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
6. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction line fitting and the accumulator tube.
7. Disconnect the wire harness connector (5) from the A/C pressure transducer (4).
8. Remove the nut (2) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly (3) to the A/C
condenser (1).
9. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C condenser and remove and discard the O-ring
seal and gasket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2464
10. Remove the bolt (7) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C
compressor (6).
11. Disconnect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly from the A/C compressor and remove
and discard the O-ring seals and gasket.
12. Remove the A/C suction and discharge line assembly from the engine compartment.
13. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings and the condenser and
compressor ports.
14. If necessary, remove the A/C pressure transducer from the A/C discharge line.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system.
Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be added to the refrigerant system.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: The A/C discharge line for the 5.9L and the 6.7L diesel engine is serviced as an assembly
with the A/C suction line.
1. If removed, install the A/C pressure transducer (4) onto the A/C suction and discharge line
assembly (3).
2. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened refrigerant line fittings and the condenser and
compressor ports.
3. Position the A/C suction and discharge line assembly into the engine compartment.
4. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the
refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
5. Connect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C condenser (1).
6. Install the nut (2) that secures the A/C discharge line to the A/C condenser. Tighten the nut to 23
Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C compressor (6).
8. Install the bolt (7) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C
compressor. Tighten the bolt to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector (5) to the A/C pressure transducer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2465
10. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened accumulator tube.
11. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the
accumulator tube fitting. Use only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
12. Connect the A/C suction line (6) to the spring-lock coupler (1) on the A/C accumulator (5) and
install the secondary retaining clip (7).
13. Install the air filter housing cover.
14. Reconnect the negative battery cables.
15. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
16. Adjust the refrigerant oil level.
17. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2466
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Line-A/C Liquid
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible personal
injury or death.
NOTE: The A/C liquid line is serviced in two sections.
FRONT SECTION
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system.
3. Remove the passenger side battery.
4. Remove the air seal from the right end of the A/C condenser (5) to gain access to the refrigerant
line fittings.
5. Remove the nut (2) that secures the front section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the A/C condenser
(3).
6. Disconnect the A/C liquid line from the A/C condenser and remove and discard the O-ring and
gasket.
7. Disengage the A/C liquid line (1) from the three body retaining clips (2 and 3) located at the right
front corner of the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2467
8. Remove the secondary retaining clip (2) from the spring-lock coupler that secures the front
section of the A/C liquid line (1) to the rear section of
the liquid line (3).
9. Using the proper A/C line disconnect tool (Special Tool Kit 7193 or equivalent), disconnect the
front section of the A/C liquid line from the rear
section of the liquid line and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
10. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened ends of the A/C liquid lines and the condenser port.
11. Remove the front section of the A/C liquid line from the engine compartment.
REAR SECTION
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable.
13. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system.
14. Remove the passenger side battery.
15. Disengage the rear section of the A/C liquid line (2) from the body retaining clip (5).
16. Remove the secondary retaining clip (1) from the spring-lock coupler that secures the front
section of the A/C liquid line (6) to the rear section of
the A/C liquid line.
17. Using the proper A/C line disconnect tool (Special Tool Kit 7193 or equivalent), disconnect the
front section of the A/C liquid line from the rear
section of the liquid line and remove and discard the O-ring seals.
18. Remove the secondary retaining clip (3) from the spring-lock coupler that secures the rear
section of the A/C liquid line to the evaporator tube (4).
19. Using the proper A/C line disconnect tool (Special Tool Kit 7193 or equivalent), disconnect the
A/C liquid line from the evaporator tube and
remove and discard the O-ring seals.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2468
20. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened ends of the A/C liquid lines and the evaporator tube,
21. Remove the rear section of the A/C liquid line from the engine compartment.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system.
Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be added to the refrigerant system.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: The A/C liquid line is serviced in two sections.
FRONT SECTION
1. Position the front section of the A/C liquid line (1) into the engine compartment.
2. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened ends of the A/C liquid lines and the condenser port.
3. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the front liquid line
spring-lock coupler fitting. Use only the specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
4. Connect the front section of the A/C liquid line to the rear section of the liquid line (3).
5. Install the secondary retaining clip (2) onto the spring-lock coupler that secures the front section
of the A/C liquid line onto the rear section of the
liquid line.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2469
6. Engage the A/C liquid line (1) into the three body retaining clips (2 and 3) located at the right
front corner of the engine compartment.
7. Lubricate a new O-ring with clean refrigerant oil and install it and a new gasket onto the front
liquid line fitting. Use only the specified O-ring seal
as it is made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
8. Connect the front section of the A/C liquid line (2) to the condenser port.
9. Install the nut (1) that secures the A/C liquid line to the A/C condenser (3). Tighten the nut to 23
Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
10. Position the air seal over the right end of the A/C condenser and install the air seal retainers.
11. Install the passenger side battery tray.
12. Reconnect the negative battery cable(s).
13. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
14. Adjust the refrigerant oil level.
15. Charge the refrigerant system.
REAR SECTION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2470
16. Position the rear section of the A/C liquid line (2) into the engine compartment.
17. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened ends of the A/C liquid lines and the evaporator tube
(4).
18. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the rear liquid line
spring-lock coupler fitting. Use only the specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
19. Connect the rear section of the A/C liquid line to the evaporator tube.
20. Install the secondary retaining clip (3) onto the spring-lock coupler that secures the rear section
of the A/C liquid line onto the evaporator tube.
21. Engage the A/C liquid line into the body retaining clip (5).
22. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the front liquid line
spring-lock coupler fitting. Use only the specified
seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the
type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
23. Connect the rear section of the A/C liquid line (6) to the front section of the liquid line.
24. Install the secondary retaining clip (1) onto the spring-lock coupler that secures the front section
of the A/C liquid line to the rear section of the
liquid line.
25. Install the passenger side battery tray.
26. Reconnect the negative battery cables.
27. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
28. Adjust the refrigerant oil level.
29. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2471
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Line-A/C Suction
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible personal
injury or death.
NOTE: The A/C suction line for the 5.9L and the 6.7L diesel engine is serviced as an assembly with
the A/C discharge line.
1. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cables.
2. Recover the refrigerant from the refrigerant system.
3. Remove the air filter housing cover.
4. Remove the secondary retaining clip (7) from the spring-lock coupler (1) that secures the A/C
suction line (6) to the A/C accumulator (5).
5. Using the proper A/C line disconnect tool (Special Tool Kit 7193 or equivalent), disconnect the
A/C suction line from the A/C accumulator and
remove and discard the O-ring seals.
6. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened suction line fitting and the accumulator tube.
7. Disconnect the wire harness connector (5) from the A/C pressure transducer (4).
8. Remove the nut (2) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly (3) to the A/C
condenser (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2472
9. Disconnect the A/C discharge line from the A/C condenser and remove and discard the O-ring
seal and gasket.
10. Remove the bolt (7) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C
compressor (6).
11. Disconnect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly from the A/C compressor and remove
and discard the O-ring seals and gasket.
12. Remove the A/C suction and discharge line assembly from the engine compartment.
13. Install plugs in, or tape over the opened refrigerant line fittings and the condenser and
compressor ports.
14. If necessary, remove the A/C pressure transducer from the A/C discharge line.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL ENGINES
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant oil level when servicing the A/C refrigerant system.
Failure to properly adjust the refrigerant oil level will prevent the A/C system from operating as
designed and can cause serious A/C compressor damage.
NOTE: When replacing multiple A/C system components, refer to the Refrigerant Oil Capacities
chart to determine how much oil should be added to the refrigerant system.
NOTE: Replacement of the refrigerant line O-ring seals and gaskets is required anytime a
refrigerant line is opened. Failure to replace the rubber O-ring seals and metal gaskets could result
in a refrigerant system leak.
NOTE: The A/C suction line for the 5.9L and the 6.7L diesel engine is serviced as an assembly with
the A/C discharge line.
1. If removed, install the A/C pressure transducer (4) onto the A/C suction and discharge line
assembly (3).
2. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened refrigerant line fittings and the condenser and
compressor ports.
3. Position the A/C suction and discharge line assembly into the engine compartment.
4. Lubricate new O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them and new gaskets onto the
refrigerant line fittings. Use only the specified
O-ring seals as they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil
of the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
5. Connect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C condenser (1).
6. Install the nut (2) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C
condenser. Tighten the nut to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C compressor (6).
8. Install the bolt (7) that secures the A/C suction and discharge line assembly to the A/C
compressor. Tighten the bolt to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
9. Connect the wire harness connector (5) to the A/C pressure transducer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Line-A/C Discharge > Page 2473
10. Remove the tape or plugs from the opened accumulator tube.
11. Lubricate new rubber O-ring seals with clean refrigerant oil and install them onto the
accumulator tube fitting. Use only the specified O-rings as
they are made of a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type
recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
12. Connect the A/C suction line (6) to the spring-lock coupler (1) on the A/C accumulator (5) and
install the secondary retaining clip (7).
13. Install the air filter housing cove.
14. Reconnect the negative battery cables.
15. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
16. Adjust the refrigerant oil level.
17. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hoses - I.F.S.
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hoses - I.F.S.
Return Hose - Gear To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - GEAR TO COOLER
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Disconnect the
return hose at the cooler. 4. Disconnect the return hose (1) at the gear. 5. Remove the return hose
from the routing clamp at the fan shroud and then remove from the vehicle.
Pressure Hose
PRESSURE HOSE
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Disconnect the
pressure hose at the pump. 4. Disconnect the pressure hose (2) at the gear. 5. Remove the
pressure hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose - Reservoir To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - RESERVOIR TO COOLER
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Disconnect the return hose at the reservoir. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Remove the return hose from the routing clamp at the fan shroud.
5. Disconnect the return hose at the cooler. 6. Remove the hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose - Gear To Cooler
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hoses - I.F.S. > Page 2478
RETURN HOSE - GEAR TO COOLER
1. Install the return hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the return hose at the cooler. 3. Reconnect
the return hose (1) at the gear. Tighten the hose to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.). 4. Reattach the hose to the
routing clip at the fan shroud. 5. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the power
steering system.
Pressure Hose
PRESSURE HOSE
NOTE: Be sure to align the pressure hose so it does not contact the fan shroud or the frame rail.
1. Install the pressure hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the pressure hose (2) at the gear. Tighten
the hose to 32 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the pressure hose at the pump. Tighten the hose to
31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). 4. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 5. Refill the power steering
system.
Return Hose - Reservoir To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - RESERVOIR TO COOLER
1. Install the return hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the return hose at the cooler. 3. Reattach the
hose to the routing clip at the fan shroud. 4. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 5.
Reconnect the return hose at the reservoir. 6. Refill the power steering system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hoses - I.F.S. > Page 2479
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Hoses - Link/Coil
Return Hose - Gear To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - GEAR TO COOLER
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Disconnect the
return hose at the cooler. 4. Disconnect the return hose (2) at the gear. 5. Remove the return hose
from the routing clamp at the fan shroud and then remove from the vehicle.
Pressure Hose
PRESSURE HOSE
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Disconnect the
pressure hose at the pump. 4. Disconnect the pressure hose (2) at the gear (4). 5. Remove the
pressure hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose - Reservoir To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - RESERVOIR TO COOLER
1. Drain and siphon the power steering system. 2. Disconnect the return hose at the reservoir. 3.
Raise and support the vehicle. 4. Remove the return hose from the routing clamp at the fan shroud.
5. Disconnect the return hose at the cooler. 6. Remove the hose from the vehicle.
Return Hose - Gear To Cooler
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Hoses - I.F.S. > Page 2480
RETURN HOSE - GEAR TO COOLER
1. Install the return hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the return hose at the cooler. 3. Reconnect
the return hose (2) at the gear. Tighten the hose to 51 Nm (38 ft. lbs.). 4. Reattach the hose to the
routing clip at the fan shroud. 5. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 6. Refill the power
steering system.
Pressure Hose
PRESSURE HOSE
NOTE: Be sure to align the pressure hose so it does not contact the fan shroud or the frame rail.
1. Install the pressure hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the pressure hose (2) at the gear (4).
Tighten the hose to 32 Nm (23 ft. lbs.). 3. Reconnect the pressure hose at the pump. Tighten the
hose to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 4. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 5. Refill the power
steering system.
Return Hose - Reservoir To Cooler
RETURN HOSE - RESERVOIR TO COOLER
1. Install the return hose to the vehicle. 2. Reconnect the return hose at the cooler. 3. Reattach the
hose to the routing clip at the fan shroud. 4. Remove the support and lower the vehicle. 5.
Reconnect the return hose at the reservoir. 6. Refill the power steering system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2486
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2487
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Mopar DOT 3 and SAE J1703 or equivalent.
NOTE: If DOT 3 is not available, then DOT 4 or DOT 4+ is acceptable. Use only recommended
brake fluids.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2488
Brake Fluid: Description and Operation
BRAKE FLUID
The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum-based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2489
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts.
Swollen rubber parts indicate the presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush system. Replace master cylinder,
proportioning valve, caliper seals, wheel cylinder seals, Antilock Brakes hydraulic unit and all
hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2490
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
Always clean the master cylinder reservoir (1) and cap (2) before checking fluid level. If not
cleaned, dirt could enter the fluid.
The fluid fill level is indicated on the side of the master cylinder reservoir (1).
The correct fluid level is to the MAX indicator on the side of the reservoir. If necessary, add fluid to
the proper level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Clutch Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2495
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2496
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Chrysler does not provide a fluid type specification for the master/slave cylinder.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2501
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Engine Coolant Capacity .....................................................................................................................
........................................................ 22.6 qts (21.4L)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2504
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula HOAT (Hybrid Organic Additive
Technology) or equivalent.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Coolant: Description and Operation Description
Coolant
COOLANT
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene glycol base coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek
medical attention immediately. Do not store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and
clothing thoroughly after coming in contact with ethylene glycol. Keep out of reach of children.
Dispose of glycol base coolant properly, contact your dealer or government agency for location of
collection center in your area. Do not open a cooling system when the engine is at operating
temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when
engine compartment related service is performed, personal injury can result.
ETHYLENE-GLYCOL MIXTURES
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethylene-glycol.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Only Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year 100,000 Mile Formula (ethylene-glycol base
coolant with corrosion inhibitors called HOAT, for Hybrid Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% distilled water
to obtain a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F).
The required ethylene-glycol (antifreeze) and water mixture depends upon the climate and vehicle
operating conditions. The antifreeze concentration must always be a minimum of 44 percent,
year-round in all climates. If percentage is lower than 44 percent, engine parts may be eroded by
cavitation, and cooling system components may be severely damaged by corrosion. Maximum
protection against freezing is provided with a 68% antifreeze concentration, which prevents
freezing down to -67.7°C (-90°F). A higher percentage will freeze at a warmer temperature. Also, a
higher percentage of antifreeze can cause the engine to overheat because the specific heat of
antifreeze is lower than that of water.
Use of 100 percent ethylene-glycol will cause formation of additive deposits in the system, as the
corrosion inhibitive additives in ethylene-glycol require the presence of water to dissolve. The
deposits act as insulation, causing temperatures to rise to as high as 149°C (300°F). This
temperature is hot enough to melt plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result
in engine detonation. In addition, 100 percent ethylene-glycol freezes at 22°C (-8°F).
PROPYLENE-GLYCOL MIXTURES
It's overall effective temperature range is smaller than that of ethylene-glycol. The freeze point of
50/50 propylene-glycol and water is -32°C (-26°F). 5° C higher than ethylene-glycol's freeze point.
The boiling point (protection against summer boil-over) of propylene-glycol is 125°C (257°F) at 96.5
kPa (14 psi), compared to 128°C (263°F) for ethylene-glycol. Use of propylene-glycol can result in
boil-over or freeze-up on a cooling system designed for ethylene-glycol. Propylene- glycol also has
poorer heat transfer characteristics than ethylene-glycol. This can increase cylinder head
temperatures under certain conditions.
Propylene-glycol/ethylene-glycol Mixtures can cause the destabilization of various corrosion
inhibitors, causing damage to the various cooling system components. Also, once ethylene-glycol
and propylene-glycol based coolants are mixed in the vehicle, conventional methods of determining
freeze point will not be accurate. Both the refractive index and specific gravity differ between
ethylene glycol and propylene-glycol.
HOAT Coolant
HOAT COOLANT
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene-glycol base coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek
medical attention immediately. Do not store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and
clothing thoroughly after coming in contact with ethylene-glycol. Keep out of reach of children.
Dispose of glycol base coolant properly, contact your dealer or government agency for location of
collection center in your area. Do not open a cooling system when the engine is at operating
temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when
engine compartment related service is performed, personal injury can result.
CAUTION: Use of Propylene-Glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less corrosion protection.
The cooling system is designed around the coolant. The coolant must accept heat from engine
metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust valves and engine block. Then coolant carries the
heat to the radiator where the tube/fin radiator can transfer the heat to the air.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the
equivalent ethylene-glycol base coolant with organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 2507
Organic Additive Technology) is recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling without
corrosion when mixed with 50% ethylene-glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of
-37°C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh
properly mixed coolant solution.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769) may not be
mixed with any other type of antifreeze. Mixing of coolants other than specified (non-HOAT or other
HOAT), may result in engine damage that may not be covered under the new vehicle warranty, and
decreased corrosion protection.
COOLANT PERFORMANCE
The required ethylene-glycol and water mixture depends upon climate and vehicle operating
conditions. The coolant performance of various mixtures follows:
Pure Water- Water can absorb more heat than a mixture of water and ethylene-glycol. This is for
purpose of heat transfer only. Water also freezes at a higher temperature and allows corrosion.
100 percent Ethylene-Glycol - The corrosion inhibiting additives in ethylene-glycol need the
presence of water to dissolve. Without water, additives form deposits in system. These act as
insulation causing temperature to rise to as high as 149°C (300°F). This temperature is hot enough
to melt plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result in engine detonation. In
addition, 100 percent ethylene-glycol freezes at -22°C (-8°F).
50/50 Ethylene-Glycol and Water - Is the recommended mixture, it provides protection against
freezing to -37°C (-34°F). The antifreeze concentration must always be a minimum of 44 percent,
year-round in all climates. If percentage is lower, engine parts may be eroded by cavitation.
Maximum protection against freezing is provided with a 68 percent antifreeze concentration, which
prevents freezing down to -67.7°C (-90°F). A higher percentage will freeze at a warmer
temperature. Also, a higher percentage of antifreeze can cause the engine to overheat because
specific heat of antifreeze is lower than that of water.
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethylene-glycol.
COOLANT SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Only Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (glycol base coolant
with corrosion inhibitors called HOAT, for Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% distilled water
to obtain a freeze point of -37 °C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush,
and replace with fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
CAUTION: Do not use coolant additives that are claimed to improve engine cooling.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 2508
Coolant: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Coolant flows through the engine block, cylinder head, absorbing the heat from the engine, then
flows to the radiator where the cooling fins in the radiator transfers the heat from the coolant to the
atmosphere. On the 6.7L diesel engine, coolant also flows through the EGR cooler and
turbocharger actuator. During cold weather the ethylene-glycol or propylene-glycol coolant
prevents water present in the cooling system from freezing within temperatures indicated by
mixture ratio of coolant to water.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
2509
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Coolant concentration should be checked when any additional coolant was added to system or
after a coolant drain, flush and refill. The coolant mixture offers optimum engine cooling and
protection against corrosion when mixed to a freeze point of -37°C (-34°F) to -46°C (-50°F). The
use of a hydrometer or Tool 8266, refractometer can be used to test coolant concentration.
A hydrometer will test the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the
mixture. The higher the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will
float, and higher the freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol).
A Refractometer Tool 8286 will test the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the
amount a beam of light bends as it passes through the fluid.
Some coolant manufactures use other types of glycols into their coolant formulations. Propylene
glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene glycol based coolants do not provide
the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and is not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant - corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2514
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2519
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2524
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Differential Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2529
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2534
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2535
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2536
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2537
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Service Fill - 42RLE .............................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.8L (4.0 Quarts) Overhaul Fill - 42RLE ......................................
........................................................................................................................................... 8.3L (8.7
Quarts)
Service Fill - 45RFE/545RFE 4X2
..............................................................................................................................................................
5.2L (5.5 Quarts) 4X4 ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................... 6.2L (6.5 Quarts) Overhaul - 45RFE/545RFE
....................................................................................................................................................... 14
-16L (14.8-16.9 Quarts)
Service Fill - 48RE ...............................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.8L (4.0 Quarts) Overhaul - 48RE ..............................................
..................................................................................................................... 14 - 16L (14.8 - 16.9
Quarts)
Service Fill - 68RFE 4X2 .....................................................................................................................
....................................................... 5.2L (5.5 Quarts) 4X4 ..................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ 6.2L (6.5
Quarts) Overhaul - 68RFE ...................................................................................................................
............................................ 15.6 - 16.6L (16.4 - 17.5 Quarts)
Service Fill - AS68RC ..........................................................................................................................
....................................................... 6.8L (7.2 Quarts) Overhaul - AS68RC .........................................
......................................................................................................................................... 13L (13.74
Quarts)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2540
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Automatic Transmission Fluid .............................................................................................................
.......................................................... Mopar ATF +4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure. 2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and auxiliary cooler. This
condition is usually the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged oil cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
3. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
- engine coolant entering the fluid
- internal failure that generates debris
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This
is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2543
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 48RE Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has two primary causes.
1. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. This condition is usually
the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged oil cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
2. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
- engine coolant entering the fluid
- internal failure that generates debris
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This
is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 2544
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure. 2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. 3.
Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer towing
or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid.
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level.
- engine coolant entering the fluid.
- internal failure that generates debris.
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown).
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair.
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This is
necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmssion has too much fluid, the
geartrain churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. It is located on the right side of the engine. Be
sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P (PARK) and N (NEUTRAL) positions. Place the selector
lever in P (PARK) to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at
idle speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating
temperature (approximately 82° C. or 180° F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region
(cross-hatched area) on the oil level indicator. The fluid level will be approximately at the upper
COLD hole of the dipstick at 21° C (70° F) fluid temperature.
FILL TUBE EQUIPPED WITH INDICATOR
NOTE: Engine and Transmission should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure. After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into PARK. 5. Hook up scan tool and select transmission. 6. Select sensors. 7. Read
the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the Transmission Fluid
Temperature Chart.
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2547
transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
CAPPED FILL TUBE
1. Verify that the vehicle is parked on a level surface. 2. Remove the dipstick tube cap.
WARNING: There is a risk of accident from vehicle starting off by itself when engine is running.
There is a risk of injury from contusions and burns if you insert your hands into the engine when it
is started or when it is running. Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving off by itself. Wear properly
fastened and close-fitting work clothes. Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
3. Actuate the service brake. Start engine and let it run at idle speed in selector lever position "P".
4. Shift through the transmission modes several times with the vehicle stationary and the engine
idling. 5. Warm up the transmission, wait at least 2 minutes and check the oil level with the engine
running. Push the Oil Dipstick 9336 into transmission fill
tube until the dipstick tip contacts the oil pan and pull out again, read off oil level, repeat if
necessary.
NOTE: The dipstick will protrude from the fill tube when installed.
6. Check transmission oil temperature using the appropriate scan tool.
NOTE: The true transmission oil temperature can only be read by a scan tool in REVERSE or any
forward gear position.
7. The transmission Oil Dipstick 9336 has indicator marks every 10 mm. Determine the height of
the oil level on the dipstick and using the height,
the transmission temperature, and the Transmission Fluid Graph, determine if the transmission oil
level is correct.
8. Add or remove oil as necessary and recheck the oil level. 9. Once the oil level is correct, install
the dipstick tube cap.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan. 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission. 4. Loosen
bolts holding rear of pan to transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2548
5. Slowly separate front of pan away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6.
Hold up pan and remove remaining bolts holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level,
lower pan away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
9. Remove the screw holding the primary oil filter (1) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and oil pump and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Inspect
the oil filter seal in the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is not installed completely in the oil pump,
or is otherwise damaged, then remove
and discard the oil filter seal from the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is installed correctly and is
in good condition, it can be reused.
12. If replacing the cooler return filter (2), use Oil Filter Wrench 8321 to remove the filter from the
transmission. 13. Dispose of used trans fluid and filter(s) properly.
INSPECTION
Inspect bottom of pan and magnet for excessive amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material
on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition
or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the
diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2549
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
CAUTION: The primary oil filter seal MUST be fully installed flush against the oil pump body. DO
NOT install the seal onto the filter neck and attempt to install the filter and seal as an assembly.
Damage to the transmission will result.
1. If necessary, install a new primary oil filter seal in the oil pump inlet bore. Seat the seal in the
bore with Installer 6960-A or another suitable tool
(appropriately sized drift or socket, the butt end of a hammer etc.).
2. Place replacement filter in position on valve body and into the oil pump. 3. Install screw to hold
the primary oil filter (1) to valve body. Tighten screw to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Install new
cooler return filter (2) onto the transmission, if necessary. Torque the filter to 9.5 Nm (84 in.lbs.). 5.
Place bead of Mopar(R) RTV sealant onto the transmission case sealing surface. 6. Place pan in
position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to transmission. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.) torque. 8. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) ATF +4.
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) ATF +4 to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 10 pints (5 quarts) of ATF +4 to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled and the torque converter was replaced or drained, add 24
pints (12 quarts) of ATF +4 to
transmission.
3. Check the transmission fluid, refer to FLUID - STANDARD PROCEDURE and adjust as
required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2550
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmssion has too much fluid, the
geartrain churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. It is located on the right side of the engine. Be
sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle before removing.
Fluid level is checked with the engine running at curb idle speed, the transmission in NEUTRAL
and the transmission fluid at normal operating temperature. The engine should be running at idle
speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground.
The transmission fluid level can be checked two ways.
PROCEDURE ONE
1. Transmission fluid must be at normal operating temperature for accurate fluid level check. Drive
vehicle if necessary to bring fluid temperature up
to normal hot operating temperature of 82°C (180°F).
2. Position vehicle on level surface. 3. Start and run engine at curb idle speed. 4. Apply parking
brakes. 5. Shift transmission momentarily into all gear ranges. Then shift transmission back to
NEUTRAL. 6. Clean top of filler tube and dipstick to keep dirt from entering tube. 7. Remove
dipstick (1) and check fluid level as follows:
a. Correct acceptable level is in crosshatch area. b. Correct maximum level is to MAX arrow mark.
c. Incorrect level is at or below MIN line. d. If fluid is low, add only enough Mopar(R) ATF +4 to
restore correct level. Do not overfill.
PROCEDURE TWO
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2551
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into NEUTRAL. 5. Hook up scan tool and select engine. 6. Select sensors. 7. Read
the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the chart.
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
The service fluid fill after a filter change is approximately 3.8 liters (4.0 quarts).
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan (3). 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2552
4. Loosen bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan and reusable
gasket (2) away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and
remove remaining bolt holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan and
gasket away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
9. Remove screws holding filter (2) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Dispose of used trans
fluid and filter properly.
INSTALLATION
1. Position a new transmission oil filter (2) onto the valve body. 2. Install the screws to hold the filter
to the valve body. Tighten the screws to 4 Nm (35 in.lbs.).
3. Clean the gasket surfaces of the transmission oil pan (3) and transmission pan rail.
NOTE: The transmission pan oil gasket (2) is reusable. Inspect the sealing surfaces of the gasket.
If the sealing ribs on both surfaces
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2553
appear to be in good condition, clean the gasket of any foreign material and reinstall.
4. Position the oil pan gasket (2) onto the oil pan (3). 5. Position the oil pan and gasket onto the
transmission and install several bolts to hold the pan and gasket to the transmission. 6. Install the
remainder of the oil pan bolts. Tighten the bolts to 13.6 Nm (125 in.lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle and fill
transmission.
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) ATF +4 to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 3 pints (1-1/2 quarts) of ATF +4 to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled, torque converter was replaced or drained, and cooler
was flushed, add 12 pints (6 quarts) of ATF
+4 to transmission.
3. Apply parking brakes. 4. Start and run engine at normal curb idle speed. 5. Apply service brakes,
shift transmission through all gear ranges then back to NEUTRAL, set parking brake, and leave
engine running at curb idle
speed.
6. Remove funnel, insert dipstick and check fluid level. If level is low, add fluid to bring level to MIN
mark on dipstick. Check to see if the oil
level is equal on both sides of the dipstick. If one side is noticeably higher than the other, the
dipstick has picked up some oil from the dipstick tube. Allow the oil to drain down the dipstick tube
and re-check.
7. Drive vehicle until transmission fluid is at normal operating temperature. 8. With the engine
running at curb idle speed, the gear selector in NEUTRAL, and the parking brake applied, check
the transmission fluid level.
CAUTION: Do not overfill transmission, fluid foaming and shifting problems can result.
9. Add fluid to bring level up to MAX arrow mark.
When fluid level is correct, shut engine off, release park brake, remove funnel, and install dipstick
in fill tube.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2554
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmission has too much fluid,
the gear train churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. Be sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle
before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P (PARK) and N (NEUTRAL) positions. Place the selector
lever in P (PARK) to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at
idle speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating
temperature (approximately 82° C. or 180° F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region
(cross-hatched area) on the oil level indicator. The fluid level will be approximately at the upper
COLD hole of the dipstick at 21° C (70° F) fluid temperature.
NOTE: Engine and Transmission should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure. Optimum fluid temperature for checking the level should be between 70°C (158°F) and
80°C ( 176°F).
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into PARK. 5. Connect the scan tool and select transmission. 6. Select sensors. 7.
Read the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the Transmission Fluid
Temperature Chart.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2555
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
DRAIN PLUG
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a large diameter drain pan beneath the transmission pan. 3. Remove the
drain plug bolt (1) and allow the oil to drain from the transmission pan. 4. Remove the drain pan
bolts from the transmission case. 5. Remove the drain pan.
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2556
6. Remove the transmission oil filter bolts (3). 7. Remove the transmission oil filter and O-ring seal
from the valve body (1).
INSPECTION
OIL PAN MAGNETS
Inspect bottom of pan, pick-up magnets (1) and magnetic drain plug (2) and fluid filter for excessive
amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a
problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated
with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2557
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
1. Lubricate the transmission oil filter seal with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the new
transmission oil filter (2) in position on valve body (1) and into the oil pump. 3. Install the
transmission oil filter bolts (3). 4. Tighten bolts to 10 Nm ( 88 in.lbs. ) torque. 5. Install a new
transmission oil pan gasket. 6. Place pan in position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to
transmission. Tighten bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) torque.
DRAIN PLUG
8. Install transmission drain plug bolt (1). 9. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm ( 20 ft.lbs) torque.
10. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE
Automatic Transmission > Page 2558
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) AS68RC ATF to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 6.8L (7.2 quarts) of AS68RC to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled and the torque converter was replaced or drained, add
13L (13.75 quarts) of Mopar(R) AS68RC
ATF to transmission.
3. Check the transmission fluid and adjust as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2563
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2568
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
G56 ......................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 5.6 L (12 pints)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2571
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Mopar ATF +4 Transmission Fluid
Note: DaimlerChrysler recommends using Mopar lubricants or lubricants of equal quality.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2576
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Front Axle C205FD ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 1.6 L ( 56 ounces) 9 1/4 AA .........................................
............................................................................................................................................................
2.2 L (74 ounces) 9 1/4 AA EL ............................................................................................................
................................................................................... 2.0 L (68 ounces)
Rear Axle 9 1/4 ....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 2.1 L (72 ounces) 10 1/2 AA ........................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
2.5 L (85 ounces) 10 1/2 AA EL ..........................................................................................................
................................................................................... 2.5 L (85 ounces) 11 1/2 AA Open ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 4.2 L (142 ounces) 11 1/2 AA Trac-Rite ......................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.0 L (135 ounces)
Note: With Track-Lok add 118 ml (4 oz) of Limited Slip Additive.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 2579
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Note: DaimlerChrysler recommends using Mopar lubricants or lubricants of equal quality.
Front Axle c205FD - Mopar Gear Lubricant 75W-90 9 1/4 AA - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant
75W-90 9 1/4 AA EL - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90
Rear Axle 9 1/4 - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-140 10 1/2 AA - Mopar Synthetic Gear
Lubricant 75W-90 10 1/2 AA EL - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90 11 1/2 AA - Mopar
Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90
Note: Trac-Lok differentials require Limited Slip Additive in the lubricant. Trac-Rite/Trac-Rite EL
differential DO NOT require Limited Slip Additive.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2584
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
NV241 GEN II ......................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 1.6 L 3.4 (pints) NV243 ................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 1.6 L (3.4
Pints) NV244 GEN II ............................................................................................................................
................................................................. 1.6 L (3.4 pints) NV246 ......................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 1.9 9L
(4.0 pints) NV271 .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 1.89 L (4.0 pints) NV273 ..............................................
..........................................................................................................................................................
1.89 L (4.0 pints)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 2587
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
All Except NV246 Recommended lubricant for the NV241 GEN II, NV271, NV243, NV 244 GEN II,
and NV273 transfer cases is Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
NV246 Recommended lubricant for the NV246 transfer case is Mopar NVG 246 Automatic
Transmission Fluid or equivalent.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV241 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2590
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV271 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (1) and drain (2) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2591
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV243 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2592
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV244 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
NOTE: The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain (3) and fill (2) plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug (3).
Tighten plug to 20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge
of fill plug opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill
plug (2) to 20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if
removed. 9. Wipe any excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2593
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
NV241 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV271 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (1) and drain (2) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2594
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV243 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV244 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2595
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair
> NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 2596
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2601
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil with Filter ............................................................................................................................
................................................. 11.4Liters (12.0 Qt)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 2604
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE OIL - DIESEL ENGINES Use only Low Ash Diesel Engine Oil meeting standard
MIL-2104C or API Classification CJ-4/SM (5.9L), or CJ-4 (6.7L), or higher that meets Cummins
CES 20081 Standards.
Low ash diesel engine oil is REQUIRED for the 6.7L engine, use MOPAR® MaxPro 15W-40 6700
Diesel DPF diesel engine oil, or equivalent.
SAE VISCOSITY GRADE
CAUTION: Low viscosity oils must have the proper API quality or the CCMC G5 designation.
To assure of properly formulated engine oils, it is recommended that SAE Grade 15W-40 engine
oils that meet Chrysler material standard MS-10902, be used in accordance to ACEA B3, B4
specification. European Grade 15W-40 oils that meet Association des Constructeurs Europe■ens
d' Automobiles (European Automobile Manufacturers Association) (ACEA) specifications, are also
acceptable.
Oils of the SAE 5W-40 grade number are preferred when minimum temperatures consistently fall
below -15°C (5°F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2605
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
CAUTION: Do not overfill crankcase with engine oil, oil foaming and oil pressure loss can result.
To ensure proper lubrication of an engine, the engine oil must be maintained at an acceptable
level. The acceptable oil level is in the SAFE RANGE (3) on the engine oil dipstick.
NOTE: The best time to check the engine oil level is after the engine is at operating temperature
and has been turned off (not running) for 30 minutes.
1. Position vehicle on level surface. 2. With engine OFF, allow approximately 30 minutes for oil to
settle to bottom of crankcase, remove engine oil dipstick. 3. Wipe dipstick clean. 4. Replace
dipstick and verify it is seated in the tube. 5. Remove dipstick, with handle held above the tip, take
oil level reading. 6. Add oil only if level is below the SAFE RANGE area on the dipstick. 7. Replace
dipstick.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2606
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL SERVICE
WARNING: Hot oil can cause personal injury.
NOTE: Change engine oil and filter at intervals specified in the owner's manual.
1. Operate the engine until the water temperature reaches 60°C (140°F). Shut the engine off. 2.
Use a container that can hold at least 14 liters (15 quarts) to hold the used oil. Remove the oil drain
plug and drain the used engine oil into the
container.
3. Always check the condition of the used oil. This can give you an indication of engine problems
that might exist.
- Thin, black oil indicates fuel dilution.
- Milky discoloration indicates coolant dilution.
4. Clean the area around the oil filter head. Remove the filter. 5. Install new oil filter. 6. Clean the
drain plug and the sealing surface of the pan. Check the condition of the threads and sealing
surface on the oil pan and drain plug. 7. Install the drain plug. Tighten the plug to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
torque. 8. Use only High-Quality Low Ash Multi-Viscosity lubricating oil in the Cummins Turbo
Diesel engine. 9. Fill the engine with the correct grade of new oil.
10. Start the engine and operate it at idle for several minutes. Check for leaks at the filter and drain
plug. 11. Stop engine. Wait 30 minutes to allow the oil to drain back to the pan and check the level
again.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing of used engine oil after it has been drained from a
vehicle's engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2611
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2612
Power Steering Fluid: Specifications
POWER STEERING FLUID
Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2613
Power Steering Fluid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: It is normal that some pressure will build up inside the reservoir, especially, with a warm
vehicle. A slight popping noise upon removal of the cap is normal. The fluid level should read
between the ADD and the FULL COLD marks. When the fluid is hot it should read between ADD
and FULL HOT marks. Only add fluid when the vehicle is cold.
The recommended fluid for the power steering system is Mopar(R) ATF +4.
Mopar(R) ATF+4, when new is red in color. The ATF+4 is dyed red so it can be identified from
other fluids used in the vehicle such as engine oil or antifreeze. The red color is not permanent and
is not an indicator of fluid condition, As the vehicle is driven, the ATF+4 will begin to look darker in
color and may eventually become brown. THIS IS NORMAL. ATF+4 also has a unique odor that
may change with age. Consequently, odor and color cannot be used to indicate the fluid condition
or the need for a fluid change.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2614
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
POWER STEERING FLUID LEVEL CHECKING
WARNING: FLUID LEVEL SHOULD BE CHECKED WITH THE ENGINE OFF TO PREVENT
PERSONAL INJURY FROM MOVING PARTS.
CAUTION: MOPAR(R) ATF+4 is to be used in the power steering system. No other power steering
or automatic transmission fluid is to be used in the system. Damage may result to the power
steering pump and system if any other fluid is used, and do not overfill.
The power steering fluid level can be viewed on the dipstick attached to the filler cap. There are
two ranges listed on the dipstick, COLD and HOT. Before opening power steering system, wipe the
reservoir filler cap free of dirt and debris. Remove the cap and check the fluid level on its dipstick.
When the fluid is at normal ambient temperature, approximately 21°C to 27°C (70°F to 80°F), the
fluid level should read between the minimum and maximum area of the cold range. When the fluid
is hot, fluid level is allowed to read up to the highest end of the HOT range. Only add fluid when the
vehicle is cold.
Use only Mopar(R) ATF+4. Do not overfill the power steering system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2615
Power Steering Fluid: Service and Repair
POWER STEERING SYSTEM BLEEDING
WARNING: The fluid level should be checked with engine off to prevent injury from moving
components.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Power Steering Fluid + 4 or Mopar(R) ATF+4 Automatic Transmission Fluid is
to be used in the power steering system. Both Fluids have the same material standard
specifications (MS-9602). No other power steering or automatic transmission fluid is to be used in
the system. Damage may result to the power steering pump and system if another fluid is used. Do
not overfill the system.
CAUTION: If the air is not purged from the power steering system correctly, pump failure could
result.
NOTE: Be sure the vacuum tool used in the following procedure is clean and free of any fluids.
1. Check the fluid level. As measured on the side of the reservoir, the level should indicate between
MAX and MIN when the fluid is at normal
ambient temperature. Adjust the fluid level as necessary.
2. Tightly insert Power Steering Cap Adapter (4), Special Tool 9688, into the mouth of the reservoir
(3).
CAUTION: Failure to use a the vacuum pump reservoir (1) may allow power steering fluid to be
sucked into the hand vacuum pump.
3. Attach Hand Vacuum Pump (2), Special Tool C-4207 or equivalent, with reservoir (1) attached,
to the Power Steering Cap Adapter (4).
CAUTION: Do not run the engine while vacuum is applied to the power steering system. Damage
to the power steering pump can occur.
NOTE: When performing the following step make sure the vacuum level is maintained during the
entire time period.
4. Using Hand Vacuum Pump (2), apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in. Hg) of vacuum to the system for a
minimum of three minutes. 5. Slowly release the vacuum and remove the special tools. 6. Adjust
the fluid level as necessary. Refer to STEP 1. 7. Repeat STEP 1 through STEP 6 until the fluid no
longer drops when vacuum is applied. 8. Start the engine and cycle the steering wheel lock-to-lock
three times.
NOTE: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops.
9. Stop the engine and check for leaks at all connections.
10. Check for any signs of air in the reservoir and check the fluid level. If air is present, repeat the
procedure as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications
Refrigerant: Specifications
R-134a Refrigerent Charge Capacity
1. 3.7/4.7/5.7 L .....................................................................................................................................
.......................................... 0.728 kg (1.604 lbs.) 2. 5.9/6.7 L ..............................................................
....................................................................................................................... 0.850 kg (1.873 lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The refrigerant used in this air conditioning system is a HydroFluoroCarbon (HFC), type R-134a.
Unlike R-12, which is a Chlorofluorocarbon (CFC), R-134a refrigerant does not contain
ozone-depleting chlorine. R-134a refrigerant is a non-toxic, non-flammable, clear, and colorless
liquefied gas.
Even though R-134a does not contain chlorine, it must be reclaimed and recycled just like
CFC-type refrigerants. This is because R-134a is a greenhouse gas and can contribute to global
warming.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 2621
Refrigerant: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
R-134a refrigerant is not compatible with R-12 refrigerant in an A/C system. Even a small amount
of R-12 refrigerant added to an R-134a refrigerant system will cause A/C compressor failure,
refrigerant oil sludge or poor A/C system performance. In addition, the polyalkylene glycol (PAG)
synthetic refrigerant oils used in an R-134a refrigerant system are not compatible with the
mineral-based refrigerant oils used in an R-12 refrigerant system.
R-134a refrigerant system service ports, service tool couplers and refrigerant dispensing bottles
have all been designed with unique fittings to ensure that an R-134a refrigerant system is not
accidentally contaminated with the wrong refrigerant (R-12). There are also labels posted in the
engine compartment of the vehicle and on the A/C compressor to identify that the A/C system is
equipped with R-134a refrigerant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2622
Refrigerant: Testing and Inspection
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM LEAKS
WARNING: R-134a service equipment or vehicle A/C system should not be pressure tested or leak
tested with compressed air. Mixture of air and R-134a can be combustible at elevated pressures.
These mixtures are potentially dangerous and may result in fire or explosion causing property
damage and serious or fatal injury .
Avoid breathing A/C refrigerant and lubricant vapor or mist. Exposure may irritate eyes, nose and
throat. Use only approved service equipment meeting SAE requirements to discharge an R-134a
system. If accidental system discharge occurs, ventilate work area before resuming service.
NOTE: If the A/C refrigerant system charge is empty or low, a leak in the A/C system is likely.
Visually inspect all A/C lines, fittings and components for an oily residue. Oil residue can be an
indicator of an A/C system leak location.
NOTE: The only way to correctly determine if the refrigerant system is fully charged with R-134a is
to completely evacuate and recharge the A/C system.
Connect a suitable manifold gauge set and determine if the static A/C system pressure is above or
below 345 kPa (50 psi). If less than 345 kPa (50 psi) , proceed to SYSTEM EMPTY. If greater than
345 kPa (50 psi), go to SYSTEM LOW.
SYSTEM EMPTY
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system to the lowest degree of vacuum possible (approximately -88 kPa
(- 26 in. Hg) or greater vacuum). Determine if
the system holds a vacuum for 15 minutes. If vacuum is held, a leak is probably not present. If
system will not maintain vacuum level, proceed to STEP 2.
2. Prepare and dispense 0.284 kilograms (10 ounces) of R-134a refrigerant into the evacuated
refrigerant system and proceed to STEP 1 of the
System Low procedure.
SYSTEM LOW
3. Position the vehicle in a wind-free work area. This will aid in detecting small leaks.
4. Operate the heating-A/C system with the engine at idle under the following conditions for at least
5 minutes.
- Doors or windows open
- Transmission in Park or Neutral with the parking brake set (depending on application)
- A/C-heater controls set to outside air, full cool, panel mode, high blower and with A/C compressor
engaged
CAUTION: A leak detector only designed for R-12 refrigerant will not detect leaks in an R-134a
refrigerant system.
5. Shut the vehicle Off and wait 2-7 minutes. Then use an electronic leak detector that is designed
to detect R-134a refrigerant and search for leaks.
Fittings, lines or components that appear to be oily usually indicate a refrigerant leak. To inspect
the A/C evaporator for leaks, insert the leak detector probe into the drain tube opening or an air
outlet. A dye for R-134a is available to aid in leak detection. Use only DaimlerChrysler approved
refrigerant dye.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Recovery
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM RECOVERY
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in serious or fatal injury.
An R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station (1) that meets SAE standard J2210 must
be used to recover the refrigerant from the R-134a refrigerant system. Refer to the operating
instructions supplied by the equipment manufacturer for the proper care and use of this equipment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 2625
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Evacuate
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM EVACUATE
NOTE: Special effort must be used to prevent moisture from entering the A/C system oil. Moisture
in the oil is very difficult to remove and will cause a reliability problem with the A/C compressor.
If an A/C compressor designed to use R-134a refrigerant is left open to the atmosphere for an
extended period of time. It is recommended that the refrigerant oil be drained and replaced with
new oil or a new A/C compressor be used. This will eliminate the possibility of contaminating the
refrigerant system.
If the refrigerant system has been open to the atmosphere, it must be evacuated before the system
can be filled. Moisture and air mixed with the refrigerant will raise the compressor head pressure
above acceptable operating levels. This will reduce the performance of the A/C system and
damage the A/C compressor. Moisture will boil at near room temperature when exposed to
vacuum. To evacuate the refrigerant system:
NOTE: When connecting the service equipment coupling to the line fitting, verify that the valve of
the coupling is fully closed. This will reduce the amount of effort required to make the connection.
1. Recover the refrigerant system.
2. Connect a suitable charging station, refrigerant recovery machine or a manifold gauge set with
vacuum pump and refrigerant recovery equipment.
3. Open the suction and discharge valves and start the vacuum pump. The vacuum pump should
run a minimum of 45 minutes prior to charge to
eliminate all moisture in system. When the suction gauge reads to the lowest degree of vacuum
possible (approximately -88 kPa (- 26 in. Hg) or greater) for 30 minutes, close all valves and turn
off vacuum pump. If the system fails to reach specified vacuum, the refrigerant system likely has a
leak that must be corrected. If the refrigerant system maintains specified vacuum for at least 30
minutes, start the vacuum pump, open the suction and discharge valves. Then allow the system to
evacuate an additional 10 minutes.
4. Close all valves. Turn off and disconnect the vacuum pump.
5. Charge the refrigerant system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Refrigerant System - Recovery > Page 2626
Refrigerant: Service and Repair Refrigerant System - Charge
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM CHARGE
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions may result in serious or fatal injury.
NOTE: The Underhood HVAC Specification Label contains the refrigerant fill specification of the
vehicle being serviced.
After all refrigerant system leaks have been repaired and the refrigerant system has been
evacuated, a refrigerant charge can be injected into the system.
An R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE Standard J2210 must be
used to charge the refrigerant system with R-134a refrigerant. Refer to the operating instructions
supplied by the equipment manufacturer for proper care and use of this equipment.
CHARGING PROCEDURE
CAUTION: A small amount of refrigerant oil is removed from the A/C system each time the
refrigerant system is recovered and evacuated. Before charging the A/C system, you MUST
replenish any oil lost during the recovery process.
1. Evacuate the refrigerant system.
2. Connect an R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station that meets SAE standard
J2210 to the refrigerant system.
3. Refer to A/C SPECIFICATIONS or the Underhood HVAC Specification Label for the proper
amount of the refrigerant charge.
4. Measure the proper amount of refrigerant and heat it to 52° C (125° F) with the charging station.
See the operating instructions supplied by the
equipment manufacturer for proper use of this equipment.
5. Open both the suction and discharge valves, then open the charge valve to allow the heated
refrigerant to flow into the system.
6. When the transfer of refrigerant has stopped, close both the suction and discharge valves.
7. If all of the refrigerant charge did not transfer from the dispensing device, open all of the
windows in the vehicle and set the heating-A/C system
controls so that the A/C compressor is engaged and the blower motor is operating at its lowest
speed setting. Run the engine at a steady high idle ( about 1400 rpm). If the A/C compressor does
not engage, test the compressor clutch circuits and repair as required.
WARNING: Take care not to open the discharge (high pressure) valve at this time. Failure to follow
this warning may result in serious or fatal injury.
8. Open the low-side valve to allow the remaining refrigerant to transfer to the refrigerant system.
9. Disconnect the charging station from the refrigerant system service ports.
10. Reinstall the caps onto the refrigerant system service ports.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
2627
Refrigerant: Tools and Equipment
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM SERVICE EQUIPMENT
WARNING: Eye protection must be worn when servicing an A/C refrigerant system. Turn all valves
off (rotate clockwise) on the equipment being used before connecting or disconnecting service
equipment from the refrigerant system. Failure to observe these warnings may result in personal
injury or death.
WARNING: Refer to the applicable warnings and cautions for this system before performing the
following operation. Failure to follow the warnings and cautions could result in possible personal
injury or death.
When servicing the A/C system, an R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging station (1) that
meets SAE standard J2210 must be used. Contact an automotive service equipment supplier for
refrigerant recovery/recycling/charging equipment. Refer to the operating instructions supplied by
the equipment manufacturer for proper care and use of this equipment.
A manifold gauge set (1) may be needed with some recovery/recycling/charging equipment. The
manifold gauge set should have manual shut-off valves (2 and 6), or automatic back-flow valves
located at the service port connector end of the manifold gauge set hoses (4 and 5). This will
prevent refrigerant from being released into the atmosphere.
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET CONNECTIONS
CAUTION: Do not use an R-12 manifold gauge set on an R-134a system. The refrigerants are not
compatible and system damage will result.
RECOVERY/RECYCLING/EVACUATION/CHARGING HOSE- The center manifold hose (Yellow,
or White, with Black stripe) (3) is used to
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
2628
recover, evacuate, and charge the refrigerant system. When the low or high pressure valves on the
manifold gauge set are opened, the refrigerant in the system will escape through this hose.
HIGH PRESSURE GAUGE HOSE- The high pressure hose (Red with Black stripe) (4) attaches to
the high side service port. This service port is located on the A/C discharge line. On this model, an
A/C pressure transducer is installed on the high side service port. A/C high-side pressures can be
read using a scan tool.
LOW PRESSURE GAUGE HOSE- The low pressure hose (Blue with Black stripe) (5) attaches to
the low side service port. This service port is located either on the top of the A/C accumulator or on
the A/C suction line near the accumulator, depending on engine application.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The refrigerant oil used in R-134a refrigerant systems is a synthetic-based, polyalkylene glycol
(PAG), wax-free lubricant. Mineral-based R-12 refrigerant oils are not compatible with PAG oils,
and should never be introduced to an R-134a refrigerant system.
There are different PAG oils available, and each contains a different additive package. Use only
refrigerant oil of the same type as recommended to service the refrigerant system (always refer to
the specification tag included with the replacement A/C compressor or the A/C Underhood
Specification Label located in the engine compartment).
The Denso 10S17 A/C compressor used in this vehicle when equipped with the 3.7L, 4.7L or 5.7L
engine is designed to use ND-8 PAG refrigerant oil. Use only this type of refrigerant oil when
servicing the A/C compressor for these engines.
The Visteon HS-18 A/C compressor used in this vehicle when equipped with 5.9L or 6.7L diesel
engine is designed to use VC-46 PAG refrigerant oil. Use only this type of refrigerant oil when
servicing this A/C compressor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 2634
Refrigerant Oil: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
After performing any refrigerant recovery or recycling operation, always replenish the refrigerant
system with the same amount of the recommended refrigerant oil as was removed. Too little
refrigerant oil can cause A/C compressor damage, and too much can reduce A/C system
performance.
PAG refrigerant oil is more hygroscopic than mineral oil, and will absorb any moisture it comes into
contact with, even moisture in the air. The PAG oil container should always be kept tightly capped
until it is ready to be used. After use, recap the oil container immediately to prevent moisture
contamination.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 2635
Refrigerant Oil: Service and Repair
REFRIGERANT OIL LEVEL
When an A/C system is assembled at the factory, all components except the A/C compressor are
refrigerant oil free. After the refrigerant system has been charged and operated, the refrigerant oil
in the A/C compressor is dispersed throughout the refrigerant system. The accumulator, A/C
evaporator, A/C condenser and the A/C compressor will each retain a significant amount of the
needed refrigerant oil.
It is important to have the correct amount of refrigerant oil in the A/C system. This ensures proper
lubrication of the A/C compressor. Too little oil will result in damage to the A/C compressor, while
too much oil will reduce the cooling capacity of the A/C system and consequently result in higher
discharge air temperatures.
CAUTION: The refrigerant oil in the R-134a A/C system is unique depending on the A/C
compressor used. Use only PAG oils that are designed to work with R-134a refrigerant and the A/C
compressor in the vehicle. Always refer to the A/C Underhood Specification Label for the correct oil
designation. The oil container should be kept tightly capped until it is ready for use and then tightly
capped after use to prevent contamination from dirt and moisture. Refrigerant oil will quickly absorb
any moisture it comes in contact with, therefore, special effort must be used to keep all R-134a
system components moisture-free. Moisture in the refrigerant oil is very difficult to remove and will
cause a reliability problem with the A/C compressor.
NOTE: Most reclaim/recycling equipment will measure the lubricant being removed during
recovery. This amount of lubricant should be added back into the system. Refer to the
reclaim/recycling equipment manufacturers instructions.
It will not be necessary to check the oil level in the A/C compressor or to add oil, unless there has
been an oil loss. An oil loss may occur due to a rupture or leak from a refrigerant line, a connector
fitting, a component, or a component seal. If a leak occurs, add 30 milliliters (1 fluid ounce) of
refrigerant oil to the refrigerant system after the repair has been made. Refrigerant oil loss will be
evident at the leak point by the presence of a wet, shiny surface around the leak.
Refrigerant oil must be added when an A/C accumulator, A/C evaporator or A/C condenser is
replaced. See the Refrigerant Oil Capacities chart.
The refrigerant oil level in a new A/C compressor must first be adjusted prior to compressor
installation.
COMPRESSOR OIL DRAIN PROCEDURE
CAUTION: Be certain to adjust the refrigerant system oil level when replacing an A/C compressor.
Failure to properly drain and measure the refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor can prevent the
A/C system from operating as designed and cause serious compressor damage.
The A/C compressor is filled with refrigerant oil from the factory. Use the following procedure to
drain and measure refrigerant oil from the A/C compressor.
1. Drain all of the refrigerant oil from the old A/C compressor into a clean measured container.
2. Drain all of the refrigerant oil from the new A/C compressor into a clean measured container.
3. Refill the new A/C compressor with the same amount of refrigerant oil that was drained out of the
old compressor. Use only clean refrigerant oil of
the type recommended for the A/C compressor in the vehicle.
4. Install the new A/C compressor onto the engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Manual Bleeding
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual Bleeding
MANUAL BLEEDING
Use Mopar brake fluid, or an equivalent quality fluid meeting SAE J1703-F and DOT 3 standards
only. Use fresh, clean fluid from a sealed container at all times.
1. Remove reservoir filler caps and fill reservoir. 2. If calipers were overhauled, open all caliper
bleed screws. Then close each bleed screw as fluid starts to drip from it. Top off master cylinder
reservoir once more before proceeding.
3. Attach one end of bleed hose (1) to bleed screw and insert opposite end in glass container (2)
partially filled with brake fluid. Be sure end of bleed
hose is immersed in fluid.
NOTE: Bleed procedure should be in this order (1) Right rear (2) Left rear (3) Right front (4) Left
front.
4. Open up bleeder, then have a helper press down the brake pedal. Once the pedal is down close
the bleeder. Repeat bleeding until fluid stream is
clear and free of bubbles. Then move to the next wheel.
5. Before moving the vehicle verify the pedal is firm and not mushy. 6. Top off the brake fluid and
install the reservoir cap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Manual Bleeding
> Page 2640
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Pressure Bleeding
PRESSURE BLEEDING
Use Mopar brake fluid, or an equivalent quality fluid meeting SAE J1703-F and DOT 3 standards
only. Use fresh, clean fluid from a sealed container at all times.
Follow the manufacturers instructions carefully when using pressure equipment. Do not exceed the
tank manufacturers pressure recommendations. Generally, a tank pressure of 15-20 psi is
sufficient for bleeding.
Fill the bleeder tank with recommended fluid and purge air from the tank lines before bleeding.
Do not pressure bleed without a proper master cylinder adapter. The wrong adapter can lead to
leakage, or drawing air back into the system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Manual Bleeding
> Page 2641
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder
MASTER CYLINDER BLEEDING
A new master cylinder should be bled before installation on the vehicle. Required bleeding tools
include bleed tubes and a wood dowel to stroke the pistons. Bleed tubes can be fabricated from
brake line.
1. Mount master cylinder in vise. 2. Attach bleed tubes to cylinder outlet ports (1). Then position
each tube end into reservoir (2). 3. Fill reservoir with fresh brake fluid. 4. Press cylinder pistons
inward with wood dowel. Then release pistons and allow them to return under spring pressure.
Continue bleeding operations
until air bubbles are no longer visible in fluid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Manual Bleeding
> Page 2642
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair ABS Brake Bleeding
ABS BRAKE BLEEDING
ABS system bleeding requires conventional bleeding methods plus use of a scan tool. The
procedure involves performing a base brake bleeding, followed by use of the scan tool to cycle and
bleed the HCU pump and solenoids. A second base brake bleeding procedure is then required to
remove any air remaining in the system.
1. Perform base brake bleeding. 2. Connect scan tool to the Data Link Connector. 3. Select
ANTILOCK BRAKES, followed by MISCELLANEOUS, then ABS BRAKES. Follow the instructions
displayed. When scan tool displays
TEST COMPLETE, disconnect scan tool and proceed.
4. Perform base brake bleeding a second time. 5. Top off master cylinder fluid level and verify
proper brake operation before moving vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Manual Bleeding
> Page 2643
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Booster-Hydro-Boost Brake
BLEEDING
The hydraulic booster is generally self-bleeding, this procedure will normally bleed the air from the
booster. Normal driving and operation of the unit will remove any remaining trapped air.
1. Fill power steering pump reservoir. 2. Disconnect fuel shutdown relay and crank the engine for
several seconds, Refer to Fuel System for relay location and WARNING. 3. Check fluid level and
add if necessary. 4. Connect fuel shutdown relay and start the engine. 5. Turn the steering wheel
slowly from lock to lock twice. 6. Stop the engine and discharge the accumulator by depressing the
brake pedal 5 times. 7. Start the engine and turn the steering wheel slowly from lock to lock twice.
8. Turn off the engine and check fluid level and add if necessary.
NOTE: If fluid foaming occurs, wait for foam to dissipate and repeat steps 7 and 8.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Bag System - Passenger Air Bag Deactivation
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag System - Passenger Air Bag
Deactivation
NUMBER: 08-001-07 REV. B
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: May 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 08-001-07 REV. A, DATED FEBRUARY 7,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION
AND NO **ASTERISKS** HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
THIS INFORMATION IS PROVIDED FOR COUNTRIES OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES,
PLEASE FOLLOW LOCAL LAWS GOVERNING AIRBAG DEACTIVATION.
DUE TO U.S. FEDERAL LAW, IT IS ILLEGAL FOR A U.S. DEALER TO INSTALL THESE PARTS
ON U.S. VEHICLES. FOR VEHICLES WITHIN THE UNITED STATES, CONTACT NHTSA'S
AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT 1-800-424-9393 FOR GUIDELINES REGARDING AIRBAG
DEACTIVATION.
SUBJECT: Passenger Air Bag Deactivation
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (JK) Wrangler/Wrangler Unlimited
2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2006 - 2007 (LE) 0300/Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2001 - 2008 (PT/PG) Chrysler PT Cruiser/Chrysler PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2004 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2004 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2005 - 2007 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2007 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2007 (XK) Commander
2006 - 2007 (HB/HG) Durango/Aspen
2006 - 2007 (ND) Dakoka
2006 - 2007 (DR) Ram Truck
2005 - 2007 (CS) Pacifica
2007 (PM) Caliber
2007 (MK49) Compass
2007 (MK74) Patriot
2007 (JS) Sebring
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Bag System - Passenger Air Bag Deactivation > Page 2648
2007 - 2008 (JS) Avenger
2008 (JS27) Sebring Convertible
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE PASSENGER AIRBAGS IN COUNTRIES OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES.
THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR PART
WARRANTY.
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering a passenger airbag deactivation wiring package for the
selected vehicles listed above operating outside of the United States. The wiring package is a kit
containing all necessary parts and a detailed instruction sheet.
NOTE:
Due to U.S. law and the inability for U.S. dealers to legally install these parts on U.S. vehicles,
orders for the following parts will only be accepted from dealers outside of the United States.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Air Bag System - Passenger Air Bag Deactivation > Page 2649
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Fuse: Locations Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2655
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2656
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2657
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2658
Fuse: Locations Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2661
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2662
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2663
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2664
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2665
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2666
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2667
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2668
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2669
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2670
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2671
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2672
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2673
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2674
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2675
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2676
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2677
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2678
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Fuse: Application and ID Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2681
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2682
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2683
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2684
Fuse: Application and ID Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Fuse: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
All vehicles are equipped with an Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse that is disconnected within the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) when the vehicle is shipped from the factory. Dealer
personnel are to reconnect the IOD fuse in the TIPM as part of the new vehicle preparation
procedures and then disconnect it again until new vehicle delivery to the customer.
A laser printed fuse layout map is integral to the TIPM cover to ensure proper fuse identification.
The IOD fuse is a 20 ampere mini blade-type fuse. The fuse is secured within a black molded
plastic fuse holder and puller unit that serves both as a tool for disconnecting and reconnecting the
fuse in the TIPM cavity, and as a fuse holder that conveniently stores the fuse in the same cavity
after it has been disconnected.
CIRCUITS INCLUDED WITH IOD FUSE
- Cluster (CCN)
- Diagnostic Connector
- Map Lamps
- Glove Box Lamp
- Courtesy Lamps
- Radio
- Underhood Lamp
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 2687
Fuse: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The term Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) identifies a normal condition where power is being drained from
the battery with the ignition switch in the Off position. The IOD fuse feeds the memory and sleep
mode functions for some of the electronic modules in the vehicle as well as various other
accessories that require battery current when the ignition switch is in the Off position. The only
reason the IOD fuse is disconnected is to reduce the normal IOD of the vehicle electrical system
during new vehicle transportation and pre-delivery storage to reduce battery depletion, while still
allowing vehicle operation so that the vehicle can be loaded, unloaded and moved as needed by
both vehicle transportation company and dealer personnel.
The IOD fuse is disconnected from Integrated Power Module (IPM) fuse cavity # 51 when the
vehicle is shipped from the assembly plant. Dealer personnel must reconnect the IOD fuse when
the vehicle is being prepared for delivery in order to restore full electrical system operation. Once
the vehicle is prepared for delivery, the IOD function of this fuse becomes transparent and the fuse
that has been assigned the IOD designation becomes only another Fused B(+) circuit fuse.
The IOD fuse can be used by the vehicle owner as a convenient means of reducing battery
depletion when a vehicle is to be stored for periods not to exceed about thirty days. However, it
must be remembered that disconnecting the IOD fuse will not eliminate IOD, but only reduce this
normal condition. If a vehicle will be stored for more than about thirty days, the battery negative
cable should be disconnected to eliminate normal IOD; and, the battery should be tested and
recharged at regular intervals during the vehicle storage period to prevent the battery from
becoming discharged or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Fuse Block: Locations Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2692
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2693
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2694
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2695
Fuse Block: Locations Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2698
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2699
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2700
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2701
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2702
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2703
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2704
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2705
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2706
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2707
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2708
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2709
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2710
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2711
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2712
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2713
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2714
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2715
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Fuse Block: Application and ID Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2718
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2719
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2720
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2721
Fuse Block: Application and ID Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Relay Box: Locations Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2726
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2727
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations
> Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2728
Relay Box: Locations Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Relay Box: Application and ID Fuses (Integrated Power Module)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2731
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2732
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Fuses (Integrated Power Module) > Page 2733
Relay Box: Application and ID Auxiliary PDC Box (Upfitter Package)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However,
on vehicles not equipped with the optional TPM, this indicator is electronically disabled. This
indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in the instrument cluster overlay.
The TPM indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of an icon that represents a cross-section of a
tire with a centered exclamation point in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The
dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not
illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the
overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent outer layer of the overlay
when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster
electronic circuit board.
The TPM indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2739
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the status
of the TPM system. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The TPM indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provide a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the TPM indicator for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the SKREEM sends an
electronic TPM indicator lamp-ON message to the cluster to illuminate the TPM indicator for about
three seconds as a bulb test.
- TPM Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic TPM indicator
lamp-ON message from the SKREEM, the TPM indicator will be illuminated. The indicator can be
flashed ON and OFF, or illuminated solid, as dictated by the SKREEM message. The indicator
remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the SKREEM or until the
ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no TPM lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the
SKREEM for six consecutive seconds, the TPM indicator is illuminated by the instrument cluster.
The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid lamp-ON or lamp-OFF
message is received from the SKREEM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the TPM indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The SKREEM performs a self-test each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position to
decide whether the TPM system is in good operating condition and whether the tire inflation
pressures are too high or too low. The SKREEM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF
message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster turns ON
the TPM indicator after the bulb test, it indicates that the inflation pressure of a tire is too low or that
a malfunction has occurred and the TPM system is ineffective.
For proper diagnosis of the TPM system, the SKREEM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the
electronic communication related to TPM indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Procedures
This vehicle is not equipped with a Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2744
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Reset Procedure
PERFORM SERVICE INDICATOR - RESET
The "Perform Service" message will display on the Electronic Vehicle Information Center each time
you turn the ignition switch to the ON/RUN position to indicate a emission maintenance is required.
To reset the "Perform Service" indicator system (after performing the scheduled maintenance) refer
to the following procedure:
- 1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start engine).
- 2. Press and release the brake pedal two times.
- 3. Fully depress the accelerator pedal slowly two times within 10 seconds.
- 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF/LOCK position.
NOTE: If the indicator message illumination when you start the vehicle, the "Perform Service"
indicator did not reset. If necessary repeat this procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. This indicator
is located near the lower edge of the instrument cluster, between the tachometer and the
speedometer.
The MIL consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International Control and Display Symbol icon for
Engine in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay
prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting
Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in
amber through the translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the
LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The MIL is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2749
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on vehicles with a gasoline engine, or the Engine Control
Module (ECM) on vehicles with a diesel engine has recorded a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for
an On-Board Diagnostics II (OBDII) emissions-related circuit or component malfunction. The MIL is
controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming
and electronic messages received by the cluster from the PCM or ECM over the Controller Area
Network (CAN) data bus.
The MIL Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster logic circuit,
and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster receives a battery
current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be
OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED only illuminates
when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The instrument cluster will
turn ON the MIL for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the indicator is illuminated
for about two seconds as a bulb test. The entire bulb test is a function of the PCM or ECM.
- MIL Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic MIL lamp-ON message
from the PCM or ECM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator can be flashed ON and OFF,
or illuminated solid, as dictated by the PCM or ECM message. For some DTCs, if a problem does
not recur, the PCM or ECM will send a lamp-OFF message automatically. Other DTCs may require
that a fault be repaired and the PCM or ECM be reset before a lamp-OFF message will be sent.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the PCM
or ECM for about 10 seconds, the MIL is illuminated by the instrument cluster to indicate a loss of
bus communication. The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid
message is received from the PCM or ECM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the MIL indicator will be
turned ON during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the
cluster control circuitry.
The PCM or ECM continually monitors the fuel and emissions system circuits and sensors to
decide whether the system is in good operating condition. The PCM or ECM then sends the proper
lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the EMIC
turns ON the MIL after the bulb test, it may indicate that a malfunction has occurred and that the
fuel and emissions systems may require service.
For proper diagnosis of the fuel and emissions systems, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to MIL operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
OIL CHANGE INDICATOR - RESET
To reset the "Oil Change Required" indicator (after performing the scheduled maintenance) refer to
the following procedure:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Do not start engine). 2. Fully depress the accelerator
pedal slowly three times within 10 seconds. 3. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF/LOCK position.
NOTE: If the "Oil Change Required" indicator message illuminates when you start the vehicle, the
indicator did not reset. If necessary repeat this procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However,
on vehicles not equipped with the optional TPM, this indicator is electronically disabled. This
indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in the instrument cluster overlay.
The TPM indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of an icon that represents a cross-section of a
tire with a centered exclamation point in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The
dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not
illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the
overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent outer layer of the overlay
when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster
electronic circuit board.
The TPM indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2759
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the status
of the TPM system. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Sentry Key REmote Entry Module (SKREEM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The TPM indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provide a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the TPM indicator for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the SKREEM sends an
electronic TPM indicator lamp-ON message to the cluster to illuminate the TPM indicator for about
three seconds as a bulb test.
- TPM Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic TPM indicator
lamp-ON message from the SKREEM, the TPM indicator will be illuminated. The indicator can be
flashed ON and OFF, or illuminated solid, as dictated by the SKREEM message. The indicator
remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the SKREEM or until the
ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no TPM lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the
SKREEM for six consecutive seconds, the TPM indicator is illuminated by the instrument cluster.
The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid lamp-ON or lamp-OFF
message is received from the SKREEM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the TPM indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The SKREEM performs a self-test each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position to
decide whether the TPM system is in good operating condition and whether the tire inflation
pressures are too high or too low. The SKREEM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF
message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster turns ON
the TPM indicator after the bulb test, it indicates that the inflation pressure of a tire is too low or that
a malfunction has occurred and the TPM system is ineffective.
For proper diagnosis of the TPM system, the SKREEM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the
electronic communication related to TPM indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required.
Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Specifications
Tires: Specifications
TIRE REVOLUTIONS PER MILE
TIRE REVOLUTIONS PER MILE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tire
Tires: Description and Operation Tire
TIRES
Tires are designed and engineered for each specific vehicle. They provide the best overall
performance for normal operation. The ride and handling characteristics match the vehicle's
requirements. With proper care they will give excellent reliability, traction, skid resistance, and tread
life.
Driving habits have more effect on tire life than any other factor. Careful drivers will obtain in most
cases, much greater mileage than severe use or careless drivers. A few of the driving habits which
will shorten the life of any tire are:
- Rapid acceleration
- Severe brake applications
- High speed driving
- Excessive speeds on turns
- Striking curbs and other obstacles
Radial-ply tires are more prone to irregular tread wear. It is important to follow the tire rotation
interval. This will help to achieve a greater tread life.
TIRE IDENTIFICATION
Tire type, size, aspect ratio and speed rating are encoded in the letters and numbers imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. Refer to the chart to decipher the tire identification code.
Performance tires have a speed rating letter after the aspect ratio number. The speed rating is not
always printed on the tire sidewall. These ratings are:
- Q up to 100 mph
- S up to 112 mph
- T up to 118 mph
- U up to 124 mph
- H up to 130 mph
- V up to 149 mph
- W (consult the tire manufacturer for the specific speed rating)
- Z more than 149 mph (consult the tire manufacturer for the specific speed rating)
An All Season type tire will have either M + S, M & S or M-S (indicating mud and snow traction)
imprinted on the side wall.
TIRE CHAINS
Tire snow chains may be used on certain models. Refer to the Owner's Manual for more
information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tire > Page 2765
Tires: Description and Operation Spare / Temporary Tire
SPARE / TEMPORARY TIRE
The temporary spare tire is designed for emergency use only. The original tire should be repaired
or replaced at the first opportunity, then reinstalled. Do not exceed speeds of 80 KMH (50 MPH).
when using the temporary spare tire. Refer to Owner's Manual for complete details.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tire > Page 2766
Tires: Description and Operation Radial - Ply Tires
RADIAL - PLY TIRES
Radial-ply tires improve handling, tread life and ride quality, and decrease rolling resistance.
Radial-ply tires must always be used in sets of four. Under no circumstances should they be used
on the front only. They may be mixed with temporary spare tires when necessary. A maximum
speed of 80 KMH (50 MPH) is recommended while a temporary spare is in use.
Radial-ply tires have the same load-carrying capacity as other types of tires of the same size. They
also use the same recommended inflation pressures.
The use of oversized tires, either in the front or rear of the vehicle, can cause vehicle drive train
failure. This could also cause inaccurate wheel speed signals when the vehicle is equipped with
Anti-Lock Brakes.
The use of tires from different manufactures on the same vehicle is NOT recommended. The
proper tire pressure should be maintained on all four tires.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tire > Page 2767
Tires: Description and Operation Replacement Tires
REPLACEMENT TIRES
The original equipment tires provide a proper balance of many characteristics such as:
- Ride
- Noise
- Handling
- Durability
- Tread life
- Traction
- Rolling resistance
- Speed capability
It is recommended that tires equivalent to the original equipment tires be used when replacement is
needed.
Failure to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect the safety and handling of the
vehicle.
The use of oversize tires may cause interference with vehicle components. Under extremes of
suspension and steering travel, interference with vehicle components may cause tire damage.
WARNING: Failure to equip the vehicle with tires having adequate speed capability can result in
sudden tire failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Tire > Page 2768
Tires: Description and Operation Full Size, Spare Wheel With Matching Tire
FULL SIZE, SPARE WHEEL WITH MATCHING TIRE
The spare is a full usage wheel with a matching tire, It can be used within the (posted legal) speed
limits or distance limitations as of the rest of the vehicles four tires. Refer to Owner's Manual for
complete details.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pressure Gauges
Tires: Testing and Inspection Pressure Gauges
PRESSURE GAUGES
A quality air pressure gauge is recommended to check tire pressure. After checking the air
pressure, replace valve cap finger tight.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pressure Gauges > Page 2771
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tire Noise Or Vibration
TIRE NOISE OR VIBRATION
Radial-ply tires are sensitive to force impulses caused by improper mounting, vibration, wheel
defects, or possibly tire imbalance.
To find out if tires are causing the noise or vibration, drive the vehicle over a smooth road at
varying speeds. Note the noise level during acceleration and deceleration. The engine, differential
and exhaust noises will change as speed varies, while the tire noise will usually remain constant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pressure Gauges > Page 2772
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tread Wear Indicators
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Tread wear indicators (3) are molded into the bottom of the tread grooves. When tread depth is 1.6
mm (1/16 in.), the tread wear indicators (3) will appear as a 13 mm (1/2 in.) band.
Tire replacement is necessary when indicators appear in two or more grooves or if localized
balding occurs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pressure Gauges > Page 2773
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tire Wear Patterns
TIRE WEAR PATTERNS
Under inflation will cause wear on the shoulders of tire. Over inflation will cause wear at the center
of tire.
Excessive camber causes the tire to run at an angle to the road. One side of tread is then worn
more than the other.
Excessive toe-in or toe-out causes wear on the tread edges and a feathered effect across the
tread.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pressure Gauges > Page 2774
Tires: Testing and Inspection Tire/Vehicle Lead
TIRE/VEHICLE LEAD
Use the following Vehicle Lead Diagnosis And Correction Chart to diagnose and correct a vehicle
lead or drift problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Tires: Procedures
Cleaning
TIRES
Remove the protective coating on the tires before delivery of a vehicle. This coating may cause
deterioration of the tires.
To remove the protective coating, apply warm water and let it soak for a few minutes. Afterwards,
scrub the coating away with a soft bristle brush. Steam cleaning may also be used to remove the
coating.
NOTE: DO NOT use gasoline, mineral oil, oil-based solvent or a wire brush for cleaning.
Tire Inflation Pressures
TIRE INFLATION PRESSURES
WARNING: Over or under inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and tread wear. This may cause
the tire to fail suddenly, resulting in loss of vehicle control.
Under inflation will cause rapid shoulder wear (1), tire flexing, and possible tire failure.
Over inflation will cause rapid center wear (1) reduction in the tire's ability to cushion shocks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2777
Improper inflation can cause:
- Uneven wear patterns
- Reduced tread life
- Reduced fuel economy
- Unsatisfactory ride
- Vehicle drift
For proper tire pressure specification refer to the vehicles Owners Manual.
Tire Pressure For High Speed Operation
TIRE PRESSURE FOR HIGH SPEEDS
For proper tire pressure specification refer to the Owners Manual.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 2778
Tires: Removal and Replacement
TIRE REPAIR AREA
For proper repairing, a radial tire must be removed from the wheel. Repairs should only be made if
the defect, or puncture, is in the tread area (1). The tire should be replaced if the puncture is
located in the sidewall.
Deflate tire completely before removing the tire from the wheel. Use lubrication such as a mild soap
solution when dismounting or mounting tire. Use tools free of burrs or sharp edges which could
damage the tire or wheel rim.
Before mounting tire on wheel, make sure all rust is removed from the rim bead and repaint if
necessary.
Install wheel on vehicle, and tighten to proper torque specification.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information
NUMBER: 22-002-09
GROUP: Wheels/Tires
DATE: July 29, 2009
SUBJECT: Chrome Clad Wheel Adapters For Proper Balancing
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper wheel adapters when mounting Chrome
Clad wheels to wheel balancing equipment.
MODELS:
2004-2008 (CS) Pacifica
2007 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2004 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007-2009 (HG) Aspen
2009-2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2008 - 2010 (JS27) Sebring Convertible
2007 - 2010 (JS41) Sebring/Avenger
2007-2010 (KA) Nitro
2002-2007 (KJ) Liberty
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Cherokee (International Markets)
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005-2010 (ND) Dakota
2007 - 2001 (PM) Caliber
2001 - 2009 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Chrome Clad Wheel Balancing Information > Page 2783
2008 - 2010 (RI) Town & Country/Grand Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005-2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
NOTE:
This information applies to any model equipped with Chrome Clad Wheels.
DISCUSSION:
Models equipped with Chrome Clad wheels require specific piloting on balance equipment to
properly center the wheel and prevent damage to the chrome clad surface. The chrome cladding is
not removable or replaceable and has cladding tabs that extend into the wheel bore. Traditional
high-taper cones will come into contact with the cladding tabs rather than properly seat on the hub
bore chamfer. Many modern aluminum wheel designs cannot be mounted with traditional cones.
Direct-Fit Collets should be used to properly mount clad wheels on balance equipment (Fig 1).
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
This kit includes the adapters for all Dodge, Chrysler & Jeep models with clad wheels. Individual
adapters for specific wheel sizes can be ordered separately. To order a kit or individual adapters,
contact Pentastar Service Equipment @ 1-800-223-5623.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Wheels
Wheels: Description and Operation Description - Wheels
WHEELS
Original equipment wheels are designed for the specified Maximum Vehicle Capacity.
All models use steel or aluminum drop center wheels.
Aluminum wheels require special balance weights and alignment equipment.
1. On vehicles equipped with dual rear wheels, the rim is an eight stud hole pattern wheel. The
wheels have a flat mounting surface (1).
2. The slots (1) in the wheel must be aligned to provide access to the valve stem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description - Wheels > Page 2786
Wheels: Description and Operation Description - Wheel Design
WHEEL DESIGN
The rim size is on the vehicle safety certification label located on the drivers door shut face.
Original equipment wheels/rims are designed for operation up to the specified maximum vehicle
capacity.
All models use stamped steel, cast aluminum or forged aluminum wheels. Every wheel has raised
sections between the rim flanges (1) and rim drop well (3) called safety humps.
Initial inflation of the tire forces the bead over these raised sections. In case of rapid loss of air
pressure, the raised sections help hold the tire on the wheel.
The wheel studs and nuts are designed for specific applications. All aluminum and some steel
wheels have wheel stud nuts with an enlarged nose. This enlarged nose is necessary to ensure
proper retention of the wheels. Do not use replacement studs or nuts with a different design or
lesser quality.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2787
Wheels: Testing and Inspection
WHEEL INSPECTION
Inspect wheels for:
- Excessive runout
- Dents, cracks or irregular bends
- Damaged wheel stud (lug) holes
- Air Leaks
NOTE: Do not attempt to repair a wheel by hammering, heating or welding.
If a wheel is damaged, an original equipment replacement wheel should be used. When obtaining
replacement wheels, they must be equivalent in load carrying capacity. The diameter, width, offset,
pilot hole and bolt circle of the wheel should be the same as the original wheel.
WARNING: Failure to use equivalent replacement wheels may adversely affect the safety and
handling of the vehicle.
WARNING: Replacement with used wheels is not recommended. The service history of the wheel
may have included severe treatment or very high mileage. The rim could fail without warning.
WARNING: DaimlerChrysler Corporation does not recommend that customers use "reconditioned"
wheels (wheels that have been damaged and repaired) because they can result in a sudden
catastrophic wheel failure which could cause loss of control and result in injury or death. For
clarification:
- Cosmetic refinishing for the purpose of repairing a superficial flaw is an acceptable procedure
providing it is limited to paint or clear coat only, the wheel is not modified in any way, and there is
no exposure to paint curing heat over 200 degrees Fahrenheit.
- Damaged wheels are those which have been bent, broken, cracked or sustained some other
physical damage which may have compromised the wheel structure.
- Repaired indicates that the wheel has been modified through bending, welding, heating,
straightening, or material removal to rectify damage.
- Re-plating of chrome plated wheels is not an acceptable procedure nor is chrome plating of
original equipment painted or polished wheels, as this may alter mechanical properties and affect
fatigue life.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front - Independent Front Suspension
Removal
4X4
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 3. Remove the brake
caliper and rotor. 4. Remove the ABS wheel speed sensor if equipped. 5. Remove the halfshaft
nut.
NOTE: Do not strike the knuckle with a hammer to remove the tie rod end or the ball joint. Damage
to the steering knuckle will occur.
6. Remove the tie rod end nut and separate the tie rod from the knuckle using remover 9360. 7.
Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the knuckle using remover
9360.
8. Pull down on the steering knuckle to separate the halfshaft (2) from the hub/bearing. 9. Remove
the three hub/bearing mounting bolts (1) from the steering knuckle.
10. Slide the hub/bearing out of the steering knuckle. 11. Remove the brake dust shield.
Installation
4X4
1. Install the brake dust shield (2). 2. Install the hub/bearing (1) into the steering knuckle (3) and
tighten the bolts to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor and caliper. 4. Install the ABS
wheel speed sensor if equipped. 5. Install the upper ball joint nut to the steering knuckle and
tighten to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (on 1500 series only an additional 90° turn). 6. Install the tie rod end
nut to the steering knuckle and tighten to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) then an additional 90°. 7. Install the
halfshaft nut and tighten to 251 Nm (185 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 2792
9. Remove the support and lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 2793
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front - Link/Coil
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the hub extension (1) mounting nuts and remove the extension from the rotor if
equipped.
4. Remove the brake caliper. 5. Remove the cotter pin (2) and the hub nut (1) from the axle shaft.
6. Remove the caliper adapter. 7. Remove the disc brake rotor. 8. Disconnect the wheel speed
sensor wire. 9. Remove the hub/bearing 4 mounting bolts and remove the hub/bearing.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 2794
1. Position the brake shield (1) on bolts. 2. Install the hub/bearing to the knuckle. Tighten the
hub/bearing bolts (2) to 202 Nm (149 ft. lbs.) 3. Install the hub nut and tighten to 356 Nm (263 ft.
lbs.). 4. Install the wheel speed sensor to the hub. 5. Install the disc brake rotor. 6. Install the brake
caliper adapter with the caliper. 7. Install the hub extension and nuts to the front rotor. Tighten nuts
to 130 Nm (96 ft.lbs). HD DRW ONLY. 8. Install the wheel and tire assemblies. 9. Remove the
support and lower the vehicle.
10. Apply the brakes several times to seat the brake shoes and caliper piston. Do not move the
vehicle until a firm brake pedal is obtained.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The hub caps must be removed before raising the vehicle off the ground.
NOTE: You must use the flat end of the hub/cap remover/installer combination tool to pry off the
wheel skins. Insert the flat tip completely and using a back and forth motion, loosen the wheel skin.
repeat this procedure around the tire until the wheel skin pops off.
1. On 2500/3500 single rear wheel (SRW) models, insert a hub/cap remover/installer combination
tool using the blade on the end of the tool to pry
the cap off in a back and forth motion.
2. On 3500 models with dual rear wheels (DRW), you must first remove the hub caps. The hub/cap
remover/installer combination tool must be
inserted in the pry off notch of the rear hub caps.
3. Position the hub/cap remover/installer combination tool and pull out on the tool firmly. The cap
should come off.
NOTE: Failure to use a back and forth motion could damage the wheel skin chrome finish.
4. The wheel skins can now be removed from the wheel. Use the flat end of the lug nut wrench to
pry off the wheel skins. Make sure that the flat end
is inserted and use a back and forth motion to remove the wheel skin.
5. On 3500 models front hub caps use the hub/cap remover/installer combination tool to pry off the
cap in a back and forth motion. The wheel skins
can now be removed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Cover > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 2799
Wheel Cover: Service and Repair Installation
Front
FRONT
1. Align the valve stem with the notch in the wheel skin. 2. Seat on side of the wheel skin's wire
retainer on to the wheel. 3. Using a rubber mallet, strike the opposite side of the wheel skin until the
skin is properly seated.
NOTE: The wheel skin and the hub cap are fully seated when there is a consistant gap between
the skin/ cap and the wheel.
4. Tug on the hub cap/wheel skin to ensure that they are properly installed.
Rear
REAR
1. Install one 1 1/2 in. valve stem extension on each rear inner wheel.
NOTE: A 3/8 in. drive 10mm deep wheel socket with a 10 in. or greater extension can be used to
remove the existing valve stem cap and install the extension.
2. Install one 1 in. valve stem extension on each outer wheel. 3. Align the cooling windows of the
wheel skin with the cooling windows of the wheel. Seat one side of the wheel skin's retainer onto
the wheel.
Using a rubber mallet, strike thew wheel skin on the outer circumference. Strike at several locations
around the circumference until the skin is fully seated.
NOTE: The wheel skin and the hub cap are fully seated when there is a consistent gap between
the skin/cap and the wheel.
4. Tug on the hub/cap wheel skin to ensure that they are properly installed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Hub Nut Tighten to ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................... 356 Nm (263 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
TORQUE
Torque Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 3. Remove the brake
caliper, caliper adapter and rotor. 4. Remove the wheel speed sensor from the hub. 5. Press the
stud from the hub using remover C-4150A (1).
6. Remove the stud (2) from the hub (1) through the backing plate access hole (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 2809
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the new stud (2) into the hub flange (1). 2. Install three proper sized washers onto the
stud, then install lug nut with the flat side of the nut against the washers. 3. Tighten the lug nut until
the stud is pulled into the hub flange. Verify that the stud is properly seated into the flange. 4.
Remove the lug nut and washers. 5. Install the brake rotor, caliper adapter, and caliper. 6. Install
the wheel speed sensor. 7. Install the wheel and tire assembly, use new lug nut on the stud or
studs that were replaced. 8. Remove the support and lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure (Minimum) ......................................................................................................
...................................................................... 350 psi.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 2815
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION/LEAKAGE TESTS
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure batteries are completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise, the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnostic
purposes.
1. Disconnect the fuel inlet line to the fuel filter housing. Plug the fuel line from the fuel tank.
NOTE: Failure to plug fuel line will result in fuel leak.
2. Remove fuel transfer pump relay from PDC. 3. Start the engine and idle until the engine stalls
(runs out of fuel). 4. Remove the cylinder head cover. 5. Remove the cylinder head cover carrier
gasket. 6. Remove the high pressure fuel line between the cylinder head and fuel rail for the
cylinder to be tested. Use tool 9864 to cap this fuel rail on the
cylinder being tested.
7. Remove the fuel connector tube nut and fuel connector tube. 8. Remove the exhaust rocker
lever. 9. Use Tool 9010 to remove the injector and copper sealing washer.
10. Install the exhaust rocker lever and torque to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 11. Cover the remaining rocker
levers with clean shop towels to prevent any oil splatter under the hood. 12. Place a rag over the
compression test tool fitting. Crank the engine for 2-3 seconds to purge any fuel that may have
drained into the cylinder when
the injector was removed.
13. Connect the compression test gauge. 14. Crank the engine for 5 seconds and record the
pressure reading. Repeat this step three times and calculate the average of the three readings.
NOTE: The minimum cylinder pressure is 350 psi. Cylinder pressure should be within 20% from
cylinder to cylinder.
15. Combustion pressure leakage can be checked if cylinder pressure is below the specification.
Perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder
according to the tester manufacturer instructions.
16. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related fault codes.
CYLINDER COMBUSTION PRESSURE LEAKAGE
The combustion pressure leakage test provides an accurate means for determining engine
condition.
Combustion pressure leakage testing will detect:
- Exhaust and intake valve leaks (improper seating).
- Leaks between adjacent cylinders or into water jacket.
- Any causes for combustion/compression pressure loss
1. Start and operate the engine until it attains normal operating temperature. 2. Disconnect injector
harness connectors. 3. Disconnect CCV tube and breather drain tube from valve cover. 4. Remove
the cylinder head cover. 5. Disconnect harness from injectors. 6. Remove the cylinder head cover
carrier gasket. 7. Bring the cylinder to be tested to TDC. 8. Remove the high pressure fuel line
between the cylinder head and the fuel rail for the cylinder to be tested. 9. Install capping Tool 9864
onto the rail.
10. Remove the high pressure connector nut and high pressure connector with Tool 9015. 11.
Remove the exhaust and intake rocker lever. 12. Use Tool # 9010 to remove the injector and
copper sealing washer. 13. Install compression test Tool # 9007 into the injector bore. 14. Connect
the leakage tester and perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder according to the tester
manufacturer's instructions. 15. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related
fault codes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Camshaft: Procedures
INSPECTION
Camshaft
Camshaft Dimensions
1. Inspect the valve lobes (1) and bearing journals (2) for cracks, pitting, scoring, or generally
excessive wear. Replace any camshaft that exceeds the
allowable limits.
2. Measure the bearing journals and lobes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2821
CAUTION: If Camshaft lobes are worn, requiring camshaft replacement, it is necessary to replace
the tappets also.
Camshaft Bushing/Bores
Camshaft bores No. 2-6 do not use a bushing.
1. Inspect the camshaft bushing and bores for signs of excessive wear. 2. Measure the camshaft
bushing and bores with a telescoping bore gauge and micrometer.
3. Inspect the camshaft bushing (1) oil holes for alignment with cylinder block.
Camshaft Gear
Inspect the camshaft gear for cracks (gear and hub), and chipped/broken/fretted teeth. If
replacement is necessary, camshaft and gear are replaced as an assembly.
Thrust Plate
Camshaft Thrust Plate Thickness Chart
Inspect the camshaft thrust plate for excessive wear in the camshaft contact area. Measure thrust
plate thickness using the CAMSHAFT THRUST PLATE THICKNESS CHART. Replace any thrust
plate that falls outside of these specifications:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2822
Camshaft: Removal and Replacement
Camshaft - Removal
CAMSHAFT
1. Disconnect both battery negative cables. 2. Recover A/C refrigerant (if A/C equipped). 3. Raise
vehicle on hoist. 4. Drain engine coolant into container suitable for re-use. 5. Lower vehicle. 6.
Remove radiator upper hose. 7. Remove viscous fan/drive/shroud assembly. 8. Disconnect the
coolant recovery bottle hose from the radiator filler neck. 9. Disconnect lower radiator hose from
radiator outlet.
10. Automatic Transmission models: Disconnect transmission oil cooler lines from front of radiator
using Special Tool 6931 (unless equipped with
finger-release disconnect).
11. Remove radiator mounting screws and lift radiator out of engine compartment. 12. Remove
upper radiator support panel. 13. If A/C equipped, disconnect A/C condenser refrigerant lines. 14.
Disconnect charge air cooler piping from the cooler inlet and outlet. 15. Remove the two charge air
cooler mounting bolts. 16. Remove charge air cooler (and A/C condenser if equipped) from vehicle.
17. Remove accessory drive belt. 18. Remove accessory drive belt tensioner. 19. Remove the fan
support/hub assembly. 20. Remove crankshaft damper. 21. Remove the gear cover-to-housing
bolts and gently pry the cover away from the housing, taking care not to mar the sealing surfaces.
Remove dust
seal with cover.
22. Using Special Tool 7471-B Crankshaft Barring Tool, rotate the crankshaft to align the timing
marks on the crankshaft and the camshaft gears. 23. Remove the cylinder head cover.
24. Remove the rocker arms, cross heads, and push rods. Mark each component so they can be
installed in their original positions.
NOTE: The #5 cylinder intake and the #6 cylinder intake and exhaust pushrods are removed by
lifting them up and through the provided cowl panel access holes. Remove the rubber plugs to
expose these relief holes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2823
25. Raise the tappets as follows, using the wooden dowel rods provided with the Miller Tool Kit
8502.
a. Insert the slotted end of the dowel rod into the tappet. The dowel rods for the rear two cylinders
will have to be cut for cowl panel
clearance. Press firmly to ensure that it is seated in the tappet.
b. Raise the dowel rod to bring the tappet to the top of its travel, and wrap a rubber band around
the dowel rods to prevent the tappets from
dropping into the crankcase.
c. Repeat this procedure for the remaining cylinders.
26. Verify that the camshaft timing marks are aligned with the crankshaft mark. 27. Remove the
bolts from the thrust plate. 28. Remove engine mount through bolts. 29. Install engine support
fixture special tool #8534, and steel bracket/wing nut special tool #8534A. 30. Raise engine enough
to allow camshaft removal. 31. Remove the camshaft, gear and thrust plate.
Camshaft - Installation
CAMSHAFT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2824
1. Lubricate the camshaft bushing and bores with fresh engine oil or suitable equivalent. 2.
Liberally coat the camshaft lobes, journals, and thrust washer with fresh engine oil or suitable
equivalent.
CAUTION: When installing the camshaft, DO NOT push it in farther than it will go with the thrust
washer in place.
3. Install the camshaft and thrust plate. Align the timing marks as shown.
4. Install the thrust plate bolts and tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Measure camshaft back
lash and end clearance. 6. Remove the wooden dowel rods and rubber bands from the tappets. 7.
Lubricate the push rods with engine oil and install in their original location. Verify that they are
seated in the tappets. 8. Lubricate the valve tips with engine oil and install the crossheads in their
original locations. 9. Lubricate the crossheads and push rod sockets with engine oil and install the
rocker arms and pedestals in their original locations. Tighten bolts to
36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.) torque.
10. Verify valve lash adjustment. 11. Install the cylinder head cover. 12. Install gear housing cover.
Install front crankshaft dust seal. 13. Install the crankshaft damper. 14. Install the fan support/hub
assembly. 15. Install the power steering pump. 16. Install accessory drive belt tensioner. Torque
bolt to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.). 17. Install the accessory drive belt. 18. Install the charge air cooler (with
a/c condenser and auxiliary transmission oil cooler, if equipped) and tighten the mounting bolts to 2
Nm (17 in.
lbs.) torque.
19. Connect charge air cooler inlet and outlet pipes. Tighten clamps to 11 Nm (95 in. lbs.) torque.
20. Install the radiator upper support panel. 21. Close radiator petcock and lower the radiator into
the engine compartment. Tighten the mounting bolts to 11 Nm (95 in. lbs.) torque. 22. Raise
vehicle on hoist. 23. Connect radiator lower hose and install clamp. 24. Connect transmission
auxiliary oil cooler lines (if equipped). 25. Lower vehicle. 26. Install the fandrive/shroud assembly.
27. Install the coolant recovery and windshield washer fluid reservoirs to the fan shroud. 28.
Connect the coolant recovery hose to the radiator filler neck. 29. Add engine coolant. 30. Charge
A/C system with refrigerant (if A/C equipped). 31. Connect the battery negative cables. 32. Start
engine and check for engine oil and coolant leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2825
Camshaft Bearings - Removal
CAMSHAFT BEARINGS
NOTE: Measure the diameter of each bore. If the camshaft bore for the cam bushing is worn
beyond the limit, install a new service bushing. Inspect the rest of the camshaft bores for damage
or excessive wear.If the bores without a bushing are worn beyond the limit, the engine must be
removed for machining and installation of service bushings. If badly worn, replace the cylinder
block.
1. Remove the camshaft. 2. Remove the bushing from the No.1 bore. 3. Mark the cylinder block so
you can align the oil hole in the cylinder block with the oil hole in the bushing.
Camshaft Bearings - Installation
CAMSHAFT BEARINGS
1. Apply a coating of Loctite(R) 640 Adhesive to the backside of the new bushing. Avoid getting
adhesive in the oil hole. 2. Use a universal cam bushing installation tool and install the front
bushing (1) so that it is even with the front face of the cylinder block. The oil
hole must be aligned. A 3.2 mm (0.128 inch) diameter rod must be able to pass through the hole.
3. Measure the installed bushings at the front bore. The minimum inside diameter is 54.083 mm
(2.1293 inch), and the maximum inside diameter is
is 54.147 mm. (2.1318 in.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean tappet with a suitable solvent. Rinse in hot water and blow dry with a clean shop rag or
compressed air.
Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Visually inspect the tappet the tappet socket, stem, and face for excessive wear, cracks, or
obvious damage. 2. Measure the tappet stem diameter. Replace the tappet if it falls below the
minimum size.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2830
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: This procedure requires use of Miller Tool 8502 Tappet Replacement Kit.
1. Remove camshaft. 2. Insert the trough (1) (provided with tool kit) the full length of the camshaft
bore. Make sure the cap end goes in first and the open side faces up
(towards tappets).
3. Remove only one tappet at a time. Remove rubber band from one cylinder pair and attach tappet
dowel not being removed to the next cylinder
pair.
4. Raise dowel rod (disengage from tappet) and allow tappet to fall into trough. 5. Carefully remove
trough (do not rotate) and tappet. If the tappet is not being replaced, mark it so it can be installed in
its original location.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2831
6. Re-install trough (1) and repeat procedure on remaining tappets.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the trough (1) the full length of the camshaft bore. Again, make sure the cap end goes in
first and the open side faces up (towards tappets).
2. Lower the tappet installation tool through the push rod hole and into the trough.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2832
3. Retrieve the tappet installation tool using the hooked rod provided with the tool kit.
4. Lubricate the tappet with clean engine oil or suitable equivalent and install the tappet to the
installation tool. 5. Pull the tappet up and into position. If difficulty is experienced getting the tappet
to make the turn into the tappet bore, wiggle the trough while
gently pulling up on the tappet.
6. With the tappet in place, rotate the trough one half turn so the open side is down (toward
crankshaft). 7. Remove the tappet installation tool from the tappet. 8. Re-install a dowel rod and
secure the rod with a rubber band.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2833
9. Rotate the trough one half turn and repeat the procedure for the remaining tappets.
10. Install the camshaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Description and Operation
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The unique intake and exhaust rocker arms have their own rocker shafts and are lubricated by
passages intersecting the cylinder block main oil rifle. Crossheads are used, which allow each
rocker arm to operate two valves.
The solid push rods are hardened at the rocker arm and tappet contact areas for superior strength
and durability.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean all components in a suitable solvent. If necessary, use a wire brush or wheel to remove
stubborn deposits. Rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed air. Inspect oil passages in
rocker arms and pedestals. Apply compressed air to lubrication orifices to purge contaminants.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Rocker Arms
1. Remove rocker shaft and inspect for cracks and excessive wear in the bore or shaft. Remove
socket and inspect ball insert and socket for signs of
wear. Replace retainer if necessary.
Measure the rocker arm bore and shaft.
Push Rods
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2839
Inspect the push rod ball and socket for signs of scoring. Check for cracks where the ball and the
socket are pressed into the tube.
Roll the push rod on a flat work surface with the socket end hanging off the edge. Replace any
push rod that appears to be bent.
Crossheads
Inspect the crossheads for cracks and/or excessive wear on rocker lever and valve tip mating
surfaces.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2840
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Remove the rocker
arm/pedestal fasteners and remove rocker arm (1) and pedestal (2) from cylinder head. Mark the
arms and pedestals so they
can be installed in their original position.
CAUTION: When removing the rocker arms, the sockets may come loose and fall into the engine.
Make sure they stay with the arm upon removal/installation.
4. Lift the push rod(s) up and out of the engine. Mark them so they can be installed in their original
position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2841
NOTE: The #5 cylinder intake and exhaust, and #6 cylinder intake and exhaust push rods must be
raised through the provided cowl panel access holes.
5. Lift the crossheads off of the valve stems. Mark them so they can be installed in their original
position.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If previously removed, install the push rods in their original location. Verify that they are seated in
the tappets. 2. Lubricate the valve tips and install the crossheads in their original locations. 3.
Lubricate the crossheads and push rod sockets and install the rocker arms and pedestals in their
original locations. Tighten bolts to 36 Nm (27 ft.
lbs.) torque.
4. Verify valve lash adjustment. 5. Install cylinder head cover. 6. Connect battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting Rods
Connecting Rods
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2846
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
CONNECTING ROD BEARING AND CRANKSHAFT JOURNAL CLEARANCE
1. Measure the connecting rod bore with bearings removed and the bolts tightened to 100 Nm (73
ft. lbs.) torque.. 2. Measure the connecting rod bore with the bearings installed and the bolts
tightened to 100 Nm (73 ft. lbs.) torque.
Measure within 20° arc from each side of the parting line. Also measure 90° from parting line.
Record the smallest and largest diameter.
Measure the diameter of the rod journal at the location shown. Calculate the average diameter for
each side of the journal.
Determine minimum bearing clearance by calculating the differance between the smallest
connecting rod bore diameter with the bearing installed and the average diameter for each side of
the crankshaft journal.
Determine the maximum bearing clearance by calculating the difference between the largest
connecting rod bore diameter and the average diameter with the bearing installed for each side of
the crankshaft journal.
If the crankshaft is within limits, replace the bearing. If the crankshaft is out of limits, grind the
crankshaft to the next smaller size and use oversize rod bearings.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting Rods
Connecting Rods
Connecting Rod-Bolts
Step 1 ..................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Step 2 ...................................................................
................................................................................................................................ 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.)
Step 3 ..................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. Rotate 60 degrees
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2850
Connecting Rod: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
PISTONS
The piston is constructed of aluminum and is gravity cast, free floating design. The piston
incorporates a centrally located high swirl combustion bowl, and utilizes a "keystone" style top
compression ring, and a "Tapered Face" intermediate ring, for superior cylinder wall scraping.
Piston cooling nozzles cool the piston and pin with engine oil supplied by the crankshaft main
journals. All pistons are gallery cooled and utilize J-jet piston cooling nozzles. Pistons are
directional in order to provide clearance to piston cooling nozzles.
CONNECTING RODS
The connecting rods are a split angle design. They have a pressed-in-place wrist pin bushing that
is lubricated by piston cooling nozzle oil spray.
Machined connecting rods are no longer used in the diesel engine. Do not install machined
connecting rods into an engine that has fractured split connecting rods.
Fractured split connecting rods are first manufactured as a single piece and then fractured into two
pieces. Fractured split connecting rods can be identified by a rough and irregular surface at the
connecting rod split face. To properly assemble the rod cap to the connecting rod, the bearing
tangs on the connecting rod and cap must be located on the same side of the rod. The long end of
the connecting rod must be assembled on the intake or camshaft side of the engine.
Each matched fractured split connecting rod and cap is an assembly and are not interchangeable.
If a connecting rod or cap is damaged, the entire assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Connecting Rod: Procedures
Piston and Connecting Rod - Cleaning
CLEANING
CAUTION: DO NOT use bead blast to clean the pistons. DO NOT clean the pistons and rods in an
acid tank.
PISTON
Clean the pistons and pins in a suitable solvent, rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed
air. Soaking the pistons over night will loosen most of the carbon build up. De-carbon the ring
grooves with a broken piston ring and again clean the pistons in solvent. Rinse in hot water and
blow dry with compressed air.
CONNECTING ROD
Clean the connecting rods in a suitable solvent, rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed
air.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Inspection
CONNECTING ROD
Inspect the connecting rod for damage and wear. The I-Beam section of the connecting rod cannot
have dents or other damage. Damage to this part can cause stress risers which will progress to
breakage.
Measure the connecting rod pin bore (1). The maximum diameter is 40.042 mm (1.5765 inch),
minimum diameter is 40.019 mm (1.5756 inch). If out of limits, replace the connecting rod.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2853
Connecting Rod: Removal and Replacement
Piston and Connecting Rod - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery cables. 2. Remove the cylinder head. 3. Remove the oil pan and suction
tube. 4. Remove bolts and the block stiffener. 5. Using Miller Tool 7471-B crankshaft barring tool,
rotate the crankshaft so all of the pistons are below TDC. 6. Before removing the piston(s) from the
bore(s):
a. Remove any carbon ridge formations or deposits at the top of the bore with a dull scraper or soft
wire brush. b. If cylinder bore wear ridges are found, use a ridge reamer to cut the ridge from the
bore. DO NOT remove more metal than necessary to
remove the ridge.
7. Remove the J-jet cooling nozzles.
NOTE: If cylinders have ridges, the cylinders are oversize and will more than likely need boring.
8. Using a hammer and steel stamp, stamp the cylinder number in the top of each piston. The front
of the piston is identified by a stamping on the top
of the piston. DO NOT stamp in the outside 5 mm (.197 in.) of the piston diameter. DO NOT stamp
over the piston pin.
9. Mark the connecting rod and cap with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
10. Remove the connecting rod bolts and rod caps. Use care so the cylinder bores and connecting
rods are not damaged. 11. Use a hammer handle or similar object to push the piston and
connecting rod through the cylinder bore. 12. Store the piston/rod assemblies in a rack.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the cylinder bores with clean engine oil. 2. Generously lubricate the rings and piston
skirts with clean engine oil. 3. Orientate the rings on the piston. 4. Compress the rings using a
piston ring compressor tool (1). If using a strap-type ring compressor, make sure the inside end of
the strap does not
hook on a ring gap and break the ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2854
5. Bar the crankshaft so the rod journal for the piston to be installed is at BDC (Bottom Dead
Center). 6. Make sure the front of the piston is oriented properly according to the marking on the
top of the piston and the connecting rod is oriented properly. 7. Position the piston and rod
assembly into the cylinder bore with the front of the piston oriented properly according to the
stamping in the top of the
piston. Use care when you install the piston and connecting rod so the cylinder bore is not
damaged. The long side of the connecting rod must be installed on the exhaust side of the engine.
8. Push the piston into the bore until the top of the piston is approximately 50 mm (2 inch) below
the top of the block. Carefully pull the connecting
rod onto the crankshaft journal.
9. Use clean engine oil to lubricate the threads and under the heads of the connecting rod bolts.
10. For fractured/split type connecting rods, the long end of the rod must be installed away from the
intake side of the engine.
a. The connecting rod split/face must face toward the same side as the piston notch feature on the
skirt. The split face will face toward the exhaust
side of the engine if properly installed.
11. Install the rod cap and bolts to the connecting rod. Tighten the connecting rod bolts evenly in 3
steps.
- Tighten the bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten the bolts to 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) torque.
- Rotate 60° clockwise.
12. The crankshaft must rotate freely. Check for freedom of rotation as the caps are installed. If the
crankshaft does not rotate freely, check the
installation of the rod bearing and the bearing size.
13. Measure the side clearance between the connecting rod and the crankshaft. DO NOT measure
the clearance between the cap and crankshaft. 14. Install J-jet piston cooling nozzles. 15. Install
block stiffener. Torque to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.). 16. Install the suction tube and oil pan. 17. Install the
cylinder head onto the engine. 18. Install a new filter and fill the crankcase with new engine oil.
Prefill the filter with clean oil. 19. Connect the battery negative cables and start engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Crankshaft Main Cap-Bolts (Previously Used)
Step 1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) Step 2 ..................................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 80 Nm (59 ft.
lbs.) Step 3 ..........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... Rotate 90°
Crankshaft Main Cap-Bolts (New Main Bearing Capscrews)
Step 1 ..................................................................................................................................................
............................................... 120 Nm (89 ft. lbs.) Step 2 ...................................................................
.............................................................................................................................. Loosen Completely
Step 3 ..................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) Step 4 ...................................................................
................................................................................................................................. 85 Nm (63 ft.
lbs.) Step 5 ..........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Rotate 120 degrees
Calculate the main bearing journal to bearing clearance. Maximum clearance is 0.119 mm
(0.00475 inch)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2858
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
MAIN BEARING CLEARANCE
Main Bearing Bore Diameter Chart
Inspect the main bearing bores for damage or abnormal wear.
1. Remove bearings and measure main bearing bore diameter after torquing main bearing cap
bolts to 176 Nm (130 ft. lbs.). 2. Install the crankshaft main bearings and measure main bearing
bore diameter with the main bolts tightened to 176 Nm (130 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 2859
Crankshaft Main Journal Diameter Chart
3. Measure the diameter of the main journal at the locations shown. Calculate the average
diameter for each side of the journal. 4. Calculate the main bearing journal to bearing clearance.
Maximum clearance is 0.119 mm (0.00475 inch). If the crankshaft journal is within
limits, replace the main bearings. If not within specifications, grind the crankshaft to next size and
use oversize bearings.
5. Measure thrust distance at the No.6 position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal
Crankshaft Seal Retainer: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Remove the oil pan drain
plug and drain the engine oil. Re-install plug and torque to 50 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Remove
transmission and transfer case (if equipped) from vehicle. 5. Remove flywheel or torque converter
drive plate. 6. Remove flywheel adapter plate. 7. Disconnect starter cables from starter motor. 8.
Remove starter motor and transmission adapter plate assembly. 9. Remove four 4 oil pan rear
bolts. Slide a feeler gauge between the seal retainer and oil pan gasket to break the seal.
10. Remove the six 6 retainer-to-block bolts (3). 11. Remove the rear seal retainer, and gasket (2).
12. Support the seal retainer and drive out the crankshaft seal with a hammer and suitable punch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal > Page 2864
Crankshaft Seal Retainer: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If using the old seal retainer, the crankshaft seal must be replaced. 2. Inspect oil pan gasket for
nicks or cuts. If gasket is damaged, the oil pan must be removed and gasket must be replaced.
Wipe oil pan gasket dry
and apply light coating of RTV.
3. Using the retainer alignment/seal installation tool provided in the seal service kit, install the
alignment tool into the retainer and install to the
cylinder block, using a new gasket. Tighten the six (6) mounting bolts by hand.
4. The seal alignment tool is used to align rear cover properly. Starting with the center two bolts,
tighten the retainer in a circular pattern to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). Remove the alignment tool.
CAUTION: The seal lip and the sealing surface on the crankshaft must be free from all oil residue
to prevent seal leaks. The crankshaft and seal surfaces must be completely dry when the seal is
installed. Use a soap and water solution on outside diameter of seal to ease assembly.
5. Make sure the provided seal pilot (1) is installed into the new crankshaft seal (3). Use the
alignment/installation tool and press the seal onto the
crankshaft. Alternately drive the seal at the 12, 3, 6 and 9 o'clock positions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Seal Retainer
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal Retainer - Removal > Page 2865
6. Remove the alignment tool and trim the retainer gasket (1) even with the oil pan mounting
surface. 7. Remove the seal pilot. 8. Apply a small amount of Mopar(R) Silicone Rubber Adhesive
Sealant to the oil pan rail T-joints. 9. Install the four (4) oil pan rear mounting bolts and torque to 28
Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
10. Install new rectangular ring seal for cam bore. 11. Install the flywheel housing and bolts. Torque
bolts to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.). 12. Install the flywheel housing and bolts. Torque bolts to 77 Nm (57 ft.
lbs.).
NOTE: A new clamping ring must be used on early or late builds, automatic or manual. Do not
reuse clamping ring.
13. Install the dual mass flywheel with crankshaft adapter. Tighten bolts to 137 Nm (101 ft. lbs.).
14. Install the starter motor. 15. Install the transmission and transfer case (if equipped). 16. Lower
vehicle. 17. Fill the crankcase with new engine oil. 18. Connect the battery negative cables. 19.
Start engine and check for oil leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Crankshaft: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft is a forged steel, internally balanced unit. It is supported by seven main bearings,
with position number six designated as the thrust journal. The crankshaft is held in place by main
caps and 12 mm capscrews. The crankshaft also has internal cross drillings to supply the
connecting rods with engine oil.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Gear - Removal
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft Gear - Removal
REMOVAL - GEAR
1. Remove the gear housing cover. 2. Split the gear and remove it from the crankshaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Gear - Removal > Page 2871
Crankshaft: Service and Repair Crankshaft Gear - Installation
INSTALLATION - GEAR
1. Remove all burrs and make sure the gear surface on the end of the crankshaft is smooth. 2. If
removed, install a new alignment pin. Drive the pin in using a ball- peen hammer, leaving it
protruding 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) to 1.5 mm (0.059
inch) above the crankshaft.
WARNING: WEAR PROTECTIVE GLOVES TO PREVENT INJURY.
CAUTION: DO NOT heat the gear longer than 45 minutes.
3. Heat the crankshaft gear for 45 minutes at a temperature of 149°C (300°F). Do not use torch,
gear failure will occur. 4. Apply a thin coat of lubricant to the nose of the crankshaft. 5. Position the
gear with the timing mark out and install it on the crankshaft using the alignment pin. Make sure the
gear contacts the shoulder.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Engine Block Heater - Description
Engine Block Heater: Description and Operation Engine Block Heater - Description
DESCRIPTION
WARNING: Do not operate engine unless block heater cord has been disconnected from power
source and secured in place. The power cord must be secured in its retaining clips and routed
away from exhaust manifolds and moving parts.
An optional engine block heater is available with all models. The heater is equipped with a power
cord. The cord is attached to an engine compartment component with tie-straps. The heater warms
the engine providing easier engine starting and faster warm-up in low temperatures. The heater is
mounted in a core hole of the engine cylinder block in place of a freeze plug with the heating
element immersed in engine coolant. The 3.7L / 4.7L gas powered engines have the block heater
located to the rear on the right side of the engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Engine Block Heater - Description > Page 2876
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Engine Block Heater - Description > Page 2877
Engine Block Heater: Description and Operation Engine Block Heater - Operation
OPERATION
The heater warms the engine coolant providing easier engine starting and faster warm-up in low
temperatures. Connecting the power cord to a grounded 110-120 volt AC electrical outlet with a
grounded three wire extension cord provides the electricity needed to heat the element.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 2878
Engine Block Heater: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER
If the unit does not operate, possible causes can be either the power cord or the heater element.
Test the power cord for continuity with a 110-volt voltmeter or 110-volt test light. Test heater
element continuity with an ohmmeter or a 12-volt test light.
CAUTION: To prevent damage, the power cord must be secured in it's retainer clips and away from
any components that may cause abrasion or damage, such as linkages, exhaust components, etc.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Block Heater - Removal
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Engine Block Heater - Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Drain coolant from radiator and cylinder block. 3.
Unscrew the power cord retaining cap and disconnect cord from heater element. 4. Using a
suitable size socket, loosen and remove the block heater element.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Engine Block Heater - Removal > Page 2881
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair Engine Block Heater - Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Clean and inspect the threads in the cylinder block and heater element. 2. Coat heater element
threads with Mopar(R) Thread Sealer with Teflon. 3. Screw block heater (1) into cylinder block and
tighten to 75 Nm (55 ft. lbs.). 4. Connect block heater cord and tighten retaining cap. 5. Fill cooling
system with recommended coolant. 6. Start and warm the engine. 7. Check block heater for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Crankshaft damper Torque bolts to
...................................................................................................................... 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) plus
an additional 60°
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Procedures
INSPECTION
NOTE: The Crankshaft damper is of viscous design and the speed indicator is incorporated into the
crankshaft damper.
1. Inspect the damper hub for cracks and replace if any are found. 2. If the crankshaft damper is
leaking fluid, discard and replace the crankshaft damper.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2887
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Removal and Replacement
Vibration Damper - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the accessory drive belt. 2. Remove the four (4) damper to crankshaft bolts and remove
damper.
Vibration Damper - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the crankshaft damper and bolts. Tighten bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque, plus an
additional 60°.
NOTE: The damper must be installed so the hole is located over the dowel pin.
2. Install the accessory drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Pistons
Pistons
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2891
Piston: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
PISTONS
The piston is constructed of aluminum and is gravity cast, free floating design. The piston
incorporates a centrally located high swirl combustion bowl, and utilizes a "keystone" style top
compression ring, and a "Tapered Face" intermediate ring, for superior cylinder wall scraping.
Piston cooling nozzles cool the piston and pin with engine oil supplied by the crankshaft main
journals. All pistons are gallery cooled and utilize J-jet piston cooling nozzles. Pistons are
directional in order to provide clearance to piston cooling nozzles.
CONNECTING RODS
The connecting rods are a split angle design. They have a pressed-in-place wrist pin bushing that
is lubricated by piston cooling nozzle oil spray.
Machined connecting rods are no longer used in the diesel engine. Do not install machined
connecting rods into an engine that has fractured split connecting rods.
Fractured split connecting rods are first manufactured as a single piece and then fractured into two
pieces. Fractured split connecting rods can be identified by a rough and irregular surface at the
connecting rod split face. To properly assemble the rod cap to the connecting rod, the bearing
tangs on the connecting rod and cap must be located on the same side of the rod. The long end of
the connecting rod must be assembled on the intake or camshaft side of the engine.
Each matched fractured split connecting rod and cap is an assembly and are not interchangeable.
If a connecting rod or cap is damaged, the entire assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston: Procedures
Piston and Connecting Rod - Cleaning
CLEANING
CAUTION: DO NOT use bead blast to clean the pistons. DO NOT clean the pistons and rods in an
acid tank.
PISTON
Clean the pistons and pins in a suitable solvent, rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed
air. Soaking the pistons over night will loosen most of the carbon build up. De-carbon the ring
grooves with a broken piston ring and again clean the pistons in solvent. Rinse in hot water and
blow dry with compressed air.
CONNECTING ROD
Clean the connecting rods in a suitable solvent, rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed
air.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Inspection
PISTONS
Inspect the pistons for damage and excessive wear. Check top of the piston, ring grooves, skirt and
pin bore. Measure the piston skirt diameter. If the piston is out of limits, replace the piston.
The upper groove only needs to be inspected for damage. Use a new piston ring (2) to measure
the clearance in the intermediate ring groove. Minimum clearance is 0.045 mm (0.0018 inch),
maximum clearance is 0.095 mm (.0037 inch). If the clearance of the intermediate ring exceeds
specifications, replace the piston (3).
Use a new oil ring to measure the clearance in the oil groove. Minimum clearance is 0.040 mm
(0.0016 inch), maximum clearance is 0.085 mm (.0033 inch). If the clearance exceeds
specifications, replace the piston.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2894
Measure the pin bore (2). The maximum diameter is 40.012 mm (1.5753 inch), Minimum is 40.006
mm (1.575 inch). If the bore is over limits, replace the piston (1).
Inspect the piston pin for nicks, gouges and excessive wear. Measure the pin diameter (1). The
minimum diameter is 39.990 mm (1.5744 inch), maximum 40.003 mm (1.5749 inch). If the diameter
is out of limits, replace the pin (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2895
Piston: Removal and Replacement
Piston and Connecting Rod - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery cables. 2. Remove the cylinder head. 3. Remove the oil pan and suction
tube. 4. Remove bolts and the block stiffener. 5. Using Miller Tool 7471-B crankshaft barring tool,
rotate the crankshaft so all of the pistons are below TDC. 6. Before removing the piston(s) from the
bore(s):
a. Remove any carbon ridge formations or deposits at the top of the bore with a dull scraper or soft
wire brush. b. If cylinder bore wear ridges are found, use a ridge reamer to cut the ridge from the
bore. DO NOT remove more metal than necessary to
remove the ridge.
7. Remove the J-jet cooling nozzles.
NOTE: If cylinders have ridges, the cylinders are oversize and will more than likely need boring.
8. Using a hammer and steel stamp, stamp the cylinder number in the top of each piston. The front
of the piston is identified by a stamping on the top
of the piston. DO NOT stamp in the outside 5 mm (.197 in.) of the piston diameter. DO NOT stamp
over the piston pin.
9. Mark the connecting rod and cap with the corresponding cylinder numbers.
10. Remove the connecting rod bolts and rod caps. Use care so the cylinder bores and connecting
rods are not damaged. 11. Use a hammer handle or similar object to push the piston and
connecting rod through the cylinder bore. 12. Store the piston/rod assemblies in a rack.
Piston and Connecting Rod - Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the cylinder bores with clean engine oil. 2. Generously lubricate the rings and piston
skirts with clean engine oil. 3. Orientate the rings on the piston. 4. Compress the rings using a
piston ring compressor tool (1). If using a strap-type ring compressor, make sure the inside end of
the strap does not
hook on a ring gap and break the ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2896
5. Bar the crankshaft so the rod journal for the piston to be installed is at BDC (Bottom Dead
Center). 6. Make sure the front of the piston is oriented properly according to the marking on the
top of the piston and the connecting rod is oriented properly. 7. Position the piston and rod
assembly into the cylinder bore with the front of the piston oriented properly according to the
stamping in the top of the
piston. Use care when you install the piston and connecting rod so the cylinder bore is not
damaged. The long side of the connecting rod must be installed on the exhaust side of the engine.
8. Push the piston into the bore until the top of the piston is approximately 50 mm (2 inch) below
the top of the block. Carefully pull the connecting
rod onto the crankshaft journal.
9. Use clean engine oil to lubricate the threads and under the heads of the connecting rod bolts.
10. For fractured/split type connecting rods, the long end of the rod must be installed away from the
intake side of the engine.
a. The connecting rod split/face must face toward the same side as the piston notch feature on the
skirt. The split face will face toward the exhaust
side of the engine if properly installed.
11. Install the rod cap and bolts to the connecting rod. Tighten the connecting rod bolts evenly in 3
steps.
- Tighten the bolts to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) torque.
- Tighten the bolts to 60 Nm (44 ft. lbs.) torque.
- Rotate 60° clockwise.
12. The crankshaft must rotate freely. Check for freedom of rotation as the caps are installed. If the
crankshaft does not rotate freely, check the
installation of the rod bearing and the bearing size.
13. Measure the side clearance between the connecting rod and the crankshaft. DO NOT measure
the clearance between the cap and crankshaft. 14. Install J-jet piston cooling nozzles. 15. Install
block stiffener. Torque to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.). 16. Install the suction tube and oil pan. 17. Install the
cylinder head onto the engine. 18. Install a new filter and fill the crankcase with new engine
oil.Prefill the filter with clean oil. 19. Connect the battery negative cables and start engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Pin: Specifications
Piston Pins
Piston Pins
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston Rings
Piston Rings
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2903
Piston Ring: Service and Repair
PISTON RING FITTING
1. Determine the piston diameter and obtain the appropriate ring set. The piston rings can be
identified as shown.
2. Position each ring in the cylinder and use a piston (1) to square it with the bore at a depth (3) of
89.0 mm (3.5 inch).
Piston Ring Gap Chart
3. Use a feeler gauge to measure the piston ring gap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2904
4. The top surface of all of the compression rings are identified with the word TOP or the supplier's
MARK. Assemble the rings with the word TOP
or the supplier's MARK up.
5. Position the oil ring expander (2) in the oil control ring (1) groove (bottom groove).
NOTE: There is no (TOP) mark on the oil ring.
6. Install the oil control ring (1) with the end gap OPPOSITE the ends on the expander.
7. Install the intermediate piston ring in the second groove. 8. Install the top piston ring in the top
groove.
9. Position the rings as shown.
- Install top and second compression rings on piston with ring gaps 180° apart.
- Install oil control ring with ring gap 90° from top and second ring. Do not position gaps over wrist
pin hole.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Adjustments
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE LASH ADJUSTMENT AND VERIFICATION
NOTE: To obtain accurate readings, valve lash measurements AND adjustments should only be
performed when the engine coolant temperature is less than 60°C (140°F).
The 24-valve overhead system is a "low-maintenance" design. Routine adjustments are no longer
necessary, however, measurement should still take place when troubleshooting performance
problems, or upon completion of a repair that includes removal and installation of the valve train
components or injectors.
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Using the crankshaft
barring tool #7471-B, rotate crankshaft to align damper TDC mark to 12:00 o'clock position.
a. If both number one cylinder rocker levers are loose, continue to next step. b. If both number one
cylinder rocker levers are not loose, rotate crankshaft 360 degrees.
4. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be measured at the following rocker arms:
INTAKE 1-2-4 / EXHAUST 1-3-5. Measure the valve
lash by inserting a feeler gauge between the rocker arm socket and crosshead. Refer to VALVE
LASH LIMIT CHART for the correct specifications. If the measurement falls within the limits,
adjustment/resetting is not necessary. If measurement finds the lash outside of the limits,
adjustment/resetting is required.
Valve Lash Limit Chart
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 2909
5. If adjustment/resetting is required, loosen the lock nut on rocker arms and turn the adjusting
screw until the desired lash is obtained:
- INTAKE 0.254 mm (0.010 in.)
- EXHAUST 0.660 mm (0.026 in.) Tighten the lock nut to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) and recheck the valve
lash.
6. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the crankshaft one revolution (360°) to align the damper
TDC mark to the 12 o'clock position. 7. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be
measured at the remaining rocker arms: INTAKE 3-5-6 / EXHAUST 2-4-6. Use the same
method as above for determining whether adjustment is necessary, and adjust those that are found
to be outside of the limits.
8. Install the cylinder head cover. 9. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Rocker Arm Assembly: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The unique intake and exhaust rocker arms have their own rocker shafts and are lubricated by
passages intersecting the cylinder block main oil rifle. Crossheads are used, which allow each
rocker arm to operate two valves.
The solid push rods are hardened at the rocker arm and tappet contact areas for superior strength
and durability.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Rocker Arm Assembly: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean all components in a suitable solvent. If necessary, use a wire brush or wheel to remove
stubborn deposits. Rinse in hot water and blow dry with compressed air. Inspect oil passages in
rocker arms and pedestals. Apply compressed air to lubrication orifices to purge contaminants.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Rocker Arms
1. Remove rocker shaft and inspect for cracks and excessive wear in the bore or shaft. Remove
socket and inspect ball insert and socket for signs of
wear. Replace retainer if necessary.
Measure the rocker arm bore and shaft.
Push Rods
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2915
Inspect the push rod ball and socket for signs of scoring. Check for cracks where the ball and the
socket are pressed into the tube.
Roll the push rod on a flat work surface with the socket end hanging off the edge. Replace any
push rod that appears to be bent.
Crossheads
Inspect the crossheads for cracks and/or excessive wear on rocker lever and valve tip mating
surfaces.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2916
Rocker Arm Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Remove the rocker
arm/pedestal fasteners and remove rocker arm (1) and pedestal (2) from cylinder head. Mark the
arms and pedestals so they
can be installed in their original position.
CAUTION: When removing the rocker arms, the sockets may come loose and fall into the engine.
Make sure they stay with the arm upon removal/installation.
4. Lift the push rod(s) up and out of the engine. Mark them so they can be installed in their original
position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2917
NOTE: The #5 cylinder intake and exhaust, and #6 cylinder intake and exhaust push rods must be
raised through the provided cowl panel access holes.
5. Lift the crossheads off of the valve stems. Mark them so they can be installed in their original
position.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. If previously removed, install the push rods in their original location. Verify that they are seated in
the tappets. 2. Lubricate the valve tips and install the crossheads in their original locations. 3.
Lubricate the crossheads and push rod sockets and install the rocker arms and pedestals in their
original locations. Tighten bolts to 36 Nm (27 ft.
lbs.) torque.
4. Verify valve lash adjustment. 5. Install cylinder head cover. 6. Connect battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Valve Cover: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Using a suitable solvent, Clean and dry gasket mating surfaces on cylinder head and rocker
housing. Wipe gasket dry and inspect for re-use.
Inspection
INSPECTION
The cylinder head cover gasket and rocker housing gasket, are reusable. However, should cracks,
nicks, or tears be present in the rubber/silicone construction, the defective components should be
replaced. Also replace gasket if it is no longer flexible. Inspect cylinder head cover rubber isolated
capscrews for cracks, nicks, or tears.Do not reuse gasket if it has been removed from the groove in
the rocker housing or cylinder head cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2922
Valve Cover: Removal and Replacement
Rocker Housing
ROCKER HOUSING
1. Remove the breather cover and the cylinder head cover. 2. Remove injector harness nuts from
injectors. 3. Remove cylinder head cover gasket. 4. Remove rocker housing bolts. 5. Remove
rocker housing and gasket.
Cylinder Head Cover
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables. 2. Remove the Breather Cover Capscrews (8-M6
screws). 3. Remove the CCV breather and filter cover (3). 4. Disconnect CCV Tube (4) at the CDR
valve (one spring clamp) and remove 10mm nut from tube bracket at EGR Cooler support bracket
stud. 5. Disconnect CDR valve Tube to Air Inlet Silencer (Spring Clamp). 6. Disconnect CDR/Valve
cover pressure sensor connector. 7. Remove Oil fill cap. 8. Remove CCV oil drains (2) from valve
cover (2 hoses). 9. Disconnect both injector harness connectors (1).
10. Remove six (6) valve cover capscrews (10mm). 11. Remove the valve cover. 12. Loosen
injector wire nuts from the valve cover gasket (8mm). 13. Remove gasket.
Cylinder Head Cover Gasket
CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2923
1. Remove cylinder head cover. 2. Disconnect injector harness connectors (3) at cylinder head
cover gasket. 3. Remove injector solenoid nuts (1) at injectors. 4. Remove cylinder head cover
gasket (2).
Rocker Housing
ROCKER HOUSING
1. Inspect rocker housing gasket for cuts, nicks, or tears. Replace if damaged or if gasket has
come out of groove. 2. Inspect rocker housing gasket for proper installation in groove. Gasket bead
must be centered in groove. A gasket bead that is tilted to the side will
cause an oil leak.
CAUTION: When installing rocker housing onto cylinder head, do not slide housing from side to
side, The gasket could fall out or be damaged.
3. Install the rocker housing. Carefully guide the rocker housing evenly down onto the cylinder
head. 4. Install rocker housing bolts and tighten finger tight. 5. Torque bolts, working from center
out, to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
Cylinder Head Cover
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2924
NOTE: Gasket must be completely dry and free of oil before installation.
1. Wipe oil from the valve cover gasket, rocker box, and valve cover. 2. Inspect valve cover gasket
for tears, or splits. Replace if necessary. 3. Install the valve cover gasket on the rocker box. 4.
Install the injector nuts (8 mm) to injector studs. Torque to 1.25 Nm (11 in. lbs.). 5. Install valve
cover and valve cover capscrews (10mm). tighten from center out. Torque to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 6.
Install the valve cover CCV drain hoses (2). 7. Remove any oil from the CCV seal area and install
the CCV filter. 8. Install the CCV cover and capscrews (6mm). Torque to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.). 9.
Connect CDR valve tube to Air Inlet Silencer (spring clamps).
10. Connect the Breather/Valve Cover Pressure sensor. 11. Install oil fill cap. 12. Connect the
batteries. 13. Start the vehicle and check for leaks.
Cylinder Head Cover Gasket
CYLINDER HEAD COVER GASKET
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2925
1. Clean oil from cylinder head cover gasket 2. Inspect cylinder head cover gasket for cuts or
damage. Replace if damaged. 3. Place cylinder head cover gasket on top of rocker housing (2). 4.
Install injector solenoid nuts (1) at injectors. Torque to 1.25 Nm (11 in. lbs.). 5. Connect injector
harness connectors (3) at cylinder head cover gasket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Spring: Service and Repair
VALVES, GUIDES AND SPRINGS
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head. 2. Support cylinder head on stands, or install head bolts upside down
(through combustion surface side) to protect injector tips from damage from
work bench.
3. Install the valve spring compressor mounting base (1) as shown.
4. Install the compressor top plate, washer, and nut. Using a suitable wrench, tighten the nut
(clockwise) to compress the valve springs and remove
the locks.
5. Rotate the compressor nut counter-clockwise to relieve tension on the springs. Remove the
spring compressor (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2929
6. Remove the retainers (5), springs (4), valve seals (3) (if necessary), and valves (2). Arrange or
number all components so they can be installed in
their original locations.
7. Repeat the procedure on all cylinders to be serviced.
CLEANING
Clean the valve stems with crocus cloth or a Scotch-Brite(TM) pad. Remove carbon with a soft wire
brush. Clean valves, springs, retainers, and valve retaining locks in a suitable solvent. Rinse in hot
water and blow dry with compressed air.
INSPECTION
Visually inspect the valves for abnormal wear on the heads, stems, and tips. Replace any valve
that is worn out or bent.
Measure the valve stem diameter in three places as shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2930
Valve Guide Bore Specifications
Measure the cylinder head valve guide bore.
Measure valve margin (rim thickness).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2931
Measure the valve spring free length and maximum inclination.
Test valve spring force with tool C-647 (1). Specification 72.0 - 80.7 lbs. when compressed to 35.33
mm (1.39 in.).
INSTALLATION
1. Install new valve seals. The yellow seals are for the intake valves and the green seals are for the
exhaust valves. 2. Install the valves in their original position. The exhaust valves are identified by a
dimple on the valve head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2932
3. Install the valve (2), springs (4), and retainer (5).
4. Install the valve spring compressor tool 8319-A (1) as shown. 5. Compress the valve springs and
install the valve retaining locks. 6. Remove the compressor and repeat the procedure on the
remaining cylinders. 7. Install new o-ring and sealing washer on injector. 8. Lubricate o-ring and
injector bore. 9. Verify sealing washer (shim) was removed with old injector.
10. Install injector. 11. Install the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Valve: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The intake valves (1) are made of heat resistant steel, and have chrome plated stems to prevent
scuffing. The exhaust valves are made of iron alloys (2). The intake and exhaust valves are both
similar in head diameter and overall length, but they have unique face angles which makes them
non-interchangeable. The valves are distinguished by unique dimples on the exhaust valve head
(2).
The exhaust valve springs are made from high strength, chrome silicon steel. The exhaust valve
springs are also exhaust brake compatible.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs
Valve: Service and Repair Removal - Valve Springs
REMOVAL - VALVE SPRINGS
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove the cylinder head cover. 3. Disconnect the
injector harness connectors at cylinder head cover gasket. Remove all injector solenoid nuts.
Remove cylinder head cover gasket. 4. Remove injector(s) for cylinder(s) to be serviced. 5.
Remove the rocker housing. 6. Remove the rocker arms and crossheads from the cylinder(s) to be
serviced. Mark each component so they can be installed in their original
position.
7. Using the crankshaft barring tool # 7471-B (2), rotate the engine to position the damper mark in
the 12 o'clock position. At this engine position,
cylinders #1 and #6 can be serviced.
8. Remove the accessory drive belt. 9. With the damper TDC mark in the 12 o'clock position, add a
paint mark anywhere on the gear housing cover next to the crankshaft damper. Place
another mark on the vibration damper in alignment with the mark you just made on the cover.
10. Divide the crankshaft damper into three equally sized segments as follows:
a. Using a tape measure, measure the circumference of the crankshaft damper and divide the
measurement by three (3). b. Measure that distance in a counterclockwise direction from the first
balancer mark and place another mark on the balancer. c. From the second damper mark, again
measure in a counterclockwise direction and place a mark on the damper at the same distance you
measured when placing the second damper mark. The damper should now be marked in three
equally spaced locations and the damper TDC mark should be in the 12 o'clock position.
d. Remove injectors, fuel lines, and high pressure connectors for every cylinder that requires repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2938
11. Compress the valve springs at cylinders. #1 and #6 as follows:
a. Install the valve spring compressor mounting base as shown in. b. Install the top plate, washer,
and nut. Using a suitable wrench tighten the nut (clockwise) to compress the valve springs and
remove the collets. c. Rotate the compressor nut counterclockwise to relieve tension on springs.
Remove spring compressor. d. Remove and replace retainers, springs, and seals as necessary. e.
Do not rotate the engine until the springs and retainers are reinstalled. f. Install seals, springs and
retainers. Install spring compressor, compress valve springs and install the collets. g. Release the
spring tension and remove the compressor. Verify that the collets are seated by tapping on the
valve stem with a plastic hammer.
12. Using the crankshaft barring tool (2), rotate the engine until the next crankshaft damper paint
mark aligns with the mark you placed on the cover.
In this position, cylinders #2 and #5 can be serviced.
13. Repeat the valve spring compressing procedure previously performed and service the
retainers, springs, and seals as necessary. 14. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the engine
until the next crankshaft damper paint mark aligns with the mark you placed on the cover. In
this position, cylinders #3 and #4 can be serviced.
15. Repeat the spring compressing procedure previously performed and service the retainers,
springs, and seals as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2939
Valve: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install rocker housing. 2. Install fuel injectors and high pressure fuel lines. 3. Lubricate the valve
tips and install the crossheads in their original locations. 4. Lubricate the crossheads and push rod
sockets and install the rocker arms and pedestals in their original locations. Tighten bolts to 36 Nm
(27 ft.
lbs.) torque.
5. Verify valve lash adjustment. 6. Install cylinder head cover gasket onto rocker housing. 7. Install
injector solenoid nuts. 8. Connect injector harness connectors. 9. Install cylinder head cover.
10. Connect battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2940
Valve: Service and Repair Valves, Guides And Springs
VALVES, GUIDES AND SPRINGS
REMOVAL
1. Remove cylinder head. 2. Support cylinder head on stands, or install head bolts upside down
(through combustion surface side) to protect injector tips from damage from
work bench.
3. Install the valve spring compressor mounting base (1) as shown.
4. Install the compressor top plate, washer, and nut. Using a suitable wrench, tighten the nut
(clockwise) to compress the valve springs and remove
the locks.
5. Rotate the compressor nut counter-clockwise to relieve tension on the springs. Remove the
spring compressor (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2941
6. Remove the retainers (5), springs (4), valve seals (3) (if necessary), and valves (2). Arrange or
number all components so they can be installed in
their original locations.
7. Repeat the procedure on all cylinders to be serviced.
CLEANING
Clean the valve stems with crocus cloth or a Scotch-Brite(TM) pad. Remove carbon with a soft wire
brush. Clean valves, springs, retainers, and valve retaining locks in a suitable solvent. Rinse in hot
water and blow dry with compressed air.
INSPECTION
Visually inspect the valves for abnormal wear on the heads, stems, and tips. Replace any valve
that is worn out or bent.
Measure the valve stem diameter in three places as shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2942
Valve Guide Bore Specifications
Measure the cylinder head valve guide bore.
Measure valve margin (rim thickness).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2943
Measure the valve spring free length and maximum inclination.
Test valve spring force with tool C-647 (1). Specification 72.0 - 80.7 lbs. when compressed to 35.33
mm (1.39 in.).
INSTALLATION
1. Install new valve seals. The yellow seals are for the intake valves and the green seals are for the
exhaust valves. 2. Install the valves in their original position. The exhaust valves are identified by a
dimple on the valve head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Valve Springs > Page 2944
3. Install the valve (2), springs (4), and retainer (5).
4. Install the valve spring compressor tool 8319-A (1) as shown. 5. Compress the valve springs and
install the valve retaining locks. 6. Remove the compressor and repeat the procedure on the
remaining cylinders. 7. Install new o-ring and sealing washer on injector. 8. Lubricate o-ring and
injector bore. 9. Verify sealing washer (shim) was removed with old injector.
10. Install injector. 11. Install the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive Belt: Diagrams
With A/C
1- Idler Pulley 2- Accessory Drive Belt 3- Power Steering Pulley 4- Radiator Fan Pulley 5Crankshaft Pulley 6- A/C Compressor Pulley 7- Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner 8- Generator 9Water Pump Pulley
Without A/C
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2949
1- Idler Pulley 2- Accessory Drive Belt 3- Power Steering Pulley 4- Radiator Fan Pulley 5Crankshaft Pulley 6- Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner 7- Generator 8- Water Pump
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2950
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The accessory drive belt is a serpentine type belt. Satisfactory performance of these belts depends
on belt condition and proper belt tension.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2951
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING
VISUAL DIAGNOSIS
NOTE: Diesel Engine - If a belt is broken or frayed, inspect engine speed sensor (located near the
crankshaft damper) for damage.
When diagnosing serpentine accessory drive belts, small cracks that run across the ribbed surface
of the belt from rib to rib , are considered normal. These are not a reason to replace the belt.
However, cracks running along a rib (not across) are not normal. Any belt with cracks running
along a rib must be replaced. Also replace the belt if it has excessive wear, frayed cords or severe
glazing.
Refer to ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT DIAGNOSIS CHART for further belt diagnosis.
NOISE DIAGNOSIS
Noises generated by the accessory drive belt are most noticeable at idle. Before replacing a belt to
resolve a noise condition, inspect all of the accessory drive pulleys for alignment, glazing, or
excessive end play.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2952
Accessory Drive Belt Diagnosis Chart (Part 1)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2953
Accessory Drive Belt Diagnosis Chart (Part 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Drive Belt: Procedures
CLEANING
Clean all foreign debris from belt pulley grooves. The belt pulleys must be free of oil, grease, and
coolants before installing the drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2956
Drive Belt: Removal and Replacement
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
Belt Routing-Diesel Engine Without A/C
1. A 1/2 inch square hole is provided in the automatic belt tensioner. Attach a 1/2 inch drive-long
handle ratchet to this hole.
BELT ROUTING-DIESEL WITH A/C
2. Rotate ratchet and tensioner assembly clockwise (as viewed from front) until tension has been
relieved from belt. 3. Remove belt from water pump pulley first. 4. Remove belt from vehicle.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2957
Belt Routing - DIESEL WITH A/C
CAUTION: When installing the accessory drive belt, the belt must be routed correctly. If not, engine
may overheat due to water pump rotating in wrong direction.
1. Position drive belt over all pulleys except water pump pulley. 2. Attach a 1/2 inch ratchet to
tensioner.
Belt Routing - DIESEL WITHOUT A/C
3. Rotate ratchet and belt tensioner clockwise. Place belt over water pump pulley. Let tensioner
rotate back into place. Remove ratchet. Be sure belt
is properly seated on all pulleys.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Drive Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Correct drive belt tension is required to ensure optimum performance of the belt driven engine
accessories. If specified tension is not maintained, belt slippage may cause; engine overheating,
lack of power steering assist, loss of air conditioning capacity, reduced generator output rate, and
greatly reduced belt life.
It is not necessary to adjust belt tension. All engines are equipped with an automatic belt tensioner.
The tensioner maintains correct belt tension at all times.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 2962
Drive Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The automatic belt tensioner maintains belt tension by using internal spring pressure, a pivoting
arm and pulley to press against the drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Because of high spring pressure, do not attempt to disassemble automatic tensioner.
Unit is serviced as an assembly.
1. Remove accessory drive belt. 2. Remove tensioner mounting bolt and remove tensioner (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 2965
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Install tensioner assembly (7) to water inlet bracket. A dowel is located on back of tensioner.
Align this dowel to hole in tensioner mounting
bracket. Tighten bolt to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) torque.
2. Install drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Front Mount
Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: If replacing a engine mount / bracket, be certain to inspect all other engine mounts /
brackets in the system. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the vehicle.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove the viscous fan/drive assembly. 3. Raise
vehicle on hoist. 4. Install engine support fixture tool #8534 and steel bracket tool #8534A 5.
Loosen the thru-bolt and nut. 6. Lift the engine SLIGHTLY and remove the insulator to block bolts.
7. Remove the RH mount (2) from the engine.
8. Remove the LH insulator (2) from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2970
CAUTION: If replacing a engine mount / bracket, be certain to inspect all other engine mounts /
brackets in the system. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the vehicle.
1. With engine raised SLIGHTLY, position the LH insulator (2) to the mount. Install the bolts and
torque to specification.
2. With engine raised SLIGHTLY, position the RH insulator (2) to the mount. Install the bolts and
torque to specification. 3. Lower the engine using tool #8534, while guiding the mount and thru-bolt
into the frame mounted support cushion brackets. 4. Install the thru bolt nut and tighten the nut to
95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Remove the engine support fixture tool #8534. 6. Lower the vehicle. 7.
Install the viscous fan/drive assembly. 8. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2971
Engine Mount: Service and Repair Rear Mount
Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: If replacing a engine mount / bracket, be certain to inspect all other engine mounts /
brackets in the system. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the vehicle.
1. Raise the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Position a transmission jack in place. 3. Remove support cushion
stud nuts (6).
4. Raise rear of transmission until cushion studs (6) clear frame. 5. Remove the nuts holding the
support cushion (5) to the transmission support bracket (8). 6. Remove support cushion (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2972
7. Remove the bolts (3) holding the transmission support to the bracket (4).
8. Remove the bolts (7) holding the transmission support to the transmission. 9. Remove the
transmission support (8).
10. Remove the nuts (1) from the transmission bracket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2973
11. Remove the bracket (3) from the transmission.
Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: If replacing a engine mount / bracket, be certain to inspect all other engine mounts /
brackets in the system. Failure to follow this caution may result in damage to the vehicle.
1. If removed, position the brackets to the transmission. Install attaching fasteners (1, 2), Do not
tighten at this time..
2. Position support cushion (5) to transmission support bracket (3). Install stud nuts (4) and tighten
to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) torque. 3. Position assembled support cushion (5) and bracket (3) to
transmission. 4. Install the support bracket bolt (7) and tighten to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2974
5. Install the support bracket bolts (3) and tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.) torque.
6. Torque the bracket to transmission nuts (11) to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) torque.
7. Using the transmission jack, lower the transmission and support cushion (5) onto the
crossmember. 8. Install the support cushion nuts (6) and tighten to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Mount > Page 2975
9. Remove the transmission jack.
10. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil Pressure
Oil Pressure
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2980
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING-ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
1. Remove the 1/8 npt plug from the top of the oil filter housing. 2. Install Oil Pressure Line and
Gauge Tool C-3292 with a suitable adapter. 3. Start engine and warm to operating temperature. 4.
Record engine oil pressure and compare with engine oil pressure chart.
CAUTION: If engine oil pressure is zero at idle, DO NOT RUN THE ENGINE.
If minimum engine oil pressure is below these ranges, Refer to ENGINE - TESTING.
5. Remove oil pressure gauge and install the 1/8 npt plug.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 2985
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil with Filter ............................................................................................................................
................................................. 11.4Liters (12.0 Qt)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2988
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE OIL - DIESEL ENGINES Use only Low Ash Diesel Engine Oil meeting standard
MIL-2104C or API Classification CJ-4/SM (5.9L), or CJ-4 (6.7L), or higher that meets Cummins
CES 20081 Standards.
Low ash diesel engine oil is REQUIRED for the 6.7L engine, use MOPAR® MaxPro 15W-40 6700
Diesel DPF diesel engine oil, or equivalent.
SAE VISCOSITY GRADE
CAUTION: Low viscosity oils must have the proper API quality or the CCMC G5 designation.
To assure of properly formulated engine oils, it is recommended that SAE Grade 15W-40 engine
oils that meet Chrysler material standard MS-10902, be used in accordance to ACEA B3, B4
specification. European Grade 15W-40 oils that meet Association des Constructeurs Europe■ens
d' Automobiles (European Automobile Manufacturers Association) (ACEA) specifications, are also
acceptable.
Oils of the SAE 5W-40 grade number are preferred when minimum temperatures consistently fall
below -15°C (5°F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2989
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
CAUTION: Do not overfill crankcase with engine oil, oil foaming and oil pressure loss can result.
To ensure proper lubrication of an engine, the engine oil must be maintained at an acceptable
level. The acceptable oil level is in the SAFE RANGE (3) on the engine oil dipstick.
NOTE: The best time to check the engine oil level is after the engine is at operating temperature
and has been turned off (not running) for 30 minutes.
1. Position vehicle on level surface. 2. With engine OFF, allow approximately 30 minutes for oil to
settle to bottom of crankcase, remove engine oil dipstick. 3. Wipe dipstick clean. 4. Replace
dipstick and verify it is seated in the tube. 5. Remove dipstick, with handle held above the tip, take
oil level reading. 6. Add oil only if level is below the SAFE RANGE area on the dipstick. 7. Replace
dipstick.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2990
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
ENGINE OIL SERVICE
WARNING: Hot oil can cause personal injury.
NOTE: Change engine oil and filter at intervals specified in the owner's manual.
1. Operate the engine until the water temperature reaches 60°C (140°F). Shut the engine off. 2.
Use a container that can hold at least 14 liters (15 quarts) to hold the used oil. Remove the oil drain
plug and drain the used engine oil into the
container.
3. Always check the condition of the used oil. This can give you an indication of engine problems
that might exist.
- Thin, black oil indicates fuel dilution.
- Milky discoloration indicates coolant dilution.
4. Clean the area around the oil filter head. Remove the filter. 5. Install new oil filter. 6. Clean the
drain plug and the sealing surface of the pan. Check the condition of the threads and sealing
surface on the oil pan and drain plug. 7. Install the drain plug. Tighten the plug to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
torque. 8. Use only High-Quality Low Ash Multi-Viscosity lubricating oil in the Cummins Turbo
Diesel engine. 9. Fill the engine with the correct grade of new oil.
10. Start the engine and operate it at idle for several minutes. Check for leaks at the filter and drain
plug. 11. Stop engine. Wait 30 minutes to allow the oil to drain back to the pan and check the level
again.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing of used engine oil after it has been drained from a
vehicle's engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Control Valve >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Engine Oil Control Valve: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
1. Clean the regulator spring and plunger with a suitable solvent and blow dry with compressed air.
If the plunger bore requires cleaning, it is
necessary to remove the oil filter head to avoid getting debris into the engine.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the plunger and plunger bore for cracks and excessive wear. Polished surfaces are
acceptable. Verify that the plunger moves freely in the bore.
Check the spring for height and load limitations. Replace the spring if out of limits shown in the
figure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Control Valve >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2995
Engine Oil Control Valve: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove the threaded plug (2), spring (4) and valve
(5). Insert a finger or a seal pick to lift the plunger from the bore.
NOTE: If the plunger is stuck in the bore, it will be necessary to remove the filter head.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the plunger, spring, and plug as shown in. Tighten the plug to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.) torque. 2.
Connect the battery negative cables. 3. Start the engine and verify that it has oil pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Oil Cooler: Procedures
CLEANING AND INSPECTION
Clean the sealing surfaces.
Apply 483 kPa (70 psi) air pressure to the element to check for leaks. If the element leaks, replace
the element.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3000
Oil Cooler: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL - OIL COOLER
1. Disconnect Negative battery cables. 2. Drain Coolant. 3. Disconnect Ambient Air and MAF
Sensors on Air Filter housing. 4. Loosen hose clamp at Turbocharger Inlet. 5. Move clamp on
Engine Breather hose at Inlet elbow at turbocharger and remove hose. 6. Remove Air Filter
housing cover and inlet hose and set aside. 7. Remove upper generator bolt, loosen lower
generator bolt, and rotate generator away from cylinder head. 8. Loosen the three clamps and
hoses from the Coolant outlet tube. 9. Loosen and remove the bracket attachment nut from Coolant
tube (10 mm).
10. Remove Coolant outlet tube. 11. Loosen turbocharger oil supply hose from oil cooler housing.
12. Remove oil filter. 13. Loosen and remove the 14 oil cooler attachment capscrews (10 mm). 14.
Remove oil cooler housing and oil cooler from engine block.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean block surface, oil cooler, and oil cooler housing of debris, dirt and remaining gasket
material 2. Using new gaskets install oil cooler, oil cooler housing to cylinder block.
NOTE: Depending on the revision of oil cooler, mounting gaskets will differ. Make sure the gaskets
line up with the oil cooler element and housing correctly. Failure to use correct gaskets will result in
severe engine damage.
3. Tighten mounting capscrews in a criss-cross pattern. Torque to 24 Nm (18 ft-lb) 4. Install
Coolant outlet tube into place and secure tube bracket to cooler mounting stud. Tighten nut to 24
Nm (18 ft-lb) 5. Connect tube to hoses and secure with hose clamps 6. Swing generator into place
and torque through bolts to specs. 7. Install Air Inlet hose to turbocharger and place Air Filter
housing lid into place 8. Tighten hose clamp at Turbocharger to specs. 9. Install Crank Case
Breather hose to Inlet elbow and place hose clamp in place.
10. Connect Ambient Air and MAP sensors. 11. Fill Engine with coolant. 12. Connect battery
cables. 13. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3001
Oil Cooler: Tools and Equipment
1/2" Oil Cooler Line Rem.
AST tool# 8016
Used for removing both of the oil cooler lines from the fittings on automatic transmission and oil
coolers.
- Used for R and R of Oil and Transmission Cooler Lines
- Green-Anodized Aluminum Construction
- See Application Chart
- Included in the 8100, 8107 and #8110 Line Disconnect Sets.
Contact AST for pricing.
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1-800-525-2943
This Tool is also available in the following kits:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Cooler, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3002
8107 - 7-Piece Line Disconnect Set
8110 - 10-Pc. Line Disconnect Set
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Clean the area around the oil filter head. Remove the filter from below using a cap-style filter
wrench. 2. Clean the gasket surface of the filter head. The filter canister O-Ring seal can stick on
the filter head. Make sure it is removed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3007
Oil Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Fill the oil filter element with clean oil before installation. Use the same type oil that will be used
in the engine. 2. Apply a light film of lubricating oil to the sealing surface before installing the filter.
CAUTION: Mechanical over-tightening may distort the threads or damage the filter element seal.
3. Install the filter until it contacts the sealing surface of the oil filter adapter. Tighten filter an
additional 1/2 turn.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Oil Line: Procedures
CLEANING AND INSPECTION
Clean the sealing surfaces.
Apply 483 kPa (70 psi) air pressure to the element to check for leaks. If the element leaks, replace
the element.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Line, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3012
Oil Line: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL - OIL COOLER
1. Disconnect Negative battery cables. 2. Drain Coolant. 3. Disconnect Ambient Air and MAF
Sensors on Air Filter housing. 4. Loosen hose clamp at Turbocharger Inlet. 5. Move clamp on
Engine Breather hose at Inlet elbow at turbocharger and remove hose. 6. Remove Air Filter
housing cover and inlet hose and set aside. 7. Remove upper generator bolt, loosen lower
generator bolt, and rotate generator away from cylinder head. 8. Loosen the three clamps and
hoses from the Coolant outlet tube. 9. Loosen and remove the bracket attachment nut from Coolant
tube (10 mm).
10. Remove Coolant outlet tube. 11. Loosen turbocharger oil supply hose from oil cooler housing.
12. Remove oil filter. 13. Loosen and remove the 14 oil cooler attachment capscrews (10 mm). 14.
Remove oil cooler housing and oil cooler from engine block.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean block surface, oil cooler, and oil cooler housing of debris, dirt and remaining gasket
material 2. Using new gaskets install oil cooler, oil cooler housing to cylinder block.
NOTE: Depending on the revision of oil cooler, mounting gaskets will differ. Make sure the gaskets
line up with the oil cooler element and housing correctly. Failure to use correct gaskets will result in
severe engine damage.
3. Tighten mounting capscrews in a criss-cross pattern. Torque to 24 Nm (18 ft-lb) 4. Install
Coolant outlet tube into place and secure tube bracket to cooler mounting stud. Tighten nut to 24
Nm (18 ft-lb) 5. Connect tube to hoses and secure with hose clamps 6. Swing generator into place
and torque through bolts to specs. 7. Install Air Inlet hose to turbocharger and place Air Filter
housing lid into place 8. Tighten hose clamp at Turbocharger to specs. 9. Install Crank Case
Breather hose to Inlet elbow and place hose clamp in place.
10. Connect Ambient Air and MAP sensors. 11. Fill Engine with coolant. 12. Connect battery
cables. 13. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil pan-Bolts ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.)
NOTE: Start in the center and work outward.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Oil Pan: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Remove all gasket material from the oil pan and cylinder block sealing surfaces. Extra effort may
be required around T-joint areas. Clean oil pan and flush suction tube with a suitable solvent.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the oil pan, suction tube, and tube braces for cracks and damage. Replace any defective
component. Inspect the oil drain plug and drain hole threads. Inspect the oil pan sealing surface for
straightness. Repair any minor imperfections with a ball-peen hammer. Do not attempt to repair an
oil pan by welding.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3018
Oil Pan: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
4x4
1. Open the hood. 2. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 3. Remove the intake air assembly. 4.
Remove the radiator shroud retaining bolts. 5. Install engine support fixture # 8534B. 6. Raise and
support the vehicle.
WARNING: HOT OIL CAN CAUSE PERSONAL INJURY.
7. Drain the engine oil. 8. Loosen the front engine mount bolts. 9. Lower the vehicle. 10. Use the
engine support fixture #8534B to raise engine out of the front mounts. 11. Remove the engine oil
dipstick. 12. Raise and support the vehicle. 13. Remove oil pan bolts, break the pan to block seal,
and lower pan slightly and remove oil suction tube fasteners. 14. Remove oil pan and suction tube.
15. Remove the 2 bolts from the front of the engine block stiffener. 16. Remove the oil pan.
4x2
1. Open the hood. 2. Remove the negative battery cables. 3. Raise and support the vehicle. 4.
Remove the transmission oil cooler lines. 5. Remove the propeller shaft. 6. Remove the starter
bolts. 7. Support the starter. 8. Remove the torque converter bolts. 9. Remove the exhaust hanger
bolts. 10. Remove the gear shift cable. 11. Remove the wiring harness. 12. Remove the
transmission mount. 13. Remove the crossover bolts. 14. Position the transmission jack. 15.
Remove the bell housing bolts. 16. Remove the transmission. 17. Remove the flywheel housing
bolts (8). 18. Remove the flex plate bolts (8). 19. Remove the engine oil dip stick. 20. Drain the oil.
21. Remove the steering rack bolts. 22. Remove the oil pan bolts. 23. Remove the oil pickup bolts.
24. Remove the oil pan.
Installation
INSTALLATION
4x4
1. Clean the sealing surfaces of the cylinder block and oil pan with a suitable cleaner. 2. Clean the
oil pan. 3. Clean the oil pan T-joints.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3019
4. Fill the T-joint between the pan rail/gear housing and pan rail/rear seal retainer with sealant. Use
Mopar® Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant or
equivalent.
5. Position the new oil pan gasket. 6. Place suction tube in oil pan and guide them into place. Using
a new tube-to-block gasket, install and tighten the suction tube bolts by hand.
Starting with the oil pump inlet bolts, tighten the bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. Tighten the
remaining tube brace bolts to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) torque.
7. Starting in the center and working outward, tighten the oil pan bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) torque.
8. Install the engine oil dipstick. 9. Install the engine block stiffener. 10. Install the flywheel to
crankshaft adapter. Torque to 137 Nm (101 ft. lbs.). 11. Lower vehicle. 12. Lower the engine into
the motor mounts and tighten the through bolts to 88 Nm (64 ft. lbs.). 13. Install battery negative
cables. 14. Fill the crankcase with new engine oil. 15. Start engine and check for leaks. Stop
engine, check oil level, and adjust, if necessary. 16. Remove the engine support fixture #8534B.
17. Install the fan and fan shroud.
NOTE: Make sure that the fan shroud seal is properly seated in the radiator fan shroud and that it
is not out of position causing excessive contact with the radiator coolant tubes.
18. Fill the engine oil. 19. Connect the battery negative cables. 20. Close the hood.
4x2
1. Clean the sealing surfaces of the cylinder block and oil pan with a suitable cleaner. 2. Clean the
oil pan. 3. Clean the oil pan T-joints. 4. Fill the T-joint between the pan rail/gear housing and pan
rail/rear seal retainer with sealant. Use Mopar® Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant or
equivalent.
5. Position the new oil pan gasket. 6. Place suction tube in oil pan and guide them into place. Using
a new tube-to-block gasket, install and tighten the suction tube bolts by hand.
Starting with the oil pump inlet bolts, tighten the bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. Tighten the
remaining tube brace bolts to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) torque.
7. Starting in the center and working outward, tighten the oil pan bolts to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.) torque.
8. Install the steering rack bolts. 9. Install the flex plate. 10. Install the flywheel to crankshaft
adapter. Torque to 137 Nm (101 ft. lbs.). 11. Install transmission and transfer case (if equipped).
12. Install the flywheel housing assembly with the starter motor attached and tighten bolts to 77 Nm
(57 ft. lbs.) torque.
NOTE: A new clamping ring must be used on early or late builds, automatic or manual. Do not
reuse clamping ring.
13. Install the EGR cooler. 14. Install the fan and fan shroud.
NOTE: Make sure that the fan shroud seal is properly seated in the radiator fan shroud and that it
is not out of position causing excessive contact with the radiator coolant tubes.
15. Remove the transmission jack. 16. Install the crossmember bolts. 17. Install the transmission
mount. 18. Install the wiring harness. 19. Install the gear shift cable. 20. Install the exhaust hanger
bolts. 21. Install the torque converter bolts. 22. Install the starter. 23. Install the starter bolts. 24.
Install the transmission oil cooler lines. 25. Connect the negative battery cables. 26. Close the
hood.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An oil pressure gauge is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. This gauge is located in the
upper right quadrant of the instrument cluster, above the coolant temperature gauge. This gauge
consists of a movable gauge needle or pointer controlled by the instrument cluster circuitry and a
fixed 90 degree scale on the cluster overlay that reads left-to-right from L (or Low) to H (or High) for
gasoline engines. On vehicles with a diesel engine the scale reads from 0 kPa to 760 kPa in
markets where a metric instrument cluster is specified, or from 0 psi to 110 psi in all other markets.
An International Control and Display Symbol icon for Engine Oil is located on the cluster overlay,
directly below the left end of the gauge scale. The oil pressure gauge graphics are black against a
white field except for a single red graduation at the low end of the gauge scale making them clearly
visible within the instrument cluster in daylight. When illuminated from behind by the panel lamps
dimmer controlled cluster general illumination lighting with the exterior lamps turned ON, the black
graphics appear blue-green and the red graphics still appear red. The gauge needle has internal
optical illumination. Gauge illumination is provided by replaceable incandescent bulb and holder
units located on the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The oil pressure gauge is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3024
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The oil pressure gauge gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the engine oil pressure. This
gauge is controlled by the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and
electronic messages received by the cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on vehicles
with a gasoline engine, or from the Engine Control Module (ECM) on vehicles equipped with a
diesel engine over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The oil pressure gauge is an air core magnetic unit that receives battery current on the instrument
cluster electronic circuit board through the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit whenever
the ignition switch is in the ON or START positions. The cluster is programmed to move the gauge
needle back to the low end of the scale after the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position. The
instrument cluster circuitry controls the gauge needle position and provides the following features:
- Engine Oil Pressure Message - The instrument cluster circuitry restricts the oil pressure gauge
needle operation in order to provide readings that are consistent with customer expectations. Each
time the cluster receives an electronic engine oil pressure message from the PCM or ECM
indicating the pressure is above about 41 kPa (6 psi) the cluster holds the gauge needle at a point
near the middle increment within the normal range on the gauge scale.
- Engine Oil Pressure Low Message - Each time the cluster receives three consecutive electronic
engine oil pressure messages from the PCM or ECM indicating the pressure is below about 41 kPa
(6 psi), the gauge needle is moved to the red graduation at the far left end of the gauge scale, the
check gauges indicator is illuminated, and a single chime tone is generated. The gauge needle
remains at the left end of the gauge scale and the check gauges indicator remains illuminated until
the cluster receives a message from the PCM or ECM indicating that the pressure is above about
41 kPa (6 psi), or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The
cluster will only turn ON the check gauges indicator in response to a low pressure message if the
engine speed is greater than zero.
- Communication Error - If the cluster fails to receive an engine oil pressure message, it will hold
the gauge needle at the last indication for about 10 seconds, or until the ignition switch is turned to
the OFF position, whichever occurs first. After 10 seconds, the cluster will move the gauge needle
to the low end of the gauge scale.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the oil pressure gauge
needle will be swept to several calibration points on the gauge scale in a prescribed sequence in
order to confirm the functionality of the gauge and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM (gasoline engines) or ECM (diesel engines) continually monitors the engine oil pressure
sensor to determine the engine oil pressure. The PCM or ECM then sends the proper messages to
the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the oil pressure gauge or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the gauge refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing. If
the instrument cluster turns ON the check gauges indicator due to a low oil pressure gauge
reading, it may indicate that the engine or the engine oiling system requires service.
For proper diagnosis of the engine oil pressure sensor, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to oil pressure gauge operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3028
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3029
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3030
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3031
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3032
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3033
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3034
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3035
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3036
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When installing a new oil pressure switch, the kit will include a special 90° fitting that must
be installed. Clock the fitting and switch assembly between the 1:00 o'clock and 2:00 o'clock
position. Torque the fitting bolt to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs)
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector. 3.
Using a suitable socket, remove the oil pressure switch from the block (counter-clockwise). 4.
Remove the banjo screw from the oil pressure switch mounting block.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3039
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install banjo screw through the oil pressure switch mounting block. The switch mounting block
port (oil switch port) should point to the 2 o'clock
position. Torque the banjo screw to 24 Nm or 18 ft lbs.
2. If the switch is not being replaced, replace and lubricate the o-ring. 3. Install the oil pressure
switch and tighten to 18 Nm (159 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect oil pressure switch connector. 5.
Connect the battery negative cables. 6. Start engine and check for oil leaks at the switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3044
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3045
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3046
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3047
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3048
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3049
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3050
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3051
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3052
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3053
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3054
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3055
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3056
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3057
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3058
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3059
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3060
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3061
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil Pressure
Oil Pressure
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3066
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING-ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
1. Remove the 1/8 npt plug from the top of the oil filter housing. 2. Install Oil Pressure Line and
Gauge Tool C-3292 with a suitable adapter. 3. Start engine and warm to operating temperature. 4.
Record engine oil pressure and compare with engine oil pressure chart.
CAUTION: If engine oil pressure is zero at idle, DO NOT RUN THE ENGINE.
If minimum engine oil pressure is below these ranges, Refer to ENGINE - TESTING.
5. Remove oil pressure gauge and install the 1/8 npt plug.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications
Intake manifold capscrews to ..............................................................................................................
..................................................... 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures
Intake Manifold: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean manifold in solvent and blow dry with compressed air.
Clean cylinder block gasket surfaces using a suitable solvent.
The plenum pan rail must be clean and dry (free of all foreign material).
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect manifold for cracks.
Inspect mating surfaces of manifold for flatness with a straightedge.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 3072
Intake Manifold: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the batteries. 2. Disconnect the EGR air Transfer tube temperature sensor. 3.
Disconnect the EGR Valve Actuator Connector 4. Disconnect the Engine Oil level tube at the Air
Inlet bracket 5. Loosen the CAC Outlet tube clamps at the CAC Outlet and Air Inlet and remove the
tube. 6. Loosen and remove both v-band clamps at each end of the Air Transfer tube 7. Remove
the P-clip mounting capscrew 8. Remove the Air Transfer tube 9. Loosen and remove six (6) Air
Inlet mounting capscrews.
10. Remove the air inlet. 11. Remove the injector fuel lines. 12. Disconnect the Fuel Rail Pressure
sensor at the rear of the fuel rail manifold. 13. Remove the High Pressure fuel line from the
dump/overflow valve. 14. Remove the fuel rail. 15. Remove the grid heater wiring connector. 16.
Disconnect the TMAP sensor. 17. Remove the intake manifold capscrews. 18. Remove the intake
manifold.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean the Intake Manifold and Cylinder Head Gasket area. 2. Install a new intake manifold
gasket. 3. Position the intake manifold and Install the intake manifold capscrews finger tight. 4.
Position the fuel rail and install the fuel rail manifold capscrews finger tight. 5. Torque the intake
manifold capscrews to 24 N.m (18 ft. lbs.). 6. Connect the fuel rail pressure sensor. 7. Connect the
intake manifold grid heater. Torque the capscrew to 10 N.m (89 in. lbs.). 8. Install the fuel lines. 9.
Torque the fuel rail mounting capscrews to 24 N.m (18 ft. lbs.).
10. Clean the Air Inlet gasket area. 11. Clean the Intake Manifold to air inlet area. 12. Install the
new Air Intake connection gasket. 13. Install the air intake connection to the intake manifold 14.
torque the intake manifold to 24 N.m (18 lbs. ft.). 15. Install the Oil Level Gauge tube and torque to
24 N.m (18 lbs. ft.). 16. Clean the gasket area of the Air Transfer Tube (both ends). 17. Clean the
EGR cooler and EGR control valve gasket area. 18. Using new gaskets, install the Air Transfer
Tube. 19. Install the V-band clamps. 20. Install the P-clip to the bracket. Torque the mounting
capscrew to 24 N.m (18 lbs. ft.). 21. Torque the V-band clamps to 10 N.m (89 lbs. in.). 22. Connect
the EGR Valve Actuator connector. 23. Connect the EGR Gas Temperature connector. 24.
Connect the batteries. 25. Start the engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure Gauge
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An oil pressure gauge is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. This gauge is located in the
upper right quadrant of the instrument cluster, above the coolant temperature gauge. This gauge
consists of a movable gauge needle or pointer controlled by the instrument cluster circuitry and a
fixed 90 degree scale on the cluster overlay that reads left-to-right from L (or Low) to H (or High) for
gasoline engines. On vehicles with a diesel engine the scale reads from 0 kPa to 760 kPa in
markets where a metric instrument cluster is specified, or from 0 psi to 110 psi in all other markets.
An International Control and Display Symbol icon for Engine Oil is located on the cluster overlay,
directly below the left end of the gauge scale. The oil pressure gauge graphics are black against a
white field except for a single red graduation at the low end of the gauge scale making them clearly
visible within the instrument cluster in daylight. When illuminated from behind by the panel lamps
dimmer controlled cluster general illumination lighting with the exterior lamps turned ON, the black
graphics appear blue-green and the red graphics still appear red. The gauge needle has internal
optical illumination. Gauge illumination is provided by replaceable incandescent bulb and holder
units located on the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The oil pressure gauge is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure Gauge
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3078
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The oil pressure gauge gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the engine oil pressure. This
gauge is controlled by the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and
electronic messages received by the cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on vehicles
with a gasoline engine, or from the Engine Control Module (ECM) on vehicles equipped with a
diesel engine over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The oil pressure gauge is an air core magnetic unit that receives battery current on the instrument
cluster electronic circuit board through the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit whenever
the ignition switch is in the ON or START positions. The cluster is programmed to move the gauge
needle back to the low end of the scale after the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position. The
instrument cluster circuitry controls the gauge needle position and provides the following features:
- Engine Oil Pressure Message - The instrument cluster circuitry restricts the oil pressure gauge
needle operation in order to provide readings that are consistent with customer expectations. Each
time the cluster receives an electronic engine oil pressure message from the PCM or ECM
indicating the pressure is above about 41 kPa (6 psi) the cluster holds the gauge needle at a point
near the middle increment within the normal range on the gauge scale.
- Engine Oil Pressure Low Message - Each time the cluster receives three consecutive electronic
engine oil pressure messages from the PCM or ECM indicating the pressure is below about 41 kPa
(6 psi), the gauge needle is moved to the red graduation at the far left end of the gauge scale, the
check gauges indicator is illuminated, and a single chime tone is generated. The gauge needle
remains at the left end of the gauge scale and the check gauges indicator remains illuminated until
the cluster receives a message from the PCM or ECM indicating that the pressure is above about
41 kPa (6 psi), or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The
cluster will only turn ON the check gauges indicator in response to a low pressure message if the
engine speed is greater than zero.
- Communication Error - If the cluster fails to receive an engine oil pressure message, it will hold
the gauge needle at the last indication for about 10 seconds, or until the ignition switch is turned to
the OFF position, whichever occurs first. After 10 seconds, the cluster will move the gauge needle
to the low end of the gauge scale.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the oil pressure gauge
needle will be swept to several calibration points on the gauge scale in a prescribed sequence in
order to confirm the functionality of the gauge and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM (gasoline engines) or ECM (diesel engines) continually monitors the engine oil pressure
sensor to determine the engine oil pressure. The PCM or ECM then sends the proper messages to
the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the oil pressure gauge or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the gauge refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing. If
the instrument cluster turns ON the check gauges indicator due to a low oil pressure gauge
reading, it may indicate that the engine or the engine oiling system requires service.
For proper diagnosis of the engine oil pressure sensor, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to oil pressure gauge operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Remove the transmission and transfer case (if
equipped). 3. Remove the clutch cover and disc (if manual transmission equipped). 4. Remove the
flywheel or converter drive plate. 5. Remove the flywheel adapter plate. 6. Drill holes 180° apart
into the seal. Be careful not to contact the drill against the crankshaft. 7. Install #10 sheet metal
screws (1) in the drilled holes and remove the rear seal with a slide hammer (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3084
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The seal lip and the sealing surface on the crankshaft must be free from all oil residue
to prevent seal leaks. The crankshaft and seal surfaces must be completely dry when the seal is
installed. Use a soap and water solution on outside diameter of seal to ease assembly.
1. Clean the crankshaft journal with a suitable solvent and dry with a clean shop towel or
compressed air. Wipe the inside bore of the crankshaft seal
retainer with a clean shop towel.
2. Inspect the crankshaft journal for gouges, nicks, or other imperfections. If the seal groove in the
crankshaft is excessively deep, install the new seal
1/8" deeper into the retainer bore, or obtain a crankshaft wear sleeve that is available in the
aftermarket.
3. Install the seal pilot and new seal, provided in the replacement kit, onto the crankshaft. 4.
Remove the seal pilot. 5. Install the installation tool over crankshaft.
6. Using a ball peen hammer, strike the tool (2) at the 12, 3, 6, and 9 o'clock positions until the
alignment tool bottoms out on the retainer.
NOTE: Always install a new clamping ring, never reuse the old clamping ring.
7. Install the flywheel or converter drive plate, and clamping ring. Tighten the bolts to 137 Nm (101
ft. lbs.) torque. 8. Install the clutch cover and disc (if equipped). 9. Install the transmission and
transfer case (if equipped).
10. Lower vehicle. 11. Connect battery negative cables. 12. Check engine oil level and adjust, if
necessary. 13. Start engine and check for oil leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect both battery negative cables. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially drain engine
coolant into container suitable for re-use. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Remove radiator upper hose. 6.
Disconnect coolant recovery bottle hose from radiator filler neck. 7. Disconnect windshield washer
pump supply hose and electrical connections and lift washer bottle off of fan shroud. 8. Remove
viscous fan/drive assembly. 9. Remove cooling fan shroud and fan assembly from the vehicle.
10. Remove the accessory drive belt. 11. Remove the cooling fan support/hub from the front of the
engine. 12. Raise the vehicle on hoist. 13. Remove the crankshaft damper. 14. Remove power
steering pump. 15. Remove accessory drive belt tensioner.
16. Remove the gear cover-to-housing bolts and gently pry the cover away from the housing,
taking care not to mar the gasket surfaces. Remove crank
seal dust shield with cover.
17. Support the cover on a flat work surface with wooden blocks, and using a suitable punch (1)
and hammer, drive the old seal out of the cover from
the back side of the cover to the front side.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3089
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: The seal lip and the sealing surface on the crankshaft must be free of all oil residue, to
prevent leaks. The crankshaft and seal surface must be completely dry when the seal is installed.
1. Clean cover and housing gasket mating surfaces. Use a suitable scraper and be careful not to
damage the gear housing surface. Remove any old
sealer from the oil seal bore. Thoroughly clean the front seal area of the crankshaft. Do not sand
this surface. The seal lip and the sealing surface on the crankshaft must be free from all oil residue
to prevent seal leaks.
2. Inspect the gear housing and cover for cracks and replace if necessary. Carefully straighten any
bends or imperfections in the gear cover with a
ball-peen hammer on a flat surface. Inspect the crankshaft front journal for any grooves or nicks
that would affect the integrity of the new seal.
3. Apply a bead of Mopar(R) Stud & Bearing Mount to the outside diameter of the seal. Do not
lubricate the inside diameter of the new seal. 4. With the cover supported by wood blocks, install
the seal into the rear of the cover using crankshaft seal installer Special Tool 8281 and driver
handle C-4171. Strike the driver handle until the installation tool bottoms out on the inside of the
cover.
CAUTION: Do not distort or damage seal.
5. Install the plastic seal pilot (provided with seal kit) into the crankshaft seal. 6. Apply a bead of
Mopar(R) Silicone Rubber Adhesive Sealant or equivalent to the gear housing cover sealing
surface. 7. Install the cover to the gear housing, aligning the seal pilot with the nose of the
crankshaft.
NOTE: Failure to follow the cover installation procedure can result in misalignment of the
crankshaft seal to the crankshaft, causing an oil leak.
8. Install the cover bolts and hand snug 2 capscrews at the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock position, to keep
the cover from moving when the first capscrew is
torqued. Torque to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. Remove pilot tool.
9. Install dust shield over nose of crankshaft.
10. Install the crankshaft damper. Torque the bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). Then rotate an additional
60°. Use the engine barring tool to keep the engine
from rotating during tightening operation.
11. Install the fan support/hub assembly and torque bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3090
12. Install power steering pump. 13. Install accessory drive belt tensioner. Torque bolt to 43 Nm (32
ft.lbs.). 14. Install cooling fan. 15. Install the accessory drive belt. 16. Refill cooling system. 17.
Connect battery negative cables. 18. Start engine and check for oil leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Oil Pan Gasket, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pan Gasket: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the intake air assembly. 3. Remove the inner radiator shroud
retaining bolts. 4. Remove the inner radiator shroud. 5. Raise and support the vehicle. 6. Remove
the front suspension rear tie bar. 7. Remove the left engine mount through bolt. 8. Remove the
right engine mount through bolt. 9. Remove the rack and pinion retaining bolts.
10. Drain the engine oil. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. Install the engine lift fixture. 13. Use the engine
lift fixture to raise the engine. 14. Raise the vehicle on the hoist. 15. Remove the oil pan retaining
bolts. 16. Lower the oil pan enough to allow the removal of the oil pan gasket. 17. Remove the oil
pan gasket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Oil Pan Gasket, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3095
Oil Pan Gasket: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean the oil pan gasket surfaces to be sure the surfaces are free of debris and oil. 2. Install a
new oil pan gasket. 3. Install the oil pan bolts in a cross pattern. 4. Install the rack and pinion bolts.
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Lower the engine into the mounts. 7. Remove the engine lift fixture. 8. Fill
the engine with oil. 9. Raise and support the vehicle.
10. Install the left engine mount through bolt. 11. Install the right engine mount through bolt. 12.
Install the front suspension rear tie bolts. 13. Lower the vehicle. 14. Install the radiator shroud. 15.
Install the radiator shroud bolts. 16. Install the intake air assembly. 17. Connect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations
Oil Pressure Sender: Locations
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3100
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3101
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3102
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3103
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3104
Oil Pressure Sender: Diagrams
Component ID: 473
Component : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-OIL PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
Pin Description Circuit
1 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
2-Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3105
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3106
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3107
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Locations > Page 3108
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: When installing a new oil pressure switch, the kit will include a special 90° fitting that must
be installed. Clock the fitting and switch assembly between the 1:00 o'clock and 2:00 o'clock
position. Torque the fitting bolt to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs)
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector. 3.
Using a suitable socket, remove the oil pressure switch from the block (counter-clockwise). 4.
Remove the banjo screw from the oil pressure switch mounting block.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3111
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install banjo screw through the oil pressure switch mounting block. The switch mounting block
port (oil switch port) should point to the 2 o'clock
position. Torque the banjo screw to 24 Nm or 18 ft lbs.
2. If the switch is not being replaced, replace and lubricate the o-ring. 3. Install the oil pressure
switch and tighten to 18 Nm (159 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect oil pressure switch connector. 5.
Connect the battery negative cables. 6. Start engine and check for oil leaks at the switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3116
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3117
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3118
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3119
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3120
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3121
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3122
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3123
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3124
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3125
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3126
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3127
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3128
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3129
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3130
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3131
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3132
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3133
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Component Alignment
Marks > Component Information > Locations
Timing Component Alignment Marks: Locations
Install the camshaft. Align the crankshaft and camshaft gear marks as shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Tighten the bolts at the 3 and 9 o'clock position finger tight, then in a clockwise direction starting at
the 3 o'clock position, torque to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Case - Front
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Case - Front
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially drain engine
coolant into container suitable for re-use. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Remove radiator upper hose. 6.
Disconnect coolant recovery bottle hose from radiator filler neck. 7. Remove viscous
fan/drive/shroud assembly. 8. Remove the accessory drive belt. 9. Remove the cooling fan
support/hub from the front of the engine.
10. Raise the vehicle on hoist. 11. Remove the crankshaft damper. 12. Remove the lower fan
shroud bracket. 13. Remove the upper fan shroud bracket that is mounted to the gear housing. 14.
Lower the vehicle. 15. Remove the power steering pump. 16. Remove the accessory drive belt
tensioner. 17. Remove the gear cover-to-housing bolts and gently pry the cover away from the
housing, taking care not to mar the gasket surfaces. 18. Remove the fuel injection pump. 19.
Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector. 20. Disconnect and remove engine speed
sensor. 21. Remove the camshaft. 22. Remove the six front oil pan fasteners. 23. Remove the gear
housing fasteners.
NOTE: Use care when removing the gear housing, to avoid damage to the oil pan gasket, as the
gasket will be reused if it is not damaged.
24. Slide a feeler gauge between the gear housing and oil pan gasket, to break the gasket seal. 25.
Remove the gear housing and gasket. 26. Clean the gasket material from the cylinder block and
gear housing.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect oil pan gasket. If torn, gasket must be replaced. 2. Install a new gear housing gasket
onto cylinder block and trim any excess gasket material flush to oil pan rail.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Case - Front > Page 3143
3. Place a small amount of Mopar(R) engine RTV to the corners of the block and pan gasket T-joint
to ensure a good seal. 4. Install the gear housing. Torque bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 5. If a new
housing is installed, the camshaft position sensor, and engine speed sensor must be transferred to
the new housing. 6. Connect the camshaft position sensor connector. 7. Install and connect engine
speed sensor. 8. Install the injection pump.
9. Install the camshaft. Align the crankshaft and camshaft gear marks as shown.
10. Install a new front crankshaft seal into the gear cover. 11. Apply a bead of Mopar(R) Silicone
Rubber Adhesive Sealant or equivalent to the gear housing cover. Be sure to surround all through
holes. 12. Using the seal pilot to align the cover, install the cover to the housing and install the
bolts. Tighten the bolts at the 3 and 9 o'clock position finger
tight, then in a clockwise direction starting at the 3 o'clock position, torque to 24 Nm (18 Ft lbs).
13. Snug, but do not torque one bolt at the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions. This center's the seal
on the crankshaft. 14. Tighten the bolt to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque in a circular pattern. 15.
Remove the seal pilot. Install front seal dust shield. 16. Raise the vehicle. 17. Install the crankshaft
damper. Torque bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.), plus an additional 60°. 18. Install the lower fan shroud
bracket. Torque bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. 19. Install the upper fan shroud brackets. Hand
tighten only. 20. Lower vehicle. 21. Install the fan support/hub assembly and tighten bolts to 32 Nm
(24 ft. lbs.) torque. 22. Install the power steering pump. 23. Install the accessory drive belt
tensioner. Torque bolt to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) torque. 24. Install the accessory drive belt. 25. Install
the upper cooling fan/drive/shroud assembly. 26. Torque the upper fan shroud brackets to 24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.) torque. 27. Connect the coolant recovery bottle hose to the radiator filler neck. 28.
Install the radiator upper hose and clamps. 29. Add engine oil. 30. Add coolant. 31. Connect the
battery cables. 32. Start engine and inspect for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Case - Front > Page 3144
Timing Cover: Service and Repair Cover - Timing
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect both battery negative cables. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Partially drain engine
coolant into container suitable for re-use. 4. Lower vehicle. 5. Remove radiator upper hose. 6.
Remove viscous fan/drive/shroud assembly. 7. Remove the accessory drive belt. 8. Remove the
cooling fan support/hub from the front of the engine. 9. Raise the vehicle on hoist.
10. Remove power steering pump. 11. Remove accessory drive belt tensioner. 12. Remove the
crankshaft damper. 13. Lower the vehicle. 14. Remove the gear cover-to-housing bolts and gently
pry the cover away from the housing, taking care not to mar the gasket surfaces.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new front crankshaft oil seal. 2. Obtain a seal pilot (1) installation tool from a crankshaft
front seal service kit and install the pilot into the seal. 3. Apply a bead of Mopar(R) Silicone Rubber
Adhesive Sealant or equivalent to the gear housing cover. Be sure to surround all through holes. 4.
Using the seal pilot to (1) align the cover , install the cover to the housing and install the bolts.
Tighten the bolts at the 3 and 9 o'clock position
finger tight, then in a clockwise direction starting at the 3 o'clock position, torque to 24 Nm (18 Ft.
lbs).
5. Snug, but do not torque one bolt at the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions. This centers the seal on
the crankshaft. 6. Tighten the bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) in a circular pattern. 7. Remove the seal
pilot. Install front seal dust shield. 8. Raise the vehicle. 9. Install the crankshaft damper.
10. Lower vehicle. 11. Install the fan support/hub assy, and tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.)
torque. 12. Install power steering pump. 13. Install accessory drive belt tensioner. Torque bolt to 43
Nm (32 ft. lbs.) torque. 14. Install the accessory drive belt. 15. Install the cooling fan/drive/shroud
assembly. 16. Install the radiator upper hose and clamps. 17. Add coolant. 18. Connect the battery
cables. 19. Start engine and inspect for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURES
Fuel Pump/Gear Pump (low pressure)
................................................................................................................................ 551.5 - 1241 KPA
(80 - 180 psi)
Injection Pump .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 200 - 1800 bar (2900 - 26107 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
*FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
1. FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
Using the scan tool, idle the engine and measure the rail pressure and determine if the rail
pressure is excessive (above 185,00 kpa/26,831 psi). If it is, troubleshoot for excessive rail
pressure first.
Remove the banjo bolt from the pressure-limiting valve on the fuel rail.
Install fuel system test fitting 9013 into the pressure-limiting valve.
Attach one end of a fuel hose to the fuel fitting and put the other end of the fuel hose into a
container
Perform the tests listed below to determine if the pressure-limiting valve is leaking.
a. Operate the engine at idle and watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
b. Operate the engine at idle and actuate the high pressure safety valve test with the scan tool.
Watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
If fuel flows into the fuel container, replace the pressure-limiting valve. If fuel does not leak from the
pressure-limiting valve, the test is complete.
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with any portion of this test kit installed
Operate the engine until the engine is at operating temperature.
Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing
Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and put the open end into the graduated cylinder .
Start the engine and let it idle for one minute.
Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
If the flow is less than 1000ml/minute at idle, the test has successfully passed.
If the flow is greater than 1000ml/minute at idle, replace the fuel injection pump.
Retest to confirm repair.
View Repair
Repair
- Test Complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 3151
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection High Pressure Fuel Pump Performance Test
*HIGH PRESSURE FUEL PUMP PERFORMANCE TEST
If the engine will run do the following:
1. Monitor rail pressure with scan tool while the engine is at idle.
2. Compare the fuel pressure set point with the actual fuel pressure reading.
3. If actual fuel pressure reading fluctuates more than ± 500 psi from the set point, then replace the
Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
NOTE: After the actuator is removed, check for debris or corrosion on the FCA. If debris or
corrosion is found, replace the entire Fuel Injection Pump.
4. Turn off engine.
5. Disconnect the FCA harness
6. Disconnect high pressure fuel line from fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
8. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 second intervals (Note: This will give you 30 total seconds of
flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals to prevent damage to the starter). Fuel flow
specification s based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of fuel in 30
seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
If the engine is a no start do the following:
1. Remove fuel pump to rail high pressure fuel line.
2. Inspect the fuel pump outlet port for rust, debris, or other signs of contamination.
3. Replace pump if any contamination is found. Check for source of water in fuel or debris in fuel to
prevent future complaints. If no contamination is found continue to step 4.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
5. Disconnect the high pressure fuel line from the fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line to a
graduated cylinder.
6. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
7. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 seconds intervals.
NOTE: This will give you 30 total seconds of flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals
to prevent damage to the starter.
Fuel flow specification's based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of
fuel in 30 seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 3152
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection In-Tank Fuel Lift Pump Flow/Diagnostic Test Procedure
*IN-TANK FUEL LIFT PUMP FLOW/DIAGNOSTIC TEST PROCEDURE
1. Using the Scan tool, check for DTCs. Troubleshoot any active DTCs before performing this test.
2. Disconnect the wiring harness from the lift pump at the fuel tank module connector and inspect
the pins for damage. Fix or replace any damaged component.
3. Connect a voltmeter between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module
connector.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Use the Scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump, record the
voltage on the voltmeter.
5. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 14. If the voltage is less than 11.5 volts, go to
step 6
6. Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage to determine that the voltage is greater than 11.5
volts. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 7. If the voltage is not greater than 11.5
volts, troubleshoot for low battery voltage.
7. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage at the fuel
lift pump relay voltage supply pin in the PDC. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 8.
If the voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, fix or replace the harness.
8. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Install a spare relay in place of the fuel lift pump
relay. Using the Scan tool, actuate the fuel lift pump. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage
between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module connector while the fuel
lift pump is actuated. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, replace the fuel lift pump relay. If the
voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 9.
9. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the lift pump relay from the
PDC. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the resistance of the fuel lift pump power supply wire between
the PDC relay output pin and the fuel tank module connector. If the resistance is less than 10
ohms, go to step 10. If it is greater than 10 ohms, fix or replace the harness.
10. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between battery negative and the fuel lift pump
power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the voltage is less than 1 volt, go to step 11. If
the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between battery negative and the fuel lift
pump power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, fix or
replace the harness. If the resistance is greater than 10 ohms, go to step 12.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the
resistance of the fuel lift pump ground wire between the fuel tank module connector and battery
negative. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, go to step 13. If the resistance is greater than 10
ohms, fix or replace the harness.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using a voltmeter, measure the
voltage between the fuel lift pump ground wire and battery negative. If the voltage is less than 1
volt, go to step 14. If the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
14. Reconnect the lift pump connector.
FLOW TEST.
1. Remove the fuel pump supply banjo fitting from the fuel injection pump.
2. Install fuel system test fitting 9863 onto the end of the quick connect line going to the fuel
injection pump.
3. Connect one end of a section of fuel hose to the test fitting.
4. Put the other end of the fuel hose into an empty fuel container.
5. Use the scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump.
6. While the lift pump is running, move the fuel hose from the fuel canister into a 1000ml graduated
cylinder for 10 seconds.
7. Read and record the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds.
8. If you have more than 570ml in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds, the test has
successfully passed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 3153
9. If you have less than 570ml of fuel in the graduated cylinder, inspect the fuel supply line from the
fuel tank to the fuel filter housing and the fuel supply line between the fuel filter housing and the
high pressure fuel pump for signs of damage, replace as necessary. If no damage is found, replace
the fuel filter and retest.
10.Verify the Screened Banjo Bolt at the outlet of the fuel filter is free of debris. If debris is found,
rinse screen with water, blow dry and reinstall. Retest vehicle. If flow meets specification then trace
back the source of debris, if flow is still below spec repair damaged component.
11. If reading is still less than 570ml in 10 seconds, remove the fuel tank and fuel tank module.
Inspect for damage and/or debris in and around the fuel tank module. If module is damaged,
replace and retest.
12. If the module is not damaged, replace the fuel lift pump and retest to confirm fix.
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures/Verification Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by manufacturer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Testing Air Cleaner Element using Filter Minder(TM)
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove top of air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
The air cleaner (filter) housing (5) is equipped with an air Filter Minder(TM) gauge (3). This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
The Filter Minder(TM) (5) consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic
housing. A yellow colored disc (2) attached to diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on side of
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within Filter Minder will
hold yellow disc at highest restriction that air cleaner element has experienced. A drop in air
pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves diaphragm and yellow disc will indicate
size of air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage plastic housing of Filter
Minder. Cover and tape Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be used.
To test, turn engine off. If yellow disc (2) has reached red colored zone (3) on graduated scale, air
cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to Removal / Installation.
Resetting Filter Minder: After air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press rubber button on
top of Filter Minder. This will allow yellow
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3162
colored disc to reset. After button has been pressed, yellow disc should spring back to UP position.
If Filter Minder gauge has reached red colored zone, and after an examination of air cleaner (filter)
element, element appears to be clean, high reading may be due to a temporary condition such as
snow build-up at air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also occur if air cleaner (filter) element
has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow element to dry out during
normal engine operation. Reset rubber button on top of Filter Minder and retest after element has
dried.
Filter Removal
1. The housing cover is equipped with spring clips and is hinged with plastic tabs. Unlatch clips
from top of air cleaner housing and tilt housing cover
up for cover removal.
2. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3163
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing new air cleaner element (filter), clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position
air cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch spring clips to seal cover to housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit >
Page 3168
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit >
Page 3169
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Severe Duty Filtration Kit Availability
NUMBER: 14-001-09
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: January 24, 2009
SUBJECT: Severe Duty Fuel Filtration Mopar Add On Kit Available
MODELS:
2005 - 2009 (D1/DH) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2009 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2005
model year and D1/DH/DC vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins engine built from 2007 model
year.
DISCUSSION: A frame mounted supplemental filter kit is now available for the vehicles listed
above. This kit includes complete instructions (K6855569AC) with all necessary components and
wiring to upgrade fuel filtering to a severe duty rating.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filters (on engine filter and added chassis mounted severe
duty fuel filtration kit filter) are 15,000 miles.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3172
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3175
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3176
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3177
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3178
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3179
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
DESCRIPTION
The cylinder block is constructed of cast iron. The casting is a skirted design which incorporates
longitudal ribs for superior strength and noise reduction. The block incorporates metric straight
thread o-ring fittings at lubrication oil access points. The engine is manufactured with the cylinders
being a non-sleeved type cylinder.
The cylinders are numbered front to rear ; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > System Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing is not adjustable on any engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure (Minimum) ......................................................................................................
...................................................................... 350 psi.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 3189
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION/LEAKAGE TESTS
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure batteries are completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise, the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnostic
purposes.
1. Disconnect the fuel inlet line to the fuel filter housing. Plug the fuel line from the fuel tank.
NOTE: Failure to plug fuel line will result in fuel leak.
2. Remove fuel transfer pump relay from PDC. 3. Start the engine and idle until the engine stalls
(runs out of fuel). 4. Remove the cylinder head cover. 5. Remove the cylinder head cover carrier
gasket. 6. Remove the high pressure fuel line between the cylinder head and fuel rail for the
cylinder to be tested. Use tool 9864 to cap this fuel rail on the
cylinder being tested.
7. Remove the fuel connector tube nut and fuel connector tube. 8. Remove the exhaust rocker
lever. 9. Use Tool 9010 to remove the injector and copper sealing washer.
10. Install the exhaust rocker lever and torque to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 11. Cover the remaining rocker
levers with clean shop towels to prevent any oil splatter under the hood. 12. Place a rag over the
compression test tool fitting. Crank the engine for 2-3 seconds to purge any fuel that may have
drained into the cylinder when
the injector was removed.
13. Connect the compression test gauge. 14. Crank the engine for 5 seconds and record the
pressure reading. Repeat this step three times and calculate the average of the three readings.
NOTE: The minimum cylinder pressure is 350 psi. Cylinder pressure should be within 20% from
cylinder to cylinder.
15. Combustion pressure leakage can be checked if cylinder pressure is below the specification.
Perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder
according to the tester manufacturer instructions.
16. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related fault codes.
CYLINDER COMBUSTION PRESSURE LEAKAGE
The combustion pressure leakage test provides an accurate means for determining engine
condition.
Combustion pressure leakage testing will detect:
- Exhaust and intake valve leaks (improper seating).
- Leaks between adjacent cylinders or into water jacket.
- Any causes for combustion/compression pressure loss
1. Start and operate the engine until it attains normal operating temperature. 2. Disconnect injector
harness connectors. 3. Disconnect CCV tube and breather drain tube from valve cover. 4. Remove
the cylinder head cover. 5. Disconnect harness from injectors. 6. Remove the cylinder head cover
carrier gasket. 7. Bring the cylinder to be tested to TDC. 8. Remove the high pressure fuel line
between the cylinder head and the fuel rail for the cylinder to be tested. 9. Install capping Tool 9864
onto the rail.
10. Remove the high pressure connector nut and high pressure connector with Tool 9015. 11.
Remove the exhaust and intake rocker lever. 12. Use Tool # 9010 to remove the injector and
copper sealing washer. 13. Install compression test Tool # 9007 into the injector bore. 14. Connect
the leakage tester and perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder according to the tester
manufacturer's instructions. 15. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related
fault codes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Adjustments
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE LASH ADJUSTMENT AND VERIFICATION
NOTE: To obtain accurate readings, valve lash measurements AND adjustments should only be
performed when the engine coolant temperature is less than 60°C (140°F).
The 24-valve overhead system is a "low-maintenance" design. Routine adjustments are no longer
necessary, however, measurement should still take place when troubleshooting performance
problems, or upon completion of a repair that includes removal and installation of the valve train
components or injectors.
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Using the crankshaft
barring tool #7471-B, rotate crankshaft to align damper TDC mark to 12:00 o'clock position.
a. If both number one cylinder rocker levers are loose, continue to next step. b. If both number one
cylinder rocker levers are not loose, rotate crankshaft 360 degrees.
4. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be measured at the following rocker arms:
INTAKE 1-2-4 / EXHAUST 1-3-5. Measure the valve
lash by inserting a feeler gauge between the rocker arm socket and crosshead. Refer to VALVE
LASH LIMIT CHART for the correct specifications. If the measurement falls within the limits,
adjustment/resetting is not necessary. If measurement finds the lash outside of the limits,
adjustment/resetting is required.
Valve Lash Limit Chart
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Adjustments > Page 3193
5. If adjustment/resetting is required, loosen the lock nut on rocker arms and turn the adjusting
screw until the desired lash is obtained:
- INTAKE 0.254 mm (0.010 in.)
- EXHAUST 0.660 mm (0.026 in.) Tighten the lock nut to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) and recheck the valve
lash.
6. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the crankshaft one revolution (360°) to align the damper
TDC mark to the 12 o'clock position. 7. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be
measured at the remaining rocker arms: INTAKE 3-5-6 / EXHAUST 2-4-6. Use the same
method as above for determining whether adjustment is necessary, and adjust those that are found
to be outside of the limits.
8. Install the cylinder head cover. 9. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Install water pump with the weep hole facing downward. Tighten mounting bolts to
............................................................................. 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Water Pump
Water Pump: Description and Operation Water Pump
Description
WATER PUMP
A centrifugal water pump circulates coolant through the water jackets, passages, intake manifold,
radiator core, cooling system hoses and heater core. The pump is driven from the engine
crankshaft by a single serpentine drive belt.
The water pump impeller is pressed onto the rear of a shaft that rotates in bearings pressed into
the housing. The housing has two small holes to allow seepage to escape. The water pump seals
are lubricated by the antifreeze in the coolant mixture. No additional lubrication is necessary.
Operation
WATER PUMP
A centrifugal water pump circulates coolant through the water jackets, passages, intake manifold,
radiator core, cooling system hoses and heater core, this coolant absorbs the heat generated when
the engine is running. The pump is driven by the engine crankshaft via a drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Water Pump > Page 3199
Water Pump: Description and Operation Water Pump Bypass
Description
WATER PUMP BYPASS
The 3.7L and 4.7L engine uses an internal water/coolant bypass system. The design uses galleries
in the timing chain cover to circulate coolant during engine warm-up preventing the coolant from
flowing through the radiator.
Operation - 3.7L/4.7L
WATER PUMP BYPASS - 3.7L/4.7L
When the thermostat is in the closed position the bypass gallery is not obstructed allowing 100%
flow. When the thermostat is in the open position the pill partially covers the bypass hole, reducing
the amount of bypass flow. This design allows the coolant to reach operating temperature quickly
when cold, while adding extra cooling during normal temperature operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3200
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
WATER PUMP
A quick test to determine if pump is working is to check if heater warms properly. A defective water
pump will not be able to circulate heated coolant through the long heater hose to the heater core.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures
Water Pump: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean the gasket mating surface. Use caution not to damage the gasket sealing surface.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the water pump assembly for cracks in the housing, water leaks from shaft seal, worn
bearing or impeller rubbing either the pump body or timing chain case/cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 3203
Water Pump: Removal and Replacement
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Drain cooling system. 3. Disconnect ambient air temp
sensor electrical connector and mass airflow sensor electrical connector (if equipped). 4. Remove
turbocharger inlet tube and air filter housing. 5. Remove generator assembly. 6. Remove the
accessory drive belt. 7. Remove water pump mounting bolts (3). 8. Remove O-ring from water
pump. 9. Clean water pump sealing surface on cylinder block.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Install new O-ring seal in groove on water pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Procedures > Page 3204
2. Install water pump with the weep hole facing downward. Tighten mounting bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft.
lbs.) torque. 3. Install generator assembly. 4. Install accessory drive belt. 5. Install air box and tube
assembly. 6. Install air filter housing. 7. Fill cooling system. 8. Connect both battery cables. 9. Start
and warm the engine. Check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 3210
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Engine Coolant Capacity .....................................................................................................................
........................................................ 22.6 qts (21.4L)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3213
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Mopar Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula HOAT (Hybrid Organic Additive
Technology) or equivalent.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Coolant: Description and Operation Description
Coolant
COOLANT
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene glycol base coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek
medical attention immediately. Do not store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and
clothing thoroughly after coming in contact with ethylene glycol. Keep out of reach of children.
Dispose of glycol base coolant properly, contact your dealer or government agency for location of
collection center in your area. Do not open a cooling system when the engine is at operating
temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when
engine compartment related service is performed, personal injury can result.
ETHYLENE-GLYCOL MIXTURES
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethylene-glycol.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Only Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year 100,000 Mile Formula (ethylene-glycol base
coolant with corrosion inhibitors called HOAT, for Hybrid Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% distilled water
to obtain a freeze point of -37°C (-35°F).
The required ethylene-glycol (antifreeze) and water mixture depends upon the climate and vehicle
operating conditions. The antifreeze concentration must always be a minimum of 44 percent,
year-round in all climates. If percentage is lower than 44 percent, engine parts may be eroded by
cavitation, and cooling system components may be severely damaged by corrosion. Maximum
protection against freezing is provided with a 68% antifreeze concentration, which prevents
freezing down to -67.7°C (-90°F). A higher percentage will freeze at a warmer temperature. Also, a
higher percentage of antifreeze can cause the engine to overheat because the specific heat of
antifreeze is lower than that of water.
Use of 100 percent ethylene-glycol will cause formation of additive deposits in the system, as the
corrosion inhibitive additives in ethylene-glycol require the presence of water to dissolve. The
deposits act as insulation, causing temperatures to rise to as high as 149°C (300°F). This
temperature is hot enough to melt plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result
in engine detonation. In addition, 100 percent ethylene-glycol freezes at 22°C (-8°F).
PROPYLENE-GLYCOL MIXTURES
It's overall effective temperature range is smaller than that of ethylene-glycol. The freeze point of
50/50 propylene-glycol and water is -32°C (-26°F). 5° C higher than ethylene-glycol's freeze point.
The boiling point (protection against summer boil-over) of propylene-glycol is 125°C (257°F) at 96.5
kPa (14 psi), compared to 128°C (263°F) for ethylene-glycol. Use of propylene-glycol can result in
boil-over or freeze-up on a cooling system designed for ethylene-glycol. Propylene- glycol also has
poorer heat transfer characteristics than ethylene-glycol. This can increase cylinder head
temperatures under certain conditions.
Propylene-glycol/ethylene-glycol Mixtures can cause the destabilization of various corrosion
inhibitors, causing damage to the various cooling system components. Also, once ethylene-glycol
and propylene-glycol based coolants are mixed in the vehicle, conventional methods of determining
freeze point will not be accurate. Both the refractive index and specific gravity differ between
ethylene glycol and propylene-glycol.
HOAT Coolant
HOAT COOLANT
WARNING: Antifreeze is an ethylene-glycol base coolant and is harmful if swallowed or inhaled. If
swallowed, drink two glasses of water and induce vomiting. If inhaled, move to fresh air area. Seek
medical attention immediately. Do not store in open or unmarked containers. Wash skin and
clothing thoroughly after coming in contact with ethylene-glycol. Keep out of reach of children.
Dispose of glycol base coolant properly, contact your dealer or government agency for location of
collection center in your area. Do not open a cooling system when the engine is at operating
temperature or hot under pressure, personal injury can result. Avoid radiator cooling fan when
engine compartment related service is performed, personal injury can result.
CAUTION: Use of Propylene-Glycol based coolants is not recommended, as they provide less
freeze protection and less corrosion protection.
The cooling system is designed around the coolant. The coolant must accept heat from engine
metal, in the cylinder head area near the exhaust valves and engine block. Then coolant carries the
heat to the radiator where the tube/fin radiator can transfer the heat to the air.
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads, and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769), or the
equivalent ethylene-glycol base coolant with organic corrosion inhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 3216
Organic Additive Technology) is recommended. This coolant offers the best engine cooling without
corrosion when mixed with 50% ethylene-glycol and 50% distilled water to obtain a freeze point of
-37°C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush, and replace with fresh
properly mixed coolant solution.
CAUTION: Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (MS-9769) may not be
mixed with any other type of antifreeze. Mixing of coolants other than specified (non-HOAT or other
HOAT), may result in engine damage that may not be covered under the new vehicle warranty, and
decreased corrosion protection.
COOLANT PERFORMANCE
The required ethylene-glycol and water mixture depends upon climate and vehicle operating
conditions. The coolant performance of various mixtures follows:
Pure Water- Water can absorb more heat than a mixture of water and ethylene-glycol. This is for
purpose of heat transfer only. Water also freezes at a higher temperature and allows corrosion.
100 percent Ethylene-Glycol - The corrosion inhibiting additives in ethylene-glycol need the
presence of water to dissolve. Without water, additives form deposits in system. These act as
insulation causing temperature to rise to as high as 149°C (300°F). This temperature is hot enough
to melt plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result in engine detonation. In
addition, 100 percent ethylene-glycol freezes at -22°C (-8°F).
50/50 Ethylene-Glycol and Water - Is the recommended mixture, it provides protection against
freezing to -37°C (-34°F). The antifreeze concentration must always be a minimum of 44 percent,
year-round in all climates. If percentage is lower, engine parts may be eroded by cavitation.
Maximum protection against freezing is provided with a 68 percent antifreeze concentration, which
prevents freezing down to -67.7°C (-90°F). A higher percentage will freeze at a warmer
temperature. Also, a higher percentage of antifreeze can cause the engine to overheat because
specific heat of antifreeze is lower than that of water.
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethylene-glycol.
COOLANT SELECTION AND ADDITIVES
The use of aluminum cylinder blocks, cylinder heads and water pumps requires special corrosion
protection. Only Mopar(R) Antifreeze/Coolant, 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula (glycol base coolant
with corrosion inhibitors called HOAT, for Hybrid Organic Additive Technology) is recommended.
This coolant offers the best engine cooling without corrosion when mixed with 50% distilled water
to obtain a freeze point of -37 °C (-35°F). If it loses color or becomes contaminated, drain, flush,
and replace with fresh properly mixed coolant solution.
CAUTION: Do not use coolant additives that are claimed to improve engine cooling.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 3217
Coolant: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Coolant flows through the engine block, cylinder head, absorbing the heat from the engine, then
flows to the radiator where the cooling fins in the radiator transfers the heat from the coolant to the
atmosphere. On the 6.7L diesel engine, coolant also flows through the EGR cooler and
turbocharger actuator. During cold weather the ethylene-glycol or propylene-glycol coolant
prevents water present in the cooling system from freezing within temperatures indicated by
mixture ratio of coolant to water.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3218
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CONCENTRATION TESTING
Coolant concentration should be checked when any additional coolant was added to system or
after a coolant drain, flush and refill. The coolant mixture offers optimum engine cooling and
protection against corrosion when mixed to a freeze point of -37°C (-34°F) to -46°C (-50°F). The
use of a hydrometer or Tool 8266, refractometer can be used to test coolant concentration.
A hydrometer will test the amount of glycol in a mixture by measuring the specific gravity of the
mixture. The higher the concentration of ethylene glycol, the larger the number of balls that will
float, and higher the freeze protection (up to a maximum of 60% by volume glycol).
A Refractometer Tool 8286 will test the amount of glycol in a coolant mixture by measuring the
amount a beam of light bends as it passes through the fluid.
Some coolant manufactures use other types of glycols into their coolant formulations. Propylene
glycol is the most common new coolant. However, propylene glycol based coolants do not provide
the same freezing protection and corrosion protection and is not recommended.
CAUTION: Do not mix types of coolant - corrosion protection will be severely reduced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The coolant reserve/overflow tank is mounted on top of the fan shroud, and is made of high
temperature plastic.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description > Page 3223
Coolant Reservoir: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The coolant reserve/overflow system works in conjunction with the radiator pressure cap. It utilizes
thermal expansion and contraction of coolant to keep coolant free of trapped air. It provides a
volume for expansion and contraction of coolant. It also provides a convenient and safe method for
checking coolant level and adjusting level at atmospheric pressure. This is done without removing
the radiator pressure cap. The system also provides some reserve coolant to the radiator to cover
minor leaks and evaporation or boiling losses.
As the engine cools, a vacuum is formed in the cooling system of both the radiator and engine.
Coolant will then be drawn from the coolant tank and returned to a proper level in the radiator.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Remove overflow hose (5) from radiator (1) 2. Remove mounting bolts (4). 3. Remove coolant
recovery bottle (2) from bracket (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3226
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Position coolant recovery bottle (2) on bracket (3). 2. Install mounting bolts (4). Tighten to 8.5
Nm (75 in. lbs). 3. Install overflow hose (5) onto radiator (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3231
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3232
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3233
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3234
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3235
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3240
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3241
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3242
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3243
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3244
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3245
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3246
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3247
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3248
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3249
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3250
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3251
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3252
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3253
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3254
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3255
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3256
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3257
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 3263
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3266
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Heater Core: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The heater core (1) is a heat exchanger made of rows of tubes and fins. The heater core is
positioned within the HVAC housing through the panel (2) located at the front of the HVAC housing.
The heater core tubes (3) are attached to the front of the heater core and are secured to the HVAC
housing by a bracket.
The heater core can be serviced by removing the HVAC housing assembly from the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 3271
Heater Core: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Engine coolant is circulated through the heater hoses to the heater core at all times. As the coolant
flows through the heater core, heat is removed from the engine and is transferred to the heater
core tubes and fins. Air directed through the heater core picks up the heat from the heater core
fins. The blend-air door(s) allows control of the heater output air temperature by regulating the
amount of air flowing through the heater core. The blower motor speed controls the volume of air
flowing through the HVAC housing.
The heater core cannot be repaired and must be replaced if restricted, leaking or damaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Installation
Heater Core: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Carefully install the heater core (3) into the front of the HVAC housing.
2. Position the heater core tube bracket (2) onto the HVAC housing.
3. Install the two screws (1) that secure the heater core bracket to the HVAC housing. Tighten the
screws to 1.1 Nm (10 in. lbs.).
4. If equipped with the dual zone heating-A/C system, install the linkage rod (4).
5. Install the foam seal onto the heater core tubes.
NOTE: If the heater core is being replaced, flush the cooling system.
6. Install the HVAC housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Installation > Page 3274
Heater Core: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: Disable the airbag system before attempting any steering wheel, steering column, or
instrument panel component diagnosis or service. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery
(ground) cable, then wait two minutes for the airbag system capacitor to discharge before
performing further diagnosis or service. This is the only sure way to disable the airbag system.
Failure to take the proper precautions could result in accidental airbag deployment and possible
personal injury or death.
NOTE: Disassembly of the HVAC housing is not required to remove heater core.
1. Remove the HVAC housing.
2. Remove the foam seal from the heater core tubes.
3. If equipped with the dual zone heating-A/C system, remove the linkage rod (4) to gain access to
the heater core (3).
4. Remove the two screws (1) that secure the heater core tube bracket (2) to the HVAC housing
and remove the bracket.
5. Carefully pull the heater core out of the front of the HVAC housing.
6. Inspect all foam seals and replace as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An engine coolant temperature gauge is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. The engine
coolant temperature gauge is located in the lower right quadrant of the instrument cluster, below
the oil pressure gauge. The gauge consists of a movable gauge needle or pointer controlled by the
instrument cluster circuitry and a fixed 90 degree scale on the cluster overlay that reads left-to-right
from C (or Cold) to H (or Hot) for gasoline engines. On vehicles with a diesel engine, the scale
reads from 60° C to 120° C in markets where a metric instrument cluster is specified, or from 140°
F to 245° F in all other markets. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for Engine
Coolant Temperature is located on the cluster overlay, directly below the left end of the gauge
scale.
The engine coolant temperature gauge graphics are black against a white field except for a single
red graduation at the high end of the gauge scale making them clearly visible within the instrument
cluster in daylight. When illuminated from behind by the panel lamps dimmer controlled cluster
illumination lighting with the exterior lamps turned ON, the black gauge graphics appear blue-green
and the red graphics still appear red. The gauge needle has internal optical illumination. Gauge
illumination is provided by replaceable incandescent bulb and holder units located on the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The engine coolant temperature gauge is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3280
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature gauge gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the engine
coolant temperature. This gauge is controlled by the instrument cluster circuit board based upon
cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine, or the Engine Control Module (ECM)
on vehicles equipped with a diesel engine over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The engine coolant temperature gauge is an air core magnetic unit that receives battery current on
the instrument cluster electronic circuit board through the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit whenever the ignition switch is in the ON or START positions. The cluster is programmed to
move the gauge needle back to the low end of the scale after the ignition switch is turned to the
OFF position. The instrument cluster circuitry controls the gauge needle position and provides the
following features:
- Engine Temperature Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic engine temperature
message from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is between the low end of normal about
54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C (140° F) for diesel engines] and the high end of
normal about 122° C (252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines],
the gauge needle is moved to the actual relative temperature position on the gauge scale.
- Engine Temperature Low Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic engine
temperature message from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is below the low end of
normal about 54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C (140° F) for diesel engines], the
gauge needle is held at the graduation on the far left end of the gauge scale. The gauge needle
remains at the low end of the gauge scale until the cluster receives a message from the PCM or
ECM indicating the temperature is above about 54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C
(140° F) for diesel engines, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever
occurs first.
- Engine Temperature High Message - Each time the cluster receives three consecutive electronic
engine temperature messages from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is above about
122° C (252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines, the gauge
needle is moved to the red increment or zone at the far right end of gauge scale, the check gauges
indicator is illuminated, and a single chime tone is sounded. The gauge needle remains at the high
end of the gauge scale and the check gauges indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a message from the PCM or ECM indicating that the temperature is below about 122° C
(252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime tone feature will only repeat
during the same ignition cycle if the check gauges indicator is cycled OFF and then ON again by
the appropriate messages from the PCM or ECM.
- Communication Error - If the cluster fails to receive an engine temperature message, it will hold
the gauge needle at the last indication for about 10 seconds or until the ignition switch is turned to
the OFF position, whichever occurs first. After 10 seconds, the cluster will move the gauge needle
to the low end of the gauge scale.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the engine coolant
temperature gauge needle will be swept to several calibration points on the gauge scale in a
prescribed sequence in order to confirm the functionality of the gauge and the cluster control
circuitry.
The PCM (gasoline engine) or ECM (diesel engine) continually monitors the engine coolant
temperature sensor to determine the engine operating temperature. The PCM or ECM then sends
the proper messages to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of
the engine coolant temperature gauge or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the gauge
refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing. If the instrument cluster turns ON the check gauges
indicator due to a high engine temperature gauge reading, it may indicate that the engine or the
engine cooling system requires service.
For proper diagnosis of the engine coolant temperature sensor, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the
CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to engine coolant temperature gauge
operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Radiator: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The radiator is a aluminum cross-flow design with horizontal tubes through the radiator core and
vertical plastic side tanks.
This radiator does not contain an internal transmission oil cooler.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 3285
Radiator: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The radiator supplies sufficient heat transfer using the cooling fins interlaced between the
horizontal tubes in the radiator core to cool the engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3286
Radiator: Testing and Inspection
RADIATOR COOLANT FLOW
Use the following procedure to determine if coolant is flowing through the cooling system.
1. Idle engine until operating temperature is reached. If the upper radiator hose is warm to the
touch, the thermostat is opening and coolant is flowing
to the radiator.
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Using a rag to cover the radiator
pressure cap, open radiator cap slowly to the first stop. This will allow any built-up pressure to vent
to the reserve/overflow tank. After pressure build-up has been released, remove cap from filler
neck.
2. Drain a small amount of coolant from the radiator until the ends of the radiator tubes are visible
through the filler neck. Idle the engine at normal
operating temperature. If coolant is flowing past the exposed tubes, the coolant is circulating.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Radiator: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean radiator fins are necessary for good heat transfer. The radiator and oil cooler fins should be
cleaned when an accumulation of debris has occurred. With the engine cold, apply cold water and
compressed air to the back (engine side) of the radiator to flush the radiator and/or oil coolers of
debris.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the radiator side tanks for cracks, and broken or missing fittings. Inspect the joint where the
tanks seam up to the radiator core for signs of leakage and/or deteriorating seals.
Inspect radiator core for corroded, bent or missing cooling fins. Inspect the core for bent or
damaged cooling tubes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3289
Radiator: Removal and Replacement
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Disconnect both battery negative cables.
WARNING: Do not remove the cylinder block drain plugs or loosen the radiator draincock with the
system hot and under pressure. Serious burns from coolant can occur.
2. Drain the cooling system. 3. Disconnect ambient air temperature sensor electrical connector and
mass airflow sensor electrical connector (If equipped). 4. Remove air box and turbocharger inlet
tube. 5. Remove coolant tank hose, washer bottle hose and the positive battery cable from the
fastening clips located on top of the radiator. 6. Remove hose clamps and hoses from radiator. 7.
Remove fan shroud mounting nuts from mounting brackets. 8. Pull shroud toward front of vehicle to
clear mounting brackets 9. Turn shroud slightly and push toward engine to gain clearance for
radiator.
10. Remove the power steering cooler mounting bolts and position the power steering cooler out of
the way. 11. Disconnect the transmission cooler lines at the transmission cooler. The transmission
cooler will remain on the radiator and can be removed as an
assembly.
12. Remove the two radiator upper mounting bolts. 13. Tilt radiator toward front of vehicle and lift
out of engine compartment. The bottom of the radiator is equipped with two alignment dowels that
fit
into holes in the lower radiator support panel. Rubber biscuits (insulators) are installed to these
dowels. Take care not to damage cooling fins or tubes on the radiator and air conditioning
condenser or the electronic viscous fan connector when removing.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3290
1. Install rubber insulators to alignment dowels at lower part of radiator. 2. Lower the radiator into
position while guiding the two alignment dowels into lower radiator support. Different alignment
holes are provided in the
lower radiator support for each engine application.
3. Install two upper radiator mounting bolts. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect
both radiator hoses and install hose clamps. 5. If equipped, connect transmission cooler lines to
transmission cooler. Inspect quick connect fittings for debris and install until an audible "click" is
heard. Tug on lines to verify connection.
6. Position power steering cooler on the radiator and tighten nuts to 10 Nm (90 in. lbs.) 7. Position
fan shroud on brackets. 8. Install fan shroud mounting nut. Tighten nut to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 9.
Install the coolant recovery container.
10. Position coolant recovery tank hose, washer bottle hose and the positive battery cable into the
clips located on the top of the radiator. 11. Install air box and turbocharger inlet hose. Tighten
clamps to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 12. Connect mass airflow sensor electrical connector and ambient air
temp sensor electrical connector (if equipped). 13. Position heater controls to full heat position. 14.
Fill cooling system with coolant. 15. Operate engine until it reaches normal temperature. Check
cooling system and automatic transmission (if equipped) fluid levels.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
All cooling systems are equipped with a pressure cap. For all engines, the pressure cap is located
on top of the radiator outlet tank. The cap releases pressure at some point within a range of
97-to-124 kPa (14-to-18 psi). The pressure relief point (in pounds) is engraved on top of the cap
The cooling system will operate at pressures slightly above atmospheric pressure. This results in a
higher coolant boiling point allowing increased radiator cooling capacity. The cap contains a
spring-loaded pressure relief valve. This valve opens when system pressure reaches the release
range of 97-to-124 kPa (14-to-18 psi).
A rubber gasket seals the radiator filler neck. This is done to maintain vacuum during coolant
cool-down and to prevent leakage when system is under pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 3295
Radiator Cap: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
A vent valve in the center of the cap will remain shut as long as the cooling system is pressurized.
As the coolant cools, it contracts and creates a vacuum in the cooling system. This causes the
vacuum valve to open and coolant in the reserve/overflow container to be drawn through the
recovery hose connecting the filler neck and reserve/overflow container. If the vacuum valve is
stuck shut, or the recovery hose is kinked, radiator hoses will collapse on cool down.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Radiator Cap
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection Radiator Cap
RADIATOR CAP
Remove the cap from the radiator. Be sure that the sealing surfaces are clean. Moisten the rubber
gasket with water and install the cap on the pressure tester 7700 or an equivalent.
Operate the tester pump to bring the pressure to 104 kPa (15 psi) on the gauge. If the pressure cap
fails to hold pressure of at least 97 kPa (14 psi) replace the cap. Refer to the following CAUTION.
The pressure cap may test properly while positioned on tool 7700 (or equivalent). It may not hold
pressure or vacuum when installed on the radiator. If so, inspect the radiator filler neck and radiator
cap's top gasket for damage. Also inspect for dirt or distortion that may prevent the cap from
sealing properly.
CAUTION: Radiator pressure testing tools are very sensitive to small air leaks which will not cause
cooling system problems. A pressure cap that does not have a history of coolant loss should not be
replaced just because it leaks slowly when tested with this tool. Add water to tool. Turn tool upside
down and recheck pressure cap to confirm that cap needs replacement.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Radiator Cap > Page 3298
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection Radiator Cap To Filler Neck Seal
RADIATOR CAP-TO-FILLER NECK SEAL
The pressure cap upper gasket (seal) pressure relief can be tested by removing overflow hose
from the radiator filler neck tube. Attach the hose of the pressure tester tool 7700 (or equivalent) to
the tube. It will be necessary to disconnect hose from its adapter for the filler neck. Pump air into
radiator. The pressure cap upper gasket should relieve at 69 to 124kPa (10 to 18 psi) and hold
pressure at a minimum of 55 kPa (8 psi).
WARNING: The warning words, "DO NOT OPEN HOT", on radiator pressure cap, are a safety
precaution. When hot, pressure builds up in cooling system. To prevent scalding or injury, radiator
cap should not be removed while system is hot and/or under pressure.
Do not remove the radiator cap at any time except for the following purposes:
- Check and adjust antifreeze freeze point.
- Refill the system with new antifreeze.
- Conducting service procedures.
- Checking for vacuum leaks.
WARNING: If vehicle has been run recently, wait at least 15 minutes before removing radiator cap.
With a rag, squeeze radiator upper hose to check if system is under pressure. Place a rag over cap
and without pushing cap down, rotate it counter-clockwise to first stop. Allow fluid to escape
through the coolant reserve/overflow hose into reserve/overflow tank. Squeeze radiator upper hose
to determine when pressure has been released. When coolant and steam stop being pushed into
tank and system pressure drops, remove radiator cap completely.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Cleaning
Radiator Cap: Service and Repair Cleaning
CLEANING
Use only a mild soap and water to clean the radiator cap. Using any type of solvent may cause
damage to the seal in the radiator cap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cap > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Cleaning > Page 3301
Radiator Cap: Service and Repair Inspection
INSPECTION
Hold cap at eye level, right side up. The vent valve at bottom of cap should closed. A slight
downward pull on the vent valve should open it. If the rubber gasket has swollen and prevents vent
valve from opening, replace cap.
Hold cap at eye level, upside down. If any light can be seen between vent valve and rubber gasket,
replace cap. A replacement cap must be the type designed for a coolant reserve/overflow system
with a completely sealed diaphragm spring and a rubber gasket. This gasket is used to seal to
radiator filler neck top surface. Use of proper cap will allow coolant return to radiator.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3306
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3307
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3308
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 80
Component : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Connector:
Name : DRIVE-FAN-RADIATOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
2 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
3 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
4-5 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
5 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
6 FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
6 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
Component Location - 37
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3309
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3310
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3317
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3320
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An engine coolant temperature gauge is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. The engine
coolant temperature gauge is located in the lower right quadrant of the instrument cluster, below
the oil pressure gauge. The gauge consists of a movable gauge needle or pointer controlled by the
instrument cluster circuitry and a fixed 90 degree scale on the cluster overlay that reads left-to-right
from C (or Cold) to H (or Hot) for gasoline engines. On vehicles with a diesel engine, the scale
reads from 60° C to 120° C in markets where a metric instrument cluster is specified, or from 140°
F to 245° F in all other markets. An International Control and Display Symbol icon for Engine
Coolant Temperature is located on the cluster overlay, directly below the left end of the gauge
scale.
The engine coolant temperature gauge graphics are black against a white field except for a single
red graduation at the high end of the gauge scale making them clearly visible within the instrument
cluster in daylight. When illuminated from behind by the panel lamps dimmer controlled cluster
illumination lighting with the exterior lamps turned ON, the black gauge graphics appear blue-green
and the red graphics still appear red. The gauge needle has internal optical illumination. Gauge
illumination is provided by replaceable incandescent bulb and holder units located on the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The engine coolant temperature gauge is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3325
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The engine coolant temperature gauge gives an indication to the vehicle operator of the engine
coolant temperature. This gauge is controlled by the instrument cluster circuit board based upon
cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) on vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine, or the Engine Control Module (ECM)
on vehicles equipped with a diesel engine over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The engine coolant temperature gauge is an air core magnetic unit that receives battery current on
the instrument cluster electronic circuit board through the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit whenever the ignition switch is in the ON or START positions. The cluster is programmed to
move the gauge needle back to the low end of the scale after the ignition switch is turned to the
OFF position. The instrument cluster circuitry controls the gauge needle position and provides the
following features:
- Engine Temperature Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic engine temperature
message from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is between the low end of normal about
54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C (140° F) for diesel engines] and the high end of
normal about 122° C (252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines],
the gauge needle is moved to the actual relative temperature position on the gauge scale.
- Engine Temperature Low Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic engine
temperature message from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is below the low end of
normal about 54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C (140° F) for diesel engines], the
gauge needle is held at the graduation on the far left end of the gauge scale. The gauge needle
remains at the low end of the gauge scale until the cluster receives a message from the PCM or
ECM indicating the temperature is above about 54° C (130° F) for gasoline engines, or about 60° C
(140° F) for diesel engines, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever
occurs first.
- Engine Temperature High Message - Each time the cluster receives three consecutive electronic
engine temperature messages from the PCM or ECM indicating the temperature is above about
122° C (252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines, the gauge
needle is moved to the red increment or zone at the far right end of gauge scale, the check gauges
indicator is illuminated, and a single chime tone is sounded. The gauge needle remains at the high
end of the gauge scale and the check gauges indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a message from the PCM or ECM indicating that the temperature is below about 122° C
(252° F) for gasoline engines, or about 116° C (240° F) for diesel engines, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime tone feature will only repeat
during the same ignition cycle if the check gauges indicator is cycled OFF and then ON again by
the appropriate messages from the PCM or ECM.
- Communication Error - If the cluster fails to receive an engine temperature message, it will hold
the gauge needle at the last indication for about 10 seconds or until the ignition switch is turned to
the OFF position, whichever occurs first. After 10 seconds, the cluster will move the gauge needle
to the low end of the gauge scale.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the engine coolant
temperature gauge needle will be swept to several calibration points on the gauge scale in a
prescribed sequence in order to confirm the functionality of the gauge and the cluster control
circuitry.
The PCM (gasoline engine) or ECM (diesel engine) continually monitors the engine coolant
temperature sensor to determine the engine operating temperature. The PCM or ECM then sends
the proper messages to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of
the engine coolant temperature gauge or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the gauge
refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing. If the instrument cluster turns ON the check gauges
indicator due to a high engine temperature gauge reading, it may indicate that the engine or the
engine cooling system requires service.
For proper diagnosis of the engine coolant temperature sensor, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the
CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to engine coolant temperature gauge
operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
The thermostat will begin to open at 85.5 - 89.4°C (186 - 193°F). If the valve starts to move before
this temperature is reached, it is opening too early. Replace thermostat. The thermostat should be
fully open (valve will stop moving) at 97°C (207°F). If the valve is still moving when the water
temperature reaches 97°C (207°F), it is opening too late. Replace thermostat. If the valve refuses
to move at any time, replace thermostat.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 3329
Thermostat: Description and Operation
DIESEL
CAUTION: Do not operate an engine without a thermostat, except for servicing or testing. An
engine with the thermostat removed will operate in the radiator bypass mode, causing an overheat
condition.
The thermostat of the diesel engine is located in the front of the cylinder head, underneath a heat
shield near the thermostat housing.
NOTE: The thermostat for 5.9L engine and the 6.7L are different and are not interchangeable. Use
caution when replacing the thermostat to ensure the proper part number is reinstalled.
An engine should not be operated without a thermostat, except for servicing or testing. Operating
without a thermostat will cause overheating.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > On-Board Diagnostics
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection On-Board Diagnostics
ON-BOARD DIAGNOSTICS
All models are equipped with On-Board Diagnostics for certain cooling system components. Refer
to On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). If the powertrain control module (PCM) detects low engine coolant
temperature, it will record a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in the PCM memory. Do not change a
thermostat for lack of heat as indicated by the instrument panel gauge or by poor heater
performance unless a DTC is present.
The DTC can also be accessed through the scan tool. Refer to the appropriate Powertrain
Diagnostic Procedures information for diagnostic information and operation of the scan tool.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > On-Board Diagnostics > Page 3332
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection Diesel Engine
DIESEL ENGINE
The cooling system used with the diesel engine provides the extra coolant capacity and extra
cooling protection needed for higher GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) and GCWR (Gross
Combined Weight Rating) vehicles.
This system capacity will not affect warm up or cold weather operating characteristics if the
thermostat is operating properly. This is because coolant will be held in the engine until it reaches
the thermostat "set" temperature.
Diesel engines, due to their inherent efficiency are slower to warm up than gasoline powered
engines, and will operate at lower temperatures when the vehicle is unloaded. Because of this,
lower temperature gauge readings for diesel versus gasoline engines may, at times be normal.
Typically, complaints of low engine coolant temperature are observed as low heater output when
combined with cool or cold outside temperatures.
To help promote faster engine warm-up, the electric engine block heater must be used with cool or
cold outside temperatures. This will help keep the engine coolant warm when the vehicle is parked.
A "Cold Weather Cover" is available from the parts department through the Mopar Accessories
product line. This accessory cover is designed to block airflow entering the radiator and engine
compartment to promote faster engine warm-up. It attaches to the front of the vehicle at the grill
opening. The cover is to be used with cool or cold temperatures only. If used with high outside
temperatures, serious engine damage could result. Refer to the literature supplied with the cover
for additional information.
For engines equipped with exhaust brakes, this device can be used to aid engine warm-up while
the engine is idling.
1. To determine if the thermostat is defective, it must be removed from the vehicle. 2. After the
thermostat has been removed, examine the thermostat and inside of thermostat housing for
contaminants. If contaminants are found, the
thermostat may already be in a "stuck open" position. Flush the cooling system before replacing
thermostat.
3. Place the thermostat into a container filled with water. 4. Place the container on a hot plate or
other suitable heating device. 5. Place a commercially available radiator thermometer into the
water. 6. Apply heat to the water while observing the thermostat and thermometer. 7. The
thermostat will begin to open at 85.5 - 89.4°C (186 - 193°F). If the valve starts to move before this
temperature is reached, it is opening too
early. Replace thermostat. The thermostat should be fully open (valve will stop moving) at 97°C
(207°F). If the valve is still moving when the water temperature reaches 97°C (207°F), it is opening
too late. Replace thermostat. If the valve refuses to move at any time, replace thermostat.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Thermostat: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL ENGINE
WARNING: Do not loosen the radiator draincock with the system hot and pressurized. Serious
burns from the coolant can occur.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Drain cooling system until coolant level is below
thermostat. 3. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3). 4. Remove
exhaust pressure tube (4) from thermostat housing. 5. Remove EGR cooler cross over tube (1). 6.
Remove radiator hose clamp and hose from thermostat housing (1). 7. Remove heat shield. 8.
Remove the three water outlet-to-cylinder head bolts (5) and remove the water outlet connector. 9.
Clean the mating surfaces of the thermostat housing (1) and clean the thermostat seat groove at
the top of the thermostat housing (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3335
Thermostat: Service and Repair Installation
6.7L DIESEL ENGINE
NOTE: The thermostat for 5.9L engine and the 6.7L are different and are not interchangeable. Use
caution when replacing the thermostat to ensure the proper part number is reinstalled.
1. Inspect thermostat seal for cuts or nicks. Replace if damaged. 2. Install the thermostat into the
groove in the top of the cylinder head. 3. Install the thermostat housing and bolts (5). Tighten the
bolts to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.). 4. Install heat shield. Tighten bolts to 9 Nm (79 in. lbs.). 5. Install
exhaust pressure tube (4). Tighten to 10 Nm (88 in. lbs.). 6. Connect exhaust pressure sensor
electrical connector (2). 7. Install EGR cross over tube (1). 8. Install P-clip and bolt. Tighten to 8
Nm (70 in. lbs.). 9. Install the radiator upper hose and clamp.
10. Fill the cooling system with coolant. 11. Connect the battery negative cables. 12. Start the
engine and check for coolant leaks. Run engine to check for proper thermostat operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Install water pump with the weep hole facing downward. Tighten mounting bolts to
............................................................................. 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Water Pump
Water Pump: Description and Operation Water Pump
Description
WATER PUMP
A centrifugal water pump circulates coolant through the water jackets, passages, intake manifold,
radiator core, cooling system hoses and heater core. The pump is driven from the engine
crankshaft by a single serpentine drive belt.
The water pump impeller is pressed onto the rear of a shaft that rotates in bearings pressed into
the housing. The housing has two small holes to allow seepage to escape. The water pump seals
are lubricated by the antifreeze in the coolant mixture. No additional lubrication is necessary.
Operation
WATER PUMP
A centrifugal water pump circulates coolant through the water jackets, passages, intake manifold,
radiator core, cooling system hoses and heater core, this coolant absorbs the heat generated when
the engine is running. The pump is driven by the engine crankshaft via a drive belt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Water Pump > Page 3341
Water Pump: Description and Operation Water Pump Bypass
Description
WATER PUMP BYPASS
The 3.7L and 4.7L engine uses an internal water/coolant bypass system. The design uses galleries
in the timing chain cover to circulate coolant during engine warm-up preventing the coolant from
flowing through the radiator.
Operation - 3.7L/4.7L
WATER PUMP BYPASS - 3.7L/4.7L
When the thermostat is in the closed position the bypass gallery is not obstructed allowing 100%
flow. When the thermostat is in the open position the pill partially covers the bypass hole, reducing
the amount of bypass flow. This design allows the coolant to reach operating temperature quickly
when cold, while adding extra cooling during normal temperature operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 3342
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
WATER PUMP
A quick test to determine if pump is working is to check if heater warms properly. A defective water
pump will not be able to circulate heated coolant through the long heater hose to the heater core.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Water Pump: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean the gasket mating surface. Use caution not to damage the gasket sealing surface.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the water pump assembly for cracks in the housing, water leaks from shaft seal, worn
bearing or impeller rubbing either the pump body or timing chain case/cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3345
Water Pump: Removal and Replacement
Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Drain cooling system. 3. Disconnect ambient air temp
sensor electrical connector and mass airflow sensor electrical connector (if equipped). 4. Remove
turbocharger inlet tube and air filter housing. 5. Remove generator assembly. 6. Remove the
accessory drive belt. 7. Remove water pump mounting bolts (3). 8. Remove O-ring from water
pump. 9. Clean water pump sealing surface on cylinder block.
Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
1. Install new O-ring seal in groove on water pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3346
2. Install water pump with the weep hole facing downward. Tighten mounting bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft.
lbs.) torque. 3. Install generator assembly. 4. Install accessory drive belt. 5. Install air box and tube
assembly. 6. Install air filter housing. 7. Fill cooling system. 8. Connect both battery cables. 9. Start
and warm the engine. Check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3353
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3354
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3355
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3356
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3357
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3358
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3359
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3360
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3363
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3364
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3365
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3366
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3367
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3368
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3369
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3370
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3373
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3376
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel Emissions
> Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Differential Pressure Sensor is remotely mounted on the transmission housing. Two
pressure tubes measure pressure before and after the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)/Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC). The sensor is critical for fail-safe of regeneration strategy, because it
interprets high pressure drops as possible high soot loads.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel Emissions
> Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at pressure
differential pressure sensor. 4. Remove mounting bolt and differential pressure sensor. 5. Remove
mounting bolts (1).
6. Remove pressure differential pressure tubing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel Emissions
> Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3383
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install differential pressure tubing, if removed. Tighten fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
2. Position differential pressure sensor (1). 3. Install mounting nuts (5) and bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 4. Install hose (2) to the rear DPF tubing. 5. Install hose (3) to the front DPF tubing. 6.
Connect electrical connector (6). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul > 09 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P1451/P200C/P242F
NUMBER: 11-001-09
GROUP: Exhaust
DATE: July 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-002-07, DATED
SEPTEMBER 25, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED TOOL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Diesel Particulate Filter - Diagnosis and Repair of DTC's P1451, P200C, P242F or
Black Smoke From Exhaust
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC's P1451,
P2OOC, P242F, black smoke from the exhaust, or a no start condition due to a nonfunctional or
plugged Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). The Mobile DeSoot procedure initiated by the service tool
will soon be replaced with a new Stationary DeSoot procedure. The stationary DeSoot procedure
will only work when a vehicle needs to have a DeSoot performed, such as is indicated by the
presence of an active P1451. A Service Bulletin will be released when this procedure becomes
available.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination, warning chime and
an overhead Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message regarding the aftertreatment
system and/or black smoke from the exhaust and/or a no start condition.
Further Investigation by the technician may reveal that the MIL illumination and/or EVIC message
is due to one or more of the following Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's):
^ P1451 - Diesel Particulate Filter - System Performance.
^ P242F - Diesel Particulate Filter Restriction - Ash Accumulation.
^ P200C - Diesel Particulate Filter Over Temperature - Bank 1.
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing, StarMOBILE desktop client, StarMOBILE
standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTCs" tab.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul > 09 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 3392
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis.
5. Are DTC's P242F and/or P200C present, either active or stored, in the PCM, or does the vehicle
have visible black smoke from the exhaust or a no
start condition caused by a restricted exhaust?
a. If YES >> then the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) may require replacement.
Proceed to REPAIR PROCEDURE B: DPF Repair Procedure.
b. If NO >> then proceed to Step # 6.
6. Is DTC P1451 ACTIVE in the PCM (but DTC's P242F and/or P200C are NOT present and there
is no black smoke concern)?
a. If YES >> then a Scan Tool initiated DeSoot is required for the DPF. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE A: DPF DeSoot.
b. If NO >> then STOP. Additional diagnosis or repair for the DPF is not needed. An inactive DTC
P1451 without other symptoms does not require
any repair. Confirm that the PCM has the latest updates per the relevant TSB's and include the
documentation kit p/n 6804917AA (while supplies last) in the vehicle, and resolve any other
concerns prior to returning the vehicle to the owner.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURES:
NOTE:
Detailed removal and installation procedures (and graphics), required to perform this bulletin, will
not be listed individually in each Inspection and Test Section of this Repair Procedure. It will be
important to refer to TechCONNECT for all detailed service procedures.
REPAIR PROCEDURE A:
DPF DeSoot
1. Resolve all DTC's unrelated to DeSoot.
NOTE:
DeSoot only addresses the amount of particulate matter (soot) in the DPF, such as indicated by an
active P1451. It DOES NOT address any other issues or conditions.
2. Confirm the PCM Calibration software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
WARNING:
Elevated exhaust temperatures during Scan Tool initiated DeSoot can cause personal injury or
property damage. It is important that ALL procedures are followed.
3. Refer to TSB or Service Information available in DealerCONNECT for information to perform a
Scan Tool initiated DeSoot.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B:
DPF Repair Procedure
NOTE:
The DPF repair procedure has been updated due to diagnostic and controls enhancements.
1. Does the vehicle have a no start condition WITHOUT P242F in the PCM?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul > 09 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 3393
a. If YES »> then proceed to Step # 2.
b. If NO »> then proceed to Step # 3.
2. Disconnect the DPF from the NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAG) by removing the three nuts at the
flange between them. Insert a non-flammable spacer
between the NAG and DPF flanges to create an exhaust leak path. Does this resolve the no start
condition?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 3.
b. No >> then STOP. The no start condition is NOT caused by the DPF. DPF replacement is NOT
needed, and this bulletin DOES NOT apply.
3. Replace the DPF. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info >
11 - Exhaust Systems > Converter, Catalytic > Removal/Installation > 6.7L diesel P/U.
4. Clean the EGR valve. Refer to the detailed cleaning procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: 25 - Emissions Controls >
Exhaust Gas Recirculation, 6.7L Diesel > Valve, Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR), 6.7L >
Cleaning.
5. Ensure all other engine driveability symptom and/or aftertreatment-related DTC's are addressed.
6. Confirm the PCM application software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Use Standard Labor Operation Times
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P1451/P200C/P242F
NUMBER: 11-001-09
GROUP: Exhaust
DATE: July 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-002-07, DATED
SEPTEMBER 25, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED TOOL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Diesel Particulate Filter - Diagnosis and Repair of DTC's P1451, P200C, P242F or
Black Smoke From Exhaust
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC's P1451,
P2OOC, P242F, black smoke from the exhaust, or a no start condition due to a nonfunctional or
plugged Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). The Mobile DeSoot procedure initiated by the service tool
will soon be replaced with a new Stationary DeSoot procedure. The stationary DeSoot procedure
will only work when a vehicle needs to have a DeSoot performed, such as is indicated by the
presence of an active P1451. A Service Bulletin will be released when this procedure becomes
available.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination, warning chime and
an overhead Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message regarding the aftertreatment
system and/or black smoke from the exhaust and/or a no start condition.
Further Investigation by the technician may reveal that the MIL illumination and/or EVIC message
is due to one or more of the following Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's):
^ P1451 - Diesel Particulate Filter - System Performance.
^ P242F - Diesel Particulate Filter Restriction - Ash Accumulation.
^ P200C - Diesel Particulate Filter Over Temperature - Bank 1.
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing, StarMOBILE desktop client, StarMOBILE
standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTCs" tab.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 3399
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis.
5. Are DTC's P242F and/or P200C present, either active or stored, in the PCM, or does the vehicle
have visible black smoke from the exhaust or a no
start condition caused by a restricted exhaust?
a. If YES >> then the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) may require replacement.
Proceed to REPAIR PROCEDURE B: DPF Repair Procedure.
b. If NO >> then proceed to Step # 6.
6. Is DTC P1451 ACTIVE in the PCM (but DTC's P242F and/or P200C are NOT present and there
is no black smoke concern)?
a. If YES >> then a Scan Tool initiated DeSoot is required for the DPF. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE A: DPF DeSoot.
b. If NO >> then STOP. Additional diagnosis or repair for the DPF is not needed. An inactive DTC
P1451 without other symptoms does not require
any repair. Confirm that the PCM has the latest updates per the relevant TSB's and include the
documentation kit p/n 6804917AA (while supplies last) in the vehicle, and resolve any other
concerns prior to returning the vehicle to the owner.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURES:
NOTE:
Detailed removal and installation procedures (and graphics), required to perform this bulletin, will
not be listed individually in each Inspection and Test Section of this Repair Procedure. It will be
important to refer to TechCONNECT for all detailed service procedures.
REPAIR PROCEDURE A:
DPF DeSoot
1. Resolve all DTC's unrelated to DeSoot.
NOTE:
DeSoot only addresses the amount of particulate matter (soot) in the DPF, such as indicated by an
active P1451. It DOES NOT address any other issues or conditions.
2. Confirm the PCM Calibration software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
WARNING:
Elevated exhaust temperatures during Scan Tool initiated DeSoot can cause personal injury or
property damage. It is important that ALL procedures are followed.
3. Refer to TSB or Service Information available in DealerCONNECT for information to perform a
Scan Tool initiated DeSoot.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B:
DPF Repair Procedure
NOTE:
The DPF repair procedure has been updated due to diagnostic and controls enhancements.
1. Does the vehicle have a no start condition WITHOUT P242F in the PCM?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 3400
a. If YES »> then proceed to Step # 2.
b. If NO »> then proceed to Step # 3.
2. Disconnect the DPF from the NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAG) by removing the three nuts at the
flange between them. Insert a non-flammable spacer
between the NAG and DPF flanges to create an exhaust leak path. Does this resolve the no start
condition?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 3.
b. No >> then STOP. The no start condition is NOT caused by the DPF. DPF replacement is NOT
needed, and this bulletin DOES NOT apply.
3. Replace the DPF. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info >
11 - Exhaust Systems > Converter, Catalytic > Removal/Installation > 6.7L diesel P/U.
4. Clean the EGR valve. Refer to the detailed cleaning procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: 25 - Emissions Controls >
Exhaust Gas Recirculation, 6.7L Diesel > Valve, Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR), 6.7L >
Cleaning.
5. Ensure all other engine driveability symptom and/or aftertreatment-related DTC's are addressed.
6. Confirm the PCM application software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Use Standard Labor Operation Times
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
DIESEL OXIDATION CATALYST (DOC)
The diesel oxidation catalyst (DOC) is a ceramic flow through substrate coated with a catalyst
washcoat that is integral to the DOC/Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) assembly. The close coupled
DOC treats engine exhaust gases by converting harmful carbon monoxide, unburned hydrocarbons
and other compounds into water, carbon dioxide and heat.
DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER
The diesel particulate filter (DPF) is a wall-pass ceramic filter substrate coated with a catalyst
washcoat that is integral to the DOC/DPF assembly. The partially treated exhaust gases from the
DOC, flow into the catalyzed diesel particulate filter (DPF) which traps and accumulates particulate
matter and further treats the exhaust gases to reduce unburned hydrocarbons and other harmful
compounds. the trapped particulate molecules will be periodically removed from the DPF via a
thermal regeneration process initiated by the engine's electronic control module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3403
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The oxidation catalyst raises the exhaust gas temperatures to regenerate the DPF, which is
passive regeneration. If the passive regeneration cannot keep up with the build up of soot in the
DPF, the ECM will actively regenerate the DPF to burn off the soot. Residue remains inside the
DPF in the form of non burnable ash. Ash comes from the oils and other materials that are trapped
in the oils and are present in the soot. The catalyst contains a large number of parallel channels,
which run in the axial direction and are separated by thin porous walls. The channels are
alternatively open at one end, but plugged at the other. The exhaust gases flow through the walls
and escape through the pores in the wall material. Particulates, however, are too large to escape
and are trapped in the monolith walls. The ECM starts the regeneration of the DPF if the soot load
exceeds a performance map value. The ECM determines the load condition of the DPF based
upon the exhaust gas pressure upstream and downstream of the DPC/DPF. A pressure differential
sensor provides the pressure input to the ECM. During the regeneration process, the ECM raises
the temperature in the DOC/DPF to burn off the soot accumulated. Under normal operation, the
engine does not produce enough heat to oxidize the soot inside the DOC/DPF. This process
requires temperatures above 550°C (1,022°F). After regeneration, the ECM reads the actual
pressure difference at the DOC/DPF and compares it with a reference value. From this
comparison, the ECM determines the ash quantity inside the DOC/DPF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3404
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER
EVIC Message Center - Message - Catalyst Full
The engine Electronic Control Module (ECM) monitors the soot load in the diesel particulate filter.
Under normal operating conditions the diesel particulate filter is self-cleaning, where accumulated
soot is converted to ash. Under light load operating conditions, the driver may be notified via the
vehicle's Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message center "CATALYST FULL: SEE
OWNERS MAN" message will be displayed indicating that it is necessary to modify the vehicles
driving routine/duty-cycle in order to allow the diesel particulate filter system to self clean. If the
vehicle's EVIC message center notification is ignored, the vehicle will eventually derate the engine
and set a fault, requiring service. The soot load in the diesel particulate filter is estimated by the
ECM using the Exhaust Pressure Sensor values and the calculated soot output of the engine. This
fault code will be triggered if the application is not operating at a duty cycle high enough to allow
active regeneration of the diesel particulate filter. This fault code is an indication that the exhaust
temperatures exiting the turbocharger are not high enough to allow active regeneration of the soot
that is trapped in the diesel particulate filter. It may be necessary to increase the duty cycle of the
application in order to prevent excessive soot accumulation and plugging of the diesel particulate
filter. The ECM will set this fault if it detects that the soot level has exceeded the normal desoot
trigger threshold by a sufficient amount to indicate that the driver intervention is required. There is
not a MIL lamp associated with this fault code, though the driver will be notified via the EVIC
message.
Have owner drive vehicle at highway speeds (50/60 mph) for a minimum of 45 minutes.
If the message CATALYST FULL SERVICE REQ'D. is still displayed, Refer to - ENGINE Testing.
See: Engine/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Removal - Cab Chassis
6.7L DIESEL - CAB-CHASSIS
WARNING: If torches are used when working on the exhaust system, do not allow the flame near
the fuel lines.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Saturate the bolts and nuts with heat valve lubricant. Allow 5
minutes for penetration. 3. Remove flexible tubing from particulate filter pressure sensor tubing. 4.
Loosen and remove particulate filter pressure sensor tubing from Diesel Oxidation Catalytic/Diesel
Particulate Filter (DOC/DPF). 5. Disconnect and remove temperature sensors. 6. 4X4 Vehicles Remove transfer case skid plate. 7. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transmission crossmember. 8.
Remove exhaust pipe to DOC/DPF flange nuts (5) 9. Remove intermediate pipe to DOC/PDF
clamp nuts (2).
10. Move muffler and tail pipe assembly (1) toward rear of vehicle. 11. Remove DOC/DPF (4). 12.
Remove and discard flange gaskets.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 3407
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Removal - P/U
6.7L DIESEL - P/U
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Saturate the bolts and nuts with heat valve lubricant. Allow 5
minutes for penetration. 3. Loosen and remove DPF differential pressure tubes (4 and 6). 4.
Disconnect and remove temperature sensor (2). 5. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transfer case skid plate.
6. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transmission crossmember. 7. Remove DPF to muffler clamp (5).
Discard clamp. 8. Move muffler and tail pipe assembly toward rear of vehicle. 9. Remove DPF to
catalytic converter flange nuts.
10. Remove DPF. Discard flange gaskets.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 3408
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Installation - Cab Chassis
6.7L DIESEL - CAB-CHASSIS
1. Position new exhaust flange gaskets on exhaust pipe (6) to DOC/DPF flange and DOC/DPF into
intermediate pipe (1). 2. Using new gasket, position the DOC/DPF (4) onto the front exhaust pipe
flange. 3. Install flange nuts (5). Hand tighten only. 4. Check the exhaust system for contact with
the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.) is required between the exhaust system
components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
5. Tighten flange nuts (5) to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs) 6. Tighten torque clamp nuts to 52 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) 7.
Install temperature sensor. Tighten to 29.8 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 8. Install exhaust differential pressure
tubing. Tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 9. Install flexible exhaust differential pressure sensor tubing.
10. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transmission crossmember. 11. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transfer case skid
plate. 12. Connect electrical connectors. 13. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 3409
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Installation - P/U
6.7L DIESEL - P/U
1. Position new exhaust flange gaskets on catalytic converter to DPF flange. 2. Install flange bolts.
Hand tighten only. 3. Install muffler and tailpipe assembly 4. Install new band clamp. Hand tighten
only. 5. Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.)
is required between the exhaust system components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
6. Tighten flange nuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs) 7. Tighten band clamp nuts to 52 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) 8.
Install temperature sensor. Tighten to 29.8 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 9. Install front and rear (6 and 4)
exhaust differential pressure tubing. Tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
10. Install flexible exhaust differential pressure sensor tubing. 11. 4X4 Vehicles - Install
transmission crossmember. 12. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transfer case skid plate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Brake > Exhaust Brake Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Exhaust Brake Switch: Locations
Component ID: 465
Component : SWITCH-EXHAUST BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-EXHAUST BRAKE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z933 20BK/BR
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER E11 20OR/DB
3 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 20BR/OR
4 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
5 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 20VT/DG
6--
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Brake > Exhaust Brake Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3414
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Brake > Exhaust Brake Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3415
Exhaust Brake Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 465
Component : SWITCH-EXHAUST BRAKE
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-EXHAUST BRAKE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z933 20BK/BR
2 PANEL LAMPS DRIVER E11 20OR/DB
3 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 20BR/OR
4 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
5 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 20VT/DG
6--
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Brake > Exhaust Brake Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3416
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Starting from the center and moving in a pattern outward, torque the exhaust manifold bolts to
............................................................. 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Exhaust Manifold: Procedures
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean the cylinder head and exhaust manifold sealing surfaces with a suitable scraper. Use a
Scotch-Brite(TM) pad or equivalent.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the exhaust manifold for cracks. Measure the exhaust manifold for flatness. Place a ruler
over all of the exhaust ports and insert a feeler gauge between the port flange and the ruler.
Maximum deviation from flat is 0.20 mm (.008 inch).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3422
Exhaust Manifold: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Drain the coolant. See: Cooling System/Service and
Repair 3. Raise vehicle on hoist. 4. Remove the EGR cooler. See: Powertrain
Management/Emission Control Systems/Exhaust Gas Recirculation/EGR Cooler/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement
5. Remove the air filter housing. See: Engine/Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air
Cleaner Housing/Service and Repair 6. Remove the air filter inlet hose from the turbo inlet. 7.
Remove the delta-P line bracket capscrew nuts and remove the delta-P line from the exhaust
manifold and thermostat housing. 8. Remove the heat shield and noise panel (if equipped) from the
exhaust manifold. 9. Remove the turbocharger. See: Powertrain Management/Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction/Turbocharger/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement
10. Remove the two (2) rear exhaust manifold capscrew lock plates. 11. Remove the Cab Heater
tubing/bracket from the exhaust manifold stud. 12. Remove the exhaust manifold.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 3423
1. Clean the exhaust manifold gasket surfaces. 2. Clean the cylinder head exhaust port gasket
surfaces. 3. Clean the turbo mounting flange on the exhaust manifold. 4. Clean the turbo mounting
flange on the turbocharger. 5. Install the exhaust manifold to turbocharger gasket and capscrews.
6. Install the exhaust manifold gasket.
NOTE:The five exhaust manifold capscrews with studs are used at the No.1 and No.2 cylinder
locations for the heat shield mounting and one
on the rear lower corner of the manifold for the cabin heater tube bracket.
7. Install the exhaust manifold spacers and capscrews. 8. Starting from the center and moving in a
pattern outward, tighten the exhaust manifold bolts to 43 N-m (32 ft. lbs.) 9. Install the exhaust
manifold capscrew lock plates. 10. Install the exhaust manifold heat shields/noise panels. Tighten
the mounting nuts to 24 N-m (18 ft. lbs.). 11. Install the turbocharger. See: Powertrain
Management/Fuel Delivery and Air Induction/Turbocharger/Service and Repair/Removal and
Replacement
12. Attach the mounting tabs and start the delta-P tube to exhaust manifold and thermostat
capscrews. 13. Tighten the delta-P line bracket nut to 24 N-m (18 ft. lbs.). 14. Tighten the delta-P
line bracket bolt to 10 N-m (89 in. lbs.). 15. Tighten the delta-P flare nuts to 10 N-m (89 in. lbs.). 16.
Install the EGR cooler. See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control Systems/Exhaust Gas
Recirculation/EGR Cooler/Service and
Repair/Removal and Replacement
17. Install the air filter housing. See: Engine/Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks/Air Cleaner
Housing/Service and Repair 18. Fill the coolant. See: Cooling System/Service and Repair 19.
Connect the battery negative cables. 20. Start the engine to check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Pipe-Exhaust
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Pipe-Exhaust
Removal
6.7L DIESEL
1. Raise and support the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Saturate the bolts and nuts with heat valve lubricant.
Allow 5 minutes for penetration. 3. Remove the exhaust pipe-to-DOC/DPF flange nuts. 4. 4X4
Vehicles - Remove transfer case skid plate. 5. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transmission crossmember.
6. Remove the exhaust pipe-to-turbocharger clamp and discard. 7. Remove the transmission
mounted exhaust pipe support. 8. Separate the exhaust pipe and extension pipe. 9. Remove
exhaust pipe.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Discard rusted clamps, broken or worn supports and attaching parts. Replace a component with
original equipment parts, or equivalent. This will assure proper alignment with other parts in the
system and provide acceptable exhaust noise levels.
Installation
6.7L DIESEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Pipe-Exhaust > Page 3428
1. Using a new flange gasket, position exhaust pipe on DOC/DPF flange and turbocharger flange.
2. Install flange nuts. Tighten nuts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) 3. Install a new exhaust
pipe-to-turbocharger clamp. Do not tighten clamp at this time. 4. Install transmission mounted
exhaust pipe support. Tighten bolts to 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.). 5. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transmission
crossmember. 6. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transfer case skid plate. 7. Check the exhaust system for
contact with the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.) is required between the exhaust
system components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
8. Tighten turbocharger clamp nut to 11 Nm (97 in. lbs.). 9. Lower the vehicle.
10. Start the engine and inspect for exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Pipe-Exhaust > Page 3429
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair Tailpipe
Removal
DIESEL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Saturate the clamp
nuts with heat valve lubricant. Allow 5 minutes for penetration. 4. Disconnect the exhaust tailpipe
support hanger isolators. 5. Remove the muffler-to-tailpipe clamps. 6. Remove the tailpipe from the
vehicle.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Discard rusted clamps, broken or worn supports and attaching parts. Replace a component with
original equipment parts, or equivalent. This will assure proper alignment with other parts in the
system and provide acceptable exhaust noise levels.
Installation
DIESEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Pipe-Exhaust > Page 3430
1. Install the tailpipe into the muffler. 2. Install the tailpipe hanger rods into the isolators 3. Install
the exhaust clamp, align the exhaust system, and tighten the clamp 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.) torque. 4.
Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.) is
required between the exhaust system components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
5. Lower the vehicle. 6. Connect the battery negative cables. 7. Start the engine and inspect for
exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3435
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3436
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3437
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3438
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3439
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3440
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3443
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3444
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3445
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3446
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3447
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3448
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Heat Shield: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
There are two types of heat shields used. One is stamped steel the other is molded foil sheets. The
shields attach to the vehicle around the exhaust system to prevent heat from the exhaust system
from entering the passenger area and other areas where the heat can cause damage to other
components.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Heat Shield: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle.
2. Remove the nuts or bolts holding the exhaust heat shield to the floor pan, crossmember or
bracket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3454
3. Slide the shield out around the exhaust system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3455
Heat Shield: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the exhaust heat shield to the floor pan, crossmember or bracket and install the nuts or
bolts.
2. Tighten the nuts and bolts 11 Nm (100 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3456
3. Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Muffler: Service and Repair Removal
DIESEL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Raise and support the vehicle. 3. Remove the muffler
to tail pipe and extension pipe clamps. 4. Disconnect the muffler from the hanger isolators. 5.
Disconnect the muffler from the tailpipe. 6. Disconnect the muffler from the extension pipe and
remove from the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 3461
Muffler: Service and Repair Installation
DIESEL
1. Install the muffler hanger rods into the isolators. 2. Install the muffler into the extension pipe. 3.
Install the muffler into the tail pipe. 4. Install the exhaust clamps, align the exhaust system, and
tighten the exhaust clamps to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Check the exhaust system for contact
with the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.) is required between the exhaust system
components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
6. Lower the vehicle. 7. Connect the battery negative cables. 8. Start the engine and inspect for
exhaust leaks. Repair exhaust leaks as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3467
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3468
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3469
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3470
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3471
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3472
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3475
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3476
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3477
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3478
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3479
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3480
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3485
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3486
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3487
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3488
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3489
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3490
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3491
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3492
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3495
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3496
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3497
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3498
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3499
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3500
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3501
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3502
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3505
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Sensors and Switches - Exhaust System >
Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3508
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3516
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3517
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3518
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3519
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3520
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3521
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3522
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3523
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3524
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3525
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3526
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3527
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3528
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3529
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3530
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3531
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3532
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3533
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3542
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3543
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3544
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3545
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3546
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3547
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 3548
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 3554
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 3559
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 3560
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 3561
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 3562
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails
I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails
I/M Test > Page 3568
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3573
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3574
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3575
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3576
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3581
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3582
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3583
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3584
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3585
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3586
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3587
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine
Off Idle Speed Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M
Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M
Test > Page 3597
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3602
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3603
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3604
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN
Update For Recall J35 > Page 3605
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off
Idle Speed Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3615
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3616
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3617
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3618
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3619
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3620
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 3621
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3628
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3629
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3630
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3631
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3632
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3633
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3634
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3635
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3636
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3637
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3638
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3639
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3640
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3641
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3642
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3643
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3644
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
123456-
789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 32 -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3645
33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3646
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3647
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3648
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3649
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3650
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3651
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3652
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3653
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3654
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3655
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3656
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3657
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3658
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3659
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3660
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Module-Engine Control > Page 3661
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3664
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3665
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3666
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3667
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3668
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3669
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3670
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3671
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3672
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3673
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3674
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3675
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3676
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3677
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3678
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3679
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3680
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3681
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3682
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3683
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3684
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3685
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3686
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3687
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3688
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3689
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3690
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3691
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3692
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3693
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3694
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3695
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3696
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3697
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3698
Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3699
Pin Description Circuit
123456789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 -
32 33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3700
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3701
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3702
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3703
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3704
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3705
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3706
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3707
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3708
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3709
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3710
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3711
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3712
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3713
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3714
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3715
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3716
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
CUMMINS FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 3719
The Engine Control Module (ECM) for the 5.9L diesel engine (16) is bolted to the left side of the
engine below the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 3720
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The main function of the Engine Control Module (ECM) is to electrically control the fuel system.
The ECM also controls certain transmission and other functions previously controlled by the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
The ECM receives input signals from various switches and sensors. Based on these inputs, the
ECM regulates various engine and vehicle operations through different system components. These
components are referred to as ECM Outputs. The sensors and switches that provide inputs to the
ECM are considered ECM Inputs.
NOTE: ECM Inputs:
- Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) Signals #1 and #2
- AC system pressure
- Auto shutdown (ASD) sense
- Battery temperature
- Battery temperature sensor
- Battery voltage
- Brake switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP)
- Data link connection for a scan tool
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
- EATX module (if equipped)
- Fuel level
- Fuel pressure sensor
- Fan speed (engine cooling fan)
- Generator (battery voltage) output
- Governor pressure (Auto. trans.)
- Ground circuits
- Inlet air temperature sensor/pressure sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor/MAP sensor
- CAN C BUS (+) circuits
- CAN C BUS (-) circuits
- Key switch (ignition)
- Oil Pressure switch
- Overdrive switch (automatic transmission only)
- Park/neutral switch (auto. trans. only)
- Power ground
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Sensor return
- Signal ground
- Speed control multiplexed single wire input
- Transfer case switch (4WD range position)
- Transmission governor psi (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission OSS (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil pressure (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil temperature (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve position (automatic transmission only)
- Vehicle speed signal
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor
NOTE: ECM Outputs:
After inputs are received by the ECM, certain sensors, switches and components are controlled or
regulated by the ECM. These are considered ECM Outputs. These outputs are for:
- A/C clutch relay
- Auto shutdown (ASD) relay
- Data link connection for diagnostic scan tool
- Fan clutch PWM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 3721
- Five volt sensor supply (primary)
- Five volt sensor supply (secondary)
- Fuel control actuator
- Fuel injector driver circuits
- Fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Generator field driver (-)
- Generator field driver (+)
- Governor pressure (VFS solenoid)
- Intake manifold air heater relays #1 and #2 control circuits
- CAN C BUS (+/-) circuits for: speedometer, voltmeter, fuel gauge, oil pressure gauge/lamp,
engine temp. gauge and speed control warn. lamp
- Malfunction indicator lamp (Check engine lamp). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- Oil pressure switch/warning lamp (databus)
- Overdrive/3-4 shift solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- SC source
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Speed control vacuum solenoid
- Speed control vent solenoid
- Tachometer (if equipped). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- TCC solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission battery relay (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve actuator (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission governor solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Wait-to-start warning lamp (databus)
- Turbo wastegate solenoid
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) warning lamp (databus)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection PCM/ECM Programming
PCM/ECM REPROGRAMMING
MODULE REPROGRAMING
Replacement PCM's will require programming utilizing the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. The PCM
will not operate the engine until it is programmed. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will be set "not programmed".
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a calibration is selected and programmed, the controller
cannot be reprogrammed to a different calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a
more recent version of that calibration.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT OR EQUIVALENT REQUIRED:
**REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity.
However, in order to take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent for your dealership's network.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
5. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
6. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM. 7. Program the PCM as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen, Select "ECU View" b. Touch the
screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming > Page 3724
f. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 5.
g. Select "Download to Scantool". h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select
"Back". i.
Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK". l.
Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part number.
8. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 9. b. No >> go to STEP 10.
9. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM).
a. Highlight the WCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c. Highlight "PCM Replaced". d. Select "Start" e.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step. f.
When complete proceed to STEP 11.
10. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
11. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 13. b. No >> go to STEP 12.
12. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select ECU View b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select Misc.
Function. d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select Next after each step . Select Finish after completing the
last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the Home screen select System View. Then select All DTCs. Press Clear All
Stored DTCs if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM and/or TCM.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
REPAIR PROCEDURE USING SOFTWARE UPDATE CD TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming > Page 3725
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
3. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
5. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM.
6. Insert the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software Update CD into the Techconnect or equivalent
PC. The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software
Update CD will start automatically. Select "Download Flash Updates".
7. At the "Select a method for looking up controller flash updates." screen:
a. Select "Enter part number". Enter the "Part Number" recorded in STEP 4 when prompted to do
so. b. Using the mouse highlight the appropriate "Calibration". Select "Next". c. Follow the on
screen instructions. d. When completed, proceed to STEP 8.
8. With the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent powered OFF, connect the USB Key and Gender Changer
to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent USB port .
9. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent to the vehicle (if not already connected).
10. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
11. Download the flash file from the USB key to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. Using the
StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "Flash Download", then select "Retrieve files from the USB storage device" b. Highlight
the appropriate calibration. Select "Download to Scan Tool" c. When the download is complete,
select "Close" and "Back".
12. Reprogram the ECU. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View". b. Select More Options". c. Select "ECU Flash". d. Highlight the appropriate
calibration. e. Select "Update Controller". Follow the on screen instructions. f.
When the update is complete, select "OK".
g. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part
number.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming > Page 3726
13. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 14. b. No >> go to STEP 15.
14. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM). Using the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the WCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "PCM Replaced". e. Select "Start". f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
g. When complete proceed to STEP 16.
15. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
16. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 18. b. No >> go to STEP 17.
17. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
Check all modules using "ECU View" from the Home screen, record the DTC's, and erase these
DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all
other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE: The following step is required by law.
18. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming > Page 3727
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection SKREEM Programming
SKREEM PROGRAMMING
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) for a gasoline engine, or an Engine Control Module
(ECM) for a diesel engine and the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the
Wireless Control Module/WCM) on vehicles equipped with the Sentry Key Immobilizer System
(SKIS) are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new PCM/ECM.
2. Program the new SKREEM/WCM.
3. Replace all ignition keys and program them into the new SKREEM/WCM.
PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKREEM/WCM. This code is
programmed and stored in the SKREEM/WCM, the PCM/ECM, and each ignition key transponder
chip. When the PCM/ECM or SKREEM/WCM is replaced, it is necessary to program the Secret
Key into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool. Follow the programming steps outlined in
the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, ECM REPLACED, WCM REPLACED, or
GATEWAY REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL
MODULE/WCM menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Be certain to enter the correct country code for the SKREEM/WCM. If the incorrect country
code is programmed into the SKREEM, it cannot be changed and the SKREEM must be replaced.
NOTE: In addition, the SKREEM/WCM must be configured for certain optional equipment in the
vehicle, including Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM), Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) and Remote Start.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool under MISCELLANEOUS
FUNCTIONS for the WCM/WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: A replacement SKREEM/WCM is supplied with TPM enabled by default; therefore, if the
vehicle is not equipped with TPM, the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) will incorrectly
learn that the vehicle has TPM after the replacement SKREEM is installed. The TPM indicator in
the EMIC will illuminate to show a TPM fault condition after TPM has been disabled in the
SKREEM. The EMIC must unlearn TPM to correct this false TPM indication. Follow the
programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for CLEAR LEARNED FEATURES under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the INSTRUMENT CLUSTER menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: If the PCM/ECM and the SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle ignition
keys will need to be replaced and the new keys programmed into the new SKREEM/WCM.
NOTE: Programming the PCM/ECM or SKREEM is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to
enter secure access mode. If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an
incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn
the ignition to the RUN position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all
accessories are turned OFF. Also monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if
necessary.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKREEM
Each ignition key transponder also has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is
manufactured. When a key is programmed into the SKREEM/WCM, the transponder ID code is
learned by the module and the transponder acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the
SKREEM/WCM. To program ignition keys into the SKREEM/WCM, follow the programming steps
outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS OR KEY FOBS under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE/WCM menu item.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKREEM. Once a key is learned to a
SKREEM, that key has acquired the Secret Key for that SKREEM and cannot be transferred to any
other SKREEM or vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the scan tool will display one of the following error
messages:
- PROGRAMMING NOT ATTEMPTED - The scan tool attempts to read the programmed key status
and there are no keys programmed into SKREEM memory.
- PROGRAMMING KEY FAILED (POSSIBLE USED KEY FROM WRONG VEHICLE) - SKREEM is
unable to program an ignition key transponder due to one of the following:
- The ignition key transponder is ineffective.
- The ignition key transponder is or has been already programmed to another vehicle.
- 8 KEYS ALREADY LEARNED, PROGRAMMING NOT DONE - The SKREEM transponder ID
memory is full.
- LEARNED KEY IN IGNITION - The ID for the ignition key transponder currently in the ignition lock
cylinder is already programmed into SKREEM memory.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
PCM/ECM Programming > Page 3728
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Programming The SKREEM/WCM Using The Scan
Tool
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM/WCM USING THE SCAN TOOL
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle.
2. Connect the scan tool.
CAUTION: If the ECM/PCM and SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, the ECM/PCM
MUST be programmed before the SKREEM/WCM.
3. Select "ECU View".
4. Select "WCM Wireless Control Module".
5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions".
6. Select WCM replaced.
7. Enter the PIN when prompted.
8. Verify the correct information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL
The Engine Control Module (ECM) (5) is located on the left side of the engine. A support bracket
mounts to the block with four capscrews and vibration isolators. A ground wire is fastened to the
bracket. The other end of the wire is fastened to the engine block.
1. Record any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) found in the ECM.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to the ECM, ignition key must be off, and both negative
battery cables must be disconnected before unplugging ECM connectors.
2. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Access to the ECM is easier by working through the left front wheel opening.
3. Remove left front wheel.
4. Remove plastic left front fender splash shield.
5. Remove electrical connector bolts at ECM. Note: As each bolt is being removed, very carefully
remove connectors from the ECM.
6. Remove three ECM mounting bolts (6) and remove ECM from engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3731
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
6.7L DIESEL
Do not apply paint to ECM or a poor ground will result.
1. Position ECM (5) to the ECM support bracket and install mounting bolts. Tighten bolts to 24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.).
2. Check pins in electrical connectors for corrosion, damage or dirt intrusion. Also check all pins for
being bent. Repair as necessary. Damaged,
dirty, bent or corroded pins could result in poor conductivity, causing intermittent electrical issues or
DTC's.
3. Clean pins in electrical connectors with an electrical contact cleaner.
4. Install connectors to ECM. Tighten connector bolts to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.).
5. Install splash shield.
6. Install left front wheel.
7. Connect both negative battery cables.
8. Use a diagnostic scan tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) from ECM.
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3732
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3736
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3737
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3738
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3739
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3740
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor Relay: Diagrams
2007-2009 Ram truck, 6.7L, use an O2 module for oxygen sensor heater control.
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3748
8w-30-17
Connector C1 pin 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3751
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3752
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3753
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3754
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3755
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3756
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3757
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3758
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3759
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3760
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3761
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3762
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3763
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3764
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3765
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3766
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3767
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3768
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3769
Fuel Pump Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3770
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel transfer pump (fuel lift pump) is part of the fuel pump module. The fuel pump module is
located in the fuel tank. The 12-volt electric pump is operated and controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM). The ECM controls a relay in the intelligent Power Module (IPM) for transfer pump
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Heater Relay: Locations
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3774
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3775
Intake Air Heater Relay: Diagrams
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3776
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3777
Intake Air Heater Relay: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Engine Control Module (ECM) operates the heating element through the intake manifold air
heater relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Disconnect relay trigger wires (4) at relays. Note position of wiring before removing.
3. Remove nuts (2) at cable connectors and disconnect cables (1) from mounting studs. Note
position of cables before removing.
4. Remove two relay mounting bracket screws (6) and remove relay assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3780
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Position relay and install two relay mounting bracket screws (6).
2. Position cables (1) to mounting studs and install nuts (2).
3. Connect relay trigger wires (4) at relays.
4. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3784
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3785
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3786
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3787
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3788
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3794
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3795
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3796
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description > Page 3799
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 3802
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3806
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3807
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3808
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3809
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3812
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 3818
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor (3) into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (2).
4. Install electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3822
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3823
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3824
Battery Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3825
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3826
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Battery Temperature Sensor (BTS) is used only on the diesel engine. It is attached to the
battery tray located under the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 3829
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The BTS is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery charging rate. This
temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the PCM (ECM Diesel) to
vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The PCM sends 5 volts to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As
temperature increases, resistance in the sensor decreases and the detection voltage at the PCM
increases.
The BTS is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II monitors are either enabled
or disabled, depending upon BTS input (for example, disable purge and enable Leak Detection
Pump (LDP) and O2 sensor heater tests). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20° F.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped
into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4) .
1. Remove battery.
2. Pry sensor (1) straight up from battery tray mounting hole to gain access to electrical connector
(3) .
3. Disconnect sensor from engine wire harness electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 3832
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached
(snapped into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4).
1. Pull electrical connector (3) up through mounting hole in top of battery tray.
2. Connect sensor.
3. Snap sensor into battery tray.
4. Install battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3836
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3837
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3838
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3839
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3840
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3841
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3842
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3843
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3844
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3845
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3846
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3847
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3848
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 3851
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3854
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 3859
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 3862
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3866
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3867
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3868
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3869
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3870
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3871
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3872
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3873
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3874
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3875
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3876
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3877
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3878
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3879
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3880
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3881
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3882
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3883
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3884
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3885
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3886
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3887
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3888
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3889
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3890
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3891
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3892
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3893
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3894
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3895
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3896
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3897
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3898
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 3901
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 3904
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3908
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3909
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3910
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
3911
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 3914
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3919
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3920
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3921
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3922
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3923
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3924
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3925
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3926
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3929
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3930
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3931
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3932
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3933
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3934
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3935
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 3936
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 3939
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 3942
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3947
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3948
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3949
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3950
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3951
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3952
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3955
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3956
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3957
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3958
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3959
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 3960
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 3966
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3970
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3971
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3972
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3977
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3978
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3979
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3980
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3981
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3982
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Pick Up Models
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3983
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3984
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3985
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3986
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3987
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3988
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3989
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3990
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3993
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3994
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3995
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3996
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3997
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3998
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 3999
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4000
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4001
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4002
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4003
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4004
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4005
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4006
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4007
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4008
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake > Page 4011
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4014
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4015
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4016
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4017
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 4022
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4027
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4028
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4029
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4030
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4031
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4032
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4033
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4034
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4035
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4036
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4037
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4040
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4041
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4042
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4043
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4044
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4045
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4046
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4047
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4048
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4049
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4050
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4051
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 4052
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Sensor-MAP
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-MAP
DESCRIPTION
A combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is used.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Sensor-MAP > Page 4055
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4058
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4059
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4060
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4065
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4066
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4067
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4068
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4069
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4070
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4071
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4072
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4073
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4074
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4075
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4076
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4077
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4078
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4079
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4080
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4081
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4082
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4091
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4092
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4093
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4094
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4095
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4096
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 4097
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4103
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4104
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4105
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4115
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4116
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4117
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4122
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4123
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4124
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4125
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4126
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4127
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
> Page 4128
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4138
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4139
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 4140
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4150
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4151
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4152
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4153
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4154
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4155
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update >
Page 4156
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4159
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4160
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4161
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4162
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4163
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4164
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4165
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4166
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4167
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4168
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4169
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4170
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4171
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4172
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4173
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4174
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4175
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4176
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4177
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4178
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4179
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4180
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4181
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4182
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4183
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4184
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4185
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4186
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4187
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen >
Page 4188
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Module-O2 Sensor
Component ID: 207
Component : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4191
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4192
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4193
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4194
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4195
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4196
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4197
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4198
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4199
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4200
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4201
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4202
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4203
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4204
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4205
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4206
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4207
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4208
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4209
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4210
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4211
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4212
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4213
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4214
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4215
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4216
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4217
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4218
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4219
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4220
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor >
Page 4221
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors (1) and (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models > Page 4224
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream (1), and 1/2
downstream (2).
A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description - Pick Up Models > Page 4225
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Module
Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream, and 1/2
downstream. A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Oxygen Sensor Module
Removal - Pick Up Models
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at module (1).
3. Remove four bolts (3).
4. Remove module from frame rail.
Installation - Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Position module (1) to frame rail (4).
2. Install four bolts (3).
3. Tighten bolts (3) to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to module (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 4228
5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 4229
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
CAUTION: Never apply any type of grease to the oxygen sensor electrical connector, or attempt
any soldering of the sensor wiring harness.
WARNING: The exhaust manifold, exhaust pipes and catalytic converters become very hot during
engine operation. Allow engine to cool before removing oxygen sensor.
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect main wire connector from O2S sensor pigtail harness.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wire going into
sensor.
3. Remove O2S sensor with an oxygen sensor removal and installation tool.
4. Clean threads in catalytic convertor using appropriate tap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen
Sensor Module > Page 4230
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Threads of NEW oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal.
DO NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new oxygen sensor. Be careful
not to get anti-seize compound on sensor tip.
1. Install O2S sensor. Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
2. Connect O2S sensor pigtail harness to main wire harness connector.
3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A pressure sensing switch is used in the power steering system. It is mounted on the high-pressure
steering hose. This switch will only be used on HD vehicles with the 5.7L engines. There is no
pressure switch used for the 3.7L, 4.7L, 5.9LDiesel engine or the 5.7L LD vehicle pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 4235
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The switch is used on the 5.7L V-8 engines HD vehicles only.
The power steering pressure switch provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
This input is provided during periods of high steering pump load and low engine rpm; such as
during parking maneuvers. The PCM increases the idle speed through the Idle Air Control (IAC)
motor. This is done to prevent the engine from stalling under the increased load.
When steering pump pressure exceeds 3275 kPa ± 690 kPa (475 psi ± 100 psi), the Normally
Closed (NC) switch will open and the PCM will increase the engine idle speed. This will prevent the
engine from stalling.
When pump pressure drops to approximately 1379 kPa (200 psi), the switch circuit will re-close
and engine idle speed will return to its previous setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4240
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4245
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4246
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4247
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4248
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4249
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4250
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4251
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4252
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4253
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4254
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4255
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4258
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4259
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4260
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4261
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4262
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4263
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4264
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4265
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4266
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4267
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 4268
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 4271
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 4272
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 4273
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 4274
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 4275
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 4278
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 4279
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 4280
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 4281
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 4282
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4286
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4287
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4288
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4293
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4294
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4295
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4296
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4297
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4298
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4299
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4300
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4301
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4302
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4303
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4304
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4305
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4306
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4307
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4308
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4309
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4310
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4316
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4317
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4318
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4319
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4320
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4321
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4322
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4323
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4326
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4327
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4328
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4329
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4330
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4331
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4332
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4333
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 4336
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4339
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4343
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4344
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4345
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4346
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4349
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
EGR Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 394
Component : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH/D1)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
OPERATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models > Page 4355
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Pick Up Models
OPERATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
A temperature probe (1) is located at the end of the sensor assembly (3).
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near EGR valve.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
2. Remove sensor (1) from EGR tube (6).
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4358
1. If equipped, remove four cover bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
2. If equipped, remove EGR valve cover (2).
3. A pigtail wiring harness connects sensor to engine wiring harness.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4359
4. Unscrew nut (2) at intake manifold.
5. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness electrical connector from engine wiring harness and remove
sensor assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4360
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
1. Clean EGR crossover tube at sensor mounting point.
2. Check condition of the sensors metal gasket and replace if necessary.
3. Install sensor (1) to EGR tube (6). Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4361
1. A pigtail wiring harness (3) connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Position sensor probe (1) into intake manifold.
3. Screw and tighten nut (2) into intake manifold.
4. Connect electrical connector (4) to engine wiring harness.
5. Install EGR valve cover (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4362
6. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Differential Pressure Sensor is remotely mounted on the transmission housing. Two
pressure tubes measure pressure before and after the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)/Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC). The sensor is critical for fail-safe of regeneration strategy, because it
interprets high pressure drops as possible high soot loads.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at pressure
differential pressure sensor. 4. Remove mounting bolt and differential pressure sensor. 5. Remove
mounting bolts (1).
6. Remove pressure differential pressure tubing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4368
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install differential pressure tubing, if removed. Tighten fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
2. Position differential pressure sensor (1). 3. Install mounting nuts (5) and bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 4. Install hose (2) to the rear DPF tubing. 5. Install hose (3) to the front DPF tubing. 6.
Connect electrical connector (6). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4373
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4378
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4379
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4380
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 4383
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 4386
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4390
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4391
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4392
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4393
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4396
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 4401
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 4402
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 4403
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Pressure
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
4404
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
4405
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
4406
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
4407
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel pressure sensor monitors actual high-pressure within the fuel rail. An output signal from
this sensor (relating to fuel pressure) is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
1. Remove two bolts (3) and bracket (4) at rear of cylinder head.
2. Remove engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4410
3. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
4. Remove sensor (1) from fuel rail.
5. Inspect sensor sealing surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 4411
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect fuel pressure sensor sealing surface.
2. Lubricate sensor threads with clean diesel fuel.
3. Install sensor (1) into fuel rail.
4. To prevent leaks, sensor must be tightened to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
6. Install rear engine lift bracket (4) and bolts (3). Tighten to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.).
7. Install engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
8. Start engine and check for fuel leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4415
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4416
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4417
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models >
Page 4422
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4423
Turbo Boost Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 4426
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 4427
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 4428
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Turbocharger Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove
turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt (1). 4. Remove turbocharger speed sensor (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install turbocharger speed sensor. 2. Install turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt. 3. Tighten
bolt to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4432
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4433
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
4434
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4439
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4440
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4441
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4442
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4443
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4444
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4445
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4446
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4447
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4448
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4449
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4450
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4451
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 4454
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
4457
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4461
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4462
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4463
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4464
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4465
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4466
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4467
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4468
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4469
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4470
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4471
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4472
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4473
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4474
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4475
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4476
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4477
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4478
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4479
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4480
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4481
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4482
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4483
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4484
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4485
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4486
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4487
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4488
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4489
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4490
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4491
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4492
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4493
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 4496
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
4499
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (1) for cylinder removal.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from
steering column. 3. Place shifter in PARK position. 4. A retaining pin is located at the underside of
the key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder (1) from
ignition switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Removal > Page 4505
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (3) for cylinder installation.
1. Install the key cylinder into the housing using care to align the end of the key cylinder (3) with the
ignition switch (1). 2. Push the key cylinder (3) in until it clicks. 3. Replace the upper and lower
shrouds. 4. Reconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page
4510
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURES
Fuel Pump/Gear Pump (low pressure)
................................................................................................................................ 551.5 - 1241 KPA
(80 - 180 psi)
Injection Pump .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 200 - 1800 bar (2900 - 26107 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
*FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
1. FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
Using the scan tool, idle the engine and measure the rail pressure and determine if the rail
pressure is excessive (above 185,00 kpa/26,831 psi). If it is, troubleshoot for excessive rail
pressure first.
Remove the banjo bolt from the pressure-limiting valve on the fuel rail.
Install fuel system test fitting 9013 into the pressure-limiting valve.
Attach one end of a fuel hose to the fuel fitting and put the other end of the fuel hose into a
container
Perform the tests listed below to determine if the pressure-limiting valve is leaking.
a. Operate the engine at idle and watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
b. Operate the engine at idle and actuate the high pressure safety valve test with the scan tool.
Watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
If fuel flows into the fuel container, replace the pressure-limiting valve. If fuel does not leak from the
pressure-limiting valve, the test is complete.
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with any portion of this test kit installed
Operate the engine until the engine is at operating temperature.
Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing
Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and put the open end into the graduated cylinder .
Start the engine and let it idle for one minute.
Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
If the flow is less than 1000ml/minute at idle, the test has successfully passed.
If the flow is greater than 1000ml/minute at idle, replace the fuel injection pump.
Retest to confirm repair.
View Repair
Repair
- Test Complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 4517
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection High Pressure Fuel Pump Performance Test
*HIGH PRESSURE FUEL PUMP PERFORMANCE TEST
If the engine will run do the following:
1. Monitor rail pressure with scan tool while the engine is at idle.
2. Compare the fuel pressure set point with the actual fuel pressure reading.
3. If actual fuel pressure reading fluctuates more than ± 500 psi from the set point, then replace the
Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
NOTE: After the actuator is removed, check for debris or corrosion on the FCA. If debris or
corrosion is found, replace the entire Fuel Injection Pump.
4. Turn off engine.
5. Disconnect the FCA harness
6. Disconnect high pressure fuel line from fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
8. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 second intervals (Note: This will give you 30 total seconds of
flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals to prevent damage to the starter). Fuel flow
specification s based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of fuel in 30
seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
If the engine is a no start do the following:
1. Remove fuel pump to rail high pressure fuel line.
2. Inspect the fuel pump outlet port for rust, debris, or other signs of contamination.
3. Replace pump if any contamination is found. Check for source of water in fuel or debris in fuel to
prevent future complaints. If no contamination is found continue to step 4.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
5. Disconnect the high pressure fuel line from the fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line to a
graduated cylinder.
6. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
7. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 seconds intervals.
NOTE: This will give you 30 total seconds of flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals
to prevent damage to the starter.
Fuel flow specification's based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of
fuel in 30 seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 4518
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection In-Tank Fuel Lift Pump Flow/Diagnostic Test Procedure
*IN-TANK FUEL LIFT PUMP FLOW/DIAGNOSTIC TEST PROCEDURE
1. Using the Scan tool, check for DTCs. Troubleshoot any active DTCs before performing this test.
2. Disconnect the wiring harness from the lift pump at the fuel tank module connector and inspect
the pins for damage. Fix or replace any damaged component.
3. Connect a voltmeter between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module
connector.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Use the Scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump, record the
voltage on the voltmeter.
5. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 14. If the voltage is less than 11.5 volts, go to
step 6
6. Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage to determine that the voltage is greater than 11.5
volts. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 7. If the voltage is not greater than 11.5
volts, troubleshoot for low battery voltage.
7. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage at the fuel
lift pump relay voltage supply pin in the PDC. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 8.
If the voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, fix or replace the harness.
8. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Install a spare relay in place of the fuel lift pump
relay. Using the Scan tool, actuate the fuel lift pump. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage
between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module connector while the fuel
lift pump is actuated. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, replace the fuel lift pump relay. If the
voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 9.
9. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the lift pump relay from the
PDC. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the resistance of the fuel lift pump power supply wire between
the PDC relay output pin and the fuel tank module connector. If the resistance is less than 10
ohms, go to step 10. If it is greater than 10 ohms, fix or replace the harness.
10. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between battery negative and the fuel lift pump
power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the voltage is less than 1 volt, go to step 11. If
the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between battery negative and the fuel lift
pump power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, fix or
replace the harness. If the resistance is greater than 10 ohms, go to step 12.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the
resistance of the fuel lift pump ground wire between the fuel tank module connector and battery
negative. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, go to step 13. If the resistance is greater than 10
ohms, fix or replace the harness.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using a voltmeter, measure the
voltage between the fuel lift pump ground wire and battery negative. If the voltage is less than 1
volt, go to step 14. If the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
14. Reconnect the lift pump connector.
FLOW TEST.
1. Remove the fuel pump supply banjo fitting from the fuel injection pump.
2. Install fuel system test fitting 9863 onto the end of the quick connect line going to the fuel
injection pump.
3. Connect one end of a section of fuel hose to the test fitting.
4. Put the other end of the fuel hose into an empty fuel container.
5. Use the scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump.
6. While the lift pump is running, move the fuel hose from the fuel canister into a 1000ml graduated
cylinder for 10 seconds.
7. Read and record the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds.
8. If you have more than 570ml in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds, the test has
successfully passed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 4519
9. If you have less than 570ml of fuel in the graduated cylinder, inspect the fuel supply line from the
fuel tank to the fuel filter housing and the fuel supply line between the fuel filter housing and the
high pressure fuel pump for signs of damage, replace as necessary. If no damage is found, replace
the fuel filter and retest.
10.Verify the Screened Banjo Bolt at the outlet of the fuel filter is free of debris. If debris is found,
rinse screen with water, blow dry and reinstall. Retest vehicle. If flow meets specification then trace
back the source of debris, if flow is still below spec repair damaged component.
11. If reading is still less than 570ml in 10 seconds, remove the fuel tank and fuel tank module.
Inspect for damage and/or debris in and around the fuel tank module. If module is damaged,
replace and retest.
12. If the module is not damaged, replace the fuel lift pump and retest to confirm fix.
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by manufacturer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Testing Air Cleaner Element using Filter Minder(TM)
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove top of air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
The air cleaner (filter) housing (5) is equipped with an air Filter Minder(TM) gauge (3). This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
The Filter Minder(TM) (5) consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic
housing. A yellow colored disc (2) attached to diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on side of
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within Filter Minder will
hold yellow disc at highest restriction that air cleaner element has experienced. A drop in air
pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves diaphragm and yellow disc will indicate
size of air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage plastic housing of Filter
Minder. Cover and tape Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be used.
To test, turn engine off. If yellow disc (2) has reached red colored zone (3) on graduated scale, air
cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to Removal / Installation.
Resetting Filter Minder: After air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press rubber button on
top of Filter Minder. This will allow yellow
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4528
colored disc to reset. After button has been pressed, yellow disc should spring back to UP position.
If Filter Minder gauge has reached red colored zone, and after an examination of air cleaner (filter)
element, element appears to be clean, high reading may be due to a temporary condition such as
snow build-up at air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also occur if air cleaner (filter) element
has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow element to dry out during
normal engine operation. Reset rubber button on top of Filter Minder and retest after element has
dried.
Filter Removal
1. The housing cover is equipped with spring clips and is hinged with plastic tabs. Unlatch clips
from top of air cleaner housing and tilt housing cover
up for cover removal.
2. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4529
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing new air cleaner element (filter), clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position
air cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch spring clips to seal cover to housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page
4534
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page
4535
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Severe Duty Filtration Kit Availability
NUMBER: 14-001-09
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: January 24, 2009
SUBJECT: Severe Duty Fuel Filtration Mopar Add On Kit Available
MODELS:
2005 - 2009 (D1/DH) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2009 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2005
model year and D1/DH/DC vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins engine built from 2007 model
year.
DISCUSSION: A frame mounted supplemental filter kit is now available for the vehicles listed
above. This kit includes complete instructions (K6855569AC) with all necessary components and
wiring to upgrade fuel filtering to a severe duty rating.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filters (on engine filter and added chassis mounted severe
duty fuel filtration kit filter) are 15,000 miles.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4538
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4541
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4542
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4543
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4544
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4545
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
DESCRIPTION
The cylinder block is constructed of cast iron. The casting is a skirted design which incorporates
longitudal ribs for superior strength and noise reduction. The block incorporates metric straight
thread o-ring fittings at lubrication oil access points. The engine is manufactured with the cylinders
being a non-sleeved type cylinder.
The cylinders are numbered front to rear ; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
System Information > Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing is not adjustable on any engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure (Minimum) ......................................................................................................
...................................................................... 350 psi.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 4555
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
CYLINDER COMPRESSION/LEAKAGE TESTS
CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE
The results of a cylinder compression pressure test can be utilized to diagnose several engine
malfunctions.
Ensure batteries are completely charged and the engine starter motor is in good operating
condition. Otherwise, the indicated compression pressures may not be valid for diagnostic
purposes.
1. Disconnect the fuel inlet line to the fuel filter housing. Plug the fuel line from the fuel tank.
NOTE: Failure to plug fuel line will result in fuel leak.
2. Remove fuel transfer pump relay from PDC. 3. Start the engine and idle until the engine stalls
(runs out of fuel). 4. Remove the cylinder head cover. 5. Remove the cylinder head cover carrier
gasket. 6. Remove the high pressure fuel line between the cylinder head and fuel rail for the
cylinder to be tested. Use tool 9864 to cap this fuel rail on the
cylinder being tested.
7. Remove the fuel connector tube nut and fuel connector tube. 8. Remove the exhaust rocker
lever. 9. Use Tool 9010 to remove the injector and copper sealing washer.
10. Install the exhaust rocker lever and torque to 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.). 11. Cover the remaining rocker
levers with clean shop towels to prevent any oil splatter under the hood. 12. Place a rag over the
compression test tool fitting. Crank the engine for 2-3 seconds to purge any fuel that may have
drained into the cylinder when
the injector was removed.
13. Connect the compression test gauge. 14. Crank the engine for 5 seconds and record the
pressure reading. Repeat this step three times and calculate the average of the three readings.
NOTE: The minimum cylinder pressure is 350 psi. Cylinder pressure should be within 20% from
cylinder to cylinder.
15. Combustion pressure leakage can be checked if cylinder pressure is below the specification.
Perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder
according to the tester manufacturer instructions.
16. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related fault codes.
CYLINDER COMBUSTION PRESSURE LEAKAGE
The combustion pressure leakage test provides an accurate means for determining engine
condition.
Combustion pressure leakage testing will detect:
- Exhaust and intake valve leaks (improper seating).
- Leaks between adjacent cylinders or into water jacket.
- Any causes for combustion/compression pressure loss
1. Start and operate the engine until it attains normal operating temperature. 2. Disconnect injector
harness connectors. 3. Disconnect CCV tube and breather drain tube from valve cover. 4. Remove
the cylinder head cover. 5. Disconnect harness from injectors. 6. Remove the cylinder head cover
carrier gasket. 7. Bring the cylinder to be tested to TDC. 8. Remove the high pressure fuel line
between the cylinder head and the fuel rail for the cylinder to be tested. 9. Install capping Tool 9864
onto the rail.
10. Remove the high pressure connector nut and high pressure connector with Tool 9015. 11.
Remove the exhaust and intake rocker lever. 12. Use Tool # 9010 to remove the injector and
copper sealing washer. 13. Install compression test Tool # 9007 into the injector bore. 14. Connect
the leakage tester and perform the leakage test procedure on each cylinder according to the tester
manufacturer's instructions. 15. Upon completion of the test check and erase any engine related
fault codes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Adjustments
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE LASH ADJUSTMENT AND VERIFICATION
NOTE: To obtain accurate readings, valve lash measurements AND adjustments should only be
performed when the engine coolant temperature is less than 60°C (140°F).
The 24-valve overhead system is a "low-maintenance" design. Routine adjustments are no longer
necessary, however, measurement should still take place when troubleshooting performance
problems, or upon completion of a repair that includes removal and installation of the valve train
components or injectors.
1. Disconnect battery negative cables. 2. Remove cylinder head cover. 3. Using the crankshaft
barring tool #7471-B, rotate crankshaft to align damper TDC mark to 12:00 o'clock position.
a. If both number one cylinder rocker levers are loose, continue to next step. b. If both number one
cylinder rocker levers are not loose, rotate crankshaft 360 degrees.
4. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be measured at the following rocker arms:
INTAKE 1-2-4 / EXHAUST 1-3-5. Measure the valve
lash by inserting a feeler gauge between the rocker arm socket and crosshead. Refer to VALVE
LASH LIMIT CHART for the correct specifications. If the measurement falls within the limits,
adjustment/resetting is not necessary. If measurement finds the lash outside of the limits,
adjustment/resetting is required.
Valve Lash Limit Chart
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Adjustments > Page 4559
5. If adjustment/resetting is required, loosen the lock nut on rocker arms and turn the adjusting
screw until the desired lash is obtained:
- INTAKE 0.254 mm (0.010 in.)
- EXHAUST 0.660 mm (0.026 in.) Tighten the lock nut to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) and recheck the valve
lash.
6. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the crankshaft one revolution (360°) to align the damper
TDC mark to the 12 o'clock position. 7. With the engine in this position, valve lash can be
measured at the remaining rocker arms: INTAKE 3-5-6 / EXHAUST 2-4-6. Use the same
method as above for determining whether adjustment is necessary, and adjust those that are found
to be outside of the limits.
8. Install the cylinder head cover. 9. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4564
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4565
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4566
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4569
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4572
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4576
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4577
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4578
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4579
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4582
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4587
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4588
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4589
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4590
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4591
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4592
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Pick Up Models
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4593
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4594
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4595
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4596
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4597
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4598
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4599
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4600
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4603
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4604
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4605
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4606
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4607
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4608
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4609
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4610
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4611
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4612
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4613
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4614
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4615
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4616
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4617
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Page 4618
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake > Page 4621
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4624
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4625
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4626
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 4627
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4633
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor (3) into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (2).
4. Install electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4637
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4638
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4639
Battery Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4640
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4641
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Battery Temperature Sensor (BTS) is used only on the diesel engine. It is attached to the
battery tray located under the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Battery Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 4644
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The BTS is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery charging rate. This
temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the PCM (ECM Diesel) to
vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The PCM sends 5 volts to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As
temperature increases, resistance in the sensor decreases and the detection voltage at the PCM
increases.
The BTS is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II monitors are either enabled
or disabled, depending upon BTS input (for example, disable purge and enable Leak Detection
Pump (LDP) and O2 sensor heater tests). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20° F.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped
into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4) .
1. Remove battery.
2. Pry sensor (1) straight up from battery tray mounting hole to gain access to electrical connector
(3) .
3. Disconnect sensor from engine wire harness electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 4647
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached
(snapped into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4).
1. Pull electrical connector (3) up through mounting hole in top of battery tray.
2. Connect sensor.
3. Snap sensor into battery tray.
4. Install battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4652
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4653
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4654
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4655
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4656
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4657
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4658
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4659
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4660
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4661
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4662
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4663
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4664
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4665
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4666
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4667
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4668
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4669
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4673
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4674
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4675
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4676
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4677
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4678
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4679
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4680
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4681
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4682
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4683
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4684
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4685
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4688
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4691
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4696
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4697
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4698
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4699
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4700
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4701
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4702
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4703
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4706
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4707
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4708
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4709
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4710
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4711
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4712
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 4713
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4716
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4719
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4723
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4724
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4725
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4726
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4729
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4734
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4737
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4741
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4742
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4743
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4744
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4745
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4746
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4747
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4748
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4749
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4750
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4751
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4752
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4753
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4754
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4755
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4756
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4757
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4758
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4759
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4760
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4761
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4762
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4763
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4764
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4765
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4766
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4767
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4768
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4769
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4770
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4771
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4772
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4773
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4776
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 4779
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Data Link Connector
Data Link Connector: Locations Data Link Connector
Component ID: 79
Component : DATA LINK CONNECTOR
Connector:
Name : DATA LINK CONNECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 16
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3-4 GROUND Z11 18BK/LG
5 GROUND Z111 18BK/WT
6 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (+) D52 20WT/LB
7 SCI TRANSMIT (ECM) D21 18WT/BR
7 SCI TRANSMIT (PCM) D21 18WT/BR
8-9 SCI RECEIVE (TCM) D16 18WT/OR
10 - 11 - 12 SCI RECEIVE (ECM) D20 20WT/LG
12 SCI RECEIVE (PCM) D20 20WT/LG
13 - 14 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (-) D51 20WT/BR
15 SCI TRANSMIT (TCM) D15 18WT/DG
16 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
Component Location - 49
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Data Link Connector > Page 4784
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Data Link Connector > Page 4785
Data Link Connector: Locations Port-Diagnostic
Component ID: 232
Component : PORT-DIAGNOSTIC
Connector:
Name : PORT-DIAGNOSTIC
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
A DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
B DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
C-Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Data Link Connector > Page 4786
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4789
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4790
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4791
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4792
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4793
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4794
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4795
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4796
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4797
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4798
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4799
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4800
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4801
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4802
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4803
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4804
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4805
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4806
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4807
Data Link Connector: Connector Views
Data Link Connector
Component ID: 79
Component : DATA LINK CONNECTOR
Connector:
Name : DATA LINK CONNECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 16
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3-4 GROUND Z11 18BK/LG
5 GROUND Z111 18BK/WT
6 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (+) D52 20WT/LB
7 SCI TRANSMIT (ECM) D21 18WT/BR
7 SCI TRANSMIT (PCM) D21 18WT/BR
8-9 SCI RECEIVE (TCM) D16 18WT/OR
10 - 11 - 12 SCI RECEIVE (ECM) D20 20WT/LG
12 SCI RECEIVE (PCM) D20 20WT/LG
13 - 14 DIAGNOSTIC CAN C (-) D51 20WT/BR
15 SCI TRANSMIT (TCM) D15 18WT/DG
16 FUSED B(+) A114 18GY/RD
Component Location - 49
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4808
Port-Diagnostic
Component ID: 232
Component : PORT-DIAGNOSTIC
Connector:
Name : PORT-DIAGNOSTIC
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
A DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
B DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
C-Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4809
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Data Link Connector (DLC) (3) is a 16-way molded plastic connector insulator on a dedicated
take out of the instrument panel wire harness. This connector is located at the lower edge of the
instrument panel, outboard of the steering column. The connector insulator is retained by integral
snap features within a rectangular cutout in the lower instrument panel reinforcement (2), just
below the lower edge of the instrument panel steering column opening cover (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4812
Data Link Connector: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Data Link Connector (DLC) is an industry-standard 16-way connector that permits the
connection of a diagnostic scan tool to the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus for interfacing
with, configuring, and retrieving Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) data from the electronic modules
that reside on the data bus network of the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Electronic Throttle Control Indicator: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
An Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters.
However, on vehicles not equipped with the optional 5.7 liter gasoline engine, this indicator is
electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The ETC indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International Control and Display Symbol
icon for Electronic Throttle Control in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark
outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not illuminated.
A red Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the
indicator to appear in red through the translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated
from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The ETC indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control
Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 4817
Electronic Throttle Control Indicator: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
ETC system, or a circuit or component of the system is ineffective. The ETC indicator is controlled
by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and
electronic messages received by the cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The ETC indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the ETC indicator for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the ETC indicator is
illuminated for about six seconds. The entire bulb test is a function of the PCM.
- ETC Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic ETC indicator
lamp-ON message from the PCM, the ETC indicator will be illuminated. The indicator can be
flashed ON and OFF, or illuminated solid, as dictated by the PCM message. The indicator remains
illuminated solid or continues to flash for about 12 seconds or until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF
message from the PCM, whichever is longer. If the indicator is illuminated solid with the engine
running the vehicle will usually remain drivable. If the indicator is flashing with the engine running
the vehicle may require towing. A flashing indicator means the ETC system requires immediate
service. The indicator will be extinguished when the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the PCM
for three consecutive seconds, the ETC indicator is illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated
until the cluster receives a single lamp-OFF message from the PCM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the ETC indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry. The actuator test illumination of the ETC indicator is a
function of the PCM.
The PCM continually monitors the ETC system circuits and sensors to decide whether the system
is in good operating condition. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to
the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the PCM sends a lamp-ON message after the
bulb test, it indicates that the PCM has detected an ETC system malfunction or that the ETC
system is ineffective. The PCM will store a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for any malfunction it
detects. Each time the ETC indicator fails to illuminate due to an open or short in the cluster ETC
indicator circuit, the cluster sends a message notifying the PCM of the condition, then the EMIC
and the PCM will each store a DTC.
For proper diagnosis of the ETC system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic
communication related to ETC indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4826
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4827
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4828
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4829
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4830
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4831
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust
Regeneration > Page 4832
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle
Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle
Fails I/M Test > Page 4838
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4843
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4844
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4845
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4846
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 4852
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4857
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4858
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4859
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4860
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4865
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4866
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4867
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4868
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4869
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4870
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 >
Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4871
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: >
18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10
> May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10
> May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 4881
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10
> Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10
> Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4886
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10
> Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4887
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10
> Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4888
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10
> Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 4889
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07
> Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4899
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4900
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4901
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4902
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4903
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4904
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr >
10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 4905
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4912
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4913
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4914
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4915
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4916
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4917
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4918
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4919
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4920
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4921
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4922
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4923
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4924
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - 37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4925
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4926
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4927
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4928
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
123456-
789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 32 -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4929
33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4930
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4931
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - 38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4932
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4933
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4934
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4935
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4936
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4937
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4938
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4939
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4940
56 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4941
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4942
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4943
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4944
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control > Page 4945
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4948
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4949
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4950
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4951
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4952
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4953
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4954
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4955
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4956
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4957
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4958
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4959
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4960
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4961
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4962
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4963
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4964
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4965
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4966
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4967
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4968
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4969
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4970
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4971
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4972
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4973
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4974
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4975
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4976
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4977
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4978
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4979
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - 37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4980
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4981
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4982
Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4983
Pin Description Circuit
123456789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 32 33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4984
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4985
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4986
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - 38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4987
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4988
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4989
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4990
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4991
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4992
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4993
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4994
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4995
56 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4996
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4997
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4998
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4999
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5000
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
CUMMINS FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5003
The Engine Control Module (ECM) for the 5.9L diesel engine (16) is bolted to the left side of the
engine below the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5004
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The main function of the Engine Control Module (ECM) is to electrically control the fuel system.
The ECM also controls certain transmission and other functions previously controlled by the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
The ECM receives input signals from various switches and sensors. Based on these inputs, the
ECM regulates various engine and vehicle operations through different system components. These
components are referred to as ECM Outputs. The sensors and switches that provide inputs to the
ECM are considered ECM Inputs.
NOTE: ECM Inputs:
- Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) Signals #1 and #2
- AC system pressure
- Auto shutdown (ASD) sense
- Battery temperature
- Battery temperature sensor
- Battery voltage
- Brake switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP)
- Data link connection for a scan tool
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
- EATX module (if equipped)
- Fuel level
- Fuel pressure sensor
- Fan speed (engine cooling fan)
- Generator (battery voltage) output
- Governor pressure (Auto. trans.)
- Ground circuits
- Inlet air temperature sensor/pressure sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor/MAP sensor
- CAN C BUS (+) circuits
- CAN C BUS (-) circuits
- Key switch (ignition)
- Oil Pressure switch
- Overdrive switch (automatic transmission only)
- Park/neutral switch (auto. trans. only)
- Power ground
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Sensor return
- Signal ground
- Speed control multiplexed single wire input
- Transfer case switch (4WD range position)
- Transmission governor psi (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission OSS (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil pressure (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil temperature (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve position (automatic transmission only)
- Vehicle speed signal
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor
NOTE: ECM Outputs:
After inputs are received by the ECM, certain sensors, switches and components are controlled or
regulated by the ECM. These are considered ECM Outputs. These outputs are for:
- A/C clutch relay
- Auto shutdown (ASD) relay
- Data link connection for diagnostic scan tool
- Fan clutch PWM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5005
- Five volt sensor supply (primary)
- Five volt sensor supply (secondary)
- Fuel control actuator
- Fuel injector driver circuits
- Fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Generator field driver (-)
- Generator field driver (+)
- Governor pressure (VFS solenoid)
- Intake manifold air heater relays #1 and #2 control circuits
- CAN C BUS (+/-) circuits for: speedometer, voltmeter, fuel gauge, oil pressure gauge/lamp,
engine temp. gauge and speed control warn. lamp
- Malfunction indicator lamp (Check engine lamp). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- Oil pressure switch/warning lamp (databus)
- Overdrive/3-4 shift solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- SC source
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Speed control vacuum solenoid
- Speed control vent solenoid
- Tachometer (if equipped). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- TCC solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission battery relay (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve actuator (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission governor solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Wait-to-start warning lamp (databus)
- Turbo wastegate solenoid
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) warning lamp (databus)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection PCM/ECM Programming
PCM/ECM REPROGRAMMING
MODULE REPROGRAMING
Replacement PCM's will require programming utilizing the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. The PCM
will not operate the engine until it is programmed. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will be set "not programmed".
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a calibration is selected and programmed, the controller
cannot be reprogrammed to a different calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a
more recent version of that calibration.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT OR EQUIVALENT REQUIRED:
**REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity.
However, in order to take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent for your dealership's network.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
5. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
6. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM. 7. Program the PCM as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen, Select "ECU View" b. Touch the
screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming > Page 5008
f. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 5.
g. Select "Download to Scantool". h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select
"Back". i.
Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK". l.
Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part number.
8. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 9. b. No >> go to STEP 10.
9. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM).
a. Highlight the WCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c. Highlight "PCM Replaced". d. Select "Start" e.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step. f.
When complete proceed to STEP 11.
10. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
11. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 13. b. No >> go to STEP 12.
12. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select ECU View b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select Misc.
Function. d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select Next after each step . Select Finish after completing the
last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the Home screen select System View. Then select All DTCs. Press Clear All
Stored DTCs if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM and/or TCM.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
REPAIR PROCEDURE USING SOFTWARE UPDATE CD TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming > Page 5009
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
3. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
5. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM.
6. Insert the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software Update CD into the Techconnect or equivalent
PC. The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software
Update CD will start automatically. Select "Download Flash Updates".
7. At the "Select a method for looking up controller flash updates." screen:
a. Select "Enter part number". Enter the "Part Number" recorded in STEP 4 when prompted to do
so. b. Using the mouse highlight the appropriate "Calibration". Select "Next". c. Follow the on
screen instructions. d. When completed, proceed to STEP 8.
8. With the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent powered OFF, connect the USB Key and Gender Changer
to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent USB port .
9. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent to the vehicle (if not already connected).
10. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
11. Download the flash file from the USB key to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. Using the
StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "Flash Download", then select "Retrieve files from the USB storage device" b. Highlight
the appropriate calibration. Select "Download to Scan Tool" c. When the download is complete,
select "Close" and "Back".
12. Reprogram the ECU. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View". b. Select More Options". c. Select "ECU Flash". d. Highlight the appropriate
calibration. e. Select "Update Controller". Follow the on screen instructions. f.
When the update is complete, select "OK".
g. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part
number.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming > Page 5010
13. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 14. b. No >> go to STEP 15.
14. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM). Using the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the WCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "PCM Replaced". e. Select "Start". f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
g. When complete proceed to STEP 16.
15. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
16. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 18. b. No >> go to STEP 17.
17. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
Check all modules using "ECU View" from the Home screen, record the DTC's, and erase these
DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all
other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE: The following step is required by law.
18. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming > Page 5011
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection SKREEM Programming
SKREEM PROGRAMMING
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) for a gasoline engine, or an Engine Control Module
(ECM) for a diesel engine and the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the
Wireless Control Module/WCM) on vehicles equipped with the Sentry Key Immobilizer System
(SKIS) are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new PCM/ECM.
2. Program the new SKREEM/WCM.
3. Replace all ignition keys and program them into the new SKREEM/WCM.
PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKREEM/WCM. This code is
programmed and stored in the SKREEM/WCM, the PCM/ECM, and each ignition key transponder
chip. When the PCM/ECM or SKREEM/WCM is replaced, it is necessary to program the Secret
Key into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool. Follow the programming steps outlined in
the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, ECM REPLACED, WCM REPLACED, or
GATEWAY REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL
MODULE/WCM menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Be certain to enter the correct country code for the SKREEM/WCM. If the incorrect country
code is programmed into the SKREEM, it cannot be changed and the SKREEM must be replaced.
NOTE: In addition, the SKREEM/WCM must be configured for certain optional equipment in the
vehicle, including Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM), Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) and Remote Start.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool under MISCELLANEOUS
FUNCTIONS for the WCM/WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: A replacement SKREEM/WCM is supplied with TPM enabled by default; therefore, if the
vehicle is not equipped with TPM, the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) will incorrectly
learn that the vehicle has TPM after the replacement SKREEM is installed. The TPM indicator in
the EMIC will illuminate to show a TPM fault condition after TPM has been disabled in the
SKREEM. The EMIC must unlearn TPM to correct this false TPM indication. Follow the
programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for CLEAR LEARNED FEATURES under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the INSTRUMENT CLUSTER menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: If the PCM/ECM and the SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle ignition
keys will need to be replaced and the new keys programmed into the new SKREEM/WCM.
NOTE: Programming the PCM/ECM or SKREEM is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to
enter secure access mode. If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an
incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn
the ignition to the RUN position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all
accessories are turned OFF. Also monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if
necessary.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKREEM
Each ignition key transponder also has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is
manufactured. When a key is programmed into the SKREEM/WCM, the transponder ID code is
learned by the module and the transponder acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the
SKREEM/WCM. To program ignition keys into the SKREEM/WCM, follow the programming steps
outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS OR KEY FOBS under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE/WCM menu item.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKREEM. Once a key is learned to a
SKREEM, that key has acquired the Secret Key for that SKREEM and cannot be transferred to any
other SKREEM or vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the scan tool will display one of the following error
messages:
- PROGRAMMING NOT ATTEMPTED - The scan tool attempts to read the programmed key status
and there are no keys programmed into SKREEM memory.
- PROGRAMMING KEY FAILED (POSSIBLE USED KEY FROM WRONG VEHICLE) - SKREEM is
unable to program an ignition key transponder due to one of the following:
- The ignition key transponder is ineffective.
- The ignition key transponder is or has been already programmed to another vehicle.
- 8 KEYS ALREADY LEARNED, PROGRAMMING NOT DONE - The SKREEM transponder ID
memory is full.
- LEARNED KEY IN IGNITION - The ID for the ignition key transponder currently in the ignition lock
cylinder is already programmed into SKREEM memory.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM Programming > Page 5012
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Programming The SKREEM/WCM Using The Scan
Tool
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM/WCM USING THE SCAN TOOL
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle.
2. Connect the scan tool.
CAUTION: If the ECM/PCM and SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, the ECM/PCM
MUST be programmed before the SKREEM/WCM.
3. Select "ECU View".
4. Select "WCM Wireless Control Module".
5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions".
6. Select WCM replaced.
7. Enter the PIN when prompted.
8. Verify the correct information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL
The Engine Control Module (ECM) (5) is located on the left side of the engine. A support bracket
mounts to the block with four capscrews and vibration isolators. A ground wire is fastened to the
bracket. The other end of the wire is fastened to the engine block.
1. Record any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) found in the ECM.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to the ECM, ignition key must be off, and both negative
battery cables must be disconnected before unplugging ECM connectors.
2. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Access to the ECM is easier by working through the left front wheel opening.
3. Remove left front wheel.
4. Remove plastic left front fender splash shield.
5. Remove electrical connector bolts at ECM. Note: As each bolt is being removed, very carefully
remove connectors from the ECM.
6. Remove three ECM mounting bolts (6) and remove ECM from engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5015
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
6.7L DIESEL
Do not apply paint to ECM or a poor ground will result.
1. Position ECM (5) to the ECM support bracket and install mounting bolts. Tighten bolts to 24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.).
2. Check pins in electrical connectors for corrosion, damage or dirt intrusion. Also check all pins for
being bent. Repair as necessary. Damaged,
dirty, bent or corroded pins could result in poor conductivity, causing intermittent electrical issues or
DTC's.
3. Clean pins in electrical connectors with an electrical contact cleaner.
4. Install connectors to ECM. Tighten connector bolts to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.).
5. Install splash shield.
6. Install left front wheel.
7. Connect both negative battery cables.
8. Use a diagnostic scan tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) from ECM.
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5016
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5021
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5022
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5023
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5024
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5025
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5026
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5029
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5030
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5031
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5032
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5033
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1 > Page 5034
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5040
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5044
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5045
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 5046
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5051
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5052
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5053
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5054
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5055
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5056
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5057
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5058
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5059
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5060
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5061
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5062
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5063
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5064
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5065
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5066
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5067
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5068
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5069
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
8w-18-02
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5070
8w-18-03
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5071
8w-18-04
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5072
8w-18-05
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5073
8w-18-06
Other Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (i.e. 8W-70-2, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at the vehicle level under Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical
Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5078
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5082
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5083
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5084
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5085
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5086
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. This indicator
is located near the lower edge of the instrument cluster, between the tachometer and the
speedometer.
The MIL consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International Control and Display Symbol icon for
Engine in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay
prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting
Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in
amber through the translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the
LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The MIL is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5091
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) on vehicles with a gasoline engine, or the Engine Control
Module (ECM) on vehicles with a diesel engine has recorded a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for
an On-Board Diagnostics II (OBDII) emissions-related circuit or component malfunction. The MIL is
controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming
and electronic messages received by the cluster from the PCM or ECM over the Controller Area
Network (CAN) data bus.
The MIL Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster logic circuit,
and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster receives a battery
current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be
OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED only illuminates
when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The instrument cluster will
turn ON the MIL for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the indicator is illuminated
for about two seconds as a bulb test. The entire bulb test is a function of the PCM or ECM.
- MIL Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic MIL lamp-ON message
from the PCM or ECM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator can be flashed ON and OFF,
or illuminated solid, as dictated by the PCM or ECM message. For some DTCs, if a problem does
not recur, the PCM or ECM will send a lamp-OFF message automatically. Other DTCs may require
that a fault be repaired and the PCM or ECM be reset before a lamp-OFF message will be sent.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the PCM
or ECM for about 10 seconds, the MIL is illuminated by the instrument cluster to indicate a loss of
bus communication. The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid
message is received from the PCM or ECM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the MIL indicator will be
turned ON during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the
cluster control circuitry.
The PCM or ECM continually monitors the fuel and emissions system circuits and sensors to
decide whether the system is in good operating condition. The PCM or ECM then sends the proper
lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the EMIC
turns ON the MIL after the bulb test, it may indicate that a malfunction has occurred and that the
fuel and emissions systems may require service.
For proper diagnosis of the fuel and emissions systems, the PCM, the ECM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to MIL operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5096
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5097
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5098
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5099
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5100
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5101
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5102
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5103
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5104
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5105
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5106
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5109
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5110
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5111
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5112
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5113
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5114
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5115
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5116
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5117
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5118
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5119
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5120
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5121
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sensor-MAP
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-MAP
DESCRIPTION
A combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is used.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Sensor-MAP > Page 5124
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5127
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5128
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5129
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5134
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5135
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5136
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5137
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5138
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5139
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5140
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5141
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5142
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5143
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5144
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5145
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5146
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5147
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5148
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5149
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5150
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5151
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5160
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5161
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5162
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5163
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5164
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5165
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 5166
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5172
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5173
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5174
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 >
Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5184
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5185
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 >
Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5186
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5191
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5192
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5193
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5194
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5195
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5196
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5197
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine
Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5207
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5208
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine
Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5209
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5219
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5220
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5221
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5222
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5223
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5224
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2
Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5225
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5228
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5229
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5230
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5231
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5232
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5233
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5234
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5235
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5236
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5237
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5238
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5239
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5240
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5241
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5242
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5243
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5244
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5245
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5246
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5247
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5248
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5249
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5250
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5251
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5252
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5253
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5254
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5255
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5256
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5257
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Module-O2 Sensor
Component ID: 207
Component : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5260
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5261
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5262
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5263
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5264
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5265
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5266
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5267
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5268
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5269
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5270
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5271
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5272
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5273
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5274
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5275
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5276
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5277
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5278
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5279
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5280
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5281
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5282
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5283
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5284
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5285
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5286
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5287
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5288
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5289
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page 5290
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description - Pick Up Models
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors (1) and (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description - Pick Up Models > Page 5293
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream (1), and 1/2
downstream (2).
A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description - Pick Up Models > Page 5294
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Module
Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream, and 1/2
downstream. A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor Module
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Oxygen Sensor Module
Removal - Pick Up Models
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at module (1).
3. Remove four bolts (3).
4. Remove module from frame rail.
Installation - Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Position module (1) to frame rail (4).
2. Install four bolts (3).
3. Tighten bolts (3) to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to module (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor Module > Page 5297
5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor Module > Page 5298
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
CAUTION: Never apply any type of grease to the oxygen sensor electrical connector, or attempt
any soldering of the sensor wiring harness.
WARNING: The exhaust manifold, exhaust pipes and catalytic converters become very hot during
engine operation. Allow engine to cool before removing oxygen sensor.
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect main wire connector from O2S sensor pigtail harness.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wire going into
sensor.
3. Remove O2S sensor with an oxygen sensor removal and installation tool.
4. Clean threads in catalytic convertor using appropriate tap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor Module > Page 5299
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Threads of NEW oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal.
DO NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new oxygen sensor. Be careful
not to get anti-seize compound on sensor tip.
1. Install O2S sensor. Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
2. Connect O2S sensor pigtail harness to main wire harness connector.
3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor Relay: Diagrams
2007-2009 Ram truck, 6.7L, use an O2 module for oxygen sensor heater control.
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A pressure sensing switch is used in the power steering system. It is mounted on the high-pressure
steering hose. This switch will only be used on HD vehicles with the 5.7L engines. There is no
pressure switch used for the 3.7L, 4.7L, 5.9LDiesel engine or the 5.7L LD vehicle pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 5307
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The switch is used on the 5.7L V-8 engines HD vehicles only.
The power steering pressure switch provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
This input is provided during periods of high steering pump load and low engine rpm; such as
during parking maneuvers. The PCM increases the idle speed through the Idle Air Control (IAC)
motor. This is done to prevent the engine from stalling under the increased load.
When steering pump pressure exceeds 3275 kPa ± 690 kPa (475 psi ± 100 psi), the Normally
Closed (NC) switch will open and the PCM will increase the engine idle speed. This will prevent the
engine from stalling.
When pump pressure drops to approximately 1379 kPa (200 psi), the switch circuit will re-close
and engine idle speed will return to its previous setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 5312
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Body Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5318
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5319
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5320
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5321
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5322
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5323
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5324
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5325
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5326
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5327
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5328
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5329
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5330
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5331
Body Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5332
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5333
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5334
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5335
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5344
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5345
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5346
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5347
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5348
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5349
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 5350
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 5356
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 5361
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 5362
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 5363
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 5364
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page
5370
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 5375
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 5376
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 5377
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35 > Page 5378
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5383
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5384
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5385
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5386
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5387
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5388
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
> Page 5389
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page
5399
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls - CCN Update For
Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 5404
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 5405
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 5406
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall
J35 > Page 5407
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 18-030-07 > Apr > 07 > Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed Limit
Feature
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Engine Off Idle Speed
Limit Feature
NUMBER: 18-030-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 26, 2007
SUBJECT: Engine Off-Idle Speed Limit Feature To Protect Turbocharger When Vehicle Is Not
Moving
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves a discussion regarding an engine control feature that limits
engine off-idle speeds when the vehicle is not moving.
MODELS:
2004 - 2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 5.9L or a 6.7L Cummins turbo-diesel engine (sale
codes: ETC, ETH, or ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Dependent upon engine coolant temperature, the Engine Control Module (ECM) will temporarily
delay (limit) the maximum engine speed when the vehicle is not moving. For automatic
transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is temporarily delayed when the
vehicle speed is less than one mph, and when the transmission selector is in either the neutral or
park position. For manual transmission equipped vehicles, the maximum engine speed is
temporarily delayed when the vehicle speed is less than one mph. This ECM feature is used to
protect the engine turbocharger.
By temporarily limiting the vehicle engine speed, the shaft speed of the engine turbocharger is
controlled to a low speed. This delay in maximum engine and turbo-charger shaft speed allows for
sufficient oil lubrication to the turbocharger shaft bearings. Satisfactory oil lubrication of the
turbocharger shaft bearings is important for long term turbocharger durability.
The maximum engine speed for the 5.9L engine is temporarily limited to 1,600 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The 6.7L engine speed is temporarily limited to 1,200 RPM's when the
above conditions are met. The length of time that the maximum engine speed is temporarily limited
is dependent upon engine coolant temperature. Refer to the table to determine the amount of Time
Delay.
NOTE:
The time delay values supplied in the table are an approximation and may vary per application.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5417
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5418
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5419
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5420
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5421
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5422
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 5423
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5430
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5431
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5432
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5433
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5434
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5435
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5436
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5437
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5438
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5439
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5440
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5441
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5442
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5443
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5444
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5445
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5446
Engine Control Module: Locations Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
123456-
789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 32 -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5447
33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5448
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5449
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5450
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5451
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5452
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5453
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5454
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5455
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5456
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5457
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5458
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5459
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5460
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5461
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5462
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Module-Engine Control
> Page 5463
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5466
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5467
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5468
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5469
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5470
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5471
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5472
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5473
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5474
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5475
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5476
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5477
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5478
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5479
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5480
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5481
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5482
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5483
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5484
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Module-Engine Control
Component ID: 203
Component : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
2 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
3-4 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
5 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
6 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
7 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
8 TTVA MOTOR (+) K314 18TN/YL
9-10 - 11 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR GROUND K923 18BR/WT
12 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
13 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
14 - 15 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
16 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
17 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
18 - 19 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
20 TTVA MOTOR (-) K315 18TN/OR
21 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
22 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
23 SENSOR GROUND K200 18BR/YL
24 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
25 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
28 - 29 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
30 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
31 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5485
32 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
33 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/YL
34 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N210 18DB/DG
35 - 36 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
37 - 38 - 39 - 40 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
41 SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
42 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/VT
43 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
44 - 45 - 46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
47 - 48 - 49 - 50 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
51 - 52 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
53 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
54 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
55 - 56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
57 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 16TN/PK
58 - 59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 16BR/LG
60 - Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5486
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5487
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5488
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
2 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
3 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
4 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5489
5 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
6-7 FAN SPEED SENSOR GROUND K161 18BR/LB
8-9 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
10 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
11 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
12 - 13 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-) K314 18BR
14 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
15 ECT SIGNAL K2 18VT/OR
16 - 17 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
18 FAN SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL N27 18DB/GY
19 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
20 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
21 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
22 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
23 - 24 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
25 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
27 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
28 GEN SENSE A804 18RD
29 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
30 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
31 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
32 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 18VT/GY
33 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
34 WATER IN FUEL SENSOR SIGNAL G123 18VT/LG
35 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
36 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
37 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
38 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
39 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
40 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
41 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
42 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
43 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
44 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
45 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 16BR/VT
46 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 16BR/DB
47 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
48 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
49 - 50 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
51 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 16GY/BR
52 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 16YL/BR
53 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 16OR/BR
54 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 16BR/TN
55 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 16GY
56 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 16TN
57 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 16BR/YL
58 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 16LG/BR
59 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 16LB/BR
60 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 16WT/BR
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5490
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5491
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5492
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5493
5 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 18YL/DB
6 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
7 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
8-9 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 18YL/DB
10 - 11 - 12 - 13 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 18DG
14 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
15 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
16 - 17 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
18 - 19 - 20 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
21 GROUND Z902 16BK
22 - 23 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
24 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
25 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
26 - 27 TTVA POSITION SENSOR SIGNAL K312 18OR
28 - 29 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
30 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
31 - 32 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
33 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
34 - 35 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
36 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
37 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
38 - 39 - 40 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
41 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB/OR
42 - 43 PWM FAN COIL SIGNAL K160 18BR/OR
44 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
45 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
46 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
47 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
48 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
49 GROUND Z902 16BK
50 GROUND Z902 16BK
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5494
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5495
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5496
Connector:
Name : MODULE-ENGINE CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
60
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CAN C BUS (+) D65 18WT/LG
2 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 18BR
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5497
5 EXHAUST BRAKE SWITCH SIGNAL G905 18BR/OR
6 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 18VT/YL
7 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
8 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
9 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/OR
10 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - 15 CLUTCH INTERLOCK/UPSTOP SWITCH OUTPUT T26 18DG/OR
16 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
17 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
18 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
19 - 20 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 18WT/LB
22 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
23 - 24 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 18WT/BR
25 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 18DG/WT
26 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
27 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 18BR/LB
28 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 18BR/DG
29 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
30 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 18DB/VT
31 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 18WT/OR
32 - 33 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
34 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
35 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 18BR/WT
36 - -
37 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DG/LG
38 - 39 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
40 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 18VT
41 - 42 - 43 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
44 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 18LB
45 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 18PK/GY
46 - 47 GROUND Z902 16BK
48 GROUND Z902 16BK
49 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
50 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
51 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 18WT
52 - 53 - 54 EXHAUST BRAKE LAMP SIGNAL G904 18VT/DG
55 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
56 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 18VT/OR
57 GROUND Z902 16BK
58 - 59 - 60 FUSED B(+) A209 16RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5498
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5499
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5500
Module-Powertrain Control
Component ID: 209
Component : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5501
Pin Description Circuit
123456789-10 11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 14 15 16 17 18 - 19 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
20 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
21 22 23 24 25 26 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 29 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 -
32 33 34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 38 Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5502
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5503
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C1
Color : BLACK/BLACK
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 8 K98 18DB/YL
2-3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 7 K97 18BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5504
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 8 K28 18BR/LB
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 7 K26 18BR/YL
6-7-8-9 GROUND Z130 16BK/BR
10 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
11 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F202 20PK/GY
12 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 - 17 - 18 GROUND Z131 16BK/DG
19 GROUND Z951 16BK/YL
20 OIL PRESSURE SIGNAL G6 16VT/GY
21 - 22 - 23 - 24 GEN SENSE A804 18RD/GY
25 - 27 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
28 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 4 K452 20BR/LB
29 FUSED B(+) A918 16RD
30 IGNITION START T751 20YL
31 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
32 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
33 O2 2/2 SIGNAL K243 20BR
34 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
35 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
36 - -
38 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5505
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5506
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C2
Color : BLACK/ORANGE
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 COIL CONTROL NO. 6 K10 18DB/OR
2 COIL CONTROL NO. 5 K16 18DB/YL
3 COIL CONTROL NO. 4 K15 18DB/GY
4 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5507
5 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
6 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
7 COIL CONTROL NO. 3 K18 18DB/OR
8 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
9 COIL CONTROL NO. 2 K17 18DB/TN
10 COIL CONTROL NO. 1 K19 18DB/DG
11 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
12 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
13 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
14 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
15 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
16 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 6 K453 20BR/DG
17 O2 2/1 HEATER CONTROL K199 20BR/VT
18 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
19 GEN FIELD CONTROL K20 18BR/GY
20 ECT SIGNAL K2 20VT/OR
21 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
22 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
23 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
24 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 RETURN K942 20BR/LG
25 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 1 SIGNAL K42 20DB/YL
26 - 27 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
28 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
28 IAC SIGNAL K961 20BR/VT
29 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
30 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
31 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
32 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
33 O2 2/1 SIGNAL K43 20DB/LG
34 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
35 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
36 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 SIGNAL K242 20BR/WT
37 KNOCK SENSOR NO. 2 RETURN K924 20WT/BR
38 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
38 IAC CONTROL K61 20VT/GY
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5508
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5509
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C3
Color : BLACK/NATURAL
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2-3 ASD CONTROL K51 20BR/WT
4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5510
5 S/C VENT SOL CONTROL V35 20VT/OR
5 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 7 K454 20BR/OR
6 MDS SOL CONTROL NO. 1 K451 20BR/WT
7 SPEED CONTROL SUPPLY V32 20VT/YL
8-9 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
10 O2 2/2 HEATER CONTROL K399 18BR/GY
11 A/C CLUTCH CONTROL C13 20LB/OR
12 S/C VACUUM SOL CONTROL V36 20VT/YL
13 - 14 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V32 20VT/YL
15 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 20VT/BR
16 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
17 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
18 S/C SWITCH NO. 2 SIGNAL V38 20VT/OR
19 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
20 EVAP PURGE SOL CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
21 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
22 PTO SENSE G113 20VT
22 PTO SENSE G113 18PK/YL
23 BRAKE SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL B29 20DG/WT
24 - 25 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
26 - 27 - 28 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
29 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
30 P/S SWITCH SIGNAL K66 20DB/WT
31 - 32 - 33 OIL TEMPERATURE SIGNAL G24 20VT/BR
34 S/C SWITCH NO. 1 SIGNAL V37 20VT
35 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
36 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
37 FUEL PUMP CONTROL K31 20BR
38 STARTER SOLENOID CONTROL T752 20DG/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5511
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5512
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
34 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5513
5-
6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
78 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
910 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/BK
11 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
13 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
14 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 24 25 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
27 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 -
37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5514
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5515
Connector:
Name : MODULE-POWERTRAIN CONTROL C4
Color : BLACK/GREEN
# of pins : 38
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5516
4 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
5-6 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
6 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
7-8 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
9-10 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
11 PRESSURE CONTROL SOLENOID CONTROL T118 20DG
12 GROUND Z908 18BK
13 GROUND Z977 18BK
14 GROUND Z904 18BK
15 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
16 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
17 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
18 TRANSMISSION CONTROL T515 20YL/DB
19 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
20 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
21 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
22 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
28 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
29 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
30 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
30 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
31 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
32 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
33 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
34 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
35 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
36 - 37 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
38 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Component Location - 29
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5517
Component Location - 6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 5518
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
CUMMINS FUEL SYSTEM COMPONENTS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5521
The Engine Control Module (ECM) for the 5.9L diesel engine (16) is bolted to the left side of the
engine below the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5522
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The main function of the Engine Control Module (ECM) is to electrically control the fuel system.
The ECM also controls certain transmission and other functions previously controlled by the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The ECM can adapt its programming to meet changing operating conditions.
The ECM receives input signals from various switches and sensors. Based on these inputs, the
ECM regulates various engine and vehicle operations through different system components. These
components are referred to as ECM Outputs. The sensors and switches that provide inputs to the
ECM are considered ECM Inputs.
NOTE: ECM Inputs:
- Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) Signals #1 and #2
- AC system pressure
- Auto shutdown (ASD) sense
- Battery temperature
- Battery temperature sensor
- Battery voltage
- Brake switch
- Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
- Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP)
- Data link connection for a scan tool
- Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
- EATX module (if equipped)
- Fuel level
- Fuel pressure sensor
- Fan speed (engine cooling fan)
- Generator (battery voltage) output
- Governor pressure (Auto. trans.)
- Ground circuits
- Inlet air temperature sensor/pressure sensor
- Intake air temperature sensor/MAP sensor
- CAN C BUS (+) circuits
- CAN C BUS (-) circuits
- Key switch (ignition)
- Oil Pressure switch
- Overdrive switch (automatic transmission only)
- Park/neutral switch (auto. trans. only)
- Power ground
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Sensor return
- Signal ground
- Speed control multiplexed single wire input
- Transfer case switch (4WD range position)
- Transmission governor psi (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission OSS (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil pressure (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission oil temperature (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve position (automatic transmission only)
- Vehicle speed signal
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor
NOTE: ECM Outputs:
After inputs are received by the ECM, certain sensors, switches and components are controlled or
regulated by the ECM. These are considered ECM Outputs. These outputs are for:
- A/C clutch relay
- Auto shutdown (ASD) relay
- Data link connection for diagnostic scan tool
- Fan clutch PWM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5523
- Five volt sensor supply (primary)
- Five volt sensor supply (secondary)
- Fuel control actuator
- Fuel injector driver circuits
- Fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Generator field driver (-)
- Generator field driver (+)
- Governor pressure (VFS solenoid)
- Intake manifold air heater relays #1 and #2 control circuits
- CAN C BUS (+/-) circuits for: speedometer, voltmeter, fuel gauge, oil pressure gauge/lamp,
engine temp. gauge and speed control warn. lamp
- Malfunction indicator lamp (Check engine lamp). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- Oil pressure switch/warning lamp (databus)
- Overdrive/3-4 shift solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- SC source
- SCI datalink bus (+) circuits
- SCI datalink bus (-) circuits
- Speed control vacuum solenoid
- Speed control vent solenoid
- Tachometer (if equipped). Driven through J1850 circuits.
- TCC solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission battery relay (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission throttle valve actuator (automatic transmission only)
- Transmission governor solenoid (automatic transmission only)
- Wait-to-start warning lamp (databus)
- Turbo wastegate solenoid
- Water-In-Fuel (WIF) warning lamp (databus)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection PCM/ECM Programming
PCM/ECM REPROGRAMMING
MODULE REPROGRAMING
Replacement PCM's will require programming utilizing the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. The PCM
will not operate the engine until it is programmed. A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will be set "not programmed".
CAUTION: Extreme care must be taken when programming a calibration into a generic PCM. Do
not randomly select a calibration. Once a calibration is selected and programmed, the controller
cannot be reprogrammed to a different calibration. The module can only be reprogrammed to a
more recent version of that calibration.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT OR EQUIVALENT REQUIRED:
**REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity.
However, in order to take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent for your dealership's network.
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
5. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
6. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM. 7. Program the PCM as follows:
a. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen, Select "ECU View" b. Touch the
screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select "More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash"
e. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 5526
f. Highlight the appropriate calibration based on the part number recorded in Step 5.
g. Select "Download to Scantool". h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select
"Back". i.
Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller". Follow on screen instructions.
k. When the update is complete, select "OK". l.
Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part number.
8. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 9. b. No >> go to STEP 10.
9. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM).
a. Highlight the WCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c. Highlight "PCM Replaced". d. Select "Start" e.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step. f.
When complete proceed to STEP 11.
10. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
11. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 13. b. No >> go to STEP 12.
12. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select ECU View b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select Misc.
Function. d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select Next after each step . Select Finish after completing the
last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKREEM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. From the Home screen select System View. Then select All DTCs. Press Clear All
Stored DTCs if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
NOTE: The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM and/or TCM.
13. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
REPAIR PROCEDURE USING SOFTWARE UPDATE CD TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE: If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 5527
1. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts. Set the battery charger timer to
maintain the charging voltage for the duration of the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) or equivalent vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent
and the vehicle.
3. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
4. Retrieve the old ECU part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules. c. Select
"More Options" d. Select "ECU Flash" e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM"
screen for later reference.
5. Replace the PCM with the appropriate Generic PCM.
6. Insert the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software Update CD into the Techconnect or equivalent
PC. The StarSCAN(R) or equivalent Software
Update CD will start automatically. Select "Download Flash Updates".
7. At the "Select a method for looking up controller flash updates." screen:
a. Select "Enter part number". Enter the "Part Number" recorded in STEP 4 when prompted to do
so. b. Using the mouse highlight the appropriate "Calibration". Select "Next". c. Follow the on
screen instructions. d. When completed, proceed to STEP 8.
8. With the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent powered OFF, connect the USB Key and Gender Changer
to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent USB port .
9. Connect the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent to the vehicle (if not already connected).
10. Power ON the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent.
11. Download the flash file from the USB key to the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent. Using the
StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "Flash Download", then select "Retrieve files from the USB storage device" b. Highlight
the appropriate calibration. Select "Download to Scan Tool" c. When the download is complete,
select "Close" and "Back".
12. Reprogram the ECU. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View". b. Select More Options". c. Select "ECU Flash". d. Highlight the appropriate
calibration. e. Select "Update Controller". Follow the on screen instructions. f.
When the update is complete, select "OK".
g. Verify the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen has updated to the new part
number.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 5528
13. Is "WCM - Wireless Control Module" displayed in the "ECU Overview" screen list of modules?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 14. b. No >> go to STEP 15.
14. Program the PCM to the Wireless Control Module (WCM). Using the StarSCAN(R) or
equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the WCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "PCM Replaced". e. Select "Start". f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
g. When complete proceed to STEP 16.
15. Program the VIN into the PCM.
a. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. b. Select "Misc. Function". c.
Highlight "Check PCM VIN". d. Select "Start". e. Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next"
after each step . When the window appears with 17 boxes, select "Show Keyboard". Place the
cursor to the right of the last box and then backspace to delete the boxes from the window. Enter
the VIN. Select "Finish" after completing the last step.
f. Unplug the scan tool from the Data Link Connector.
g. At the "Vehicle Disconnected" screen, press "OK". h. Connect the scan tool to the Data Link
Connector and verify that the VIN is visible at the top of the "Home" screen.
16. Is the vehicle equipped with a 3.7L or 4.7L engine?
a. Yes >> go to STEP 18. b. No >> go to STEP 17.
17. Using the StarSCAN(R) or equivalent at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View" b. Scroll through the list of controllers and highlight the PCM. c. Select "Misc.
Function". d. Highlight "Learn ETC". e. Select "Start" f.
Follow the on screen instructions. Select "Next" after each step . Select "Finish" after completing
the last step.
NOTE: Due to the PCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (TCM, BCM,
MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
Check all modules using "ECU View" from the Home screen, record the DTC's, and erase these
DTC's prior to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all
other modules have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE: The following step is required by law.
18. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 5529
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection SKREEM Programming
SKREEM PROGRAMMING
When a Powertrain Control Module (PCM) for a gasoline engine, or an Engine Control Module
(ECM) for a diesel engine and the Sentry Key Remote Entry Module (SKREEM) (also known as the
Wireless Control Module/WCM) on vehicles equipped with the Sentry Key Immobilizer System
(SKIS) are replaced at the same time, perform the following steps in order:
1. Program the new PCM/ECM.
2. Program the new SKREEM/WCM.
3. Replace all ignition keys and program them into the new SKREEM/WCM.
PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM
The SKIS Secret Key is an ID code that is unique to each SKREEM/WCM. This code is
programmed and stored in the SKREEM/WCM, the PCM/ECM, and each ignition key transponder
chip. When the PCM/ECM or SKREEM/WCM is replaced, it is necessary to program the Secret
Key into the new module using a diagnostic scan tool. Follow the programming steps outlined in
the diagnostic scan tool for PCM REPLACED, ECM REPLACED, WCM REPLACED, or
GATEWAY REPLACED under MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL
MODULE/WCM menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: Be certain to enter the correct country code for the SKREEM/WCM. If the incorrect country
code is programmed into the SKREEM, it cannot be changed and the SKREEM must be replaced.
NOTE: In addition, the SKREEM/WCM must be configured for certain optional equipment in the
vehicle, including Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM), Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) and Remote Start.
Follow the programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool under MISCELLANEOUS
FUNCTIONS for the WCM/WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: A replacement SKREEM/WCM is supplied with TPM enabled by default; therefore, if the
vehicle is not equipped with TPM, the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC) will incorrectly
learn that the vehicle has TPM after the replacement SKREEM is installed. The TPM indicator in
the EMIC will illuminate to show a TPM fault condition after TPM has been disabled in the
SKREEM. The EMIC must unlearn TPM to correct this false TPM indication. Follow the
programming steps outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for CLEAR LEARNED FEATURES under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the INSTRUMENT CLUSTER menu item as appropriate.
NOTE: If the PCM/ECM and the SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, all vehicle ignition
keys will need to be replaced and the new keys programmed into the new SKREEM/WCM.
NOTE: Programming the PCM/ECM or SKREEM is done using a diagnostic scan tool and a PIN to
enter secure access mode. If three attempts are made to enter secure access mode using an
incorrect PIN, secure access mode will be locked out for one hour. To exit this lockout mode, turn
the ignition to the RUN position for one hour then enter the correct PIN. Be certain that all
accessories are turned OFF. Also monitor the battery state and connect a battery charger if
necessary.
PROGRAMMING IGNITION KEYS TO THE SKREEM
Each ignition key transponder also has a unique ID code that is assigned at the time the key is
manufactured. When a key is programmed into the SKREEM/WCM, the transponder ID code is
learned by the module and the transponder acquires the unique Secret Key ID code from the
SKREEM/WCM. To program ignition keys into the SKREEM/WCM, follow the programming steps
outlined in the diagnostic scan tool for PROGRAM IGNITION KEYS OR KEY FOBS under
MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS for the WIRELESS CONTROL MODULE/WCM menu item.
NOTE: A maximum of eight keys can be learned to each SKREEM. Once a key is learned to a
SKREEM, that key has acquired the Secret Key for that SKREEM and cannot be transferred to any
other SKREEM or vehicle.
If ignition key programming is unsuccessful, the scan tool will display one of the following error
messages:
- PROGRAMMING NOT ATTEMPTED - The scan tool attempts to read the programmed key status
and there are no keys programmed into SKREEM memory.
- PROGRAMMING KEY FAILED (POSSIBLE USED KEY FROM WRONG VEHICLE) - SKREEM is
unable to program an ignition key transponder due to one of the following:
- The ignition key transponder is ineffective.
- The ignition key transponder is or has been already programmed to another vehicle.
- 8 KEYS ALREADY LEARNED, PROGRAMMING NOT DONE - The SKREEM transponder ID
memory is full.
- LEARNED KEY IN IGNITION - The ID for the ignition key transponder currently in the ignition lock
cylinder is already programmed into SKREEM memory.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > PCM/ECM
Programming > Page 5530
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Programming The SKREEM/WCM Using The Scan
Tool
STANDARD PROCEDURE - PROGRAMMING THE SKREEM/WCM USING THE SCAN TOOL
CAUTION: Read all notes and cautions for programming procedures.
1. Connect a battery charger to the vehicle.
2. Connect the scan tool.
CAUTION: If the ECM/PCM and SKREEM/WCM are replaced at the same time, the ECM/PCM
MUST be programmed before the SKREEM/WCM.
3. Select "ECU View".
4. Select "WCM Wireless Control Module".
5. Select "Miscellaneous Functions".
6. Select WCM replaced.
7. Enter the PIN when prompted.
8. Verify the correct information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL
The Engine Control Module (ECM) (5) is located on the left side of the engine. A support bracket
mounts to the block with four capscrews and vibration isolators. A ground wire is fastened to the
bracket. The other end of the wire is fastened to the engine block.
1. Record any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) found in the ECM.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to the ECM, ignition key must be off, and both negative
battery cables must be disconnected before unplugging ECM connectors.
2. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Access to the ECM is easier by working through the left front wheel opening.
3. Remove left front wheel.
4. Remove plastic left front fender splash shield.
5. Remove electrical connector bolts at ECM. Note: As each bolt is being removed, very carefully
remove connectors from the ECM.
6. Remove three ECM mounting bolts (6) and remove ECM from engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 5533
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Installation
6.7L DIESEL
Do not apply paint to ECM or a poor ground will result.
1. Position ECM (5) to the ECM support bracket and install mounting bolts. Tighten bolts to 24 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.).
2. Check pins in electrical connectors for corrosion, damage or dirt intrusion. Also check all pins for
being bent. Repair as necessary. Damaged,
dirty, bent or corroded pins could result in poor conductivity, causing intermittent electrical issues or
DTC's.
3. Clean pins in electrical connectors with an electrical contact cleaner.
4. Install connectors to ECM. Tighten connector bolts to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.).
5. Install splash shield.
6. Install left front wheel.
7. Connect both negative battery cables.
8. Use a diagnostic scan tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) from ECM.
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 5534
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5538
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5539
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5540
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5541
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 5542
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor Relay > Component Information > Diagrams
Oxygen Sensor Relay: Diagrams
2007-2009 Ram truck, 6.7L, use an O2 module for oxygen sensor heater control.
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5550
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5551
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5552
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 5555
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 5558
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5562
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5563
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5564
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5565
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 5568
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Barometric Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 5574
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor (3) into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (2).
4. Install electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5578
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5579
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5580
Battery Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 388
Component : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-BATTERY TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BATT TEMP SIGNAL K25 20DB/VT
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5581
Component Location - 30
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5582
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Description
DESCRIPTION
The Battery Temperature Sensor (BTS) is used only on the diesel engine. It is attached to the
battery tray located under the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Battery Temperature Sensor - Description > Page 5585
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Battery Temperature Sensor - Operation
OPERATION
The BTS is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery charging rate. This
temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the PCM (ECM Diesel) to
vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
The PCM sends 5 volts to the sensor and is grounded through the sensor return line. As
temperature increases, resistance in the sensor decreases and the detection voltage at the PCM
increases.
The BTS is also used for OBD II diagnostics. Certain faults and OBD II monitors are either enabled
or disabled, depending upon BTS input (for example, disable purge and enable Leak Detection
Pump (LDP) and O2 sensor heater tests). Most OBD II monitors are disabled below 20° F.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery
Temperature Sensor - Removal
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Removal
REMOVAL
The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped
into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4) .
1. Remove battery.
2. Pry sensor (1) straight up from battery tray mounting hole to gain access to electrical connector
(3) .
3. Disconnect sensor from engine wire harness electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Battery
Temperature Sensor - Removal > Page 5588
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Battery Temperature Sensor - Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: The battery temperature sensor (1) is located under the vehicle battery and is attached
(snapped into) a mounting hole on battery tray (4).
1. Pull electrical connector (3) up through mounting hole in top of battery tray.
2. Connect sensor.
3. Snap sensor into battery tray.
4. Install battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5592
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5593
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5594
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5595
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5596
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5597
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5598
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5599
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5600
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5601
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5602
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5603
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5604
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5607
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 5610
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is used to sense engine coolant temperature. The
sensor protrudes into an engine water jacket.
The ECT sensor is a two-wire Negative Thermal Coefficient (NTC) sensor. Meaning, as engine
coolant temperature increases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor decreases. As temperature
decreases, resistance (voltage) in the sensor increases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 5615
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
At key-on, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) sends out a regulated 5 volt signal to the ECT
sensor. The PCM then monitors the signal as it passes through the ECT sensor to the sensor
ground (sensor return).
When the engine is cold, the PCM will operate in Open Loop cycle. It will demand slightly richer
air-fuel mixtures and higher idle speeds. This is done until normal operating temperatures are
reached.
The PCM uses inputs from the ECT sensor for the following calculations:
- for engine coolant temperature gauge operation through CAN Bus communications
- Injector pulse-width
- Spark-advance curves
- ASD relay shut-down times
- Idle Air Control (IAC) motor key-on steps
- Pulse-width prime-shot during cranking
- O2 sensor closed loop times
- Purge solenoid on/off times
- Cooling fan control
- Temperature gauge operation
- A/C cutoff at high coolant temperatures
- EGR solenoid on/off times (if equipped)
- Leak Detection Pump operation (if equipped)
- Radiator fan relay on/off times (if equipped)
- Target idle speed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Hot, pressurized coolant can cause injury by scalding. Cooling system must be partially
drained before removing the coolant temperature sensor.
1. Partially drain the cooling system.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
2. Remove heat shield (if equipped). 3. Disconnect the electrical connector (2) from the ETC
sensor (3). 4. Remove the ETC sensor from the cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 5618
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
ECT LOCATION - 6.7L DIESEL
1. Install sensor (1 or 3) to engine. 2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) torque.
ECT LOCATION - 5.9L DIESEL
3. Connect electrical connector (2) to ETC sensor (1 or 3). 4. Install heat shield (if equipped). 5.
Replace any lost engine coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5622
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5623
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5624
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5625
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5626
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5627
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5628
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5629
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5630
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5631
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5632
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5633
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5634
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5635
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5636
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5637
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5638
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5639
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5640
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5641
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5642
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5643
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5644
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5645
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5646
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5647
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5648
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5649
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5650
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5651
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5652
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5653
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5654
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5657
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 5660
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5664
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5665
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5666
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 5667
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
> Page 5670
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5675
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5676
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5677
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5678
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5679
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5680
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5681
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5682
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5685
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5686
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5687
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5688
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5689
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5690
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5691
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Temperature 1/1 > Page 5692
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 5695
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 5698
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5703
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5704
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5705
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5706
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5707
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5708
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/1
Component ID: 397
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 EXHAUST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K355 18BR/DG
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5711
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5712
Exhaust Pressure Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Pressure 1/2
Component ID: 398
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5713
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5714
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
2 EXHAUST PRESSURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K182 18BR/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5715
Component Location - 25
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust
Pressure 1/1 > Page 5716
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
5722
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5726
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5727
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5728
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Component Locations
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5733
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5734
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5735
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5736
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5737
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5738
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Pick Up Models
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5739
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5740
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Connector Locations
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5741
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5742
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5743
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5744
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5745
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 5746
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Intake Air Temperature Sensor
Component ID: 406
Component : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5749
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5750
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5751
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 IAT SIGNAL K21 20DB/LG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5752
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5753
Component Location - 7
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5754
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5755
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5756
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5757
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5758
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5759
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5760
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5761
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5762
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5763
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air
Temperature Sensor > Page 5764
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake
OPERATION
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor is a combination dual-function sensor. The sensor
element extends into the intake air stream at the top of the air filter housing. Ambient air
temperature as well as barometric pressure is monitored by this sensor. The Engine Control
Module (ECM) monitors signals from this sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Intake > Page 5767
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Removal
REMOVAL
The Inlet Air Temperature/Pressure Sensor (3) is located on the air cleaner cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (7) at sensor.
2. Remove mounting screw (2).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 5770
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 5771
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 5772
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet > Page 5773
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 5778
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5783
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5784
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5785
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5786
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5787
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5788
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5789
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5790
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5791
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5792
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5793
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure
Component ID: 411
Component : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MAP SIGNAL K1 20VT/BR
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5796
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5797
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5798
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5799
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-Inlet
Component ID: 426
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K690 18BR/YL
2 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY K668 18BR
4 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5800
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5801
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5802
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-INLET
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INLET AIR PRESSURE SENSE K616 18BR/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INLET AIR TEMPERATURE SENSE K615 18VT/WT
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5803
Component Location - 4
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5804
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5805
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5806
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Component ID: 427
Component : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (5.9L)
A SENSOR GROUND K210 18DB/TN
B INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
C 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
D BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18LB
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5807
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TEMPERATURE/PRESSURE-MAP
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 BOOST PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL K37 18BR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
3 INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K21 18DB/LG
3 CHARGE AIR COOLER OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR K735 18BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Manifold Absolute Pressure > Page 5808
4 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-MAP
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-MAP
DESCRIPTION
A combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is used.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Sensor-MAP > Page 5811
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 5814
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 5815
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 5816
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5821
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5822
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5823
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5824
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5825
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5826
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5827
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5828
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5829
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5830
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5831
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5832
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5833
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5834
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5835
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5836
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5837
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5838
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5847
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5848
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5849
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5850
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5851
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5852
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30
> Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 5853
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5859
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5860
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 > Page 5861
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5871
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5872
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5873
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5878
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5879
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5880
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5881
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5882
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5883
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5884
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 08-035-08 > Nov > 08 > Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing Information
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Oxygen Sensor Testing
Information
NUMBER: 08-035-08
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: November 21, 2008
SUBJECT: Proper Testing Tools For Oxygen Sensor Terminals
OVERVIEW: This bulletin describes the use of proper test probes to test the Oxygen (02) Sensor
connector terminals equipped with the new TP2 style of sensor.
MODELS:
2007-2009 (DH) 2500 Pick Up
2007-2009 (D1) 3500 Pick Up
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to models equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
The new TP2 style 02 sensors have smaller terminals that may be damaged (spread) when using
standard Digital Volt Ohm Meter (DVOM) test probes.
The recommended tool for these testing procedures is the Miller Tool # 6801 (Fig. 1)
Two (2) of these probes are required when performing circuit tests as described in
DealerCONNECT. The tool was originally included as part of Miller Tool # 6807 and # 8197A. Each
of these kits contained one (1) # 6801 terminal probe. Two (2) additional Miller test probes # 6801
will be delivered to affected Dodge dealers shortly.
Two (2) new terminal probes (# 6801) will be included and shipped as kit # 10190.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01
Oxygen Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2000/P2A00/P2A01
NUMBER: 18-035-08
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: September 13, 2008
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN MUST BE RETRIEVED FROM THE
INTERNET.
StarSCAN(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.02 OR HIGHER.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT - OR - StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE MAY ALSO BE USED
TO PERFORM THE FLASH.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to P2000, P2A00 and/or P2A01
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves verifying all TSB's related to high sooting issues have been
properly addressed, replacing both Oxygen (02) Sensors, and wrapping the exhaust pipe in the
area of the FRONT 02 sensor.
This bulletin also involves verifying that the Documentation Kit has been installed in the vehicle and
the customer has been informed of its contents.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck 2500/3500
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Customer may experience MIL illumination. Further investigation by the
technician may find one or more of the following DTC(s) present:
^ P2000 - NOX Absorber Efficiency Below Threshold - Bank 1.
^ P2A00 - 02 Sensor 1/1 Circuit Performance.
^ P2A01 - 02 Sensor 1/2 Circuit Performance.
DIAGNOSIS: If DTC's other than those listed above are present record them on the repair order
and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. Refer to TSB's related to
turbocharger and DPF repairs (11-002-07,11-001-08,11 -002-08 and 18-013-08) if needed.
NOTE:
ECM (PCM) software commands when and what the CCN will display on the EVIC regarding the
new engine system and exhaust aftertreatment system messages. The ECM software must be up
to date (correct software level) in order for the new EVIC messages to display as designed and to
address the symptoms and conditions above.
^ Verify software level in ECM and CCN is at the latest software level available in
DealerCONNECT.
^ Verify DTC's other than those listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION should be addressed with the
appropriate TSB or Service Procedures available in DealerCONNECT.
^ IF making a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) or turbocharger repair in conjunction with this TSB,
ensure EGR system, Turbo, Intake, Charge Air Cooler, and other sensors are inspected and
cleaned as described in these TSB's. Systems should be cleaned to "Like New" condition. Vehicles
that have excess soot build up should have the source of the soot build up diagnosed and repaired
prior to proceeding with this bulletin.
^ Verify proper maintenance has been performed, including: fuel and air filter brand (Mopar
recommended) and condition.
^ Check Crankcase Ventilation (CCV) system for restriction which may cause oil infiltration into
turbo and intake system.
^ Some vehicles may only have a part of the Documentation Kit (i.e. Diesel Owners Manual
Supplement). Make sure the vehicle/customer has received a complete Documentation Kit.
If any of the DTC's listed in the SYMPTOM/CONDITION are present and the conditions listed
above have been met, perform the REPAIR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5894
PROCEDURE.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Remove and replace both Oxygen Sensors with p/n 05149263AA. Torque to 41 N.m (30 ft.lbs).
Connect wiring to both of the Oxygen (02) sensors.
NOTE:
Do not use earlier versions of 02 sensor when performing this repair. Ensure part number is
05149263AA or higher level.
2. Using scissors or a utility knife, cut exhaust wrap to a length of 12.5 (3.8 m).
3. Locate the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) downpipe to NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAC) flange.
Measure and mark a line at a distance of 7 (18 cm) in front of this flange (Fig. 1).
4. Loosely install band clamps;
a. One in front of 02 sensor.
b. One between DOC-to-NAC flange and 02 sensor.
NOTE:
Do not wrap or cover wiring for oxygen sensor or temperature sensor with insulation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5895
5. Starting about 1" (25 mm) in front of the (DOC)-to-(NAG) flange and using full overlap, wrap
insulation once around the exhaust pipe (Fig. 2).
6. Wrap pipe in an upstream direction (toward 02 sensor) using a 1" (25 mm) over lap. Wrap to the
02 sensor. Wrap the body of the 02 sensor two times.
7. Then continue wrapping the exhaust pipe in an upstream direction to the 7 (17.75cm) mark
established in Step # 3.
8. Now continue the exhaust pipe wrap in a downstream direction and slalom around sensor. This
time, do not wrap the insulation around the body of the 02 sensor. Continue to the wrap until you
reach the (DOC)-to-(NAC) flange (Fig. 3).
9. Slide a band clamp over each end of the wrap.
10. Tighten both clamps. One at front of wrap and one at rear of wrap.
11. If a complete Documentation Kit has not been installed on the vehicle, install the
Documentation Kit now. (Kit is zero cost).
a. Place the new Diesel Owners Manual Supplement in the vehicle Glove Box.
b. Place the Informational DVD in the vehicle Glove Box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > 18-035-08 > Sep > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2000/P2A00/P2A01 >
Page 5896
c. Place the Informational CD in the vehicle's CD player, (if equipped).
d. Install the new Sun Visor Label on the left (driver) side sun visor. The label should be centered
on the sun visor and to the left of the seat belt warnings. Verify that the label is firmly attached to
the sun visor material.
e. Dealer personnel should inform the customer the Documentation Kit has been installed on the
vehicle and advise the customer to familiarize themselves with this information.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5906
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5907
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5908
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5909
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5910
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5911
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Oxygen Sensor: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page
5912
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5915
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5916
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5917
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5918
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5919
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5920
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5921
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5922
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5923
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5924
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5925
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5926
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5927
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5928
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5929
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5930
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5931
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5932
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Sensor - Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5933
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5934
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5935
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5936
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5937
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5938
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5939
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5940
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5941
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5942
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5943
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor - Oxygen > Page 5944
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Module-O2 Sensor
Component ID: 207
Component : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Connector:
Name : MODULE-O2 SENSOR
Color : # of pins :
16
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5947
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
3 DIAGNOSTIC PORT LOW DATA LINK D132 20WT
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
5 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
7 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
8 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
9 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
10 GROUND Z902 20BK
11 DIAGNOSTIC PORT HIGH DATA LINK D133 20WT/OR
12 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
13 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
14 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
15 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
16 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5948
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/1
Component ID: 416
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5949
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5950
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5951
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5952
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
2 GROUND Z42 20BK/LG
3 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
4 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5953
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5954
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5955
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5956
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5957
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5958
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5959
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5960
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/1
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/1 PUMP CURRENT K89 20BR/LG
2 O2 1/1 RETURN K902 20BR/DG
3 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K79 20BR/LB
4 O2 1/1 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K99 20BR/LG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5961
5 O2 1/1 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K103 20BR/LB
6 O2 1/1 SIGNAL K41 20DB/LB
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5962
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5963
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5964
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5965
Oxygen Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Oxygen 1/2
Component ID: 417
Component : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (3.7L/5.7L LD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5966
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5967
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5968
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (4.7L/5.7L HD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
2 GROUND Z43 20BK/LB
3 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
4 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5969
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5970
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5971
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5972
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5973
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5974
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OXYGEN 1/2
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 02 1/2 PUMP CURRENT K734 20BR/DG
2 O2 1/2 RETURN K904 20DB/DG
3 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL RETURN K80 20BR/TN
4 O2 1/2 HEATER CONTROL SUPPLY K299 20BR/WT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5975
5 O2 1/2 PUMP CELL CURRENT TRIM K733 20BR
6 O2 1/2 SIGNAL K141 20DB/YL
Component Location - 21
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5976
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-O2 Sensor > Page
5977
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description Pick Up Models
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors (1) and (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description Pick Up Models > Page 5980
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream (1), and 1/2
downstream (2).
A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description Pick Up Models > Page 5981
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation Oxygen Sensor Module
Description - Pick Up Models
DESCRIPTION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
Operation - Pick Up Models
OPERATION - PICK UP MODELS
Two different six-wire O2 sensors are used. These sensors are titled 1/1 upstream, and 1/2
downstream. A separate O2 Sensor Module (1) is also used.
The engine aftertreatment system monitors the O2 content in the diesel engine exhaust. The ECM
monitors the exhaust gases for oxygen content and varies the rich/lean fuel mixture of the intake air
fuel mixture to adjust the system. This diagnostic monitors the status message broadcast by the O2
Sensor Module (1) for the upstream O2 sensor's internal heater circuit. The ECM will set the fault if
it receives a FMI (Failure Mode Indicator) message from the O2 Sensor Module. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL lamp immediately when the diagnostic runs and fails. The ECM will turn off the
MIL lamp diagnostic runs and passes in four consecutive drive cycles.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor
Module
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Oxygen Sensor Module
Removal - Pick Up Models
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at module (1).
3. Remove four bolts (3).
4. Remove module from frame rail.
Installation - Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The oxygen sensor module (1) is located under the vehicle. It is bolted to the outer side of right
frame rail (4).
1. Position module (1) to frame rail (4).
2. Install four bolts (3).
3. Tighten bolts (3) to 6 Nm (53 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to module (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor
Module > Page 5984
5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor
Module > Page 5985
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
CAUTION: Never apply any type of grease to the oxygen sensor electrical connector, or attempt
any soldering of the sensor wiring harness.
WARNING: The exhaust manifold, exhaust pipes and catalytic converters become very hot during
engine operation. Allow engine to cool before removing oxygen sensor.
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Disconnect main wire connector from O2S sensor pigtail harness.
CAUTION: When disconnecting sensor electrical connector, do not pull directly on wire going into
sensor.
3. Remove O2S sensor with an oxygen sensor removal and installation tool.
4. Clean threads in catalytic convertor using appropriate tap.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Oxygen Sensor
Module > Page 5986
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION - PICK UP MODELS
The two oxygen (O2) sensors 1/1 (1) and 1/2 (2) are located at each end of the #2 catalyst.
Threads of NEW oxygen sensors are factory coated with anti-seize compound to aid in removal.
DO NOT add any additional anti-seize compound to threads of a new oxygen sensor. Be careful
not to get anti-seize compound on sensor tip.
1. Install O2S sensor. Tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft. lbs.) torque.
2. Connect O2S sensor pigtail harness to main wire harness connector.
3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A pressure sensing switch is used in the power steering system. It is mounted on the high-pressure
steering hose. This switch will only be used on HD vehicles with the 5.7L engines. There is no
pressure switch used for the 3.7L, 4.7L, 5.9LDiesel engine or the 5.7L LD vehicle pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 5991
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The switch is used on the 5.7L V-8 engines HD vehicles only.
The power steering pressure switch provides an input to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
This input is provided during periods of high steering pump load and low engine rpm; such as
during parking maneuvers. The PCM increases the idle speed through the Idle Air Control (IAC)
motor. This is done to prevent the engine from stalling under the increased load.
When steering pump pressure exceeds 3275 kPa ± 690 kPa (475 psi ± 100 psi), the Normally
Closed (NC) switch will open and the PCM will increase the engine idle speed. This will prevent the
engine from stalling.
When pump pressure drops to approximately 1379 kPa (200 psi), the switch circuit will re-close
and engine idle speed will return to its previous setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 5996
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6001
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6002
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6003
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6004
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6005
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6006
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6007
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6008
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6009
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6010
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6011
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6014
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6015
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6016
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6017
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6018
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6019
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6020
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6021
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6022
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6023
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6024
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6027
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6028
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6029
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6030
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 6031
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6034
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6035
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6036
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6037
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6038
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6042
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6043
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6044
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6049
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6050
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6051
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6052
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6053
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6054
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6055
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6056
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6057
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6058
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6059
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6060
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6061
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6062
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6063
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6064
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6065
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 6066
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6071
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6072
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6073
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6074
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6075
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6076
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6077
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6078
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6079
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6080
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6081
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6084
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6085
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6086
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6087
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6088
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6089
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6090
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6091
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6092
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6093
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 6094
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6097
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6098
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6099
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 6100
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6101
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6104
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6105
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6106
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6107
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 6108
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6112
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6113
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Turbocharger Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6114
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6119
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6120
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6121
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6122
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6123
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6124
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6125
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6126
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6127
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6128
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6129
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6130
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6131
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6132
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6133
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6134
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6135
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6136
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6143
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6144
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6145
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6146
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6147
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6148
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6149
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6150
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6153
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6154
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6155
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6156
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6157
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6158
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6159
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1 > Page 6160
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6163
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Exhaust
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6166
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel
Emissions > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Differential Pressure Sensor is remotely mounted on the transmission housing. Two
pressure tubes measure pressure before and after the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)/Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC). The sensor is critical for fail-safe of regeneration strategy, because it
interprets high pressure drops as possible high soot loads.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel
Emissions > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at pressure
differential pressure sensor. 4. Remove mounting bolt and differential pressure sensor. 5. Remove
mounting bolts (1).
6. Remove pressure differential pressure tubing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Continuous Trap Oxidizer, Diesel
Emissions > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6173
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install differential pressure tubing, if removed. Tighten fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
2. Position differential pressure sensor (1). 3. Install mounting nuts (5) and bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 4. Install hose (2) to the rear DPF tubing. 5. Install hose (3) to the front DPF tubing. 6.
Connect electrical connector (6). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P1451/P200C/P242F
NUMBER: 11-001-09
GROUP: Exhaust
DATE: July 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-002-07, DATED
SEPTEMBER 25, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED TOOL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Diesel Particulate Filter - Diagnosis and Repair of DTC's P1451, P200C, P242F or
Black Smoke From Exhaust
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC's P1451,
P2OOC, P242F, black smoke from the exhaust, or a no start condition due to a nonfunctional or
plugged Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). The Mobile DeSoot procedure initiated by the service tool
will soon be replaced with a new Stationary DeSoot procedure. The stationary DeSoot procedure
will only work when a vehicle needs to have a DeSoot performed, such as is indicated by the
presence of an active P1451. A Service Bulletin will be released when this procedure becomes
available.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination, warning chime and
an overhead Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message regarding the aftertreatment
system and/or black smoke from the exhaust and/or a no start condition.
Further Investigation by the technician may reveal that the MIL illumination and/or EVIC message
is due to one or more of the following Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's):
^ P1451 - Diesel Particulate Filter - System Performance.
^ P242F - Diesel Particulate Filter Restriction - Ash Accumulation.
^ P200C - Diesel Particulate Filter Over Temperature - Bank 1.
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing, StarMOBILE desktop client, StarMOBILE
standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTCs" tab.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 6182
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis.
5. Are DTC's P242F and/or P200C present, either active or stored, in the PCM, or does the vehicle
have visible black smoke from the exhaust or a no
start condition caused by a restricted exhaust?
a. If YES >> then the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) may require replacement.
Proceed to REPAIR PROCEDURE B: DPF Repair Procedure.
b. If NO >> then proceed to Step # 6.
6. Is DTC P1451 ACTIVE in the PCM (but DTC's P242F and/or P200C are NOT present and there
is no black smoke concern)?
a. If YES >> then a Scan Tool initiated DeSoot is required for the DPF. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE A: DPF DeSoot.
b. If NO >> then STOP. Additional diagnosis or repair for the DPF is not needed. An inactive DTC
P1451 without other symptoms does not require
any repair. Confirm that the PCM has the latest updates per the relevant TSB's and include the
documentation kit p/n 6804917AA (while supplies last) in the vehicle, and resolve any other
concerns prior to returning the vehicle to the owner.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURES:
NOTE:
Detailed removal and installation procedures (and graphics), required to perform this bulletin, will
not be listed individually in each Inspection and Test Section of this Repair Procedure. It will be
important to refer to TechCONNECT for all detailed service procedures.
REPAIR PROCEDURE A:
DPF DeSoot
1. Resolve all DTC's unrelated to DeSoot.
NOTE:
DeSoot only addresses the amount of particulate matter (soot) in the DPF, such as indicated by an
active P1451. It DOES NOT address any other issues or conditions.
2. Confirm the PCM Calibration software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
WARNING:
Elevated exhaust temperatures during Scan Tool initiated DeSoot can cause personal injury or
property damage. It is important that ALL procedures are followed.
3. Refer to TSB or Service Information available in DealerCONNECT for information to perform a
Scan Tool initiated DeSoot.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B:
DPF Repair Procedure
NOTE:
The DPF repair procedure has been updated due to diagnostic and controls enhancements.
1. Does the vehicle have a no start condition WITHOUT P242F in the PCM?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): > 11-001-09 > Jul
> 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 6183
a. If YES »> then proceed to Step # 2.
b. If NO »> then proceed to Step # 3.
2. Disconnect the DPF from the NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAG) by removing the three nuts at the
flange between them. Insert a non-flammable spacer
between the NAG and DPF flanges to create an exhaust leak path. Does this resolve the no start
condition?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 3.
b. No >> then STOP. The no start condition is NOT caused by the DPF. DPF replacement is NOT
needed, and this bulletin DOES NOT apply.
3. Replace the DPF. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info >
11 - Exhaust Systems > Converter, Catalytic > Removal/Installation > 6.7L diesel P/U.
4. Clean the EGR valve. Refer to the detailed cleaning procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: 25 - Emissions Controls >
Exhaust Gas Recirculation, 6.7L Diesel > Valve, Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR), 6.7L >
Cleaning.
5. Ensure all other engine driveability symptom and/or aftertreatment-related DTC's are addressed.
6. Confirm the PCM application software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Use Standard Labor Operation Times
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): >
11-001-09 > Jul > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P1451/P200C/P242F
NUMBER: 11-001-09
GROUP: Exhaust
DATE: July 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-002-07, DATED
SEPTEMBER 25, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED TOOL FOR THIS
PROCEDURE.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Diesel Particulate Filter - Diagnosis and Repair of DTC's P1451, P200C, P242F or
Black Smoke From Exhaust
OVERVIEW: This bulletin provides revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC's P1451,
P2OOC, P242F, black smoke from the exhaust, or a no start condition due to a nonfunctional or
plugged Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). The Mobile DeSoot procedure initiated by the service tool
will soon be replaced with a new Stationary DeSoot procedure. The stationary DeSoot procedure
will only work when a vehicle needs to have a DeSoot performed, such as is indicated by the
presence of an active P1451. A Service Bulletin will be released when this procedure becomes
available.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination, warning chime and
an overhead Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message regarding the aftertreatment
system and/or black smoke from the exhaust and/or a no start condition.
Further Investigation by the technician may reveal that the MIL illumination and/or EVIC message
is due to one or more of the following Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's):
^ P1451 - Diesel Particulate Filter - System Performance.
^ P242F - Diesel Particulate Filter Restriction - Ash Accumulation.
^ P200C - Diesel Particulate Filter Over Temperature - Bank 1.
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing, StarMOBILE desktop client, StarMOBILE
standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTCs" tab.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): >
11-001-09 > Jul > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 6189
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis.
5. Are DTC's P242F and/or P200C present, either active or stored, in the PCM, or does the vehicle
have visible black smoke from the exhaust or a no
start condition caused by a restricted exhaust?
a. If YES >> then the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) may require replacement.
Proceed to REPAIR PROCEDURE B: DPF Repair Procedure.
b. If NO >> then proceed to Step # 6.
6. Is DTC P1451 ACTIVE in the PCM (but DTC's P242F and/or P200C are NOT present and there
is no black smoke concern)?
a. If YES >> then a Scan Tool initiated DeSoot is required for the DPF. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE A: DPF DeSoot.
b. If NO >> then STOP. Additional diagnosis or repair for the DPF is not needed. An inactive DTC
P1451 without other symptoms does not require
any repair. Confirm that the PCM has the latest updates per the relevant TSB's and include the
documentation kit p/n 6804917AA (while supplies last) in the vehicle, and resolve any other
concerns prior to returning the vehicle to the owner.
PARTS REQUIRED:
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURES:
NOTE:
Detailed removal and installation procedures (and graphics), required to perform this bulletin, will
not be listed individually in each Inspection and Test Section of this Repair Procedure. It will be
important to refer to TechCONNECT for all detailed service procedures.
REPAIR PROCEDURE A:
DPF DeSoot
1. Resolve all DTC's unrelated to DeSoot.
NOTE:
DeSoot only addresses the amount of particulate matter (soot) in the DPF, such as indicated by an
active P1451. It DOES NOT address any other issues or conditions.
2. Confirm the PCM Calibration software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
WARNING:
Elevated exhaust temperatures during Scan Tool initiated DeSoot can cause personal injury or
property damage. It is important that ALL procedures are followed.
3. Refer to TSB or Service Information available in DealerCONNECT for information to perform a
Scan Tool initiated DeSoot.
REPAIR PROCEDURE B:
DPF Repair Procedure
NOTE:
The DPF repair procedure has been updated due to diagnostic and controls enhancements.
1. Does the vehicle have a no start condition WITHOUT P242F in the PCM?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): >
11-001-09 > Jul > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P1451/P200C/P242F > Page 6190
a. If YES »> then proceed to Step # 2.
b. If NO »> then proceed to Step # 3.
2. Disconnect the DPF from the NOx Absorber Catalyst (NAG) by removing the three nuts at the
flange between them. Insert a non-flammable spacer
between the NAG and DPF flanges to create an exhaust leak path. Does this resolve the no start
condition?
a. Yes >> proceed to Step # 3.
b. No >> then STOP. The no start condition is NOT caused by the DPF. DPF replacement is NOT
needed, and this bulletin DOES NOT apply.
3. Replace the DPF. Refer to the detailed removal and installation procedures available in
DealerCONNECT > TechCONNECT under: Service Info >
11 - Exhaust Systems > Converter, Catalytic > Removal/Installation > 6.7L diesel P/U.
4. Clean the EGR valve. Refer to the detailed cleaning procedures available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: 25 - Emissions Controls >
Exhaust Gas Recirculation, 6.7L Diesel > Valve, Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR), 6.7L >
Cleaning.
5. Ensure all other engine driveability symptom and/or aftertreatment-related DTC's are addressed.
6. Confirm the PCM application software is at the latest revision level. If an update is required,
follow the latest calibration update TSB.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Use Standard Labor Operation Times
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
DIESEL OXIDATION CATALYST (DOC)
The diesel oxidation catalyst (DOC) is a ceramic flow through substrate coated with a catalyst
washcoat that is integral to the DOC/Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) assembly. The close coupled
DOC treats engine exhaust gases by converting harmful carbon monoxide, unburned hydrocarbons
and other compounds into water, carbon dioxide and heat.
DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER
The diesel particulate filter (DPF) is a wall-pass ceramic filter substrate coated with a catalyst
washcoat that is integral to the DOC/DPF assembly. The partially treated exhaust gases from the
DOC, flow into the catalyzed diesel particulate filter (DPF) which traps and accumulates particulate
matter and further treats the exhaust gases to reduce unburned hydrocarbons and other harmful
compounds. the trapped particulate molecules will be periodically removed from the DPF via a
thermal regeneration process initiated by the engine's electronic control module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6193
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The oxidation catalyst raises the exhaust gas temperatures to regenerate the DPF, which is
passive regeneration. If the passive regeneration cannot keep up with the build up of soot in the
DPF, the ECM will actively regenerate the DPF to burn off the soot. Residue remains inside the
DPF in the form of non burnable ash. Ash comes from the oils and other materials that are trapped
in the oils and are present in the soot. The catalyst contains a large number of parallel channels,
which run in the axial direction and are separated by thin porous walls. The channels are
alternatively open at one end, but plugged at the other. The exhaust gases flow through the walls
and escape through the pores in the wall material. Particulates, however, are too large to escape
and are trapped in the monolith walls. The ECM starts the regeneration of the DPF if the soot load
exceeds a performance map value. The ECM determines the load condition of the DPF based
upon the exhaust gas pressure upstream and downstream of the DPC/DPF. A pressure differential
sensor provides the pressure input to the ECM. During the regeneration process, the ECM raises
the temperature in the DOC/DPF to burn off the soot accumulated. Under normal operation, the
engine does not produce enough heat to oxidize the soot inside the DOC/DPF. This process
requires temperatures above 550°C (1,022°F). After regeneration, the ECM reads the actual
pressure difference at the DOC/DPF and compares it with a reference value. From this
comparison, the ECM determines the ash quantity inside the DOC/DPF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6194
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - DIESEL PARTICULATE FILTER
EVIC Message Center - Message - Catalyst Full
The engine Electronic Control Module (ECM) monitors the soot load in the diesel particulate filter.
Under normal operating conditions the diesel particulate filter is self-cleaning, where accumulated
soot is converted to ash. Under light load operating conditions, the driver may be notified via the
vehicle's Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) message center "CATALYST FULL: SEE
OWNERS MAN" message will be displayed indicating that it is necessary to modify the vehicles
driving routine/duty-cycle in order to allow the diesel particulate filter system to self clean. If the
vehicle's EVIC message center notification is ignored, the vehicle will eventually derate the engine
and set a fault, requiring service. The soot load in the diesel particulate filter is estimated by the
ECM using the Exhaust Pressure Sensor values and the calculated soot output of the engine. This
fault code will be triggered if the application is not operating at a duty cycle high enough to allow
active regeneration of the diesel particulate filter. This fault code is an indication that the exhaust
temperatures exiting the turbocharger are not high enough to allow active regeneration of the soot
that is trapped in the diesel particulate filter. It may be necessary to increase the duty cycle of the
application in order to prevent excessive soot accumulation and plugging of the diesel particulate
filter. The ECM will set this fault if it detects that the soot level has exceeded the normal desoot
trigger threshold by a sufficient amount to indicate that the driver intervention is required. There is
not a MIL lamp associated with this fault code, though the driver will be notified via the EVIC
message.
Have owner drive vehicle at highway speeds (50/60 mph) for a minimum of 45 minutes.
If the message CATALYST FULL SERVICE REQ'D. is still displayed, Refer to - ENGINE Testing.
See: Engine, Cooling and Exhaust/Engine/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Removal - Cab Chassis
6.7L DIESEL - CAB-CHASSIS
WARNING: If torches are used when working on the exhaust system, do not allow the flame near
the fuel lines.
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Saturate the bolts and nuts with heat valve lubricant. Allow 5
minutes for penetration. 3. Remove flexible tubing from particulate filter pressure sensor tubing. 4.
Loosen and remove particulate filter pressure sensor tubing from Diesel Oxidation Catalytic/Diesel
Particulate Filter (DOC/DPF). 5. Disconnect and remove temperature sensors. 6. 4X4 Vehicles Remove transfer case skid plate. 7. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transmission crossmember. 8.
Remove exhaust pipe to DOC/DPF flange nuts (5) 9. Remove intermediate pipe to DOC/PDF
clamp nuts (2).
10. Move muffler and tail pipe assembly (1) toward rear of vehicle. 11. Remove DOC/DPF (4). 12.
Remove and discard flange gaskets.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 6197
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Removal - P/U
6.7L DIESEL - P/U
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Saturate the bolts and nuts with heat valve lubricant. Allow 5
minutes for penetration. 3. Loosen and remove DPF differential pressure tubes (4 and 6). 4.
Disconnect and remove temperature sensor (2). 5. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transfer case skid plate.
6. 4X4 Vehicles - Remove transmission crossmember. 7. Remove DPF to muffler clamp (5).
Discard clamp. 8. Move muffler and tail pipe assembly toward rear of vehicle. 9. Remove DPF to
catalytic converter flange nuts.
10. Remove DPF. Discard flange gaskets.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 6198
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Installation - Cab Chassis
6.7L DIESEL - CAB-CHASSIS
1. Position new exhaust flange gaskets on exhaust pipe (6) to DOC/DPF flange and DOC/DPF into
intermediate pipe (1). 2. Using new gasket, position the DOC/DPF (4) onto the front exhaust pipe
flange. 3. Install flange nuts (5). Hand tighten only. 4. Check the exhaust system for contact with
the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.) is required between the exhaust system
components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
5. Tighten flange nuts (5) to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs) 6. Tighten torque clamp nuts to 52 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) 7.
Install temperature sensor. Tighten to 29.8 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 8. Install exhaust differential pressure
tubing. Tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 9. Install flexible exhaust differential pressure sensor tubing.
10. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transmission crossmember. 11. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transfer case skid
plate. 12. Connect electrical connectors. 13. Connect negative battery cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Diesel Particle Filter (DPF) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal - Cab Chassis > Page 6199
Diesel Particle Filter (DPF): Service and Repair Installation - P/U
6.7L DIESEL - P/U
1. Position new exhaust flange gaskets on catalytic converter to DPF flange. 2. Install flange bolts.
Hand tighten only. 3. Install muffler and tailpipe assembly 4. Install new band clamp. Hand tighten
only. 5. Check the exhaust system for contact with the body panels. A minimum of 25 mm (1.0 in.)
is required between the exhaust system components
and body/frame parts. Make the necessary adjustments, if needed.
6. Tighten flange nuts to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs) 7. Tighten band clamp nuts to 52 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) 8.
Install temperature sensor. Tighten to 29.8 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) 9. Install front and rear (6 and 4)
exhaust differential pressure tubing. Tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
10. Install flexible exhaust differential pressure sensor tubing. 11. 4X4 Vehicles - Install
transmission crossmember. 12. 4X4 Vehicles - Install transfer case skid plate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Canister Purge Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 441
Component : SOLENOID-EVAP PURGE
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-EVAP PURGE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EVAP PURGE CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
2 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6204
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6205
Canister Purge Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 441
Component : SOLENOID-EVAP PURGE
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-EVAP PURGE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EVAP PURGE CONTROL K52 20DB/WT
2 EVAP PURGE SOL SIGNAL K70 20DB/BR
Component Location - 32
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6206
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
Leak Detector: Locations
Component ID: 464
Component : SWITCH-EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z910 20BK
2 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 6210
Component Location - 69
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 6211
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 6212
Leak Detector: Diagrams
Component ID: 464
Component : SWITCH-EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-EVAP SYSTEM MONITOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z910 20BK
2 ESM SIGNAL K107 20VT/WT
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 6213
Component Location - 69
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detector, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 6214
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for EGR Cooler: > NHTSA08V641000 > Dec > 08
> Recall 08V641000: Potential Engine Compartment Fire
EGR Cooler: Recalls Recall 08V641000: Potential Engine Compartment Fire
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/RAM 2500 2007-2008 Dodge/RAM 3500
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V641000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Engine and Engine Cooling: Engine: Diesel
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 108429
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 108,429 M/Y 2007-2008 Dodge RAM 2500 and 3500 pickup
trucks equipped with 6.7L Diesel engines. A silencer pad can sag and contact the Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) cooler.
CONSEQUENCE: This could result in an engine compartment fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will add a bracket to support the engine compartment silencer pad adjacent to
the EGR cooler. The recall is expected to begin during December 2008. Owners may contact
Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H34. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for EGR Cooler: >
NHTSA08V641000 > Dec > 08 > Recall 08V641000: Potential Engine Compartment Fire
EGR Cooler: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V641000: Potential Engine Compartment Fire
VEHICLE MAKE/MODEL: MODEL YEAR(S): Dodge/RAM 2500 2007-2008 Dodge/RAM 3500
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Chrysler LLC.
MFR'S REPORT DATE: December 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V641000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Engine and Engine Cooling: Engine: Diesel
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 108429
SUMMARY: Chrysler is recalling 108,429 M/Y 2007-2008 Dodge RAM 2500 and 3500 pickup
trucks equipped with 6.7L Diesel engines. A silencer pad can sag and contact the Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) cooler.
CONSEQUENCE: This could result in an engine compartment fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will add a bracket to support the engine compartment silencer pad adjacent to
the EGR cooler. The recall is expected to begin during December 2008. Owners may contact
Chrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: Chrysler recall No. H34. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6229
EGR Cooler: Diagrams
Component ID: 498
Component : VALVE-EGR COOLER BYPASS
Connector:
Name : VALVE-EGR COOLER BYPASS
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L DH/D1)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR BYPASS STATUS K671 18BR/DB
2 EGR BYPASS VALVE SIGNAL K670 18BR/LB
3 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
4 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
EGR Cooler: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Gas Recycling cooler is located above the exhaust manifold on the right side of the
engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6232
EGR Cooler: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Exhaust gas enter the rear portion of the EGR Cooler from the exhaust manifold. The gas is cooled
as it passes through the EGR Cooler and then enters the EGR crossover tube and is routed to the
EGR valve.
Coolant enters the rear of the EGR Cooler and flow the same direction as the exhaust gases.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
EGR Cooler: Procedures
CLEANING
1. Remove EGR Cooler. 2. Spray the internal cavity of EGR Cooler with hot tap water for 10
minutes. 3. Plug EGR Cooler outlet (1) with a locally obtained rubber expansion plug to make a
watertight seal. 4. Following instruction on the container, mix MOPAR(R) EGR System Cleaner and
hot tap water with a ratio of one part EGR Cleaner, four parts
water.
5. Position EGR Cooler with the outlet (1) facing up. Fill EGR Cooler with hot tap water and
MOPAR(R) EGR System Cleaner until cooler is
completely full. Soak for one hour.
6. Remove plug from EGR Cooler outlet (1). Drain cleaning solution from cooler. Discard according
to local governmental regulations. 7. Rinse cooler using hot tap water until all cleaning solution has
been rinsed clean. Dry completely. 8. Install EGR Cooler.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6235
EGR Cooler: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
EGR COOLER - 6.7L DIESEL - P/U
WARNING: Locking constant tension hose clamps are used on the EGR cooler system hoses.
When removing, use only tools designed for servicing this type of clamp. Always wear safety
glasses when servicing locking constant tension clamps.
1. Remove engine cover. 2. Drain cooling system below level of EGR cooler. 3. Disconnect EGR
bypass control electrical connector (1), (if equipped). 4. Remove EGR bypass control assembly (2)
and position aside, (if equipped).
EGR COOLER - 6.7L DIESEL - CAB-CHASSIS
5. Remove EGR crossover tube clamp (4) and crossover tube (5). 6. Remove EGR Transfer
Connection Tube from casting, (if equipped). 7. Using Tool 6094, remove forward coolant tube (6)
from EGR cooler (2). 8. Using Tool 6094, remove breather tube (7). 9. Using Tool 6094, remove
rear coolant tube (8) from EGR cooler (2).
10. Remove EGR Transfer Connection Tube from casting, (if equipped). 11. Remove EGR cooler
flange nuts (1). 12. Remove EGR cooler mount bolts. 13. Remove EGR cooler. Discard flange
gasket.
Installation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6236
INSTALLATION
EGR COOLER - 6.7L DIESEL
WARNING: Locking constant tension hose clamps are used on the EGR cooler system hoses.
When removing or installing, use only tools designed for servicing this type of clamp. Always wear
safety glasses when servicing locking constant tension clamps.
1. Using a new gasket, position EGR cooler (2) on flange. 2. Install flange nuts (1). Tighten to 10
Nm (89 in. lbs.). 3. Install EGR cooler mounting bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs). 4. Install EGR
crossover tube (5) and crossover tube clamp (4). Tighten clamp nut to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.). 5. Install
EGR Transfer Connection Tube into casting, (if equipped). Tighten clamp nut to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Locking constant tension clamps will SNAP when released.
NOTE: Locking constant tension clamps can be released using a suitable screwdriver.
6. Position locking constant tension clamp (1) on froward coolant tube (4) and install tube. 7. Using
a suitable screwdriver (3), release constant tension clamp (1). 8. Position locking constant tension
clamp on rear coolant tube and install tube. 9. Using a suitable screwdriver, release constant
tension clamp
10. Position locking constant tension clamp on breather tube and install tube. 11. Using a suitable
screwdriver, release constant tension clamp.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6237
EGR COOLER - 6.7L DIESEL - P/U
12. Install EGR Control Assembly, if equipped. Tighten mounting bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 13.
Install EGR Control Assembly electrical connector, (if equipped). 14. Fill coolant system. 15. Install
engine cover. 16. Connect negative battery cable(s). 17. Start engine and check for coolant or
exhaust leaks.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Cooler Bypass Valve Assembly (1) is mounted between the EGR crossover tube and the
EGR cooler. Two mechanical cables (3) join the units together. An electrical drive servo (4) moves
the cables (3) to operate a butterfly plate (2) within a cast manifold.
Parts 1, 2, 3 and 4 are serviced as one entire assembly. Do not attempt to disassemble unit.
1. Disconnect and isolate both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6238
2. Remove four bolts (2) and remove EGR tube cover (1).
3. Loosen and remove two clamps (1) and (6) at ends of EGR Crossover Tube.
4. Remove clamp mounting bolt (3) at center of EGR Crossover Tube.
5. Remove EGR Crossover Tube (4).
6. Remove and discard gaskets (doughnuts) at each end of tube (2) and (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6239
7. Remove nuts (7) and remove upper heat shield (6).
8. Remove bolts (10), nut (8) and remove lower heat shield (9).
9. Remove bolts (5) and (14).
10. Separate casting (4) from casting (15) and discard gasket (3).
11. Disconnect electrical connector (1).
12. Remove bracket bolts (2) at outside of mounting bracket.
13. Remove bracket bolts at inside of mounting bracket.
14. Remove EGR cooler bypass valve assembly from engine.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6240
1. Clean gasket mating surfaces on castings (4) and (15).
2. Position EGR cooler bypass valve assembly to engine.
3. Position new gasket (3) between castings (4) and (15).
4. Install bolts (5) and (14). Do not tighten these bolts at this time.
5. Install bracket bolts (2) at outside of mounting bracket. Do not tighten these bolts at this time.
6. Install bracket bolts at inside of mounting bracket. Do not tighten these bolts at this time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6241
7. Tighten bolts (5) and (14) to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
8. Tighten bracket bolts (2) at outside of mounting bracket to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
9. Tighten bracket bolts at inside of mounting bracket to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
10. Connect electrical connector (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6242
11. Clean each end of EGR crossover tube and its connection points of any old gasket material
12. Install new gaskets (doughnuts) (2) and (5) to each end of tube.
13. Position EGR crossover tube (4) to engine.
14. Position bolt (3) at center of EGR crossover tube. Install bolt loosely (finger tight).
15. First, tighten EGR tube clamp (1) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.), then tighten clamp (6) to 10 Nm (7 ft.
lbs.).
16. Tighten clamp bolt (3) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
17. Install upper heat shield (6) and nuts (7). Tighten nuts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque.
18. Install lower heat shield (9), bolts (10), and nut (8). Tighten nut/bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Cooler > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6243
19. Install EGR tube cover (1) and four bolts (2).
20. Connect and both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
EGR Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 394
Component : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH/D1)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
OPERATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Operation-Cab/Chassis Models > Page 6249
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Pick Up Models
OPERATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
A temperature probe (1) is located at the end of the sensor assembly (3).
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near EGR valve.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
2. Remove sensor (1) from EGR tube (6).
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6252
1. If equipped, remove four cover bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
2. If equipped, remove EGR valve cover (2).
3. A pigtail wiring harness connects sensor to engine wiring harness.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6253
4. Unscrew nut (2) at intake manifold.
5. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness electrical connector from engine wiring harness and remove
sensor assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6254
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
1. Clean EGR crossover tube at sensor mounting point.
2. Check condition of the sensors metal gasket and replace if necessary.
3. Install sensor (1) to EGR tube (6). Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6255
1. A pigtail wiring harness (3) connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Position sensor probe (1) into intake manifold.
3. Screw and tighten nut (2) into intake manifold.
4. Connect electrical connector (4) to engine wiring harness.
5. Install EGR valve cover (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6256
6. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
EGR Tube: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Disconnect and isolate both negative battery cables at batteries.
2. Remove four bolts (2) and EGR crossover tube cover (1).
3. Remove heat shield (2) over EGR valve (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6261
4. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at EGR Temperature Sensor.
5. Loosen and remove two clamps (1) and (3) at ends of EGR Crossover Tube.
6. Remove "P" clamp mounting bolt (5) at center of EGR Crossover Tube.
7. Remove EGR Crossover Tube (2).
8. Remove and discard gaskets (doughnuts) at each end of tube.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
1. Disconnect and isolate both negative battery cables at batteries.
2. Remove four bolts (2) and EGR crossover tube cover (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6262
3. Remove heat shield (2) over EGR valve (1).
4. Loosen and remove two clamps (1) and (6) at ends of EGR Crossover Tube.
5. Remove clamp mounting bolt (3) at center of EGR Crossover Tube.
6. Remove EGR Crossover Tube (4).
7. Remove and discard gaskets (doughnuts) at each end of tube (2) and (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6263
EGR Tube: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Clean each end of EGR crossover tube, and its connection points of any old gasket material
2. Install new gaskets (doughnuts) to each end of tube.
3. Position EGR crossover tube (2) to engine.
4. Position "P" clamp (5) at center of EGR crossover tube. Install "P" clamp bolt loosely (finger
tight).
5. First, tighten EGR tube clamp (1) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.), then tighten clamp (3) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
6. Tighten "P" clamp bolt (5) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
7. Connect electrical connector (4) to EGR temperature sensor.
8. Install heat shield (2) over EGR valve (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6264
9. Install cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
10. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
1. Clean each end of EGR crossover tube and its connection points of any old gasket material
2. Install new gaskets (doughnuts) (2) and (5) to each end of tube.
3. Position EGR crossover tube (4) to engine.
4. Position bolt (3) at center of EGR crossover tube. Install bolt loosely (finger tight).
5. First, tighten EGR tube clamp (1) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.), then tighten clamp (6) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
6. Tighten clamp bolt (3) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6265
7. Install heat shield (2) over EGR valve (1).
8. Install cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
9. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve
EGR Valve: Locations Assembly-EGR Valve
Component ID: 14
Component : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
3 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
4 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
5 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
6 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
7 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
8 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6270
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : PINK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
3 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
4 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6271
5 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
6 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
7 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
8 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
Component Location - 11
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (GAS EXCEPT 5.7L HD)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6272
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GROUND Z335 20BK/WT
5-6 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6273
EGR Valve: Locations Valve-EGR Airflow Control
Component ID: 497
Component : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Connector:
Name : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
2 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-)K314 18BR
3 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
4 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6274
Connector:
Name : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
2 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-)K314 18BR
3 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
4 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6275
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve
EGR Valve: Diagrams Assembly-EGR Valve
Component ID: 14
Component : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
3 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
4 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
5 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
6 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
7 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
8 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6278
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : PINK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 EGR SIGNAL NO. 3 K687 18DB/LB
3 EGR SIGNAL NO. 2 K685 18DB
4 EGR SIGNAL NO. 1 K683 18DB/GY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6279
5 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
6 EGR CONTROL NO. 3 K686 18GY/DB
7 EGR CONTROL NO. 2 K684 18DB/YL
8 EGR CONTROL NO. 1 K682 18DB/WT
Component Location - 11
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-EGR VALVE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (GAS EXCEPT 5.7L HD)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6280
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR SIGNAL K34 20DB/LG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GROUND Z335 20BK/WT
5-6 EGR SOL CONTROL K35 20DB/VT
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6281
EGR Valve: Diagrams Valve-EGR Airflow Control
Component ID: 497
Component : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Connector:
Name : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
2 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-)K314 18BR
3 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
4 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6282
Connector:
Name : VALVE-EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (+) K158 18BR/YL
2 EGR AIRFLOW CONTROL VALVE MOTOR (-)K314 18BR
3 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
4 SENSOR GROUND K971 18BR/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-EGR Valve > Page 6283
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve
EGR Valve: Service and Repair EGR Valve
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
1. Disconnect and isolate both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Remove four bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
3. Remove EGR valve heat shield (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6286
4. Loosen (only) clamp (6). Remove clamp (1) at end of EGR Crossover Tube.
5. Remove bolt (3) at center of EGR Crossover Tube.
6. Disconnect electrical connector at end of valve assembly.
7. Remove two EGR valve assembly mounting bolts and two nuts (1).
8. Remove EGR valve assembly (2) from intake connector (3) by prying up.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6287
9. Remove crossover tube doughnut gasket (1) and clean EGR valve. Also clean end of EGR tube
of any old gasket material.
10. Remove two gaskets on bottom EGR valve (4). Clean bottom of EGR valve and top of its intake
connection point of any old gasket material.
11. To prevent contaminants, cover the exposed opening at intake connection.
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Disconnect and isolate both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Remove four bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6288
3. Remove EGR valve heat shield (2).
4. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at EGR Actuator.
5. Loosen (only) clamp (1). Remove clamp (3) at end of EGR Crossover Tube.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6289
6. Loosen (only) bolt at "P" clamp (5) at center of EGR Crossover Tube.
7. Remove two EGR valve assembly mounting bolts and two nuts (1).
8. Remove EGR valve assembly (2) from intake connector (3) by prying up.
9. Remove crossover tube doughnut gasket (1) and clean EGR valve. Also clean end of EGR tube
of any old gasket material.
10. Remove two gaskets on bottom EGR valve (4). Clean bottom of EGR valve and top of its intake
connection point of any old gasket material.
11. To prevent contaminants, cover the exposed opening at intake connection.
Cleaning
CLEANING
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6290
6.7L EGR VALVE CLEANING PROCEDURE
1. Remove EGR valve assembly from engine.
2. Remove four mounting screws (4) from EGR valve motor (3).
3. Remove valve motor (6) and shim (5) from EGR valve housing (1). Motor (6) and shim (5) must
be kept for reassembly. The original EGR valve
motor and its shim must be reinstalled onto the original EGR valve housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6291
4. Use two fingers to press down on valve spring retainer (3) to unlock two valve keepers (2). If
valve keepers will not release using finger pressure,
locate a 5/8 inch deep socket to the spring retainer (3). Gently tap on the socket with a small
hammer to release keepers, then use two fingers and press for keeper removal.
5. Remove valve spring retainer (3) and valve spring (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6292
6. Lightly press on valve stem (1) about 3/8 inch to force valve faces from valve seats.
7. Using a small nylon scrubbing brush, lightly brush away loose soot from EGR valve housing.
8. The EGR valve shaft stem (3) is comprised of two valve faces (1) on two valve seats. Using the
same small nylon scrubbing brush, lightly brush
away loose soot from stem (3), valve seat (2) and also from valve seat on EGR valve housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6293
9. Completely submerge valve housing using a mixture of hot tap water and MOPAR(R) EGR
System Cleaner (ESC). Mix cleaning solution 1 part
ESC and 4 parts water. Allow cleaning solution to soak for 1 hour.
10. Remove assembly from cleaning solution. Completely remove remaining soot from valve
stems, both valve seats, and both valve faces using a
small nylon scrubbing brush. Dispose of cleaning solution per local governmental regulations.
11. Rinse EGR valve housing in hot tap water until all cleaning solution is rinsed clean. Dry
completely.
12. Assemble valve spring (2) and retainer (3) to housing.
13. Position valve keepers (2). Press down on retainer (3) until groves on valve keepers lock into
valve stem (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6294
14. Install original shim (5) and original motor (6) to housing. Motor is not indexed. Rotate motor
until its electrical connector is pointed towards front
of vehicle. Install four mounting screws (7).
15. Install EGR valve assembly to engine.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
1. Install new gasket (1) to end of EGR tube.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6295
2. Position EGR valve assembly (2) and two new gaskets to intake connection (3).
3. Install two EGR valve mounting bolts (1) and two nuts (1). Tighten four nuts/bolts finger tight
only.
4. Install and lightly tighten two clamps (1) and (6) at ends of EGR Crossover Tube.
5. Install bolt (3) finger tight only.
6. Tighten clamp (6) first to 10 Nm. (7 ft. lbs.), then tighten clamp (1) to 10 Nm. (7 ft. lbs.).
7. Tighten tube bolt (3) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6296
8. Tighten two EGR valve mounting bolts and two nuts (1) to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). Tighten these four
nuts/bolts in an alternating, criss-cross fashion.
9. Connect electrical connector to EGR Actuator.
10. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6297
11. Install EGR valve heat shield (2). Tighten bolts/nuts to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
12. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Install new gasket (1) to end of EGR tube.
2. Position EGR valve assembly (2) and two new gaskets to intake connection (3).
3. Install two EGR valve mounting bolts (1) and two nuts (1). Tighten four nuts/bolts finger tight
only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6298
4. Install and lightly tighten two clamps (1) and (3) at ends of EGR Crossover Tube.
5. Install "P" clamp bolt (5) finger tight only.
6. Tighten clamp (1) first to 10 Nm. (7 ft. lbs.), then tighten clamp (3) to 10 Nm. (7 ft. lbs.).
7. Tighten "P" clamp bolt (5) to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
8. Tighten two EGR valve mounting bolts and two nuts (1) to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). Tighten these four
nuts/bolts in an alternating, criss-cross fashion.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6299
9. Connect electrical connector (5) to EGR Actuator.
10. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four bolts (2).
11. Install EGR valve heat shield (2). Tighten bolts/nuts to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6300
12. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6301
EGR Valve: Service and Repair EGR Valve Air Flow Control
Removal
REMOVAL
The EGR Air Flow Control Valve (5) is bolted to the end of the air intake connection (2).
1. Remove clamp for charge air cooler duct at point (5). Disconnect air cooler duct at this point.
2. Disconnect electrical connector at point (2). This point is located at bottom/inside of air control
valve (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6302
3. Remove four mounting bolts (4) and (6) and remove air flow control valve (5).
4. Remove gasket (3) and discard.
Installation
INSTALLATION
The EGR Air Flow Control Valve (5) is bolted to the end of the air intake connection (2).
1. Obtain new gasket (3). Before positioning new gasket (3), be sure to clean mating surfaces at
top of air flow control valve and bottom of air intake
connection (2).
2. Install four mounting bolts (4) and (6). Tighten four bolts to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.) (160 in. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair > EGR Valve > Page 6303
3. Connect electrical connector at point (2).
4. Connect air cooler duct to bottom of air flow control valve. Install and tighten duct clamp.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6308
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation
Crankcase Filter: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Closed Crankcase Ventilation System (CCV) consists of several parts to make it functional.
One part is the filter. The filter is serviceable and prevents oil mist from entering the discharge tube
of the CCV system. It is not cleaned, but replaced at 60,000 mile intervals.
The crankcase breather assembly is integrated into the cylinder head cover (3) and is serviced
separately. The external fittings (2) to the breather tube and breather drain tube are serviceable.
The crankcase breather assembly is integrated into the cylinder head cover and corresponding
breather cover. Crankcase gasses travel into the breather cavity under the breather cover where
they pass through a filtering media (serviceable maintenance component) which separates the oil
from the crankcase gasses. The oil drains back into the engine block through two hoses (2) on the
left side of the engine.
The crankcase gasses are directed through the Crankcase Depression Regulator (CDR) valve
which allows the system to maintain a constant positive pressure in the crankcase. The CDR valve
is a non-serviceable component located on the underside of the breather cover. Clean crankcase
gasses flow from the CDR valve into the fresh air side of the turbocharger compressor.
The closed crankcase ventilation valve is used to vent the crankcase gases back into the intake of
engine. If the crankcase ventilation filter becomes too restrictive, under high intake vacuum
situations, the closed crankcase ventilation prevents the engine from syphoning crankcase
gases/oil from the crankcase of the engine. The closed crankcase ventilation valve is located under
the crankcase ventilation filter cover at the top of the engine.
TESTING
1. If troubleshooting high crankcase pressure, the following items can be causing the closed
crankcase ventilation valve to close during engine
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6313
operation: High air intake restriction. Check for high intake restriction
- A restricted crankcase ventilation filter. Change the filter
- A malfunctioning or misassembled closed crankcase ventilation valve. Check the valve operation
and change if necessary
2. The closed crankcase ventilation valve should allow crankcases gases to flow when the engine
is not running and/or removed from the engine.
NOTE: Application of air can be applied either to the inlet or outlet of the closed crankcase
ventilation valve.
3. A small amount of air can be blown through the closed crankcase ventilation valve (less than 34
kPa [5 psi]) to check the closed crankcase
ventilation valve.
4. If air does not go through the closed crankcase ventilation valve, replace the valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using hose clamp pliers, loosen the breather plumbing from the breather cover connections. 2.
Carefully remove the breather hoses (2) from the breather cover assembly (3). 3. Remove the
capscrews surrounding the parameter of the breather cover (3). 4. Separate the breather cover (3)
assembly from the cylinder head cover (1).
FILTER ELEMENT REMOVAL
1. With the breather cover removed, remove the filter element from the cylinder head cover cavity
by lifting the element straight up from its sealing
surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6316
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair Installation
FILTER ELEMENT INSPECTION
1. Inspect the crankcase breather assembly by ensuring the oil drain hoses are not kinked or
cracked. 2. Inspect all external hose connections for signs of leakage, repair where necessary.
Inspect the breather for cracks or damage. 3. Inspect the filter element sealing surface for gouges
or cracks; this surface should be smooth and free of abrasions.
FILTER ELEMENT INSTALLATION
1. Clean the filter sealing surface on the cylinder head cover with a clean shop towel. 2. Install the
new filter element, lubrication of the new sealing surface is not recommended. 3. Press the new
filter into the cylinder head cover cavity until fully seated. 4. Install the breather cover assembly.
BREATHER COVER INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the filter element for proper installation. The filter should be completely seated around
the circumference of the sealing surface. 2. Install the breather cover to the cylinder head cover. 3.
Install the capscrews surrounding the breather cover. 4. Install the breather drain hoses onto the
hose barbs. Do not damage or hose connection during installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6320
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6321
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6322
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6323
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6326
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Locations
PCV FILTER
The crankcase breather/filter is no longer used with the 3.9L, 5.2L or 5.9L engine.
PCV VALVE
All 3.9L V-6 and 5.2L/5.9L V-8 gas powered engines are equipped with a closed crankcase
ventilation system and a positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) valve. The 8.0L V-10 engine is not
equipped with a PCV valve. Refer to Crankcase Ventilation System-8.0L V-10 Engine for
information.
Fig. 4 Typical PCV Valve/Hose (Non-California Shown)
This system consists of a PCV valve mounted on the cylinder head (valve) cover with a hose
extending from the valve to the intake manifold. Another hose connects the opposite cylinder head
(valve) cover to the air cleaner housing to provide a source of clean air for the system. A separate
crankcase breather/filter is not used.
Fig. 5 Typical Closed Crankcase Ventilation System
The PCV system operates by engine intake manifold vacuum. Filtered air is routed into the
crankcase through the air cleaner hose. The metered air, along with crankcase vapors, are drawn
through the PCV valve and into a passage in the intake manifold. The PCV system manages
crankcase
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 6330
pressure and meters blow by gases to the intake system, reducing engine sludge formation.
The PCV valve contains a spring loaded plunger. This plunger meters the amount of crankcase
vapors routed into the combustion chamber based on intake manifold vacuum.
Fig. 6 Engine Off Or Engine Pop-Back - No Vapor Flow
When the engine is not operating or during an engine pop-back, the spring forces the plunger back
against the seat. This will prevent vapors from flowing through the valve.
Fig. 7 High Intake Manifold Vacuum - Minimal Vapor Flow
During periods of high manifold vacuum, such as idle or cruising speeds, vacuum is sufficient to
completely compress spring. It will then pull the plunger to the top of the valve. In this position there
is minimal vapor flow through the valve.
Fig. 8 High Intake Manifold Vacuum - Maximum Vapor Flow
During periods of moderate manifold vacuum, the plunger is only pulled part way back from inlet.
This results in maximum vapor flow through the valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6336
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6337
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6338
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6339
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6340
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6341
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Locations Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6342
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6343
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
Component ID: 399
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6346
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 20BR/LB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE SENSOR 1 SIGNAL K185 18BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6347
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20BD/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18BD/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6348
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/2
Component ID: 400
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6349
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 20BR/DB
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/2 SENSOR SIGNAL K186 18BR/DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6350
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6351
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/3
Component ID: 401
Component : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6352
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 20BR/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 EXHAUST TEMPERATURE 1/3 SENSOR SIGNAL K372 18BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Exhaust Temperature 1/1
> Page 6353
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 18DB/DG
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Diesel Exhaust Temperature Sensors are thermistors and change resistance based on the
temperature being measured. The Engine Control Module (ECM) provides a 5 volt reference
voltage to the sensor. The ECM monitors the change in signal voltage and converts this to a
temperature value.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 6356
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
When the exhaust gas temperature is cold, the sensor resistance is high, the Engine Control
Module (ECM) will sense the resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as cold.
When the exhaust gas temperature is high, the sensor resistance is low, the ECM will sense the
resistance and sense the exhaust temperature as high.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect diesel exhaust temperature sensor electrical connector
(1). 3. Remove diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6359
Exhaust Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the diesel exhaust temperature sensor (2). 2. Connect diesel exhaust temperature sensor
electrical connector (1) 3. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6363
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6364
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 391
Component : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKCASE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CRANKCASE SENSOR SIGNAL K926 18DB/GY
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6365
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6366
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4). The CP sensor
monitors crankcase pressure that builds up as the result of combustion gas blow-by. The Engine
Control Module (ECM) uses data from the CP sensor to determine the condition of the crankcase
breather (ventilation) filter. The ECM can also determine if a crankcase breather (ventilation) filter is
present.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Remove mounting screw (6).
2. Disconnect electrical connector (7).
3. Remove sensor (5) from valve cover (4).
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Crankcase Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6369
Crankcase Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The Crankcase Pressure (CP) Sensor (5) is mounted on the valve cover (4).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Install sensor (5) into valve cover (4).
3. Install mounting screw (6). Tighten to 3 Nm (27 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (7).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
EGR Temperature Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 394
Component : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-EGR TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L DH/D1)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K914 18BR/WT
2 EGR TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL K935 18DB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Cab/Chassis Models
OPERATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Operation-Cab/Chassis Models > Page 6375
EGR Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation Operation-Pick Up Models
OPERATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
A temperature probe (1) is located at the end of the sensor assembly (3).
The EGR temperature sensor is a negative temperature coefficient thermistor used to measure the
temperature of the EGR gas flow after it exits the EGR cooler.
The ECM (Engine Control Module) supplies 5-volts to the EGR temperature signal circuit. To
determine the temperature of the EGR gas flow, the ECM monitors the change in voltage caused
by changes in the resistance of the sensor. The ECM uses the exhaust gas recirculation
temperature value for the engine protection system, and also for engine emissions control.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near EGR valve.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
2. Remove sensor (1) from EGR tube (6).
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6378
1. If equipped, remove four cover bolts (2) and remove EGR crossover tube cover (1).
2. If equipped, remove EGR valve cover (2).
3. A pigtail wiring harness connects sensor to engine wiring harness.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6379
4. Unscrew nut (2) at intake manifold.
5. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness electrical connector from engine wiring harness and remove
sensor assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6380
EGR Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the EGR crossover tube (6) near the EGR valve.
1. Clean EGR crossover tube at sensor mounting point.
2. Check condition of the sensors metal gasket and replace if necessary.
3. Install sensor (1) to EGR tube (6). Tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
4. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
The EGR Temperature Sensor (1) is located on the intake manifold, below, and to the rear of the
EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6381
1. A pigtail wiring harness (3) connects the sensor to the engine wiring harness.
2. Position sensor probe (1) into intake manifold.
3. Screw and tighten nut (2) into intake manifold.
4. Connect electrical connector (4) to engine wiring harness.
5. Install EGR valve cover (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > EGR Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6382
6. Install EGR crossover tube cover (1) and four cover bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Exhaust Differential Pressure Sensor is remotely mounted on the transmission housing. Two
pressure tubes measure pressure before and after the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)/Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC). The sensor is critical for fail-safe of regeneration strategy, because it
interprets high pressure drops as possible high soot loads.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Disconnect hoses at pressure
differential pressure sensor. 4. Remove mounting bolt and differential pressure sensor. 5. Remove
mounting bolts (1).
6. Remove pressure differential pressure tubing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
6388
Exhaust Pressure Differential Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install differential pressure tubing, if removed. Tighten fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
2. Position differential pressure sensor (1). 3. Install mounting nuts (5) and bolts. Tighten to 10 Nm
(89 in. lbs.). 4. Install hose (2) to the rear DPF tubing. 5. Install hose (3) to the front DPF tubing. 6.
Connect electrical connector (6). 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (1).
2. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, remove exhaust gas sensor (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 6393
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Using a 6 point deepwell socket, install exhaust gas pressure sensor.
2. Tighten sensor to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.).
3. Connect exhaust gas pressure sensor electrical connector (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURES
Fuel Pump/Gear Pump (low pressure)
................................................................................................................................ 551.5 - 1241 KPA
(80 - 180 psi)
Injection Pump .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 200 - 1800 bar (2900 - 26107 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
*FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
1. FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
Using the scan tool, idle the engine and measure the rail pressure and determine if the rail
pressure is excessive (above 185,00 kpa/26,831 psi). If it is, troubleshoot for excessive rail
pressure first.
Remove the banjo bolt from the pressure-limiting valve on the fuel rail.
Install fuel system test fitting 9013 into the pressure-limiting valve.
Attach one end of a fuel hose to the fuel fitting and put the other end of the fuel hose into a
container
Perform the tests listed below to determine if the pressure-limiting valve is leaking.
a. Operate the engine at idle and watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
b. Operate the engine at idle and actuate the high pressure safety valve test with the scan tool.
Watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
If fuel flows into the fuel container, replace the pressure-limiting valve. If fuel does not leak from the
pressure-limiting valve, the test is complete.
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with any portion of this test kit installed
Operate the engine until the engine is at operating temperature.
Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing
Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and put the open end into the graduated cylinder .
Start the engine and let it idle for one minute.
Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
If the flow is less than 1000ml/minute at idle, the test has successfully passed.
If the flow is greater than 1000ml/minute at idle, replace the fuel injection pump.
Retest to confirm repair.
View Repair
Repair
- Test Complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6400
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection High Pressure Fuel Pump Performance Test
*HIGH PRESSURE FUEL PUMP PERFORMANCE TEST
If the engine will run do the following:
1. Monitor rail pressure with scan tool while the engine is at idle.
2. Compare the fuel pressure set point with the actual fuel pressure reading.
3. If actual fuel pressure reading fluctuates more than ± 500 psi from the set point, then replace the
Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
NOTE: After the actuator is removed, check for debris or corrosion on the FCA. If debris or
corrosion is found, replace the entire Fuel Injection Pump.
4. Turn off engine.
5. Disconnect the FCA harness
6. Disconnect high pressure fuel line from fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
8. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 second intervals (Note: This will give you 30 total seconds of
flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals to prevent damage to the starter). Fuel flow
specification s based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of fuel in 30
seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
If the engine is a no start do the following:
1. Remove fuel pump to rail high pressure fuel line.
2. Inspect the fuel pump outlet port for rust, debris, or other signs of contamination.
3. Replace pump if any contamination is found. Check for source of water in fuel or debris in fuel to
prevent future complaints. If no contamination is found continue to step 4.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
5. Disconnect the high pressure fuel line from the fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line to a
graduated cylinder.
6. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
7. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 seconds intervals.
NOTE: This will give you 30 total seconds of flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals
to prevent damage to the starter.
Fuel flow specification's based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of
fuel in 30 seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6401
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection In-Tank Fuel Lift Pump Flow/Diagnostic Test Procedure
*IN-TANK FUEL LIFT PUMP FLOW/DIAGNOSTIC TEST PROCEDURE
1. Using the Scan tool, check for DTCs. Troubleshoot any active DTCs before performing this test.
2. Disconnect the wiring harness from the lift pump at the fuel tank module connector and inspect
the pins for damage. Fix or replace any damaged component.
3. Connect a voltmeter between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module
connector.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Use the Scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump, record the
voltage on the voltmeter.
5. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 14. If the voltage is less than 11.5 volts, go to
step 6
6. Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage to determine that the voltage is greater than 11.5
volts. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 7. If the voltage is not greater than 11.5
volts, troubleshoot for low battery voltage.
7. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage at the fuel
lift pump relay voltage supply pin in the PDC. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 8.
If the voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, fix or replace the harness.
8. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Install a spare relay in place of the fuel lift pump
relay. Using the Scan tool, actuate the fuel lift pump. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage
between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module connector while the fuel
lift pump is actuated. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, replace the fuel lift pump relay. If the
voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 9.
9. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the lift pump relay from the
PDC. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the resistance of the fuel lift pump power supply wire between
the PDC relay output pin and the fuel tank module connector. If the resistance is less than 10
ohms, go to step 10. If it is greater than 10 ohms, fix or replace the harness.
10. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between battery negative and the fuel lift pump
power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the voltage is less than 1 volt, go to step 11. If
the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between battery negative and the fuel lift
pump power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, fix or
replace the harness. If the resistance is greater than 10 ohms, go to step 12.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the
resistance of the fuel lift pump ground wire between the fuel tank module connector and battery
negative. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, go to step 13. If the resistance is greater than 10
ohms, fix or replace the harness.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using a voltmeter, measure the
voltage between the fuel lift pump ground wire and battery negative. If the voltage is less than 1
volt, go to step 14. If the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
14. Reconnect the lift pump connector.
FLOW TEST.
1. Remove the fuel pump supply banjo fitting from the fuel injection pump.
2. Install fuel system test fitting 9863 onto the end of the quick connect line going to the fuel
injection pump.
3. Connect one end of a section of fuel hose to the test fitting.
4. Put the other end of the fuel hose into an empty fuel container.
5. Use the scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump.
6. While the lift pump is running, move the fuel hose from the fuel canister into a 1000ml graduated
cylinder for 10 seconds.
7. Read and record the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds.
8. If you have more than 570ml in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds, the test has
successfully passed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6402
9. If you have less than 570ml of fuel in the graduated cylinder, inspect the fuel supply line from the
fuel tank to the fuel filter housing and the fuel supply line between the fuel filter housing and the
high pressure fuel pump for signs of damage, replace as necessary. If no damage is found, replace
the fuel filter and retest.
10.Verify the Screened Banjo Bolt at the outlet of the fuel filter is free of debris. If debris is found,
rinse screen with water, blow dry and reinstall. Retest vehicle. If flow meets specification then trace
back the source of debris, if flow is still below spec repair damaged component.
11. If reading is still less than 570ml in 10 seconds, remove the fuel tank and fuel tank module.
Inspect for damage and/or debris in and around the fuel tank module. If module is damaged,
replace and retest.
12. If the module is not damaged, replace the fuel lift pump and retest to confirm fix.
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Information not supplied by manufacturer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 6409
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 6410
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 6411
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6414
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6417
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Testing Air Cleaner Element using Filter Minder(TM)
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove top of air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
The air cleaner (filter) housing (5) is equipped with an air Filter Minder(TM) gauge (3). This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
The Filter Minder(TM) (5) consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic
housing. A yellow colored disc (2) attached to diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on side of
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within Filter Minder will
hold yellow disc at highest restriction that air cleaner element has experienced. A drop in air
pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves diaphragm and yellow disc will indicate
size of air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage plastic housing of Filter
Minder. Cover and tape Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be used.
To test, turn engine off. If yellow disc (2) has reached red colored zone (3) on graduated scale, air
cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to Removal / Installation.
Resetting Filter Minder: After air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press rubber button on
top of Filter Minder. This will allow yellow
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6423
colored disc to reset. After button has been pressed, yellow disc should spring back to UP position.
If Filter Minder gauge has reached red colored zone, and after an examination of air cleaner (filter)
element, element appears to be clean, high reading may be due to a temporary condition such as
snow build-up at air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also occur if air cleaner (filter) element
has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow element to dry out during
normal engine operation. Reset rubber button on top of Filter Minder and retest after element has
dried.
Filter Removal
1. The housing cover is equipped with spring clips and is hinged with plastic tabs. Unlatch clips
from top of air cleaner housing and tilt housing cover
up for cover removal.
2. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6424
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing new air cleaner element (filter), clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position
air cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch spring clips to seal cover to housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6428
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6429
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6430
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6431
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6434
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Actuator-Fuel Control
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Locations Actuator-Fuel Control
Component ID: 4
Component : ACTUATOR-FUEL CONTROL
Connector:
Name : ACTUATOR-FUEL CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
2 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
2 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Actuator-Fuel Control > Page 6440
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Actuator-Fuel Control > Page 6441
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Actuator-Fuel Control > Page 6442
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Locations Actuator - Fuel Control
The Fuel Control Actuator (FCA) (3) is located at the rear of the high-pressure, fuel injection pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Page 6443
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Diagrams
Component ID: 4
Component : ACTUATOR-FUEL CONTROL
Connector:
Name : ACTUATOR-FUEL CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K604 18BR/TN
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR DRIVER K365 18DB/BR
2 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K65 18BR/LB
2 FUEL CONTROL ACTUATOR RETURN K366 18BR/LB
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Page 6444
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Locations > Page 6445
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Description and Operation > Valve-Cascade Overflow
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Description and Operation Valve-Cascade Overflow
Description
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: The cascade overflow valve is not serviced separately.
The cascade overflow valve (4) is located on the top/rear side of the fuel injection pump.
Operation
OPERATION
When the fuel control actuator (FCA) is opened, the maximum amount of fuel is being delivered to
the fuel injection pump. The cascade valve regulates how much excess fuel is used for lubrication
of the injection pump, and is also used to route excess fuel through the drain circuit and back into
the fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Description and Operation > Valve-Cascade Overflow > Page 6448
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Description and Operation Actuator - Fuel Control
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Fuel Control Actuator (FCA) (3) is located at the rear of the high-pressure, fuel injection pump.
Operation
OPERATION
The Fuel Control Actuator (FCA) is an electronically controlled solenoid valve. The ECM controls
the amount of fuel that enters the high-pressure pumping chambers by opening and closing the
FCA based on a demanded fuel pressure. When the FCA is opened, the maximum amount of fuel
is being supplied to the fuel injection pump. Any fuel that does not enter the injection pump is
directed to the cascade overflow valve. The cascade overflow valve regulates how much excess
fuel is used for lubrication of the pump and how much is returned to the fuel tank through the drain
manifold.
An audible click from the FCA is normal when operating the key from the ON to the OFF position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove electrical connector (6) from Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
2. Remove FCA mounting screws (1).
3. Twist and pull FCA to remove from injection pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diesel MFI Pump > Fuel Inlet
Metering Valve, Diesel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6451
Fuel Inlet Metering Valve: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate new Fuel Control Actuator (FCA) O-ring with clean oil before installation.
2. Turn FCA in a clockwise direction while pressing it into machined bore on rear of fuel injection
pump. Be sure FCA flange is flush with the
mounting surface on fuel injection pump.
3. Install FCA mounting screws (1) by hand.
4. Tighten FCA mounting screws (1) to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 6456
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page 6457
Fuel Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Severe Duty Filtration Kit Availability
NUMBER: 14-001-09
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: January 24, 2009
SUBJECT: Severe Duty Fuel Filtration Mopar Add On Kit Available
MODELS:
2005 - 2009 (D1/DH) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2009 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2005
model year and D1/DH/DC vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins engine built from 2007 model
year.
DISCUSSION: A frame mounted supplemental filter kit is now available for the vehicles listed
above. This kit includes complete instructions (K6855569AC) with all necessary components and
wiring to upgrade fuel filtering to a severe duty rating.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filters (on engine filter and added chassis mounted severe
duty fuel filtration kit filter) are 15,000 miles.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6460
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6463
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6464
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6465
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6466
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6467
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Heater-Fuel
Fuel Heater: Locations Heater-Fuel
Component ID: 139
Component : HEATER-FUEL
Connector:
Name : HEATER-FUEL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
A GROUND Z902 14BK
A GROUND Z816 14BK
B FUEL HEATER CONTROL OUTPUT A961 14RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Heater-Fuel > Page 6472
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Heater-Fuel > Page 6473
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Heater-Fuel > Page 6474
Fuel Heater: Locations Fuel Heater Element
The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing (4).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6475
Fuel Heater: Diagrams
Component ID: 139
Component : HEATER-FUEL
Connector:
Name : HEATER-FUEL
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
A GROUND Z902 14BK
A GROUND Z816 14BK
B FUEL HEATER CONTROL OUTPUT A961 14RD
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6476
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6477
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6478
Fuel Heater: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel heater is used to prevent diesel fuel from waxing during cold weather operation.
When the fuel temperature is below 45 ± 8° F (7° C), the temperature sensor allows current to flow
to the heater element warming the fuel. When the fuel temperature is above 75 ± 8° F (24° C), the
sensor stops current flow to the heater element.
Battery voltage to operate the fuel heater element is supplied from the ignition switch and through a
solid stated device in the TIPM. The fuel heater element and "solid state device in TIPM" are not
computer controlled. The heater element operates on 12 volts, 300 watts at 0° F (-18° C).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6479
Fuel Heater: Testing and Inspection
FUEL HEATER
The fuel heater is used to prevent diesel fuel from waxing during cold weather operation.
NOTE: The fuel heater element, "solid state device in TIPM" is not controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM).
A malfunctioning fuel heater can cause a wax build-up in the fuel filter/water separator. Wax
build-up in the filter/separator can cause engine starting problems and prevent the engine from
revving up. It can also cause blue or white fog-like exhaust. If the heater is not operating in cold
temperatures, the engine may not operate due to fuel waxing.
The fuel heater assembly is located on the side of fuel filter housing and internal to the fuel filter
housing.
The heater assembly is equipped with a built-in fuel temperature sensor (thermostat) that senses
fuel temperature. When fuel temperature drops below 45 ° ± 8° F (7° C), the sensor allows current
to flow to built-in heater element to warm fuel. When fuel temperature rises above 75° ± 8° F (24°
C), the sensor stops current flow to heater element (circuit is open).
Voltage to operate fuel heater element is supplied from ignition switch, through "solid state device
in TIPM", to fuel temperature sensor and on to fuel heater element.
The heater element operates on 12 volts, 300 watts at 0° F (-18° C). As temperature increases,
power requirements decrease.
A minimum of 7 volts is required to operate the fuel heater. The resistance value of the heater
element is less than 1 ohm (cold) and up to 1000 ohms warm.
TESTING
1. Disconnect electrical connector (1) from heater element.
Ambient temperature must be below the circuit close temperature. If necessary, induce this
ambient temperature by placing ice packs on thermostat to produce an effective ambient
temperature below circuit close temperature.
Measure resistance across two pins. Operating range is 0.3 - 0.45 Ohms.
2. If resistance is out of range, replace heater element.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Heater > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6480
Fuel Heater: Service and Repair
Fuel Heater Element Replacement:
The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing (4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1
Fuel Injector: Locations Injector-Fuel 1
Component ID: 145
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6485
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6486
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6487
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6488
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6489
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6490
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6491
Fuel Injector: Locations Injector-Fuel 2
Component ID: 146
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 14BK
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6492
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6493
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6494
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6495
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6496
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6497
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6498
Fuel Injector: Locations Injector-Fuel 3
Component ID: 147
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6499
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6500
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6501
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6502
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6503
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6504
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6505
Fuel Injector: Locations Injector-Fuel 4
Component ID: 148
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 14BK
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6506
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6507
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6508
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6509
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6510
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6511
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6512
Fuel Injector: Locations
Injector-Fuel 1
Component ID: 145
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6513
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6514
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6515
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6516
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6517
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6518
Injector-Fuel 2
Component ID: 146
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6519
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6520
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6521
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6522
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6523
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6524
Injector-Fuel 3
Component ID: 147
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6525
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 14BK
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6526
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6527
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6528
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6529
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6530
Injector-Fuel 4
Component ID: 148
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6531
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6532
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6533
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6534
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6535
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6536
Injector-Fuel 5
Component ID: 149
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6537
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 14BK
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6538
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6539
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6540
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6541
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6542
Injector-Fuel 6
Component ID: 150
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6543
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6544
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6545
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6546
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6547
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Locations > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6548
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Injector-Fuel 1
Component ID: 145
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6551
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6552
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6553
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6554
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6555
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6556
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6557
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Injector-Fuel 2
Component ID: 146
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 14BK
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6558
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6559
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6560
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6561
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6562
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6563
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6564
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Injector-Fuel 3
Component ID: 147
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6565
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6566
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6567
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6568
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6569
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6570
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6571
Fuel Injector: Diagrams Injector-Fuel 4
Component ID: 148
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 14BK
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6572
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6573
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6574
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6575
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6576
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6577
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6578
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
Injector-Fuel 1
Component ID: 145
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 1 K611 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 14BK
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6579
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6580
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6581
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 1
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 1 K11 18BR/YL
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6582
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6583
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6584
Injector-Fuel 2
Component ID: 146
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6585
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 2 K612 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6586
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6587
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 2
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 2 K12 18BR/DB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6588
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6589
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6590
Injector-Fuel 3
Component ID: 147
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6591
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 1 K227 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 3 K613 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 14BK
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6592
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6593
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 3
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 3 K13 18BR/LB
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6594
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6595
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6596
Injector-Fuel 4
Component ID: 148
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6597
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 4 K614 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6598
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6599
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 4
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 4 K14 18BR/TN
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6600
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6601
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6602
Injector-Fuel 5
Component ID: 149
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6603
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 5 K638 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 14BK
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6604
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6605
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 5
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 5 K38 18BR/OR
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6606
Component Location - 9
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6607
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6608
Injector-Fuel 6
Component ID: 150
Component : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Gender : MALE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6609
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER-BANK 2 K229 14BK
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR HIGH SIDE DRIVER NO. 6 K658 14BK
2 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 14BK
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6610
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6611
Connector:
Name : INJECTOR-FUEL 6
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (NGC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INJECTOR CONTROL NO. 6 K58 18BR/VT
2 ASD CONTROL OUTPUT K342 16BR/WT
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6612
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6613
Component Location - 15
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Injector-Fuel 1 > Page 6614
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Six individual, solenoid actuated high-pressure fuel injectors are used (6). The injectors are
vertically mounted into a bored hole in the top of the cylinder head. This bored hole is located
between the intake/exhaust valves.
High-pressure connectors (13), mounted into the side of the cylinder head, connect each fuel
injector to each high-pressure fuel line (1).
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6617
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
The valve cover and valve cover gasket will need to be removed in order to manually record the
values from the original injectors. Contact cleaner or brake cleaner may be used to clean the fuel
injector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6618
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
High-pressure fuel is supplied from the injection pump, through a high-pressure fuel line, into a fuel
rail, through high-pressure lines, through steel connectors and into the solenoid actuated fuel
injector. The ECM actuates the solenoid causing the needle valve to rise and fuel flows through the
spray holes in the nozzle tip into the combustion chamber.
Each fuel injector is connected to the fuel rail by a high-pressure fuel line and a steel connector.
This steel connector is positioned into the cylinder head and sealed with an O-ring. The connector
is retained in the cylinder head by a nut (fitting) that is threaded into the cylinder head.
The torquing force of this threaded nut (fitting) provides a sealing pressure between the fuel line
connector and the fuel injector. Retaining nut torque is very critical. If the nut (fitting) is under
torqued, the mating surfaces will not seal and a high-pressure fuel leak will result. If the fitting is
over torqued, the connector and injector will deform and also cause a high-pressure fuel leak. This
leak will be inside the cylinder head and will not be visible. The result will be a possible fuel injector
miss-fire and low power, or a no-start condition.
The fuel injectors use hole type nozzles. High-pressure flows into the side of the injector, the ECM
activates the solenoid causing the injector needle to lift and fuel to be injected. The clearances in
the nozzle bore are extremely small and any dirt or contaminants will cause the injector to stick.
Because of this, it is very important to do a thorough cleaning of any lines before opening up any
fuel system component. Always cover or cap any open fuel connections before a fuel system repair
is performed.
Each fuel injector connector tube contains an edge filter that is designed to break up small
contaminants before entering the fuel injector. The edge filters are not a substitute for proper
cleaning and covering of all fuel system components during repair.
The bottom of each fuel injector is sealed to the cylinder head with a 1.5mm thick copper shim
(gasket). The correct thickness shim must always be re-installed after removing an injector.
Fuel pressure in the injector circuit decreases after injection. The injector needle valve is
immediately closed and fuel flow into the combustion chamber is stopped. Exhaust gases are
prevented from entering the injector nozzle by the needle valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6619
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection
*INJECTOR RETURN FLOW TEST
1. ENGINE RUNS
NOTE: Review Warranty bulletin D-05-24.
NOTE: Battery charger may be utilized if cranking speed is below 170 RPM's.
Does the engine run?
Yes
- Go To 2
No
- Go To 3
2. * INJECTOR RETURN FLOW TEST @ 1200 RPM AND 1400 BAR RAIL PRESSURE
1. Operate the engine until the coolant temperature is above 180° F.
2. Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing.
3. Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
4. Remove the vehicle fuel return line from the engine fuel drain tube.
5. Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and into a fuel container or into the fuel tank.
6. Install one end of a test hose onto the fuel drain tube. Place the other end of the test hose into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Start engine and allow to idle for 30 sec. This step allows the flows to stabilize. Gather
appropriate measuring device to measure collected return fuel.
8. Using the scan tool, navigate to ECM view -> PCM Cummins -> More Options-> System Tests
-> Fuel Pressure override test. Select Start, then press Next.
9. Press the Run button on the screen. As you press the Run button to start the overpressure test,
please move the injector return hose from the bucket and insert into the appropriate measuring
device. The engine speed will elevate rapidly to 1200 rpm and the rail pressure will increase to
20000 psi (1400 bar).
10. While the test is running, please record the FCA duty cycle % and actual rail pressure record
the readings on the Cummins Diesel Diagnostic Worksheet located under e-files, service, Star
center in dealerconnect.
11. Measure and Record the amount of fuel collected.
12. If the flow is less than 160 ml/30 secs, the test has successfully passed, and the condition has
been fixed
13. If the flow is greater than 250 ml/30 seconds, refer to step 20.
14. If the flow is greater than 160 ml/30 secs after step 11, shut off the engine and remove all 6
high pressure fuel lines. Re-torque the high-pressure connector nut. Inspect for damage,
repair/replace as necessary. Reinstall high pressure fuel lines.
15. Start the engine and perform steps 7 through 10.
16. Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
17. If the amount of fuel is greater than 160 ml/30 sec, shut off the engine and remove the #1 high
pressure fuel line. Cap the #1 fuel port using tool 9011 on the fuel rail and repeat steps 7 through
10.
18. Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder. If the amount is less than 160 ml.30 sec,
remove and replace the #1 injector and #1 High pressure connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6620
19. If the amount of fuel is not less than 160-ml/30 secs, repeat steps 17-18 for cylinders 2-6.
20. If the amount of fuel is greater than 250 ml/30 secs it is recommended that all 6 injectors be
replaced.
21. Install all high-pressure connectors, fuel injectors, and fuel injector supply lines. Repeat steps
1-12 to confirm repair.
SPECIFICATION: Less than 160 ml/ 30 seconds total fuel returns flow
Repair
- Test Complete.
3. * INJECTOR RETURN FLOW TEST DURING ENGINE CRANKING @200 RPM WHEN THE
VEHICLE WILL NOT START
1. Install 9012 fitting in standard location on back of fuel filter head to measure pump and injector
return flows.
2. Install hoses to the test fitting and the injector return line and route them to a bucket or other
container. Make sure test lines are straight and slope downward their entire length. This is to avoid
trapping air/fuel in the lines while testing.
3. Unplug the injector harnesses at the valve cover, Unplug the connector to the FCA.
4. Crank the engine for least 10 seconds until fuel starts to flow out of the pump and injector return
hoses. Turn Key off when finished.
5. Let all the fuel drain out of each line before continuing.
6. Place the injector return hose into an appropriate measuring device.
7. Crank the engine for 10 seconds. Go from Keyoff to Crank back to Keyoff. Do not leave the
ignition on between tests.
8. Let all of the fuel drain out of the injector hose.
9. Record the amount of injector return for a 10 sec crank.
10. Flow should be less than 40 ml for 10 seconds of cranking
11. If the flow is greater than 40 ml after step 10, remove the #1 fuel injector supply line. Re-torque
the high-pressure connector nut. Cap the #1 fuel port using tool 9011 on the fuel rail.
12. Crank the engine and perform steps 7 through 9.
13. Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
14. If the amount of fuel is less than 40 ml, remove the #1 high pressure connector and the #1 fuel
injector. Inspect for damage, repair/replace as necessary.
15. If the amount of fuel is not less than 40 ml, repeat steps 12-14 for cylinders 2-6.
16. Install all high-pressure connectors, fuel injectors, and fuel injector supply lines. Repeat steps
1-12 to confirm repair.
Repair
- Note: DTC's will be set by this process. Remember to go in and clear all DTC's from all modules.
Test complete.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
The valve cover and valve cover gasket will need to be removed in order to manually record the
values from the original injectors. Contact cleaner or brake cleaner may be used to clean the fuel
injector.
NOTE: If the fuel injectors are being removed such as for engine teardown or diagnostic purposes,
be sure to mark each injector with its corresponding cylinder number. The fuel injectors MUST be
reinstalled into the original (same) cylinder due to the fuel injector correction code.
NOTE: Do not install new fuel injectors unless the alphanumeric codes have been recorded.
CAUTION: Refer to Cleaning Fuel System Parts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6623
Six individual, solenoid actuated high-pressure fuel injectors (7) are used. The injectors are
vertically mounted into a bored hole in the top of the cylinder head. This bored hole is located
between the intake/exhaust valves. High-pressure connectors, mounted into the side of the cylinder
head, connect each fuel injector to each high-pressure fuel line.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables from both batteries. Cover and isolate ends of cables.
2. Remove vanity cover.
3. Remove breather assembly and tubes.
4. Remove valve cover.
5. Remove all 12 fuel injector wire harness nuts (1) securing integrated wiring harness to all 6 fuel
injectors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6624
6. An integrated fuel injector wire harness / valve cover gasket (2) is used. After all 12 nuts (1) have
been removed, remove this integrated gasket.
Before removing gasket, disconnect engine wiring harness at both electrical connectors (3).
7. Remove necessary high pressure fuel line connecting the necessary fuel injector rail to high
pressure connector.
8. A connector retainer (nut) is used on each connector tube (12). Remove this nut(s) by
unthreading from cylinder head. These nuts (12) hold the
fuel injector retainers (13) to the fuel injector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6625
9. Using special high-pressure connector removal tool #9015 (4) remove necessary high-pressure
connector(s) from cylinder head. Tool #9015
threads onto connector tube. Use tool to pry connector tube(s) from cylinder head.
10. Remove 2 fuel injector hold-down clamp bolts (1) at each injector being removed.
11. Remove necessary exhaust rocker arm assembly(s).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6626
12. USING TOOL #9010:
a. Special Tool #9010 is equipped with 2 clamshell clamps, a sliding retainer sleeve to retain the
clamshell clamps, a 2-piece mounting stud, and
a pivoting handle. Do not attempt to remove the fuel injector with any other device. Damage to
injector will occur.
b. The rocker housing is bolted to the top of cylinder head. The mounting stud from tool #9010 was
meant to temporarily replace a rocker
housing mounting bolt. Remove the necessary rocker housing mounting bolt. These mounting bolts
are located at the center of each of the 5 rocker housing support bridges.
c. Install and tighten 2-piece mounting stud to rocker housing. If removing the No. 6 fuel injector,
separate the 2-piece mounting stud. Install
lower half of mounting stud to center of rocker housing bridge. Install upper half of mounting stud to
lower half.
d. Position tool handle to mounting stud and install handle nut. Leave handle nut loose to allow a
pivoting action. e. Position lower part of clamshell halves to sides of fuel injector (wider shoulder to
bottom). The upper part of clamshell halves should also be
positioned into machined shoulder on the handles pivoting head.
f. Slide the retainer sleeve over pivoting handle head to lock clamshell halves together.
g. Be sure handle pivot nut is loose. h. Depress handle downward to remove fuel injector straight
up from cylinder head bore.
13. Remove and discard injector sealing washer (2). This washer (2) should be located on tip of
injector, or may have remained in the injector bore.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6627
14. Measure sealing gasket (washer) (1).
NOTE: If the fuel injectors are being removed such as for engine teardown or diagnostic purposes,
be sure to mark each injector with its corresponding cylinder number. The fuel injectors MUST be
reinstalled into the original (same) cylinder due to the fuel injector correction code.
NOTE: Do not install new fuel injectors unless the alphanumeric codes have been recorded.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6628
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect fuel injector :
a. Look for burrs on injector inlet. b. Check nozzle holes for hole erosion or plugging. c. Inspect end
of nozzle for burrs or rough machine marks. d. Look for cracks at nozzle end. e. If any of these
conditions occur, replace injector.
2. Record six-digit alphanumeric correction code located on the side of injector.
3. Inspect high-pressure fuel injector connector for :
a. Damaged tip. b. Loose of missing alignment pin. c. Cut or missing O-ring.
4. Thoroughly clean fuel injector cylinder head bore. Blow out bore hole with compressed air.
5. The bottom of fuel injector is sealed to cylinder head bore with a copper sealing washer (shim)
(1) of a certain thickness. A new shim (1) with
correct thickness must always be re-installed after removing injector. Measure thickness of injector
shim (1). Shim Thickness: 1.5 mm (0.060 inch)
6. Install new shim (1) (washer) to bottom of injector. Apply light coating of clean engine oil to
washer. This will keep washer in place during
installation.
7. Install new O-ring to fuel injector. Apply small amount of clean engine oil to O-ring and injector
bore.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6629
8. Install injector into cylinder head with male (high-pressure) connector port facing the intake
manifold. Push down on fuel injector mounting flange
to engage O-ring and seat injector.
9. Tightening Sequence:
a. Install fuel injector holdown clamp (mounting flange) bolts. Be sure the clamp is perpendicular to
the injector body. Do a preliminary
tightening of these bolts to 5 Nm (44 in. lbs.) torque. This preliminary tightening insures the fuel
injector is seated and centered.
b. After tightening, relieve bolt torque, but leave both bolts threaded in place. c. Install
high-pressure connector (13) and retaining nut (12). Do a preliminary tightening of nut (12) to 15
Nm (11 ft. lbs.) torque. d. Alternately tighten injector holdown bolts to 8 Nm (71 in. lbs.) torque. e.
Do a final tightening of the high-pressure connector and retaining nut (12). Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft.
lbs.) torque.
10. Install integrated gasket
11. Connect injector solenoid wires and nuts to top of injectors. Tighten connector nuts to 1.25 Nm
(11 in. lbs.) torque. Be very careful not to
overtighten these nuts as damage to fuel injector will occur.
12. Install exhaust rocker arm assembly.
13. Set exhaust valve lash.
14. Install fuel connector tube nut at cylinder head and tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.). Be sure to use
a secondary back-up wrench on the connector nut
(fitting) while torquing fuel line fitting.
15. Install valve cover.
16. Install breather assembly.
FUEL INJECTOR ID CORRECTION CODES:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6630
Each fuel injector has a six-digit alphanumeric correction code. The correction code is printed on
the intake side of the fuel injector (1) and is used to identify injector calibration. When replacing any
fuel injectors, this code must be entered into the vehicles Engine Control Module (ECM) using a
diagnostic scan tool. In addition, if a new ECM is installed, use a diagnostic scan tool to program all
six of the injector codes from the original fuel injectors into the new ECM.
1. Connect negative battery cables to both batteries.
2. Programming Fuel Injector Correction Code:
- Turn ignition switch "ON".
- Using a diagnostic scan tool, select ECU View> PCM > MISCELLANEOUS FUNCTIONS.
- Select Injector Quantity Adjustments and click Start.
- Choose appropriate cylinder number and click next.
- Click on Show Keyboard.
NOTE: A fault code will be set if incorrect serialization codes have been inputted.
- Input six-digit Injector Correction Code and click enter.
- Review code as it was typed, then click Next if correct, or edit if necessary.
- Repeat the preceding steps for other cylinders if necessary.
- Once all fuel injector correction codes are entered, cycle the ignition to complete.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Locations
The fuel pressure limiting valve (1) is screwed into the front of the fuel rail (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6634
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation
OPERATION
Fuel pressure at the fuel rail is monitored by the fuel rail pressure sensor. If fuel pressure becomes
excessive, the pressure limiting valve opens and vents excess fuel pressure vents through the fuel
pressure limiting valve drain port.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Cleanliness cannot be overemphasized when handling or replacing diesel fuel system
components. This especially includes the fuel injectors, high-pressure fuel lines and fuel injection
pump. Very tight tolerances are used with these parts. Dirt contamination could cause rapid part
wear and possible plugging of fuel injector nozzle tip holes. This in turn could lead to possible
engine misfire. Always wash/clean any fuel system component thoroughly before disassembly and
then air dry. Cap or cover any open part after disassembly. Before assembly, examine each part
for dirt, grease or other contaminants and clean if necessary. When installing new parts, lubricate
them with clean engine oil or clean diesel fuel only.
The fuel pressure limiting valve (1) is screwed into the front of the fuel rail (2).
The fuel pressure limiting valve drain port is located on the side of the fuel rail next to the limiting
valve. The drain port is not serviceable.
1. Thoroughly clean area at pressure limiting valve (1).
2. To gain access to the limiting valve, the intake connection/EGR valve assembly must be
removed. Loosen clamp (5) securing EGR crossover tube
(6) to EGR valve. Also loosen opposite end of EGR crossover tube. Remove clamp from intake
connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6637
3. Remove six bolts (1) securing intake connection (2). Lift the entire EGR valve/intake connection
up and to the side to gain access to fuel pressure
limiting valve.
4. Discard gasket (3).
5. Remove pressure limiting valve from fuel rail.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6638
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Be sure both end of manifold and limiting valve mounting area are clean.
2. Lubricate O-ring on limiting valve with fresh diesel oil. Also lubricate limiting valve threads with
fresh diesel oil.
3. Install valve (1) and torque to 100 Nm (74 ft. lbs.). To prevent leaks, valve MUST be tightened to
prescribed torque.
4. Install new intake connection gasket (3).
5. Position EGR valve/intake connection and install six bolts. Tighten bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Install new EGR crossover tube gasket. Tighten crossover tube clamps to 10 Nm (88 in. lbs.).
7. Using a diagnostic scan tool, reset vale life by using the "Reset Two-Stage Dump Valve
Accumulator" function in the PCM portion of the
diagnostic tool
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6639
8. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 6644
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 6645
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure > Page 6646
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Pressure
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6647
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6648
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6649
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6650
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel pressure sensor monitors actual high-pressure within the fuel rail. An output signal from
this sensor (relating to fuel pressure) is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
1. Remove two bolts (3) and bracket (4) at rear of cylinder head.
2. Remove engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6653
3. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
4. Remove sensor (1) from fuel rail.
5. Inspect sensor sealing surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6654
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect fuel pressure sensor sealing surface.
2. Lubricate sensor threads with clean diesel fuel.
3. Install sensor (1) into fuel rail.
4. To prevent leaks, sensor must be tightened to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
6. Install rear engine lift bracket (4) and bolts (3). Tighten to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.).
7. Install engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
8. Start engine and check for fuel leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
FUEL PRESSURES
Fuel Pump/Gear Pump (low pressure)
................................................................................................................................ 551.5 - 1241 KPA
(80 - 180 psi)
Injection Pump .....................................................................................................................................
............................ 200 - 1800 bar (2900 - 26107 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection Fuel Pump Return Flow Test
*FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
1. FUEL PUMP RETURN FLOW TEST
Using the scan tool, idle the engine and measure the rail pressure and determine if the rail
pressure is excessive (above 185,00 kpa/26,831 psi). If it is, troubleshoot for excessive rail
pressure first.
Remove the banjo bolt from the pressure-limiting valve on the fuel rail.
Install fuel system test fitting 9013 into the pressure-limiting valve.
Attach one end of a fuel hose to the fuel fitting and put the other end of the fuel hose into a
container
Perform the tests listed below to determine if the pressure-limiting valve is leaking.
a. Operate the engine at idle and watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
b. Operate the engine at idle and actuate the high pressure safety valve test with the scan tool.
Watch for fuel flow into the fuel container.
If fuel flows into the fuel container, replace the pressure-limiting valve. If fuel does not leak from the
pressure-limiting valve, the test is complete.
NOTE: Do not drive the vehicle with any portion of this test kit installed
Operate the engine until the engine is at operating temperature.
Remove the banjo connector from the fuel drain tube at the rear of the fuel filter housing
Install fuel system test fitting 9012 in place of the banjo connector.
Install a piece of fuel line onto the test fitting and put the open end into the graduated cylinder .
Start the engine and let it idle for one minute.
Measure the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder.
If the flow is less than 1000ml/minute at idle, the test has successfully passed.
If the flow is greater than 1000ml/minute at idle, replace the fuel injection pump.
Retest to confirm repair.
View Repair
Repair
- Test Complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6661
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection High Pressure Fuel Pump Performance Test
*HIGH PRESSURE FUEL PUMP PERFORMANCE TEST
If the engine will run do the following:
1. Monitor rail pressure with scan tool while the engine is at idle.
2. Compare the fuel pressure set point with the actual fuel pressure reading.
3. If actual fuel pressure reading fluctuates more than ± 500 psi from the set point, then replace the
Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
NOTE: After the actuator is removed, check for debris or corrosion on the FCA. If debris or
corrosion is found, replace the entire Fuel Injection Pump.
4. Turn off engine.
5. Disconnect the FCA harness
6. Disconnect high pressure fuel line from fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line into a
graduated cylinder.
7. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
8. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 second intervals (Note: This will give you 30 total seconds of
flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals to prevent damage to the starter). Fuel flow
specification s based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of fuel in 30
seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
If the engine is a no start do the following:
1. Remove fuel pump to rail high pressure fuel line.
2. Inspect the fuel pump outlet port for rust, debris, or other signs of contamination.
3. Replace pump if any contamination is found. Check for source of water in fuel or debris in fuel to
prevent future complaints. If no contamination is found continue to step 4.
4. Disconnect the Fuel Control Actuator (FCA).
5. Disconnect the high pressure fuel line from the fuel rail and route the high pressure fuel line to a
graduated cylinder.
6. Crank the engine until fuel exits this line. This will not be high pressure fuel.
7. Crank the engine for three (3) 10 seconds intervals.
NOTE: This will give you 30 total seconds of flow time. These are broken into 3 separate intervals
to prevent damage to the starter.
Fuel flow specification's based on engine cranking speed. If you do not collect the stated amount of
fuel in 30 seconds, replace the pump:
Minimum fuel pump flow at 150 rpm cranking speed is 70mL
Minimum fuel pump flow at 200 rpm cranking speed is 90mL
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6662
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection In-Tank Fuel Lift Pump Flow/Diagnostic Test Procedure
*IN-TANK FUEL LIFT PUMP FLOW/DIAGNOSTIC TEST PROCEDURE
1. Using the Scan tool, check for DTCs. Troubleshoot any active DTCs before performing this test.
2. Disconnect the wiring harness from the lift pump at the fuel tank module connector and inspect
the pins for damage. Fix or replace any damaged component.
3. Connect a voltmeter between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module
connector.
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Use the Scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump, record the
voltage on the voltmeter.
5. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 14. If the voltage is less than 11.5 volts, go to
step 6
6. Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage to determine that the voltage is greater than 11.5
volts. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 7. If the voltage is not greater than 11.5
volts, troubleshoot for low battery voltage.
7. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage at the fuel
lift pump relay voltage supply pin in the PDC. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 8.
If the voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, fix or replace the harness.
8. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from the PDC. Install a spare relay in place of the fuel lift pump
relay. Using the Scan tool, actuate the fuel lift pump. Use a voltmeter to measure the voltage
between the fuel lift pump supply and return pins at the fuel tank module connector while the fuel
lift pump is actuated. If the voltage is greater than 11.5 volts, replace the fuel lift pump relay. If the
voltage is not greater than 11.5 volts, go to step 9.
9. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the lift pump relay from the
PDC. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the resistance of the fuel lift pump power supply wire between
the PDC relay output pin and the fuel tank module connector. If the resistance is less than 10
ohms, go to step 10. If it is greater than 10 ohms, fix or replace the harness.
10. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between battery negative and the fuel lift pump
power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the voltage is less than 1 volt, go to step 11. If
the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
11. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Remove the fuel lift pump relay from
the PDC. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between battery negative and the fuel lift
pump power supply wire at the fuel module connector. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, fix or
replace the harness. If the resistance is greater than 10 ohms, go to step 12.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using an Ohmmeter, measure the
resistance of the fuel lift pump ground wire between the fuel tank module connector and battery
negative. If the resistance is less than 10 ohms, go to step 13. If the resistance is greater than 10
ohms, fix or replace the harness.
13. Disconnect the wiring harness from the fuel tank module. Using a voltmeter, measure the
voltage between the fuel lift pump ground wire and battery negative. If the voltage is less than 1
volt, go to step 14. If the voltage is greater than 1 volt, fix or replace the harness.
14. Reconnect the lift pump connector.
FLOW TEST.
1. Remove the fuel pump supply banjo fitting from the fuel injection pump.
2. Install fuel system test fitting 9863 onto the end of the quick connect line going to the fuel
injection pump.
3. Connect one end of a section of fuel hose to the test fitting.
4. Put the other end of the fuel hose into an empty fuel container.
5. Use the scan tool to actuate the fuel lift pump.
6. While the lift pump is running, move the fuel hose from the fuel canister into a 1000ml graduated
cylinder for 10 seconds.
7. Read and record the amount of fuel in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds.
8. If you have more than 570ml in the graduated cylinder after 10 seconds, the test has
successfully passed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > System Diagnosis > Fuel Pump Return Flow Test > Page 6663
9. If you have less than 570ml of fuel in the graduated cylinder, inspect the fuel supply line from the
fuel tank to the fuel filter housing and the fuel supply line between the fuel filter housing and the
high pressure fuel pump for signs of damage, replace as necessary. If no damage is found, replace
the fuel filter and retest.
10.Verify the Screened Banjo Bolt at the outlet of the fuel filter is free of debris. If debris is found,
rinse screen with water, blow dry and reinstall. Retest vehicle. If flow meets specification then trace
back the source of debris, if flow is still below spec repair damaged component.
11. If reading is still less than 570ml in 10 seconds, remove the fuel tank and fuel tank module.
Inspect for damage and/or debris in and around the fuel tank module. If module is damaged,
replace and retest.
12. If the module is not damaged, replace the fuel lift pump and retest to confirm fix.
Test complete
Repair
- Test complete.
- Perform POWERTRAIN VERIFICATION TEST. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing
and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures/Verification
Tests/Powertrain Verification Test
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6667
8w-30-17
Connector C1 pin 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6670
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6671
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6672
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6673
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6674
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6675
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6676
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6677
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6678
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6679
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6680
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6681
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6682
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6683
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6684
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6685
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6686
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6687
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6688
Fuel Pump Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6689
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel transfer pump (fuel lift pump) is part of the fuel pump module. The fuel pump module is
located in the fuel tank. The 12-volt electric pump is operated and controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM). The ECM controls a relay in the intelligent Power Module (IPM) for transfer pump
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Rail: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel rail is used as a distribution device to supply high-pressure fuel to the high-pressure fuel
lines.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Cleanliness cannot be overemphasized when handling or replacing diesel fuel system
components. This especially includes the fuel injectors, high-pressure fuel lines and fuel injection
pump. Very tight tolerances are used with these parts. Dirt contamination could cause rapid part
wear and possible plugging of fuel injector nozzle tip holes. This in turn could lead to possible
engine misfire. Always wash/clean any fuel system component thoroughly before disassembly and
then air dry. Cap or cover any open part after disassembly. Before assembly, examine each part
for dirt, grease or other contaminants and clean if necessary. When installing new parts, lubricate
them with clean engine oil or clean diesel fuel only.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. Isolate ends of both cables.
2. Disconnect electrical connector at fuel pressure sensor (2).
3. Disconnect electrical connector at MAP sensor (3).
4. Disconnect necessary wiring harness retention clips from intake manifold.
5. Disconnect cables for intake air heater.
6. Remove fuel line (8).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6695
7. Loosen fittings (9).
CAUTION: WHEN LOOSENING OR TIGHTENING HIGH-PRESSURE LINE FITTINGS (11)
ATTACHED TO A SEPARATE FITTING (12), USE A BACK-UP WRENCH ON FITTING (12). DO
NOT ALLOW FITTING (12) TO ROTATE. DAMAGE TO BOTH FUEL LINE AND FITTING WILL
RESULT.
8. Loosen fittings (11) and remove all fuel lines (1). Note and mark position of each fuel line while
removing.
9. Remove fuel line connecting injection pump to fuel rail.
10. Remove fuel injection rail mounting bolts (7).
11. Remove rail (6) from top of intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6696
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean any dirt/debris from top of intake manifold and bottom of fuel rail.
2. Position fuel rail to top of manifold and install rail mounting bolts (7). Torque bolts to 24 Nm (18
ft. lbs.).
CAUTION: WHEN LOOSENING OR TIGHTENING HIGH-PRESSURE LINE FITTINGS (11)
ATTACHED TO A SEPARATE FITTING (12), USE A BACK-UP WRENCH ON FITTING (12). DO
NOT ALLOW FITTING (12) TO ROTATE. DAMAGE TO BOTH FUEL LINE AND FITTING WILL
RESULT.
3. Install all high-pressure lines to rail. Torque fittings to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.).
4. Reposition wiring harness to intake elbow and install nut.
5. Install two new sealing washers to fuel limiting valve banjo bolt. Torque to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
6. Connect electrical connector to fuel pressure sensor (2).
7. Connect electrical connector to MAP sensor (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6697
8. Install air intake heater cables.
9. Connect battery cables to both batteries.
10. Start engine and check for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Return Line: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Low-Pressure Lines Are:
- the fuel supply line from fuel tank to fuel filter housing.
- the fuel return line back to fuel tank.
- the fuel drain (manifold) line at rear of cylinder head.
- the fuel supply line from fuel filter to fuel injection pump.
- the fuel injection pump return line.
High-Pressure Lines Are:
- the fuel line from fuel injection pump to fuel rail.
- the six fuel lines from fuel rail up to injector connector tubes
WARNING: High-pressure fuel lines deliver diesel fuel under extreme pressure from the injection
pump to the fuel injectors. This may be as high as 180,000 kpa (26,107 psi). Use extreme caution
when inspecting for high-pressure fuel leaks. Inspect for high-pressure fuel leaks with a sheet of
cardboard. High fuel injection pressure can cause personal injury if contact is made with the skin.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6702
Fuel Return Line: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
High-Pressure Lines
CAUTION: The high-pressure fuel lines must be held securely in the brace. The lines cannot
contact each other or other components. Do not attempt to weld high-pressure fuel lines or to
repair lines that are damaged. If lines are ever kinked or bent, they must be replaced. Use only the
recommended lines when replacement of high-pressure fuel line is necessary.
High-pressure fuel lines deliver fuel (under pressure) of up to approximately 180,000 kPa (26,107
PSI) from the injection pump to the fuel injectors. The lines expand and contract from the
high-pressure fuel pulses generated during the injection process. All high-pressure fuel lines are of
the same length and inside diameter. Correct high-pressure fuel line usage and installation is
critical to smooth engine operation.
WARNING: Use extreme caution when inspecting for high-pressure fuel leaks. Inspect for
high-pressure fuel leaks with a sheet of cardboard. High fuel injection pressure can cause personal
injury if contact is made with the skin.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Return Line: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Cleanliness cannot be overemphasized when handling or replacing diesel fuel system
components. This especially includes the fuel injectors, high-pressure fuel lines and fuel injection
pump. Very tight tolerances are used with these parts. Dirt contamination could cause rapid part
wear and possible plugging of fuel injector nozzle tip holes. This in turn could lead to possible
engine misfire. Always wash/clean any fuel system component thoroughly before disassembly and
then air dry. Cap or cover any open part after disassembly. Before assembly, examine each part
for dirt, grease or other contaminants and clean if necessary. When installing new parts, lubricate
them with clean engine oil or clean diesel fuel only.
If removing fuel line at either No. 1 or No. 2 cylinder, the air inlet housing/EGR valve assembly
must first be removed from the top of the intake manifold.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables from both batteries. Cover and isolate ends of cables.
2. Thoroughly clean fuel lines at both ends.
CAUTION: When loosening or tightening high-pressure lines attached to a separate fitting (11), use
a back-up wrench on fitting (12). Do not allow fittings (12) to rotate. Damage to both fuel line and
fitting will result.
3. If removing fuel line at # 6 cylinder, a bracket (4) is located above fuel line connection at cylinder
head. Two bolts (3) secure this bracket to rear
of cylinder head. The upper bolt hole is slotted. Loosen (but do not remove) these two bracket
bolts. Tilt bracket down to gain access to # 6 fuel line connection.
4. If removing fuel line at either #1 or #2 cylinder, the air inlet housing/EGR assembly must first be
removed from top of intake manifold.
5. Place shop towels around fuel lines at fuel rail and injectors. If possible, do not allow fuel to drip
down side of engine.
6. Carefully remove each fuel line from engine. Note position of each while removing. Do not bend
lines while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6705
Fuel Return Line: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
All high-pressure fuel lines are of the same length and inside diameter. Correct high-pressure fuel
line usage and installation is critical to smooth engine operation.
CAUTION: Anytime a high-pressure line is removed from the engine, its fuel connector nut (12) at
the cylinder head must first be retorqued.
1. Tighten nuts (12) at high pressure injector connector nut at the cylinder head. Torque nut to 50
Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
2. Position proper fuel line to proper injector on engine. Tighten fittings hand tight at both ends of
line.
3. Tighten fuel line at cylinder head. Torque nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
4. Tighten fuel line nuts at fuel rail to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
5. If fuel line at No. 6 cylinder has been replaced, tilt metal bracket (4) upward and tighten two bolts
(3) at rear of cylinder head. Tighten to 43 Nm
(32 ft. lbs.).
6. If necessary, install EGR valve/air intake manifold assembly.
7. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
8. Prime fuel system.
9. Check lines/fittings for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel Supply Line: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Low-Pressure Lines Are:
- the fuel supply line from fuel tank to fuel filter housing.
- the fuel return line back to fuel tank.
- the fuel drain (manifold) line at rear of cylinder head.
- the fuel supply line from fuel filter to fuel injection pump.
- the fuel injection pump return line.
High-Pressure Lines Are:
- the fuel line from fuel injection pump to fuel rail.
- the six fuel lines from fuel rail up to injector connector tubes
WARNING: High-pressure fuel lines deliver diesel fuel under extreme pressure from the injection
pump to the fuel injectors. This may be as high as 180,000 kpa (26,107 psi). Use extreme caution
when inspecting for high-pressure fuel leaks. Inspect for high-pressure fuel leaks with a sheet of
cardboard. High fuel injection pressure can cause personal injury if contact is made with the skin.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6710
Fuel Supply Line: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
High-Pressure Lines
CAUTION: The high-pressure fuel lines must be held securely in the brace. The lines cannot
contact each other or other components. Do not attempt to weld high-pressure fuel lines or to
repair lines that are damaged. If lines are ever kinked or bent, they must be replaced. Use only the
recommended lines when replacement of high-pressure fuel line is necessary.
High-pressure fuel lines deliver fuel (under pressure) of up to approximately 180,000 kPa (26,107
PSI) from the injection pump to the fuel injectors. The lines expand and contract from the
high-pressure fuel pulses generated during the injection process. All high-pressure fuel lines are of
the same length and inside diameter. Correct high-pressure fuel line usage and installation is
critical to smooth engine operation.
WARNING: Use extreme caution when inspecting for high-pressure fuel leaks. Inspect for
high-pressure fuel leaks with a sheet of cardboard. High fuel injection pressure can cause personal
injury if contact is made with the skin.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Cleanliness cannot be overemphasized when handling or replacing diesel fuel system
components. This especially includes the fuel injectors, high-pressure fuel lines and fuel injection
pump. Very tight tolerances are used with these parts. Dirt contamination could cause rapid part
wear and possible plugging of fuel injector nozzle tip holes. This in turn could lead to possible
engine misfire. Always wash/clean any fuel system component thoroughly before disassembly and
then air dry. Cap or cover any open part after disassembly. Before assembly, examine each part
for dirt, grease or other contaminants and clean if necessary. When installing new parts, lubricate
them with clean engine oil or clean diesel fuel only.
If removing fuel line at either No. 1 or No. 2 cylinder, the air inlet housing/EGR valve assembly
must first be removed from the top of the intake manifold.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables from both batteries. Cover and isolate ends of cables.
2. Thoroughly clean fuel lines at both ends.
CAUTION: When loosening or tightening high-pressure lines attached to a separate fitting (11), use
a back-up wrench on fitting (12). Do not allow fittings (12) to rotate. Damage to both fuel line and
fitting will result.
3. If removing fuel line at # 6 cylinder, a bracket (4) is located above fuel line connection at cylinder
head. Two bolts (3) secure this bracket to rear
of cylinder head. The upper bolt hole is slotted. Loosen (but do not remove) these two bracket
bolts. Tilt bracket down to gain access to # 6 fuel line connection.
4. If removing fuel line at either #1 or #2 cylinder, the air inlet housing/EGR assembly must first be
removed from top of intake manifold.
5. Place shop towels around fuel lines at fuel rail and injectors. If possible, do not allow fuel to drip
down side of engine.
6. Carefully remove each fuel line from engine. Note position of each while removing. Do not bend
lines while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6713
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
All high-pressure fuel lines are of the same length and inside diameter. Correct high-pressure fuel
line usage and installation is critical to smooth engine operation.
CAUTION: Anytime a high-pressure line is removed from the engine, its fuel connector nut (12) at
the cylinder head must first be retorqued.
1. Tighten nuts (12) at high pressure injector connector nut at the cylinder head. Torque nut to 50
Nm (37 ft. lbs.).
2. Position proper fuel line to proper injector on engine. Tighten fittings hand tight at both ends of
line.
3. Tighten fuel line at cylinder head. Torque nut to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
4. Tighten fuel line nuts at fuel rail to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.).
5. If fuel line at No. 6 cylinder has been replaced, tilt metal bracket (4) upward and tighten two bolts
(3) at rear of cylinder head. Tighten to 43 Nm
(32 ft. lbs.).
6. If necessary, install EGR valve/air intake manifold assembly.
7. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
8. Prime fuel system.
9. Check lines/fittings for leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6719
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6720
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6721
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6722
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6723
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6724
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6725
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6726
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6727
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6728
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6729
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6730
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6731
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6732
Fuel Gauge Sender: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6733
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6734
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6735
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6736
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6737
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6740
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Shield >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Tank Shield: > NHTSA07V247000 > Jun > 07 >
Recall 07V247000: Fuel Tank Shield Installation
Fuel Tank Shield: Recalls Recall 07V247000: Fuel Tank Shield Installation
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Dodge/RAM 2500 2007 MANUFACTURER:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 07V247000 MFR'S REPORT
DATE: June 05, 2007
COMPONENT: Fuel System, Gasoline:Storage
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 5062
SUMMARY: Certain pickup trucks equipped with 34 gallon fuel tanks fail to comply with the
requirements of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 301, "Fuel System Integrity." The fuel
tank may become damaged during certain crash conditions, which could allow fuel leakage to
occur if the vehicle rolls over.
CONSEQUENCE: Fuel leakage, in the presence of an ignition source, could result in a fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will install a fuel tank shield onto the front frame cross member. The recall
began on June 12, 2007. Owners may contact DaimlerChrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: DaimlerChrysler Recall No. G16. Customers may also contact The National Highway
Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or
go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Shield >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Tank Shield: >
NHTSA07V247000 > Jun > 07 > Recall 07V247000: Fuel Tank Shield Installation
Fuel Tank Shield: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 07V247000: Fuel Tank Shield Installation
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Dodge/RAM 2500 2007 MANUFACTURER:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 07V247000 MFR'S REPORT
DATE: June 05, 2007
COMPONENT: Fuel System, Gasoline:Storage
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 5062
SUMMARY: Certain pickup trucks equipped with 34 gallon fuel tanks fail to comply with the
requirements of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 301, "Fuel System Integrity." The fuel
tank may become damaged during certain crash conditions, which could allow fuel leakage to
occur if the vehicle rolls over.
CONSEQUENCE: Fuel leakage, in the presence of an ignition source, could result in a fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will install a fuel tank shield onto the front frame cross member. The recall
began on June 12, 2007. Owners may contact DaimlerChrysler at 1-800-853-1403.
NOTES: DaimlerChrysler Recall No. G16. Customers may also contact The National Highway
Traffic Safety Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or
go to http://www.safercar.gov.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit
Fuel Tank Vent: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit
Retrofit
NUMBER: 14-004-11
GROUP: Fuel System
DATE: April 01, 2011
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 14-002-10, DATED
FEBRUARY 11, 2010, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS
ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE NEW PARTS.
SUBJECT: Heavy Duty Filtration MOPAR Retrofit or Add On Parts Available
MODELS:
2003 - 2009 (D1/DH/DR) Ram Truck (2500/3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to D1/DH/DR vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins engine built from 2003
model year (sales codes ETH, ETC) and DC/DH/D1/vehicles equipped with a 6.7L Cummins
engine built from 2007 model year (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Several fuel system add-on or retrofit parts are available to enhance the filtering capability for
customers exposing their vehicles to extremely dirty conditions.
Description of parts available for Cummins diesel equipped vehicles are listed below:
^ **Severe duty, frame mounted fuel filter** (application for 2004.5 - 2009 Pickup & 2007 - 2010
Cab Chassis DC).
^ 6.7L up-graded (5 & 10 micron filter-in-filter) fuel filter to retrofit earlier models (shell and element).
^ 6.7L Element only, fuel filter.
^ 5.9L & 6.7L Add-on or up-graded fuel tank vent hose kit with vent cap.
^ Filter for fuel tank vent hose, (replaces vent cap).
^ 5.9L up-graded air filter. This filter is similar in design to the current 6.7L air filter.
NOTE:
Do not sell p/n 05183410AA fuel filter for (bottom load style) 6.7L engines. Use 68061633AA shell
and filter.
NOTE:
The maintenance intervals for the fuel filter(s) is 15,000 miles, 400 engine hours or 12 Months,
(whichever occurs first) or more often as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Tank Vent >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Heavy Duty MOPAR Filtration Kit Retrofit > Page
6758
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components:
- An electric fuel transfer (lift) pump
- Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- A special lockring to retain module to fuel tank
- Fuel return line connection.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Tank Unit: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank.
2. Note rotational position of module before attempting removal. An indexing arrow is located on
top of module for this purpose.
3. Position Special Tool 9340 (3) into notches on outside edge of lockring (5).
4. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker bar (1) to tool 9340 (3).
5. Rotate breaker bar counterclockwise to remove lockring.
6. Remove lockring. The module will spring up slightly when lockring is removed.
7. Remove module from fuel tank. Be careful not to bend float arm while removing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6764
Fuel Tank Unit: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel pump module is serviced, the rubber seal (gasket) must be replaced.
1. Using a new seal (gasket), position fuel pump module into opening in fuel tank.
2. Position lockring (5) over top of fuel pump module.
3. Rotate module until embossed alignment arrow points to center alignment mark. This step must
be performed to prevent float from contacting side
of fuel tank. Also be sure fuel fitting on top of pump module is pointed to drivers side of vehicle.
4. Install Special Tool 9340 (3) to lockring.
5. Install 1/2 inch drive breaker (1) into Special Tool 9340 (3).
6. Tighten lockring (clockwise) until all seven notches have engaged.
7. Install fuel tank.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel/Water Separator: Locations
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fuel/Water Separator: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above the starter motor.
The assembly also includes the fuel heater, water drain valve, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor and a
quick-connect fittings attached at the side of the fuel filter canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6770
Fuel/Water Separator: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the filter.
Refer to the maintenance schedules for the recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel/Water Separator Removal.
There is a screened quick-connect fitting that is attached at the side of the fuel filter canister. It
provides additional filtering for the high pressure fuel system components.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to the bottom of fuel filter element.
The fuel heater is installed into the side of the filter/separator housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel/Water Separator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
Draining water from fuel filter canister:
The housing drain valve (3) serves two purposes. One is to partially drain the filter housing of
excess water. The other is to partially drain the housing for fuel filter or heater element
replacement.
The filter housing (1) should be partially drained whenever the water-in-fuel warning lamp remains
illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when ignition key is
initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
1. A drain hose (4) is located at the bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose.
2. With engine not running, rotate drain valve (3) approximately two revolutions to open it. Leave
open until all water and contaminants have been
removed and clean fuel exits. Hand tighten drain valve after tightening.
3. If fuel heater element is being replaced, drain housing completely. Dispose of mixture in drain
pan according to applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, close and tighten drain valve (3).
5. Fuel Filter Replacement:
a. Remove left front tire/wheel. b. Remove left front wheel splash shield. c. Clean all debris from
around filter canister (1) and canister head. d. Disconnect WIF sensor electrical connector (5). e.
Open drain valve (3) two complete revolutions. Drain approximately 1 cup of fuel into a waste
canister. Dispose of fuel according to
environmental regulations.
f. Remove drain hose (4) from drain valve (3).
g. Use an oil filter type wrench to loosen filter (1). Continue removing filter by hand.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6773
6. After fuel filter removal, also check and clean secondary filter screen. Press button (2) on
quick-connect fitting. Disconnect fitting (1) from fitting
(3). Unscrew fitting (3) from canister head to expose screen.
7. Clean screen (5) and check condition of O-ring (6).
8. Water-In-Fuel (WIF) Sensor Replacement: The WIF sensor (2) is located on the bottom of the
fuel filter housing.
The WIF sensor is not a separately serviceable item. If diagnostics have led you to replace this
sensor, then the whole fuel filter assembly (1) needs to be changed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6774
9. Fuel Heater Element Replacement: The heater element (2) is located in the fuel filter housing
(4).
a. Drain fuel filter. See previous steps. b. Disconnect electrical connector (1). c. Remove two
mounting screws (3). d. Remove fuel heater (2).
10. Check condition of fuel heater O-ring (2).
11. Drain Valve Replacement: The Drain Valve is located on the bottom of the fuel filter. This is not
a separately serviceable item. If replacement is
necessary, replace the entire filter/filter canister assembly.
12. Fuel Filter Head (Housing) Replacement:
a. If equipped, remove transmission dipstick tube from filter housing. b. Remove all low-pressure
fuel lines at filter housing c. Remove housing from cylinder head.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6775
Fuel/Water Separator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Refer to maintenance schedules for recommended fuel filter replacement intervals.
1. Fuel Filter:
CAUTION: Do not pre-fill the fuel filter with fuel. Severe damage to fuel system and injection
system components may result.
a. The engine has a self-priming low-pressure fuel system. b. Lubricate new fuel filter O-ring with
clean engine oil. c. Position new fuel filter/canister assembly (1) to housing.
d. Rotate fuel filter/canister assembly (1) until it comes to a hard stop.
e. Tighten the filter element an additional half-inch of rotation. f.
Connect WIF sensor electrical connector (5).
g. Attach drain hose (4) to drain valve (3). h. Install left front tire/wheel. i.
Install left front wheel splash shield.
2. Clean screen (5).
3. Check condition of new O-ring (6) and lubricate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6776
4. Install screen assembly into housing and tighten fitting (3) to 20 ft. lbs. (27 Nm).
5. Connect quick connect fuel supply line (1) to fitting (3).
6. Fuel Heater Element:
a. Check condition of O-ring (2). b. Lubricate new element O-ring before installation.
7. Install fuel heater element (3) into fuel filter housing (4).
8. Install two fuel heater mounting screws (3) and tighten to 60 in lbs. (6.8 Nm).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel/Water Separator >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6777
9. Connect electrical connector (1).
10. Fuel Filter Head (Housing):
a. Install fuel filter head to cylinder head. Tighten bolts to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.) torque. b. Replace
sealing washers on banjo bolts and install all low-pressure fuel lines to filter housing. Tighten banjo
bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Tighten quick-connect fitting to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) torque.
c. If equipped, install transmission dipstick tube to filter housing. Tighten bolt to 10 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6781
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6782
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6783
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Heater Relay: Locations
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6788
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6789
Intake Air Heater Relay: Diagrams
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6790
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6791
Intake Air Heater Relay: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Engine Control Module (ECM) operates the heating element through the intake manifold air
heater relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Disconnect relay trigger wires (4) at relays. Note position of wiring before removing.
3. Remove nuts (2) at cable connectors and disconnect cables (1) from mounting studs. Note
position of cables before removing.
4. Remove two relay mounting bracket screws (6) and remove relay assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater > Intake Air
Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6794
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Position relay and install two relay mounting bracket screws (6).
2. Position cables (1) to mounting studs and install nuts (2).
3. Connect relay trigger wires (4) at relays.
4. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6798
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6799
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6800
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6801
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6802
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6807
8w-30-17
Connector C1 pin 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6810
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6811
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6812
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6813
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6814
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6815
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6816
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6817
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6818
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6819
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6820
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6821
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6822
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6823
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6824
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6825
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6826
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6827
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 6828
Fuel Pump Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 6829
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
The fuel transfer pump (fuel lift pump) is part of the fuel pump module. The fuel pump module is
located in the fuel tank. The 12-volt electric pump is operated and controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM). The ECM controls a relay in the intelligent Power Module (IPM) for transfer pump
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations
Intake Air Heater Relay: Locations
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6833
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6834
Intake Air Heater Relay: Diagrams
Component ID: 240
Component : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-INTAKE AIR HEATER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10DG
30 FUSED B(+) A19 10RD/YL
85 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL K174 18BR/YL
86 GROUND Z174 18BK
86 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY CONTROL RETURN K974 18BR/BK
87 INTAKE AIR HEATER RELAY OUTPUT A58 4BK
Component Location - 4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6835
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 6836
Intake Air Heater Relay: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Engine Control Module (ECM) operates the heating element through the intake manifold air
heater relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
2. Disconnect relay trigger wires (4) at relays. Note position of wiring before removing.
3. Remove nuts (2) at cable connectors and disconnect cables (1) from mounting studs. Note
position of cables before removing.
4. Remove two relay mounting bracket screws (6) and remove relay assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
6839
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The intake manifold air heater relay (5) is located in the engine compartment. It attached to a
bracket. This bracket is attached to the right battery tray (3).
The mounting bracket and relay is replaced as an assembly.
1. Position relay and install two relay mounting bracket screws (6).
2. Position cables (1) to mounting studs and install nuts (2).
3. Connect relay trigger wires (4) at relays.
4. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6843
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6844
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Diagrams
Component ID: 241
Component : RELAY-SMART POWER
Connector:
Name : RELAY-SMART POWER
Color : # of pins :
5
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
2 FUSED B(+) A118 18RD/OR
3-4 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
5 SMART POWER RELAY RETURN K348 18BR
Component Location - 33
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6845
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6846
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Fig.1 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 1
Fig.2 ASD And Fuel Pump Relay Terminals-Type 2
The following description of operation and tests apply only to the Automatic Shutdown (ASD) and
fuel pump relays. The terminals on the bottom of each relay are numbered. Two different types of
relays may be used, or.
- Terminal number 30 is connected to battery voltage. For both the ASD and fuel pump relays,
terminal 30 is connected to battery voltage at all times.
- The PCM grounds the coil side of the relay through terminal number 85.
- Terminal number 86 supplies voltage to the coil side of the relay.
- When the PCM de-energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal number 87A connects to
terminal 30. This is the OFF position. In the OFF position, voltage is not supplied to the rest of the
circuit. Terminal 87A is the center terminal on the relay.
- When the PCM energizes the ASD and fuel pump relays, terminal 87 connects to terminal 30.
This is the ON position. Terminal 87 supplies voltage to the rest of the circuit.
The following procedure applies to the ASD and fuel pump relays.
1. Remove relay from connector before testing. 2. With the relay removed from the vehicle, use an
ohmmeter to check the resistance between terminals 85 and 86. The resistance should be 75
ohms
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 6847
± 5 ohms.
3. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 30 and 87A. The ohmmeter should show continuity
between terminals 30 and 87A. 4. Connect the ohmmeter between terminals 87 and 30. The
ohmmeter should not show continuity at this time. 5. Connect one end of a jumper wire (16 gauge
or smaller) to relay terminal 85. Connect the other end of the jumper wire to the ground side of a 12
volt power source.
6. Connect one end of another jumper wire (16 gauge or smaller) to the power side of the 12 volt
power source. Do not attach the other end of the
jumper wire to the relay at this time.
WARNING: DO NOT ALLOW OHMMETER TO CONTACT TERMINALS 85 OR 86 DURING THIS
TEST. DAMAGE TO OHMMETER MAY RESULT.
7. Attach the other end of the jumper wire to relay terminal 86. This activates the relay. The
ohmmeter should now show continuity between relay
terminals 87 and 30. The ohmmeter should not show continuity between relay terminals 87A and
30.
8. Disconnect jumper wires. 9. Replace the relay if it did not pass the continuity and resistance
tests. If the relay passed the tests, it operates properly. Check the remainder of the
ASD and fuel pump relay circuits.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6852
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6853
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 386
Component : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K852 20BR/VT
2 APPS NO. 1 SIGNAL K23 20BR/WT
3 APPS NO. 1 RETURN K167 20BR/YL
4 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 20BR/VT
5 APPS NO. 2 SIGNAL K29 20WT/BR
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
6 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 20VT/BR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6854
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) (1) is located inside the vehicle. It is attached to the
accelerator pedal assembly (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 6857
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) provides the Engine Control Module (ECM) with
two DC voltage signals which change as the position of the accelerator pedal changes. One of the
DC voltage signals will be half the voltage of the other signal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Disconnect 6-way electrical connector at top of APPS (2).
2. Remove APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
3. Remove pedal and APPS assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 6860
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Do not attempt to separate or remove the Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS)
from the accelerator pedal assembly. The APPS is replaced as an assembly along with the pedal.
If sensor is removed from pedal, its electronic calibration may be destroyed.
1. Position pedal and APPS assembly to its mounting bracket.
2. Connect 6-way electrical connector to top of APPS (2).
3. Install APPS lower mounting bolt (4) and two mounting nuts.
4. If necessary, use a Scan Tool to erase any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6864
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6865
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 412
Component : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-MASS AIR FLOW
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MASS AIR FLOW SENSOR SIGNAL K157 18BR/OR
2 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
3 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
4-Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6866
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6867
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor is a frequency based device. A constant voltage is applied to a
heated wire on the sensor. This wire is positioned in the air cleaner air stream and is heated by the
electrical current that the voltage produces. As air flows across it, it cools down. The heated wire or
film is a positive temperature coefficient resistor. This means that its resistance drops when its
temperature drops. The drop in resistance allows more current to flow through it in order to
maintain the programmed temperature. This current is changed to a frequency which is sent to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) and interpreted as air flow. Adjustments for air temperature and
humidity are taken into consideration because they also affect the temperature of the heated wire
or film.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The Mass Airflow Sensor (5) is located on the air cleaner cover (8).
1. Disconnect electrical connector (6) at sensor.
2. Remove two mounting screws (4).
3. Remove sensor from air cleaner cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6870
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Position sensor into top of air cleaner cover with a slight twisting action.
3. Install mounting screw (4).
4. Install electrical connector (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail
Pressure
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Rail Pressure
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail
Pressure > Page 6875
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail
Pressure > Page 6876
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Fuel Rail
Pressure > Page 6877
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Fuel Pressure
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6878
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 404
Component : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-FUEL RAIL PRESSURE
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FUEL RAIL SENSOR RETURN K915 18BR/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
2 FUEL RAIL SENSOR SIGNAL K181 18BR/YL
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
Component Location - 18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6879
Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6880
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6881
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The fuel pressure sensor monitors actual high-pressure within the fuel rail. An output signal from
this sensor (relating to fuel pressure) is sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The fuel pressure sensor (1) is mounted to the rear of the fuel rail (6).
1. Remove two bolts (3) and bracket (4) at rear of cylinder head.
2. Remove engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 6884
3. Disconnect electrical connector (2) at sensor.
4. Remove sensor (1) from fuel rail.
5. Inspect sensor sealing surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 6885
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect fuel pressure sensor sealing surface.
2. Lubricate sensor threads with clean diesel fuel.
3. Install sensor (1) into fuel rail.
4. To prevent leaks, sensor must be tightened to 70 Nm (52 ft. lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
6. Install rear engine lift bracket (4) and bolts (3). Tighten to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.).
7. Install engine oil dipstick tube mounting bolts.
8. Start engine and check for fuel leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations
High Idle Switch: Locations
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6889
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6890
High Idle Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 210
Component : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Connector:
Name : MODULE-REMOTE THROTTLE PROVISION
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (6.7L DIESEL)
Gender : FEMALE
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K854 18VT/BR
2 APPS NO. 2 RETURN K400 18BR/VT
3 REMOTE THROTTLE SIGNAL K128 18DB/LG
4 REMOTE THROTTLE SWITCH SIGNAL K129 18DB/DG
5 MAXIMUM OPERATING SPEED SWITCH SIGNAL K119 18LG/BK
6 ACCELERATOR INTERLOCK SWITCH SIGNAL K810 18VT/DG
7 REMOTE POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH RELAY SIGNAL F425 18PK
8 S/C SWITCH RETURN V937 18VT/BR
9 IN CAB POWER TAKEOFF SWITCH INPUT K425 18OR/BR
10 - Component Location - 14
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > High Idle Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6891
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models > Page 6896
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6897
Turbo Boost Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6900
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6901
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbo Boost Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6902
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Turbocharger Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove
turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt (1). 4. Remove turbocharger speed sensor (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install turbocharger speed sensor. 2. Install turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt. 3. Tighten
bolt to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6906
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6907
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6908
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations
Throttle Body: Locations
Component ID: 495
Component : THROTTLE BODY
Connector:
Name : THROTTLE BODY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
3 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
4 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
5 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
6 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6912
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6913
Component Location - 10
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6914
Connector:
Name : THROTTLE BODY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
3 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
4 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6915
5 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
6 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6916
Component Location - 10
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6917
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6918
Throttle Body: Diagrams
Component ID: 495
Component : THROTTLE BODY
Connector:
Name : THROTTLE BODY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
3 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
4 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
5 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
6 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
Component Location - 8
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6919
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6920
Component Location - 10
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6921
Connector:
Name : THROTTLE BODY
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 6
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TP NO. 1 SIGNAL K22 20BR/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
3 ETC MOTOR (+) K447 20TN/YL
4 TP NO. 2 SIGNAL K122 20BR/DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6922
5 ETC MOTOR (-) K448 20TN/OR
6 TP SENSOR RETURN K922 20BR/DB
Component Location - 8
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6923
Component Location - 10
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6924
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Intercooler: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The charge air system consists of the charge air cooler piping, charge air cooler and intake air grid
heater.
The Charge Air Cooler is a heat exchanger that uses air flow from vehicle motion to dissipate heat
from the intake air. As the turbocharger increases air pressure, the air temperature increases.
Lowering the intake air temperature increases engine efficiency and power.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6930
Intercooler: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Intake air is drawn through the air cleaner and into the turbocharger compressor housing.
Pressurized air from the turbocharger then flows forward through the charge air cooler located in
front of the radiator. From the charge air cooler the air flows back into the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6931
Intercooler: Testing and Inspection
CHARGE AIR COOLER SYSTEM - LEAKS
Low turbocharger boost pressure and low engine performance can be caused by leaks in the
charge air cooler or plumbing. Fuel staining on the exhaust manifold can also be an indication that
there are leaks in the air system. The following procedure outlines how to check for leaks in the
charge air cooler system.
This procedure can also be used to check for leaks in the wastegate signal line or the wastegate
canister.
1. Loosen clamp and remove air inlet hose from turbocharger. 2. Insert Special Tool 9022 Adapter
and tool 9860 into the turbocharger inlet. Tighten tool clamp to 8 Nm (72 in. lbs.).
CAUTION: Do not apply more than 138 kPa (20 psi) air pressure to the charge air cooler system,
severe damage to the charge air cooler system may occur.
3. Connect a regulated air supply to air fitting on Tool 9022 Adapter. Set air pressure to a Maximum
of 138 kPa (20 psi). 4. Using soapy water check the rubber sleeves, charge air cooler and intake
manifold for leaks. 5. Using soapy water check for leaks at the wastegate signal line, wastegate
canister and wastegate command valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Intercooler: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
WARNING: IF THE ENGINE WAS JUST TURNED OFF, THE AIR INTAKE SYSTEM TUBES MAY
BE HOT.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Discharge the A/C system. 3. Remove the
transmission auxiliary cooler. 4. Remove intake air tubing from the charge air cooler. 5. Remove
the charge air cooler bolts. Pivot the charge air cooler forward and up to remove.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6934
Intercooler: Service and Repair Cleaning
CLEANING
CAUTION: Do not use caustic or acid based cleaners to clean the charge air cooler. Damage to the
charge air cooler will result.
NOTE: If internal debris cannot be removed from the cooler, the charge air cooler MUST be
replaced.
NOTE: Charge air cooler must be a room temperature for this procedure.
1. If the engine experiences a turbocharger failure or any other situation where oil or debris get into
the charge air cooler, the charge air cooler must
be cleaned internally.
2. Remove charge air cooler. 3. Position the charge air cooler so the inlet and outlet tubes are
vertical. 4. Flush the cooler internally with solvent such as mineral spirits in the direction opposite of
normal air flow. 5. Shake the cooler and lightly tap on the end tanks with a rubber mallet to dislodge
trapped debris. 6. Continue flushing until all debris or oil are removed. 7. Rinse the cooler with hot
soapy water to remove any remaining solvent. 8. Rinse thoroughly with clean water and blow dry
with compressed air.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6935
Intercooler: Service and Repair Inspection
INSPECTION
Visually inspect the charge air cooler for cracks, holes, or damage. Inspect the tubes, fins, and
welds for tears, breaks, or other damage. Replace the charge air cooler if damage is found.
Pressure test the charge air cooler, using Charge Air Cooler Tester Kit No. 3824556. This kit is
available through Cummins(R) Service Products. Instructions are provided with the kit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Intercooler >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6936
Intercooler: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the charge air cooler. Install the bolts and tighten to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.) torque.
2. Install the air intake system tubes to the charge air cooler. With the clamps in position, tighten
the clamps to 11 Nm (95 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Install the transmission auxiliary cooler (if equipped). 4.
Install the A/C condenser (if A/C equipped). 5. Connect the battery negative cables. 6. Start engine
and check for boost system leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Pick Up Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Pick Up Models > Page 6941
Turbo Boost Sensor: Locations Cab/Chassis Models
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6942
Turbo Boost Sensor: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP Sensor is installed
into the top of the intake manifold with the sensor element extending into the air stream.
The IAT portion of the sensor provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
indicating intake manifold air temperature. The MAP portion of the sensor provides an input voltage
to the ECM indicating turbocharger boost pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP
Removal-Cab/Chassis Models
REMOVAL-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (4) sensor
is installed into the top of the intake manifold.
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (3) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (5).
4. Remove sensor from intake manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Removal-Pick Up Models
REMOVAL-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6945
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Clean area around sensor.
2. Disconnect electrical connector (2) from IAT/MAP sensor.
3. Remove mounting screw (4).
4. Remove sensor from manifold.
5. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Installation-Cab/Chassis Models
INSTALLATION-CAB/CHASSIS MODELS
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold cover with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (4) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (5) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (3) to sensor.
Installation-Pick Up Models
INSTALLATION-PICK UP MODELS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6946
The combination, dual function Intake Manifold Air Temperature Sensor/MAP (IAT/MAP) (3) sensor
is installed into the intake air connection manifold, below, and to the rear of the EGR valve (5).
1. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
2. Clean sensor mounting area at intake manifold.
3. Lubricate sensor O-ring and sensor mounting hole in intake manifold with clean engine oil.
4. Position sensor (3) into intake manifold.
5. Install and tighten sensor mounting screw (4) to 1 Nm (9 in. lbs.) torque.
6. Connect electrical connector (2) to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbo Boost
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Temperature/Pressure-MAP > Page 6947
Turbo Boost Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Turbocharger Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove
turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt (1). 4. Remove turbocharger speed sensor (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install turbocharger speed sensor. 2. Install turbocharger speed sensor mounting bolt. 3. Tighten
bolt to 10 Nm (89 in. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6951
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6952
Turbocharger Speed Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 432
Component : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TURBO SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TURBO SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL K540 18BR/GY
2 TURBO SPEED SENSOR GROUND K541 18BR/VT
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6953
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Vane Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Turbocharger Vane Actuator: Locations
Component ID: 3
Component : ACTUATOR-ELECTRONIC TURBO
Connector:
Name : ACTUATOR-ELECTRONIC TURBO
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
2 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
3 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
4 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Vane Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 6957
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Vane Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 6958
Turbocharger Vane Actuator: Diagrams
Component ID: 3
Component : ACTUATOR-ELECTRONIC TURBO
Connector:
Name : ACTUATOR-ELECTRONIC TURBO
Color : # of pins :
4
Qualifier : (6.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SMART POWER RELAY FEED F348 16PK/OR
2 ACTUATOR GROUND K972 18DB/TN
3 ACTUATOR HIGH DATA LINK D130 18BR/VT
4 ACTUATOR LOW DATA LINK D131 18WT/LG
Component Location - 16
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Turbocharger
Vane Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 6959
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Wastegate Actuator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION - 6.7L
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED ACTUATOR
The Electronically Controlled Actuator is mounted to the turbocharger bearing housing. The
actuator consists of an integrated controller and a gear train that controls the position of the sliding
nozzle ring. The actuator uses a signal from the Engine Control Module (ECM) to control the
relationship between the sliding nozzle ring and turbine blades.
Moving the nozzle ring rearward or forward redirects the exhaust flow so that the turbine wheel
spins faster or slower as needed
- If the sliding nozzle is moved rearward, the turbocharger builds more pressure (turbine wheel
moves faster)
- If the sliding nozzle is moved forward, the turbocharger builds less pressure (turbine wheel moves
slower)
VGT EXHAUST BRAKE
The VGT Exhaust Brake works in conjunction with the engine and transmission to provide an
integrated braking system to help slow the vehicle. This is commonly referred to as exhaust
braking. Braking power is achieved by modulating the sliding nozzle ring to restrict the flow of
exhaust gasses from the engine, this will create high back pressure on the engine. The high back
pressure creates a high level of resistance to the motion of the pistons within the engine and this
resistance is used to reduce engine speed and thus vehicle.
The exhaust brake feature will only function when the Exhaust Brake Switch to the ON position.
With the switch in the ON Position and the vehicle moving faster then 5 MPH; the exhaust brake
will automatically operate when pressure is removed from the accelerator pedal allowing the ECM
to see 0% throttle and 0% fuel delivery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Wastegate Actuator: Service and Repair Removal
6.7L DIESEL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables. 2. Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Drain cooling system. 4.
Remove air filter housing. 5. Disconnect turbocharger actuator electrical connector (1). 6. Remove
turbocharger actuator mounting bolts (3). 7. Remove turbocharger actuator (2). 8. Clean mounting
surface.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 6965
Wastegate Actuator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean turbocharger actuator housing and turbocharger mounting surfaces. 2. Position
turbocharger actuator in engine compartment so gear will be free to rotate. 3. Connect
turbocharger actuator electrical connector. 4. Connect negative battery cable. 5. Using a scan tool,
perform TURBO ACTUATOR PRE-ALIGN.
NOTE: Do not turn key OFF after performing TURBO ACTUATOR PRE-ALIGN procedure. This
holds the actuator gear in position for installation.
CAUTION: Use only turbocharger actuator grease. Use of any other type of grease or too much
grease may result in damage to turbocharger.
6. Apply grease to turbocharger actuator sector gear in a line across center of all teeth. 7. Install
O-ring on turbocharger actuator. 8. Install guide pins on turbocharger. 9. Rotate turbocharger
sector gear clockwise and insert small end of turbocharger actuator alignment tool (supplied with
new actuator) or 3.175 mm
(1/8 in.) drill, through sector gear until it engages the alignment hole in turbocharger bearing
housing and sector gear will not rotate. If alignment pin does not engage hole in turbocharger
bearing housing, variable geometry mechanism is not opening completely.
10. Remove pin from turbocharger actuator sector gear. Turbocharger actuator sector gear must
stay in this position, rotated fully clockwise while
installing actuator.
11. Position turbocharger actuator on guide pins and install. 12. Install two mounting screws. Hand
tighten only. 13. Remove guide pins. Install remaining two mounting screws. Tighten mounting
screws in a cross pattern to 11 Nm (96 in. lbs.). 14. Using scan tool, perform TURBO ACTUATOR
SELF CALIBRATE procedure.
NOTE: If the TURBO ACTUATOR SELF CALIBRATE procedure fails, remove actuator and repeat
installation one additional time. If this fails to clear error, replace turbocharger.
15. Place ignition in the OFF position. 16. Install air filter housing. 17. Fill cooling system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Wastegate Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 448
Component : SOLENOID-WASTEGATE
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-WASTEGATE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
A WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
B FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6969
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6970
Wastegate Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 448
Component : SOLENOID-WASTEGATE
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-WASTEGATE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
A WASTEGATE SOLENOID CONTROL K139 18DB
B FUSED B(+) A212 18PK/YL
Component Location - 12
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Turbocharger > Wastegate
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 6971
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
DESCRIPTION
The cylinder block is constructed of cast iron. The casting is a skirted design which incorporates
longitudal ribs for superior strength and noise reduction. The block incorporates metric straight
thread o-ring fittings at lubrication oil access points. The engine is manufactured with the cylinders
being a non-sleeved type cylinder.
The cylinders are numbered front to rear ; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > System Information >
Specifications
Ignition Timing: Specifications
IGNITION TIMING
Ignition timing is not adjustable on any engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6982
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6983
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6984
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6985
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6986
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6987
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6988
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6989
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6990
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6991
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6992
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6993
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6994
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 6997
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7000
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Condenser: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
One coil capacitor (1) is used. It is located in the right-rear section of the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 7005
Condenser: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The coil capacitor(s) help dampen the amount of conducted electrical noise to the camshaft
position sensor, crankshaft position sensor, and throttle position sensor. This noise is generated on
the 12V supply wire to the ignition coils and fuel injectors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Condenser: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The coil capacitor is located in the right-rear section of the engine compartment. It is attached with
a mounting stud and nut.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at capacitor.
2. Remove mounting nut and remove ground strap.
3. Remove capacitor (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Condenser, Ignition > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7008
Condenser: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position capacitor (1) to mounting stud (2).
2. Position ground strap (3) to mounting stud (2).
3. Tighten nut (4) to 7 Nm (60 in. lbs.) torque.
4. Connect electrical connector (5) to coil capacitor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7012
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7013
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7014
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7015
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7016
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7017
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7018
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7019
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7020
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7021
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7022
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7023
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7024
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7025
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7026
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7027
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7028
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7029
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7030
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7031
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7032
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7033
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7034
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7035
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7036
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7037
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7038
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7039
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7040
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7041
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7042
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7043
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7044
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7047
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7050
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 7055
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7060
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7061
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7062
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7063
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7064
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7065
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7066
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 390
Component : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : # of pins :
3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 18PK/YL
2 CMP SENSOR GROUND K944 18BK/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K916 18BR/OR
3 CMP SIGNAL K44 18DB/GY
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7067
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7068
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7069
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CAMSHAFT POSITION
Color : GRAY
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (GAS)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CMP SIGNAL K44 20DB/GY
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7070
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7071
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7072
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is bolted to the
back of the timing gear cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7075
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) (1) contains a hall effect device. A rotating target wheel
(tonewheel) for the CMP is located on the front timing gear. This hall effect device detects notches
located on the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CMP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs:
The interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CMP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The CMP provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM) at all times when the engine is
running. The ECM uses the CMP information primarily on engine start-up. Once the engine is
running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed. The Crankshaft Position
Sensor (CKP) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after the engine is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) on the diesel engine is located below the fuel injection pump
(1). It is bolted to the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Disconnect electrical connector (5) at CMP sensor.
2. Remove sensor mounting bolt (6).
3. Carefully twist sensor from timing gear cover.
4. Check condition of sensor O-ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7078
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
5.9L/6.7L DIESEL
The CMP (1) is located on the back of the timing gear cover.
1. Clean out machined hole in back of timing gear cover.
2. Apply a small amount of engine oil to sensor O-ring.
3. Install sensor into timing gear cover with a slight rocking action. Do not twist sensor into position
as damage to O-ring may result.
CAUTION: Before tightening sensor mounting bolt, be sure sensor is completely flush to back of
timing chain cover. If sensor is not flush, damage to sensor mounting tang may result.
4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 12 Nm (106 in.lbs.).
5. Connect electrical connector to sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7082
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7083
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7084
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7085
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7086
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7087
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7088
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7089
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7090
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7091
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7092
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7093
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7094
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7095
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7096
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7097
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7098
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagrams
Component ID: 392
Component : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (3.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Component Location - 5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7099
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7100
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7101
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7102
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (4.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7103
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7104
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7105
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7106
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (5.7L)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY F855 20PK/YL
2 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 20BR/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7107
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7108
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7109
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7110
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-CRANKSHAFT POSITION
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 3
Qualifier : (DIESEL)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K853 18DB/BR
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY K824 18DB/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7111
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K975 18BR/OR
2 CKP SENSOR GROUND K925 18BR/OR
3 CKP SIGNAL K24 18BR/LB
Component Location - 5
Component Location - 11
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7112
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7113
Component Location - 13
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7114
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) on the diesel engine is attached at the front / left side of the
engine next to the engine harmonic balancer (crankshaft damper).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7117
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) (5) is the primary engine speed indicator for the engine after
the engine is running.
The CKP contains a hall effect device. A rotating, notched target wheel (tonewheel) (3) for the CKP
is attached to the engine harmonic balancer (2). This hall effect device detects notches located on
the tonewheel. As the tonewheel rotates, the notches pass the tip of the CKP.
When the leading edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
interruption of magnetic field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of
approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the tonewheel notch passes the tip of the CKP, the following occurs: The
change of the magnetic field causes the signal voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) also provides a signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM)
at all times when the engine is running. The ECM uses this CMP information primarily on engine
start-up. Once the engine is running, the ECM uses the CMP as a backup sensor for engine speed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle
2. Disconnect electrical connector (4) at CKP sensor.
3. Remove 1 sensor mounting bolt (3).
4. Remove CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7120
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position and install CKP sensor (5) to engine.
2. Install 1 sensor mounting bolt and tighten to 9 Nm (80 in. lbs.) torque.
3. Install electrical connector (4) to CKP sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (1) for cylinder removal.
1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from
steering column. 3. Place shifter in PARK position. 4. A retaining pin is located at the underside of
the key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder (1) from
ignition switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7126
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder (3) for cylinder installation.
1. Install the key cylinder into the housing using care to align the end of the key cylinder (3) with the
ignition switch (1). 2. Push the key cylinder (3) in until it clicks. 3. Replace the upper and lower
shrouds. 4. Reconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Two knock sensors are bolted into the cylinder block under the intake manifold 3.7L, 4.7L & 8.3L.
Two knock sensors are also used with the 5.7L. These are bolted into each side of the cylinder
block (outside) under the exhaust manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7131
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Two knock sensors are used; one for each cylinder bank. When the knock sensor detects a knock
in one of the cylinders on the corresponding bank, it sends an input signal to the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM). In response, the PCM retards ignition timing for all cylinders by a scheduled
amount.
Knock sensors contain a piezoelectric material which constantly vibrates and sends an input
voltage (signal) to the PCM while the engine operates. As the intensity of the crystal's vibration
increases, the knock sensor output voltage also increases.
The voltage signal produced by the knock sensor increases with the amplitude of vibration. The
PCM receives the knock sensor voltage signal as an input. If the signal rises above a
predetermined level, the PCM will store that value in memory and retard ignition timing to reduce
engine knock. If the knock sensor voltage exceeds a preset value, the PCM retards ignition timing
for all cylinders. It is not a selective cylinder retard.
The PCM ignores knock sensor input during engine idle conditions. Once the engine speed
exceeds a specified value, knock retard is allowed.
Knock retard uses its own short term and long term memory program.
Long term memory stores previous detonation information in its battery-backed RAM. The
maximum authority that long term memory has over timing retard can be calibrated.
Short term memory is allowed to retard timing up to a preset amount under all operating conditions
(as long as rpm is above the minimum rpm) except at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The PCM, using
short term memory, can respond quickly to retard timing when engine knock is detected. Short term
memory is lost any time the ignition key is turned off.
NOTE: Over or under tightening the sensor mounting bolts will affect knock sensor performance,
possibly causing improper spark control. Always use the specified torque when installing the knock
sensors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Glow Plug System > Wait To Start Light > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description
Wait To Start Light: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A wait-to-start indicator is only found in the instrument clusters for vehicles equipped with an
optional diesel engine. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The wait-to-start indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International Control and Display
Symbol icon for Diesel Preheat in the opaque layer of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark
outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being clearly visible when it is not illuminated.
An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes
the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is
illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit
board.
The wait-to-start indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Glow Plug System > Wait To Start Light > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description > Page 7137
Wait To Start Light: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The wait-to-start indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the air temperature
within the diesel engine intake manifold is too cool for efficient and reliable engine starting, and that
the intake air heater grids are energized in their pre-heat operating mode. This indicator is
controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming
and electronic messages received by the cluster from the Engine Control Module (ECM) over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The wait-to-start indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the wait-to-start indicator for the following reasons:
- Wait-To-Start Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
wait-to-start indicator lamp-ON message from the ECM indicating that the air temperature within
the intake manifold is too cool for efficient and reliable engine starting, the wait-to-start indicator will
be illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message,
until the ECM detects that the engine is running or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF
position, whichever occurs first.
Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the wait-to-start indicator will
be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality
of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The ECM continually monitors the engine intake air temperature sensor to determine when the
intake air heater grids should be energized in their pre-heat operating mode. The ECM then sends
the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC).
For further diagnosis of the wait-to-start indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the
indicator, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the engine intake air temperature sensor, the intake air heater grid control
circuits, the ECM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to
wait-to-start indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate
diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 7145
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 7148
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7153
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7154
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7155
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7156
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7157
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7158
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7159
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7160
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7163
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7164
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7165
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7166
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7167
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7168
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7169
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7170
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7173
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7176
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7180
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7181
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7182
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7183
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7184
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7189
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7190
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7191
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7192
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7193
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7194
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7195
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch
Component ID: 17
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Color : LT. BROWN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
5 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
6 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
7 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
8-9-10 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20YL/TN
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7196
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7197
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7198
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7201
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7202
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7203
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7204
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7205
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7206
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7207
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7208
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Description > Page 7211
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Removal > Page 7214
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with a Cummins diesel engine, the transmission throttle valve cable has
been replace by the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA). The TTVA consists of an electric
DC motor, two potentiometers, and a gear drive system. The TTVA is mechanically connected to
the transmission throttle valve in the valve body by the "D" shaped opening in the bottom of the
TTVA shaft. Changes in the TTVA position are therefore transferred to the throttle valve and cause
changes in the transmission throttle pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7218
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
The Transmission Throttle Valve Actuator (TTVA) does not require any mechanical adjustments.
All changes in throttle valve position are controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The TTVA does require an initialization period after the actuator has been removed or replaced.
After the actuator has been removed or replaced, move the ignition to the ON position for thirty (30)
seconds. This will allow the ECM sufficient time to perform the internal calibration procedures to
learn the TTVA's current "zero" position. Once this is done, check the ECM for diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs). If no DTCs are set relating to the TTVA, the TTVA is fully calibrated and ready for
use.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the bolts (2) holding the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) to the
transmission case. 2. Allow the TTVA (1) to rotate clockwise away from the transmission.
3. Remove the wiring connector (2) from the TTVA (1). 4. Lift the TTVA (1) straight upward and off
the throttle valve shaft (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7221
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) over the throttle valve shaft (3). 2.
Align the D-shaped opening in the bottom of the TTVA to the throttle valve shaft and install the
TTVA onto the shaft. 3. Install the wiring connector (2) to the TTVA (1).
4. Rotate the TTVA (1) to the transmission case and install the bolts (2) to hold the TTVA to the
transmission. 5. Tighten the bolts to 8.5 Nm (75 in.lbs.). 6. Initialize the TTVA.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal
Actuator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove actuator wiring connector. 2. Remove actuator (1) bolts (2).
3. Remove actuator (1) from disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7227
Actuator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean actuator (1) sealing surface and install new gasket (2) if necessary.
2. Align actuator shift fork (1) with disconnect collar (2) and install actuator on disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7228
3. Install actuator (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Install disconnect actuator wiring
connector. 5. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Locations Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7233
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7234
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7235
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7236
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7237
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Diagrams Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7240
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7241
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7242
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7243
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information
> Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 7244
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7249
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7250
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7251
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7252
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7253
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7254
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7255
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7256
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7257
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7258
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7259
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7260
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Page 7261
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7264
torque device. The output of the device is coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and
range forks that change the transfer case operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps
maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7265
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7266
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a high
speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is coupled
to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case operating
ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Front Control Module (FCM) commands to move the
transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case operating mode
indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7267
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV243 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7270
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7271
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV246 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Remove the front propeller shaft. 3. Disengage the
wiring connectors from the shift motor and mode sensor. 4. Remove the bolts (1) holding the shift
motor and mode sensor assembly (2) onto the transfer case.
5. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7272
6. Remove the shift motor isolator (1) from the transfer case (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the shift motor isolator (1) onto the transfer case (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7273
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Install the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) onto the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7274
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information
> Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7275
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV273 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Overdrive Off Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
An overdrive off indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles
not equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically
disabled. This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the
coolant temperature gauge.
The overdrive off indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text O/D OFF in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the overdrive off indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The overdrive off indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The overdrive off indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the overdrive-OFF
position of the tow/haul switch has been selected, disabling the electronically controlled overdrive
feature of the automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus.
The overdrive off indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the overdrive off indicator for the following reasons:
- Overdrive Off Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
overdrive off indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the overdrive-OFF position
of the tow/haul switch has been selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch
is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the overdrive off indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the overdrive off indicator or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier
Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 7282
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to overdrive off indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 7283
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Tow/Haul Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
A tow/haul indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically disabled.
This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant
temperature gauge.
The tow/haul indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text TOW/HAUL in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the tow/haul indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The tow/haul indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The tow/haul indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the tow/haul function of the
tow/haul switch has been selected, revising the shift schedule of the electronically controlled
automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The tow/haul indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the tow/haul indicator for the following reasons:
- Tow/Haul Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic tow/haul
indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the tow/haul shift schedule has been
selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF
position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the tow/haul indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the tow/haul indicator or the
instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator refer to Instrument Cluster / Carrier testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 7284
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to tow/haul indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A transmission over-temperature indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters.
However, on vehicles not equipped with an optional automatic transmission, this indicator is
electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The transmission over-temperature indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International
Control and Display Symbol icon for Transmission Temperature in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. A red Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the
opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in red through the translucent outer
layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The transmission over-temperature indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description > Page 7289
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The transmission over-temperature indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
transmission fluid temperature is excessive, which may lead to accelerated transmission
component wear or failure. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster
circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The transmission over-temperature indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by
the instrument cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the
instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON
or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the transmission over-temperature indicator for the
following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the transmission
over-temperature indicator is illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Trans Over-Temp Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
trans over-temp indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the transmission fluid
temperature is 135° C (275° F) or higher, the indicator will be illuminated and a single chime tone is
sounded. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from
the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime
tone feature will only repeat during the same ignition cycle if the indicator is cycled OFF and then
ON again by the appropriate lamp-ON and lamp-OFF messages from the PCM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the transmission
over-temperature indicator will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the
test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the transmission temperature sensor to determine the transmission
operating condition. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster illuminates the transmission
over-temperature indicator due to a high transmission oil temperature condition, it may indicate that
the transmission or the transmission cooling system are being overloaded, or that they require
service. For further diagnosis of the transmission over-temperature indicator or the instrument
cluster circuitry that controls the LED,refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transmission temperature sensor, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data
bus or the electronic communication related to transmission over-temperature indicator operation a
diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Description
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
A 4WD auto indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD auto indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure gauge.
The 4WD auto indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD AUTO in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD auto indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD auto indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7295
A 4WD indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional four-wheel drive system, this indicator is electronically disabled. The
4WD indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure
gauge.
The 4WD indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD indicator is dimmable,
which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel lamps dimmer
thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
A 4WD low indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD low indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant temperature gauge.
The 4WD low indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD LOW in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD low indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD low indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7296
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Operation
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
The 4WD auto indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer
case has been shifted into the 4WD auto mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD auto indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD auto indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Auto Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD auto
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD auto indicator will
be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality
of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD auto mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD auto indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD auto indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
The 4WD indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the transfer case has been
shifted into a 4WD mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The 4WD indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD indicator
lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly or the manual transfer case through the transfer case switch to
determine when the 4WD mode is engaged. The TIPM then sends the proper lamp-ON or
lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of
the 4WD indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the LED, refer to Instrument
Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the transfer case switch, the
TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD indicator
operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
The 4WD low indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer case
has been shifted into the 4WD low mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD low indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7297
indicator to operate when the instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused
ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition
switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path
to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD low
indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Low Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD low
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD low indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the LED portion of the test to confirm the functionality of the
LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD low mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD low indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD low indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A service 4WD indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer
dial face in the instrument cluster overlay.
The service 4WD indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text SVC 4WD in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The service 4WD indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transfer Case > Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7302
Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The service 4WD indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) has recorded a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for an electronic transfer
case circuit or component malfunction. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the TIPM over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The service 4WD indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the service 4WD indicator for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the service 4WD indicator is
illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Service 4WD Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic service
4WD indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the service 4WD indicator will be illuminated. The
indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until
the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the TIPM
for 10 seconds the service 4WD indicator is illuminated by the cluster to indicate a loss of TIPM
communication. The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid
message is received from the TIPM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the service 4WD indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case control circuits and transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine the condition of the system. The TIPM then sends the
proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For
further diagnosis of the service 4WD indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the
LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication
related to service 4WD indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast
Downshift
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast
Downshift > Page 7313
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast
Downshift > Page 7314
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
> Page 7319
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
> Page 7320
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
> Page 7321
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
> Page 7322
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7328
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7329
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7334
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7335
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7336
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7337
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7338
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7339
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7340
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7341
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7342
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7343
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7344
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7345
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7346
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7347
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
On gasoline vehicles the Transmission Control Module (TCM) (2) may be sub-module within the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) (3).
68RFE TCM LOCATION
Vehicles equipped 68RFE transmission and a 6.7L Diesel engine, the TCM is housed in the NGC4
controller utilizing only the C1 and C4 connectors (TCM only). The controller is located at the rear
of the engine compartment, near the right inner fender.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7350
AS68RC TCM LOCATION
On Cab Chassis models equipped with the AS68RC transmission the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) has three electrical connectors and is located in the passenger compartment underneath of
the left side of the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7351
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
RLE and RFE TRANSMISSIONS
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) (if equipped)
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Line Pressure Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids
- Torque Reduction Request
Some examples of TCM indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool)
NOTE: If the TCM has been replaced, the "Quick Learn Procedure" must be performed.
BATTERY FEED
A fused, direct battery feed to the TCM is used for continuous power. This battery voltage is
necessary to retain memory in the TCM. When the battery (B+) is disconnected, this memory is
lost. When the battery (B+) is restored, this memory loss is detected by the TCM and a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) is set.
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEXES (CVI)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7352
An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transmission gear position. This is important
to the CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the input clutch assembly can cause inadequate or
out-of-range element volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following charts identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7353
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7354
SHIFT SCHEDULES
As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules.
Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7355
AISIN AS68RC TRANSMISSION
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Speed Sensor
- Output Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Engine/Body Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 7356
- Manifold Pressure
- Throttle position
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Brake Status (if equipped)
- PTO Request (if equipped)
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Exhaust Brake Cut Request (if equipped).
- Solenoids.
- Torque Reduction Request.
Some examples of TCM .indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM).
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN).
- PTO Status.
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI).
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules.
- System self-diagnostics.
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool).
Clutch filling time is continuously maintained when the vehicle is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7361
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7362
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7363
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7364
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7365
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7366
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7367
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7368
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7369
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7370
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7371
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7372
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7373
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7374
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7375
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7376
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7377
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7378
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7379
Transmission Control System Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Due to different power control configurations, the Transmission Control Relay (if equipped)
may be referred to as a PCM relay.
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TIPM, and is used to supply power to the
TCM when the transmission is in normal operating mode.
Operation
OPERATION
The TIPM energizes the transmission control relay. When the relay is "off", no power is supplied to
the TCM and the transmission will not operate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7386
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7387
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7388
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7389
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7390
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality now resides in the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM), refer to the TIPM information for location. The TIPM controls the 4X4
transfer case shift functions via the actuation of a shift motor and utilizing the feedback of a mode
sensor assembly. Communication is via the CAN bus. Inputs include user selectable 4X4 modes
that include 2WD, AWD, 4HI, 4LO, and Neutral (selections vary with the specific transfer case).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7393
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality in the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM) utilizes the input from the transfer case mounted mode sensor, the instrument panel
mounted selector switch, and the following information from the vehicle's CAN bus to determine if a
shift is allowed.
- Engine RPM and Vehicle Speed
- Diagnostic Requests
- Manual Transmission and Brake Applied
- PRNDL
- Ignition Status
- ABS Messages
Once the TIP determines that a requested shift is allowed, it actuates the bi-directional shift motor
as necessary to achieve the desired transfer case operating mode. The TIPM also monitors the
mode sensor while controlling the shift motor to determine the status of the shift attempt.
Several items can cause the requested shift not to be completed. If the TIPM has recognized a
fault (DTC) of some variety, it will begin operation in one of four Functionality Levels. These levels
are:
- Level Zero - Normal Operation.
- Level One - Only Mode Shifts Are Allowed.
- Level Two - Only Mode Shifts and Shifts Into LOW Are Allowed (No Neutral Shifts Are Allowed).
- Level Three - No Shifts Are Allowed
The TIPM can also be operating in one of three possible power modes. These power modes are:
- Full Power Mode is the normal operational mode of the module. This mode is achieved by normal
CAN bus traffic being present and the ignition being in the RUN position.
Reduced Power Mode will be entered when the ignition has been powered off. In this state, the
module will shut down power supplied to external devices, and to electronic interface inputs and
outputs. From this state the module can enter either Sleep Mode or Full Power Mode. To enter this
mode, the module must receive an ignition message denoting that the ignition is off, or not receive
any messages for 5 ± 0.5 seconds. To exit this mode, the module must receive one ignition
message that denotes that the ignition is in the RUN position.
- Sleep Mode will be entered, from the Reduced Power Mode, when no CAN traffic has been
sensed for 20 ± 1 seconds. If during Sleep Mode the module detects CAN bus traffic, it will revert
to the Reduced Power mode while monitoring for ignition messages. It will remain in this state as
long as there is traffic other than run or start messages, and will return to Sleep mode if the bus
goes without traffic for 20 ± 1 seconds.
SHIFT REQUIREMENTS
If the TIPM is in full power mode and at functionality level zero, it uses the following criteria to
determine if a shift is allowed.
If any of the driver controllable conditions are not met once the shift request is recognized, the
TIPM will solidly illuminate the source position's LED and flash the desired position's LED for all
shifts except NEUTRAL. The NEUTRAL shift LED strategy will be discussed later.
Mode shifts will be allowed regardless of transmission gear or vehicle speed, whenever the
following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector switch state indicates that a mode shift has been requested.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
Range shifts will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector Switch state indicating a range shift has been requested.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal must be recognized for at least 1.5 seconds ± 100 msec.
(Automatic transmissions only)
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Clutch signal is recognized for 500 msec ± 50 msec (Manual transmissions only).
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7394
A shift into transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 4.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus. (Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position, engine off.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
A shift out of transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 1.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus.(Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
SHIFT SEQUENCES
Once all the driver controllable conditions for the requested shift have been met, the TIPM begins a
shift timer with a maximum duration of 1 second per 'D' channel transition. If the shift timer expires
before the TIPM recognizes to correct mode sensor code, the shift is considered to have been
blocked. The blocked shift will increment the blocked shift counter by one. The TIPM strategy for
handling blocked shifts will be described later. The process the TIPM performs for the various shifts
will be described first.
RANGE AND MODE SHIFTS
The process for performing all the range and mode shifts are the same. The following steps
describe the process.
- Allow time for Selector Switch debounce; 250 msec ± 50 msec.
- Extinguish the source gear's LED while flashing desired transfer case position's LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel transition in the
destination gear's direction while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Solidly illuminate the selected gear's LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds ± 100 msec. per 'D'
channel. The TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired
position.
The exception to the preceding sequence is when a shift from 4L to 2WD/AWD is requested. If
2WD/AWD is requested from the 4L position, the transfer case is first driven to the 4H position. If
the 4H position is reached, the transfer case is then driven back to the 2WD/AWD position and the
shift is considered complete. If the transfer case does not reach any the 4H position, but is in the
2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the 2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the
shift is also considered complete.
SHIFT OUT OF NEUTRAL
The following steps describe the process for a shift out of NEUTRAL.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec toward the transfer case 4H mode
position while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds 100 msec. The
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7395
TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired position.
- When the Neutral button is released, if the 4H position is the desired position, the shift is
complete. Illuminate the 4H LED.
- Otherwise when the Neutral button is released, if all of the shift requirements are being met then
engage the shift motor towards the desired position for 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel. (if
requirements for shifting are not met, illuminate the 4H LED and flash the destination LED as an
indication to the driver that all of the driver controllable shift conditions are not being met). If this
requires another range or mode shift, begin the range/mode shift process.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (i.e. a blocked or other
condition exists), refer to Blocked Shift Strategy.
BLOCKED SHIFT STRATEGY
When a shift is commanded, the shift motor will be driven towards its destination position, except in
the case of shifting out of Neutral if 4L was selected (the transfer case will shift to the 4H position
first, before proceeding to 4L). If the shift is blocked on the way to the destination, the TIPM may
attempt to drive the motor back to the original position. This process will be allowed to occur 5
times. If the transfer case has reached a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel during the shift re-attempts,
the LED for the achieved gear position is illuminated and the shift attempts are stopped. To
re-attempt the desired shift, the selector switch will need to be rotated to the current position until
the switch debounce timer expires then a shift will need to be requested again.
At the end of the 5th blocked attempt, the shift motor is driven towards the last known 'D' channel
position. If this motor drive allows the transfer case to reach the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the
2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the shift is considered complete
and the shift attempts are ended.
If the mode sensor is in the NEUTRAL region at the expiration of the shift timer, the TIPM will
continue to make the shift attempts according to the blocked shift strategy independent of whether
or not the driver controlled conditions are met.
For shifts from NEUTRAL, if all 5 attempts fail to reach the desired position (which by default is
4H), the motor will be driven to stall in the direction of 4H or 4L, depending on the achieved
position. If the transfer case has reached the 2WD/AWD or 4L between gear position nearest the
NEUTRAL positions and the shift conditions are no longer being met, the transfer case will be
driven toward the corresponding 'D' channel. Otherwise, the transfer case will be driven in the
direction opposite the last attempt with the desired target being 4H or 4L.
If the transfer case reaches the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel when being driven in the 4H direction, then
one final 1.0 second drive toward 4H is attempted. If the transfer case then reaches any of the 4H
positions, the shift is considered complete and the 4H LED is illuminated. If the transfer case is still
the 2WD/AWD position, the shift is considered complete and the 2WD/AWD LED is illuminated.
NOTE: If after the 5th blocked shift and reversal attempt, if the transfer case position is in the
NEUTRAL region, shift attempts will continue until a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel is reached.
SHIFT REVERSAL TARGETS
If the shift timer expires (1 second per 'D' channel) and the transfer case has not reached the
desired position, all shifts will attempt to return to their original position with the exceptions of:
- If the intended shift is going to the High rail from Low and can't make it, but it can make the
2WD/AWD position, the motor stops at that position. The TIPM will not attempt to cross back over
NEUTRAL if it does not have to. This means that there was a block on the first attempt to go to 4H
and the transfer case has made it through NEUTRAL to a known good position, then the motor will
go back only to the 2WD/4WD position and execute the remainder of the attempts from there.
- For shifts out of NEUTRAL, any time a shift is commanded out of NEUTRAL, the system needs to
get out. The TIPM should never go to NEUTRAL unless the driver is commanding it and all
required conditions are being met
ENCODER DRIFT CORRECTION
Whenever a shift is completed, the TIPM stores the position in memory as the transfer case's
intended position. The TIPM continuously monitors the mode sensor and if the mode sensor drifts
toward into a NEUTRAL region sensor position for 2.0 seconds, the TIPM will perform a motor
drive to correct the drift. The transfer case will be driven toward the intended position for 1.0
seconds ± 100 msec. The TIPM will wait for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeat the attempt to shift
to the desired position. This will continue until the intended position is reached.
SHIFT MOTOR BRAKING
Two modes of shift motor braking are employed to improve shift performance, static and dynamic.
Static shift motor braking is utilized under the following conditions:
- Whenever the transfer case is in the 2WD/AWD or 4L 'D' channel position.
- Whenever an invalid mode sensor code is present.
Static motor braking is achieved by applying +12V on both shift motor wires.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7396
NOTE: Static Shift Motor Braking is independent of ignition key position.
SHIFT ATTEMPT LIMIT
To protect the transfer case system, the TIPM will impose a limit on the number of shifts that can
occur over a calibrated time period. The system will monitor the number of 'D' channel segment
transitions that occur in any 30 second time period. If the number of segment transitions is 30 or
greater, the system will go into a default mode. The default mode of operation for shifting is that the
number of allowed 'D' channel transitions permitted to occur will be 3 over each 15 second ± 100
msec calibrated window of time. After 5 minutes ± 100 msec, the motor can be assumed to have
cooled down and the system will revert to normal operation. The following rules also apply to the
shift limit:
- The attempt limit will not prevent shifts coming out of NEUTRAL, they will be allowed regardless
of the counter/timer.
- Any shift that is in progress when the counter reaches a maximum count in time will be allowed to
complete before the default mode is entered. D-channel transitions during this period will not be
counted towards the default mode limit.
- A block, regardless of the direction, whether towards destination or back towards reversal target
(shift timer expiring), will count as a value of 2 transitions towards the 30 segment transitions to go
into default mode as defined above. Current attempt limit values are 30 transitions in 30 seconds
and default mode values are 3 transitions every 15 seconds for 5 minutes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7402
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7403
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7404
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The TCM utilizes a closed-loop system to control transmission line pressure. The system contains
a variable force style solenoid, the Pressure Control Solenoid, which is part of the pressure switch
assembly. The solenoid is duty cycle controlled by the TCM to vent the unnecessary line pressure
supplied by the oil pump back to the pump inlet. The system contains a Line Pressure Sensor,
which is a direct input to the TCM. The line pressure sensor monitors the transmission line
pressure and completes the feedback loop to the TCM. The TCM uses this information to adjust its
control of the pressure control solenoid to achieve the desired line pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Description > Page 7407
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The TCM calculates the desired line pressure based upon inputs from the transmission and engine.
The TCM calculates the torque input to the transmission and uses that information as the primary
input to the calculation. The line pressure is set to a predetermined value during shifts, to ensure
consistent shift quality. During all other operation, the desired line pressure value is adjusted based
on torque level and other transmission requirements.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Remove the bolt holding the line pressure sensor
(2) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the line pressure sensor (2) from the transmission case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7410
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the line
pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Overdrive Switch: Locations
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7414
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7415
Overdrive Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7416
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7417
Overdrive Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - OVERDRIVE ELECTRICAL CONTROLS
The tow/haul overdrive off switch, valve body solenoid, case connectors and related wiring can all
be tested with a 12 volt test lamp or a volt/ohmmeter. Check continuity of each component when
diagnosis indicates this is necessary.
Switch and solenoid continuity should be checked whenever the transmission fails to shift into
fourth gear range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7420
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7421
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7422
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7423
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7424
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7425
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and
Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 7426
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7431
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7432
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7433
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7434
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7435
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7436
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7437
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7438
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7439
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7440
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7441
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7444
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7445
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7446
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7447
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7448
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7449
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7450
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7451
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7452
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7453
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 7454
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7457
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7458
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7459
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7460
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7461
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 7464
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 7465
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 7466
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 7467
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 7468
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7473
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7474
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7475
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7476
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7477
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7478
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7479
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7480
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7481
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7482
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7483
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7484
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7485
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7486
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7487
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7488
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7489
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7490
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7491
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7494
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7495
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7496
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7497
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7498
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7499
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7500
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7501
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7502
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7503
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7504
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7505
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7506
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7507
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7508
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7509
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7510
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7511
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 7512
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor (1) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the park
gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed.
Operation
OPERATION
Speed sensor signals are triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup
face. Input signals from the sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing.
Signals from this sensor are shared with the powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7515
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 7516
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
INPUT AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSORS
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate DC
square wave signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case
and are considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the "teeth"
of the gear pass by the sensor coil, an DC square wave is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an DC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the rear planetary carrier lugs. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the input speed sensor (3). 4. Remove the bolt holding the input speed sensor to
the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor (3) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the input speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the input
speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid as
necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 7519
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the output speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the bolt holding the output speed sensor
(1) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor (1) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the output speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the output
speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor (1). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 7520
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3.
Remove the wiring connector from the output speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the output
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 7521
3. Remove the wiring connector from the input speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the input
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the output
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission fluid
level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF as necessary.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 7522
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the input
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
electrical wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission
fluid level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7526
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7527
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7528
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - M/T > Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH-CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION
1. Disconnect switch 2-wire connector (2) attached to pedal support bracket (1), under instrument
panel to left of clutch pedal. 2. Check switch continuity with an ohmmeter while operating clutch
pedal.
- Pedal Depressed - Continuity
- Pedal Released - No Continuity
3. If continuity is not present or always present, replace clutch master cylinder. Switch is not
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This Engine Control Module (ECM) input is used only on models equipped with aftermarket Power
Take Off (PTO) units.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Description > Page 7538
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
This input is used only to tell the ECM that the aftermarket PTO (Power Take Off) unit has been
engaged. The ECM will disable (temporarily shut down) certain OBD II diagnostic trouble codes
when the PTO unit is engaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7543
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7544
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7545
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7546
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7547
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7548
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7549
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7552
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere, is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7553
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7554
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7555
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7556
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7557
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7558
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7563
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7564
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7565
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7566
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7567
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7568
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7569
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7570
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7571
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7574
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7575
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7576
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7577
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7578
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7579
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7580
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7581
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 7582
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7585
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7586
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The FCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and monitor
the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is mechanically
linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode sensor draws less
than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Front Control Module (FCM) monitors the mode sensor
outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to for the relative angles of the transfer case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case
gear operating mode. Refer to for the sensor codes returned to the FCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angle Vs. Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7587
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7588
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV271 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case position sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the transfer case's current operating mode. The sensor consists of a five position, resistive
multiplexed circuit which returns a specific resistance value to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) for each transfer case operating mode. The sensor is located on the top of the transfer
case, just left of the transfer case centerline and rides against the sector plate roostercomb. The
PCM supplies 5VDC (+/- 0.5V) to the sensor and monitors the return voltage to determine the
sector plate, and therefore the transfer case, position.
Operation
OPERATION
Operating Mode Versus Resistance
Position Sensor Linear Movement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7589
During normal vehicle operation, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) monitors the transfer case
position sensor return voltage to determine the operating mode of the transfer case. Refer to the
Operating Mode Versus Resistance table for the correct resistance for each position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7590
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7591
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7592
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 7593
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Disengage the transfer case position sensor connector from
the position sensor. 3. Remove the position sensor from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7596
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring seal on the transfer case position sensor. Replace the O-ring if necessary. 2.
Install the transfer case position sensor into the transfer case. Torque the sensor to 27 Nm (20
ft.lbs.). 3. Engage the transfer case position sensor connector to the position sensor. 4. Lower
vehicle. 5. Verify proper sensor operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7601
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7602
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7603
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7606
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7607
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7608
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the front output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the front output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the front output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the front output shaft speed sensor. 3.
Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front > Page 7611
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Rear
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the rear output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the rear output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the rear output shaft speed sensor. 3. Lower
the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7620
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7621
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7622
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7623
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7624
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7625
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration >
Page 7626
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7631
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7632
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7633
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7634
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7635
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7636
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls: > G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software
Update > Page 7637
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
> Page 7643
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35 > Page 7648
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35 > Page 7649
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35 > Page 7650
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update
For Recall J35 > Page 7651
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2262 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2262 Set
NUMBER: 09-002-09
GROUP: Engine
DATE: May 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-001-08 and 11-002-08
BOTH DATED MAY21, 2008. THIS ISA COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE
BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to DIG P2262 - Revised Diagnosis and Repair Procedures
OVERVIEW: This bulletin discusses revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical. Recent PGM calibration updates have
improved the robustness to this DIG through updated diagnostic strategies. As a result, many
events which have no adverse affects on drivability, emissions, or reliability will no longer set the
P2262 fault.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicle equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC):
P2262 - Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical.
As a result of recent PCM calibration updates, the proper repair for some P2262 faults is to just
update the calibration, while others will require cleaning or replacing the turbocharger. Scan Tool
software update 9.05 (and later) includes a P2262 diagnosis test for this purpose. This diagnostic
test uses Freeze Frame data stored in the PCM and a dynamic turbocharger response test to
determine the correct repair for each truck with DTC P2262.
The new P2262 diagnosis test must be used prior to performing any of the following:
^ Clearing codes.
^ Updating the PCM.
^ Beginning the turbocharger repair.
The test must be used with the key in the run position with the engine off, and with coolant
temperature between 50°F and 180° F. The time required to run this test will vary with the
calibration level of the truck, from a few seconds up to a couple minutes. This is normal operation
for the test.
NOTE:
The P2262 diagnosis test MUST NOT be used after the repair is complete, as this test CANNOT
be used to confirm the repair. Test results will be inaccurate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2262 Set > Page 7656
If the customer is experiencing MIL illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC): P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical follow the revised diagnosis and repair
procedures below.
NOTE:
Using the wiTECH Diagnostic Application for flashing an ECU is made available through the
wiTECH Diagnostic Application. For instructions select the "HELP" tab on upper portion of the
wiTECH window, then "HELP CONTENTS." This will open the Welcome to wiTECH Help screen
were help topics can now selected.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing and flashing, StarMOBILE desktop client,
StarMOBILE standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
NOTE:
Please read through this entire Service Bulletin to gain a full understanding before performing the
procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTC's button.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
DO NOT erase DTC's or reprogram the PCM at this point. If P2262 is not present in the PCM due
to clearing the faults or reprogramming the PCM, the P2262 diagnosis test in Scan Tool will not
run.
NOTE:
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis. Procedures later may cause all DTC's to be erased.
5. Is DTC P2262 present in the PCM?
a. If YES >> Proceed to Step # 6.
b. If NO >> Then STOP. This bulletin does not apply.
6. Confirm the engine coolant temperature is between 50°F and 180°F.
7. Perform the P2262 diagnostic test with wiTECH(R), From the "Vehicle View screen select:
a. Select "PCM".
b. Select "Systems Tests".
c. Select "P2262 Fault Diagnosis Test Start".
d. Follow on-screen prompts to complete test.
NOTE:
If you receive an error message from test, confirm that the Diagnostic Link Connector and
turbocharger actuator harness connections are secure. Also confirm that engine coolant
temperature is between 50°F and 180°F, then run the test again.
8. Based on the outcome of the P2262 diagnosis test, the Scan Tool will provide one of the
following as the proper direction for the appropriate repair.
Based on these results, refer to the detailed service information available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info and complete
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P2262 Set > Page 7657
the repair as directed;
a. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration. No repair required to the turbocharger.
b. Clean the Turbocharger.
c. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Clean the Turbocharger.
d. Replace the Turbocharger.
e. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Replace the Turbocharger.
9. Does the vehicle have other DTC's as recorded in Step # 4 above?
a. Yes >> Follow appropriate diagnosis procedures or TSB related to diagnosis and repair of each
fault.
b. No >> Repair complete.
NOTE:
All other DTC's or symptoms MUST be addressed prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE:
When/if replacing Turbocharger, p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA must NOT be used on a D1/DH
(Pick Up) models. Turbocharger p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA are to be used on DA/DC/DM
(Cab/Chassis) ONLY.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7662
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3
Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7663
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0868 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868
Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0868 Set > Page 7668
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0868 Set > Page 7669
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0868 Set > Page 7670
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC
P0868 Set > Page 7671
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default
To Neutral
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - A/T May Default
To Neutral
NUMBER: 18-035-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 18, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 545RFE Transmission Defaults To Neutral
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (1500/2500/3500)
2007 (HB/HG) Durango/Aspen
2007 (ND) Dakota
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 545RFE transmission (sale code DGQ) built on or
before March 26, 2007 (MDH 0326XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The transmission may default into neutral gear if the transmission gear selector is moved into
"reverse gear range under certain operating conditions.
The default into neutral gear is done to protect the transmission mechanical components from
potential damage. New PCM software will monitor transmission hydraulic pressure and allow
reverse gear engagement, if the transmission is in "reverse gear range and the transmission
hydraulic pressure is sufficient to support reverse gear operation.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default
To Neutral > Page 7676
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN® must be
programmed with software release level 7.04 SPI or higher. The software release level is visible in
the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (PCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default
To Neutral > Page 7677
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the PCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-001-10 > Jul > 10 > Diesel Engine - Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Diesel Engine Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info
NUMBER: 09-001-10
GROUP: Engine
DATE: July 2, 2010
SUBJECT: Dust-Out Diagnosis For Cummins Diesel Engines
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves proper inspection procedures to determine engine failure due to
dust-out condition. Engines damaged due to the infiltration of dirt and/or debris through the air
intake system are NOT WARRANTABLE.
NOTE:
Contact your Business Center or Service and Parts Area Manager if dust out evidence is noticed or
any type of tampering is suspected.
MODELS:
2003 - 2005 (DR) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2006 - 2009 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2010 - 2011 (DJ) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2003 - 2005 (DR) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2010 - 2011 (D2) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (3500)
2011 (DD) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (3500)
2008 - 2010 (DM) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (4500/5500)
2011 (DP) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (4500/5500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to any Cummins diesel equipped vehicle still covered under the manufacturers
warranty.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Engines that exhibit particular symptoms that may have been caused by improper air filtration.
Some of these symptoms are listed below (not limited to)
^ Knocking
^ Hard or no start
^ Low power / poor performance
^ Oil consumption
^ Lower end bearing failure
^ Smoking
^ Blow-by (rings not sealing)
^ Oil on turbo (dust damage to seal/bearing)
NOTE:
See the "Cummins Diesel Dust-Out Inspection for Warranty" document located in eFiles Under:
Service> STAR Center> Cummins - HEV
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-001-10 > Jul > 10 > Diesel Engine - Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info > Page 7683
documents for pictures regarding dust-outs.
NOTE:
Canadian dealers can refer to Tech-Tip # 18 - CUMMINS DIESEL ENGINES FAILURES DO TO
DIRTY AIR ENTERING THE INDUCTION SYSTEM - HOW TO INSPECT FOR SIGNS OF A
"DUST OUT" ENGINE FAILURE sent 05/19/2010 for pictures regarding dust-outs.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Perform a compression test. Low compression is generally due to ring/piston/valve issues. High
compression may be due to oil infiltration causing a
hydraulic effect.
2. Major mechanical damage can also be caused by fuel, fuel injectors or "Up-rate kits or
"programmers". Inspect vehicle for any device that adds more
power, (fuel) which may damage the engine mechanically. Check for any aftermarket power
enhancer or "box" or "downloader".Repairs of failures caused by these devices do not qualify for
warranty coverage.
3. Inspect all air handling ducts and components. (See eFiles document). If dirt is found in the air
handling components, further diagnostics may not be
necessary. Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air filter will not qualify for warranty
coverage.
4. Inspect for aftermarket "cold air" performance air filter housing, duct work and filters. Again,
Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air
filter will not qualify for warranty coverage.
5. Inspect cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring ridge. The absence of
cylinder bore cross-hatching MAY be one of the first
signs of cylinder dust or dirt damage. Cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring
ridge may be inspected using a bore scope (if available), or cylinder head removal may be
necessary. Contact your Business Center or Service and Parts Area Manager if dust out evidence
is noticed or any type of tampering is suspected. Dirt carried in through the air handling system is
typically funneled and concentrated to the end (1 & 6) cylinders*. Vertical scratches (broken rings)
will follow. Generally, a properly maintained engine will have well defined hone marks visible
beyond 100,000 miles.
NOTE:
Be aware of stains or marks in cylinder wall(s). Marks may follow the ring gap but have no depth or
damage to the cylinder bore wall. These marks have a look similar to a "scored" cylinder, yet have
no physical damage to the surface and will not cause any harm. These marks be checked by
physically inspecting (scratching) the surface to detect if cylinder wall is damaged (grooved).
6. When inspecting the cylinder bore(s), compare cylinders # 1 & # 6 to the others. Cylinder honing
(cross-hatching) performed in the Cummins
engine manufacturing process is very aggressive. Engines that have dirt introduced will "polish out"
this hone witness mark first and then start cutting or wearing down the cylinder walls which will
create a ring ridge in the cylinder bore at the top of the bore. The absence of the cross-hatching
ALONG WITH dirt found anywhere in the "clean-side" of the air intake system, is evidence of a
dust-out condition.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle
Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 7688
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7693
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7694
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7695
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7696
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7701
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7702
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7703
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7704
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7705
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7706
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
J35 > Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7707
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2262 Set
NUMBER: 09-002-09
GROUP: Engine
DATE: May 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-001-08 and 11-002-08
BOTH DATED MAY21, 2008. THIS ISA COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE
BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to DIG P2262 - Revised Diagnosis and Repair Procedures
OVERVIEW: This bulletin discusses revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical. Recent PGM calibration updates have
improved the robustness to this DIG through updated diagnostic strategies. As a result, many
events which have no adverse affects on drivability, emissions, or reliability will no longer set the
P2262 fault.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicle equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC):
P2262 - Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical.
As a result of recent PCM calibration updates, the proper repair for some P2262 faults is to just
update the calibration, while others will require cleaning or replacing the turbocharger. Scan Tool
software update 9.05 (and later) includes a P2262 diagnosis test for this purpose. This diagnostic
test uses Freeze Frame data stored in the PCM and a dynamic turbocharger response test to
determine the correct repair for each truck with DTC P2262.
The new P2262 diagnosis test must be used prior to performing any of the following:
^ Clearing codes.
^ Updating the PCM.
^ Beginning the turbocharger repair.
The test must be used with the key in the run position with the engine off, and with coolant
temperature between 50°F and 180° F. The time required to run this test will vary with the
calibration level of the truck, from a few seconds up to a couple minutes. This is normal operation
for the test.
NOTE:
The P2262 diagnosis test MUST NOT be used after the repair is complete, as this test CANNOT
be used to confirm the repair. Test results will be inaccurate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set > Page 7712
If the customer is experiencing MIL illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC): P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical follow the revised diagnosis and repair
procedures below.
NOTE:
Using the wiTECH Diagnostic Application for flashing an ECU is made available through the
wiTECH Diagnostic Application. For instructions select the "HELP" tab on upper portion of the
wiTECH window, then "HELP CONTENTS." This will open the Welcome to wiTECH Help screen
were help topics can now selected.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing and flashing, StarMOBILE desktop client,
StarMOBILE standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
NOTE:
Please read through this entire Service Bulletin to gain a full understanding before performing the
procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTC's button.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
DO NOT erase DTC's or reprogram the PCM at this point. If P2262 is not present in the PCM due
to clearing the faults or reprogramming the PCM, the P2262 diagnosis test in Scan Tool will not
run.
NOTE:
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis. Procedures later may cause all DTC's to be erased.
5. Is DTC P2262 present in the PCM?
a. If YES >> Proceed to Step # 6.
b. If NO >> Then STOP. This bulletin does not apply.
6. Confirm the engine coolant temperature is between 50°F and 180°F.
7. Perform the P2262 diagnostic test with wiTECH(R), From the "Vehicle View screen select:
a. Select "PCM".
b. Select "Systems Tests".
c. Select "P2262 Fault Diagnosis Test Start".
d. Follow on-screen prompts to complete test.
NOTE:
If you receive an error message from test, confirm that the Diagnostic Link Connector and
turbocharger actuator harness connections are secure. Also confirm that engine coolant
temperature is between 50°F and 180°F, then run the test again.
8. Based on the outcome of the P2262 diagnosis test, the Scan Tool will provide one of the
following as the proper direction for the appropriate repair.
Based on these results, refer to the detailed service information available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info and complete
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set > Page 7713
the repair as directed;
a. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration. No repair required to the turbocharger.
b. Clean the Turbocharger.
c. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Clean the Turbocharger.
d. Replace the Turbocharger.
e. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Replace the Turbocharger.
9. Does the vehicle have other DTC's as recorded in Step # 4 above?
a. Yes >> Follow appropriate diagnosis procedures or TSB related to diagnosis and repair of each
fault.
b. No >> Repair complete.
NOTE:
All other DTC's or symptoms MUST be addressed prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE:
When/if replacing Turbocharger, p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA must NOT be used on a D1/DH
(Pick Up) models. Turbocharger p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA are to be used on DA/DC/DM
(Cab/Chassis) ONLY.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh
2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7718
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7719
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7724
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7725
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7726
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7727
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7728
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7729
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7730
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7735
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7736
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7737
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7738
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/T
May Default To Neutral
NUMBER: 18-035-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 18, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 545RFE Transmission Defaults To Neutral
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (1500/2500/3500)
2007 (HB/HG) Durango/Aspen
2007 (ND) Dakota
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 545RFE transmission (sale code DGQ) built on or
before March 26, 2007 (MDH 0326XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The transmission may default into neutral gear if the transmission gear selector is moved into
"reverse gear range under certain operating conditions.
The default into neutral gear is done to protect the transmission mechanical components from
potential damage. New PCM software will monitor transmission hydraulic pressure and allow
reverse gear engagement, if the transmission is in "reverse gear range and the transmission
hydraulic pressure is sufficient to support reverse gear operation.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral > Page 7743
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN® must be
programmed with software release level 7.04 SPI or higher. The software release level is visible in
the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (PCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral > Page 7744
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the PCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-001-10 > Jul > 10 > Diesel Engine - Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Diesel Engine Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info
NUMBER: 09-001-10
GROUP: Engine
DATE: July 2, 2010
SUBJECT: Dust-Out Diagnosis For Cummins Diesel Engines
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves proper inspection procedures to determine engine failure due to
dust-out condition. Engines damaged due to the infiltration of dirt and/or debris through the air
intake system are NOT WARRANTABLE.
NOTE:
Contact your Business Center or Service and Parts Area Manager if dust out evidence is noticed or
any type of tampering is suspected.
MODELS:
2003 - 2005 (DR) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2006 - 2009 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2010 - 2011 (DJ) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500)
2003 - 2005 (DR) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2010 - 2011 (D2) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (3500)
2011 (DD) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (3500)
2008 - 2010 (DM) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (4500/5500)
2011 (DP) Ram Truck Cab Chassis (4500/5500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to any Cummins diesel equipped vehicle still covered under the manufacturers
warranty.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Engines that exhibit particular symptoms that may have been caused by improper air filtration.
Some of these symptoms are listed below (not limited to)
^ Knocking
^ Hard or no start
^ Low power / poor performance
^ Oil consumption
^ Lower end bearing failure
^ Smoking
^ Blow-by (rings not sealing)
^ Oil on turbo (dust damage to seal/bearing)
NOTE:
See the "Cummins Diesel Dust-Out Inspection for Warranty" document located in eFiles Under:
Service> STAR Center> Cummins - HEV
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-001-10 > Jul > 10 > Diesel Engine - Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info > Page 7750
documents for pictures regarding dust-outs.
NOTE:
Canadian dealers can refer to Tech-Tip # 18 - CUMMINS DIESEL ENGINES FAILURES DO TO
DIRTY AIR ENTERING THE INDUCTION SYSTEM - HOW TO INSPECT FOR SIGNS OF A
"DUST OUT" ENGINE FAILURE sent 05/19/2010 for pictures regarding dust-outs.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Perform a compression test. Low compression is generally due to ring/piston/valve issues. High
compression may be due to oil infiltration causing a
hydraulic effect.
2. Major mechanical damage can also be caused by fuel, fuel injectors or "Up-rate kits or
"programmers". Inspect vehicle for any device that adds more
power, (fuel) which may damage the engine mechanically. Check for any aftermarket power
enhancer or "box" or "downloader".Repairs of failures caused by these devices do not qualify for
warranty coverage.
3. Inspect all air handling ducts and components. (See eFiles document). If dirt is found in the air
handling components, further diagnostics may not be
necessary. Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air filter will not qualify for warranty
coverage.
4. Inspect for aftermarket "cold air" performance air filter housing, duct work and filters. Again,
Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air
filter will not qualify for warranty coverage.
5. Inspect cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring ridge. The absence of
cylinder bore cross-hatching MAY be one of the first
signs of cylinder dust or dirt damage. Cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring
ridge may be inspected using a bore scope (if available), or cylinder head removal may be
necessary. Contact your Business Center or Service and Parts Area Manager if dust out evidence
is noticed or any type of tampering is suspected. Dirt carried in through the air handling system is
typically funneled and concentrated to the end (1 & 6) cylinders*. Vertical scratches (broken rings)
will follow. Generally, a properly maintained engine will have well defined hone marks visible
beyond 100,000 miles.
NOTE:
Be aware of stains or marks in cylinder wall(s). Marks may follow the ring gap but have no depth or
damage to the cylinder bore wall. These marks have a look similar to a "scored" cylinder, yet have
no physical damage to the surface and will not cause any harm. These marks be checked by
physically inspecting (scratching) the surface to detect if cylinder wall is damaged (grooved).
6. When inspecting the cylinder bore(s), compare cylinders # 1 & # 6 to the others. Cylinder honing
(cross-hatching) performed in the Cummins
engine manufacturing process is very aggressive. Engines that have dirt introduced will "polish out"
this hone witness mark first and then start cutting or wearing down the cylinder walls which will
create a ring ridge in the cylinder bore at the top of the bore. The absence of the cross-hatching
ALONG WITH dirt found anywhere in the "clean-side" of the air intake system, is evidence of a
dust-out condition.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Vehicle
Fails I/M Test
NUMBER: 18-017-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 15, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-038-09, DATED DECEMBER 19, 2009,
WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS REVISED BULLETIN WILL COVER
FEDERAL EMISSIONS (EPA) CERTIFIED VEHICLES ONLY. VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
CARB (CALIFORNIA) EMISSIONS HAVE BEEN REMOVED AND WILL NOW BE ADDRESSED
IN RECALL K01, DATED MAY, 2010. THIS IS A COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS
HAVE BEEN INCLUDED. WHENEVER A 2006-2007 MODULE IS REPROGRAMMED, THE
wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
SUBJECT: Flash: Smog Check On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) Test OR Inspection & Maintenance
Check Will Not Pass
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Engine Control
Module (ECM) with new software.
MODELS:
2006 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2006 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DH Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 D1 Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up 5.9L)
2007 DC Ram Truck (3500 Cab Chassis 6.7L)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to 2006 & 2007 vehicles equipped with a 5.9L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales
code ETC or ETH) with Federal emissions (sales code NAA) built after January 1, 2006, or Cab
Chassis equipped with a 6.7L Cummins Diesel Engine (sales code ETJ) built prior to January 11,
2007.
NOTE:
2003, 2006 & 2007 5.9L (DR/DH/D1) & 2007 6.7L (DC) equipped vehicles with similar
SYMPTOM/CONDITION as stated below equipped with California Emissions, (CARB Certified)
(sales code NAE) will be addressed in Recall K01, dated May, 2010.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer's vehicle may have difficulty passing a government mandated SMOG / Emissions
test or and Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test due to a scan tool reporting issue. These issues
now effect diesel vehicles due to the recent expansion/change of SMOG/Emissions tests and/or
Inspection & Maintenance (I & M) test programs in some locations, including California.
DIAGNOSIS: Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures
available in TechCONNECT, verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If any DTC's
are present record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with
this bulletin. If the above symptom/condition is experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE 2006-2007 VEHICLE USING wiTECH or StarMOBILE(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-017-10 > May > 10 > Emissions - Vehicle Fails I/M Test > Page 7755
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Reprogram the ECM with the latest software. Follow the detailed service procedures available in
DealerCONNECT/TechCONNECT, Refer To
Group 8 - Electrical> Electronic Control Modules - Service Information> Module - Powertrain
Control> Standard Procedures> PCM/ECM Programming - Diesel. After ECM reprogramming, the
following must be performed:
a. Clear any DTC's that may have been set in other modules due to reprogramming. The wiTECH
application will automatically present all DTCs
after the flash and allow the tech to clear them.
2. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" and attach it near the
VECI label.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Computers/Controls CCN Update For Recall J35
NUMBER: 18-016-10
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: April 30, 2010
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-013-08 REV. A, DATED
DECEMBER 4, 2008, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A
COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN INCLUDED.
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT -OR- StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE or
StarSCAN(R) can be used to perform this bulletin. FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE
AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.03 OR HIGHER. StarSCAN(R)
SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER.
SUBJECT: FLASH: CCN Update Required With J35 Recall
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves:
- As stated in Recall J35, verify that Emission Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM has been performed. If not, perform Recall G30 first.
- Verifying software level, and if necessary, selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cab
Compartment Node (CCN) module with new software.
- It is recommended to discuss with the customer any required necessary maintenance as
suggested in the owners manual. Inform the customer the importance of properly maintaining their
vehicle. Possible required maintenance items may include (not limited to) lube, oil change and filter
service, air filter replacement, fuel filter replacement, and crankcase ventilation filter replacement
and EGR valve cleaning based on customer use and mileage accumulation.
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH) Ram Pick Up Truck (2500 Series)
2007 - 2008 (D1) Ram Pick Up Truck (3500 Series)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sale code ETJ).
NOTE:
2009 MY vehicle had proper CCN software installed during production.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
NOTE:
Many improvements have been addressed with the latest Engine Control Module (ECM) software
addressed in Recall J35. The Cab Compartment Node (CCN) may require updating in conjunction
with the Recall. This Service Bulletin (SB) only addresses the labor associated with the
reprogramming of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional
diagnostics is not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
DIAGNOSIS: If J35 Recall is being performed, verify the CCN is up to date with the latest software
(flash) and that Recall G30 Has been performed. Using a Scan Tool (StarSCAN(R) /
StarMOBILE(R)) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT(R), verify
all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTC's other than those listed above are present
record them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
1. Is the vehicle eligible to have Emissions Recall G30 - Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM performed?
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7760
a. If YES then perform G30 Recall and then continue to Step # 2.
b. If NO then proceed to Step # 2.
2. Using the scan tool, determine current software level of the CCN. Record on the repair order.
Proceed to Step # 3.
3. Determine if the current CCN module level software part number, that was recorded earlier in
Step # 2, is one of the following (or with a higher
suffix):
a. 05172187AG (or higher) = 2007 DH (2500) or 2007 D1 (3500).
b. 05172334AG (or higher) = 2008 DH (2500) or 2008 D1 (3500).
4. Is the part number of the current CCN level software at (or higher) than one of the software part
numbers listed in Step # 3?
a. If YES then the CCN DOES NOT require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on
the repair order for later reference. This bulletin is
complete.
b. If NO then the CCN DOES require reprogramming as part of this repair. Record this on the
repair order for later reference. Proceed to REPAIR
PROCEDURE.
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT AS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
CCN software controls the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) messages. The CCN
software must be up to date (correct software level) in order for the new engine system and
exhaust aftertreatment system messages to be displayed on the EVIC.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
The repairs in this Service Bulletin (SB) only address the labor associated with the reprogramming
of the CCN. Any other labor associated with the performance of additional diagnostics or repairs
are not addressed by this SB and must be claimed separately.
NOTE:
Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. Do not allow
the charger to time out during the flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to
continuous charge.
CN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING wiTECH(R):
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7761
WiTECH(R) SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 10.02 OR HIGHER.
1. Connect the wiTECH(R) VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
2. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
3. Open the wiTECH(R) Diagnostic application.
4. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD(R) device you are using.
5. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
6. Select the "Next tab" at the bottom of the screen.
7. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the CCN icon.
8. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step # 14. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step # 9.
9. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the green arrow button on the right side of the
screen.
10. From the "ECU Flash screen" follow the wiTECH(R) screen instructions to complete the flash.
11. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
12. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's" button.
13. From the "CCN View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 9 through 13.
14. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD(R) and battery charger from the
vehicle.
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarMOBILE(R):
1. Connect the StarMOBILE(R) to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN" position.
2. Power ON the StarMOBILE(R) scan tool.
3. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE(R) Desktop Client" software.
4. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
5. Retrieve the old CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash CCN" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
CCN" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the CCN is up to date.
Continue to Step # 7. If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7762
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
8. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
9. Retrieve the CCN part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "CCN" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
CCN MODULE REPROGRAM - USING StarSCAN(R):
1. Connect the CH941 0 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
2. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
3. Turn the ignition switch to the "RUN/ON" position.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old CCN module part number and reprogram the CCN module. Using the
StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the CCN in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash CCN" screen on the WRO for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the CCN module update is complete, select "OK".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-016-10 > Apr > 10 > Computers/Controls - CCN Update For Recall J35 > Page 7763
CUSTOMER INFORMATION SHEET INCLUDED:
Please print the "DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM" at the end of this bulletin for
customer reference.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
DIESEL EXHAUST AFTERTREATMENT SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) which is used to clean the exhaust.
The DPF (exhaust filter) will self clean as part of normal vehicle operation. In some cases, your
intervention may be required to allow the self-cleaning process to occur.
WHAT YOU WILL SEE IN THE OVERHEAD DISPLAY
^ "ExhaustFilter xx% Full" - Indicates that the DPF is approaching full.
^ "Regeneration Required Now" - Indicates you will need to intervene by changing your driving
mode. See Owner Manual.
^ "Regeneration in Process" - Indicates the DPF is self-cleaning. Please try to maintain you current
driving condition until regeneration is complete.
^ "Regeneration Completed" - DPF self-cleaning is complete.
^ "Service Required-See Dealer Now" - Indicated DPF regeneration is not functioning. Your Check
Engine Light (MIL) may come on. Please see dealer. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED.
Damage to the exhaust system could occur soon with continued operation.
^ "Exhaust Filter FULL - Power Reduced - See Dealer" - Your DPF is full. Engine power will be
reduced to decrease risk of damage. IMMEDIATE SERVICE IS REQUIRED. Please see dealer
immediately. Damage to the exhaust system will occur with continued operation.
For additional assistance contact Chrysler.
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P2262 Set
NUMBER: 09-002-09
GROUP: Engine
DATE: May 23, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 11-001-08 and 11-002-08
BOTH DATED MAY21, 2008. THIS ISA COMPLETE REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE
BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION IS THE PREFERRED METHOD FOR FLASHING
ECUs.
HELP USING THE wiTECH DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION FOR FLASHING AN ECU IS
AVAILABLE BY SELECTING "HELP" THEN "HELP CONTENTS" AT THE TOP OF THE wiTECH
DIAGNOSTIC APPLICATION WINDOW.
THE wiTECH SOFTWARE LEVEL MUST BE AT RELEASE 9.05 OR HIGHER TO PERFORM
THIS PROCEDURE.
StarMOBILE DESKTOP CLIENT, StarMOBILE STANDALONE MODE OR StarSCAN MAY ALSO
BE USED TO PERFORM THIS PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: MIL Illumination Due to DIG P2262 - Revised Diagnosis and Repair Procedures
OVERVIEW: This bulletin discusses revised diagnostic and repair procedures for DTC P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical. Recent PGM calibration updates have
improved the robustness to this DIG through updated diagnostic strategies. As a result, many
events which have no adverse affects on drivability, emissions, or reliability will no longer set the
P2262 fault.
MODELS:
2007 - 2009 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicle equipped with a Cummins 6.7L engine (sales code ETJ).
DISCUSSION:
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC):
P2262 - Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical.
As a result of recent PCM calibration updates, the proper repair for some P2262 faults is to just
update the calibration, while others will require cleaning or replacing the turbocharger. Scan Tool
software update 9.05 (and later) includes a P2262 diagnosis test for this purpose. This diagnostic
test uses Freeze Frame data stored in the PCM and a dynamic turbocharger response test to
determine the correct repair for each truck with DTC P2262.
The new P2262 diagnosis test must be used prior to performing any of the following:
^ Clearing codes.
^ Updating the PCM.
^ Beginning the turbocharger repair.
The test must be used with the key in the run position with the engine off, and with coolant
temperature between 50°F and 180° F. The time required to run this test will vary with the
calibration level of the truck, from a few seconds up to a couple minutes. This is normal operation
for the test.
NOTE:
The P2262 diagnosis test MUST NOT be used after the repair is complete, as this test CANNOT
be used to confirm the repair. Test results will be inaccurate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set > Page 7768
If the customer is experiencing MIL illumination due to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC): P2262 Turbocharger Boost Pressure Not Detected - Mechanical follow the revised diagnosis and repair
procedures below.
NOTE:
Using the wiTECH Diagnostic Application for flashing an ECU is made available through the
wiTECH Diagnostic Application. For instructions select the "HELP" tab on upper portion of the
wiTECH window, then "HELP CONTENTS." This will open the Welcome to wiTECH Help screen
were help topics can now selected.
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
While the wiTECH tool is the preferred method of testing and flashing, StarMOBILE desktop client,
StarMOBILE standalone mode OR StarSCAN may also be used to perform this procedure.
NOTE:
Please read through this entire Service Bulletin to gain a full understanding before performing the
procedure.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Connect the Scan Tool to the Diagnostic Link Connector (DLC).
2. Turn the ignition key to the RUN position, DO NOT start the engine.
3. From the "Vehicle View" screen on the Scan Tool select:
a. "All DTC's button.
4. Record all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) that are present in the PCM.
NOTE:
DO NOT erase DTC's or reprogram the PCM at this point. If P2262 is not present in the PCM due
to clearing the faults or reprogramming the PCM, the P2262 diagnosis test in Scan Tool will not
run.
NOTE:
It is IMPORTANT to record (capture) all DTC's present in the PCM prior to proceeding further with
this diagnosis. Procedures later may cause all DTC's to be erased.
5. Is DTC P2262 present in the PCM?
a. If YES >> Proceed to Step # 6.
b. If NO >> Then STOP. This bulletin does not apply.
6. Confirm the engine coolant temperature is between 50°F and 180°F.
7. Perform the P2262 diagnostic test with wiTECH(R), From the "Vehicle View screen select:
a. Select "PCM".
b. Select "Systems Tests".
c. Select "P2262 Fault Diagnosis Test Start".
d. Follow on-screen prompts to complete test.
NOTE:
If you receive an error message from test, confirm that the Diagnostic Link Connector and
turbocharger actuator harness connections are secure. Also confirm that engine coolant
temperature is between 50°F and 180°F, then run the test again.
8. Based on the outcome of the P2262 diagnosis test, the Scan Tool will provide one of the
following as the proper direction for the appropriate repair.
Based on these results, refer to the detailed service information available in DealerCONNECT >
TechCONNECT under: Service Info and complete
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-002-09 > May > 09 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC P2262 Set > Page 7769
the repair as directed;
a. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration. No repair required to the turbocharger.
b. Clean the Turbocharger.
c. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Clean the Turbocharger.
d. Replace the Turbocharger.
e. Update PCM Flash Calibration to the latest calibration and Replace the Turbocharger.
9. Does the vehicle have other DTC's as recorded in Step # 4 above?
a. Yes >> Follow appropriate diagnosis procedures or TSB related to diagnosis and repair of each
fault.
b. No >> Repair complete.
NOTE:
All other DTC's or symptoms MUST be addressed prior to returning the vehicle to the customer.
NOTE:
When/if replacing Turbocharger, p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA must NOT be used on a D1/DH
(Pick Up) models. Turbocharger p/n 68048234AA or 68031095AA are to be used on DA/DC/DM
(Cab/Chassis) ONLY.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh
2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7774
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 7775
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL
ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7780
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7781
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7782
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 7783
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/T
May Default To Neutral
NUMBER: 18-035-07
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: May 18, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 545RFE Transmission Defaults To Neutral
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 (DR/DH/D1/DC) Ram Truck (1500/2500/3500)
2007 (HB/HG) Durango/Aspen
2007 (ND) Dakota
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 545RFE transmission (sale code DGQ) built on or
before March 26, 2007 (MDH 0326XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The transmission may default into neutral gear if the transmission gear selector is moved into
"reverse gear range under certain operating conditions.
The default into neutral gear is done to protect the transmission mechanical components from
potential damage. New PCM software will monitor transmission hydraulic pressure and allow
reverse gear engagement, if the transmission is in "reverse gear range and the transmission
hydraulic pressure is sufficient to support reverse gear operation.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral > Page 7788
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN® must be
programmed with software release level 7.04 SPI or higher. The software release level is visible in
the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN® for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (PCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the PCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
18-035-07 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - A/T May Default To Neutral > Page 7789
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the PCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
09-001-10 > Jul > 10 > Diesel Engine - Dust/Debris Ingestion/Power Upgrade Info > Page 7795
documents for pictures regarding dust-outs.
NOTE:
Canadian dealers can refer to Tech-Tip # 18 - CUMMINS DIESEL ENGINES FAILURES DO TO
DIRTY AIR ENTERING THE INDUCTION SYSTEM - HOW TO INSPECT FOR SIGNS OF A
"DUST OUT" ENGINE FAILURE sent 05/19/2010 for pictures regarding dust-outs.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Perform a compression test. Low compression is generally due to ring/piston/valve issues. High
compression may be due to oil infiltration causing a
hydraulic effect.
2. Major mechanical damage can also be caused by fuel, fuel injectors or "Up-rate kits or
"programmers". Inspect vehicle for any device that adds more
power, (fuel) which may damage the engine mechanically. Check for any aftermarket power
enhancer or "box" or "downloader".Repairs of failures caused by these devices do not qualify for
warranty coverage.
3. Inspect all air handling ducts and components. (See eFiles document). If dirt is found in the air
handling components, further diagnostics may not be
necessary. Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air filter will not qualify for warranty
coverage.
4. Inspect for aftermarket "cold air" performance air filter housing, duct work and filters. Again,
Engines with dirt detected on the "clean side" of air
filter will not qualify for warranty coverage.
5. Inspect cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring ridge. The absence of
cylinder bore cross-hatching MAY be one of the first
signs of cylinder dust or dirt damage. Cylinder bore(s) for cross-hatching and excessive piston ring
ridge may be inspected using a bore scope (if available), or cylinder head removal may be
necessary. Contact your Business Center or Service and Parts Area Manager if dust out evidence
is noticed or any type of tampering is suspected. Dirt carried in through the air handling system is
typically funneled and concentrated to the end (1 & 6) cylinders*. Vertical scratches (broken rings)
will follow. Generally, a properly maintained engine will have well defined hone marks visible
beyond 100,000 miles.
NOTE:
Be aware of stains or marks in cylinder wall(s). Marks may follow the ring gap but have no depth or
damage to the cylinder bore wall. These marks have a look similar to a "scored" cylinder, yet have
no physical damage to the surface and will not cause any harm. These marks be checked by
physically inspecting (scratching) the surface to detect if cylinder wall is damaged (grooved).
6. When inspecting the cylinder bore(s), compare cylinders # 1 & # 6 to the others. Cylinder honing
(cross-hatching) performed in the Cummins
engine manufacturing process is very aggressive. Engines that have dirt introduced will "polish out"
this hone witness mark first and then start cutting or wearing down the cylinder walls which will
create a ring ridge in the cylinder bore at the top of the bore. The absence of the cross-hatching
ALONG WITH dirt found anywhere in the "clean-side" of the air intake system, is evidence of a
dust-out condition.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
Technical Service Bulletin # J35 Date: 100416
Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration
April 2010
Dealer Service Instructions for:
Emissions Recall J35 Reprogram ECM Regeneration Strategy
Effective immediately, all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this
notification. Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 09-086 and Technical Service Bulletin (TSB) #
18-024-09 rev. A have been cancelled. All vehicles that have previously had the above RRT or
TSB completed will require this Recall.
Models
2007-2009 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram Truck (2500/3500 series)
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine (sales code ETJ).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete this
recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The Engine Control Module (ECM) software program on about 159,700 of the above vehicles may
cause illumination of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) when no problem exists or under certain
conditions allow heavy sooting of the turbocharger, exhaust gas recirculation valve and diesel
particulate filter. Heavy sooting could damage emissions components and result in increased
emissions.
Repair
The Engine Control Module must be reprogrammed (flashed).
Parts Information
Due to the likelihood that the required labels are already in your parts inventory, no labels will be
distributed initially. The following label may be ordered as needed.
Each vehicle requires application of the following label:
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7800
The following special tools are required to perform this repair:
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
NOTE:
See the Warranty Administration Manual, Recall Claim Processing Section, for complete recall
claim processing instructions.
Dealer Notification
To view this notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab,
then click on the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7801
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler Group LLC
Service Procedure
NOTE:
Either wiTECH, StarMOBILE or StarSCAN can be used to perform this recall. This procedure must
be performed with software release level 10.02 or higher for wiTECH and Star Mobile applications,
or software release level 9.05 for StarSCAN applications. If the reprogramming flash for the ECM is
aborted or interrupted, repeat the procedure.
A. Reprogram the ECM Using wiTECH:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the wiTECH VCI pod to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column.
3. Place the ignition in the "RUN" position.
4. Open the wiTECH Diagnostic application.
5. Starting at the "Select Tool" screen, select the row/tool for the wiPOD device you are using.
6. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
7. Select the "Next" tab at the bottom of the screen.
8. From the "Vehicle View" screen, click on the PCM icon.
9. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" continue to Step 15. If the part
numbers are not the same, continue to Step 10.
10. With the cursor over the desired flash file, click the small green arrow button on the right side of
the screen.
11. From the "ECU Flash" screen follow the wiTECH screen instructions to complete the flash.
12. Once the flash is complete click the "OK" button on the "ECU Flash" screen.
13. From the "Clear Stored DTC" screen clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) by clicking the
"Clear DTC's button.
14. From the "PCM View" screen, compare the "Current ECU Flash Number" with the "New Part
Number" listed on the "sort table". If the "Current
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7802
ECU Flash Number" is the same as the "New Part Number" the flash is complete. If the part
numbers are not the same, repeat Steps 8 through 14.
15. Turn the ignition to the "OFF" position, remove the wiPOD and battery charger from the vehicle.
16. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications Label.
B. Reprogram the ECM Using StarSCAN:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
3. Connect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the StarSCAN and the vehicle.
4. Place the Ignition in the "RUN" position, then Power "ON" the StarSCAN.
5. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
6. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarSCAN. With the StarSCAN on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 5e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 11.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 6c.
c. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarSCAN screen.
d. Select "Download to Scantool".
e. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
f. Highlight the listed calibration.
g. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
h. When the update is completed, select "OK".
7. Disconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable from the vehicle. Wait until the StarSCAN
screen reads "Vehicle Disconnected", then press
"OK".
8. Reconnect the CH9404D StarSCAN vehicle cable to the vehicle.
9. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarSCAN on the "Home" screen, follow the procedure
below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7803
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
10. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
11. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarSCAN unit, StarSCAN cable,
StarSCAN ethernet cable and battery charger from
the vehicle.
12. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
C. Reprogram the ECM Using StarMOBILE:
CAUTION:
On 2007 model year trucks, verify that Emissions Recall G30 has been completed prior to
performing this notification. Recall G30 contains "bootloader" software that must be installed to
prevent damage to the ECM.
1. Open the hood. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5
volts. Do not allow the charger to time out during the
flash process. Set the battery charger timer (if so equipped) to continuous charge.
NOTE:
Use an accurate stand alone voltmeter. The battery charger volt meter may not be sufficiently
accurate. Voltages outside of the specified range will cause an unsuccessful flash. If voltage
reading is too high, apply an electrical load by activating the park or headlamps and/or HVAC
blower motor to lower the voltage.
2. Connect the StarMOBILE scan tool to the vehicle data link connector located under the steering
column and turn the ignition key to the "RUN"
position.
3. Power ON the StarMOBILE scan tool.
4. From the desktop, launch the "StarMOBILE Desktop Client" software.
5. Establish a connection with the StarMOBILE scan tool.
6. Retrieve the old PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the "Part Number" displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement near the
top of "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
7. Download the flash file from the internet to the StarMOBILE. With the StarMOBILE on the "Flash
PCM" screen, follow the procedure below:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7804
a. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
b. Enter your "User id" and "Password", then select "OK".
c. If the newly downloaded flash file "Part Number" description is the same as the number recorded
in Step 6e, then the PCM is up to date.
Continue to Step 12.
If the part numbers are not the same, continue to Step 7d.
d. Highlight the listed calibration on the StarMOBILE screen.
e. Select "Download to Client".
f. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select the "Back" arrow.
g. Highlight the listed calibration.
h. Select "Update Controller" and follow the on screen instructions.
i. When the update is completed, select "OK".
8. Disconnect the StarMOBILE vehicle cable from the vehicle.
9. Turn off the StarMOBILE scan tool and then restart the scan tool.
NOTE:
The StarMOBILE scan tool must be shut down and restarted to unlock the flash.
10. Retrieve the PCM part number. With the StarMOBILE on the "Home" screen, follow the
procedure below:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "PCM" in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Verify the "Part Number" (displayed at the end of the "Resident flash file for" statement) has
been updated to the new part number. If it has
updated, then the flash has been completed successfully.
11. Clear any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) as follows:
NOTE:
Due to the ECM programming procedure, DTC(s) may be set in other modules (TCM, ABS, BCM,
MIC, WCM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate.
a. From the "Home" screen select "System View".
b. Select "All DTCs".
c. Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the list.
12. Turn the ignition key to the "OFF" position and remove the StarMOBILE unit, StarMOBILE
vehicle cable, and battery charger from the vehicle.
13. Continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modification Label.
D. Install the Authorized Modifications Label:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7805
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, repair modification, dealer code and date
on the Authorized Modifications Label (Figure 1).
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
NOTE:
This recall is subject to the State of California Registration Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement
Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053)
and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of California for proof that this recall has been
performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > J35
> Apr > 10 > Recall - ECM Update For Exhaust Regeneration > Page 7806
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
Technical Service Bulletin # G30 Date: 071001
Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update
October 2007
Dealer Service Instructions for: Emissions Recall G30 Replace Oxygen Sensor Module and
Reprogram ECM
Effective immediately all repairs on involved vehicles are to be performed according to this recall.
Rapid Response Transmittal (RRT) 07-037 and Service Bulletin # 18-033-07 are being cancelled.
Models
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Dodge Ram 2500/3500 Pick Up Truck
NOTE:
This recall applies only to the above vehicles equipped with a 6.7L diesel engine ("A" in the 8th VIN
position) built through August 20, 2007 (MDH 082019).
IMPORTANT:
Some of the involved vehicles may be in dealer new vehicle inventory. Dealers should complete
this recall service on these vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also perform this recall on
vehicles in for service. Involved vehicles can be determined by using the VIP inquiry process.
Subject
The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) system on about 74,000 of the above vehicles may not detect a
failed oxygen sensor or illuminate the Malfunction Indicator Light as required. In addition, the OBD
system may cause these trucks to fail an Inspection Maintenance (Readiness) test and may not
store mileage as required for certain transmission faults.
Repair
The Oxygen Sensor Module must be replaced and the Engine Control Module (ECM) must be
reprogrammed (flashed).
NOTE:
The new software will also improve vehicle driveability and reduce the potential for exhaust soot
accumulation in the vehicle's particulate filter.
Parts Information
Special Tools
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7811
These existing special tools may be required to perform this repair shown.
Completion Reporting and Reimbursement
Claims for vehicles that have been serviced must be submitted on the DealerCONNECT Claim
Entry Screen located on the Service tab. Claims submitted will be used by Chrysler to record recall
service completions and provide dealer payments.
Use one of the labor operation numbers and time allowances shown.
Dealer Notification
All dealers will receive three copies of this dealer recall notification letter by mail. To view this
notification on DealerCONNECT, select "Global Recall System" on the Service tab, then click on
the description of this notification.
Owner Notification and Service Scheduling
All involved vehicle owners known to Chrysler are being notified of the service requirement by first
class mail. They are requested to schedule appointments for this service with their dealers. A
generic copy of the owner letter is included.
Enclosed with each owner letter is an Owner Notification postcard to allow owners to update our
records if applicable.
Vehicle Lists, Global Recall System, VIP and Dealer Follow up
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7812
All involved vehicles have been entered into the DealerCONNECT Global Recall System (GRS)
and Vehicle Information Plus (VIP) for dealer inquiry as needed.
GRS provides involved dealers with an updated VIN list of their incomplete vehicles. The owner's
name, address and phone number are listed if known. Completed vehicles are removed from GRS
within several days of repair claim submission.
To use this system, click on the "Service" tab and then click on "Global Recall System." Your
dealer's VIN list for each recall displayed can be sorted by: those vehicles that were unsold at
recall launch, those with a phone number, city, zip code, or VIN sequence.
Dealers must perform this repair on all unsold vehicles before retail delivery. Dealers should also
use the VIN list to follow up with all owners to schedule appointments for this repair.
Recall VIN lists may contain confidential, restricted owner name and address information that was
obtained from the Department of Motor Vehicles of various states. Use of this information is
permitted for this recall only and is strictly prohibited from all other use.
Additional Information
If you have any questions or need assistance in completing this action, please contact your Service
and Parts District Manager.
Customer Services Field Operations Chrysler LLC
A. Replace the Oxygen Sensor Module
1. Open the hood and disconnect the negative battery cables from both batteries.
2. Using a mechanic's creeper, slide under the right side of the truck and locate the oxygen sensor
module on the outer side of the right frame rail (Figure 1).
3. Disconnect the electrical connector at the oxygen sensor module (Figure 1).
4. Remove the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts (Figure 1).
5. Remove and discard the original oxygen sensor module from frame rail.
6. Position the new oxygen sensor module onto the frame rail.
7. Install the four oxygen sensor module mounting bolts.
8. Tighten the oxygen sensor module mounting bolts to 53 in. lbs. (6 N.m).
9. Connect the oxygen sensor module electrical connector to the module.
10. Connect the negative battery cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7813
11. Continue with Section B - Check ECM Software Level.
B. Check ECM Software Level
1. Connect the StarSCAN to the vehicle.
2. Turn the vehicle ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position (engine not running).
3. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN ethernet cable to the StarSCAN and the dealer's network drop.
4. Power up the StarSCAN and verify that the StarSCAN is at software release 8.03 or higher.
NOTE:
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
5. Starting from the "Home" screen, select "ECU View".
6. Touch the StarSCAN screen to highlight the "PCM Powertrain Control Module" in the list of
modules.
7. Select "More Options".
8. Select "ECU Flash".
9. Record the part number of the Application software file in the ECM.
10. Determine if the application software file part number currently in the ECM is one of the
following part numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits):
If the current application software file part number in the ECM matches one of the above part
numbers (or the same root part number with a higher suffix - last two digits), no further action is
required. Disconnect the StarSCAN and continue with Section D. Install Authorized Modifications
Label.
If the current application software file part number in the ECM does not match one of the above
part numbers, continue with Section C. Program the ECM.
C. Program the ECM
NOTE:
This repair procedure cannot be performed using the StarMOBILE in its standalone mode. Use the
StarSCAN to perform this repair procedure.
NOTE:
Before performing this repair procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher. The software release level is visible in the
blue header at the top of the StarSCAN screen.
CAUTION:
On 2007 model trucks, before the application software can be reprogrammed (flashed) into the
Engine Control Module (ECM), the ECM must first be reprogrammed (flashed) with new
"bootloader" software. Failure to reprogram the ECM with the new "bootloader" software first may
cause the process of reprogramming the ECM with the application software to fail. The ECM
"bootloader" software special flash procedure must be followed exactly to prevent damage to the
ECM.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort - recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be
permanently disabled and will require replacement.
1. Install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides 13.0 to 13.5 volts. If the
battery charger is timer controlled, set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the
charger to time out during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7814
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to exceed 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Make sure the ignition is in the "RUN" position.
3. For 2007 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is required. Continue with Step 4 of
this procedure.
For 2008 model trucks, "bootloader" software replacement is not required. Continue with Step 12 of
this procedure.
4. Erase all flash files from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. From the StarSCAN "Home" screen select "Show Short Cuts" button located in the upper right
corner of the screen.
b. Select "Tool Menu" button in the upper left corner of the screen.
c. Select "Manage Files".
d. Select "More Options".
e. Select "Delete All".
f. Select "Yes" on the pop-up screen.
g. Select "OK" on the pop-up screen.
h. Select "Back" at the "User's Files" menu.
5. Obtain the ECM "Bootloader" software file and download it to the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Select "ECU View".
b. Select "(PCM) Powertrain Control Module" from the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options".
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number of the new application software in the ECM ("Resident Flash File for
Part # xxxxxxxxxx").
f. Select "Browse for New File".
g. Select "OK" at the flash down load screen.
h. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
i. Select "Finish".
j. Highlight the ECM "Bootloader" software file.
CAUTION:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number. DO
NOT select the application software file with the letters "AU" or higher suffix in the last two digits of
its part number.
k. Select "Download to Scantool".
l. Select "Close" on the pop-up screen when the download is complete.
m. Select "Back" one (1) time.
CAUTION:
When performing the "bootloader" section of the repair procedure, DO NOT interrupt the ECM
reprogramming session. This special ECM "bootloader" software reprogramming session does not
support "abort recovery" mode. If "bootloader" software is interrupted, the ECM will be permanently
disabled and will require replacement.
6. Close all doors and turn OFF all accessories (i.e. radio, hvac, lights, etc.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7815
7. Download the "Bootloader" software from the StarSCAN to the vehicle using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the "Bootloader" software selected previously.
NOTE:
The "Bootloader" file will have the letters "BT" in the last two digits (suffix) of its part number.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at ECU flash.
d. Select "OK" at the "Flash Update Successful" screen after the flash process is complete.
e. Select "Back" three (3) times to return to the "ECU View" screen.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position, remove the key from the ignition, and wait two
minutes.
9. Insert the ignition key into the ignition switch and turn the ignition switch to the "RUN" position
(do not start the engine).
10. Confirm that the ECM has the new "Bootloader" software using the following procedure:
a. From the "ECU View" screen, select "PCM" in the list of modules.
b. Select "More Options".
c. Select "ECU Flash".
d. Confirm that the available "Bootloader" software file part number matches the resident flash file
part number in the ECM.
11. Erase the "Bootloader" software file from the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Starting at the "Flash PCM" screen, select "Manage Files".
b. Highlight the "Bootloader" software file listed in the StarSCAN memory.
c. Select "Delete".
d. Select "YES" on the pop-up screen.
e. Select the "BACK" button five (5) times.
12. From the "Home" screen select "ECU View" (select the "BACK" button 4 times if bootloader
was not reprogrammed).
13. Select "PCM Powertrain Control Module".
14. Select "More Options".
15. Select "ECU Flash".
16. Download the ECM application software file to the StarSCAN using the following procedure:
a. Select "Browse for New File".
b. Select "OK" at the Flash Download screen.
c. Enter the required data and select "OK" at the password screen.
d. Select "Finish" at the "Flash Update" screen to display download results.
e. Select the application software file.
NOTE:
The application software file will have suffix letters "AU" or higher for 2007 models or "AG" or
higher for 2008 models (in the last two digits of the part number).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7816
f. Highlight the application software file for download to the StarSCAN.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" at the "Download File" screen when the download is complete.
i. After the file has been downloaded, select "Back" one (1) time.
17. Reprogram the ECM with new application software from the StarSCAN using the following
procedure:
a. Highlight the application software file to be downloaded.
b. Select "Update Controller".
c. Select "OK" at the ECU Flash screen.
d. Wait for the software file to download to the ECM.
e. Select "OK" at the "Flash ECU Successful" screen after the download is complete.
18. Verify that the new software part number on the "Flash PCM" screen matches the downloaded
file.
19. Select "Back" four (4) times to return to the "Home" screen.
20. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
21. Clear all Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) using the following procedure:
a. Place the ignition switch to the "RUN" position (do not start the engine).
b. Select "System View".
c. Select "All DTC's".
d. Select "Clear All Stored DTC's".
e. Select "Yes" at the confirm screen.
f. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position and wait 10 seconds.
g. Start the engine to verify that all DTC's have been erased.
h. Turn the ignition switch to the "OFF" position.
22. Turn off and disconnect the battery charger.
23. Disconnect the StarSCAN from the vehicle and continue with Section D - Install Authorized
Modifications Label.
D. Install Authorized Modifications Label
1. Type or print (with a ballpoint pen) the recall number, dealer code and date on the Authorized
Modifications Label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
G30 > Oct > 07 > Recall - O2 Sensor Replacement/ECM Software Update > Page 7817
2. Attach the label near the VECI label and then close the hood.
3. Complete Proof of Correction Form for California Residents.
Renewal/Emissions Recall Enforcement Program. Complete a Vehicle Emission Recall Proof of
Correction Form (Form No. 81-016-1053) and supply it to vehicle owners residing in the state of
California for proof that this recall has been performed when they renew the vehicle registration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 7825
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
7828
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7833
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7834
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7835
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7836
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7837
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7838
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7839
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7840
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7843
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7844
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7845
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7846
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7847
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7848
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7849
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 7850
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Description > Page 7853
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 7856
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7860
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7861
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7862
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7863
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7864
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7869
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7870
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7871
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7872
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7873
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7874
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7875
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch
Component ID: 17
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Color : LT. BROWN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
5 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
6 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
7 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
8-9-10 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20YL/TN
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7876
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7877
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7878
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7881
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7882
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7883
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7884
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7885
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7886
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7887
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission
Solenoid > Page 7888
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description >
Page 7891
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
7894
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with a Cummins diesel engine, the transmission throttle valve cable has
been replace by the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA). The TTVA consists of an electric
DC motor, two potentiometers, and a gear drive system. The TTVA is mechanically connected to
the transmission throttle valve in the valve body by the "D" shaped opening in the bottom of the
TTVA shaft. Changes in the TTVA position are therefore transferred to the throttle valve and cause
changes in the transmission throttle pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
7898
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
The Transmission Throttle Valve Actuator (TTVA) does not require any mechanical adjustments.
All changes in throttle valve position are controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The TTVA does require an initialization period after the actuator has been removed or replaced.
After the actuator has been removed or replaced, move the ignition to the ON position for thirty (30)
seconds. This will allow the ECM sufficient time to perform the internal calibration procedures to
learn the TTVA's current "zero" position. Once this is done, check the ECM for diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs). If no DTCs are set relating to the TTVA, the TTVA is fully calibrated and ready for
use.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the bolts (2) holding the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) to the
transmission case. 2. Allow the TTVA (1) to rotate clockwise away from the transmission.
3. Remove the wiring connector (2) from the TTVA (1). 4. Lift the TTVA (1) straight upward and off
the throttle valve shaft (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal >
Page 7901
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) over the throttle valve shaft (3). 2.
Align the D-shaped opening in the bottom of the TTVA to the throttle valve shaft and install the
TTVA onto the shaft. 3. Install the wiring connector (2) to the TTVA (1).
4. Rotate the TTVA (1) to the transmission case and install the bolts (2) to hold the TTVA to the
transmission. 5. Tighten the bolts to 8.5 Nm (75 in.lbs.). 6. Initialize the TTVA.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Actuator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove actuator wiring connector. 2. Remove actuator (1) bolts (2).
3. Remove actuator (1) from disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 7907
Actuator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean actuator (1) sealing surface and install new gasket (2) if necessary.
2. Align actuator shift fork (1) with disconnect collar (2) and install actuator on disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 7908
3. Install actuator (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Install disconnect actuator wiring
connector. 5. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Locations Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7913
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7914
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7915
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7916
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7917
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Diagrams Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7920
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7921
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7922
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7923
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Differential > Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle
Disconnect-Front > Page 7924
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7929
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7930
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7931
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7932
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7933
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7935
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7936
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7937
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7938
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7939
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7940
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7941
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7944
torque device. The output of the device is coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and
range forks that change the transfer case operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps
maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7945
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7946
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a high
speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is coupled
to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case operating
ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Front Control Module (FCM) commands to move the
transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case operating mode
indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7947
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV243 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7950
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7951
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV246 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Remove the front propeller shaft. 3. Disengage the
wiring connectors from the shift motor and mode sensor. 4. Remove the bolts (1) holding the shift
motor and mode sensor assembly (2) onto the transfer case.
5. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7952
6. Remove the shift motor isolator (1) from the transfer case (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the shift motor isolator (1) onto the transfer case (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7953
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Install the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) onto the transfer case.
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (2) onto the transfer case.
Tighten the bolts to 23.5 Nm (17 ft.lbs.). 4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and
mode sensor. 5. Install the front propeller shaft. 6. Refill the transfer case as necessary with the
correct fluid for the application. 7. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case > Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 7954
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV273 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7961
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7964
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7969
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7970
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7971
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7972
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7973
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7974
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7975
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7976
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7979
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7980
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7981
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7982
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7983
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7984
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7985
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page
7986
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 7989
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 7992
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7996
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7997
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7998
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 7999
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8000
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8005
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8006
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8007
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8008
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8009
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8010
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8011
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch
Component ID: 17
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Color : LT. BROWN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
5 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
6 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
7 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
8-9-10 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20YL/TN
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8012
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8013
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8014
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8017
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8018
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8019
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8020
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8021
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8022
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8023
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8024
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8027
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8030
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with a Cummins diesel engine, the transmission throttle valve cable has
been replace by the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA). The TTVA consists of an electric
DC motor, two potentiometers, and a gear drive system. The TTVA is mechanically connected to
the transmission throttle valve in the valve body by the "D" shaped opening in the bottom of the
TTVA shaft. Changes in the TTVA position are therefore transferred to the throttle valve and cause
changes in the transmission throttle pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8034
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
The Transmission Throttle Valve Actuator (TTVA) does not require any mechanical adjustments.
All changes in throttle valve position are controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The TTVA does require an initialization period after the actuator has been removed or replaced.
After the actuator has been removed or replaced, move the ignition to the ON position for thirty (30)
seconds. This will allow the ECM sufficient time to perform the internal calibration procedures to
learn the TTVA's current "zero" position. Once this is done, check the ECM for diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs). If no DTCs are set relating to the TTVA, the TTVA is fully calibrated and ready for
use.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the bolts (2) holding the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) to the
transmission case. 2. Allow the TTVA (1) to rotate clockwise away from the transmission.
3. Remove the wiring connector (2) from the TTVA (1). 4. Lift the TTVA (1) straight upward and off
the throttle valve shaft (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8037
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) over the throttle valve shaft (3). 2.
Align the D-shaped opening in the bottom of the TTVA to the throttle valve shaft and install the
TTVA onto the shaft. 3. Install the wiring connector (2) to the TTVA (1).
4. Rotate the TTVA (1) to the transmission case and install the bolts (2) to hold the TTVA to the
transmission. 5. Tighten the bolts to 8.5 Nm (75 in.lbs.). 6. Initialize the TTVA.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Accumulator: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The valve body consists of a cast aluminum valve body, a separator plate, and transfer plate. The
valve body contains valves and check balls that control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch,
bands, and frictional clutches. The valve body contains the following components.
By adjusting the spring pressure acting on the regulator valve, transmission line pressure can be
adjusted.
Upper Housing Control Valve Locations
- Regulator valve (2)
- Switch valve (3)
- Regulator valve spring (4)
- Kickdown valve (5)
- Kickdown detent (6)
- Throttle valve and spring (7)
- Manual valve (8)
- 1-2 Governor plug (9)
- Throttle pressure plug (11)
- 2-3 Governor plug (12)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8042
- Shuttle valve primary spring (13)
Shuttle and Boost Valve Locations
- Boost Valve (3)
- Boost valve plug (4)
- Shuttle valve (9)
- Shuttle valve throttle plug (12)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8043
Upper Housing Shift Valve and Pressure Plug Locations
- 1-2 shift valve (2)
- 1-2 control valve
- 2-3 shift valve
- 2-3 throttle plug
- Throttle pressure plug
- Limit valve and spring
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8044
Lower Housing Shift Valves and Springs
- 3-4 shift valve
- 3-4 timing valve
- 3-4 quick fill valve
- 3-4 accumulator
- Converter clutch lock-up valve
- Converter clutch lock-up timing valve
Operation
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for a visual aid in determining valve location, operation
and design.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8045
CHECK BALLS
REGULATOR VALVE
Regulator Valve in Park Position
The pressure regulator valve is needed to control the hydraulic pressure within the system and
reduce the amount of heat produced in the fluid. The pressure regulator valve is located in the
valve body near the manual valve. The pressure regulator valve train controls the maximum
pressure in the lines by metering the dumping of fluid back into the sump. Regulated pressure is
referred to as "line pressure."
The regulator valve has a spring on one end that pushes the valve to the left. This closes a dump
(vent) that is used to lower pressure. The closing of the dump will cause the oil pressure to
increase. Oil pressure on the opposite end of the valve pushes the valve to the right, opening the
dump and lowering oil pressure. The result is spring pressure working against oil pressure to
maintain the oil at specific pressures. With the engine running, fluid flows from the pump to the
pressure regulator valve, manual valve, and the interconnected circuits. As fluid is sent through
passages to the regulator valve, the pressure pushes the valve to the right against the large spring.
It is also sent to the reaction areas on the left side of the throttle pressure plug and the line
pressure plug. With the gear selector in the PARK position, fluid recirculates through the regulator
and manual valves back to the sump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8046
Regulator Valve in Neutral Position
Meanwhile, the torque converter is filled slowly. In all other gear positions, fluid flows between two
right side lands to the switch valve and torque converter. At low pump speeds, the flow is controlled
by the pressure valve groove to reduce pressure to the torque converter. After the torque converter
and switch valve fill with fluid, the switch valve becomes the controlling metering device for torque
converter pressure. The regulator valve then begins to control the line pressure for the other
transmission circuits. The balance of the fluid pressure pushing the valve to the right and the spring
pressure pushing to the left determines the size of the metering passage at land #2 (land #1 being
at the far right of the valve in the diagram). As fluid leaks past the land, it moves into a groove
connected to the filter or sump. As the land meters the fluid to the sump, it causes the pressure to
reduce and the spring decreases the size of the metering passage. When the size of the metering
passage is reduced, the pressure rises again and the size of the land is increased again. Pressure
is regulated by this constant balance of hydraulic and spring pressure.
Regulator Valve in Drive Position
The metering at land #2 establishes the line pressure throughout the transmission. It is varied
according to changes in throttle position and the transmission's internal condition within a range of
57-94 psi (except in REVERSE).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8047
Regulator Valve in Reverse Position
The regulated line pressure in REVERSE is held at much higher pressures than in the other gear
positions: 145-280 psi. The higher pressure for REVERSE is achieved by the manual valve
blocking the supply of line pressure to the reaction area left of land #4. With this pressure blocked,
there is less area for pressure to act on to balance the force of the spring on the right. This allows
line pressure to push the valve train to the right, reducing the amount of fluid returned to the
pump's inlet, increasing line pressure.
KICKDOWN VALVE
Kickdown Valve - Wide Open Throttle
When the throttle valve is as far over to the left as it can go, the maximum line pressure possible
will enter the throttle pressure circuit. In this case, throttle pressure will equal line pressure. With
the kickdown valve pushed into the bore as far as it will go, fluid initially flows through the annular
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8048
groove of the 2-3 shift valve (which will be in the direct drive position to the right).
After passing the annular groove, the fluid is routed to the spring end of the 2-3 shift valve. Fluid
pressure reacting on the area of land #1 overcomes governor pressure, downshifting the 2-3 shift
valve into the kickdown, or second gear stage of operation. The valve is held in the kickdown
position by throttle pressure routed from a seated check ball (#2). Again, if vehicle speed is low
enough, throttle pressure will also push the 1-2 shift valve left to seat its governor plug, and
downshift to drive breakaway.
KICKDOWN LIMIT VALVE
Kickdown Limit Valve - Low Speeds
The purpose of the limit valve is to prevent a 3-2 downshift at higher speeds when a part-throttle
downshift is not desirable. At these higher speeds only a full throttle 3-2 downshift will occur. At low
road speeds the limit valve does not come into play and does not affect the downshifts.
Kickdown Limit Valve - High Speeds
As the vehicle's speed increases, the governor pressure also increases. The increased governor
pressure acts on the reaction area of the bottom land of the limit valve overcoming the spring force
trying to push the valve toward the bottom of its bore. This pushes the valve upward against the
spring and bottoms the valve against the top of the housing. With the valve bottomed against the
housing, the throttle pressure supplied to the valve will be closed off by the bottom land of the limit
valve. When the supply of throttle pressure has been shut off, the 3-2 part throttle downshift plug
becomes inoperative, because no pressure is acting on its reaction area.
1-2 SHIFT VALVE
1-2 Shift Valve - Before Shift
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8049
The 1-2 shift valve assembly, or mechanism, consists of: the 1-2 shift valve, governor plug, and a
spring on the end of the valve. After the manual valve has been placed into a forward gear range,
line pressure is directed to the 1-2 shift valve. As the throttle is depressed, throttle pressure is
applied to the right side of the 1-2 shift valve assembly. With throttle pressure applied to the right
side of the valve, there is now both spring pressure and throttle pressure acting on the valve,
holding it against the governor plug. As the vehicle begins to move and build speed, governor
pressure is created and is applied to the left of the valve at the governor plug.
1-2 Shift Valve - After Shift
When governor pressure builds to a point where it can overcome the combined force of the spring
and throttle pressure on the other side of the valve, the valve will begin to move over to the right.
As the valve moves to the right, the middle land of the valve will close off the circuit supplying the
throttle pressure to the right side of the valve. When the throttle pressure is closed off, the valve will
move even farther to the right, allowing line pressure to enter another circuit and energize the front
servo, applying the front band.
The governor plug serves a dual purpose:
- It allows the shift valves to move either left or right, allowing both upshifts and downshifts.
- When in a manual selection position, it will be hydraulically "blocked" into position so no upshift
can occur.
The physical blocking of the upshift while in the manual "1" position is accomplished by the
directing of line pressure between both lands of the governor plug. The line pressure reacts against
the larger land of the plug, pushing the plug back against the end plate overcoming governor
pressure. With the combination of the line pressure and spring pressure, the valve cannot move,
preventing any upshift.
1-2 SHIFT CONTROL VALVE
1-2 Shift Control Valve
It contains a valve with four lands and a spring. It is used as both a "relay" and "balanced" valve.
The valve has two specific operations:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8050
- Aid in quality of the 1-2 upshift.
- Aid in the quality and timing of the 3-2 kickdown ranges.
When the manual valve is set to the DRIVE position and the transmission is in the first or second
gear range, 1-2 shift control or "modulated throttle pressure" is supplied to the middle of the
accumulator piston by the 1-2 shift control valve. During the 1-2 upshift, this pressure is used to
control the kickdown servo apply pressure that is needed to apply the kickdown and accumulator
pistons. Thus, the 1-2 shift point is "cushioned" and the quality is improved. During a WOT
kickdown, kickdown pressure is applied between the kickdown valve and the 1-2 shift control valve.
This additional pressure is directed to the 1-2 shift control's spring cavity, adding to the spring load
on the valve. The result of this increased "modulated" throttle pressure is a firmer WOT upshift.
2-3 SHIFT VALVE
2-3 Shift Valve - Before Shift
The 2-3 shift valve mechanism consists of the 2-3 shift valve, governor plug and spring, and a
throttle plug. After the 1-2 shift valve has completed its operation and applied the front band, line
pressure is directed to the 2-3 shift valve through the connecting passages from the 1-2 shift valve.
The line pressure will then dead-end at land #2 until the 2-3 valve is ready to make its shift. Now
that the vehicle is in motion and under acceleration, there is throttle pressure being applied to the
spring side of the valve and between lands #3 and #4.
2-3 Shift Valve - After Shift
As vehicle speed increases, governor pressure increases proportionately, until it becomes great
enough to overcome the combined throttle and spring pressure on the right side of the valve. Since
the throttle pressure end of the 2-3 shift valve is larger in diameter than the 1-2 shift valve, the 2-3
shift will always happen at a greater speed than the 1-2 shift. When this happens, the governor
plug is forced against the shift valve moving it to the right. The shift valve causes land #4 to close
the passage supplying throttle pressure to the 2-3 shift valve. Without throttle pressure present in
the circuit now, the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8051
governor plug will push the valve over far enough to bottom the valve in its bore. This allows land
#2 to direct line pressure to the front clutch.
After the shift, line pressure is directed to the release side of the kickdown servo. This releases the
front band and applies the front clutch, shifting into third gear or direct drive. The rear clutch
remains applied, as it has been in the other gears. During a manual "1" or manual "2" gear
selection, line pressure is sent between the two lands of the 2-3 governor plug. This line pressure
at the governor plug locks the shift valve into the second gear position, preventing an upshift into
direct drive. The theory for the blocking of the valve is the same as that of the 1-2 shift valve.
If the manual "2" or manual "1" gear position is selected from the drive position, the PCM will
control the timing of the downshift by targeting for a high governor pressure. When a safe vehicle
speed is reached, the PCM will switch to its normal control governor curve and the downshift will
occur.
3-4 SHIFT VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
The PCM energizes the overdrive solenoid during the 3-4 upshift. This causes the solenoid check
ball to close the vent port allowing line pressure from the 2-3 shift valve to act directly on the 3-4
upshift valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8052
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
Line pressure on the 3-4 shift valve overcomes valve spring pressure moving the valve to the
upshift position. This action exposes the feed passages to the 3-4 timing valve, 3-4 quick fill valve,
3-4 accumulator, and ultimately to the overdrive piston.
3-4 TIMING VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
The 3-4 timing valve is moved by line pressure coming through the 3-4 shift valve or the converter
clutch valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8053
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
After the shift, the timing valve holds the 2-3 shift valve in an upshift position. The purpose is to
prevent the 2-3 valve from downshifting while either the overdrive clutch or converter clutch is
applied.
3-4 QUICK FILL VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
The 3-4 quick fill valve provides faster engagement of the overdrive clutch during 3-4 upshifts. The
valve temporarily bypasses the clutch piston feed orifice at the start of a 3-4 upshift.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8054
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
This exposes a larger passage into the piston retainer resulting in a much faster clutch fill and
apply sequence. The quick fill valve does not bypass the regular clutch feed orifice throughout the
3-4 upshift. Instead, once a predetermined pressure develops within the clutch, the valve closes
the bypass. Clutch fill is then completed through the regular feed orifice.
THROTTLE VALVE
Throttle Valve
In all gear positions, the throttle valve is being supplied with line pressure. The throttle valve meters
and reduces the line pressure that now becomes throttle pressure. The throttle valve is moved by a
spring and the kickdown valve, which is mechanically connected to the throttle. The larger the
throttle opening, the higher the throttle pressure (to a maximum of line pressure). The smaller the
throttle opening, the lower the throttle pressure (to a minimum of zero at idle). As engine speed
increases, the increase in pump speed increases pump output. The increase in pressure and
volume must be regulated to maintain the balance within the transmission. To do this, throttle
pressure is routed to the reaction area on the right side of the throttle pressure plug (in the
regulator valve).
The higher engine speed and line pressure would open the vent too far and reduce line pressure
too much. Throttle pressure, which increases with engine speed (throttle opening), is used to
oppose the movement of the pressure valve to help control the metering passage at the vent. The
throttle pressure is combined with spring pressure to reduce the force of the throttle pressure plug
on the pressure valve. The larger spring at the right closes the regulator valve passage and
maintains or increases line pressure. The increased line pressure works against the reaction area
of the line pressure plug and the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8055
reaction area left of land #3 simultaneously moves the regulator valve train to the right and controls
the metering passage.
The kickdown valve, along with the throttle valve, serve to delay upshifts until the correct vehicle
speed has been reached. It also controls downshifts upon driver demand, or increased engine
load. If these valves were not in place, the shift points would be at the same speed for all throttle
positions. The kickdown valve is actuated by a cam connected to the throttle. This is accomplished
through either a linkage or a cable. The cam forces the kickdown valve toward the throttle valve
compressing the spring between them and moving the throttle valve. As the throttle valve land
starts to uncover its port, line pressure is "metered" out into the circuits and viewed as throttle
pressure. This increased throttle pressure is metered out into the circuits it is applied to: the 1-2
and 2-3 shift valves. When the throttle pressure is high enough, a 3-2 downshift will occur. If the
vehicle speed is low enough, a 2-1 downshift will occur.
SWITCH VALVE
Switch Valve - Torque Converter Unlocked
When the transmission is in Drive Second before the TCC application occurs, the pressure
regulator valve is supplying torque converter pressure to the switch valve. The switch valve directs
this pressure through the transmission input shaft, into the converter, through the converter, back
out between the input shaft and the reaction shaft, and back up to the switch valve. From the
switch valve, the fluid pressure is directed to the transmission cooler, and lubrication pressure
returns from the cooler to lubricate different portions of the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8056
Switch Valve - Torque Converter Locked
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is a relay valve. The purpose of the manual valve is to direct fluid to the correct
circuit needed for a specific gear or driving range. The manual valve, as the name implies, is
manually operated by the driver with a lever located on the side of the valve body. The valve is
connected mechanically by either a cable or linkage to the gearshift mechanism. The valve is held
in each of its positions by a spring-loaded roller or ball that engages the "roostercomb" of the
manual valve lever.
Manual Valve
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8057
Once the TCC control valve has moved to the right, line pressure is directed to the tip of the switch
valve, forcing the valve to the right. The switch valve now vents oil from the front of the piston in the
torque converter, and supplies line pressure to the (rear) apply side of the torque converter piston.
This pressure differential causes the piston to apply against the friction material, cutting off any
further flow of line pressure oil. After the switch valve is shuttled right allowing line pressure to
engage the TCC, torque converter pressure is directed past the switch valve into the transmission
cooler and lubrication circuits.
CONVERTER CLUTCH LOCK-UP VALVE
The torque converter clutch (TCC) lock-up valve controls the back (ON) side of the torque
converter clutch. When the PCM energizes the TCC solenoid to engage the converter clutch
piston, pressure is applied to the TCC lock-up valve which moves to the right and applies pressure
to the torque converter clutch.
CONVERTER CLUTCH LOCK-UP TIMING VALVE
The torque converter clutch (TCC) lock-up timing valve is there to block any 4-3 downshift until the
TCC is completely unlocked and the clutch is disengaged.
SHUTTLE VALVE
The assembly is contained in a bore in the valve body above the shift valves. When the manual
valve is positioned in the Drive range, throttle pressure acts on the throttle plug of the shuttle valve
to move it against a spring, increasing the spring force on the shuttle valve. During a part or full
throttle 1-2 upshift, the throttle plug is bottomed by throttle pressure, holding the shuttle valve to the
right against governor pressure, and opening a by-pass circuit. The shuttle valve controls the
quality of the kickdown shift by restricting the rate of fluid discharge from the front clutch and servo
release circuits. During a 3-2 kickdown, fluid discharges through the shuttle by-pass circuit. When
the shuttle valve closes the by-pass circuit, fluid discharge is restricted and controlled for the
application of the front band. During a 2-3 "lift foot" upshift, the shuttle valve by-passes the
restriction to allow full fluid flow through the by-pass groove for a faster release of the band.
BOOST VALVE
Boost Valve Before Lock-up
The boost valve provides increased fluid apply pressure to the overdrive clutch during 3-4 upshifts,
and when accelerating in fourth gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8058
Boost Valve After Lock-up
The boost valve also serves to increase line pressure during torque converter lock-up.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8059
Accumulator: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
Valve Body Components
The valve body consists of a cast aluminum valve body, a separator plate, and a transfer plate. The
valve body contains valves and check balls that control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch
and frictional clutches. The valve body contains the following components:
- Solenoid switch valve
- Manual valve
- Low/reverse shuttle valve
- 5 Accumulators
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8060
Check Ball Locations
- 7 check balls
Operation
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for a visual aid in determining valve location, operation
and design.
SOLENOID SWITCH VALVE
The Solenoid Switch Valve (SSV) controls the direction of the transmission fluid when the L/R-TCC
solenoid is energized.
The Solenoid Switch Valve controls line pressure from the LR-TCC solenoid. In 1st gear, the SSV
will be in the downshifted position, thus directing fluid to the L/R clutch circuit. In all other gears, the
solenoid switch valve will be in the upshifted position and directs the fluid into the torque converter
clutch (TCC) circuit.
When shifting into 1st gear, a special hydraulic sequence is performed to ensure SSV movement
into the downshifted position. The L/R pressure switch is monitored to confirm SSV movement. If
the movement is not confirmed (the L/R pressure switch does not close), 2nd gear is substituted for
1st. A DTC will be set after three unsuccessful attempts are made to get into 1st gear in one given
key start.
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is a relay valve. The purpose of the manual valve is to direct fluid to the correct
circuit needed for a specific gear or driving range. The manual valve, as the name implies, is
manually operated by the driver with a lever located on the top of the valve body. The valve is
connected mechanically to the gearshift mechanism. The valve is held in each of its positions by a
roller detent spring (2) that engages the roostercomb of the TRS selector plate (1).
LOW/REVERSE SWITCH VALVE
The low/reverse switch valve allows the low/reverse clutch to be operated by either the LR/CC
solenoid or the MS solenoid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8061
Accumulator: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The valve body consists of a two piece aluminum valve body. Extensive electronic control effected
by a microcomputer (the automatic transmission electronic control unit) over the hydraulic circuitry
enables precise control over gearshifts. The valve body contains valves and pressure sensors that
control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch, forward clutches, and brake clutches.
UPPER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
The upper valve body contains the following components:
- 1 = Combined Drain
- 2 = Gain change solenoid valve
- 3 = Manual valve
- 4 = Modulator valve
- 5 = Shift solenoid valve No. 3
- 6 = Shift solenoid valve No. 2
- 7 = Shift valve No. 1
LOWER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8062
LOWER VALVE BODY
The lower valve body contains the following components:
- 1 = Control valve No. 3
- 2 = Shift solenoid valve No. 4
- 3 = Lockup control valve
- 4 = Control valve No. 1
- 5 = Control valve No. 2
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8063
VALVE BODY OIL SWITCH HARNESS
There are eight pressure switches and one ATF temperature switch used to inform the
Transmission Control Module (TCM) when there is pressure in various hydraulic circuits. Six of
them are located on the bottom of the valve body. The remainder are located on the top of the
valve body.
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8064
VALVE BODY SOLENOID HARNESS
Eight solenoids are used to control various shift functions in the transmission. Four are located on
the top of the valve body (3, 4) and the remainder are located on the bottom of the valve body.
Operation
OPERATION
LOWER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8065
LOWER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8066
UPPER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8067
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
VALVE BODY OIL SWITCH HARNESS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8068
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
VALVE BODY SOLENOID HARNESS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Accumulator, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8069
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 >
A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 >
A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8078
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 >
A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8079
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 >
A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 >
A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8084
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 >
A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8085
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 >
A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8086
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 >
A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8087
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 >
Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 >
Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8093
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 >
Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8094
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A >
Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A >
Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8099
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A >
Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8100
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A >
Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8101
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A >
Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8102
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8103
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8104
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8105
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8106
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8107
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8108
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8109
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8110
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8111
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8112
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
On gasoline vehicles the Transmission Control Module (TCM) (2) may be sub-module within the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) (3).
68RFE TCM LOCATION
Vehicles equipped 68RFE transmission and a 6.7L Diesel engine, the TCM is housed in the NGC4
controller utilizing only the C1 and C4 connectors (TCM only). The controller is located at the rear
of the engine compartment, near the right inner fender.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8115
AS68RC TCM LOCATION
On Cab Chassis models equipped with the AS68RC transmission the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) has three electrical connectors and is located in the passenger compartment underneath of
the left side of the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8116
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
RLE and RFE TRANSMISSIONS
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) (if equipped)
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Line Pressure Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids
- Torque Reduction Request
Some examples of TCM indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool)
NOTE: If the TCM has been replaced, the "Quick Learn Procedure" must be performed.
BATTERY FEED
A fused, direct battery feed to the TCM is used for continuous power. This battery voltage is
necessary to retain memory in the TCM. When the battery (B+) is disconnected, this memory is
lost. When the battery (B+) is restored, this memory loss is detected by the TCM and a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) is set.
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEXES (CVI)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8117
An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transmission gear position. This is important
to the CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the input clutch assembly can cause inadequate or
out-of-range element volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following charts identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8118
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8119
SHIFT SCHEDULES
As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules.
Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8120
AISIN AS68RC TRANSMISSION
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Speed Sensor
- Output Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Engine/Body Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8121
- Manifold Pressure
- Throttle position
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Brake Status (if equipped)
- PTO Request (if equipped)
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Exhaust Brake Cut Request (if equipped).
- Solenoids.
- Torque Reduction Request.
Some examples of TCM .indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM).
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN).
- PTO Status.
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI).
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules.
- System self-diagnostics.
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool).
Clutch filling time is continuously maintained when the vehicle is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
Differential Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Automatic
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information > Page 8127
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8132
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8133
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - ATF + 4 Fluid Usage
NUMBER: 21-014-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: October 16, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 21-010-06, DATED APRIL 14,
2006, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES THE ADDITION OF THE ASIAN
WARNER (AW4) TRANSMISSION AND ADDITIONAL MODELS AND YEARS.
SUBJECT: Automatic Transmission Fluid Usage ATF+4 (Type M59602)
MODELS:
1989 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1989 - 2003 (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1989 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1989 - 1993 (AD) Ram Truck
1989 - 1994 (AG) Daytona
1989 (AH) Lancer/Lebaron GTS
1989 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Lebaron Convertible
1989 - 1990 (AK) Aries/Reliant
1989 - 1990 (AL) Horizon/Omni
1989 (AM) Diplomat/Gran Fury/New Yorker fifth Avenue
1989 - 2004 (AN) Dakota
1989 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Sundance
1990 - 1991 (AQ) Maserati
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - 2003 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2004 - **2008** (CS) Pacifica
1998-2003 (DN) Durango
2002 - **2008** (DR/DH/D1) Ram Truck
2007 - **2008** (DC) Ram 3500 Cab Chassis
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Sebring/Avenger/Talon
1996 - 2000 (GS) Chrysler Voyager (International Market)
2004 - **2008** (HB) Durango
**2008 (HG) Aspen**
1995 - 2000 (JA) Cirrus/Stratus/Breeze
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8134
2007 - **2008** (JK) Wrangler
2001 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - **2008** (JS) Avenger/Sebring/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
**2007 - 2008 (KA) Nitro**
2002 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
**2008 (KK) Liberty**
**2008 (L2) 300C (China)**
1993 - 2004 (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker /300M
2005 - **2008** (LX/LE) 300/Magnum/Charger
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - 2005 (PL) Neon
2002 - 2003 (PG) PT Cruiser (International Markets)
2001 - **2008** (PT) PT Cruiser
1997 - 2002 (PR) Prowler
2001 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2001 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**2008 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan/Grand Voyager (U.S. & International Markets)**
1997-2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2001 - 2004 (WG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets) Vehicles equipped with Gas engines
1999 - 2004 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
2005 - **2008** (WK/WH) Grand Cherokee
2006 - **2008** (XK/XH) Commander
1989 - 1995 (YJ) Wrangler
**1989 - 2001 (XJ) Cherokee**
**1989 - 1993 (MJ) Comanche**
1996 - 1998 (ZG) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
1994 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
**AWA (Asian Warner) transmission are now included in this Service Bulletin. ATF+4(R) is
recommended for AW-4 (Asian Warner) transmissions**
NOTE:
This Service Bulletin DOES NOT apply to Sprinter transmissions, Crossfire transmissions, MK/PM
vehicles equipped with Continuously Variable
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8135
Transmission (CVT) and WG vehicles equipped with a diesel engine (sales code ENF) and a
W5J400 or NAG1 transmission (sales code DGJ).
DISCUSSION:
ATF+4(R) - (Type 9602) is being used as factory fill for Chrysler Group automatic transmissions.
ATF+4(R) is recommended for all vehicles equipped with Chrysler Group automatic transmissions
EXCEPT FOR THOSE LISTED IN THE NOTE ABOVE.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) must always be used in vehicles that were originally filled with ATF+4(R). DO NOT USE
ANY OTHER FLUID.
NOTE:
ATF+4(R) is backward compatible with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+. Additionally, ATF+4(R) can be
used to top off vehicles that used ATF+3, ATF+2, or ATF+.
NOTE:
If ATF+4® is used to service models originally filled with ATF+3, ATF+2, and ATF+ the fluid
maintenance schedules listed for that model does not change. The service interval currently in
effect for a given model should continue to be followed. Refer to the Service or Owners manual for
maintenance schedule directions.
In general terms, If ATF+, ATF+2 or ATF+3 was the recommended fluid, it is now recommended to
use ATF+4®
BENEFITS
^ Better anti-wear properties
^ Improved rust/corrosion prevention
^ Controls oxidation
^ Eliminates deposits
^ Controls friction
^ Retains anti-foaming properties
^ Superior properties for low temperature operation
FLUID COLOR
Mopar ATF+4(R) has exceptional durability. However, the red dye used in ATF+4(R) is not
permanent; as the fluid ages it may become darker or appear brown in color. ATF+4(R) also has a
unique odor that may change with age. With ATF+4(R) fluid, color and odor are no longer
indicators of fluid condition and do not necessarily support a fluid change.
PARTS REQUIRED:
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Service Fill - 42RLE .............................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.8L (4.0 Quarts) Overhaul Fill - 42RLE ......................................
........................................................................................................................................... 8.3L (8.7
Quarts)
Service Fill - 45RFE/545RFE 4X2
..............................................................................................................................................................
5.2L (5.5 Quarts) 4X4 ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................... 6.2L (6.5 Quarts) Overhaul - 45RFE/545RFE
....................................................................................................................................................... 14
-16L (14.8-16.9 Quarts)
Service Fill - 48RE ...............................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.8L (4.0 Quarts) Overhaul - 48RE ..............................................
..................................................................................................................... 14 - 16L (14.8 - 16.9
Quarts)
Service Fill - 68RFE 4X2 .....................................................................................................................
....................................................... 5.2L (5.5 Quarts) 4X4 ..................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ 6.2L (6.5
Quarts) Overhaul - 68RFE ...................................................................................................................
............................................ 15.6 - 16.6L (16.4 - 17.5 Quarts)
Service Fill - AS68RC ..........................................................................................................................
....................................................... 6.8L (7.2 Quarts) Overhaul - AS68RC .........................................
......................................................................................................................................... 13L (13.74
Quarts)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 8138
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Automatic Transmission Fluid .............................................................................................................
.......................................................... Mopar ATF +4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure. 2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and auxiliary cooler. This
condition is usually the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged oil cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
3. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
- engine coolant entering the fluid
- internal failure that generates debris
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This
is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8141
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 48RE Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has two primary causes.
1. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. This condition is usually
the result of a faulty or improperly installed
drainback valve, a damaged oil cooler, or severe restrictions in the coolers and lines caused by
debris or kinked lines.
2. Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer
towing or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level
- engine coolant entering the fluid
- internal failure that generates debris
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown)
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should also be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This
is necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8142
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Effects Of Incorrect Fluid Level
EFFECTS OF INCORRECT FLUID LEVEL
A low fluid level allows the pump to take in air along with the fluid. Air in the fluid will cause fluid
pressures to be low and develop slower than normal. If the transmission is overfilled, the gears
churn the fluid into foam. This aerates the fluid and causing the same conditions occurring with a
low level. In either case, air bubbles cause fluid overheating, oxidation, and varnish buildup which
interferes with valve and clutch operation. Foaming also causes fluid expansion which can result in
fluid overflow from the transmission vent or fill tube. Fluid overflow can easily be mistaken for a
leak if inspection is not careful.
Causes Of Burnt Fluid
CAUSES OF BURNT FLUID
Burnt, discolored fluid is a result of overheating which has three primary causes.
1. Internal clutch slippage, usually caused by low line pressure, inadequate clutch apply pressure,
or clutch seal failure. 2. A result of restricted fluid flow through the main and/or auxiliary cooler. 3.
Heavy duty operation with a vehicle not properly equipped for this type of operation. Trailer towing
or similar high load operation will overheat
the transmission fluid if the vehicle is improperly equipped. Such vehicles should have an auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler, a heavy duty cooling system, and the engine/axle ratio combination
needed to handle heavy loads.
Fluid Contamination
FLUID CONTAMINATION
Transmission fluid contamination is generally a result of:
- adding incorrect fluid.
- failure to clean dipstick and fill tube when checking level.
- engine coolant entering the fluid.
- internal failure that generates debris.
- overheat that generates sludge (fluid breakdown).
- failure to replace contaminated converter after repair.
The use of non-recommended fluids can result in transmission failure. The usual results are erratic
shifts, slippage, abnormal wear and eventual failure due to fluid breakdown and sludge formation.
Avoid this condition by using recommended fluids only.
The dipstick cap and fill tube should be wiped clean before checking fluid level. Dirt, grease and
other foreign material on the cap and tube could fall into the tube if not removed beforehand. Take
the time to wipe the cap and tube clean before withdrawing the dipstick.
Engine coolant in the transmission fluid is generally caused by a cooler malfunction. The only
remedy is to replace the radiator as the cooler in the radiator is not a serviceable part. If coolant
has circulated through the transmission, an overhaul is necessary.
The torque converter should be replaced whenever a failure generates sludge and debris. This is
necessary because normal converter flushing procedures will not remove all contaminants.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmssion has too much fluid, the
geartrain churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. It is located on the right side of the engine. Be
sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P (PARK) and N (NEUTRAL) positions. Place the selector
lever in P (PARK) to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at
idle speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating
temperature (approximately 82° C. or 180° F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region
(cross-hatched area) on the oil level indicator. The fluid level will be approximately at the upper
COLD hole of the dipstick at 21° C (70° F) fluid temperature.
FILL TUBE EQUIPPED WITH INDICATOR
NOTE: Engine and Transmission should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure. After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into PARK. 5. Hook up scan tool and select transmission. 6. Select sensors. 7. Read
the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the Transmission Fluid
Temperature Chart.
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8145
transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
CAPPED FILL TUBE
1. Verify that the vehicle is parked on a level surface. 2. Remove the dipstick tube cap.
WARNING: There is a risk of accident from vehicle starting off by itself when engine is running.
There is a risk of injury from contusions and burns if you insert your hands into the engine when it
is started or when it is running. Secure vehicle to prevent it from moving off by itself. Wear properly
fastened and close-fitting work clothes. Do not touch hot or rotating parts.
3. Actuate the service brake. Start engine and let it run at idle speed in selector lever position "P".
4. Shift through the transmission modes several times with the vehicle stationary and the engine
idling. 5. Warm up the transmission, wait at least 2 minutes and check the oil level with the engine
running. Push the Oil Dipstick 9336 into transmission fill
tube until the dipstick tip contacts the oil pan and pull out again, read off oil level, repeat if
necessary.
NOTE: The dipstick will protrude from the fill tube when installed.
6. Check transmission oil temperature using the appropriate scan tool.
NOTE: The true transmission oil temperature can only be read by a scan tool in REVERSE or any
forward gear position.
7. The transmission Oil Dipstick 9336 has indicator marks every 10 mm. Determine the height of
the oil level on the dipstick and using the height,
the transmission temperature, and the Transmission Fluid Graph, determine if the transmission oil
level is correct.
8. Add or remove oil as necessary and recheck the oil level. 9. Once the oil level is correct, install
the dipstick tube cap.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan. 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission. 4. Loosen
bolts holding rear of pan to transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8146
5. Slowly separate front of pan away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6.
Hold up pan and remove remaining bolts holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level,
lower pan away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
9. Remove the screw holding the primary oil filter (1) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and oil pump and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Inspect
the oil filter seal in the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is not installed completely in the oil pump,
or is otherwise damaged, then remove
and discard the oil filter seal from the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is installed correctly and is
in good condition, it can be reused.
12. If replacing the cooler return filter (2), use Oil Filter Wrench 8321 to remove the filter from the
transmission. 13. Dispose of used trans fluid and filter(s) properly.
INSPECTION
Inspect bottom of pan and magnet for excessive amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material
on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition
or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the
diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8147
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
CAUTION: The primary oil filter seal MUST be fully installed flush against the oil pump body. DO
NOT install the seal onto the filter neck and attempt to install the filter and seal as an assembly.
Damage to the transmission will result.
1. If necessary, install a new primary oil filter seal in the oil pump inlet bore. Seat the seal in the
bore with Installer 6960-A or another suitable tool
(appropriately sized drift or socket, the butt end of a hammer etc.).
2. Place replacement filter in position on valve body and into the oil pump. 3. Install screw to hold
the primary oil filter (1) to valve body. Tighten screw to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Install new
cooler return filter (2) onto the transmission, if necessary. Torque the filter to 9.5 Nm (84 in.lbs.). 5.
Place bead of Mopar(R) RTV sealant onto the transmission case sealing surface. 6. Place pan in
position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to transmission. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.) torque. 8. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) ATF +4.
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) ATF +4 to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 10 pints (5 quarts) of ATF +4 to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled and the torque converter was replaced or drained, add 24
pints (12 quarts) of ATF +4 to
transmission.
3. Check the transmission fluid, refer to FLUID - STANDARD PROCEDURE and adjust as
required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8148
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmssion has too much fluid, the
geartrain churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. It is located on the right side of the engine. Be
sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle before removing.
Fluid level is checked with the engine running at curb idle speed, the transmission in NEUTRAL
and the transmission fluid at normal operating temperature. The engine should be running at idle
speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground.
The transmission fluid level can be checked two ways.
PROCEDURE ONE
1. Transmission fluid must be at normal operating temperature for accurate fluid level check. Drive
vehicle if necessary to bring fluid temperature up
to normal hot operating temperature of 82°C (180°F).
2. Position vehicle on level surface. 3. Start and run engine at curb idle speed. 4. Apply parking
brakes. 5. Shift transmission momentarily into all gear ranges. Then shift transmission back to
NEUTRAL. 6. Clean top of filler tube and dipstick to keep dirt from entering tube. 7. Remove
dipstick (1) and check fluid level as follows:
a. Correct acceptable level is in crosshatch area. b. Correct maximum level is to MAX arrow mark.
c. Incorrect level is at or below MIN line. d. If fluid is low, add only enough Mopar(R) ATF +4 to
restore correct level. Do not overfill.
PROCEDURE TWO
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8149
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into NEUTRAL. 5. Hook up scan tool and select engine. 6. Select sensors. 7. Read
the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the chart.
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
The service fluid fill after a filter change is approximately 3.8 liters (4.0 quarts).
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan (3). 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8150
4. Loosen bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan and reusable
gasket (2) away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and
remove remaining bolt holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan and
gasket away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
9. Remove screws holding filter (2) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Dispose of used trans
fluid and filter properly.
INSTALLATION
1. Position a new transmission oil filter (2) onto the valve body. 2. Install the screws to hold the filter
to the valve body. Tighten the screws to 4 Nm (35 in.lbs.).
3. Clean the gasket surfaces of the transmission oil pan (3) and transmission pan rail.
NOTE: The transmission pan oil gasket (2) is reusable. Inspect the sealing surfaces of the gasket.
If the sealing ribs on both surfaces
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8151
appear to be in good condition, clean the gasket of any foreign material and reinstall.
4. Position the oil pan gasket (2) onto the oil pan (3). 5. Position the oil pan and gasket onto the
transmission and install several bolts to hold the pan and gasket to the transmission. 6. Install the
remainder of the oil pan bolts. Tighten the bolts to 13.6 Nm (125 in.lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle and fill
transmission.
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) ATF +4 to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 3 pints (1-1/2 quarts) of ATF +4 to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled, torque converter was replaced or drained, and cooler
was flushed, add 12 pints (6 quarts) of ATF
+4 to transmission.
3. Apply parking brakes. 4. Start and run engine at normal curb idle speed. 5. Apply service brakes,
shift transmission through all gear ranges then back to NEUTRAL, set parking brake, and leave
engine running at curb idle
speed.
6. Remove funnel, insert dipstick and check fluid level. If level is low, add fluid to bring level to MIN
mark on dipstick. Check to see if the oil
level is equal on both sides of the dipstick. If one side is noticeably higher than the other, the
dipstick has picked up some oil from the dipstick tube. Allow the oil to drain down the dipstick tube
and re-check.
7. Drive vehicle until transmission fluid is at normal operating temperature. 8. With the engine
running at curb idle speed, the gear selector in NEUTRAL, and the parking brake applied, check
the transmission fluid level.
CAUTION: Do not overfill transmission, fluid foaming and shifting problems can result.
9. Add fluid to bring level up to MAX arrow mark.
When fluid level is correct, shut engine off, release park brake, remove funnel, and install dipstick
in fill tube.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8152
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Fluid Level Check
FLUID LEVEL CHECK
Low fluid level can cause a variety of conditions because it allows the pump to take in air along with
the fluid. As in any hydraulic system, air bubbles make the fluid spongy, therefore, pressures will be
low and build up slowly.
Improper filling can also raise the fluid level too high. When the transmission has too much fluid,
the gear train churns up foam and cause the same conditions which occur with a low fluid level.
In either case, air bubbles can cause overheating and/or fluid oxidation, and varnishing. This can
interfere with normal valve, clutch, and accumulator operation. Foaming can also result in fluid
escaping from the transmission vent where it may be mistaken for a leak.
After the fluid has been checked, seat the dipstick fully to seal out water and dirt.
The transmission has a dipstick to check oil level. Be sure to wipe all dirt from dipstick handle
before removing.
The torque converter fills in both the P (PARK) and N (NEUTRAL) positions. Place the selector
lever in P (PARK) to be sure that the fluid level check is accurate. The engine should be running at
idle speed for at least one minute, with the vehicle on level ground. At normal operating
temperature (approximately 82° C. or 180° F), the fluid level is correct if it is in the HOT region
(cross-hatched area) on the oil level indicator. The fluid level will be approximately at the upper
COLD hole of the dipstick at 21° C (70° F) fluid temperature.
NOTE: Engine and Transmission should be at normal operating temperature before performing this
procedure. Optimum fluid temperature for checking the level should be between 70°C (158°F) and
80°C ( 176°F).
1. Start engine and apply parking brake. 2. Shift the transmission into DRIVE for approximately 2
seconds. 3. Shift the transmission into REVERSE for approximately 2 seconds. 4. Shift the
transmission into PARK. 5. Connect the scan tool and select transmission. 6. Select sensors. 7.
Read the transmission temperature value. 8. Compare the fluid temperature value with the chart. 9.
Adjust transmission fluid level shown on the dipstick according to the Transmission Fluid
Temperature Chart.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8153
NOTE: After adding any fluid to the transmission, wait a minimum of 2 minutes for the oil to fully
drain from the fill tube into the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.
10. Check transmission for leaks.
Fluid And Filter Replacement
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
DRAIN PLUG
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a large diameter drain pan beneath the transmission pan. 3. Remove the
drain plug bolt (1) and allow the oil to drain from the transmission pan. 4. Remove the drain pan
bolts from the transmission case. 5. Remove the drain pan.
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8154
6. Remove the transmission oil filter bolts (3). 7. Remove the transmission oil filter and O-ring seal
from the valve body (1).
INSPECTION
OIL PAN MAGNETS
Inspect bottom of pan, pick-up magnets (1) and magnetic drain plug (2) and fluid filter for excessive
amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a
problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated
with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8155
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
1. Lubricate the transmission oil filter seal with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the new
transmission oil filter (2) in position on valve body (1) and into the oil pump. 3. Install the
transmission oil filter bolts (3). 4. Tighten bolts to 10 Nm ( 88 in.lbs. ) torque. 5. Install a new
transmission oil pan gasket. 6. Place pan in position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to
transmission. Tighten bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) torque.
DRAIN PLUG
8. Install transmission drain plug bolt (1). 9. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm ( 20 ft.lbs) torque.
10. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8156
Transmission Fill
TRANSMISSION FILL
To avoid overfilling transmission after a fluid change or overhaul, perform the following procedure:
1. Remove dipstick and insert clean funnel in transmission fill tube. 2. Add following initial quantity
of Mopar(R) AS68RC ATF to transmission:
a. If only fluid and filter were changed, add 6.8L (7.2 quarts) of AS68RC to transmission. b. If
transmission was completely overhauled and the torque converter was replaced or drained, add
13L (13.75 quarts) of Mopar(R) AS68RC
ATF to transmission.
3. Check the transmission fluid and adjust as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan. 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission. 4. Loosen
bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan away from transmission
allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and remove remaining bolts holding pan to
transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid
in pan into drain pan.
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
9. Remove the screw holding the primary oil filter (1) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and oil pump and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Inspect
the oil filter seal in the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is not installed completely in the oil pump,
or is otherwise damaged, then remove
and discard the oil filter seal from the bottom of the oil pump. If the seal is installed correctly and is
in good condition, it can be reused.
12. If replacing the cooler return filter (2), use Oil Filter Wrench 8321 to remove the filter from the
transmission. 13. Dispose of used trans fluid and filter(s) properly.
INSPECTION
Inspect bottom of pan and magnet for excessive amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material
on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition
or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the
diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8161
Transmission Filters - 4X4 Shown
CAUTION: The primary oil filter seal MUST be fully installed flush against the oil pump body. DO
NOT install the seal onto the filter neck and attempt to install the filter and seal as an assembly.
Damage to the transmission will result.
1. If necessary, install a new primary oil filter seal in the oil pump inlet bore. Seat the seal in the
bore with Installer 6960-A or another suitable tool
(appropriately sized drift or socket, the butt end of a hammer etc.).
2. Place replacement filter in position on valve body and into the oil pump. 3. Install screw to hold
the primary oil filter (1) to valve body. Tighten screw to 4.5 Nm (40 in. lbs.) torque. 4. Install new
cooler return filter (2) onto the transmission, if necessary. Torque the filter to 9.5 Nm (84 in.lbs.). 5.
Place bead of Mopar(R) RTV sealant onto the transmission case sealing surface. 6. Place pan in
position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to transmission. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in.
lbs.) torque. 8. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) ATF +4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8162
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
The service fluid fill after a filter change is approximately 3.8 liters (4.0 quarts).
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Place a large diameter shallow drain pan beneath
the transmission pan (3). 3. Remove bolts holding front and sides of pan to transmission (1). 4.
Loosen bolts holding rear of pan to transmission. 5. Slowly separate front of pan and reusable
gasket (2) away from transmission allowing the fluid to drain into drain pan. 6. Hold up pan and
remove remaining bolt holding pan to transmission. 7. While holding pan level, lower pan and
gasket away from transmission. 8. Pour remaining fluid in pan into drain pan.
9. Remove screws holding filter (2) to valve body.
10. Separate filter from valve body and pour fluid in filter into drain pan. 11. Dispose of used trans
fluid and filter properly.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8163
1. Position a new transmission oil filter (2) onto the valve body. 2. Install the screws to hold the filter
to the valve body. Tighten the screws to 4 Nm (35 in.lbs.).
3. Clean the gasket surfaces of the transmission oil pan (3) and transmission pan rail.
NOTE: The transmission pan oil gasket (2) is reusable. Inspect the sealing surfaces of the gasket.
If the sealing ribs on both surfaces appear to be in good condition, clean the gasket of any foreign
material and reinstall.
4. Position the oil pan gasket (2) onto the oil pan (3). 5. Position the oil pan and gasket onto the
transmission and install several bolts to hold the pan and gasket to the transmission. 6. Install the
remainder of the oil pan bolts. Tighten the bolts to 13.6 Nm (125 in.lbs.). 7. Lower vehicle and fill
transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8164
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
FLUID AND FILTER REPLACEMENT
REMOVAL
DRAIN PLUG
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a large diameter drain pan beneath the transmission pan. 3. Remove the
drain plug bolt (1) and allow the oil to drain from the transmission pan. 4. Remove the drain pan
bolts from the transmission case. 5. Remove the drain pan.
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8165
6. Remove the transmission oil filter bolts (3). 7. Remove the transmission oil filter and O-ring seal
from the valve body (1).
INSPECTION
OIL PAN MAGNETS
Inspect bottom of pan, pick-up magnets (1) and magnetic drain plug (2) and fluid filter for excessive
amounts of metal. A light coating of clutch material on the bottom of the pan does not indicate a
problem unless accompanied by a slipping condition or shift lag. If fluid and pan are contaminated
with excessive amounts of debris, refer to the diagnosis information.
CLEANING
1. Using a suitable solvent, clean pan and magnet. 2. Using a suitable gasket scraper, clean
original sealing material from surface of transmission case and the transmission pan.
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8166
TRANSMISSION OIL FILTER
1. Lubricate the transmission oil filter seal with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the new
transmission oil filter (2) in position on valve body (1) and into the oil pump. 3. Install the
transmission oil filter bolts (3). 4. Tighten bolts to 10 Nm ( 88 in.lbs. ) torque. 5. Install a new
transmission oil pan gasket. 6. Place pan in position on transmission. 7. Install bolts to hold pan to
transmission. Tighten bolts to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) torque.
DRAIN PLUG
8. Install transmission drain plug bolt (1). 9. Tighten oil pan drain plug to 27 Nm ( 20 ft.lbs) torque.
10. Lower vehicle and fill transmission with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pan: Specifications 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pan Tighten bolts to ....................................................................................................................
..................................................... 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8171
Fluid Pan: Specifications 48RE Automatic Transmission
Transmission oil pan
NOTE: The transmission pan oil gasket (2) is reusable. Inspect the sealing surfaces of the gasket.
If the sealing ribs on both surfaces appear to be in good condition, clean the gasket of any foreign
material and reinstall.
Tighten the bolts to ..............................................................................................................................
............................................... 13.6 Nm (125 in.lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8172
Fluid Pan: Specifications AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pan Tighten bolts to ....................................................................................................................
......................................................... 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8176
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8177
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8178
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The TCM utilizes a closed-loop system to control transmission line pressure. The system contains
a variable force style solenoid, the Pressure Control Solenoid, which is part of the pressure switch
assembly. The solenoid is duty cycle controlled by the TCM to vent the unnecessary line pressure
supplied by the oil pump back to the pump inlet. The system contains a Line Pressure Sensor,
which is a direct input to the TCM. The line pressure sensor monitors the transmission line
pressure and completes the feedback loop to the TCM. The TCM uses this information to adjust its
control of the pressure control solenoid to achieve the desired line pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8181
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The TCM calculates the desired line pressure based upon inputs from the transmission and engine.
The TCM calculates the torque input to the transmission and uses that information as the primary
input to the calculation. The line pressure is set to a predetermined value during shifts, to ensure
consistent shift quality. During all other operation, the desired line pressure value is adjusted based
on torque level and other transmission requirements.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Remove the bolt holding the line pressure sensor
(2) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the line pressure sensor (2) from the transmission case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8184
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the line
pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pump: Testing and Inspection 68RFE Automatic Transmission
STANDARD PROCEDURE - OIL PUMP VOLUME CHECK
Measuring the oil pump output volume will determine if sufficient oil flow to the transmission oil
cooler exists, and whether or not an internal transmission failure is present.
Verify that the transmission fluid is at the proper level. Refer to the Fluid Level Check procedure. If
necessary, fill the transmission to the proper level with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission
Fluid.
1. Disconnect the To cooler line at the cooler inlet and place a collecting container under the
disconnected line. 2. Plug the inlet to the oil cooler.
CAUTION: With the fluid set at the proper level, fluid collection should not exceed (1) quart or
internal damage to the transmission may occur.
3. Run the engine at 1800 rpm, with the shift selector in neutral. Verify that the transmission fluid
temperature is below 104.5° C (220° F) for this
test.
4. If one quart of transmission fluid is collected in the container in 30 seconds or less, oil pump flow
volume is within acceptable limits. If fluid flow
is intermittent, or it takes more than 30 seconds to collect one quart of fluid, refer to the Hydraulic
Pressure tests for further diagnosis. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/68RFE Automatic Transmission/Hydraulic Pressure Test
5. Unplug the oil cooler inlet. 6. Re-connect the To cooler line to the transmission cooler inlet. 7.
Refill the transmission to proper level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8189
Fluid Pump: Testing and Inspection AS68RC Automatic Transmission
OIL PUMP VOLUME CHECK
Measuring the oil pump output volume will determine if sufficient oil flow to the transmission oil
cooler exists, and whether or not an internal transmission failure is present.
Verify that the transmission fluid is at the proper level. Refer to the Fluid Level Check procedure. If
necessary, fill the transmission to the proper level with Mopar(R) AS68RC, Automatic Transmission
Fluid.
1. Disconnect the To cooler line at the cooler inlet and place a collecting container under the
disconnected line.
CAUTION: With the fluid set at the proper level, fluid collection should not exceed one (1) quart or
internal damage to the transmission may occur.
2. Run the engine at 1800 rpm, with the shift selector in neutral. Verify that the transmission fluid
temperature is below 104.5° C (220° F) for this
test.
3. If one quart of transmission fluid is collected in the container in 30 seconds or less, oil pump flow
volume is within acceptable limits. If fluid flow
is intermittent, or it takes more than 30 seconds to collect one quart of fluid, refer to the Hydraulic
Pressure tests for further diagnosis. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/AS68RC Automatic Transmission/Hydraulic Pressure Test
4. Install the To cooler line to the transmission cooler inlet. 5. Refill the transmission to proper level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Governor: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
Governor pressure is controlled electronically. Components used for governor pressure control
include:
- Governor body
- Valve body transfer plate
- Governor pressure solenoid valve
- Governor pressure sensor
- Fluid temperature thermistor
- Throttle position sensor (TPS)
- Transmission speed sensor
- Powertrain control module (PCM)
GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
The solenoid valve (2) is a duty-cycle solenoid which regulates the governor pressure needed for
upshifts and downshifts. It is an electro-hydraulic device located in the governor body on the valve
body transfer plate.
GOVERNOR BODY, TRANSFER PLATE, AND PRESSURE SENSOR
The governor pressure sensor (2) measures output pressure of the governor pressure solenoid
valve.
The transfer plate is designed to supply transmission line pressure to the governor pressure
solenoid valve and to return governor pressure.
The governor pressure solenoid valve is mounted in the governor body (1). The body is bolted to
the lower side of the transfer plate.
GOVERNOR PRESSURE CURVES
There are four governor pressure curves programmed into the transmission control module. The
different curves allow the control module to adjust governor pressure for varying conditions. One
curve is used for operation when fluid temperature is at, or below, -1°C (30°F). A second curve is
used when fluid temperature is at, or above, 10°C (50°F) during normal city or highway driving. A
third curve is used during wide-open throttle operation. The fourth curve is used when driving with
the transfer case in low range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8194
Governor: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
Compensation is required for performance variations of two of the input devices. Though the slope
of the transfer functions is tightly controlled, offset may vary due to various environmental factors or
manufacturing tolerances.
The pressure transducer is affected by barometric pressure as well as temperature. Calibration of
the zero pressure offset is required to compensate for shifting output due to these factors.
Normal calibration will be performed when sump temperature is above 50 degrees F, or in the
absence of sump temperature data, after the first 10 minutes of vehicle operation. Calibration of the
pressure transducer offset occurs each time the output shaft speed falls below 200 RPM.
Calibration shall be repeated each 3 seconds the output shaft speed is below 200 RPM. A 0.5
second pulse of 95% duty cycle is applied to the governor pressure solenoid valve and the
transducer output is read during this pulse. Averaging of the transducer signal is necessary to
reject electrical noise.
Under cold conditions (below 50 degrees F sump), the governor pressure solenoid valve response
may be too slow to guarantee 0 psi during the 0.5 second calibration pulse. Calibration pulses are
continued during this period, however the transducer output valves are discarded. Transducer
offset must be read at key-on, under conditions which promote a stable reading. This value is
retained and becomes the offset during the "cold" period of operation.
GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID VALVE
The inlet side of the solenoid valve is exposed to normal transmission line pressure. The outlet side
of the valve leads to the valve body governor circuit.
The solenoid valve regulates line pressure to produce governor pressure. The average current
supplied to the solenoid controls governor pressure. One amp current produces zero kPa/psi
governor pressure. Zero amps sets the maximum governor pressure.
The powertrain control module (PCM) turns on the trans control relay which supplies electrical
power to the solenoid valve. Operating voltage is 12 volts (DC). The PCM controls the ground side
of the solenoid using the governor pressure solenoid control circuit.
GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR
The sensor output signal provides the necessary feedback to the PCM. This feedback is needed to
adequately control governor pressure.
GOVERNOR BODY AND TRANSFER PLATE
The transfer plate channels line pressure to the solenoid valve through the governor body. It also
channels governor pressure from the solenoid valve to the governor circuit. It is the solenoid valve
that develops the necessary governor pressure.
GOVERNOR PRESSURE CURVES
LOW TRANSMISSION FLUID TEMPERATURE
When the transmission fluid is cold the conventional governor can delay shifts, resulting in higher
than normal shift speeds and harsh shifts. The electronically controlled low temperature governor
pressure curve is higher than normal to make the transmission shift at normal speeds and sooner.
The PCM uses a temperature sensor in the transmission oil sump to determine when low
temperature governor pressure is needed.
NORMAL OPERATION
Normal operation is refined through the increased computing power of the PCM and through
access to data on engine operating conditions provided by the PCM that were not available with
the previous stand-alone electronic module. This facilitated the development of a load adaptive
shift strategy - the ability to alter the shift schedule in response to vehicle load condition. One
manifestation of this capability is grade "hunting" prevention - the ability of the transmission logic to
delay an upshift on a grade if the engine does not have sufficient power to maintain speed in the
higher gear. The 3-2 downshift and the potential for hunting between gears occurs with a heavily
loaded vehicle or on steep grades. When hunting occurs, it is very objectionable because shifts are
frequent and accompanied by large changes in noise and acceleration.
WIDE OPEN THROTTLE OPERATION
In wide-open throttle (WOT) mode, adaptive memory in the PCM assures that up-shifts occur at the
preprogrammed optimum speed. WOT operation is determined from the throttle position sensor,
which is also a part of the emission control system. The initial setting for the WOT upshift is below
the optimum engine speed. As WOT shifts are repeated, the PCM learns the time required to
complete the shifts by comparing the engine speed when the shifts occur to the optimum speed.
After each shift, the PCM adjusts the shift point until the optimum speed is reached. The PCM also
considers vehicle loading, grade and engine performance changes due to high altitude in
determining when to make WOT shifts. It does this by measuring vehicle and engine acceleration
and then factoring in the shift time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8195
TRANSFER CASE LOW RANGE OPERATION
On four-wheel drive vehicles operating in low range, the engine can accelerate to its peak more
rapidly than in Normal range, resulting in delayed shifts and undesirable engine "flare." The low
range governor pressure curve is also higher than normal to initiate upshifts sooner. The PCM
compares electronic vehicle speed signal used by the speedometer to the transmission output
shaft speed signal to determine when the transfer case is in low range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Governor: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Hoist and support vehicle on safety stands. 2. Remove transmission fluid pan and filter. 3.
Disengage wire connectors from pressure sensor (1) and solenoid (2).
4. Remove screws holding pressure solenoid retainer (1) to governor body (2). 5. Separate
solenoid retainer from governor.
6. Pull solenoid (1) from governor body (3). 7. Pull pressure sensor from governor body. 8. Remove
bolts holding governor body to valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8198
9. Separate governor body (1) from valve body.
10. Remove governor body gasket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8199
Governor: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
Before installing the pressure sensor and solenoid in the governor body, replace O-ring seals,
clean the gasket surfaces and replace gasket.
1. Place gasket (2) in position on back of governor body (1). 2. Place governor body in position on
valve body. 3. Install bolts to hold governor body to valve body.
4. Lubricate O-ring on pressure sensor with transmission fluid. 5. Align pressure sensor to bore in
governor body. 6. Push pressure sensor into governor body. 7. Lubricate O-ring (2), on pressure
solenoid (1), with transmission fluid. 8. Align pressure solenoid (1) to bore in governor body (3). 9.
Push solenoid into governor body.
10. Place solenoid retainer (1) in position on governor (2). 11. Install screws to hold pressure
solenoid retainer to governor body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8200
12. Engage wire connectors into pressure sensor (1) and solenoid (2). 13. Install transmission fluid
pan and (new) filter. 14. Lower vehicle and road test to verify repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Overdrive Off Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
An overdrive off indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles
not equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically
disabled. This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the
coolant temperature gauge.
The overdrive off indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text O/D OFF in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the overdrive off indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The overdrive off indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The overdrive off indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the overdrive-OFF
position of the tow/haul switch has been selected, disabling the electronically controlled overdrive
feature of the automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus.
The overdrive off indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the overdrive off indicator for the following reasons:
- Overdrive Off Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
overdrive off indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the overdrive-OFF position
of the tow/haul switch has been selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch
is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the overdrive off indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the overdrive off indicator or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier
Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page
8206
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to overdrive off indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page
8207
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Tow/Haul Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
A tow/haul indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically disabled.
This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant
temperature gauge.
The tow/haul indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text TOW/HAUL in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the tow/haul indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The tow/haul indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The tow/haul indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the tow/haul function of the
tow/haul switch has been selected, revising the shift schedule of the electronically controlled
automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The tow/haul indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the tow/haul indicator for the following reasons:
- Tow/Haul Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic tow/haul
indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the tow/haul shift schedule has been
selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF
position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the tow/haul indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the tow/haul indicator or the
instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator refer to Instrument Cluster / Carrier testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page
8208
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to tow/haul indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A transmission over-temperature indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters.
However, on vehicles not equipped with an optional automatic transmission, this indicator is
electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The transmission over-temperature indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International
Control and Display Symbol icon for Transmission Temperature in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. A red Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the
opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in red through the translucent outer
layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The transmission over-temperature indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page
8213
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The transmission over-temperature indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
transmission fluid temperature is excessive, which may lead to accelerated transmission
component wear or failure. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster
circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The transmission over-temperature indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by
the instrument cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the
instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON
or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the transmission over-temperature indicator for the
following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the transmission
over-temperature indicator is illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Trans Over-Temp Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
trans over-temp indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the transmission fluid
temperature is 135° C (275° F) or higher, the indicator will be illuminated and a single chime tone is
sounded. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from
the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime
tone feature will only repeat during the same ignition cycle if the indicator is cycled OFF and then
ON again by the appropriate lamp-ON and lamp-OFF messages from the PCM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the transmission
over-temperature indicator will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the
test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the transmission temperature sensor to determine the transmission
operating condition. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster illuminates the transmission
over-temperature indicator due to a high transmission oil temperature condition, it may indicate that
the transmission or the transmission cooling system are being overloaded, or that they require
service. For further diagnosis of the transmission over-temperature indicator or the instrument
cluster circuitry that controls the LED,refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transmission temperature sensor, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data
bus or the electronic communication related to transmission over-temperature indicator operation a
diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Assembly, A/T >
Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Assembly, A/T >
Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8219
Overdrive Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Assembly, A/T >
Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Assembly, A/T >
Overdrive Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8222
Overdrive Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Indicator Lamp
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Overdrive Off Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
An overdrive off indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles
not equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically
disabled. This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the
coolant temperature gauge.
The overdrive off indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text O/D OFF in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the overdrive off indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The overdrive off indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The overdrive off indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the overdrive-OFF
position of the tow/haul switch has been selected, disabling the electronically controlled overdrive
feature of the automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus.
The overdrive off indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the overdrive off indicator for the following reasons:
- Overdrive Off Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
overdrive off indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the overdrive-OFF position
of the tow/haul switch has been selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch
is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the overdrive off indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the overdrive off indicator or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier
Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Indicator Lamp
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 8227
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to overdrive off indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Indicator Lamp
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 8228
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Tow/Haul Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
A tow/haul indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically disabled.
This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant
temperature gauge.
The tow/haul indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text TOW/HAUL in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the tow/haul indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The tow/haul indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The tow/haul indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the tow/haul function of the
tow/haul switch has been selected, revising the shift schedule of the electronically controlled
automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The tow/haul indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the tow/haul indicator for the following reasons:
- Tow/Haul Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic tow/haul
indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the tow/haul shift schedule has been
selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF
position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the tow/haul indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the tow/haul indicator or the
instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator refer to Instrument Cluster / Carrier testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Indicator Lamp
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off Indicator > Page 8229
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to tow/haul indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations
Overdrive Switch: Locations
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8233
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8234
Overdrive Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8235
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8236
Overdrive Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - OVERDRIVE ELECTRICAL CONTROLS
The tow/haul overdrive off switch, valve body solenoid, case connectors and related wiring can all
be tested with a 12 volt test lamp or a volt/ohmmeter. Check continuity of each component when
diagnosis indicates this is necessary.
Switch and solenoid continuity should be checked whenever the transmission fails to shift into
fourth gear range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8239
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8240
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8241
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8242
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8243
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8244
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8245
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8250
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8251
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8252
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8253
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8254
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8255
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8256
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8257
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8260
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8261
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8262
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8263
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8264
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8265
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8266
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8267
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8270
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8273
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8283
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8284
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8289
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8290
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8291
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8292
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8298
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 8299
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8304
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8305
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8306
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 8307
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8308
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8309
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8310
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8311
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8312
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8313
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8314
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8315
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8316
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8317
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
On gasoline vehicles the Transmission Control Module (TCM) (2) may be sub-module within the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) (3).
68RFE TCM LOCATION
Vehicles equipped 68RFE transmission and a 6.7L Diesel engine, the TCM is housed in the NGC4
controller utilizing only the C1 and C4 connectors (TCM only). The controller is located at the rear
of the engine compartment, near the right inner fender.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8320
AS68RC TCM LOCATION
On Cab Chassis models equipped with the AS68RC transmission the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) has three electrical connectors and is located in the passenger compartment underneath of
the left side of the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8321
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
RLE and RFE TRANSMISSIONS
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) (if equipped)
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Line Pressure Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids
- Torque Reduction Request
Some examples of TCM indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool)
NOTE: If the TCM has been replaced, the "Quick Learn Procedure" must be performed.
BATTERY FEED
A fused, direct battery feed to the TCM is used for continuous power. This battery voltage is
necessary to retain memory in the TCM. When the battery (B+) is disconnected, this memory is
lost. When the battery (B+) is restored, this memory loss is detected by the TCM and a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) is set.
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEXES (CVI)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8322
An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transmission gear position. This is important
to the CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the input clutch assembly can cause inadequate or
out-of-range element volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following charts identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8323
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8324
SHIFT SCHEDULES
As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules.
Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8325
AISIN AS68RC TRANSMISSION
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Speed Sensor
- Output Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Engine/Body Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8326
- Manifold Pressure
- Throttle position
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Brake Status (if equipped)
- PTO Request (if equipped)
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Exhaust Brake Cut Request (if equipped).
- Solenoids.
- Torque Reduction Request.
Some examples of TCM .indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM).
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN).
- PTO Status.
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI).
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules.
- System self-diagnostics.
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool).
Clutch filling time is continuously maintained when the vehicle is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8331
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8332
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8333
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8334
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8335
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8336
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8337
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8338
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8339
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8340
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8341
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8342
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8343
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8344
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8345
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8346
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8347
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8348
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 8349
Transmission Control System Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T
> Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Due to different power control configurations, the Transmission Control Relay (if equipped)
may be referred to as a PCM relay.
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TIPM, and is used to supply power to the
TCM when the transmission is in normal operating mode.
Operation
OPERATION
The TIPM energizes the transmission control relay. When the relay is "off", no power is supplied to
the TCM and the transmission will not operate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. On 4WD vehicles remove the transfer case from the transmission, on 2WD vehicles remove the
propeller shaft. 2. Using a pry tool, remove the output shaft seal.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: On the 2WD models use Seal Installer 8154 with Handle C-4171.
SEAL INSTALLER 10020
1. Clean the seal bore in the extension housing of any residue or particles remaining from the
original seal. 2. Install new oil seal in the extension housing using Handle C-4171 (1) and Seal
Installer 10020 (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8356
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Mark propeller shaft and axle yoke for alignment reference. 3. Disconnect and
remove propeller shaft. 4. Remove old seal with a screw mounted in a slide hammer.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place seal in position on overdrive housing. 2. Drive seal into overdrive housing with Seal
Installer 8154 (1) or 9037 (1) if equipped with a dust boot and Handle C-4171. 3. Carefully guide
propeller shaft slip yoke into housing and onto output shaft splines. Align marks made at removal
and connect propeller shaft to
rear axle pinion yoke.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8357
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. 2. Remove the torque converter from the
transmission torque converter housing. 3. Use a pry tool to remove oil pump seal.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Apply trans jell or petroleum jelly to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust
surfaces etc. to prevent burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with
MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours
before assembly of clutch packs.
1. Clean and inspect oil pump seal seat. Then install seal using Converter Hub Seal Installer 9987.
2. Clean and inspect torque converter hub. If nicks, scratches or hub wear are found, torque
converter replacement will be required.
CAUTION: If the torque converter is being replaced, apply a light coating of grease to the
crankshaft pilot hole. Also inspect the engine drive plate for cracks. If any cracks are found replace
the drive plate. Do not attempt to repair a cracked drive plate. Always use new torque converter to
drive plate bolts.
3. Apply a light film of MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF oil to the torque converter hub and oil seal lips.
Then install torque converter into transmission.
Be sure that the hub lugs mesh with the front pump lugs when installing.
4. Install the transmission into the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8362
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8363
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8364
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The TCM utilizes a closed-loop system to control transmission line pressure. The system contains
a variable force style solenoid, the Pressure Control Solenoid, which is part of the pressure switch
assembly. The solenoid is duty cycle controlled by the TCM to vent the unnecessary line pressure
supplied by the oil pump back to the pump inlet. The system contains a Line Pressure Sensor,
which is a direct input to the TCM. The line pressure sensor monitors the transmission line
pressure and completes the feedback loop to the TCM. The TCM uses this information to adjust its
control of the pressure control solenoid to achieve the desired line pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8367
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The TCM calculates the desired line pressure based upon inputs from the transmission and engine.
The TCM calculates the torque input to the transmission and uses that information as the primary
input to the calculation. The line pressure is set to a predetermined value during shifts, to ensure
consistent shift quality. During all other operation, the desired line pressure value is adjusted based
on torque level and other transmission requirements.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Remove the bolt holding the line pressure sensor
(2) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the line pressure sensor (2) from the transmission case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8370
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the line
pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Overdrive Switch: Locations
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8374
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8375
Overdrive Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8376
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8377
Overdrive Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - OVERDRIVE ELECTRICAL CONTROLS
The tow/haul overdrive off switch, valve body solenoid, case connectors and related wiring can all
be tested with a 12 volt test lamp or a volt/ohmmeter. Check continuity of each component when
diagnosis indicates this is necessary.
Switch and solenoid continuity should be checked whenever the transmission fails to shift into
fourth gear range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8380
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8381
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8382
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8383
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8384
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8385
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8386
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8391
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8392
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8393
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8394
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8395
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8396
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8397
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8398
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8399
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8400
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8401
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8404
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8405
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8406
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8407
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8408
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8409
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8410
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8411
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8412
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8413
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range >
Page 8414
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 8417
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 8418
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 8419
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4
Speed > Page 8420
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8421
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission > Page 8424
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission > Page 8425
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission > Page 8426
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission > Page 8427
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic
Transmission > Page 8428
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8433
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8434
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8435
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8436
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8437
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8438
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8439
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8440
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8441
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8442
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8443
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8444
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8445
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8446
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8447
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8448
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8449
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8450
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8451
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8454
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8455
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8456
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8457
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8458
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8459
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8460
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8461
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8462
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8463
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8464
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8465
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8466
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8467
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8468
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8469
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8470
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8471
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8472
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor (1) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the park
gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed.
Operation
OPERATION
Speed sensor signals are triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup
face. Input signals from the sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing.
Signals from this sensor are shared with the powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed >
Page 8475
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed >
Page 8476
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
INPUT AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSORS
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate DC
square wave signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case
and are considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the "teeth"
of the gear pass by the sensor coil, an DC square wave is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an DC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the rear planetary carrier lugs. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the input speed sensor (3). 4. Remove the bolt holding the input speed sensor to
the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor (3) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the input speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the input
speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid as
necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission >
Page 8479
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the output speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the bolt holding the output speed sensor
(1) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor (1) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the output speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the output
speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor (1). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission >
Page 8480
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3.
Remove the wiring connector from the output speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the output
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission >
Page 8481
3. Remove the wiring connector from the input speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the input
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the output
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission fluid
level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF as necessary.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission >
Page 8482
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the input
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
electrical wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission
fluid level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8486
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8487
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8488
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Locations
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8493
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8494
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8495
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Diagrams
Component ID: 440
Component : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-BRAKE TRANSMISSION SHIFT INTERLOCK
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Pin Description Circuit
1 BTSI SOLENOID CONTROL K32 18DB/YL
2 GROUND Z101 18BK/VT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8496
Component Location - 42
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 8497
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8502
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8503
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8504
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8505
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8506
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8507
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8508
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/Pressure Switch
Component ID: 17
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/PRESSURE SWITCH
Color : LT. BROWN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
2 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 2-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T19 18YL/DB
5 2-4 PRESSURE SWITCH SENSE T47 18YL/DG
6 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
7 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
8-9-10 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20YL/TN
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8509
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8510
Shift Solenoid: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8511
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid
Component ID: 16
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
Color : # of pins :
8
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 18YL/PK
3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SENSOR SIGNAL T38 18YL/BR
5 GOVERNOR PRESSURE SOLENOID CONTROL T118 18DG
6 3-4 SOLENOID CONTROL T9 18DG/TN
7 TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH SOLENOID CONTROL T75 18YL/LB
8 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 18DG/OR
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8514
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8515
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C1
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
3 TRANMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
4 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8516
5 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
8 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
9 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
10 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8517
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID C2
Color : # of pins :
12
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
2 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
3 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
4 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8518
5 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
6 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
7 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
8 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
9 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
10 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
11 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
12 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8519
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8520
Shift Solenoid: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Transmission Solenoid > Page 8521
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
SOLENOID AND PRESSURE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
The transmission solenoid/TRS assembly is internal to the transmission and mounted on the valve
body assembly. The assembly consists of six solenoids that control hydraulic pressure to the six
friction elements (transmission clutches), and the torque converter clutch. The pressure control
solenoid is located on the side of the solenoid/TRS assembly. The solenoid/TRS assembly also
contains the Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) and five pressure switches that feed information to
the TCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8524
Shift Solenoid: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
SOLENOIDS
Solenoids are used to control the L/R, 2C, 4C, OD, and UD friction elements. The reverse clutch is
controlled by line pressure and the position of the manual valve in the valve body. All the solenoids
are contained within the Solenoid and Pressure Switch Assembly. The solenoid and pressure
switch assembly contains one additional solenoid, Multi-Select (MS), which serves primarily to
provide 3rd gear and reverse limp-in operation.
The TCM energizes or operates the solenoids individually by grounding the return wire of the
solenoid as necessary. When a solenoid is energized, the solenoid valve shifts, and a fluid
passage is opened or closed (vented or applied), depending on its default operating state. The
result is an apply or release of a frictional element.
The MS and UD solenoids are normally applied to allow transmission limp-in in the event of an
electrical failure.
The continuity of the solenoids and circuits are periodically tested. Each solenoid is turned on or off
depending on its current state. An inductive spike should be detected by the TCM during this test. If
no spike is detected, the circuit is tested again to verify the failure. In addition to the periodic
testing, the solenoid circuits are tested if a speed ratio or pressure switch error occurs.
PRESSURE SWITCHES
The TCM relies on five pressure switches to monitor fluid pressure in the L/R, 2C, 4C, UD, and OD
hydraulic circuits. The primary purpose of these switches is to help the TCM detect when clutch
circuit hydraulic failures occur. The switches close at 23 psi and open at 11 psi, and simply indicate
whether or not pressure exists. The switches are continuously monitored by the TCM for the
correct states (open or closed) in each gear as shown in the following charts and
68RFE Pressure Switch States
A Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) will set if the TCM senses any switch open or closed at the
wrong time in a given gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: If the Transmission Solenoid/TRS Assembly is being replaced, the Quick Learn Procedure
must be performed.
1. Remove the valve body from the transmission.
2. Remove the bolts (1) holding the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 3.
Separate the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly from the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8527
Shift Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Place TRS selector plate in the PARK position. 2. Position the transmission solenoid/TRS
assembly onto the valve body. Be sure that both alignment dowels are fully seated in the valve
body and
that the TRS switch contacts are properly positioned in the selector plate
3. Install the bolts (1) to hold the transmission solenoid/TRS assembly onto the valve body. 4.
Tighten the solenoid assembly screws adjacent to the arrows cast into the bottom of the valve body
first. Tighten the screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 5. Tighten the remainder of the solenoid assembly
screws to 6 Nm (50 in.lbs.). 6. Install the valve body into the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The gear shift mechanism provides six shift positions which are:
- Park (P)
- Reverse (R)
- Neutral (N)
- Drive (D)
- Manual second (2)
- Manual low (1)
Operation
OPERATION
MANUAL LOW (1) range provides FIRST gear only. Overrun braking is also provided in this range.
MANUAL SECOND (2) range provides FIRST and SECOND gear only.
DRIVE range provides FIRST, SECOND, THIRD and OVERDRIVE FOURTH gear ranges. The
shift into OVERDRIVE FOURTH gear range occurs only after the transmission has completed the
shift into D THIRD gear range. No further movement of the shift mechanism is required to complete
the 3-4 shift.
The FOURTH gear upshift occurs automatically when the overdrive selector switch is in the ON
position. An upshift to FOURTH gear may not occur or may be delayed in some of the possible
shift schedules.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8532
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The gear shift mechanism provides six shift positions which are:
- Park (P)
- Reverse (R)
- Neutral (N)
- Drive (D)
- Manual second (2)
- Manual low (1)
Operation
OPERATION
MANUAL LOW (1) range provides first gear only. Maximum engine braking is also provided in this
range. MANUAL SECOND (2) range provides first and second gear only.
DRIVE range provides FIRST, SECOND, THIRD, OVERDRIVE FOURTH, and OVERDRIVE
FIFTH gear ranges. The shift into OVERDRIVE FOURTH and FIFTH gear ranges occurs only after
the transmission has completed the shift into D THIRD gear range. No further movement of the
shift mechanism is required to complete the 3-4 or 4-5 shifts.
The FOURTH and FIFTH gear upshifts occur automatically unless the Tow/Haul or OD Off mode is
enabled. No upshift to FOURTH or FIFTH gears will occur if any of the following are true:
- The transmission fluid temperature is below 10° C (50° F) or above 121° C (250° F).
- The shift to THIRD is not yet complete.
- Vehicle speed is too low for the 3-4 or 4-5 shifts to occur.
Upshifts into FOURTH or FIFTH will be delayed when the transmission fluid temperature is below
4.5° C (40° F) or above 115.5° C (240° F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8533
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The gear shift mechanism provides four shift positions which are:
- Park (P)
- Reverse (R)
- Neutral (N)
- Drive (D)
Operation
OPERATION
Drive range provides underdrive FIRST, SECOND and THIRD gears, direct FOURTH gear and
overdrive FIFTH and SIXTH gears. The shift into overdrive FIFTH and SIXTH gear occurs only
after the transmission has completed the shift into FOURTH gear. No other movement of the shift
mechanism is required to complete the 4-5 or 5-6 gear shifts.
The FOURTH and FIFTH gear upshift occurs automatically unless the Tow/Haul mode is enabled.
Upshifts into both overdrive gears, FIFTH and SIXTH, will be delayed when the transmission fluid
temperature is below 4.5° C (40° F) or above 115.5° C (240° F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8534
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation 48RE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The gear shift mechanism provides six shift positions which are:
- PARK (P)
- REVERSE (R)
- NEUTRAL (N)
- DRIVE (D)
- Manual SECOND (2)
- Manual LOW (1)
Operation
OPERATION
Manual LOW (1) range provides first gear only. Overrun braking is also provided in this range.
Manual SECOND (2) range provides first and second gear only.
DRIVE range provides first, second, third, and overdrive fourth gear ranges. The shift into overdrive
fourth gear range occurs only after the transmission has completed the shift into D third gear range.
No further movement of the shift mechanism is required to complete the 3-4 shift.
The fourth gear upshift occurs automatically when the overdrive selector switch is in the ON
position. No upshift to fourth gear will occur if any of the following are true:
- The transmission fluid temperature is below 10° C (50° F) or above 121° C (250° F).
- The shift to third is not yet complete.
- Vehicle speed is too low for the 3-4 shift to occur.
- Battery temperature is below -5° C (23° F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Description and Operation > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8535
Shifter A/T: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The gear shift mechanism provides seven shift positions which are:
- Park (P)
- Reverse (R)
- Neutral (N)
- Drive (D)
- Manual Third (3)
- Manual second (2)
- Manual low (1)
Operation
OPERATION
MANUAL LOW (1) range provides first gear only. Maximum engine braking is also provided in this
range. MANUAL SECOND (2) range provides first and second gear only. MANUAL THIRD range
provides first, second and third gear only.
DRIVE range provides FIRST, SECOND, THIRD, FOURTH, OVERDRIVE FIFTH, OVERDRIVE
SIXTH gear ranges. The shift into OVERDRIVE FOURTH and FIFTH gear ranges occurs only after
the transmission has completed the shift into D THIRD gear range.
The SIXTH gear upshifts occur automatically unless the Tow/Haul or OD Off mode is enabled. No
upshift to FIFTH or SIXTH gears will occur if any of the following are true:
- The transmission fluid temperature is below 5° C (41° F).
- The shift to Fourth is not yet complete.
- Vehicle speed is too low for the 4-5 or 5-6 shifts to occur.
- Transfer case is in low range.
Upshifts into FOURTH or FIFTH will be delayed when the transmission fluid temperature is below
4.5° C (40° F) or above 115.5° C (240° F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the kneeblocker (2) and steering column opening reinforcement (1).
2. Remove the upper and lower column shrouds (1&2). 3. Loosen the column bolts and lower the
column enough to allow clearance for the gear shift lever removal.
4. Disconnect the overdrive switch harness (3) (if equipped). 5. Disconnect the shift cable (2) from
the shift lever. 6. Remove the gear shift lever mounting screws (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8538
7. Remove the blocker pin (1) from the inhibit link slot (2) and remove the lever (3) by pulling
forward toward the steering wheel and to the left then
down.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8539
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the lever assembly (3) reversing the way it came out using care to install the pin (2) in the
blocker to slider slot (1).
2. The block inhibitor pin and spring (1) should seat into the slider slot (2).
3. Install the mounting screws (1) and tighten to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.). 4. Cycle the key from ACC to
RUN and ensure that the blocker does not stick or bind. 5. Turn the key to the OFF position and
ensure that the shifter will not pull from the PARK position. 6. Connect the over drive switch
harness (if equipped) (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8540
NOTE: Route and tie off harness to original location.
7. Connect the shift cable to the lever (2).
8. Ensure the gear shift lever and transmission are in the PARK position and snap the cable adjust
clip in place. 9. Install the upper and lower column shrouds (1&2).
10. Install the column back into place and tighten. 11. Install the kneeblocker (2) and steering
column reinforcement cover (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Shift Cable: Testing and Inspection 42RLE Automatic Transmission
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - GEARSHIFT CABLE
1. Engine starts must be possible with shift lever in PARK or NEUTRAL positions only. Engine
starts must not be possible in any other gear
position.
2. With the shift lever in the:
a. PARK position - Apply upward force on the shift arm and remove pressure. Engine starts must
be possible. b. PARK position - Apply downward force on the shift arm and remove pressure.
Engine starts must be possible. c. NEUTRAL position - Normal position. Engine starts must be
possible. d. NEUTRAL position - Engine running and brakes applied, apply upward force on the
shift arm. Transmission shall not be able to shift from
neutral to reverse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8546
Shift Cable: Testing and Inspection 545RFE Automatic Transmission
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - GEARSHIFT CABLE
1. Engine starts must be possible with shift lever in PARK or NEUTRAL positions only. Engine
starts must not be possible in any other gear
position.
2. With the shift lever in the:
a. PARK position - Apply upward force on the shift arm and remove pressure. Engine starts must
be possible. b. PARK position - Apply downward force on the shift arm and remove pressure.
Engine starts must be possible. c. NEUTRAL position - Normal position. Engine starts must be
possible. d. NEUTRAL position - Engine running and brakes applied, apply upward force on the
shift arm. Transmission shall not be able to shift from
neutral to reverse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8547
Shift Cable: Testing and Inspection 68RFE Automatic Transmission
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - GEARSHIFT CABLE
1. Engine starts must be possible with shift lever in PARK or NEUTRAL positions only. Engine
starts must not be possible in any other gear
position.
2. With the shift lever in the:
a. PARK position - Apply upward force on the shift arm and remove pressure. Engine starts must
be possible. b. PARK position - Apply downward force on the shift arm and remove pressure.
Engine starts must be possible. c. NEUTRAL position - Normal position. Engine starts must be
possible. d. NEUTRAL position - Engine running and brakes applied, apply upward force on the
shift arm. Transmission shall not be able to shift from
neutral to reverse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8548
Shift Cable: Testing and Inspection 48RE Automatic Transmission
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - GEARSHIFT CABLE
1. Engine starts must be possible with shift lever in PARK or NEUTRAL positions only. Engine
starts must not be possible in any other gear
position.
2. With the shift lever in the:
a. PARK position - Apply upward force on the shift arm and remove pressure. Engine starts must
be possible. b. PARK position - Apply downward force on the shift arm and remove pressure.
Engine starts must be possible. c. NEUTRAL position - Normal position. Engine starts must be
possible. d. NEUTRAL position - Engine running and brakes applied, apply upward force on the
shift arm. Transmission shall not be able to shift from
neutral to reverse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8549
Shift Cable: Testing and Inspection AS68RC Automatic Transmission
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - GEARSHIFT CABLE
1. Engine starts must be possible with shift lever in PARK or NEUTRAL positions only. Engine
starts must not be possible in any other gear
position.
2. With the shift lever in the:
a. PARK position - Apply upward force on the shift arm and remove pressure. Engine starts must
be possible. b. PARK position - Apply downward force on the shift arm and remove pressure.
Engine starts must be possible. c. NEUTRAL position - Normal position. Engine starts must be
possible. d. NEUTRAL position - Engine running and brakes applied, apply upward force on the
shift arm. Transmission shall not be able to shift from
neutral to reverse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Shift Cable: Adjustments 68RFE Automatic Transmission
ADJUSTMENTS - GEARSHIFT CABLE
NOTE: Always run the shift lever test using the scan tool to help diagnose a potential TRS problem
Check adjustment by starting the engine in PARK and NEUTRAL. Adjustment is CORRECT if the
engine starts only in these positions. Adjustment is INCORRECT if the engine starts in one but not
both positions. If the engine starts in any position other than PARK or NEUTRAL, or if the engine
will not start at all, the transmission range sensor may be faulty.
Gearshift Adjustment Procedure
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Release cable adjuster lock tab (3) (underneath the steering
column) to unlock cable. 3. Raise vehicle. 4. Disengage the cable eyelet from the transmission
manual shift lever. 5. Verify transmission shift lever is in PARK detent by moving lever fully
rearward. Last rearward detent is PARK position. 6. Verify positive engagement of transmission
park lock by attempting to rotate propeller shaft. Shaft will not rotate when park lock is engaged. 7.
Snap the cable eyelet onto the transmission manual shift lever. 8. Lower vehicle. 9. Lock shift cable
by pressing cable adjuster lock tab (3) downward until it snaps into place.
10. Check engine starting. Engine should start only in PARK and NEUTRAL.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8552
Shift Cable: Adjustments 48RE Automatic Transmission
ADJUSTMENTS - GEARSHIFT CABLE
NOTE: Always run the shift lever test using the scan tool to help diagnose a potential TRS problem
Check adjustment by starting the engine in PARK and NEUTRAL. Adjustment is CORRECT if the
engine starts only in these positions. Adjustment is INCORRECT if the engine starts in one but not
both positions. If the engine starts in any position other than PARK or NEUTRAL, or if the engine
will not start at all, the transmission range sensor may be faulty.
Gearshift Adjustment Procedure
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Release cable adjuster lock tab (3) (underneath the steering
column) to unlock cable. 3. Raise vehicle. 4. Disengage the cable eyelet from the transmission
manual shift lever. 5. Verify transmission shift lever is in PARK detent by moving lever fully
rearward. Last rearward detent is PARK position. 6. Verify positive engagement of transmission
park lock by attempting to rotate propeller shaft. Shaft will not rotate when park lock is engaged. 7.
Snap the cable eyelet onto the transmission manual shift lever. 8. Lower vehicle. 9. Lock shift cable
by pressing cable adjuster lock tab (3) downward until it snaps into place.
10. Check engine starting. Engine should start only in PARK and NEUTRAL.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8553
Shift Cable: Adjustments AS68RC Automatic Transmission
ADJUSTMENTS - GEARSHIFT CABLE
NOTE: Always run the shift lever test using the scan tool to help diagnose a potential TRS problem
Check adjustment by starting the engine in PARK and NEUTRAL. Adjustment is CORRECT if the
engine starts only in these positions. Adjustment is INCORRECT if the engine starts in one but not
both positions. If the engine starts in any position other than PARK or NEUTRAL, or if the engine
will not start at all, the transmission range sensor may be faulty.
Gearshift Adjustment Procedure
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Release cable adjuster lock tab (3) (underneath the steering
column) to unlock cable. 3. Raise vehicle. 4. Disengage the cable eyelet from the transmission
manual shift lever. 5. Verify transmission shift lever is in PARK detent by moving lever fully
rearward. Last rearward detent is PARK position. 6. Verify positive engagement of transmission
park lock by attempting to rotate propeller shaft. Shaft will not rotate when park lock is engaged. 7.
Snap the cable eyelet onto the transmission manual shift lever. 8. Lower vehicle. 9. Lock shift cable
by pressing cable adjuster lock tab (3) downward until it snaps into place.
10. Check engine starting. Engine should start only in PARK and NEUTRAL.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Shift Cable: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Disengage cable (1) eyelet at transmission
manual shift lever (3) and pull cable adjuster out of mounting bracket.
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the dash panel insulation pad as necessary to access the
gearshift cable grommet (2). 6. Remove grommet (2) from the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8556
Gearshift Cable at Steering Column
7. Remove any steering column (1) trim necessary to access the gearshift cable (2) and BTSI
mechanism. 8. Disconnect the BTSI wiring connector (5). 9. Disconnect cable at lower column
bracket and shift lever pin and pull the cable through the dash panel opening into the vehicle.
10. Remove gearshift cable (2) from vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the transmission end of the gearshift cable (1) through the opening in the dash panel. 2.
Seat the cable grommet (2) into the dash panel opening.
Gearshift Cable at Steering Column
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8557
3. Snap the cable into the steering column (1) bracket so the retaining ears are engaged and snap
the cable eyelet onto the shift lever ball stud. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Place the transmission
manual shift lever in the "PARK" detent (rearmost) position and rotate prop shaft to ensure
transmission is in PARK. 6. Route the gearshift cable through the transmission mounting bracket
and secure the cable by snapping the cable retaining ears into the transmission
bracket and snapping the cable eyelet on the manual shift lever ball stud.
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Lock the shift cable adjustment by pressing the cable adjuster lock tab (3)
downward until it snaps into place. 9. Check for proper operation of the transmission range sensor.
10. Adjust the gearshift cable, and BTSI mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8558
Shift Cable: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Disengage cable (1) eyelet at transmission
manual shift lever (3) and pull cable adjuster out of mounting bracket.
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the dash panel insulation pad as necessary to access the
gearshift cable grommet (2). 6. Remove grommet (2) from the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8559
7. Remove any steering column (1) trim necessary to access the gearshift cable (2) and BTSI
mechanism. 8. Disconnect the BTSI wiring connector (5). 9. Disconnect cable at lower column
bracket and shift lever pin and pull the cable through the dash panel opening into the vehicle.
10. Remove gearshift cable (2) from vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the transmission end of the gearshift cable (1) through the opening in the dash panel. 2.
Seat the cable grommet (2) into the dash panel opening.
3. Snap the cable into the steering column (1) bracket so the retaining ears are engaged and snap
the cable eyelet onto the shift lever ball stud. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Place the transmission
manual shift lever in the "PARK" detent (rearmost) position and rotate prop shaft to ensure
transmission is in PARK. 6. Route the gearshift cable through the transmission mounting bracket
and secure the cable by snapping the cable retaining ears into the transmission
bracket and snapping the cable eyelet on the manual shift lever ball stud.
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Lock the shift cable adjustment by pressing the cable adjuster lock tab (3)
downward until it snaps into place. 9. Check for proper operation of the transmission range sensor.
10. Adjust the gearshift cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8560
Shift Cable: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Disengage cable (1) eyelet at transmission
manual shift lever (3) and pull cable adjuster out of mounting bracket.
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the dash panel insulation pad as necessary to access the
gearshift cable grommet (2). 6. Remove grommet (2) from the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8561
7. Remove any steering column (1) trim necessary to access the gearshift cable (2) and BTSI
mechanism. 8. Disconnect the BTSI wiring connector (5). 9. Disconnect cable at lower column
bracket and shift lever pin and pull the cable through the dash panel opening into the vehicle.
10. Remove gearshift cable (2) from vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the transmission end of the gearshift cable (1) through the opening in the dash panel. 2.
Seat the cable grommet (2) into the dash panel opening.
3. Snap the cable into the steering column (1) bracket so the retaining ears are engaged and snap
the cable eyelet onto the shift lever ball stud. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Place the transmission
manual shift lever in the "PARK" detent (rearmost) position and rotate prop shaft to ensure
transmission is in PARK. 6. Route the gearshift cable through the transmission mounting bracket
and secure the cable by snapping the cable retaining ears into the transmission
bracket and snapping the cable eyelet on the manual shift lever ball stud.
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Lock the shift cable adjustment by pressing the cable adjuster lock tab (3)
downward until it snaps into place. 9. Check for proper operation of the transmission range sensor.
10. Adjust the gearshift cable and BTSI mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8562
Shift Cable: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Disengage cable (1) eyelet at transmission
manual shift lever (3) and pull cable adjuster out of mounting bracket.
GEARSHIFT CABLE AT THE DASH PANE
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the dash panel insulation pad as necessary to access the
gearshift cable grommet (2). 6. Remove grommet (2) from the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8563
BRAKE TRANSMISSION INTERLOCK MEC
7. Remove any steering column (1) trim necessary to access the gearshift cable (2) and BTSI
mechanism. 8. Disconnect the BTSI wiring connector (5). 9. Disconnect cable at lower column
bracket and shift lever pin and pull the cable through the dash panel opening into the vehicle.
10. Remove gearshift cable (2) from vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the transmission end of the gearshift cable (1) through the opening in the dash panel. 2.
Seat the cable grommet (2) into the dash panel opening.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8564
3. Snap the cable into the steering column (1) bracket so the retaining ears are engaged and snap
the cable eyelet onto the shift lever ball stud. 4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Place the transmission
manual shift lever in the "PARK" detent (rearmost) position and rotate prop shaft to ensure
transmission is in PARK. 6. Route the gearshift cable through the transmission mounting bracket
and secure the cable by snapping the cable retaining ears into the transmission
bracket and snapping the cable eyelet on the manual shift lever ball stud.
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Lock the shift cable adjustment by pressing the cable adjuster lock tab (3)
downward until it snaps into place. 9. Check for proper operation of the transmission range sensor.
10. Adjust the gearshift cable and BTSI mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8565
Shift Cable: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Shift transmission into PARK. 2. Raise vehicle. 3. Disconnect the shift cable ball socket (3) at
transmission manual shift lever (4) and pull shift cable out of mounting bracket (1).
4. Lower the vehicle. 5. Remove the dash panel insulation pad as necessary to access the
gearshift cable grommet (2). 6. Remove grommet (2) from the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8566
7. Remove any steering column (1) trim necessary to access the gearshift cable (2) and BTSI
mechanism. 8. Disconnect the BTSI wiring connector (5). 9. Disconnect cable at lower column
bracket and shift lever pin and pull the cable through the dash panel opening into the vehicle.
10. Remove gearshift cable (2) from vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Route the transmission end of the gearshift cable (1) through the opening in the dash panel. 2.
Seat the cable grommet (2) into the dash panel opening.
3. Snap the cable into the steering column (1) bracket so the retaining ears are engaged and snap
the cable eyelet onto the shift lever ball stud.
4. Raise the vehicle. 5. Place the transmission manual shift lever in the "PARK" detent (rearmost)
position and rotate prop shaft to ensure transmission is in PARK.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic Transmission > Page 8567
6. Route the gearshift cable through the shift cable mounting bracket (1) and secure the cable by
snapping the cable retaining ears into the bracket
and by snapping the shift cable ball socket (3) onto the manual shift lever (4) ball stud.
7. Lower vehicle. 8. Lock the shift cable adjustment by pressing the cable adjuster lock tab (3)
downward until it snaps into place. 9. Check for proper operation of the transmission range sensor.
10. Adjust the gearshift cable and BTSI mechanism.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Temperature Warning
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A transmission over-temperature indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters.
However, on vehicles not equipped with an optional automatic transmission, this indicator is
electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The transmission over-temperature indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International
Control and Display Symbol icon for Transmission Temperature in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. A red Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the
opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in red through the translucent outer
layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The transmission over-temperature indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Temperature Warning
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8572
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The transmission over-temperature indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
transmission fluid temperature is excessive, which may lead to accelerated transmission
component wear or failure. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster
circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The transmission over-temperature indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by
the instrument cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the
instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON
or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the transmission over-temperature indicator for the
following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the transmission
over-temperature indicator is illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Trans Over-Temp Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
trans over-temp indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the transmission fluid
temperature is 135° C (275° F) or higher, the indicator will be illuminated and a single chime tone is
sounded. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from
the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime
tone feature will only repeat during the same ignition cycle if the indicator is cycled OFF and then
ON again by the appropriate lamp-ON and lamp-OFF messages from the PCM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the transmission
over-temperature indicator will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the
test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the transmission temperature sensor to determine the transmission
operating condition. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster illuminates the transmission
over-temperature indicator due to a high transmission oil temperature condition, it may indicate that
the transmission or the transmission cooling system are being overloaded, or that they require
service. For further diagnosis of the transmission over-temperature indicator or the instrument
cluster circuitry that controls the LED,refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transmission temperature sensor, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data
bus or the electronic communication related to transmission over-temperature indicator operation a
diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On vehicles equipped with a Cummins diesel engine, the transmission throttle valve cable has
been replace by the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA). The TTVA consists of an electric
DC motor, two potentiometers, and a gear drive system. The TTVA is mechanically connected to
the transmission throttle valve in the valve body by the "D" shaped opening in the bottom of the
TTVA shaft. Changes in the TTVA position are therefore transferred to the throttle valve and cause
changes in the transmission throttle pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8577
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENT
The Transmission Throttle Valve Actuator (TTVA) does not require any mechanical adjustments.
All changes in throttle valve position are controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM).
The TTVA does require an initialization period after the actuator has been removed or replaced.
After the actuator has been removed or replaced, move the ignition to the ON position for thirty (30)
seconds. This will allow the ECM sufficient time to perform the internal calibration procedures to
learn the TTVA's current "zero" position. Once this is done, check the ECM for diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs). If no DTCs are set relating to the TTVA, the TTVA is fully calibrated and ready for
use.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the bolts (2) holding the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) to the
transmission case. 2. Allow the TTVA (1) to rotate clockwise away from the transmission.
3. Remove the wiring connector (2) from the TTVA (1). 4. Lift the TTVA (1) straight upward and off
the throttle valve shaft (3).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve Assembly,
A/T > Throttle Valve Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8580
Throttle Valve Solenoid: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position the transmission throttle valve actuator (TTVA) (1) over the throttle valve shaft (3). 2.
Align the D-shaped opening in the bottom of the TTVA to the throttle valve shaft and install the
TTVA onto the shaft. 3. Install the wiring connector (2) to the TTVA (1).
4. Rotate the TTVA (1) to the transmission case and install the bolts (2) to hold the TTVA to the
transmission. 5. Tighten the bolts to 8.5 Nm (75 in.lbs.). 6. Initialize the TTVA.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Transmission throttle valve cable (1) adjustment is extremely important to proper operation. This
adjustment positions the throttle valve, which controls shift speed, quality, and part-throttle
downshift sensitivity.
If cable setting is too loose, early shifts and slippage between shifts may occur. If the setting is too
tight, shifts may be delayed and part throttle downshifts may be very sensitive.
The transmission throttle valve is operated by a cam on the throttle lever. The throttle lever is
operated by an adjustable cable (3). The cable is attached to an arm mounted on the throttle lever
shaft. A retaining clip (2) at the engine-end of the cable is removed to provide for cable adjustment.
The retaining clip is then installed back onto the throttle valve cable to lock in the adjustment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8584
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS - THROTTLE VALVE CABLE
A correctly adjusted throttle valve cable (1) will cause the throttle lever on the transmission to move
simultaneously with the throttle body lever (3) from the idle position. Proper adjustment will allow
simultaneous movement without causing the transmission throttle lever to either move ahead of, or
lag behind the lever on the throttle body.
ADJUSTMENT VERIFICATION
1. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 2. Remove air cleaner. 3. Verify that lever on throttle body is at
curb idle position. Then verify that the transmission throttle lever is also at idle (fully forward)
position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8585
4. Slide cable off attachment stud on throttle body lever. 5. Compare position (B) of cable end to
attachment stud on throttle body lever:
- Cable end and attachment stud should be aligned (or centered on one another) to within 1 mm
(0.039 in.) in either direction (B).
- If cable end and attachment stud are misaligned (off center), cable will have to be adjusted as
described in Throttle Valve Cable Adjustment procedure.
6. Reconnect cable end to attachment stud. Then with aid of a helper, observe movement of
transmission throttle lever and lever on throttle body.
- If both levers move simultaneously from idle to half-throttle and back to idle position, adjustment is
correct.
- If transmission throttle lever moves ahead of, or lags behind throttle body lever, cable adjustment
will be necessary. Or, if throttle body lever prevents transmission lever from returning to closed
position, cable adjustment will be necessary.
ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8586
1. Turn ignition switch to OFF position. 2. Remove air cleaner if necessary. 3. Disconnect cable
end (3) from attachment stud on throttle lever (1). Carefully slide cable off stud. Do not pry or pull
cable off. 4. Verify that transmission throttle lever is in fully closed position. Then be sure lever on
throttle body is at curb idle position. 5. Pry the T.V. cable lock (A) into the UP position. This will
unlock the cable and allow for readjustment. 6. Apply just enough tension on the T.V. cable (B) to
remove any slack in the cable. Pulling too tight will cause the T.V. lever on the
transmission to move out of its idle position, which will result in an incorrect T.V. cable adjustment.
Slide the sheath of the T.V. cable (D) back and forth until the centerlines of the T.V. cable end (B)
and the throttle bell crank lever (C) are aligned within one millimeter (1mm).
7. While holding the T.V. cable in the set position push the T.V. cable lock (A) into the down
position. This will lock the present T.V. cable
adjustment.
NOTE: Be sure that as the cable is pulled forward and centered on the throttle lever stud, the cable
housing moves smoothly with the cable. Due to the angle at which the cable housing enters the
spring housing, the cable housing may bind slightly and create an incorrect adjustment.
8. Reconnect the T.V. cable (B) to the throttle bellcrank lever (C). 9. Check cable adjustment. Verify
transmission throttle lever and lever on throttle body move simultaneously.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The torque converter is a hydraulic device that couples the engine crankshaft to the transmission.
The torque converter consists of an outer shell with an internal turbine (1), a stator (4), an
overrunning clutch, an impeller (2), and an electronically applied converter clutch (6). The converter
clutch provides reduced engine speed and greater fuel economy when engaged. Clutch
engagement also provides reduced transmission fluid temperatures. The torque converter hub
drives the transmission oil (fluid) pump.
The torque converter is a sealed, welded unit that is not repairable and is serviced as an assembly.
CAUTION: The torque converter must be replaced if a transmission failure resulted in large
amounts of metal or fiber contamination in the fluid.
IMPELLER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8591
Impeller
The impeller is an integral part of the converter housing. The impeller consists of curved blades
placed radially along the inside of the housing on the transmission side of the converter. As the
converter housing is rotated by the engine, so is the impeller, because they are one and the same
and are the driving members of the system.
TURBINE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8592
Turbine
The turbine is the output, or driven, member of the converter. The turbine is mounted within the
housing opposite the impeller, but is not attached to the housing. The input shaft is inserted
through the center of the impeller and splined into the turbine. The design of the turbine is similar to
the impeller, except the blades of the turbine are curved in the opposite direction.
STATOR
The stator assembly is mounted on a stationary shaft which is an integral part of the oil pump. The
stator contains an over-running clutch (1-4), which allows the stator to rotate only in a clockwise
direction. When the stator is locked against the over-running clutch, the torque multiplication
feature of the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8593
torque converter is operational.
The stator (1) is located between the impeller (2) and turbine (4) within the torque converter case.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
The TCC was installed to improve the efficiency of the torque converter that is lost to the slippage
of the fluid coupling. Although the fluid coupling provides smooth, shock-free power transfer, it is
natural for all fluid couplings to slip. If the impeller and turbine were mechanically locked together, a
zero slippage condition could be obtained. A hydraulic piston (6) was added to the turbine (5), and
a friction material (7) was added to the inside of the front cover (1) to provide this mechanical
lock-up.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8594
Torque Converter Fluid Operation
The converter impeller (driving member), which is integral to the converter housing and bolted to
the engine drive plate, rotates at engine speed. The converter turbine (driven member), which
reacts from fluid pressure generated by the impeller, rotates and turns the transmission input shaft.
TURBINE
As the fluid that was put into motion by the impeller blades strikes the blades of the turbine, some
of the energy and rotational force is transferred into the turbine and the input shaft. This causes
both of them (turbine and input shaft) to rotate in a clockwise direction following the impeller. As the
fluid is leaving the trailing edges of the turbine's blades it continues in a "hindering" direction back
toward the impeller. If the fluid is not redirected before it strikes the impeller, it will strike the
impeller in a direction that would tend to slow it down.
STATOR
Stator Operation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8595
Torque multiplication is achieved by locking the stator's over-running clutch to its shaft. Under stall
conditions the turbine is stationary and the oil leaving the turbine blades strikes the face of the
stator blades and tries to rotate them in a counterclockwise direction. When this happens the
overrunning clutch of the stator locks and holds the stator from rotating. With the stator locked, the
oil strikes the stator blades (1) and is redirected into a "helping" direction before it enters the
impeller. This circulation of oil from impeller to turbine, turbine to stator, and stator to impeller, can
produce a maximum torque multiplication of about 1.75:1. As the turbine begins to match the speed
of the impeller, the fluid that was hitting the stator in such as way as to cause it to lock-up is no
longer doing so. In this condition of operation, the stator begins to free wheel and the converter
acts as a fluid coupling.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
The torque converter clutch is hydraulically applied or released when fluid is feed or vented from
the hydraulic circuit by the torque converter control (TCC) solenoid on the valve body. The torque
converter clutch is controlled by the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The torque converter clutch
engages in FOURTH gear, and in THIRD gear under various conditions, such as when the O/D
switch is OFF, or when the vehicle is cruising on a level surface after the vehicle has warmed up.
The torque converter clutch can also be engaged in the MANUAL SECOND gear position if high
transmission temperatures are sensed by the PCM. The torque converter clutch may disengage
momentarily when an increase in engine load is sensed by the PCM, such as when the vehicle
begins to go uphill or the throttle pressure is increased.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8596
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The torque converter is a hydraulic device that couples the engine crankshaft to the transmission.
The torque converter consists of an outer shell with an internal turbine (1), a stator (2), an
overrunning clutch, an impeller (5), and an electronically applied converter clutch (6). The converter
clutch provides reduced engine speed and greater fuel economy when engaged. Clutch
engagement also provides reduced transmission fluid temperatures. The torque converter hub (3)
drives the transmission oil (fluid) pump and contains an O-ring seal (4) to better control oil flow.
The torque converter is a sealed, welded unit that is not repairable and is serviced as an assembly.
CAUTION: The torque converter must be replaced if a transmission failure resulted in large
amounts of metal or fiber contamination in the fluid.
IMPELLER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8597
The impeller is an integral part of the converter housing. The impeller consists of curved blades
placed radially along the inside of the housing on the transmission side of the converter. As the
converter housing is rotated by the engine, so is the impeller, because they are one and the same
and are the driving members of the system.
TURBINE
The turbine is the output, or driven, member of the converter. The turbine is mounted within the
housing opposite the impeller, but is not attached to the housing. The input shaft is inserted
through the center of the impeller and splined into the turbine. The design of the turbine is similar to
the impeller, except the blades of the turbine are curved in the opposite direction.
STATOR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8598
The stator assembly is mounted on a stationary shaft which is an integral part of the oil pump. The
stator (1) is located between the impeller (2) and the turbine (4) within the torque converter case.
The stator contains an over-running clutch (1-4), which allows the stator to rotate only in a
clockwise direction. When the stator is locked against the over-running clutch, the torque
multiplication feature of the torque converter is operational.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8599
The TCC was installed to improve the efficiency of the torque converter that is lost to the slippage
of the fluid coupling. Although the fluid coupling provides smooth, shock-free power transfer, it is
natural for all fluid couplings to slip. If the impeller (3) and turbine (5) were mechanically locked
together, a zero slippage condition could be obtained. A hydraulic piston (6) with friction material
(7) was added to the turbine assembly (5) to provide this mechanical lock-up.
In order to reduce heat build-up in the transmission and buffer the powertrain against torsional
vibrations, the TCM can duty cycle the L/R-CC Solenoid to achieve a smooth application of the
torque converter clutch. This function, referred to as Electronically Modulated Converter Clutch
(EMCC) can occur at various times depending on the following variables:
- Shift lever position
- Current gear range
- Transmission fluid temperature
- Engine coolant temperature
- Input speed
- Throttle angle
- Engine speed
Operation
OPERATION
The converter impeller (driving member), which is integral to the converter housing and bolted to
the engine drive plate, rotates at engine speed. The converter turbine (driven member), which
reacts from fluid pressure generated by the impeller, rotates and turns the transmission input shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8600
TURBINE
As the fluid that was put into motion by the impeller blades strikes the blades of the turbine, some
of the energy and rotational force is transferred into the turbine and the input shaft. This causes
both of them (turbine and input shaft) to rotate in a clockwise direction following the impeller. As the
fluid is leaving the trailing edges of the turbine's blades it continues in a "hindering" direction back
toward the impeller. If the fluid is not redirected before it strikes the impeller, it will strike the
impeller in such a direction that it would tend to slow it down.
STATOR
Torque multiplication is achieved by locking the stator's over-running clutch to its shaft. Under stall
conditions (the turbine is stationary), the oil leaving the turbine blades strikes the face of the stator
blades and tries to rotate them in a counterclockwise direction. When this happens the
over-running clutch of the stator locks and holds the stator from rotating. With the stator locked, the
oil strikes the stator blades and is redirected into a "helping" direction before it enters the impeller.
This circulation of oil from impeller to turbine, turbine to stator, and stator to impeller, can produce a
maximum torque multiplication of about 1.75:1. As the turbine begins to match the speed of the
impeller, the fluid that was hitting the stator in such as way as to cause it to lock-up is no longer
doing so. In this condition of operation, the stator begins to free wheel and the converter acts as a
fluid coupling.
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC)
In a standard torque converter, the impeller and turbine are rotating at about the same speed and
the stator is freewheeling, providing no torque multiplication. By applying the turbine's piston and
friction material to the front cover, a total converter engagement can be obtained. The result of this
engagement is a direct 1:1 mechanical link between the engine and the transmission.
The clutch can be engaged in all gear ranges except first depending on the Tow/Haul and ERS
status. In normal operation, the clutch will engage after the shift to fourth gear. If the Tow/Haul
mode is enabled, the clutch will engage after the shift to third (direct) gear.
The TCM controls the torque converter clutch via the L/R-CC Solenoid. There are four TCC
operational modes:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8601
- No EMCC
- Partial EMCC
- Full EMCC
- Gradual EMCC Release
NO EMCC
Under No EMCC conditions, the L/R Solenoid is OFF. There are several conditions that can result
in NO EMCC operations. No EMCC can be initiated due to a fault in the transmission or because
the TCM does not see the need for EMCC under current driving conditions.
PARTIAL EMCC
Partial EMCC operation modulates the L/R Solenoid (duty cycle) to obtain partial torque converter
clutch application. Partial EMCC operation is maintained until Full EMCC is called for and actuated.
During Partial EMCC some slip does occur. Partial EMCC will usually occur at low speeds, low
load and light throttle situations.
FULL EMCC
During Full EMCC operation, the TCM increases the L/R Solenoid duty cycle to full ON after Partial
EMCC control brings the engine speed within the desired slip range of transmission input speed
relative to engine rpm.
GRADUAL EMCC RELEASE
This operation is to soften the change from Full or Partial EMCC to No EMCC. This is done at
mid-throttle by slowly decreasing the L/R Solenoid duty cycle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8602
Torque Converter: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The torque converter is a hydraulic device that couples the engine crankshaft to the transmission.
The torque converter consists of an outer shell with an lock-up damper (1), lock-up piston (3 ),
pump impeller (4), turbine runner (5), stator (6), and one-way clutch (7). The converter clutch
provides reduced engine speed and greater fuel economy when engaged. Clutch engagement also
provides reduced transmission fluid temperatures.
The torque converter is a sealed, welded unit that is not repairable and is serviced as an assembly.
CAUTION: The torque converter must be replaced if a transmission failure resulted in large
amounts of metal or fiber contamination in the fluid.
IMPELLER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8603
Impeller
The impeller is an integral part of the converter housing. The impeller consists of curved blades
placed radially along the inside of the housing on the transmission side of the converter. As the
converter housing is rotated by the engine, so is the impeller, because they are one and the same
and are the driving members of the system.
TURBINE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8604
Turbine
The turbine is the output, or driven, member of the converter. The turbine is mounted within the
housing opposite the impeller, but is not attached to the housing. The input shaft is inserted
through the center of the impeller and splined into the turbine. The design of the turbine is similar to
the impeller, except the blades of the turbine are curved in the opposite direction.
STATOR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8605
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8606
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: ‘~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Torque Converter: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission and torque converter from vehicle. 2. Place a suitable drain pan under the
converter housing end of the transmission.
CAUTION: Verify that transmission is secure on the lifting device or work surface, the center of
gravity of the transmission will shift when the torque converter is removed creating an unstable
condition. The torque converter is a heavy unit. Use caution when separating the torque converter
from the transmission.
3. Pull the torque converter forward until the center hub clears the oil pump seal. 4. Separate the
torque converter from the transmission.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Check converter hub and drive notches for sharp edges, burrs, scratches, or nicks. Polish the hub
and notches with 320/400 grit paper or crocus cloth if necessary. The hub must be smooth to avoid
damaging the pump seal at installation.
1. Lubricate oil pump seal lip with transmission fluid. 2. Place torque converter in position on
transmission.
CAUTION: Do not damage oil pump seal or bushing while inserting torque converter into the front
of the transmission.
3. Align torque converter to oil pump seal opening. 4. Insert torque converter hub into oil pump. 5.
While pushing torque converter inward, rotate converter until converter is fully seated in the oil
pump gears. 6. Check converter seating with a scale (1) and straightedge (2). Surface of converter
lugs should be 19mm (0.75 in.) to the rear of the straightedge
when converter is fully seated.
7. If necessary, temporarily secure converter with C-clamp attached to the converter housing. 8.
Install the transmission in the vehicle. 9. Fill the transmission with the recommended fluid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8609
Torque Converter: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission and torque converter from vehicle. 2. Place a suitable drain pan under the
converter housing end of the transmission.
CAUTION: Verify that transmission is secure on the lifting device or work surface, the center of
gravity of the transmission will shift when the torque converter is removed creating an unstable
condition. The torque converter is a heavy unit. Use caution when separating the torque converter
from the transmission.
3. Pull the torque converter forward until the center hub clears the oil pump seal. 4. Separate the
torque converter from the transmission.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Check converter hub and drive flats for sharp edges, burrs, scratches, or nicks. Polish the
hub and flats with 800/1000 grit paper or crocus cloth if necessary. Verify that the converter hub
O-ring is properly installed and is free from debris. The hub must be smooth to avoid damaging the
pump seal at installation.
1. Lubricate oil pump seal lip with transmission fluid. 2. Place torque converter in position on
transmission.
CAUTION: Do not damage oil pump seal or converter hub O-ring while inserting torque converter
into the front of the transmission.
3. Align torque converter to oil pump seal opening. 4. Insert torque converter hub into oil pump. 5.
While pushing torque converter inward, rotate converter until converter is fully seated in the oil
pump gears. 6. Check converter seating with a scale (1) and straightedge (2). Surface of converter
lugs should be at least 25 mm (1in.) to rear of straightedge
when converter is fully seated.
7. If necessary, temporarily secure converter with C-clamp attached to the converter housing. 8.
Install the transmission in the vehicle. 9. Fill the transmission with the recommended fluid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8610
Torque Converter: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission from vehicle. 2. Place a suitable drain pan under the converter housing
end of the transmission.
WARNING: Be certain the transmission is secure when removing the torque converter, the torque
converter is very heavy. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury or may be
fatal.
TC REMOVAL
3. Pull the torque converter forward until the center hub clears the oil pump seal. 4. Separate the
torque converter from the transmission.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Check converter hub and drive flats for sharp edges, burrs, scratches, or nicks. Polish the
hub and flats with 800/10000 grit paper or crocus cloth if necessary. Verify that the oil pump seal is
properly installed and is free from debris. The hub must be smooth to avoid damaging the pump
seal at installation.
TC REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8611
1. Lubricate oil pump seal lip and input shaft seal rings with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
WARNING: Be certain the transmission is secure when installing the torque converter, the torque
converter is very heavy. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury or may be
fatal.
2. Place torque converter in position on transmission.
CAUTION: Do not damage oil pump seal or input shaft seal rings while inserting torque converter
into the front of the transmission.
3. Align torque converter to oil pump seal opening. 4. Insert torque converter hub into oil pump. 5.
While pushing torque converter inward, rotate converter until converter is fully seated in the oil
pump gears. 6. Install the transmission into the vehicle.
7. Check converter seating with a scale (1) and straightedge (2). Surface of converter lugs should
be at least 28.2 mm (1.12 in.) to rear of
straightedge when converter is fully seated.
8. If necessary, temporarily secure converter with C-clamp attached to the converter housing. 9.
Install the transmission in the vehicle.
10. Fill the transmission with the recommended fluid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Check
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Torque Converter Check Valve: Description and Operation Description
DIESEL ENGINE
The converter drainback check valve is located in the in the TOC pressure - supply line, between
the engine mounted TOC and the air to oil TOC.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Check
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 8616
Torque Converter Check Valve: Description and Operation Operation
DIESEL ENGINE
The valve prevents fluid from draining from the converter into the cooler and lines when the vehicle
is shut down for lengthy periods. Production valves have pipe thread on one end, while the
opposite end is threaded for a flare fitting, and are threaded into the oil cooler mounted on the side
of the engine. All valves have an arrow (or similar mark) to indicate direction of flow through the
valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Check
Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8617
Torque Converter Check Valve: Service and Repair
DIESEL ENGINE
The converter drainback check valve is located in the in the TOC pressure - supply line, between
the engine mounted transmission oil cooler and the air to oil transmission oil cooler. The valve
prevents fluid drainback when the vehicle is parked for lengthy periods. The valve check ball is
spring loaded and has an opening pressure of approximately 2 psi.
The valve is serviced as an assembly; it is not repairable. Do not clean the valve if restricted, or
contaminated by sludge, or debris. If the valve fails, or if a transmission malfunction occurs that
generates significant amounts of sludge and/or clutch particles and metal shavings, the valve must
be replaced.
If the valve is restricted, installed backwards, or in the wrong line, it will cause an transmission
overheating condition and possible transmission failure.
CAUTION: The drainback valve is a one-way flow device. It must be properly oriented in terms of
flow direction for the cooler to function properly. The valve must be installed in the pressure line.
Otherwise flow will be blocked and would cause an transmission overheating condition and
eventual transmission failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8622
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8623
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8624
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8625
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8626
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8627
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8628
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8629
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8630
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8631
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8632
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8633
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8634
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8635
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8636
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8637
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8638
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8639
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8640
Transmission Control System Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Control
System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Due to different power control configurations, the Transmission Control Relay (if equipped)
may be referred to as a PCM relay.
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TIPM, and is used to supply power to the
TCM when the transmission is in normal operating mode.
Operation
OPERATION
The TIPM energizes the transmission control relay. When the relay is "off", no power is supplied to
the TCM and the transmission will not operate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Description and Operation > All Vehicles
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation All Vehicles
ALL VEHICLES
An air-to-oil transmission oil cooler is standard on all engine packages. The transmission oil cooler
is mounted to the front of the radiator above the power steering cooler and
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Description and Operation > All Vehicles > Page 8647
Transmission Cooler: Description and Operation Diesel
DIESEL
The 5.9L diesel models equipped with an automatic transmission are equipped with a water-to-oil
cooler and a separate air-to-oil cooler. Both coolers are supplied as standard equipment on diesel
engine powered models when equipped with an automatic transmission.
The water-to-oil transmission oil cooler is mounted to a bracket on the intake side of the engine.
The 6.7L model diesel with automatic transmission is equipped with an air-to-oil cooler only. This
cooler is located in front of the radiator.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Oil Cooler
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Transmission Oil Cooler
Air To Oil Cooler - Diesel
AIR TO OIL COOLER - DIESEL
1. Remove Charge Air Cooler. 2. Place a drain pan under the oil cooler. 3. Raise the vehicle. 4.
Disconnect the oil cooler quick-connect fittings from the transmission lines. 5. Remove the charge
air cooler-to-oil cooler bolt. 6. Remove two mounting nuts. 7. Remove the oil cooler and line
assembly towards the front of vehicle. Cooler must be rotated and tilted into position while
removing.
Water To Oil Cooler
REMOVAL - WATER TO OIL COOLER
CAUTION: If a leak should occur in the water-to-oil cooler mounted to the side of the engine block,
engine coolant may become mixed with transmission fluid. Transmission fluid may also enter
engine cooling system. Both cooling system and transmission should be drained and inspected in
case of oil cooler leakage.
1. Disconnect both battery negative cables. 2. Remove starter. 3. Drain cooling system. 4.
Disconnect coolant lines from cooler.
NOTE: Use a back-up wrench on the transmission cooler fittings to prevent damage to the cooler.
5. Disconnect transmission oil lines from cooler. Plug cooler lines to prevent oil leakage. 6. Remove
cooler bracket to transmission adapter bolt. 7. Remove wire harness push in clip at bottom of
coolant bracket. 8. Remove wire harness push in clip at bottom of coolant bracket. 9. Remove two
cooler bracket to block bolts.
10. Remove cooler assembly from vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Oil Cooler > Page 8650
Air To Oil Cooler - Diesel
AIR TO OIL COOLER - DIESEL
1. Carefully position the oil cooler assembly to the vehicle. 2. Install two nuts and one bolt. Tighten
to 11 Nm (95 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the quick-connect fittings to the transmission cooler lines.
4. Install Charge Air Cooler. 5. Start the engine and check all fittings for leaks. 6. Check the fluid
level in the automatic transmission.
Water-To-Oil Cooler
INSTALLATION - WATER-TO-OIL COOLER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Oil Cooler > Page 8651
1. Position oil cooler on cylinder block. 2. Install 2 capscrews to cylinder block finger tight. 3. Install
capscrews at the transmission adapter. Torque bolt to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) 4. Tighten lower mounting
bolt to cooler at the cylinder block. Tighten to 77 Nm (57 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Use a back-up wrench on the transmission cooler fittings to prevent damage to the cooler.
5. Tighten upper mounting bolt to cooler at cylinder block to 24 N.m (18 ft. lbs). 6. Install wire
harness push in clip at bottom of cooler bracket. 7. Install starter motor. 8. Connect battery
negative cables. 9. Fill cooling system.
10. Check transmission oil level and fill as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Oil Cooler > Page 8652
Transmission Cooler: Service and Repair Transmission Oil Cooler Lines
TRANSMISSION COOLER LINE QUICK CONNECT FITTING DISASSEMBLY/ASSEMBLY
DISCONNECT
1. Remove dust cap by pulling it straight back off of quick connect fitting. 2. Place disconnect tool
Special Tool 8875A onto transmission cooler line with the fingers of the tool facing the quick
connect fitting. 3. Slide disconnect tool down the transmission line and engage the fingers of the
tool into the retaining clip. When properly engaged in the clip, the
tool will fit flush against the quick connect fitting.
4. Rotate the disconnect tool 60° to expand the retaining clip. 5. While holding the disconnect tool
against the quick connect fitting, pull back on the transmission cooler line to remove.
CONNECT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Oil Cooler > Page 8653
1. Align transmission cooler line with quick connect fitting while pushing straight into the fitting. 2.
Push in on transmission cooler line until a "click" is heard or felt. 3. Slide dust cap down the
transmission cooler line and snap it over the quick connect fitting until it is fully seated and rotates
freely. Dust cap will
only snap over quick connect fitting when the transmission cooler line is properly installed.
NOTE: If dust cap will not snap into place, repeat assembly step 2.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8658
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8659
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8660
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8661
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8662
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8663
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8664
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8665
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8666
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8667
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8668
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8671
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8672
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8673
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8674
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8675
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8676
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8677
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8678
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8679
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8680
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 8681
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8684
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8685
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8686
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8687
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8688
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 8691
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 8692
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 8693
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 8694
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC Automatic Transmission > Page 8695
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8700
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8701
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8702
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8703
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8704
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8705
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8706
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8707
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8708
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8709
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8710
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8711
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8712
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8713
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8714
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8715
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8716
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8717
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8718
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8721
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8722
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8723
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8724
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8725
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8726
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8727
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8728
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8729
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8730
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8731
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8732
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8733
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8734
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8735
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8736
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8737
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8738
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page 8739
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor (1) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the park
gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed.
Operation
OPERATION
Speed sensor signals are triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup
face. Input signals from the sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing.
Signals from this sensor are shared with the powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8742
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8743
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
INPUT AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSORS
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate DC
square wave signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case
and are considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the "teeth"
of the gear pass by the sensor coil, an DC square wave is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an DC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the rear planetary carrier lugs. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the input speed sensor (3). 4. Remove the bolt holding the input speed sensor to
the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor (3) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the input speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the input
speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid as
necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8746
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the output speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the bolt holding the output speed sensor
(1) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor (1) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the output speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the output
speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor (1). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8747
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3.
Remove the wiring connector from the output speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the output
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8748
3. Remove the wiring connector from the input speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the input
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the output
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission fluid
level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF as necessary.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8749
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the input
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
electrical wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission
fluid level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8753
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8754
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission
Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 8755
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Valve Body: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The valve body consists of a cast aluminum valve body, a separator plate, and transfer plate. The
valve body contains valves and check balls that control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch,
bands, and frictional clutches. The valve body contains the following components.
By adjusting the spring pressure acting on the regulator valve, transmission line pressure can be
adjusted.
Upper Housing Control Valve Locations
- Regulator valve (2)
- Switch valve (3)
- Regulator valve spring (4)
- Kickdown valve (5)
- Kickdown detent (6)
- Throttle valve and spring (7)
- Manual valve (8)
- 1-2 Governor plug (9)
- Throttle pressure plug (11)
- 2-3 Governor plug (12)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8760
- Shuttle valve primary spring (13)
Shuttle and Boost Valve Locations
- Boost Valve (3)
- Boost valve plug (4)
- Shuttle valve (9)
- Shuttle valve throttle plug (12)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8761
Upper Housing Shift Valve and Pressure Plug Locations
- 1-2 shift valve (2)
- 1-2 control valve
- 2-3 shift valve
- 2-3 throttle plug
- Throttle pressure plug
- Limit valve and spring
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8762
Lower Housing Shift Valves and Springs
- 3-4 shift valve
- 3-4 timing valve
- 3-4 quick fill valve
- 3-4 accumulator
- Converter clutch lock-up valve
- Converter clutch lock-up timing valve
Operation
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for a visual aid in determining valve location, operation
and design.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8763
CHECK BALLS
REGULATOR VALVE
Regulator Valve in Park Position
The pressure regulator valve is needed to control the hydraulic pressure within the system and
reduce the amount of heat produced in the fluid. The pressure regulator valve is located in the
valve body near the manual valve. The pressure regulator valve train controls the maximum
pressure in the lines by metering the dumping of fluid back into the sump. Regulated pressure is
referred to as "line pressure."
The regulator valve has a spring on one end that pushes the valve to the left. This closes a dump
(vent) that is used to lower pressure. The closing of the dump will cause the oil pressure to
increase. Oil pressure on the opposite end of the valve pushes the valve to the right, opening the
dump and lowering oil pressure. The result is spring pressure working against oil pressure to
maintain the oil at specific pressures. With the engine running, fluid flows from the pump to the
pressure regulator valve, manual valve, and the interconnected circuits. As fluid is sent through
passages to the regulator valve, the pressure pushes the valve to the right against the large spring.
It is also sent to the reaction areas on the left side of the throttle pressure plug and the line
pressure plug. With the gear selector in the PARK position, fluid recirculates through the regulator
and manual valves back to the sump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8764
Regulator Valve in Neutral Position
Meanwhile, the torque converter is filled slowly. In all other gear positions, fluid flows between two
right side lands to the switch valve and torque converter. At low pump speeds, the flow is controlled
by the pressure valve groove to reduce pressure to the torque converter. After the torque converter
and switch valve fill with fluid, the switch valve becomes the controlling metering device for torque
converter pressure. The regulator valve then begins to control the line pressure for the other
transmission circuits. The balance of the fluid pressure pushing the valve to the right and the spring
pressure pushing to the left determines the size of the metering passage at land #2 (land #1 being
at the far right of the valve in the diagram). As fluid leaks past the land, it moves into a groove
connected to the filter or sump. As the land meters the fluid to the sump, it causes the pressure to
reduce and the spring decreases the size of the metering passage. When the size of the metering
passage is reduced, the pressure rises again and the size of the land is increased again. Pressure
is regulated by this constant balance of hydraulic and spring pressure.
Regulator Valve in Drive Position
The metering at land #2 establishes the line pressure throughout the transmission. It is varied
according to changes in throttle position and the transmission's internal condition within a range of
57-94 psi (except in REVERSE).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8765
Regulator Valve in Reverse Position
The regulated line pressure in REVERSE is held at much higher pressures than in the other gear
positions: 145-280 psi. The higher pressure for REVERSE is achieved by the manual valve
blocking the supply of line pressure to the reaction area left of land #4. With this pressure blocked,
there is less area for pressure to act on to balance the force of the spring on the right. This allows
line pressure to push the valve train to the right, reducing the amount of fluid returned to the
pump's inlet, increasing line pressure.
KICKDOWN VALVE
Kickdown Valve - Wide Open Throttle
When the throttle valve is as far over to the left as it can go, the maximum line pressure possible
will enter the throttle pressure circuit. In this case, throttle pressure will equal line pressure. With
the kickdown valve pushed into the bore as far as it will go, fluid initially flows through the annular
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8766
groove of the 2-3 shift valve (which will be in the direct drive position to the right).
After passing the annular groove, the fluid is routed to the spring end of the 2-3 shift valve. Fluid
pressure reacting on the area of land #1 overcomes governor pressure, downshifting the 2-3 shift
valve into the kickdown, or second gear stage of operation. The valve is held in the kickdown
position by throttle pressure routed from a seated check ball (#2). Again, if vehicle speed is low
enough, throttle pressure will also push the 1-2 shift valve left to seat its governor plug, and
downshift to drive breakaway.
KICKDOWN LIMIT VALVE
Kickdown Limit Valve - Low Speeds
The purpose of the limit valve is to prevent a 3-2 downshift at higher speeds when a part-throttle
downshift is not desirable. At these higher speeds only a full throttle 3-2 downshift will occur. At low
road speeds the limit valve does not come into play and does not affect the downshifts.
Kickdown Limit Valve - High Speeds
As the vehicle's speed increases, the governor pressure also increases. The increased governor
pressure acts on the reaction area of the bottom land of the limit valve overcoming the spring force
trying to push the valve toward the bottom of its bore. This pushes the valve upward against the
spring and bottoms the valve against the top of the housing. With the valve bottomed against the
housing, the throttle pressure supplied to the valve will be closed off by the bottom land of the limit
valve. When the supply of throttle pressure has been shut off, the 3-2 part throttle downshift plug
becomes inoperative, because no pressure is acting on its reaction area.
1-2 SHIFT VALVE
1-2 Shift Valve - Before Shift
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8767
The 1-2 shift valve assembly, or mechanism, consists of: the 1-2 shift valve, governor plug, and a
spring on the end of the valve. After the manual valve has been placed into a forward gear range,
line pressure is directed to the 1-2 shift valve. As the throttle is depressed, throttle pressure is
applied to the right side of the 1-2 shift valve assembly. With throttle pressure applied to the right
side of the valve, there is now both spring pressure and throttle pressure acting on the valve,
holding it against the governor plug. As the vehicle begins to move and build speed, governor
pressure is created and is applied to the left of the valve at the governor plug.
1-2 Shift Valve - After Shift
When governor pressure builds to a point where it can overcome the combined force of the spring
and throttle pressure on the other side of the valve, the valve will begin to move over to the right.
As the valve moves to the right, the middle land of the valve will close off the circuit supplying the
throttle pressure to the right side of the valve. When the throttle pressure is closed off, the valve will
move even farther to the right, allowing line pressure to enter another circuit and energize the front
servo, applying the front band.
The governor plug serves a dual purpose:
- It allows the shift valves to move either left or right, allowing both upshifts and downshifts.
- When in a manual selection position, it will be hydraulically "blocked" into position so no upshift
can occur.
The physical blocking of the upshift while in the manual "1" position is accomplished by the
directing of line pressure between both lands of the governor plug. The line pressure reacts against
the larger land of the plug, pushing the plug back against the end plate overcoming governor
pressure. With the combination of the line pressure and spring pressure, the valve cannot move,
preventing any upshift.
1-2 SHIFT CONTROL VALVE
1-2 Shift Control Valve
It contains a valve with four lands and a spring. It is used as both a "relay" and "balanced" valve.
The valve has two specific operations:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8768
- Aid in quality of the 1-2 upshift.
- Aid in the quality and timing of the 3-2 kickdown ranges.
When the manual valve is set to the DRIVE position and the transmission is in the first or second
gear range, 1-2 shift control or "modulated throttle pressure" is supplied to the middle of the
accumulator piston by the 1-2 shift control valve. During the 1-2 upshift, this pressure is used to
control the kickdown servo apply pressure that is needed to apply the kickdown and accumulator
pistons. Thus, the 1-2 shift point is "cushioned" and the quality is improved. During a WOT
kickdown, kickdown pressure is applied between the kickdown valve and the 1-2 shift control valve.
This additional pressure is directed to the 1-2 shift control's spring cavity, adding to the spring load
on the valve. The result of this increased "modulated" throttle pressure is a firmer WOT upshift.
2-3 SHIFT VALVE
2-3 Shift Valve - Before Shift
The 2-3 shift valve mechanism consists of the 2-3 shift valve, governor plug and spring, and a
throttle plug. After the 1-2 shift valve has completed its operation and applied the front band, line
pressure is directed to the 2-3 shift valve through the connecting passages from the 1-2 shift valve.
The line pressure will then dead-end at land #2 until the 2-3 valve is ready to make its shift. Now
that the vehicle is in motion and under acceleration, there is throttle pressure being applied to the
spring side of the valve and between lands #3 and #4.
2-3 Shift Valve - After Shift
As vehicle speed increases, governor pressure increases proportionately, until it becomes great
enough to overcome the combined throttle and spring pressure on the right side of the valve. Since
the throttle pressure end of the 2-3 shift valve is larger in diameter than the 1-2 shift valve, the 2-3
shift will always happen at a greater speed than the 1-2 shift. When this happens, the governor
plug is forced against the shift valve moving it to the right. The shift valve causes land #4 to close
the passage supplying throttle pressure to the 2-3 shift valve. Without throttle pressure present in
the circuit now, the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8769
governor plug will push the valve over far enough to bottom the valve in its bore. This allows land
#2 to direct line pressure to the front clutch.
After the shift, line pressure is directed to the release side of the kickdown servo. This releases the
front band and applies the front clutch, shifting into third gear or direct drive. The rear clutch
remains applied, as it has been in the other gears. During a manual "1" or manual "2" gear
selection, line pressure is sent between the two lands of the 2-3 governor plug. This line pressure
at the governor plug locks the shift valve into the second gear position, preventing an upshift into
direct drive. The theory for the blocking of the valve is the same as that of the 1-2 shift valve.
If the manual "2" or manual "1" gear position is selected from the drive position, the PCM will
control the timing of the downshift by targeting for a high governor pressure. When a safe vehicle
speed is reached, the PCM will switch to its normal control governor curve and the downshift will
occur.
3-4 SHIFT VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
The PCM energizes the overdrive solenoid during the 3-4 upshift. This causes the solenoid check
ball to close the vent port allowing line pressure from the 2-3 shift valve to act directly on the 3-4
upshift valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8770
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
Line pressure on the 3-4 shift valve overcomes valve spring pressure moving the valve to the
upshift position. This action exposes the feed passages to the 3-4 timing valve, 3-4 quick fill valve,
3-4 accumulator, and ultimately to the overdrive piston.
3-4 TIMING VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
The 3-4 timing valve is moved by line pressure coming through the 3-4 shift valve or the converter
clutch valve.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8771
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
After the shift, the timing valve holds the 2-3 shift valve in an upshift position. The purpose is to
prevent the 2-3 valve from downshifting while either the overdrive clutch or converter clutch is
applied.
3-4 QUICK FILL VALVE
3-4 Shift Valve Before Shift
The 3-4 quick fill valve provides faster engagement of the overdrive clutch during 3-4 upshifts. The
valve temporarily bypasses the clutch piston feed orifice at the start of a 3-4 upshift.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8772
3-4 Shift Valve After Shift
This exposes a larger passage into the piston retainer resulting in a much faster clutch fill and
apply sequence. The quick fill valve does not bypass the regular clutch feed orifice throughout the
3-4 upshift. Instead, once a predetermined pressure develops within the clutch, the valve closes
the bypass. Clutch fill is then completed through the regular feed orifice.
THROTTLE VALVE
Throttle Valve
In all gear positions, the throttle valve is being supplied with line pressure. The throttle valve meters
and reduces the line pressure that now becomes throttle pressure. The throttle valve is moved by a
spring and the kickdown valve, which is mechanically connected to the throttle. The larger the
throttle opening, the higher the throttle pressure (to a maximum of line pressure). The smaller the
throttle opening, the lower the throttle pressure (to a minimum of zero at idle). As engine speed
increases, the increase in pump speed increases pump output. The increase in pressure and
volume must be regulated to maintain the balance within the transmission. To do this, throttle
pressure is routed to the reaction area on the right side of the throttle pressure plug (in the
regulator valve).
The higher engine speed and line pressure would open the vent too far and reduce line pressure
too much. Throttle pressure, which increases with engine speed (throttle opening), is used to
oppose the movement of the pressure valve to help control the metering passage at the vent. The
throttle pressure is combined with spring pressure to reduce the force of the throttle pressure plug
on the pressure valve. The larger spring at the right closes the regulator valve passage and
maintains or increases line pressure. The increased line pressure works against the reaction area
of the line pressure plug and the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8773
reaction area left of land #3 simultaneously moves the regulator valve train to the right and controls
the metering passage.
The kickdown valve, along with the throttle valve, serve to delay upshifts until the correct vehicle
speed has been reached. It also controls downshifts upon driver demand, or increased engine
load. If these valves were not in place, the shift points would be at the same speed for all throttle
positions. The kickdown valve is actuated by a cam connected to the throttle. This is accomplished
through either a linkage or a cable. The cam forces the kickdown valve toward the throttle valve
compressing the spring between them and moving the throttle valve. As the throttle valve land
starts to uncover its port, line pressure is "metered" out into the circuits and viewed as throttle
pressure. This increased throttle pressure is metered out into the circuits it is applied to: the 1-2
and 2-3 shift valves. When the throttle pressure is high enough, a 3-2 downshift will occur. If the
vehicle speed is low enough, a 2-1 downshift will occur.
SWITCH VALVE
Switch Valve - Torque Converter Unlocked
When the transmission is in Drive Second before the TCC application occurs, the pressure
regulator valve is supplying torque converter pressure to the switch valve. The switch valve directs
this pressure through the transmission input shaft, into the converter, through the converter, back
out between the input shaft and the reaction shaft, and back up to the switch valve. From the
switch valve, the fluid pressure is directed to the transmission cooler, and lubrication pressure
returns from the cooler to lubricate different portions of the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8774
Switch Valve - Torque Converter Locked
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is a relay valve. The purpose of the manual valve is to direct fluid to the correct
circuit needed for a specific gear or driving range. The manual valve, as the name implies, is
manually operated by the driver with a lever located on the side of the valve body. The valve is
connected mechanically by either a cable or linkage to the gearshift mechanism. The valve is held
in each of its positions by a spring-loaded roller or ball that engages the "roostercomb" of the
manual valve lever.
Manual Valve
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8775
Once the TCC control valve has moved to the right, line pressure is directed to the tip of the switch
valve, forcing the valve to the right. The switch valve now vents oil from the front of the piston in the
torque converter, and supplies line pressure to the (rear) apply side of the torque converter piston.
This pressure differential causes the piston to apply against the friction material, cutting off any
further flow of line pressure oil. After the switch valve is shuttled right allowing line pressure to
engage the TCC, torque converter pressure is directed past the switch valve into the transmission
cooler and lubrication circuits.
CONVERTER CLUTCH LOCK-UP VALVE
The torque converter clutch (TCC) lock-up valve controls the back (ON) side of the torque
converter clutch. When the PCM energizes the TCC solenoid to engage the converter clutch
piston, pressure is applied to the TCC lock-up valve which moves to the right and applies pressure
to the torque converter clutch.
CONVERTER CLUTCH LOCK-UP TIMING VALVE
The torque converter clutch (TCC) lock-up timing valve is there to block any 4-3 downshift until the
TCC is completely unlocked and the clutch is disengaged.
SHUTTLE VALVE
The assembly is contained in a bore in the valve body above the shift valves. When the manual
valve is positioned in the Drive range, throttle pressure acts on the throttle plug of the shuttle valve
to move it against a spring, increasing the spring force on the shuttle valve. During a part or full
throttle 1-2 upshift, the throttle plug is bottomed by throttle pressure, holding the shuttle valve to the
right against governor pressure, and opening a by-pass circuit. The shuttle valve controls the
quality of the kickdown shift by restricting the rate of fluid discharge from the front clutch and servo
release circuits. During a 3-2 kickdown, fluid discharges through the shuttle by-pass circuit. When
the shuttle valve closes the by-pass circuit, fluid discharge is restricted and controlled for the
application of the front band. During a 2-3 "lift foot" upshift, the shuttle valve by-passes the
restriction to allow full fluid flow through the by-pass groove for a faster release of the band.
BOOST VALVE
Boost Valve Before Lock-up
The boost valve provides increased fluid apply pressure to the overdrive clutch during 3-4 upshifts,
and when accelerating in fourth gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8776
Boost Valve After Lock-up
The boost valve also serves to increase line pressure during torque converter lock-up.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8777
Valve Body: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
Valve Body Components
The valve body consists of a cast aluminum valve body, a separator plate, and a transfer plate. The
valve body contains valves and check balls that control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch
and frictional clutches. The valve body contains the following components:
- Solenoid switch valve
- Manual valve
- Low/reverse shuttle valve
- 5 Accumulators
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8778
Check Ball Locations
- 7 check balls
Operation
OPERATION
NOTE: Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for a visual aid in determining valve location, operation
and design.
SOLENOID SWITCH VALVE
The Solenoid Switch Valve (SSV) controls the direction of the transmission fluid when the L/R-TCC
solenoid is energized.
The Solenoid Switch Valve controls line pressure from the LR-TCC solenoid. In 1st gear, the SSV
will be in the downshifted position, thus directing fluid to the L/R clutch circuit. In all other gears, the
solenoid switch valve will be in the upshifted position and directs the fluid into the torque converter
clutch (TCC) circuit.
When shifting into 1st gear, a special hydraulic sequence is performed to ensure SSV movement
into the downshifted position. The L/R pressure switch is monitored to confirm SSV movement. If
the movement is not confirmed (the L/R pressure switch does not close), 2nd gear is substituted for
1st. A DTC will be set after three unsuccessful attempts are made to get into 1st gear in one given
key start.
MANUAL VALVE
The manual valve is a relay valve. The purpose of the manual valve is to direct fluid to the correct
circuit needed for a specific gear or driving range. The manual valve, as the name implies, is
manually operated by the driver with a lever located on the top of the valve body. The valve is
connected mechanically to the gearshift mechanism. The valve is held in each of its positions by a
roller detent spring (2) that engages the roostercomb of the TRS selector plate (1).
LOW/REVERSE SWITCH VALVE
The low/reverse switch valve allows the low/reverse clutch to be operated by either the LR/CC
solenoid or the MS solenoid.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8779
Valve Body: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The valve body consists of a two piece aluminum valve body. Extensive electronic control effected
by a microcomputer (the automatic transmission electronic control unit) over the hydraulic circuitry
enables precise control over gearshifts. The valve body contains valves and pressure sensors that
control fluid delivery to the torque converter clutch, forward clutches, and brake clutches.
UPPER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
The upper valve body contains the following components:
- 1 = Combined Drain
- 2 = Gain change solenoid valve
- 3 = Manual valve
- 4 = Modulator valve
- 5 = Shift solenoid valve No. 3
- 6 = Shift solenoid valve No. 2
- 7 = Shift valve No. 1
LOWER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8780
LOWER VALVE BODY
The lower valve body contains the following components:
- 1 = Control valve No. 3
- 2 = Shift solenoid valve No. 4
- 3 = Lockup control valve
- 4 = Control valve No. 1
- 5 = Control valve No. 2
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8781
VALVE BODY OIL SWITCH HARNESS
There are eight pressure switches and one ATF temperature switch used to inform the
Transmission Control Module (TCM) when there is pressure in various hydraulic circuits. Six of
them are located on the bottom of the valve body. The remainder are located on the top of the
valve body.
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8782
VALVE BODY SOLENOID HARNESS
Eight solenoids are used to control various shift functions in the transmission. Four are located on
the top of the valve body (3, 4) and the remainder are located on the bottom of the valve body.
Operation
OPERATION
LOWER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8783
LOWER VALVE BODY
UPPER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8784
UPPER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8785
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
VALVE BODY OIL SWITCH HARNESS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8786
SWITCHES AND SOLENOIDS
VALVE BODY SOLENOID HARNESS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 8787
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8788
Valve Body: Adjustments
ADJUSTMENTS - VALVE BODY
CONTROL PRESSURE ADJUSTMENTS
There are two control pressure adjustments on the valve body;
- Line Pressure
- Throttle Pressure
Line and throttle pressures are interdependent because each affects shift quality and timing. As a
result, both adjustments must be performed properly and in the correct sequence. Adjust line
pressure first and throttle pressure last.
LINE PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT
1. Measure distance (2) from the valve body to the inner edge of the adjusting screw with an
accurate steel scale. Distance should be 33.4 mm
(1-5/16 in.). If adjustment is required, turn the adjusting screw in, or out, to obtain required distance
setting.
NOTE: The 33.4 mm (1-5/16 in.) setting is an approximate setting. Manufacturing tolerances may
make it necessary to vary from this dimension to obtain desired pressure.
One complete turn of the adjusting screw changes line pressure approximately 1-2/3 psi (9 kPa).
Turning the adjusting screw counterclockwise increases pressure while turning the screw clockwise
decreases pressure.
THROTTLE PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT
2. Insert Throttle Setting Gauge Tool C-3763 between the throttle lever cam and the kickdown
valve stem (2). 3. Push the gauge tool inward to compress the kickdown valve against the spring
and bottom the throttle valve. 4. Maintain pressure against kickdown valve spring. Turn throttle
lever stop screw until the screw head touches throttle lever tang and the throttle
lever cam touches gauge tool.
NOTE: The kickdown valve spring must be fully compressed and the kickdown valve completely
bottomed to obtain correct adjustment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Valve Body: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean the valve housings, valves, plugs, springs, transfer plate and separator plate with a standard
parts cleaning solution only. Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or any type of caustic solution.
Do not immerse any of the electrical components in cleaning solution. Clean the electrical
components by wiping them off with dry shop towels only.
Dry all except the electrical parts with compressed air. Make sure all passages are clean and free
from obstructions. Do not use rags or shop towels to dry or wipe off valve body components. Lint
from these materials can stick to valve body parts, interfere with valve operation, and clog filters
and fluid passages.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8791
Valve Body Components
NOTE: Only the INNER accumulator seal ring actually seals the pressure in the bore. The outer
seal ring only serves to guide the piston in the bore. Gouges which do not extend past the inner
seal ring (and have no raised edges, which could damage the guide ring) are acceptable. The
machined accumulator bores often have a tiger-striped appearance. This is NORMAL and does
NOT require replacement, as long as the bores are smooth in the inner seal ring area.
Inspect all of the valve body mating surfaces for scratches, nicks, burrs, or distortion. Use a
straightedge to check surface flatness. Minor scratches may be removed with crocus cloth using
only very light pressure.
Minor distortion of a valve body mating surface may be corrected by smoothing the surface with a
sheet of crocus cloth. Position the crocus cloth on a surface plate, sheet of plate glass or equally
flat surface. If distortion is severe or any surfaces are heavily scored, the valve body will have to be
replaced.
Inspect the valves and plugs for scratches, burrs, nicks, or scores. Minor surface scratches on steel
valves and plugs can be removed with crocus cloth but do not round off the edges of the valve or
plug lands. Maintaining sharpness of these edges is vitally important. The edges prevent foreign
matter from lodging between the valves and plugs and the bore.
Inspect all the valve and plug bores in the valve body. Use a penlight to view the bore interiors.
Replace the valve body if any bores are distorted or scored. Inspect all of the valve body springs.
The springs must be free of distortion, warpage or broken coils.
Trial fit each valve and plug in its bore to check freedom of operation. When clean and dry, the
valves and plugs should drop freely into the bores.
Valve body bores do not normally change dimensionally with use. If the valve body functioned
correctly when new, it should continue to operate properly after cleaning and inspection. It should
not be necessary to replace a valve body assembly unless it is damaged in handling.
Inspect all the accumulator bores in the valve body as well as the accumulator piston seal rings,
and replace if cut or damaged. Use a penlight to view the bore interiors. Replace the valve body if
any bores are distorted or scored. Inspect all of the accumulator springs. The springs must be free
of distortion, warpage or broken coils.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8792
Valve Body Seals
Inspect all the fluid seals on the valve body. Replace any seals that are cracked, distorted, or
damaged in any way. These seals pass fluid pressure directly to the clutches. Any pressure leak at
these points, may cause transmission performance problems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8793
Valve Body: Service and Repair 48RE Automatic Transmission
Cleaning
CLEANING
Clean the valve housings, valves, plugs, springs, and separator plates with a standard parts
cleaning solution only. Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or any type of caustic solution.
Do not immerse any of the electrical components in cleaning solution. Clean the governor solenoid
and sensor and the dual solenoid and harness assembly by wiping them off with dry shop towels
only.
Dry all except the electrical parts with compressed air. Make sure all passages are clean and free
from obstructions. Do not use rags or shop towels to dry or wipe off valve body components. Lint
from these materials can stick to valve body parts, interfere with valve operation, and clog filters
and fluid passages.
Wipe the governor pressure sensor and solenoid valve with dry, lint free shop towels only. The
O-rings on the sensor and solenoid valve are the only serviceable components. Be sure the vent
ports in the solenoid valve are open and not blocked by dirt or debris. Replace the valve and/or
sensor only when DRB scan tool diagnosis indicates this is necessary. Or, if either part has
sustained physical damage (dented, deformed, broken, etc.).
CAUTION: Do not turn the small screw at the end of the solenoid valve for any reason. Turning the
screw in either direction will ruin solenoid calibration and result in solenoid failure. In addition, the
filter on the solenoid valve is NOT serviceable. Do not try to remove the filter as this will damage
the valve housing.
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect the throttle and manual valve levers and shafts. Do not attempt to straighten a bent shaft or
correct a loose lever. Replace these components if worn, bent, loose or damaged in any way.
Inspect all of the valve body mating surfaces for scratches, nicks, burrs, or distortion. Use a
straightedge to check surface flatness. Minor scratches may be removed with crocus cloth using
only very light pressure.
Minor distortion of a valve body mating surface may be corrected by smoothing the surface with a
sheet of crocus cloth. Position the crocus cloth on a surface plate, sheet of plate glass or equally
flat surface. If distortion is severe or any surfaces are heavily scored, the valve body will have to be
replaced.
CAUTION: Many of the valves and plugs, such as the throttle valve, shuttle valve plug, 1-2 shift
valve and 1-2 governor plug, are made of coated aluminum. Aluminum components are identified
by the dark color of the special coating applied to the surface (or by testing with a magnet). Do not
sand aluminum valves or plugs under any circumstances. This practice could damage the special
coating causing the valves/plugs to stick and bind.
Inspect the valves and plugs for scratches, burrs, nicks, or scores. Minor surface scratches on steel
valves and plugs can be removed with crocus cloth but do not round off the edges of the valve or
plug lands. Maintaining sharpness of these edges is vitally important. The edges prevent foreign
matter from lodging between the valves and plugs and the bore.
Inspect all the valve and plug bores in the valve body. Use a penlight to view the bore interiors.
Replace the valve body if any bores are distorted or scored. Inspect all of the valve body springs.
The springs must be free of distortion, warpage or broken coils.
Check the two separator plates for distortion or damage of any kind. Inspect the upper housing,
lower housing, 3-4 accumulator housing, and transfer plate carefully. Be sure all fluid passages are
clean and clear. Check condition of the upper housing and transfer plate check balls as well. The
check balls and ball seats must not be worn or damaged.
Trial fit each valve and plug in its bore to check freedom of operation. When clean and dry, the
valves and plugs should drop freely into the bores.
Valve body bores do not change dimensionally with use. If the valve body functioned correctly
when new, it will continue to operate properly after cleaning and inspection. It should not be
necessary to replace a valve body assembly unless it is damaged in handling.
The only serviceable valve body components are listed below. The remaining valve body
components are serviced only as part of a complete valve body assembly. Serviceable parts are:
- dual solenoid and harness assembly
- solenoid gasket
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8794
- solenoid case connector O-rings and shoulder bolt
- switch valve and spring
- pressure adjusting screw and bracket assembly
- throttle lever
- manual lever and shaft seal
- throttle lever shaft seal, washer, and E-clip
- fluid filter and screws
- detent ball and spring
- valve body screws
- governor pressure solenoid
- governor pressure sensor and retaining clip
- park lock rod and E-clip
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8795
Valve Body: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Cleaning
CLEANING
UPPER VALVE BODY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8796
LOWER VALVE BODY
Clean the valve housings, valves, plugs, springs, and separator plates with a standard parts
cleaning solution only. Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or any type of caustic solution.
Do not immerse any of the electrical components in cleaning solution. Clean the electrical
components by wiping them off with dry shop towels only.
Dry all except the electrical parts with compressed air. Make sure all passages are clean and free
from obstructions. Do not use rags or shop towels to dry or wipe off valve body components. Lint
from these materials can stick to valve body parts, interfere with valve operation, and clog filters
and fluid passages.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8797
SOLENOID FILTER SCREEN
1 - SOLENOID FILTER SCREEN
Clean the solenoid filter screen (1), (if equipped).
Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect all of the valve body mating surfaces for scratches, nicks, burrs, or distortion. Use a
straightedge to check surface flatness. Minor scratches may be removed with crocus cloth using
only very light pressure.
Minor distortion of a valve body mating surface may be corrected by smoothing the surface with a
sheet of crocus cloth. Position the crocus cloth on a surface plate, sheet of plate glass or equally
flat surface. If distortion is severe or any surfaces are heavily scored, the valve body will have to be
replaced.
Inspect the valves and plugs for scratches, burrs, nicks, or scores. Minor surface scratches on steel
valves and plugs can be removed with crocus cloth but do not round off the edges of the valve or
plug lands. Maintaining sharpness of these edges is vitally important. The edges prevent foreign
matter from lodging between the valves and plugs and the bore.
Inspect all the valve and plug bores in the valve body. Use a penlight to view the bore interiors.
Replace the valve body if any bores are distorted or scored. Inspect all of the valve body springs.
The springs must be free of distortion, warpage or broken coils.
Trial fit each valve and plug in its bore to check freedom of operation. When clean and dry, the
valves and plugs should drop freely into the bores.
Valve body bores do not change dimensionally with use. If the valve body functioned correctly
when new, it will continue to operate properly after cleaning and inspection. It should not be
necessary to replace a valve body assembly unless it is damaged in handling.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic Transmission > Page 8798
SOLENOID FILTER SCREEN
1 - SOLENOID FILTER SCREEN
Inspect all solenoid filter screens (1).
Inspect all the fluid seals in the transmission case. Replace any seals that are cracked, distorted, or
damaged in any way. These seals pass fluid pressure directly to the clutches. Any pressure leak at
these points, may cause transmission performance problems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Adjustments
Clutch Disc: Adjustments
PRESSURE PLATE DIAPHRAGM SPRINGS
NOTE:Perform the following procedure, when replacing only the clutch disc on Diesel vehicles with
Dual Mass Flywheel and self- adjusting
pressure plate. The pressure plate must be reset before installing a new disc.
1. Support pressure plate flange with press blocks (3) on a press. 2. Center press ram (2) on the
pressure plate diaphragm spring fingers (1). 3. Compress the diaphragm spring fingers (1), until
tension is released from the stepped adjusting ring.
4. Place two screwdrivers against two of the three stepped adjusting ring (1) tension spring stops,
just ahead of the adjusting ring tension springs on
the pressure plate (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Adjustments > Page 8803
5. Rotate stepped adjusting ring (1) on the pressure plate (2) counterclockwise until the coil springs
are fully compressed. Then hold adjusting ring
while releasing the press pressure.
6. Remove the screwdrivers. The pressure plate is know adjusted for a new clutch disc.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Clutch Disc - Removal
Clutch Disc: Service and Repair Clutch Disc - Removal
REMOVAL
1. Support engine with wood block and adjustable jack stand, to prevent strain on engine mounts.
2. Remove transmission and transfer case, if equipped. 3. If pressure plate (3) will be reused, mark
(2) the position on flywheel (1) with paint or scriber. Also note location marks on the pressure next
to the
bolt holes. The mark will be a L or a circle with an X in it.
4. Insert clutch alignment tool (3) through pressure plate (2) and into pilot bushing, to hold disc in
place while removing bolts. 5. Loosen pressure plate bolts evenly, a few threads at a time and in a
diagonal pattern to prevent warping the plate. 6. Remove bolts completely and remove pressure
plate, disc and alignment tool.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Clutch Disc - Removal > Page 8806
Clutch Disc: Service and Repair Clutch Disc - Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Before installing a clutch disc on the Diesel engine with Dual Mass Flywheel and
self-adjusting pressure plate, the pressure plate must be reset. Failure to reset the pressure will
result in damage to the clutch disc.
1. Check runout and free operation of new clutch disc. 2. Lubricate crankshaft pilot bearing with a
NLGI - 2 rated grease. 3. Install clutch alignment tool in clutch disc hub with the raised side of hub
is facing away from the flywheel.
NOTE: Flywheel side is imprinted on the disc face.
4. Install alignment tool (3) in pilot bearing and position disc on the flywheel (1). 5. Position
pressure plate over disc (2) and onto the flywheel.
NOTE: Over the wear life of a clutch disc the pressure plate will loose some of it's clamp load. It is
recommended when replacing a worn clutch, the pressure plate is replaced at the same time.
6. Align and hold pressure plate in position and install bolts finger tight. 7. Tighten bolts evenly and
a few threads at a time in a diagonal pattern.
CAUTION: Bolts must be tightened evenly and to specified torque to avoid warping pressure plate
cover.
8. Tighten pressure plate bolts to:
- V6 & V8 Engines - 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
- Diesel Engines - 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Clutch Disc - Removal > Page 8807
9. Remove release lever (3) and release bearing from clutch housing (1). Apply Mopar(R) high
temperature bearing grease to bore (4) of release
bearing, release lever (5) contact surfaces and release lever pivot stud (2).
10. Apply light coat of Mopar(R) high temperature bearing grease to splines (3) of transmission
input shaft (1) and to release bearing slide surface of
the transmission front bearing retainer (2).
CAUTION: Do not over lubricate shaft splines. This can result in grease contamination of the disc.
11. Wipe pilot bearing surface clean.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Disc, M/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Clutch Disc - Removal > Page 8808
12. Install release lever and bearing in clutch housing. Verify spring clips (2) that retain lever on
pivot ball (4) and release bearing (3) are installed
properly.
NOTE: If release lever is installed correctly, the lever part number will be toward the bottom of the
transmission and right side up. There is also a stamped "I" in the lever which goes to the pivot ball
side of the transmission.
13. Install transmission and transfer case if equipped. 14. Check fluid level in clutch master cylinder
and depress clutch pedal several time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Clutch Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8814
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8815
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Chrysler does not provide a fluid type specification for the master/slave cylinder.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The hydraulic linkage has a quick disconnect at the slave cylinder. This fitting should
never be disconnected or tampered with. Once the hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder,
it should never be disconnected.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove heat shield over hydraulic line. 3. Remove slave cylinder
(2) nuts (1) on clutch housing. 4. Remove slave cylinder from clutch housing. 5. Remove plastic clip
securing the hydraulic line to the dash panel from the lower dash panel flange. 6. Remove plastic
clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel from the upper dash panel stud. 7. Lower vehicle.
8. Disconnect clutch pedal interlock switch connector (2). 9. Remove clutch master cylinder (1) rod
pin (3).
10. Ensure cap on clutch cylinder reservoir is tight. 11. Remove clutch master cylinder nuts holding
cylinder to the dash panel. 12. Remove clutch cylinders, reservoir and connecting lines from
vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8820
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position cylinders and connecting line in vehicle engine compartment. Position clutch hydraulic
line against the dash panel and behind all engine
hoses and wiring.
2. Apply a light coating of grease to the inside diameter of the master cylinder push rod eye. 3.
Install clutch master cylinder (1) on dash panel and tighten clutch master cylinder nuts to 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs.). 4. Install clutch master cylinder push rod pin (3). 5. Connect clutch pedal position
interlock switch connector (2). 6. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel into the
lower dash panel flange. 7. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel onto the
upper dash panel stud. 8. Raise vehicle.
9. Install slave cylinder (2) and verify cylinder rod is properly seated in release lever.
10. Install and tighten slave cylinder nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 11. If new clutch linkage is being
installed, connect the clutch hydraulic line to the clutch slave cylinder.
CAUTION: Once the clutch hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder, it should never be
disconnected.
12. Install heat shield over hydraulic line. 13. Operate linkage several times to verify proper
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The hydraulic linkage has a quick disconnect at the slave cylinder. This fitting should
never be disconnected or tampered with. Once the hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder,
it should never be disconnected.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove heat shield over hydraulic line. 3. Remove slave cylinder
(2) nuts (1) on clutch housing. 4. Remove slave cylinder from clutch housing. 5. Remove plastic clip
securing the hydraulic line to the dash panel from the lower dash panel flange. 6. Remove plastic
clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel from the upper dash panel stud. 7. Lower vehicle.
8. Disconnect clutch pedal interlock switch connector (2). 9. Remove clutch master cylinder (1) rod
pin (3).
10. Ensure cap on clutch cylinder reservoir is tight. 11. Remove clutch master cylinder nuts holding
cylinder to the dash panel. 12. Remove clutch cylinders, reservoir and connecting lines from
vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave Cylinder
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8825
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position cylinders and connecting line in vehicle engine compartment. Position clutch hydraulic
line against the dash panel and behind all engine
hoses and wiring.
2. Apply a light coating of grease to the inside diameter of the master cylinder push rod eye. 3.
Install clutch master cylinder (1) on dash panel and tighten clutch master cylinder nuts to 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs.). 4. Install clutch master cylinder push rod pin (3). 5. Connect clutch pedal position
interlock switch connector (2). 6. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel into the
lower dash panel flange. 7. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel onto the
upper dash panel stud. 8. Raise vehicle.
9. Install slave cylinder (2) and verify cylinder rod is properly seated in release lever.
10. Install and tighten slave cylinder nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 11. If new clutch linkage is being
installed, connect the clutch hydraulic line to the clutch slave cylinder.
CAUTION: Once the clutch hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder, it should never be
disconnected.
12. Install heat shield over hydraulic line. 13. Operate linkage several times to verify proper
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Hydraulic Hose,
Clutch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Hydraulic Hose: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
CAUTION: The hydraulic linkage has a quick disconnect at the slave cylinder. This fitting should
never be disconnected or tampered with. Once the hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder,
it should never be disconnected.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove heat shield over hydraulic line. 3. Remove slave cylinder
(2) nuts (1) on clutch housing. 4. Remove slave cylinder from clutch housing. 5. Remove plastic clip
securing the hydraulic line to the dash panel from the lower dash panel flange. 6. Remove plastic
clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel from the upper dash panel stud. 7. Lower vehicle.
8. Disconnect clutch pedal interlock switch connector (2). 9. Remove clutch master cylinder (1) rod
pin (3).
10. Ensure cap on clutch cylinder reservoir is tight. 11. Remove clutch master cylinder nuts holding
cylinder to the dash panel. 12. Remove clutch cylinders, reservoir and connecting lines from
vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Hydraulic Hose,
Clutch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8830
Hydraulic Hose: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Position cylinders and connecting line in vehicle engine compartment. Position clutch hydraulic
line against the dash panel and behind all engine
hoses and wiring.
2. Apply a light coating of grease to the inside diameter of the master cylinder push rod eye. 3.
Install clutch master cylinder (1) on dash panel and tighten clutch master cylinder nuts to 28 Nm
(21 ft. lbs.). 4. Install clutch master cylinder push rod pin (3). 5. Connect clutch pedal position
interlock switch connector (2). 6. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel into the
lower dash panel flange. 7. Install plastic clip securing hydraulic line to the dash panel onto the
upper dash panel stud. 8. Raise vehicle.
9. Install slave cylinder (2) and verify cylinder rod is properly seated in release lever.
10. Install and tighten slave cylinder nuts (1) to 23 Nm (17 ft. lbs.). 11. If new clutch linkage is being
installed, connect the clutch hydraulic line to the clutch slave cylinder.
CAUTION: Once the clutch hydraulic line is connected to the slave cylinder, it should never be
disconnected.
12. Install heat shield over hydraulic line. 13. Operate linkage several times to verify proper
operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH-CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION
1. Disconnect switch 2-wire connector (2) attached to pedal support bracket (1), under instrument
panel to left of clutch pedal. 2. Check switch continuity with an ohmmeter while operating clutch
pedal.
- Pedal Depressed - Continuity
- Pedal Released - No Continuity
3. If continuity is not present or always present, replace clutch master cylinder. Switch is not
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Clutch Release Bearing: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission and transfer case, if equipped. 2. Remove spring clip (6). 3. Disconnect
release bearing (4) from release lever (3) and remove bearing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Bearing, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8838
Clutch Release Bearing: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect bearing slide surface on transmission front bearing retainer. Replace retainer if slide
surface is scored, worn, or cracked. 2. Inspect release lever (2) and pivot stud (1). Verify stud is
secure and in good condition and lever is not distorted or worn. Replace fork spring clips
if bent or damaged.
3. Lubricate input shaft splines, bearing retainer slide surface, pivot stud (1) and release lever pivot
surface with Mopar(R) high temperature bearing
grease.
4. Install release fork and release bearing. Verify fork and bearing are properly secured by spring
clips and release lever is installed properly. Rear
side of release lever has one end with a raised area, which goes toward the slave cylinder side of
the transmission.
5. Install transmission and transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Clutch Release Fork: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission and transfer case, if equipped. 2. Remove spring clip (6). 3. Disconnect
release bearing (4) from release lever (3) and remove bearing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8843
Clutch Release Fork: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect bearing slide surface on transmission front bearing retainer. Replace retainer if slide
surface is scored, worn, or cracked. 2. Inspect release lever (2) and pivot stud (1). Verify stud is
secure and in good condition and lever is not distorted or worn. Replace fork spring clips
if bent or damaged.
3. Lubricate input shaft splines, bearing retainer slide surface, pivot stud (1) and release lever pivot
surface with Mopar(R) high temperature bearing
grease.
4. Install release fork and release bearing. Verify fork and bearing are properly secured by spring
clips and release lever is installed properly. Rear
side of release lever has one end with a raised area, which goes toward the slave cylinder side of
the transmission.
5. Install transmission and transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pilot Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal
Pilot Bearing: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove transmission assembly from the vehicle. 2. Remove pressure plate (2) and clutch disc.
3. Remove pilot bearing with an internal puller and slide hammer to remove.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pilot Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Removal > Page 8848
Pilot Bearing: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean bearing bore with solvent and wipe dry with shop towel. 2. Install new bearing (1) with
clutch alignment tool (2) and letter side of the bearing (3) facing the transmission. Bearing should
be flush with edge
of bearing bore.
CAUTION: Do not allow bearing to become cocked and do not recess bearing.
3. Install clutch disc, pressure plate and transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pressure Plate > Component Information >
Specifications
Pressure Plate: Specifications
Pressure Plate
Align and hold pressure plate in position and install bolts finger tight. Tighten bolts evenly and a few
threads at a time in a diagonal pattern.
CAUTION: Bolts must be tightened evenly and to specified torque to avoid warping pressure plate
cover.
Pressure Plate Bolts - V6 & V8 Tighten to ...........................................................................................
....................................................................................................... 50 Nm (37 ft.lbs.) Pressure Plate
Bolts - Diesel Tighten to ......................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 30 Nm (22 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Differential, CVT > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid
Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Differential, CVT > Differential Fluid - CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid
Flushing Information > Page 8858
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Fluid CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - CVT: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT > Fluid CVT > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8863
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Actuator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove actuator wiring connector. 2. Remove actuator (1) bolts (2).
3. Remove actuator (1) from disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8870
Actuator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean actuator (1) sealing surface and install new gasket (2) if necessary.
2. Align actuator shift fork (1) with disconnect collar (2) and install actuator on disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Actuator, Differential Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8871
3. Install actuator (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Install disconnect actuator wiring
connector. 5. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Locations Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8876
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8877
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8878
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8879
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8880
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Diagrams Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8883
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8884
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8885
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8886
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Actuators and Solenoids - Differential >
Solenoid, Differential Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8887
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD
Differential Cover: Service and Repair Front Axle - C205FD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove vent hose. 3. Remove differential
cover (1) bolts (2). 4. Remove cover and drain lubricant.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a 4 mm (0.15 in.) bead of Mopar(R) Silicone Rubber Sealant (1) or equivalent to the cover
(2).
CAUTION: If housing cover is not installed within 3 to 5 minutes, the cover must be cleaned and
new RTV applied. Failure to follow these instructions will result in a leak.
2. Install cover (2) and identification tag. Tighten cover bolts in a criss-cross pattern to 23 Nm (17 ft.
lbs.). 3. Fill differential to specifications. 4. Install fill plug.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8892
Differential Cover: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 9 1/4
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove drain plug. 3. Remove cover bolts.
4. Remove cover and drain lubricant.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Apply a 6.35mm (1/4 in.) bead of Mopar(R) Silicone Rubber Sealant (1) or equivalent to the
cover (2).
CAUTION: If housing cover is not installed within 3 to 5 minutes, the cover must be cleaned and
new RTV applied. Failure to follow these instructions will result in a leak.
2. Install cover and identification tag. Tighten cover bolts in a criss-cross pattern to 41 Nm (30 ft.
lbs.). 3. Fill differential with lubricant to specifications. 4. Install fill plug.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Actuator, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Actuator: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove actuator wiring connector. 2. Remove actuator (1) bolts (2).
3. Remove actuator (1) from disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Actuator, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8898
Actuator: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean actuator (1) sealing surface and install new gasket (2) if necessary.
2. Align actuator shift fork (1) with disconnect collar (2) and install actuator on disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Actuator, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8899
3. Install actuator (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.). 4. Install disconnect actuator wiring
connector. 5. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Locations Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8904
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8905
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8906
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8907
Solenoid: Locations Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Locations > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8908
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Solenoid: Diagrams Module-Axle Disconnect-Front
Component ID: 200
Component : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Connector:
Name : MODULE-AXLE DISCONNECT-FRONT
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (LD 4WD)
Pin Description Circuit
1 GROUND Z906 20BK
2 FRONT AXLE LOCK CONTROL G304 20VT/DB
3 FUSED B(+) A880 20DB/RD
4 FRONT AXLE LOCK SIGNAL G303 20VT/DG
Component Location - 35
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8911
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8912
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Front
Component ID: 442
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-FRONT
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 18YL/BK
3 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 18YL/LB
4 FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
Component Location - 36
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8913
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8914
Solenoid: Diagrams Solenoid-Locker-Rear
Component ID: 443
Component : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Connector:
Name : SOLENOID-LOCKER-REAR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
Pin Description Circuit
1 REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
2 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 18YL/BK
3 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 18YL/TN
4 REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 70
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Differential Lock > Solenoid, Differential
Lock > Component Information > Diagrams > Module-Axle Disconnect-Front > Page 8915
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Differential: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 8920
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Front Axle C205FD ..............................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 1.6 L ( 56 ounces) 9 1/4 AA .........................................
............................................................................................................................................................
2.2 L (74 ounces) 9 1/4 AA EL ............................................................................................................
................................................................................... 2.0 L (68 ounces)
Rear Axle 9 1/4 ....................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 2.1 L (72 ounces) 10 1/2 AA ........................................
...........................................................................................................................................................
2.5 L (85 ounces) 10 1/2 AA EL ..........................................................................................................
................................................................................... 2.5 L (85 ounces) 11 1/2 AA Open ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 4.2 L (142 ounces) 11 1/2 AA Trac-Rite ......................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 4.0 L (135 ounces)
Note: With Track-Lok add 118 ml (4 oz) of Limited Slip Additive.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 8923
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Note: DaimlerChrysler recommends using Mopar lubricants or lubricants of equal quality.
Front Axle c205FD - Mopar Gear Lubricant 75W-90 9 1/4 AA - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant
75W-90 9 1/4 AA EL - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90
Rear Axle 9 1/4 - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-140 10 1/2 AA - Mopar Synthetic Gear
Lubricant 75W-90 10 1/2 AA EL - Mopar Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90 11 1/2 AA - Mopar
Synthetic Gear Lubricant 75W-90
Note: Trac-Lok differentials require Limited Slip Additive in the lubricant. Trac-Rite/Trac-Rite EL
differential DO NOT require Limited Slip Additive.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from disconnect side of the axle. 2. Remove disconnect actuator wiring
connector. 3. Remove disconnect actuator (1) bolts (2) and remove actuator from disconnect
pocket.
4. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2) from output shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8929
5. Remove disconnect seal (1) bolts (2).
6. Remove output shaft (1) and disconnect seal (2) with Remover 8420A (3) and Slide Hammer
C-3752.
7. Slide disconnect collar (1) from intermediate shaft (2) and remove through disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8930
8. Remove differential cover. 9. Drive intermediate shaft (1) out of side gear with a hammer and
brass punch (2).
10. Remove intermediate shaft (1) from disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8931
11. Install Puller 9766 (1) in intermediate shaft bearing (2) then tighten nut (3) to expand tool in
bearing.
12. Tighten puller (1) nut (2) to remove intermediate shaft bearing from disconnect pocket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8932
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install intermediate shaft bearing (1) with Installer 9767 (2) and Handle C-4171.
CAUTION: Bearing must be installed with lettering facing outwards. Failure to follow these
instructions will damage the bearing.
2. Install new intermediate shaft snap ring. 3. Install intermediate shaft (1) through disconnect
pocket (2) and verify intermediate shaft snap ring is seated in side gear.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8933
4. Install disconnect collar (1) through disconnect pocket onto intermediate shaft (2).
5. Position disconnect collar (1) on intermediate shaft (2) in 2WD position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 8934
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Axle - C205FD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from disconnect side of the axle. 2. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2) from
the output shaft.
3. Remove disconnect seal (1) bolts (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8939
4. Remove output shaft and disconnect seal (1) with Remover 8420A (2) and Slide Hammer
C-3752.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify output shaft bearing cup (1) is seated in disconnect pocket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8940
2. Install output shaft (1) in disconnect pocket (2).
3. Install disconnect seal (1) on output shaft (2).
4. Align disconnect seal (1) with bolt holes in disconnect pocket with Pins MD998412 (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8941
5. Install disconnect seal (1) in disconnect pocket with Installer 6761(2) and a hammer.
6. Install disconnect seal (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
7. Install output shaft O-ring (1) and snap ring (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8942
8. Install half shaft. 9. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from vehicle. 2. Clean axle seal area. 3. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2)
from axle shaft (3).
4. Remove axle with Remove 8420A (2,3,4) and Slide Hammer C-3752. 5. Remove axle shaft seal
with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8943
1. Wipe axle shaft tube bore clean. 2. Install new axle shaft seal with Installer 8694 (1). 3. Install
axle shaft with new snap ring and verify axle shaft snap ring is seated in side gear.
4. Install O-ring (1) and snap ring (2) on axle shaft (3). 5. Install half shaft. 6. Verify differential fluid
level and add fluid if necessary.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8944
1. With axle in 2WD remove front propeller shaft and left half shaft. 2. Rotate pinion gear three or
four times and verify pinion rotates smoothly. 3. Record pinion torque to rotate with an inch pound
torque wrench (2), for installation reference. 4. Position Holder 6719 against the companion flange
(1) and install a four bolts and washers into the threaded holes and tighten the bolts. 5. Remove
pinion nut.
6. Mark a line across the pinion shaft and flange for installation reference. 7. Remove companion
flange with (1) Remover C-452 (2). 8. Remove pinion seal with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8945
1. Apply a light coating of gear lubricant on the lip of pinion seal. 2. Install seal with Installer 8695
(2) and Handle C-4171 (1). 3. Install flange on the pinion shaft with the reference marks aligned. 4.
Install companion flange onto the pinion with Installer C-3718 and Holder 6719A.
5. Position holder (2) against the companion flange and install four bolts and washers into the
threaded holes. Tighten the bolt and washer so that the
holder is held to the flange.
6. Install a new pinion nut onto the pinion shaft and tighten the pinion nut until there is zero bearing
end-play
CAUTION: Do not exceed 271 Nm (200 ft. lbs.) the minimum tightening torque when installing the
companion flange at this point. Never loosen pinion nut to decrease pinion bearing rotating torque
and never exceed specified preload torque. Failure to follow these instruction will damage the axle.
7. Measure pinion Torque To Rotate with an inch pound torque wrench (2). Pinion Torque To
Rotate should be equal to recorded reading plus an
additional 0.56 Nm (5 in. lbs.).
8. If rotating torque is low, tighten the pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until pinion Torque
To Rotate is achieved.
CAUTION: If maximum tightening torque 475 Nm (350 ft. lbs.) is reached prior to reaching the
required rotating torque, the collapsible spacer may have been damaged. Failure to follow these
instruction will damage the axle.
9. Install propeller shaft and half shafts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8946
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Axle - 9 1/4 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove hub bearings and axle shafts. 2. Remove differential from differential housing (2). 3.
Remove differential bearing adjusters (1).
4. Remove axle seals (2) located behind adjusters with Receiver 8498 and Extractor 6310.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8947
5. Install Receiver 8498 (1) into the adjuster bore. 6. Install Extractor Rod 6310 with Extractor Foot
6310-9 (2) through the receiver and axle seal.
7. Install Extractor Plate 6310-2 and Nut 6310-7 (2) on the extractor rod (1). 8. Tighten nut (2) on
extractor rod (1) to pull seal into the receiver.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install axle seal on Installer Cups 8885-2 (1) (3) and position cups with seals into the housing.
NOTE: Seals are installed with the axle guide facing outward.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8948
2. Install Turnbuckle 8885-1(2) into installer cups and expand the turnbuckle until the seals bottom
out in the housing.
3. Install adjuster (1) into the differential housing (2). 4. Install differential in housing. 5. Install axle
shaft and hub bearings.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Mark propeller shaft and pinion flange (1) for installation reference. 2. Remove propeller shaft. 3.
Remove hub bearings and axle shafts. 4. Rotate pinion gear three or four times. 5. Record pinion
torque to rotate (1) with an inch pound torque wrench (2) for installation reference.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8949
6. Hold pinion flange (1) with Flange Wrench 8979 (2) and remove pinion flange nut and washer.
7. Mark a line across the pinion shaft and flange for installation reference. 8. Remove pinion flange
(1) with Pinion Flange Puller 8992 (2). 9. Remove pinion seal with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install new pinion seal with Installer 8882 (2) and Handle C-4171 (1). 2. Apply a light coat of
teflon thread sealant, to pinion flange splines.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8950
3. Install flange on the pinion shaft with the reference marks aligned. 4. Lightly tap pinion flange
onto the pinion, until a few threads are showing. 5. Install flange washer and new pinion nut. 6.
Hold flange (1) with Flange Wrench 8979 (2) and tighten pinion nut until pinion end play is taken
up.
7. Rotate pinion flange (1) several times to seat bearings. 8. Measure pinion torque to rotate (1)
with an inch pound torque wrench (2). Pinion torque to rotate should be equal to recorded reading
plus an
additional 0.40-0.57 Nm (3-5 in. lbs.).
9. If torque to rotating is low, tighten the pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until pinion
torque to rotate is achieved.
10. Rotate pinion several times then verify pinion torque to rotate again. 11. Install axle shafts and
hub bearings. 12. Install propeller shaft with reference marks aligned.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8951
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 9 1/4
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft. 2. Remove axle shaft seal (1) from the axle tube with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe the axle tube bore clean. Remove any old sealer or burrs from the tube. 2. Coat the lip of
the new seal with axle lubricant and install a seal with Installer C-4076-B and Handle C-4735.
NOTE: When tool contacts the axle tube, the seal is installed to the correct depth.
3. Install the axle shaft (1). 4. Install differential cover and fill with gear lubricant to the bottom of the
fill plug hole.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8952
1. Mark universal joint, companion flange and pinion shaft for installation reference. 2. Remove
propeller shaft from the companion flange. 3. Remove the brake rotors to prevent any drag. 4.
Rotate companion flange three or four times. 5. Record pinion torque to rotating (1) with an inch
pound torque wrench (2).
6. Install two bolts into the companion flange threaded holes, 180° apart. Position Holder 6719A
against the companion flange and install and tighten
two bolts and washers into the remaining holes.
7. Hold the companion flange with Holder 6719A and remove pinion nut and washer. 8. Mark a line
across the pinion shaft and flange for installation reference. 9. Remove companion flange with
Puller C-452 (2).
10. Remove pinion seal with seal puller or slide-hammer mounted screw.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8953
1. Apply a light coating of gear lubricant on the lip of pinion seal. 2. Install new pinion seal (3) with
Handle C-4735 and Installer C-4076-B (1).
3. Install flange on the pinion shaft with the reference marks aligned. 4. Install two bolts into the
threaded holes in the companion flange, 180° apart. 5. Position Holder 6719A (2) against the
companion flange and install a bolt and washer into one of the remaining threaded holes. Tighten
the bolts
so holder is held to the flange.
6. Install companion flange on pinion shaft with Installer C-3718 and Holder 6719A. 7. Install pinion
washer and a new pinion nut. The convex side of the washer must face outward. 8. Hold
companion flange with Holder 6719A (2) and tighten pinion nut with a torque wrench (3) to 285 Nm
(210 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Do not exceed the minimum torque 285 Nm (210 ft. lbs.) when installing the pinion nut at
this point.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8954
9. Rotate pinion several times to ensure pinion bearings are seated.
10. Measure pinion torque to rotate (1) with an inch pound torque wrench (2). Pinion torque to
rotate should be equal to recorded reading plus an
additional 0.56 Nm (5 in. lbs.).
If pinion torque to rotate is low, tighten pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until pinion torque
to rotating is achieved.
CAUTION: Never loosen pinion nut to decrease pinion bearing rotating torque. If pinion torque to
rotating is exceeded, a new collapsible spacer must be installed. Failure to follow these instructions
will result in damage to the axle.
11. Install propeller shaft. 12. Install rear brake rotors components.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8955
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 10 1/2 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shafts. 2. Mark propeller shaft and pinion flange for installation reference and
remove shaft. 3. Rotate pinion gear three or four times. 4. Record pinion torque to rotate (1) with an
inch pound torque wrench (2).
5. Hold pinion flange (1) with Wrench 8979 (2) and remove pinion flange nut and washer.
6. Mark a line across the pinion shaft and flange for installation reference. 7. Remove pinion flange
(1) with Puller 8992 (2). 8. Remove pinion shaft seal with a pry tool or slide hammer mounted
screw.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8956
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install new pinion seal with Installer 8896 (2) and Handle C-4171 (1).
2. Apply a light coat of teflon sealant to the pinion flange splines. 3. Install flange on the pinion shaft
with the reference marks aligned. 4. Lightly tap the pinion flange onto the pinion until a few threads
are showing. 5. Install flange washer and new pinion nut. 6. Hold flange (2) with Flange Wrench
8979 (1) and tighten pinion nut until pinion end play is taken up.
7. Rotate pinion several times to seat bearings. 8. Measure pinion torque to rotate (1) with an inch
pound torque wrench (2). Pinion torque to rotate should be equal to recorded reading plus an
additional 0.40-0.57 Nm (3-5 in. lbs.).
9. If torque to rotating is low, tighten the pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until pinion
torque to rotate is achieved.
10. Rotate pinion several times then verify pinion torque to rotate again. 11. Install axle shafts. 12.
Install propeller shaft with reference marks aligned. 13. Check and fill differential if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8957
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 11 1/2 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shafts. 2. Mark the propeller shaft and pinion flange for installation reference. 3.
Remove propeller shaft. 4. Rotate pinion gear (1) three or four times. 5. Measure and record the
amount of torque necessary to rotate the pinion gear with an inch pound torque wrench (2).
6. Hold pinion flange (1) with Flange Wrench 8979 (2) and remove pinion flange nut.
7. Remove pinion flange (1) with Pinion Flange Puller 8992 (2). 8. Remove pinion shaft seal with a
seal puller or slide hammer mounted screw.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential >
System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8958
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install new pinion seal with Handle C-4171 (1) and Installer 8896 (2). 2. Apply a light coat of
teflon sealant to the pinion flange splines. 3. Lightly tap the pinion flange onto the pinion until a few
threads are showing. 4. Install flange washer and new pinion nut.
5. Hold pinion flange (2) with Flange Wrench 8979 (1) and tighten pinion nut until pinion end play is
taken up.
6. Rotate pinion several times to seat bearings. 7. Measure pinion (1) Torque To Rotate with an
inch pound torque wrench (2) and compare it to recorded measurement. Tighten pinion nut in small
increments, until pinion Torque To Rotate is 0.40-0.57 Nm (3-5 in. lbs.) greater than recorded
measurement.
8. Rotate pinion several times then verify pinion Torque To Rotate again. 9. Install axle shafts.
10. Install propeller shaft with reference marks aligned. 11. Check differential fluid level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Front Axle - C205FD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from vehicle. 2. Clean axle seal area. 3. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2)
from axle shaft (3).
4. Remove axle with Remove 8420A (2) (3) Collar 8420-3 (4) and Slide Hammer C-3752. 5.
Remove axle shaft seal with a seal puller.
6. Install axle shaft bearing Remover C-4660-A (3) in the bearing (1). Then tighten the nut (2) to
spread remover in the bearing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8964
7. Install bearing remove cup (1) bearing (2) and nut (3). Tighten nut (3) to draw the bearing out.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe axle shaft bearing bore clean. 2. Install axle shaft bearing with Installer 5063 (1) and
Handle C-4171 (2).
CAUTION: Bearing must be installer with lettering facing outwards. Failure to follow these
instructions will damage the bearing.
3. Install a new axle shaft seal with Installer 8694 (1). 4. Lubricate seal lip with gear lubricant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8965
5. Install axle shaft with new snap ring and verify axle shaft snap ring is seated in side gear. 6.
Install axle shaft (3) O-ring (1) and snap ring (2). 7. Install half shaft. 8. Verify differential fluid level
and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8966
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 9 1/4
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft. 2. Remove axle shaft seal from axle tube with a small pry bar.
NOTE: The seal and bearing can be removed at the same time with the bearing removal tool.
3. Remove axle shaft bearing with Bearing Remover 6310 (2) (3) (4) (5) and Foot 6310-9 (7).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe axle tube bore clean and remove any old sealer or burrs from the tube. 2. Install axle shaft
bearing with Installer C-4198 and Handle C-4171. Drive bearing in until tool contacts the axle tube.
NOTE: Bearing is installed with the bearing part number against the installer.
3. Coat lip of the new axle seal with axle lubricant and install with Installer C-4076-B and Handle
C-4735. 4. Install the axle shaft (1). 5. Install differential cover and fill with gear lubricant to the
bottom of the fill plug hole.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8967
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 10 1/2 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft flange bolts and remove axle shaft. 2. Remove retainer ring (1) from axle
shaft tube.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8968
ERROR: undefined
OFFENDING COMMAND: f‘~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8969
Axle Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 11 1/2 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft flange bolts and remove shaft. 2. Remove retainer ring (1) from the axle shaft
tube.
3. Remove hub bearing nut (1) locking key (2) form axle tube (3). 4. Remove hub bearing nut with
Socket 8954. 5. Remove hub and bearings from the axle.
6. Pry out hub bearing seal from the back of the hub.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 8970
NOTE: The inner part of the seal (3) may stay on the axle tube (2). This part must also be removed
with a pry bar (1).
7. Remove rear bearing. 8. Remove hub bearing cups with a hammer and drift.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install outer hub bearing cup with Installer 8961 and Handle C-4171. 2. Install inner hub bearing
cup with Installer 8153 and Handle C-4171. 3. Pack bearings with the appropriate wheel bearing
grease. 4. Install rear bearing and install new grease seal with Installer 8963 and Handle C-4171.
5. Slide hub on the axle tube and install front bearing into the hub. 6. Install hub bearing nut with
Socket 8954 (1) and tighten with torque wrench (2) to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) while rotating the hub. 7.
Back off nut about 30° and align next hub nut key slot with axle tube key slot and install locking
key.
NOTE: End play should be 0.025-0.25 mm (0.01-0.001 in.)
8. Install retainer ring (1) with ring end in the key slot (2). 9. Install new axle shaft gasket and install
the axle shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Axle Shaft: Procedures
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Position a lift under axle and secure axle to
lift. 3. Remove all brake components. 4. Remove axle vent hose. 5. Mark propeller shaft and
companion flange for installation alignment reference. 6. Remove propeller shaft. 7. Remove shock
absorbers (3) from axle (2).
8. Remove U-bolts (5) from axle. 9. Remove axle from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8976
1. Raise axle with lift and align to the leaf spring centering bolts. 2. Install axle U-bolts (5) and
tighten to 149 Nm (110 ft. lbs.). 3. Install shock absorbers to axle and tighten to specification. 4.
Install all brake components. 5. Install axle vent hose. 6. Install propeller shaft with reference marks
aligned and tighten to specification. 7. Fill differential to specifications.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft flange (1) bolts (2). 2. Slide axle shaft out of the axle tube. 3. Remove axle
shaft gasket.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8977
NOTE: Axle flange bolts must be replaced or cleaned existing bolts apply Mopar(R) Lock N' Seal or
Loctite(R) 242 on the threads.
1. Clean axle flange and hub. 2. Install new axle shaft gasket. 3. Slide axle shaft into the axle tube.
4. Install axle shaft flange (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 129 Nm (95 ft. lbs.).
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft flange (1) bolts (2). 2. Slide axle shaft out of the axle tube. 3. Remove axle
shaft gasket.
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Axle flange bolts must be replaced or use Mopar(R) Lock N' Seal or Loctite(R) 242 on
cleaned existing bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8978
1. Clean axle flange and hub. 2. Install new axle shaft gasket. 3. Slide axle shaft into the axle tube.
4. Install axle shaft flange (1) bolts (2) and tighten to 129 Nm ( 95 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8979
Axle Shaft: Removal and Replacement
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from vehicle. 2. Clean axle seal area. 3. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2)
from axle shaft (3).
4. Remove axle with Remove 8420A (2,3,4) and Slide Hammer C-3752.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8980
1. Lubricate bearing bore and seal lip with gear lubricant. 2. Install axle shaft with new snap ring
and verify axle shaft snap ring is seated in side gear. 3. Install O-ring (1) and snap ring (2) on axle
shaft (3). 4. Install half shaft. 5. Verify differential fluid level and add fluid if necessary.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With the vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove brake caliper, rotor and ABS
wheel speed sensor if equipped. 3. Remove axle shaft (2) cotter pin (3), hub nut (1) and washer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8981
4. Remove four hub bearing bolts (2) from the back of the steering knuckle. 5. Remove hub bearing
from the steering knuckle.
6. Remove axle shaft (2) from steering knuckle (1) and axle housing.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean axle shaft and apply a thin film of grease to the shaft splines and hub bore. 2. Install axle
shaft (2) through the steering knuckle (3) and into the differential side gears.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8982
3. Install hub bearing in the knuckle. 4. Install hub bearing bolts (2) and tighten to 202 Nm (149 ft.
lbs.).
5. Install ABS wheel speed sensor, brake rotor and caliper. 6. Install axle (2) washer and nut (1).
Tighten axle nut to 179 Nm (132 ft. lbs.). 7. Rotate axle several 5 to 10 times to seat the wheel
bearing. 8. Tighten axle nut (1) to final torque of 356 Nm (263 ft. lbs.). 9. Align nut to next cotter pin
hole and install new cotter pin (3).
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Position a lift under axle and secure lift to the
axle. 3. Remove all brake components.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8983
4. Remove axle vent hose. 5. Mark propeller shaft and companion flange for installation alignment
reference. 6. Remove propeller shaft. 7. Remove shock absorbers (3) from axle (2).
8. Remove U-bolts (5) from axle. 9. Remove axle from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Raise axle with lift and align to the leaf spring centering bolts. 2. Install axle U-bolts (5) and
tighten to 149 Nm (110 ft. lbs.). 3. Install shock absorbers to axle and tighten to specification. 4.
Install all brake components. 5. Install axle vent hose. 6. Install propeller shaft with reference marks
aligned and tighten to specification. 7. Fill differential to specifications.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8984
1. Remove lubricant fill hole plug from the differential housing cover. 2. Remove differential housing
cover and drain the lubricant from housing. 3. Remove axle shafts. 4. Remove adjuster lock bolts
(1) and adjuster locks (2). 5. Mark bearing caps (4) left and right for installation reference. 6.
Remove bearing cap bolts and remove bearing caps.
7. Loosen differential bearing (1, 3) adjusters (2, 4) with a hammer and punch. 8. Remove
differential case from the housing. 9. Remove bearing cups (1, 3) and tag them left and right for
installation reference.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8985
1. Clean housing (1) cavity with a flushing oil, light engine oil or lint free cloth.
CAUTION: Do not use water, steam, kerosene or gasoline for cleaning.
2. Lubricate differential case bearing. 3. Install differential case with bearings cups into the housing.
NOTE: A light coat of grease on the cups will hold them in place during installation.
4. Install bearing caps (2) and bolts. Tighten bearing cap bolts finger-tight.
5. Slide differential case (2) toward the pinion gear until the gears make contact/zero backlash. If
zero backlash cannot be obtained, turn the pinion
side adjuster until zero backlash is obtained.
6. Holding the differential case toward the pinion gear, turn bearing adjusters with Adjuster Wrench
8883A (1) until they make contact with the
differential bearings/cups.
7. Back off the ring gear side adjuster 4 holes, to obtain initial ring gear backlash. 8. Install ring
gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time. 9. Tighten pinion gear
side adjuster firmly against the differential case bearing cup.
10. Rotate the pinion several times to seat the differential bearings. 11. Loosen pinion gear side
adjuster until it is no longer in contact with the bearing cup. 12. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster
until it just makes contact with the bearing cup. 13. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster an additional:
- New Bearings 6 Adjuster Holes
- Original Bearings 4 Adjuster Holes
14. Install pinion gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8986
15. Tighten bearing cap bolts to 165 Nm (122 ft. lbs.). 16. Tighten adjuster (2) lock bolts (3) to 25
Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 17. Measure ring gear backlash and check gear tooth contact pattern. Refer to
Adjustments for procedure. 18. Install axle shafts. 19. Install differential housing gasket and cover.
Tighten cover bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 20. Fill differential with lubricant to specifications. 21.
Install fill plug and tighten to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove differential case from the housing. 2. Install Plug 8888 (4) into the end of the case. 3.
Remove differential case bearings (3) with Bearing Splitter 1130 (2) and Bridge 938 (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8987
1. Install open and Trac-Rite differential case (2) bearings (3) with Installer 8956 (4) and Handle
C-4171 (1). 2. Install differential case into housing.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the differential case from the housing. 2. Install Plug 8888 (1) into the end of the
differential case on the coil side. 3. Install Puller 6444 (2) onto the end of the plug (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8988
4. Install puller Jaws 9915 (1) onto puller (2) and around the bearing.
5. Install puller collar (1) onto puller jaws (2). Tighten puller bolt and remove bearing.
NOTE: Bearing on the other side of the case can be removed with Puller C-293-PA and Adapters
9614.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8989
1. Install differential bearings (1) with Handle C-4171 (2) and Installer 8956 (3).
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The ring and pinion gears are service in a matched set. Never replace the ring gear/pinion
gear without replacing the other matching gear.
1. Mark pinion flange and propeller shaft for installation alignment. 2. Disconnect propeller shaft
from pinion flange and remove propeller shaft. 3. Remove differential from axle housing. 4. Place
differential on Plug 8888 and drive exciter ring (4) off the differential case (1) with a hammer and
punch (3).
NOTE: Do not remove the exciter ring if it is not being replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8990
5. Place differential case in a vise with soft metal jaw protectors. 6. Remove bolts holding ring gear
to differential case. 7. Drive ring gear (2) from differential case (1) with a soft hammer (3).
8. Hold pinion flange (1) with Flange Wrench 8979 (2) and remove pinion flange nut and washer.
9. Remove pinion flange (1) from the pinion with Flange Puller 8992 (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8991
10. Remove pinion gear (1) from housing, with Pinion Driver 8977 (2) and a hammer.
NOTE: Thread the driver on the pinion shaft till it bottoms out.
11. Remove pinion seal with a slide hammer or pry bar. 12. Remove and discard front pinion
bearing.
CAUTION: Do not reuse front pinion bearing/cup.
13. Remove collapsible spacer from the pinion shaft.
14. Remove rear pinion bearing with Puller C-293-PA (1) and Adapter Blocks 8879 (4). 15.
Remove pinion depth shim from pinion gear shaft and record shim thickness. 16. Remove front
pinion bearing cup from the housing with a punch and hammer and discard cup.
CAUTION: Do not reuse front pinion bearing/cup.
17. Remove rear pinion bearing cup from the housing with a punch and hammer, if bearing is going
to be replaced.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8992
1. Install new front pinion bearing cup with Installer 8960 (1) and Handle C-4171 (2).
2. Install new rear pinion bearing cup with Installer 8959 (1) and Handle C-4171 (2).
3. Install pinion depth shim (1) on the pinion gear shaft (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8993
4. Install rear pinion bearing (4) on pinion (3) with Installer MD-998805 (2) and a press (1).
5. Install new collapsible spacer (1) on pinion gear (2).
6. Lubricate pinion and bearings. 7. Install pinion into housing (2) and place front pinion bearing
onto the pinion shaft. Draw pinion shaft into the front bearing with Installer 8981 (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8994
8. Install new pinion seal with Installer 8896 (2) and Handle C-4171 (1).
9. Apply a light coat of teflon sealant to the pinion flange splines.
10. Hold the pinion and lightly tap the pinion flange onto the pinion, until a few threads are showing.
11. Install pinion flange washer and new pinion nut. 12. Hold pinion flange (2) with Flange Wrench
8979 (1) and tighten pinion nut until pinion end play is taken up.
13. Rotate pinion several times to seat pinion bearings. 14. Measure Pinion Torque To Rotate (1)
with an inch pound torque wrench (2). Tighten pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until
pinion
torque to rotate is achieved.
Pinion Torque To Rotate is:
- New Pinion Bearings: 1.7 - 2.8 Nm (15 - 25 in. lbs.)
- Original Pinion Bearings: 1.1 - 2.2 Nm (10 - 20 in. lbs.)
15. Rotate pinion several times then verify pinion torque to rotate again.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8995
16. Position ring gear (2) on differential case (4) and start two new ring gear bolts. 17. Install the
rest of the new ring gear bolts and tighten them alternately to seat the ring gear. 18. Torque ring
gear bolts to 237 Nm (175 ft. lbs.).
19. If exciter ring was removed, position differential assembly on differential Plug 8888 and place
exciter ring on the differential case. 20. Install exciter ring (1) on the differential case evenly with a
hammer and brass punch (2). Drive the ring down until it is seated against the ring gear
(3).
CAUTION: Do not damage exciter ring teeth during installation.
21. Install differential into the housing. 22. Verify ring gear backlash and gear contact pattern. 23.
Measure Total Torque to Rotate (TTTR) with an inch pound torque wrench.
Total Torque To Rotate is:
- New Bearings: 3.4 - 5.6 Nm (30 - 50 in. lbs.)
- Original Bearings: 2.8 - 5.1 Nm (25 - 45 in. lbs.)
If TTTR is to high back off adjusters evenly on both sides slightly and check TTTR again. If TTTR is
to low tighten adjusters evenly on both sides slightly and check TTTR again.
24. Install axle shafts. 25. Install the propeller shaft with the reference marks aligned. 26. Install
differential cover with gasket and tighten bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 27. Fill differential with fluid
and tighten fill plug to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8996
1. Remove lubricant fill hole plug from the differential housing cover. 2. Remove differential housing
cover and drain the lubricant from housing. 3. Remove axle shafts. 4. Cut sensor wire tie strap (4)
from adjuster lock. 5. Remove sensor target magnet (1) from bearing cap.
6. Remove adjuster lock bolts (3) and adjuster locks (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8997
7. Remove electric locker connector (1) retainer (2) bolt from differential housing. 8. Remove
connector (1) and retainer (2) from differential housing.
9. Remove retainer (1) from connector and remove O-ring (2) from connector.
10. Mark bearing caps (2) left and right for installation reference. 11. Remove bearing cap bolts and
remove bearing caps (2). 12. Loosen differential bearing adjusters (3) with a hammer and punch.
13. Slid electric locker connector through differential housing. 14. Remove differential case with
bearing cups from the housing. 15. Tag bearing cups left and right for installation reference.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8998
1. Clean the housing cavity with a flushing oil, light engine oil or lint free cloth. 2. Lubricate
differential case bearing. 3. Install differential case with bearings cups into the housing. 4. Slide
electric locker connector through differential housing. 5. Install O-ring (2) on electric locker
connector. 6. Install electric locker connector retainer (1) and install connector with retainer in
differential housing. 7. Install connector retainer bolt.
8. Install bearing caps (2) and tighten bearing cap bolts finger-tight.
NOTE: Do not torque bearing cap and bolts at this time.
9. Slide differential case toward the pinion gear until the gears make contact/zero backlash. If zero
backlash cannot be obtained, turn the pinion side
adjuster until zero backlash is obtained.
10. Holding the differential case toward the pinion gear, turn bearing adjusters with Adjuster
Wrench 8883A until they make contact with the
differential bearings/cups.
11. Back off the ring gear side adjuster 4 holes, to obtain initial ring gear backlash. 12. Install ring
gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time. 13. Tighten pinion
gear side adjuster firmly against the differential case bearing cup. 14. Rotate the pinion several
times to seat the differential bearings. 15. Loosen pinion gear side adjuster until it is no longer in
contact with the bearing cup. 16. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster until it just makes contact with
the bearing cup. 17. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster an additional:
- New Bearings: 6 Adjuster Holes
- Original Bearings: 4 Adjuster Holes
18. Install pinion gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8999
19. Tighten bearing cap bolts (4) to 165 Nm (122 ft. lbs.). 20. Tighten adjuster (2) lock bolts (3) to
25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.).
21. Measure ring gear backlash and check gear tooth contact pattern. Refer to Adjustments for
procedure. 22. Install axle shafts. 23. Install sensor target magnet (1) on bearing cap. 24. Energize
locker and rotate axle shaft. Verify dog clutch is engaged by rotating one axle while holding the
other. If engaged axle will not rotate. 25. De-energize locker and rotate left axle 15 to 40 degrees
so dog clutch gears will not engage. 26. Energize locker and set sensor air gap (2) to 5.5 mm ±
0.25 mm (0.21 in. ± 0.01 in.).
NOTE: System will time out within 2 minutes, when the key is in the on position and the engine is
not running.
27. Tighten sensor target magnet bolt (3) to 7 Nm (62 in. lbs.). 28. Hold right axle and rotate left
axle until dog clutch engages with an audible click nose.
NOTE: This will verify the sensor air gap was adjusted with the dog clutch gears ear to ear.
29. Install sensor wire tie strap (4) in the original location or at white dot on wiring harness to the
top leg of adjuster lock and de-energize coil. 30. Install differential housing gasket and cover.
Tighten cover bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 31. Fill differential with lubricant to specifications. 32.
Install fill plug and tighten to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9000
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Position a lift under axle and secure lift to the
axle. 3. Remove all brake components. 4. Mark propeller shaft and companion flange for
installation alignment reference. 5. Remove propeller shaft. 6. Remove axle vent hose. 7. Remove
shock absorbers (3) from axle (2).
8. Remove U-bolts (4) from axle. 9. Remove axle from the vehicle.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9001
1. Raise axle with lift and align to the leaf spring (1) centering bolts. 2. Install axle U-bolts (5) and
tighten to 149 Nm (110 ft. lbs.). 3. Install shock absorbers to axle and tighten to specification. 4.
Install all brake components. 5. Install propeller shaft with reference marks aligned and tighten to
specification. 6. Install axle vent hose. 7. Fill differential to specifications. 8. Remove lift from axle
and lower the vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove fill hole plug from the differential housing cover. 2. Remove differential housing cover
and drain the lubricant. 3. Remove axle shafts. 4. Remove adjuster (3) lock bolts (1) and adjuster
locks (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9002
5. Mark bearing caps left and right for installation reference. 6. Remove bearing cap bolts and
remove bearing caps. 7. Loosen differential bearing (1, 3) adjusters (2, 4) with a hammer and
punch. 8. Remove differential case from the housing. 9. Remove bearing cups (1, 3) and tag them
left and right for installation reference.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Clean the housing cavity with a flushing oil, light engine oil or lint free cloth.
NOTE: Do not use water, steam, kerosene or gasoline for cleaning.
2. Lubricate differential case bearing. 3. Install differential case with bearings cups into the housing.
NOTE: A light coat of grease on the cups will hold them in place during installation.
4. Install bearing caps (2) and bolts. Tighten the bearing cap (2) bolts finger-tight.
NOTE: Do not torque bearing cap and bolts at this time.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9003
5. Slide differential case toward the pinion gear until the gears make contact/zero backlash. If zero
backlash cannot be obtained, turn the pinion side
adjuster until zero backlash is obtained.
6. Holding the differential case (2) toward the pinion gear, turn bearing adjusters with Adjuster
Wrench 8883A (1) until they make contact with the
differential bearings/cups.
7. Back off the ring gear side adjuster 4 holes, to obtain initial ring gear backlash. 8. Install ring
gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time. 9. Tighten pinion gear
side adjuster firmly against the differential case bearing cup.
10. Rotate the pinion several times to seat the differential bearings. 11. Loosen pinion gear side
adjuster until it is no longer in contact with the bearing cup. 12. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster
until it just makes contact with the bearing cup. 13. Tighten pinion gear side adjuster an additional:
- New Bearings 6 Adjuster Holes
- Original Bearings 4 Adjuster Holes
14. Install pinion gear side adjuster lock and bolt. Do not tighten adjuster lock bolt at this time.
15. Tighten bearing cap bolts (4) to 281 Nm (207 ft. lbs.). 16. Tighten adjuster lock bolts (3) to 25
Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 17. Measure ring gear backlash and check gear tooth contact pattern. Refer to
Adjustments for procedure. 18. Install axle shaft gasket and install axle shafts. 19. Install differential
housing gasket and cover. Tighten cover bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 20. Fill differential with
lubricant to specifications. 21. Install fill plug and tighten to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9004
1. Remove differential case from the housing. 2. Install Plug 8964 (4) into the end of the case. 3.
Remove differential case bearings (3) with Bearing Splitter 1130 (2) and Bridge 938 (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
WARNING: Use welding gloves when handling heated components. Failure to follow these
instructions will result in personal injury.
CAUTION: A bearing heater (2) is used to install Trac-Rite differential case bearings (1). Use only a
bearing heater/hot plate and follow manufacture's instructions. Heat components to 100 - 177
Celsius (212° - 350° Max Fahrenheit). Never use an open flame to heat components. Never leave
components on heater for and extended amount of time. If component is discolored after heating
the component has been overheated and must not be used. Failure to follow these instructions will
result in component damage.
1. Heat Trac-Rite(R) differential case bearings (1) with bearing heater (2). 2. With welding gloves or
tongs install bearings on differential case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9005
3. Install open differential case (2) bearings (3) with Installer 8965 (4) and Handle C-4171 (1). 4.
Install differential case into housing.
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: The ring and pinion gears are service in a matched set. Never replace the ring gear/pinion
gear without replacing the other matching gear.
1. Mark pinion flange and propeller shaft for installation alignment. 2. Remove propeller shaft. 3.
Remove differential from the housing. 4. Place differential case (1) on Plug 8964. Drive exciter ring
(4) off the differential case with a hammer and punch (3).
NOTE: Do not remove the exciter ring if it is not being replaced.
5. Place differential case in a vise with soft metal jaw protectors.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9006
6. Remove bolts holding ring gear to differential case. 7. Drive ring gear (2) from differential case
(1) with a soft hammer (3).
8. Hold pinion flange (1) with Flange Wrench 8979 (2) and remove pinion flange nut.
9. Remove pinion flange (1) from pinion with pinion Puller 8992 (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9007
10. Remove pinion gear (1) from housing with pinion Driver 8977 (2) and a hammer.
NOTE: Thread the driver on the pinion shaft till it bottoms out.
11. Remove pinion seal with a slide hammer or pry bar.
12. Remove front pinion bearing and discard bearing.
NOTE: Do not reuse front pinion bearing/cup.
13. Remove collapsible spacer from the pinion shaft. 14. Remove rear pinion bearing (1) with
Bearing Splitter 1130 (2) and a press. 15. Remove pinion depth shim from the pinion gear shaft
and record thickness of the shims. 16. Remove front pinion bearing cup from the housing with a
punch and hammer, and discard cup.
NOTE: Do not reuse front pinion bearing/cup.
17. Remove rear pinion bearing cup from the housing with a punch and hammer, if bearing is going
to be replaced.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install new front pinion bearing cup with Installer 8960 (1) and Handle C-4171 (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9008
2. Install new rear pinion bearing cup with Installer 8968 (1) and Handle C-4171 (2).
3. Install pinion depth shim (1) on the pinion gear shaft (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9009
4. Install rear pinion bearing (4) with Installer D-389 (1) and a press (1).
5. Install new collapsible spacer (1) on the pinion (2). 6. Lubricate pinion and bearings.
7. Install pinion into the housing (2) and place front pinion bearing onto the pinion shaft. Draw the
pinion shaft into the front bearing with Installer
8981 (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9010
8. Install new pinion seal with Installer 8896 (2) and Handle C-4171 (1).
9. Apply a light coat of teflon sealant to the pinion flange splines.
10. Hold pinion and lightly tap the pinion flange (2) onto the pinion, until a few threads are showing.
11. Install pinion flange washer and new pinion nut. 12. Hold pinion flange (2) with Flange Wrench
8979 (1) and tighten pinion nut until pinion end play is eliminated.
13. Rotate pinion several times to seat pinion bearings. 14. Measure Pinion Torque To Rotate (1)
with an inch pound torque wrench (2). Tighten pinion nut in 6.8 Nm (5 ft. lbs.) increments until
pinion
torque to rotate is achieved.
Pinion Torque To Rotate is:
- New Pinion Bearings: 1.7 - 2.8 Nm (15 - 25 in. lbs.)
- Original Pinion Bearings: 1.1 - 2.2 Nm (10 - 20 in. lbs.)
15. Rotate pinion several times then verify pinion rotating torque again.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly > Axle
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9011
16. Position the ring gear (2) on differential case (4) and start two new ring gear bolts. 17. Install
the rest of the new ring gear bolts and tighten them alternately to seat the ring gear. 18. Torque
ring gear bolts to 237 Nm (175 ft. lbs.).
19. If exciter ring was removed, position differential assembly on differential Plug 8965 and place
exciter ring (1) on the differential case. 20. Install the exciter ring on the differential case evenly
with a hammer and brass punch (2). Drive the ring down until it is seated against the ring gear
(2).
21. Install differential in housing and verify gear backlash and gear contact pattern. 22. Measure
Total Torque To Rotate (TTTR) with an inch pound torque wrench.
Total Torque To Rotate is:
- New Bearings: 3.4 - 5.6 Nm (30 - 50 in. lbs.)
- Original Bearings: 2.8 - 5.1 Nm (25 - 45 in. lbs.)
If TTTR is to high, back off adjusters evenly on both sides slightly and check TTTR again. If TTTR
is to low, tighten adjusters evenly on both sides slightly and check TTTR again.
23. Install axle shafts. 24. Install the propeller shaft with the reference marks aligned. 25. Install
differential cover with gasket and tighten bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.). 26. Fill differential with fluid
and tighten fill plug to 32 Nm (24 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair CV Joint-Outer
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Clamp shaft in a vise (with soft jaws) and support C/V joint.
CAUTION: Do not damage C/V housing or half shaft.
2. Remove clamps (2) (4) with a cut-off wheel or grinder.
3. Slide the boot down the shaft. 4. Remove lubricant to expose the C/V joint snap ring (1). 5.
Spread snap ring (1) and slide the joint off the shaft. 6. Slide boot off the shaft and discard old boot.
7. Mark alignment marks (1) on the inner race/hub (2), bearing cage (3) and housing with dabs of
paint. 8. Clamp C/V joint in a vertical position in a soft jawed vise.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer > Page 9016
9. Press down one side of the bearing cage (3) to gain access to the ball at the opposite side.
NOTE: If joint is tight, use a hammer and brass drift to loosen the bearing hub. Do not contact the
bearing cage with the drift.
10. Remove ball (4) from the bearing cage (3). 11. Repeat step above until all six balls are
removed from the bearing cage.
12. Lift cage and inner race (2) upward and out from the housing (1).
13. Turn inner race 90° in the cage and rotate the inner race/hub out of the cage.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer > Page 9017
NOTE: If C/V joint is worn, replace entire C/V joint and boot.
1. Clean all C/V joint components and shaft. 2. Apply a light coat of grease supplied with the
joint/boot to the C/V joint components before assembling them. 3. Align the inner race (1) cage (2)
and housing according to the alignment reference marks. 4. Insert the inner race (1) into the cage
(2) and rotate race into the cage.
5. Rotate the inner race/hub (2) in the cage.
6. Insert cage (2) into the housing. Rotate the cage 90° into the housing (3) so the large bearing
hub counterbore is facing outwards. 7. Apply the grease supplied with the joint/boot to the ball
races. Spread the grease equally between all the races.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer > Page 9018
8. Tilt inner race/hub (1) and cage (3) and install the balls(4). 9. Place new clamps onto new boot
and slide boot onto the shaft to it's original position.
10. Apply the rest of grease to the C/V joint and boot.
11. Install the joint onto the shaft (2). Push the joint onto the shaft until the snap ring (1) seats in the
groove (3).
NOTE: Pull on the joint to verify the span ring has engaged.
12. Position the boot on the joint in it's original position.
NOTE: Verify boot is not twisted and remove any excess air.
13. Secure both boot (5) clamps (2) (4) with Clamp Installer C-4975A. Place tool on clamp bridge
and tighten tool until jaws of the tool are closed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer > Page 9019
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair CV Joint-Inner
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Clamp shaft in vise (with soft jaws) and support C/V joint. 2. Remove clamps (2) (4) with a cut-off
wheel or grinder.
CAUTION: Do not damage C/V housing or half shaft with cut-off wheel or grinder.
3. Remove housing (2) from the half shaft and slide boot (1) down shaft. 4. Remove housing
bushing from the housing.
5. Remove tripod (2) snap ring (1). 6. Remove tripod (2) and boot from the half shaft. 7. Clean and
inspect C/V components for excessive wear and damage. Replace the tripod as a unit only if
necessary.
Installation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > CV Joint-Outer > Page 9020
INSTALLATION
1. Clean all C/V joint components and shaft. 2. Slide new boot (1) down the half shaft. 3. Install
tripod (2) and tripod snap ring on the half shaft. 4. Pack grease supplied with the joint/boot into the
housing and boot. 5. Coat tripod with supplied grease.
6. Install new bushing (1) onto the housing (2). 7. Insert the tripod and shaft in the housing.
8. Position the boot (2) on the housing (5) and shaft (4) in it's original position.
NOTE: Verify boot is not twisted and remove any excess air.
9. Measure the distance from the end of the housing to the end of the boot on the shaft. This
measurement should be 260 mm (10.25 in.).
NOTE: If measurement is not correct, allow more or less air into the boot.
10. Secure both boot clamps (1) (3) with Clamp Installer C-4975A. Place tool on clamp bridge and
tighten tool until the jaws of the tool are closed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Saturate bearing caps with penetrating oil prior to removal.
1. Remove axle shaft. 2. Remove bearing cap snap rings (1) from stub shaft yoke (2) bearing caps.
3. Position receiver/socket (2) and driver/socket (1) on stub shaft yoke (3) in press. Press bearing
cup into receiver/socket (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9025
4. Remove bearing cap (1) from stub shaft yoke (2).
5. Position receiver/socket (2) under stub shaft yoke (3) remaining bearing cup and driver/socket
(1) on U-joint cross in press. Press bearing cup into
receiver/socket (2)
6. Remove bearing cap (1) from stub shaft yoke (2). Then remove stub shaft from U-joint cross.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9026
7. Remove snap rings (1) from shaft yoke (2) bearing caps.
8. Position receiver/socket (2) and driver/socket (1) on shaft yoke (3) in press. Press bearing cup
into receiver/socket (2).
9. Remove bearing cap (1) from shaft yoke (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9027
10. Position receiver/socket (2) under shaft yoke (3) remaining bearing cup and driver/socket (1) on
U-joint cross in press. Press bearing cup into
receiver/socket (2)
11. Remove bearing cap (1) from shaft yoke (2). Then remove U-joint cross from shaft yoke.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9028
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Keep cross and bearing cap straight during installation. Failure to follow these
instruction will result in damage.
1. Pack bearing caps 1/3 full of wheel bearing lubricant. Apply extreme pressure (EP), lithium-base
lubricant to aid in installation. 2. Position cross (1) in the shaft yoke (2).
3. Tap bearing cap into the yoke bores far enough to position cross. 4. Position receiver/socket (1)
on shaft yoke and driver/socket (2) on bearing cap in press.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9029
5. Press bearing cap into shaft yoke (1) until bearing cap snap ring groove is visible and install
snap ring (2).
6. Position receiver/socket (1) on shaft yoke and driver/socket (2) on bearing cap in press.
7. Press bearing cap into shaft yoke (1) until bearing cap snap ring groove is visible and install
snap ring (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9030
8. Install stub shaft yoke (1) on U-joint cross (2).
9. Tap fist bearing cap into the stub shaft yoke bore far enough to position cross.
10. Position receiver/socket (1) on shaft yoke and driver/socket (2) on bearing cap in press.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Universal Joint, Half Shaft/Short Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9031
11. Press bearing cap into stub shaft yoke (1) until bearing cap snap ring groove is visible and
install snap ring (2).
12. Position receiver/socket (1) on stub shaft yoke and driver/socket (2) on bearing cap in press.
13. Press bearing cap into stub shaft yoke (1) until bearing cap snap ring groove is visible and
install snap ring (2). 14. Install axle shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Axle - C205FD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove half shaft from vehicle. 2. Clean axle seal area. 3. Remove O-ring (1) and snap ring (2)
from axle shaft (3).
4. Remove axle with Remove 8420A (2,3,4) and Slide Hammer C-3752. 5. Remove axle shaft seal
with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 9036
1. Wipe axle shaft tube bore clean. 2. Install new axle shaft seal with Installer 8694 (1). 3. Install
axle shaft with new snap ring and verify axle shaft snap ring is seated in side gear.
4. Install O-ring (1) and snap ring (2) on axle shaft (3). 5. Install half shaft. 6. Verify differential fluid
level and add fluid if necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 9037
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Axle - 9 1/4 AA
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove hub bearings and axle shafts. 2. Remove differential from differential housing (2). 3.
Remove differential bearing adjusters (1).
4. Remove axle seals (2) located behind adjusters with Receiver 8498 and Extractor 6310.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 9038
5. Install Receiver 8498 (1) into the adjuster bore. 6. Install Extractor Rod 6310 with Extractor Foot
6310-9 (2) through the receiver and axle seal.
7. Install Extractor Plate 6310-2 and Nut 6310-7 (2) on the extractor rod (1). 8. Tighten nut (2) on
extractor rod (1) to pull seal into the receiver.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install axle seal on Installer Cups 8885-2 (1) (3) and position cups with seals into the housing.
NOTE: Seals are installed with the axle guide facing outward.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 9039
2. Install Turnbuckle 8885-1(2) into installer cups and expand the turnbuckle until the seals bottom
out in the housing.
3. Install adjuster (1) into the differential housing (2). 4. Install differential in housing. 5. Install axle
shaft and hub bearings.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Service and Repair > Front Axle - C205FD > Page 9040
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Axle - 9 1/4
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove axle shaft. 2. Remove axle shaft seal (1) from the axle tube with a seal puller.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Wipe the axle tube bore clean. Remove any old sealer or burrs from the tube. 2. Coat the lip of
the new seal with axle lubricant and install a seal with Installer C-4076-B and Handle C-4735.
NOTE: When tool contacts the axle tube, the seal is installed to the correct depth.
3. Install the axle shaft (1). 4. Install differential cover and fill with gear lubricant to the bottom of the
fill plug hole.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front - Independent Front Suspension
Removal
4X4
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly. 3. Remove the brake
caliper and rotor. 4. Remove the ABS wheel speed sensor if equipped. 5. Remove the halfshaft
nut.
NOTE: Do not strike the knuckle with a hammer to remove the tie rod end or the ball joint. Damage
to the steering knuckle will occur.
6. Remove the tie rod end nut and separate the tie rod from the knuckle using remover 9360. 7.
Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the knuckle using remover
9360.
8. Pull down on the steering knuckle to separate the halfshaft (2) from the hub/bearing. 9. Remove
the three hub/bearing mounting bolts (1) from the steering knuckle.
10. Slide the hub/bearing out of the steering knuckle. 11. Remove the brake dust shield.
Installation
4X4
1. Install the brake dust shield (2). 2. Install the hub/bearing (1) into the steering knuckle (3) and
tighten the bolts to 163 Nm (120 ft. lbs.). 3. Install the brake rotor and caliper. 4. Install the ABS
wheel speed sensor if equipped. 5. Install the upper ball joint nut to the steering knuckle and
tighten to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.) (on 1500 series only an additional 90° turn). 6. Install the tie rod end
nut to the steering knuckle and tighten to 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) then an additional 90°. 7. Install the
halfshaft nut and tighten to 251 Nm (185 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the wheel and tire assembly.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 9045
9. Remove the support and lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 9046
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front - Link/Coil
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Remove the wheel and tire assembly.
3. Remove the hub extension (1) mounting nuts and remove the extension from the rotor if
equipped.
4. Remove the brake caliper. 5. Remove the cotter pin (2) and the hub nut (1) from the axle shaft.
6. Remove the caliper adapter. 7. Remove the disc brake rotor. 8. Disconnect the wheel speed
sensor wire. 9. Remove the hub/bearing 4 mounting bolts and remove the hub/bearing.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front - Independent Front Suspension > Page 9047
1. Position the brake shield (1) on bolts. 2. Install the hub/bearing to the knuckle. Tighten the
hub/bearing bolts (2) to 202 Nm (149 ft. lbs.) 3. Install the hub nut and tighten to 356 Nm (263 ft.
lbs.). 4. Install the wheel speed sensor to the hub. 5. Install the disc brake rotor. 6. Install the brake
caliper adapter with the caliper. 7. Install the hub extension and nuts to the front rotor. Tighten nuts
to 130 Nm (96 ft.lbs). HD DRW ONLY. 8. Install the wheel and tire assemblies. 9. Remove the
support and lower the vehicle.
10. Apply the brakes several times to seat the brake shoes and caliper piston. Do not move the
vehicle until a firm brake pedal is obtained.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Hub Nut Tighten to ..............................................................................................................................
............................................................... 356 Nm (263 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Center Support >
Component Information > Adjustments
Center Support: Adjustments
BEARING CENTER
Launch shudder is a vibration that occurs at first acceleration from a stop. Shudder vibration
usually peaks at the engines highest torque output. Shudder is a symptom associated with vehicles
using a two-piece propeller shaft. To decrease shudder, lower the center bearing in 3.0 mm (0.125
in.) increments. Use shim stock or fabricated plates. Do not use washers. Replace the original bolts
with the appropriate increased length bolts.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Center Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Center Support: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear propeller shaft. 2. Make installation reference marks on rear shaft (1) and front
shaft (2).
3. Remove slip joint boot (1) clamp (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Center Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9058
4. Slide boot (1) off boot collar (2) and separate the two shafts.
5. Position Bearing Splitter Tool 1130 (1) between propeller shaft and center bearing (2). 6. Install
Bridge 938 (3) on the splitter (1) and remove center bearing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Center Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9059
Center Support: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Slide center bearing (1) and boot collar (2) on shaft.
2. Install boot collar (2) and center bearing (1) with Installer 6448A. 3. Clean shaft splines and
apply a coat of multi-purpose grease. 4. Align master splines and slide front and rear half-shafts
together.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Center Support >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page 9060
5. Slide slip yoke boot (1) on boot collar (2).
6. Install slip yoke boot (1) clamp (2). 7. Install propeller shaft in vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Specifications
PROPELLER SHAFT
Torque Specifications
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9064
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Testing and Inspection
PROPELLER SHAFT
PROPELLER SHAFT VIBRATION
Out-of-round tires or wheels that are out of balance, will cause a low frequency vibration.
Driveline vibration can also be caused by loose or damaged engine mounts.
Propeller shaft vibration increases with vehicle speed. A vibration that occurs at a specific speed
range, is not usually caused by an out of balance propeller shaft. Defective universal joints or an
incorrect propeller shaft angle are usually the cause of such a vibration.
Driveline Vibration
PROPELLER SHAFT BALANCE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9065
If propeller shaft is suspected of being out of balance, use the following procedure.
NOTE: Indexing propeller shaft 180 degrees relative to the yoke may eliminate some vibrations.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Clean all foreign material from the propeller shaft and universal
joints. 3. Inspect propeller shaft for missing balance weights, broken welds and bent areas. If
propeller shaft is bent, it must be replaced. 4. Inspect universal joints for wear and properly
installed. 5. Check propeller shaft bolt torques. 6. Remove wheels and install lug nuts to retain
brake rotors. 7. Mark and number the shaft six inches from the pinion yoke end at four positions 90
degrees apart. 8. Run and accelerate vehicle until vibration occurs. Note the intensity and speed
the vibration occurred. Stop the engine. 9. Install a screw clamp at position (1).
10. Start engine and check vibration. If there is little or no change move the clamp to the next
positions. Repeat the vibration test.
NOTE: If there is no difference in vibration at this positions, the vibration may not be the propeller
shaft.
11. If vibration decreased, install a second clamp (1) and repeat the test.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Specifications > Page 9066
12. If additional clamp causes an additional vibration, separate the clamps 1/2 inch (1) above and
below the mark. Repeat the vibration test. 13. Increase distance between the clamp screws (1) (2)
and repeat test, until the least amount of vibration is noticed. Bend the slack end of the clamps
so screws will not loosen.
14. If vibration remains unacceptable, repeat the procedure to the front end of the propeller shaft.
15. Install wheels and lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Propeller Shaft Angle
PROPELLER SHAFT ANGLE
ONE PIECE PROPELLER SHAFT
This procedure applies to front and rear propeller shafts.
NOTE: To obtain output angle (A) on the front propeller shaft equipped with a C/V joint, place
inclinometer on machined surface of the C/V joint.
1. Raise vehicle and support the axles as level as possible, allowing the wheels and propeller shaft
to turn. 2. Remove universal joint snap rings if equipped, so inclinometer base sits flat. 3. Rotate
shaft until transmission/transfer case output yoke bearing is facing downward.
NOTE: Always take measurements from front to rear and on the same side of the vehicle.
4. Place Inclinometer 7663 on yoke bearing cap or pinion flange ring parallel to the shaft. Center
bubble in sight glass and record measurement (A).
This measurement will give you the transmission yoke Output Angle (A).
5. Rotate propeller shaft 90 degrees and place Inclinometer on yoke bearing parallel to the shaft.
Center bubble in sight glass and record
measurement. This measurement can also be taken at the rear end of the shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9069
This measurement will give you the Propeller Shaft Angle (C).
6. Rotate propeller shaft 90 degrees and place inclinometer on companion flange yoke bearing
parallel to the shaft. Center bubble in sight glass and
record measurement.
This measurement will give you the pinion Companion Flange Input Angle (B).
7. Subtract smaller figure from larger (C minus A) to obtain Transmission/Transfer Case Output
Operating Angle. 8. Subtract smaller figure from larger (C minus B) to obtain axle Input Operating
Angle.
Refer to rules and example for additional information.
RULES
- Good cancellation of U-joint operating angles should be within 1 degree.
- Operating angles should be less than 3 degrees.
- Operating angles less than 10 degrees for double cardan U-joint.
- At least 1/2 of one degree continuous operating propeller shaft angle.
TWO PIECE PROPELLER SHAFT
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9070
Two piece propeller shaft angles measurement is the same as a one-piece propeller shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9071
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Lubrication
LUBRICATION
Vehicles with double cardan universal joint front propeller shaft (1) are equipped with a grease
fitting (2). Grease the double cardan universal joint at each oil change.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9072
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Propeller Shaft Front HD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove exhaust crossover pipe. 3. Mark a
line across axle (3)/transfer case (2) companion flange and propeller shaft flange yokes for
installation reference. 4. Remove axle/transfer case companion flange bolts. 5. Remove propeller
shaft.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install propeller shaft (1) with all reference marks aligned. 2. Install transfer case companion
flange (2) bolts and tighten to 88 Nm (65 ft. lbs.). 3. Install new axle companion flange (3) bolts and
tighten to 28 Nm (21 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Companion flange bolts incorporate a Loctite(R) patch, new bolts should be used. If bolts
are not available, clean bolts and apply Loctite(R) 242 to the threads.
4. Install skid plate, if equipped.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9073
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Propeller Shaft Rear HD
Removal
REMOVAL
1. With vehicle in neutral, position vehicle on hoist. 2. Mark propeller shaft (1) pinion flange (2) and
propeller shaft flange (4) with installation reference marks (3).
3. If equipped with manual transmission, mark manual transmission flange (1) and propeller shaft
flange (2) for installation reference.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9074
4. If equipped with a center bearing (1) mark an outline of the center bearing on the center bearing
bracket for installation reference. Then support
propeller shaft and remove center bearing bolts (2).
5. Remove pinion flange (1) bolts from propeller shaft (2).
6. Slide propeller shaft back off automatic transmission/transfer case output shaft, then mark
propeller shaft (1) and transmission/transfer case output
shaft (2) for installation reference.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9075
7. If equipped with manual transmission remove flange (1) bolts (2). 8. Remove propeller shaft from
vehicle.
CAUTION: Failure to follow these instructions may result in a driveline vibration.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Slide slip yoke (1) onto automatic transmission/transfer case output shaft (2) with reference
marks aligned.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Propeller Shaft Angle > Page 9076
2. If equipped with manual transmission, align transmission flange (1) and propeller shaft reference
marks. Install new flange bolts (2) and tighten to
115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.).
3. If two piece propeller shaft, align center bearing (1) with reference marks on center bearing
bracket and tighten bolts (2) to 54 Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
4. Align reference marks on propeller shaft and pinion flange. Install new companion flange (1)
bolts and tighten to 115 Nm (85 ft. lbs.)
CAUTION: Failure to follow these instruction may result in a driveline vibration.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9077
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Tools and Equipment
PROPELLER SHAFT
SPLITTER 1130
INSTALLER 6052
INSTALLER 6448A
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9078
INCLINOMETER 7663
BRIDGE 938
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Universal Joints-Single Cardan
Disassembly - With Injected Ring
DISASSEMBLY - WITH INJECTED RING
1. Place shaft yoke in vise. 2. Position U-joint press (1) with receiver (2) on propeller shaft yoke.
3. Pressed U-joint bearing caps (1) out of shaft yoke (2). 4. Remove lower bearing cap from shaft
yoke.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9083
5. Turn shaft over and position press (1) with receiver (2) on shaft yoke. 6. Press remaining U-joint
bearing cap out of shaft yoke.
7. Remove flange (1) with U-joint out of shaft yoke (2).
8. Position U-joint press (2) with receiver (1) on flange.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9084
9. Press U-joint bearing caps (1) out of flange (2).
10. Remove bearing cap on the outside of the flange.
11. Position U-joint press (2) with receiver (1) on flange. 12. Press remaining U-joint bearing cap
out of flange. 13. Remove U-joint from flange.
Disassembly - With Snap Rings
DISASSEMBLY - WITH SNAP RINGS
1. Tap outside of bearing cap with a drift to loosen snap ring. 2. Remove snap rings (1) from both
sides of yoke.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9085
3. Position yoke with the grease fitting if equipped, pointing up. 4. Position a socket (2) with a inside
diameter large enough to receive the bearing cap, beneath the yoke on a press. 5. Place another
socket with an outside diameter smaller than bearing cap on the upper bearing cap and press (1)
the lower cap through the yoke.
NOTE: If bearing cap will not pull out of the yoke after pressing, tap yoke ear near bearing cap to
dislodge the cap.
6. Pull bearing cap of the yoke. 7. Turn yoke over in the press and straighten the cross (1). Press
the cross until the remaining bearing cap (2) can be removed.
CAUTION: If cross or bearing cap are not straight during removal, the bearing cap will score the
walls of the yoke bore and damage can occur.
Assembly - With Injected Ring
ASSEMBLY - WITH INJECTED RING
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9086
NOTE: Replacement joint has internal snap rings.
1. Place joint in flange with one bearing cap. 2. Position press (3) with receiver (1) on flange and
bearing cap (2).
3. Press bearing cap until snap ring groove (1) is through the flange (2).
4. Install snap ring (2) on bearing (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9087
5. Position press (3) with receiver (2) on remaining bearing cap (1) and flange. 6. Press bearing
cap until snap ring groove is through the flange.
7. Install snap ring (1) on bearing cap (2).
8. Install flange (1) with U-joint in yoke (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9088
9. Position press (2) with receiver (1) and lower bearing cap (3) on yoke.
10. Press bearing cap until snap ring groove is through the yoke.
11. Install snap ring (2) on bearing cap (1).
12. Position press (2) with receiver (3) on remaining bearing cap (1) and yoke. 13. Press remaining
bearing cap until snap ring groove is through the yoke.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9089
14. Install snap ring (2) on bearing cap (1).
Assembly - With Snap Rings
ASSEMBLY - WITH SNAP RINGS
1. Apply (EP) N.L.G.I. Grade 1 or 2 grease to inside of yoke bores. 2. Position cross (1) in yoke (2)
with lube fitting pointing up, if equipped.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9090
3. Place a bearing cap (1) over the cross end (2) and align cap with yoke bore. 4. Press bearing
cap into the yoke bore enough to clear snap ring groove. 5. Repeat STEP 3 and STEP 4 to install
the opposite bearing cap.
NOTE: If joint is stiff or binding, strike the yoke with a soft hammer to seat the needle bearings.
6. Add grease to lube fitting, if equipped. 7. Install propeller shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9091
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Universal Joints-Double Cardan
Disassembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove propeller shaft. 2. Mark propeller shaft, link yoke and flange yoke for assembly
reference. 3. Tap outside of the bearing cap assembly with drift to loosen snap rings. 4. Remove all
bearing cap snap rings. 5. Remove grease fittings if equipped. 6. Position a socket on the press
with an inside diameter large enough to receive the bearing cap under the link yoke. 7. Place
another socket with an outside diameter smaller than the bearing cap on the upper bearing cap.
8. Press one bearing cap from outboard side of the link yoke, enough to grasp the cap with vise
jaws.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9092
9. Grasp protruding bearing cap with vise jaws and tap link yoke with a mallet to remove bearing
cap.
10. Flip assembly and repeat STEP 6, STEP 7, STEP 8 and STEP 9 to remove the opposite
bearing cap.
11. Remove cross centering kit assembly and spring. 12. Press remaining bearing caps out the
other end of the link yoke.
Assembly
ASSEMBLY
CAUTION: All alignment marks on the link yoke and propeller shaft yoke must be aligned during
assembled.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9093
1. Apply (EP) N.L.G.I. Grade 1 or 2 grease to inside of yoke bores. 2. Fit cross into the propeller
shaft yoke.
3. Place bearing cap over the trunnion and align cap with the yoke bore. Keep needle bearings
upright in the bearing cap.
4. Press bearing cap into yoke bore enough to clear snap ring groove and install snap-ring.
5. Flip propeller shaft yoke and install other bearing cap onto the opposite trunnion and install a
snap ring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9094
6. Fit link yoke onto remaining trunnions and press both bearing caps into place and install snap
rings.
7. Install centering kit assembly inside the link yoke.
NOTE: Verify spring is properly positioned.
8. Place two bearing caps on opposite trunnions of the remaining cross. Fit open trunnions into the
link yoke bores and bearing caps into the
centering kit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Universal Joints-Single Cardan > Page 9095
9. Press remaining two bearing caps into place and install snap rings.
10. Tap snap rings to seat them into the grooves.
11. Flexing the joint beyond center, the joint should snap over-center in both directions if correctly
assembled. 12. Install propeller shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Description and Operation
Flywheel: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
STANDARD FLYWHEEL
The standard (3) is a heavy plate bolted to the rear of the crankshaft (1). The flywheel incorporates
the ring gear (2) around the outer circumference to mesh with the starter to permit engine cranking.
The rear face of the flywheel serves as the driving member to the clutch disc.
DUAL MASS FLYWHEEL
The Dual Mass Flywheel (1) is used on the Diesel engine with G56 transmission. The flywheel
incorporates the ring gear around the outer circumference to mesh with the starter to permit engine
cranking. The primary flywheel side is bolted to an adapter plate which is bolted to the crankshaft.
The secondary flywheel side (2) serves as the driving member to the clutch disc. Internal springs
(3) are used to dampen energy. The Dual Mass Flywheel is serviced as an assembly only and
should never be taken apart.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 9099
Flywheel: Testing and Inspection
FLYWHEEL
Check flywheel (3) runout whenever misalignment is suspected. Flywheel runout should not
exceed 0.08 mm (0.003 in.). Measure runout at the outer edge of the flywheel face with a dial
indicator. Mount the indicator on a stud installed in place of one of the flywheel bolts.
Common causes of runout are:
- heat warpage
- improper machining
- incorrect bolt tightening
- improper seating on crankshaft flange shoulder
- foreign material on crankshaft flange
Flywheel machining is not recommended. The flywheel clutch surface is machined to a unique
contour and machining will negate this feature. Minor flywheel scoring can be cleaned up by hand
with 180 grit emery or with surface grinding equipment. Remove only enough material to reduce
scoring (approximately 0.001 - 0.003 in.). Heavy stock removal is not recommended. Replace the
flywheel if scoring is severe and deeper than 0.076 mm (0.003 in.). Excessive stock removal can
result in flywheel cracking or warpage after installation; it can also weaken the flywheel and
interfere with proper clutch release.
Clean the crankshaft flange before mounting the flywheel. Dirt and grease on the flange surface
may cock the flywheel causing excessive runout. Use new bolts when remounting a flywheel and
secure the bolts with Mopar(R) Lock And Seal or equivalent. Tighten flywheel bolts to specified
torque only. Overtightening can distort the flywheel hub causing runout.
On a Dual Mass Flywheel (1) inspect all springs (2) for damage.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Flywheel: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Remove the transmission.
NOTE: Vehicles with Dual Mass Flywheel use an adapter plate between the flywheel and crank.
This plate does not need to be removed.
2. Remove the dust cover bolts (1) and the dust cover (2).
3. Using the access hole, remove each flexplate-to-flywheel bolt (1). Use Barring Tool 7471B to
rotate the engine and flywheel.
4. Remove the assembly place the flywheel (1) , clutch disc (2) , and pressure plate (3) assembly
on a workbench.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 9102
5. Loosen pressure plate bolts (1-8) evenly, a few threads at a time and in a diagonal pattern to
prevent warping the plate. 6. Remove the eight pressure plate bolts (1-8) completely and remove
pressure plate and disc. 7. Remove the flywheel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flywheel > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 9103
Flywheel: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install flywheel on the crankshaft or adapter plate if vehicle has Dual Mass flywheel. 2. Install
flywheel bolts and tighten evenly in sequence to 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.). Vehicles with Dual Mass
Flywheel, tighten adapter plate bolts to 55
Nm (40 ft. lbs.).
3. Install clutch. 4. Install transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off
Indicator
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Overdrive Off Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
An overdrive off indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles
not equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically
disabled. This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the
coolant temperature gauge.
The overdrive off indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text O/D OFF in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the overdrive off indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The overdrive off indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The overdrive off indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the overdrive-OFF
position of the tow/haul switch has been selected, disabling the electronically controlled overdrive
feature of the automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data
bus.
The overdrive off indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the overdrive off indicator for the following reasons:
- Overdrive Off Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
overdrive off indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the overdrive-OFF position
of the tow/haul switch has been selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch
is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the overdrive off indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the overdrive off indicator or
the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier
Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off
Indicator > Page 9110
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to overdrive off indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off
Indicator > Page 9111
Overdrive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Tow/Haul Indicator
Description
DESCRIPTION
A tow/haul indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional overdrive automatic transmission, this indicator is electronically disabled.
This indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant
temperature gauge.
The tow/haul indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text TOW/HAUL in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the tow/haul indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The tow/haul indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Operation
OPERATION
The tow/haul indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the tow/haul function of the
tow/haul switch has been selected, revising the shift schedule of the electronically controlled
automatic transmission. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The tow/haul indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the tow/haul indicator for the following reasons:
- Tow/Haul Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic tow/haul
indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the tow/haul shift schedule has been
selected, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster
receives a lamp-OFF message from the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF
position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the tow/haul indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the tow/haul switch to determine the proper outputs to the automatic
transmission. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of the tow/haul indicator or the
instrument cluster circuitry that controls the indicator refer to Instrument Cluster / Carrier testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Overdrive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation > Overdrive Off
Indicator > Page 9112
For proper diagnosis of the transmission control system, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or
the electronic communication related to tow/haul indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is
required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A transmission over-temperature indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters.
However, on vehicles not equipped with an optional automatic transmission, this indicator is
electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer dial face in
the instrument cluster overlay.
The transmission over-temperature indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the International
Control and Display Symbol icon for Transmission Temperature in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. A red Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in the
opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in red through the translucent outer
layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The transmission over-temperature indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9117
Temperature Warning Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The transmission over-temperature indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the
transmission fluid temperature is excessive, which may lead to accelerated transmission
component wear or failure. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster
circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received over the
Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
The transmission over-temperature indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by
the instrument cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the
instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start)
circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON
or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the transmission over-temperature indicator for the
following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the transmission
over-temperature indicator is illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Trans Over-Temp Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic
trans over-temp indicator lamp-ON message from the PCM indicating that the transmission fluid
temperature is 135° C (275° F) or higher, the indicator will be illuminated and a single chime tone is
sounded. The indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from
the PCM, or until the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first. The chime
tone feature will only repeat during the same ignition cycle if the indicator is cycled OFF and then
ON again by the appropriate lamp-ON and lamp-OFF messages from the PCM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the transmission
over-temperature indicator will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the
test to confirm the functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The PCM continually monitors the transmission temperature sensor to determine the transmission
operating condition. The PCM then sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the
ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). If the instrument cluster illuminates the transmission
over-temperature indicator due to a high transmission oil temperature condition, it may indicate that
the transmission or the transmission cooling system are being overloaded, or that they require
service. For further diagnosis of the transmission over-temperature indicator or the instrument
cluster circuitry that controls the LED,refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transmission temperature sensor, the PCM, the EMIC, the CAN data
bus or the electronic communication related to transmission over-temperature indicator operation a
diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Description
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
A 4WD auto indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD auto indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure gauge.
The 4WD auto indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD AUTO in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD auto indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD auto indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9123
A 4WD indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional four-wheel drive system, this indicator is electronically disabled. The
4WD indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure
gauge.
The 4WD indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD indicator is dimmable,
which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel lamps dimmer
thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
A 4WD low indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD low indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant temperature gauge.
The 4WD low indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD LOW in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD low indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD low indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9124
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Operation
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
The 4WD auto indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer
case has been shifted into the 4WD auto mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD auto indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD auto indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Auto Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD auto
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD auto indicator will
be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality
of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD auto mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD auto indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD auto indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
The 4WD indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the transfer case has been
shifted into a 4WD mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The 4WD indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD indicator
lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly or the manual transfer case through the transfer case switch to
determine when the 4WD mode is engaged. The TIPM then sends the proper lamp-ON or
lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of
the 4WD indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the LED, refer to Instrument
Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the transfer case switch, the
TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD indicator
operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
The 4WD low indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer case
has been shifted into the 4WD low mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD low indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9125
indicator to operate when the instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused
ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition
switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path
to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD low
indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Low Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD low
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD low indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the LED portion of the test to confirm the functionality of the
LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD low mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD low indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD low indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description
Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
A service 4WD indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. This indicator is located in the lower portion of the tachometer
dial face in the instrument cluster overlay.
The service 4WD indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text SVC 4WD in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
The service 4WD indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - Transfer Case > Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Description > Page 9130
Malfunction Indicator Lamp - Transfer Case: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The service 4WD indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM) has recorded a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) for an electronic transfer
case circuit or component malfunction. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument
cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the
cluster from the TIPM over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The service 4WD indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the service 4WD indicator for the following reasons:
- Bulb Test - Each time the ignition switch is turned to the ON position the service 4WD indicator is
illuminated for about two seconds as a bulb test.
- Service 4WD Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic service
4WD indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the service 4WD indicator will be illuminated. The
indicator remains illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until
the ignition switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Communication Error - If the cluster receives no lamp-ON or lamp-OFF messages from the TIPM
for 10 seconds the service 4WD indicator is illuminated by the cluster to indicate a loss of TIPM
communication. The indicator remains controlled and illuminated by the cluster until a valid
message is received from the TIPM.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the service 4WD indicator
will be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the
functionality of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case control circuits and transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine the condition of the system. The TIPM then sends the
proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For
further diagnosis of the service 4WD indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the
LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication
related to service 4WD indicator operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the
appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
Differential Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information > Page 9137
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - M/T: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 9142
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
G56 ......................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 5.6 L (12 pints)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 9145
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Mopar ATF +4 Transmission Fluid
Note: DaimlerChrysler recommends using Mopar lubricants or lubricants of equal quality.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - M/T
> Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH-CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION
1. Disconnect switch 2-wire connector (2) attached to pedal support bracket (1), under instrument
panel to left of clutch pedal. 2. Check switch continuity with an ohmmeter while operating clutch
pedal.
- Pedal Depressed - Continuity
- Pedal Released - No Continuity
3. If continuity is not present or always present, replace clutch master cylinder. Switch is not
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This Engine Control Module (ECM) input is used only on models equipped with aftermarket Power
Take Off (PTO) units.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9155
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
This input is used only to tell the ECM that the aftermarket PTO (Power Take Off) unit has been
engaged. The ECM will disable (temporarily shut down) certain OBD II diagnostic trouble codes
when the PTO unit is engaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Sensors and Switches - Power Take-Off >
Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This Engine Control Module (ECM) input is used only on models equipped with aftermarket Power
Take Off (PTO) units.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Sensors and Switches - Power Take-Off >
Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9161
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
This input is used only to tell the ECM that the aftermarket PTO (Power Take Off) unit has been
engaged. The ECM will disable (temporarily shut down) certain OBD II diagnostic trouble codes
when the PTO unit is engaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 9172
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 9173
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9178
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9179
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9180
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9181
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift
NUMBER: 21-019-07
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: November 14, 2007
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: FLASH: 68RFE Transmission - Harsh Coastdown Shift And/Or Harsh 2-3 Upshift
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Transmission
Control Module (1CM) with new software.
MODELS:
2007 - 2008 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before November 06, 2007 (MDH 1106XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a harsh downshift from the transmission when coming to a stop.
When a vehicle stop is initiated from 4th gear (around 40 Km/h or 25 MPH), the harsh downshift
condition will usually occur as the vehicle decelerates to a speed of about 16Km/h (10MPH). If the
transmission is in 2nd, 3rd, 5th, or 6th gear, when the stop is initiated, the condition will not be
present. This may cause the condition to appear to be intermittent to the customer. Because the
harsh downshift may occur below 16 Km/h (10 MPH), the customer may believe that they are
experiencing a harsh 2 - 1 downshift.
Some customers may also experience a harsh 2-3 upshift during normal acceleration. This
symptom is less common than the harsh coastdown shift.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
2. If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 9187
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO RETRIEVE THE FLASH
FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.03 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN® for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Place the ignition switch in the "RUN" position. Do not start engine.
5. Power ON the StarSCAN®.
6. Retrieve the old ECU (1CM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the TCM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash PCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
7. Clear all DTC's from the vehicle electronic modules.
NOTE:
Due to the TCM programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules within the
vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select "System
View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs shown on the
list.
8. Using the StarSCAN(R), perform a transmission "Quick Learn" procedure prior to returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-019-07 > Nov > 07 > A/T Controls - Harsh 2-3 Upshift/Coast Downshift > Page 9188
NOTE:
A "Quick Learn" must be performed.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set
NUMBER: 18-037-07 REV. A
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: July 20, 2007
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-037-07, DATED MAY 25,
2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE A CHANGE TO THE IGNITION SWITCH
POSITION WHEN PERFORMING SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT TEST.
THE StarSCAN(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE VIA THE INTERNET.
SUBJECT: 68RFE Transmission - DTC P0868 Low Line Pressure
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves checking the Transmission Control Module (TCM) to determine
that it is in proper working order and then selectively erasing and reprogramming the TCM with new
software.
MODELS:
2007 (DH/D1) Ram Truck (2500/3500)
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to vehicles equipped with a 68RFE automatic transmission (sale code DG7)
built on or before April 30, 2007 (MDH 0430XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may experience a Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illumination due to Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DIG) P0868 - Low Line Pressure
This condition may be due to the Transmission Control Module (1CM) software or to a hardware
circuit in the TCM.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using a StarSCAN(R) with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures available in TechCONNECT,
verify all engine systems are functioning as designed. If DTCs are present record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
If the vehicle operator describes or experiences the Symptom/Condition, perform the Repair
Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9193
SPECIAL TOOLS / EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
SECTION A - TCM CIRCUIT CHECK:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the ignition
switch.
2. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
3. Locate the TCM in the rear of the engine compartment.
4. Disconnect the "D" (green) electrical harness connector from the TCM. The "D" connector will
have a green color stripe to identify it.
5. Install special tool 8815-1 (Adapter) to the TCM "D" connector. Connect the harness "D"
connector to the 8815-1 Adapter.
6. Install special tool 8815 (PCM Diagnostic Pinout Box) to the 8815-1 Adapter.
7. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "OFF" ** position (the first detent clockwise from the ** "LOCK"
** position). DO NOT turn the ignition switch to the "ON/RUN" position, this will cause an incorrect
voltage reading to be obtain when testing.
NOTE:
Verify that the ignition switch is in the ** "OFF" ** position and NOT in the "ON/RUN" position. The
following steps must be followed in order.
9. Check of the D19 circuit:
a. Set the DVOM to DC voltage. Adjust the DC volts to the appropriate setting to correctly read 12
volts.
b. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 13 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 13, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
c. Pins 13 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to D13 (0 volts - ground) and to pins D19
(12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
d. Does the VOLT meter read 12 volts?
e. If YES, then proceed to the next step.
f. If NO, then further diagnosis of the circuit is required.
10. Check for a voltage difference between circuit D11 and D19:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 19 of the
8815 Pinout Box. Install the negative lead of the DVOM in pin 11, and the positive lead of the
DVOM in pin 19.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9194
b. Pins 11 and 19 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 (12 volts - driver output
voltage) and to D19 (12 volts - switched battery voltage) of the TCM.
c. The VOLT meter should read LESS THAN 2 volts. There should not be more than a 2 volt
difference between the two circuits (D11 and D19).
d. If the volt meter reading is LESS THAN 2 volts, then proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash)
The TCM.
e. If the volt meter reading is GREATER THAN 2 volts, then proceed to the next step.
11. Turn the ignition switch to the ** "LOCK" ** position and remove the ignition key from the
ignition switch.
12. Disconnect and isolate the negative battery cable from the battery negative terminal.
13. Disconnect the electrical harness "D" connector from the 8815-1 Adapter. The 8815-1 Adapter
should now be connected only to the "D" connector of the TCM and to the 8815 Pinout Box.
14. Check for the resistance between circuit D11 and D13 in the TCM:
a. Install the two leads of a known GOOD DVOM (Digital Volt Ohm Meter) to pins 11 and 13 of the
8815 Pinout Box. For this resistance test there is no difference/concern which lead of the DVOM is
connected to which pin (11 or 13)
b. Set the DVOM to OHM's. Adjust the ohm meter to the appropriate setting to correctly read
100,000 ohm (same as 100K ohm) resistance.
c. Pins 11 and 13 of the 8815 Pinout Box should connect to pins D11 and to D13 of the TCM for
this resistance test.
d. For this test, if the circuit is good, the OHM meter should read GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm
resistance (100K ohm). There should not be less than a 100,000 ohm resistance between the two
circuits (D11 and D13). If the circuit is good, the technician will probably read a resistance of about
2,000,000 ohm (same as 2M ohm), significantly higher than the 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) cut point.
e. If the ohm meter reading is GREATER THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance then the TCM
is good. Proceed to Section B - Reprogram (Flash) The TCM.
f. If ohm meter reading is LESS THAN 100,000 ohm (100K ohm) resistance, then the TCM is bad
(circuit is shorted). Replace the TCM. If a new TCM is required, make sure the TCM software is at
the latest revision level.
15. Connect the negative battery cable to the battery.
NOTE:
Additional circuit analysis and the replacement of the TCM under warranty is not addressed by this
Service Bulletin and if required would be claimed separate to this bulletin.
SECTION B - REPROGRAM (FLASH) TCM - USING StarSCAN AND THE INTERNET TO
RETRIEVE THE FLASH FILE:
NOTE:
Before performing this Repair Procedure, the operating software in the StarSCAN(R) must be
programmed with software release level 8.01 or higher.
The software release level is visible in the blue header at the top of the StarSCAN(R) screen.
NOTE:
The StarSCAN(R) diagnostic scan tool fully supports Internet connectivity. However, in order to
take advantage of this feature you must first configure the StarSCAN(R) for your dealership's
network. For instruction on setting up your StarSCAN(R) for the dealer's network; refer to the
StarSCAN(R) Quick Start Networking Guide available on the website under the "download center".
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash should be restarted.
1. Open the hood and install a battery charger. Using a voltmeter, verify that the charging rate
provides 13.2 - 13.5 volts. Set the battery charger to continuous charge. Do not allow the charger
to time out during the flash process. Remove the charger from the battery when the flash process
is complete.
NOTE:
Do not allow the charging voltage to climb above 13.5 volts during the flash process.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9195
2. Connect the CH9410 StarSCAN(R) ethernet cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the dealer's network
drop.
3. Connect the CH9404 StarSCAN(R) vehicle cable to the StarSCAN(R) and the vehicle.
4. Power ON the StarSCAN(R).
5. Retrieve the old ECU (TCM) part number. Using the StarSCAN(R) at the "Home" screen:
a. Select "ECU View"
b. Touch the screen to highlight the 1CM in the list of modules.
c. Select "More Options"
d. Select "ECU Flash".
e. Record the part number at the top of the "Flash TCM" screen for later reference.
f. Select "Browse for New File". Follow the on screen instructions.
g. Select "Download to Scantool".
h. Select "Close" after the download is complete, then select "Back".
i. Highlight the listed calibration.
j. Select "Update Controller".
k. When the TCM update is complete, select "OK".
NOTE:
Due to the ECU (TCM) programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other electronic modules
within the vehicle. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to illuminate. From the "Home" screen select
"System View". Then select "All DTCs". Press "Clear All Stored DTCs" if there are any DTCs
shown on the list.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law when reprogramming a PCM or TCM.
6. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 18-037-07A > Jul > 07 > A/T Controls - MIL ON/DTC P0868 Set > Page 9196
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE:
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9197
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9198
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9199
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9200
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9201
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9202
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 214
Component : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C1
Color : # of pins :
17
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2-3 POWER TAKEOFF RELAY ENABLE K427 18OR/LG
4-5 PRESSURE SIGNAL 4 T803 20DG/BR
6 PRESSURE SIGNAL 1 T800 20DG/BR
7-8-9-10 - 11 PRESSURE SIGNAL 5 T804 20YL/DB
12 PRESSURE SIGNAL 3 T802 20DG/PK
13 - 14 - 15 - 16 PRESSURE SIGNAL 6 T805 20DG/OR
17 PRESSURE SIGNAL 2 T801 20DG/RD
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9203
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C2
Color : # of pins :
24
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
2 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
3 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
4 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9204
5-6-7 FUSED B(+) A104 20YL/RD
8 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
9-10 - 11 - 12 - 13 - 14 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
15 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
16 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
17 GROUND Z133 18BK/LG
18 - 19 SHIFT 4 CONTROL T811 20DG/LB
20 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
21 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
22 - 23 - 24 - Component Location - 31
Connector:
Name : MODULE-TRANSMISSION CONTROL C3
Color : # of pins :
31
Qualifier : (RC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9205
Pin Description Circuit
1 SHIFT 1 CONTROL T808 20DG/GY
2-3 SHIFT 3 CONTROL T810 20DG/DB
4-5 LINEAR 3 CONTROL T817 20YL/BR
6 LINEAR 1 GROUND T812 20DG/TN
7 LINEAR 1 CONTROL T813 20DG/LG
8 LINEAR 2 CONTROL T815 20YL/RD
9 LINEAR 2 GROUND T814 20YL/BR
10 PRESSURE SIGNAL 7 T806 20DG/VT
11 - 12 - 13 - 14 - -
15 LINEAR 3 GROUND T816 20YL/PK
16 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
17 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
18 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
19 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
20 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
21 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
22 SHIFT 2 CONTROL T809 20DG/YL
23 - 24 - 25 - 26 PRESSURE SIGNAL 8 T807 20DG/WT
27 - 28 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
29 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
30 LINEAR 4 CONTROL T821 20YL/GY
31 LINEAR 4 GROUND T818 20YL/OR
Component Location - 31
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9206
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
On gasoline vehicles the Transmission Control Module (TCM) (2) may be sub-module within the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) (3).
68RFE TCM LOCATION
Vehicles equipped 68RFE transmission and a 6.7L Diesel engine, the TCM is housed in the NGC4
controller utilizing only the C1 and C4 connectors (TCM only). The controller is located at the rear
of the engine compartment, near the right inner fender.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9209
AS68RC TCM LOCATION
On Cab Chassis models equipped with the AS68RC transmission the Transmission Control Module
(TCM) has three electrical connectors and is located in the passenger compartment underneath of
the left side of the dash panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9210
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
RLE and RFE TRANSMISSIONS
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Control Relay (Switched B+) (if equipped)
- Throttle Position Sensor
- Crankshaft Position Sensor
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Shaft Speed Sensor
- Output Shaft Speed Sensor
- Line Pressure Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Target Idle
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient/Battery Temperature
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Transmission Control Relay
- Solenoids
- Torque Reduction Request
Some examples of TCM indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM)
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN)
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI)
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules
- System self-diagnostics
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool)
NOTE: If the TCM has been replaced, the "Quick Learn Procedure" must be performed.
BATTERY FEED
A fused, direct battery feed to the TCM is used for continuous power. This battery voltage is
necessary to retain memory in the TCM. When the battery (B+) is disconnected, this memory is
lost. When the battery (B+) is restored, this memory loss is detected by the TCM and a Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) is set.
CLUTCH VOLUME INDEXES (CVI)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9211
An important function of the TCM is to monitor Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI). CVIs represent the
volume of fluid needed to compress a clutch pack.
The TCM monitors gear ratio changes by monitoring the Input and Output Speed Sensors. The
Input, or Turbine Speed Sensor sends an electrical signal to the TCM that represents input shaft
rpm. The Output Speed Sensor provides the TCM with output shaft speed information.
By comparing the two inputs, the TCM can determine transmission gear position. This is important
to the CVI calculation because the TCM determines CVIs by monitoring how long it takes for a gear
change to occur.
Gear ratios can be determined by using the Scan Tool and reading the Input/Output Speed Sensor
values in the "Monitors" display. Gear ratio can be obtained by dividing the Input Speed Sensor
value by the Output Speed Sensor value.
For example, if the input shaft is rotating at 1000 rpm and the output shaft is rotating at 500 rpm,
then the TCM can determine that the gear ratio is 2:1. In direct drive (3rd gear), the gear ratio
changes to 1:1. The gear ratio changes as clutches are applied and released. By monitoring the
length of time it takes for the gear ratio to change following a shift request, the TCM can determine
the volume of fluid used to apply or release a friction element.
The volume of transmission fluid needed to apply the friction elements are continuously updated for
adaptive controls. As friction material wears, the volume of fluid need to apply the element
increases.
Certain mechanical problems within the input clutch assembly can cause inadequate or
out-of-range element volumes. Also, defective Input/Output Speed Sensors and wiring can cause
these conditions. The following charts identifies the appropriate clutch volumes and when they are
monitored/updated:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9212
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9213
SHIFT SCHEDULES
As mentioned earlier, the TCM has programming that allows it to select a variety of shift schedules.
Shift schedule selection is dependent on the following:
- Shift lever position
- Throttle position
- Engine load
- Fluid temperature
- Software level
As driving conditions change, the TCM appropriately adjusts the shift schedule. Refer to the
following chart to determine the appropriate operation expected, depending on driving conditions.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9214
AISIN AS68RC TRANSMISSION
The Transmission Control Module (TCM) controls all electronic operations of the transmission. The
TCM receives information regarding vehicle operation from both direct and indirect inputs, and
selects the operational mode of the transmission. Direct inputs are hard wired to, and used
specifically by the TCM. Indirect inputs are shared with the TCM via the vehicle communication
bus.
Some examples of direct inputs to the TCM are:
- Battery (B+) voltage
- Ignition "ON" voltage
- Transmission Range Sensor
- Pressure Switches
- Transmission Temperature Sensor
- Input Speed Sensor
- Output Speed Sensor
Some examples of indirect inputs to the TCM are:
- Engine/Body Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9215
- Manifold Pressure
- Throttle position
- Torque Reduction Confirmation
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Exhaust Brake Status (if equipped)
- PTO Request (if equipped)
- Scan Tool Communication
Based on the information received from these various inputs, the TCM determines the appropriate
shift schedule and shift points, depending on the present operating conditions and driver demand.
This is possible through the control of various direct and indirect outputs.
Some examples of TCM direct outputs are:
- Exhaust Brake Cut Request (if equipped).
- Solenoids.
- Torque Reduction Request.
Some examples of TCM .indirect outputs are:
- Transmission Temperature (to PCM).
- PRNDL Position (to cluster/CCN).
- PTO Status.
In addition to monitoring inputs and controlling outputs, the TCM has other important
responsibilities and functions:
- Storing and maintaining Clutch Volume Indexes (CVI).
- Storing and selecting appropriate Shift Schedules.
- System self-diagnostics.
- Diagnostic capabilities (with scan tool).
Clutch filling time is continuously maintained when the vehicle is running.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Warnings
WARNINGS - GENERAL
WARNINGS: provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING: Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
WARNING: Use safety stands anytime a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
WARNING: Be sure that the ignition switch always is in the off position, unless the procedure
requires it to be on.
WARNING: Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should
be in park. A manual transmission should be in neutral.
WARNING: Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area.
WARNING: Keep away from moving parts when the engine is running, especially the fan and belts.
WARNING: To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold(s), tail pipe, catalytic converter and muffler.
WARNING: Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around
the battery.
WARNING: Always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid loose clothing.
How to Use Wiring Diagrams
DESCRIPTION - HOW TO USE WIRING DIAGRAMS
DaimlerChrysler Corporation wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the
vehicles wiring content. In order to effectively use the wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair
DaimlerChrysler Corporation vehicles, it is important to understand all of their features and
characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around the component indicates that the component is being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9220
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9221
SYMBOLS
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9222
TERMINOLOGY
This is a list of terms and definitions used in the wiring diagrams.
LHD -Left Hand Drive Vehicles RHD -Right Hand Drive Vehicles ATX -Automatic
Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9223
MTX -Manual Transmissions-Front Wheel Drive AT -Automatic Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive
MT -Manual Transmissions-Rear Wheel Drive SOHC -Single Over Head Cam Engine DOHC
-Double Over Head Cam Engine Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In Markets Other Than North
America Except Export -Vehicles Built For Sale In North America
Circuit Functions
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT FUNCTIONS
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and it's function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9224
Circuit Information
DESCRIPTION - CIRCUIT INFORMATION
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, a specific part of
the main circuit, gage of wire, and color. An example would be A 2 18 LB/YL. This is a Battery
Feed circuit, level two, eighteen gauge, light blue with a yellow tracer.
Connector, Ground and Splice Information
DESCRIPTION - CONNECTOR, GROUND AND SPLICE INFORMATION
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9225
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows:
- In-line connectors located in the engine compartment are C100 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the instrument panel area are C200 series numbers.
- In-line connectors located in the body are C300 series numbers.
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connectors.
- Splices are identified with an "S" and follow the same series numbering as the in-line connectors.
In addition, S001-S099 numbers are located in the engine compartment.
- Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number. Multiple
connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
LOCATIONS
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location section to indicate a point in which the
wiring harness branches out to a component. The abbreviation N/S means Not Shown in the
illustrations
Section Identification and Information
DESCRIPTION - SECTION IDENTIFICATION AND INFORMATION
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shutdown Relay is most likely to be found in Powertrain Management, so it is
shown there complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some
associated wiring.
Splice diagrams show the entire splice and provide references to other sections the splices serves.
Splice Information contains splice diagrams that are not shown in their entirety somewhere else in
the wiring diagrams.
Connector Pin-Outs shows each connector and the circuits involved with that connector. The
connectors are identified using the name/number on the diagram pages.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Release Connector Lock (2).
3. Disconnect the connector (3) being repaired from its mating half/component.
4. Remove the dress cover (if applicable) (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9226
5. Release the Secondary Terminal Lock, if required (1).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9227
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9228
6. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper special tool. Pull
on the wire to remove the terminal from the
connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the removed terminal in the same cavity on the repair connector.
2. Repeat steps for each terminal in the connector, being sure that all wires are inserted into the
proper cavities. For additional connector pin-out
identification, refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. When the connector is re-assembled, the secondary terminal lock must be placed in the locked
position to prevent terminal push out.
4. Replace dress cover (if applicable).
5. Connect connector to its mating half/component.
6. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9229
1. Disconnect the battery.
2. Locate the diode in the harness, and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction (1) (2) (3).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Remove the insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in
the new diode.
2. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. If necessary, refer to the
appropriate wiring diagram for current flow.
3. Solder the connection together using rosin core type solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
4. Tape the diode to the harness using electrical tape. Make sure the diode is completely sealed
from the elements.
5. Re-connect the battery and test affected systems.
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Follow steps for removing terminals described in the connector removal section.
2. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Select a wire from the terminal repair kit that best matches the color and gage of the wire being
repaired.
2. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation.
3. Splice the repair wire to the wire harness (see wire splicing procedure).
4. Insert the repaired wire into the connector.
5. Install the connector locking wedge, if required, and reconnect the connector to its mating
half/component.
6. Re-tape the wire harness starting at 1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the
repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9230
7. Connect battery and test all affected systems.
Wire Splicing
STANDARD PROCEDURE - WIRE SPLICING
When splicing a wire, it is important that the correct gage be used as shown in the wiring diagrams.
1. Remove one-half (1/2) inch of insulation from each wire that needs to be spliced.
2. Place a piece of adhesive lined heat shrink tubing on one side of the wire. Make sure the tubing
will be long enough to cover and seal the entire
repair area.
3. Place the strands of wire overlapping each other inside of the splice clip (1).
4. Using crimping tool (1), Mopar p/n 05019912AA, crimp the splice clip and wires together.
5. Solder (3) the connection (2) together using rosin core type solder (1) only.
CAUTION: DO NOT USE ACID CORE SOLDER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9231
6. Center the heat shrink tubing (2) over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant (1) comes out
of both ends of the tubing.
Special Tools
WIRING/TERMINAL
PROBING TOOL PACKAGE 6807
TERMINAL PICK TOOL SET 6680
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9232
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOLS 6932 AND 8638
TERMINAL REMOVING TOOL 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9233
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
STANDARD PROCEDURE - ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE (ESD) SENSITIVE DEVICES
All ESD sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to indicate this. When handling
any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures to reduce the possibility of
electrostatic charge build up on the body and inadvertent discharge into the component. If it is not
known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first.
4. Do not remove the part from it's protective packing until it is time to install the part.
5. Before removing the part from it's package, ground the package to a known good ground on the
vehicle.
Testing Of Voltage Potential
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING OF VOLTAGE POTENTIAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9234
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need
to be turned ON to check voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Testing For Continuity
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR CONTINUITY
1. Remove the fuse (1) for the circuit being checked or, disconnect the battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9235
2. Connect one lead of the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested
3. Connect the other lead to the other end of the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means
good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse.
2. Connect a test light or a voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse.
3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness about six to eight inches apart and watch
the voltmeter/test lamp.
4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the test lamp glows, there is a short to ground in that general
area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short To Ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A SHORT TO GROUND ON FUSES POWERING
SEVERAL LOADS
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the suspected fused circuits.
2. Replace the blown fuse.
3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the battery.
4. Start connecting or energizing the items in the fuse circuit one at a time. When the fuse blows
the circuit with the short to ground has been isolated.
Testing For A Voltage Drop
STANDARD PROCEDURE - TESTING FOR A VOLTAGE DROP
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery.
2. Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch, component or circuit.
3. Operate the item.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9236
4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - WIRING HARNESS
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: Never use a jumper wire across a load, such as a motor, connected between a battery
feed and ground.
- Voltmeter - Used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black lead to a known good
ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
- Ohmmeter - Used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low or no resistance in
a circuit means good continuity.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicles are Solid State. When
checking resistance in these circuits use a meter with a 10 - megohm or greater impedance rating.
In addition, make sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered up by
the vehicle's electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807, and insert the probing end (2) into the terminal being tested.
Use the other end of the tool (1) to insert the meter probe.
INTERMITTENT AND POOR CONNECTIONS
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly, check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked into
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt or moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
TROUBLESHOOTING WIRING PROBLEMS
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9237
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem area.
6. Verify the proper operation. For this step, check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 9238
Transmission Control System Relay: Connector Views
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Transmission Control System Relay: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
AS68RC Automatic Transmission
NOTE: Due to different power control configurations, the Transmission Control Relay (if equipped)
may be referred to as a PCM relay.
The relay is supplied fused B+ voltage, energized by the TIPM, and is used to supply power to the
TCM when the transmission is in normal operating mode.
Operation
OPERATION
The TIPM energizes the transmission control relay. When the relay is "off", no power is supplied to
the TCM and the transmission will not operate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 9245
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 9246
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 9247
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 9248
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 9249
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality now resides in the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM), refer to the TIPM information for location. The TIPM controls the 4X4
transfer case shift functions via the actuation of a shift motor and utilizing the feedback of a mode
sensor assembly. Communication is via the CAN bus. Inputs include user selectable 4X4 modes
that include 2WD, AWD, 4HI, 4LO, and Neutral (selections vary with the specific transfer case).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9252
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality in the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM) utilizes the input from the transfer case mounted mode sensor, the instrument panel
mounted selector switch, and the following information from the vehicle's CAN bus to determine if a
shift is allowed.
- Engine RPM and Vehicle Speed
- Diagnostic Requests
- Manual Transmission and Brake Applied
- PRNDL
- Ignition Status
- ABS Messages
Once the TIP determines that a requested shift is allowed, it actuates the bi-directional shift motor
as necessary to achieve the desired transfer case operating mode. The TIPM also monitors the
mode sensor while controlling the shift motor to determine the status of the shift attempt.
Several items can cause the requested shift not to be completed. If the TIPM has recognized a
fault (DTC) of some variety, it will begin operation in one of four Functionality Levels. These levels
are:
- Level Zero - Normal Operation.
- Level One - Only Mode Shifts Are Allowed.
- Level Two - Only Mode Shifts and Shifts Into LOW Are Allowed (No Neutral Shifts Are Allowed).
- Level Three - No Shifts Are Allowed
The TIPM can also be operating in one of three possible power modes. These power modes are:
- Full Power Mode is the normal operational mode of the module. This mode is achieved by normal
CAN bus traffic being present and the ignition being in the RUN position.
Reduced Power Mode will be entered when the ignition has been powered off. In this state, the
module will shut down power supplied to external devices, and to electronic interface inputs and
outputs. From this state the module can enter either Sleep Mode or Full Power Mode. To enter this
mode, the module must receive an ignition message denoting that the ignition is off, or not receive
any messages for 5 ± 0.5 seconds. To exit this mode, the module must receive one ignition
message that denotes that the ignition is in the RUN position.
- Sleep Mode will be entered, from the Reduced Power Mode, when no CAN traffic has been
sensed for 20 ± 1 seconds. If during Sleep Mode the module detects CAN bus traffic, it will revert
to the Reduced Power mode while monitoring for ignition messages. It will remain in this state as
long as there is traffic other than run or start messages, and will return to Sleep mode if the bus
goes without traffic for 20 ± 1 seconds.
SHIFT REQUIREMENTS
If the TIPM is in full power mode and at functionality level zero, it uses the following criteria to
determine if a shift is allowed.
If any of the driver controllable conditions are not met once the shift request is recognized, the
TIPM will solidly illuminate the source position's LED and flash the desired position's LED for all
shifts except NEUTRAL. The NEUTRAL shift LED strategy will be discussed later.
Mode shifts will be allowed regardless of transmission gear or vehicle speed, whenever the
following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector switch state indicates that a mode shift has been requested.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
Range shifts will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector Switch state indicating a range shift has been requested.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal must be recognized for at least 1.5 seconds ± 100 msec.
(Automatic transmissions only)
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Clutch signal is recognized for 500 msec ± 50 msec (Manual transmissions only).
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9253
A shift into transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 4.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus. (Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position, engine off.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
A shift out of transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 1.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus.(Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
SHIFT SEQUENCES
Once all the driver controllable conditions for the requested shift have been met, the TIPM begins a
shift timer with a maximum duration of 1 second per 'D' channel transition. If the shift timer expires
before the TIPM recognizes to correct mode sensor code, the shift is considered to have been
blocked. The blocked shift will increment the blocked shift counter by one. The TIPM strategy for
handling blocked shifts will be described later. The process the TIPM performs for the various shifts
will be described first.
RANGE AND MODE SHIFTS
The process for performing all the range and mode shifts are the same. The following steps
describe the process.
- Allow time for Selector Switch debounce; 250 msec ± 50 msec.
- Extinguish the source gear's LED while flashing desired transfer case position's LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel transition in the
destination gear's direction while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Solidly illuminate the selected gear's LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds ± 100 msec. per 'D'
channel. The TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired
position.
The exception to the preceding sequence is when a shift from 4L to 2WD/AWD is requested. If
2WD/AWD is requested from the 4L position, the transfer case is first driven to the 4H position. If
the 4H position is reached, the transfer case is then driven back to the 2WD/AWD position and the
shift is considered complete. If the transfer case does not reach any the 4H position, but is in the
2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the 2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the
shift is also considered complete.
SHIFT OUT OF NEUTRAL
The following steps describe the process for a shift out of NEUTRAL.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec toward the transfer case 4H mode
position while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds 100 msec. The
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9254
TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired position.
- When the Neutral button is released, if the 4H position is the desired position, the shift is
complete. Illuminate the 4H LED.
- Otherwise when the Neutral button is released, if all of the shift requirements are being met then
engage the shift motor towards the desired position for 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel. (if
requirements for shifting are not met, illuminate the 4H LED and flash the destination LED as an
indication to the driver that all of the driver controllable shift conditions are not being met). If this
requires another range or mode shift, begin the range/mode shift process.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (i.e. a blocked or other
condition exists), refer to Blocked Shift Strategy.
BLOCKED SHIFT STRATEGY
When a shift is commanded, the shift motor will be driven towards its destination position, except in
the case of shifting out of Neutral if 4L was selected (the transfer case will shift to the 4H position
first, before proceeding to 4L). If the shift is blocked on the way to the destination, the TIPM may
attempt to drive the motor back to the original position. This process will be allowed to occur 5
times. If the transfer case has reached a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel during the shift re-attempts,
the LED for the achieved gear position is illuminated and the shift attempts are stopped. To
re-attempt the desired shift, the selector switch will need to be rotated to the current position until
the switch debounce timer expires then a shift will need to be requested again.
At the end of the 5th blocked attempt, the shift motor is driven towards the last known 'D' channel
position. If this motor drive allows the transfer case to reach the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the
2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the shift is considered complete
and the shift attempts are ended.
If the mode sensor is in the NEUTRAL region at the expiration of the shift timer, the TIPM will
continue to make the shift attempts according to the blocked shift strategy independent of whether
or not the driver controlled conditions are met.
For shifts from NEUTRAL, if all 5 attempts fail to reach the desired position (which by default is
4H), the motor will be driven to stall in the direction of 4H or 4L, depending on the achieved
position. If the transfer case has reached the 2WD/AWD or 4L between gear position nearest the
NEUTRAL positions and the shift conditions are no longer being met, the transfer case will be
driven toward the corresponding 'D' channel. Otherwise, the transfer case will be driven in the
direction opposite the last attempt with the desired target being 4H or 4L.
If the transfer case reaches the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel when being driven in the 4H direction, then
one final 1.0 second drive toward 4H is attempted. If the transfer case then reaches any of the 4H
positions, the shift is considered complete and the 4H LED is illuminated. If the transfer case is still
the 2WD/AWD position, the shift is considered complete and the 2WD/AWD LED is illuminated.
NOTE: If after the 5th blocked shift and reversal attempt, if the transfer case position is in the
NEUTRAL region, shift attempts will continue until a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel is reached.
SHIFT REVERSAL TARGETS
If the shift timer expires (1 second per 'D' channel) and the transfer case has not reached the
desired position, all shifts will attempt to return to their original position with the exceptions of:
- If the intended shift is going to the High rail from Low and can't make it, but it can make the
2WD/AWD position, the motor stops at that position. The TIPM will not attempt to cross back over
NEUTRAL if it does not have to. This means that there was a block on the first attempt to go to 4H
and the transfer case has made it through NEUTRAL to a known good position, then the motor will
go back only to the 2WD/4WD position and execute the remainder of the attempts from there.
- For shifts out of NEUTRAL, any time a shift is commanded out of NEUTRAL, the system needs to
get out. The TIPM should never go to NEUTRAL unless the driver is commanding it and all
required conditions are being met
ENCODER DRIFT CORRECTION
Whenever a shift is completed, the TIPM stores the position in memory as the transfer case's
intended position. The TIPM continuously monitors the mode sensor and if the mode sensor drifts
toward into a NEUTRAL region sensor position for 2.0 seconds, the TIPM will perform a motor
drive to correct the drift. The transfer case will be driven toward the intended position for 1.0
seconds ± 100 msec. The TIPM will wait for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeat the attempt to shift
to the desired position. This will continue until the intended position is reached.
SHIFT MOTOR BRAKING
Two modes of shift motor braking are employed to improve shift performance, static and dynamic.
Static shift motor braking is utilized under the following conditions:
- Whenever the transfer case is in the 2WD/AWD or 4L 'D' channel position.
- Whenever an invalid mode sensor code is present.
Static motor braking is achieved by applying +12V on both shift motor wires.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays
and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9255
NOTE: Static Shift Motor Braking is independent of ignition key position.
SHIFT ATTEMPT LIMIT
To protect the transfer case system, the TIPM will impose a limit on the number of shifts that can
occur over a calibrated time period. The system will monitor the number of 'D' channel segment
transitions that occur in any 30 second time period. If the number of segment transitions is 30 or
greater, the system will go into a default mode. The default mode of operation for shifting is that the
number of allowed 'D' channel transitions permitted to occur will be 3 over each 15 second ± 100
msec calibrated window of time. After 5 minutes ± 100 msec, the motor can be assumed to have
cooled down and the system will revert to normal operation. The following rules also apply to the
shift limit:
- The attempt limit will not prevent shifts coming out of NEUTRAL, they will be allowed regardless
of the counter/timer.
- Any shift that is in progress when the counter reaches a maximum count in time will be allowed to
complete before the default mode is entered. D-channel transitions during this period will not be
counted towards the default mode limit.
- A block, regardless of the direction, whether towards destination or back towards reversal target
(shift timer expiring), will count as a value of 2 transitions towards the 30 segment transitions to go
into default mode as defined above. Current attempt limit values are 30 transitions in 30 seconds
and default mode values are 3 transitions every 15 seconds for 5 minutes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9261
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9262
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 410
Component : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-LINE PRESSURE
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 4
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Pin Description Circuit
1 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
2 5 VOLT SUPPLY F856 20YL/PK
3 LINE PRESSURE SIGNAL T38 20YL/BR
4--
Component Location - 23
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9263
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The TCM utilizes a closed-loop system to control transmission line pressure. The system contains
a variable force style solenoid, the Pressure Control Solenoid, which is part of the pressure switch
assembly. The solenoid is duty cycle controlled by the TCM to vent the unnecessary line pressure
supplied by the oil pump back to the pump inlet. The system contains a Line Pressure Sensor,
which is a direct input to the TCM. The line pressure sensor monitors the transmission line
pressure and completes the feedback loop to the TCM. The TCM uses this information to adjust its
control of the pressure control solenoid to achieve the desired line pressure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9266
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The TCM calculates the desired line pressure based upon inputs from the transmission and engine.
The TCM calculates the torque input to the transmission and uses that information as the primary
input to the calculation. The line pressure is set to a predetermined value during shifts, to ensure
consistent shift quality. During all other operation, the desired line pressure value is adjusted based
on torque level and other transmission requirements.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Remove the bolt holding the line pressure sensor
(2) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the line pressure sensor (2) from the transmission case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal > Page
9269
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the line pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the line
pressure sensor (2) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the line pressure sensor (2). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Overdrive Switch: Locations
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9273
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9274
Overdrive Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 490
Component : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF
Color : NATURAL
# of pins : 6
Pin Description Circuit
123 TOW/HAUL OVERDRIVE OFF SWITCH SIGNAL T6 20DG
4 GROUND Z71 20LB/BK
5 AUTOSTICK (ERS)-TOW/HAUL SIGNAL T5 20DG/YL
6 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9275
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9276
Overdrive Switch: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - OVERDRIVE ELECTRICAL CONTROLS
The tow/haul overdrive off switch, valve body solenoid, case connectors and related wiring can all
be tested with a 12 volt test lamp or a volt/ohmmeter. Check continuity of each component when
diagnosis indicates this is necessary.
Switch and solenoid continuity should be checked whenever the transmission fails to shift into
fourth gear range.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 42RLE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9279
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9280
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 545RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9281
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9282
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9283
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9284
Overdrive Switch: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Using a plastic trim tool, remove the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer (2) from the shift lever
(1).
2. Pull the switch (2) outwards to release it from the connector in the lever (1).
Installation
INSTALLATION
NOTE: There is enough slack in the wire to pull out the connector from the lever.
1. Pull the connector (2) out of the lever (1) just enough to grasp it.
CAUTION: Be careful not to bend the pins on the tow/haul overdrive off switch. Use care when
installing the switch, as it is not indexed,
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 42RLE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9285
and can be accidentally installed incorrectly.
2. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch (3) into the connector (2). 3. Push the tow/haul overdrive
off switch (3) and wiring into the shift lever (1). 4. Install the tow/haul overdrive off switch retainer
onto the shift lever.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9290
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9291
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9292
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9293
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9294
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9295
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9296
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9297
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9298
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9299
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Locations Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9300
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Transmission Range
Component ID: 430
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
10
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRS NEUTRAL SIGNAL T825 20DG/YL
2 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
3 TRS 1 SIGNAL T828 20DG/DB
4 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (OFF-RUN-START) F1 20PK/WT
5 TRS PARK SIGNAL T824 20YL/DB
6 GROUND Z157 16BK/LG
7 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
8 TRS DRIVE SIGNAL T827 20DG/LB
9 TRS REVERSE SIGNAL T826 20DG/DB
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9303
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9304
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9305
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : # of pins :
6
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 TRS SIGNAL T117 20DG/YL
3-4--
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9306
5 TRS RETURN T917 20YL/TN
6 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9307
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9308
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION RANGE
Color : LT. GREEN
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
2-3 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
4 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9309
5-6-7 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
10 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9310
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9311
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9312
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagrams Assembly-Transmission Solenoid/TRS
Component ID: 18
Component : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-TRANSMISSION SOLENOID/TRS
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 23
Qualifier : (RFE)
Pin Description Circuit
1-2 L/R CONTROL T20 20DG/WT
3-4 TRS T41 SIGNAL (P/N) T41 20YL/DB
5 TRS T42 SIGNAL T42 20DG/YL
6--
7 OD SOLENOID CONTROL T60 20YL/GY
8 TRS T3 SIGNAL T3 20DG/DB
9 TRS T1 SIGNAL T1 20DG/LB
10 TRANSMISSION CONTROL OUTPUT T16 16YL/OR
11 4C PRESSURE SIGNAL T48 20BR/YL
12 LINE PRESSURE CONTROL T118 20DG
13 TRS T2 SIGNAL T4 20DG/LB
14 L/R PRESSURE SIGNAL T50 20DG/PK
15 2C PRESSURE SIGNAL T147 20DG/YL
16 OD PRESSURE SIGNAL T9 20DG/TN
17 UD CONTROL T59 20YL/LB
18 UD PRESSURE SIGNAL T29 20YL/WT
19 4C CONTROL T259 20YL/DG
20 2C CONTROL T219 20YL/LG
21 MS CONTROL T140 20YL/GY
22 SENSOR GROUND T160 20DG/WT
22 SENSOR GROUND K900 20DB/DG
23 TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T54 20DG/OR
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Sensor-Transmission Range > Page 9313
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has 3 primary functions:
- Provide a PARK/NEUTRAL start signal to the engine controller and the starter relay.
- Turn the Back-up lamps on when the transmission is in REVERSE and the engine (ignition) is on.
- Provide a transmission range signal to the instrument cluster.
The sensor is mounted in the transmission housing near the valve body, just above the pan rail. It's
in the same position as the Park/Neutral switch on other transmissions. The TRS contacts a
cammed surface on the manual valve lever. The cammed surface translates the rotational motion
of the manual lever into the linear motion of the sensor. The cammed surface on the manual lever
is comprised of two parts controlling the TRS signal: The insulator portion contacts the switch
poppet when the manual lever is not in PARK or NEUTRAL. The manual lever itself contacts the
poppet when the lever is in PARK or NEUTRAL; providing a ground for the signal from the starter
relay and the appropriate engine controller.
Operation
OPERATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9316
As the switch moves through its linear motion contacts slide across a circuit board which changes
the resistance between the range sensing pins of the switch. A power supply on the instrument
cluster provides a regulated voltage signal to the switch. The return signal is decoded by the
cluster, which then controls the PRNDL display to correspond with the correct transmission range.
A bus message of transmission range is also sent by the cluster. In REVERSE range a second
contact set closes the circuit providing power to the reverse lamps.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9317
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9318
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) is part of the solenoid module, which is mounted to the top
of the valve body inside the transmission.
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) has five switch contact pins that:
- Determine shift lever position
- Supply ground to the Starter Relay in Park and Neutral only.
The TRS also has an integrated temperature sensor (thermistor) that communicates transmission
temperature to the TCM and PCM.
Operation
OPERATION
The Transmission Range Sensor (TRS) communicates shift lever position to the TCM as a
combination of open and closed switches. Each shift lever position has an assigned combination of
switch states (open/closed) that the TCM receives from four sense circuits. The TCM interprets this
information and determines the appropriate transmission gear position and shift schedule.
There are many possible combinations of open and closed switches (codes). Five of these possible
codes correspond to valid gear position, there are two codes for the neutral position and three are
recognized as "between gear" codes. This results in many codes which should never occur. These
are called "invalid" codes. An invalid code will result in a DTC, and the TCM will then determine the
shift lever position based on pressure switch data. This allows reasonably normal transmission
operation with a TRS failure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
48RE (A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9319
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
The transmission range sensor (1) is mounted externally on the left side of the transmission case.
Operation
OPERATION
The transmission range sensor prohibits the vehicle from starting in any gear other than park and
neutral.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 9320
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
DIAGNOSIS AND TESTING - TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR (TRS)
NOTE: For all circuit identification in the following steps, Refer to the appropriate Wiring
Information.
1. Raise vehicle on suitable hoist. 2. Disconnect the vehicle's shift cable from the manual lever. 3.
With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved to
the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the TRS and the transmission case. The
resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
4. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Park/Neutral Position Sense pin of the
TRS and the transmission case. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms.
5. If the resistance is greater than 5 ohms in either of the previous steps, check for a dirty contact
between the tip of the TRS rod and the valve body
manual lever. If the contact is OK, replace the TRS.
6. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Fused Ignition Switch Output and the Back-up Lamp
feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be less than 5 ohms. If the resistance is greater than 5
ohms, replace the TRS.
7. With the manual lever in the PARK position (the PARK position is with the manual lever moved
to the full rearward position), measure the
resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Transmission Range Sensor 5V
Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 522.2 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
8. With the manual lever in the REVERSE position (the REVERSE position is with the manual lever
moved one detent forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 206.2 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
9. With the manual lever in the NEUTRAL position (the NEUTRAL position is with the manual lever
moved two detents forward of the full
rearward position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 108.6 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
10. With the manual lever in the DRIVE position (the DRIVE position is with the manual lever
moved three detents forward of the full rearward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the
Transmission Range Sensor 5V Supply pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 59.9 ohms. If
the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
11. With the manual lever in the SECOND position (the SECOND position is with the manual lever
moved one detent rearward of the full forward
position), measure the resistance between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up
Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The resistance should be 31.9 ohms. If the resistance is not correct,
replace the TRS.
12. With the manual lever in the LOW position (the LOW position is with the manual lever moved to
the full forward position), measure the resistance
between the Transmission Range Sensor MUX and the Back-up Lamp feed pins of the TRS. The
resistance should be 13.7 ohms. If the resistance is not correct, replace the TRS.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: Be certain the transmission is in the park lock position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
1. Remove the shift cable from the manual shift lever (2). 2. Disconnect the wire harness from the
transmission range sensor. 3. Remove the two nuts (3) from the control shaft.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 9323
TRS REMOVAL/INSTALLATION
4. Pry open the tabs on the stake washer (5), remove the nut (3) and the stake washer (5). 5.
Remove the bolts (2). 6. Remove the transmission range sensor (1) from the transmission control
shaft (4).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the transmission range sensor (3) onto the control shaft (5). 2. Install the stake washer
and the nut (4) and hand tighten. 3. With the transmission in neutral install the alignment tool 9983
(6) onto the control shaft (5) and into the alignment hole (1). 4. Install the bolts (2). 5. After aligning
the transmission range sensor, tighten the bolts (2) 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 9324
6. Remove the alignment tool 9983 (6) 7. Tighten the control shaft nut to 7 Nm (62 in.lbs.) 8. Bend
the tabs on the stake washer and nut (4) in at least two places to lock in position.
TRANSMISSION RANGE SENSOR
9. Install the manual shift lever (2) onto the control shaft.
10. Install the inner nut (3) onto the control shaft. Tighten the inner nut to 12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs). 11.
Install the outer nut (3) onto the control shaft. While holding the inner nut, tighten the outer not to
12.5 Nm (9 ft.lbs)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 9325
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under the transmission range sensor (TRS). 2. Move the
transmission manual lever to the manual LOW position. The manual LOW position is with the
manual lever in the forward-most detent. 3. Disengage the wiring connector from the TRS. 4.
Remove the two screws holding the TRS to the TRS mounting bracket. 5. Remove the TRS (3)
from the TRS mounting bracket by pulling it straight out of the bracket.
6. If necessary, loosen the TRS mounting bracket (2) in the transmission case using Adapter 8581
(3).
7. If necessary, remove the TRS mounting bracket (2) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 9326
1. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the manual LOW position. 2. If necessary, install
the TRS mounting bracket (2) into the transmission case. Using Adapter 8581 (3), tighten the
mounting bracket to 34 Nm (300
in.lbs.).
3. Install the TRS (3) into the mounting bracket (2) with the wiring connector facing the front of the
transmission.
4. Install the two screws to hold the TRS to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 5 Nm (45
in.lbs.). 5. Verify proper sensor operation (1-4). 6. Move the transmission manual shaft lever to the
PARK position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > AS68RC
Automatic Transmission > Page 9327
7. Connect TRS wiring connector to the TRS and lower vehicle. 8. Refill the transmission fluid to
the correct level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9332
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9333
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9334
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9335
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9336
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9337
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9338
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9339
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9340
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9341
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9342
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9343
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9344
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9345
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9346
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9347
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9348
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9349
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9350
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Input Speed
Component ID: 405
Component : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9353
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9354
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9355
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-INPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SIGNAL T52 20DG/OR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9356
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9357
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9358
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9359
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Output Speed
Component ID: 415
Component : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 8 VOLT SUPPLY T72 20YL/DB
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9360
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9361
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9362
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9363
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 18DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 18DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9364
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9365
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9366
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9367
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-OUTPUT SPEED
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 2
Qualifier : (RFE/RLE)
Pin Description Circuit
1 OUTPUT SPEED SIGNAL T14 20DG/BR
2 SPEED SENSOR GROUND T13 20DG/VT
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9368
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9369
Component Location - 19
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9370
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Input Speed > Page
9371
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 48RE (A-618) 4 Speed
Description
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor (1) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the park
gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed.
Operation
OPERATION
Speed sensor signals are triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup
face. Input signals from the sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing.
Signals from this sensor are shared with the powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9374
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Description
DESCRIPTION
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate AC
signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case and are
considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the teeth of
the input clutch hub pass by the sensor coil, an AC voltage is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an AC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the park gear teeth. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation > 48RE
(A-618) 4 Speed > Page 9375
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Description
DESCRIPTION
INPUT AND OUTPUT SPEED SENSORS
The Input and Output Speed Sensors are two-wire magnetic pickup devices that generate DC
square wave signals as rotation occurs. They are mounted in the left side of the transmission case
and are considered primary inputs to the Transmission Control Module (TCM).
Operation
OPERATION
The Input Speed Sensor provides information on how fast the input shaft is rotating. As the "teeth"
of the gear pass by the sensor coil, an DC square wave is generated and sent to the TCM. The
TCM interprets this information as input shaft rpm.
The Output Speed Sensor generates an DC signal in a similar fashion, though its coil is excited by
rotation of the rear planetary carrier lugs. The TCM interprets this information as output shaft rpm.
The TCM compares the input and output speed signals to determine the following:
- Transmission gear ratio
- Speed ratio error detection
- CVI calculation
The TCM also compares the input speed signal and the engine speed signal to determine the
following:
- Torque converter clutch slippage
- Torque converter element speed ratio
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair 68RFE Automatic Transmission
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the input speed sensor (3). 4. Remove the bolt holding the input speed sensor to
the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor (3) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the input speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the input
speed sensor (3) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid as
necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Removal
REMOVAL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9378
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3. Remove the wiring
connector from the output speed sensor (1). 4. Remove the bolt holding the output speed sensor
(1) to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor (1) from the transmission case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the output speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. 2. Install the bolt to hold the output
speed sensor (1) into the transmission case. Tighten the bolt to 12 Nm (105 in.lbs.). 3. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor (1). 4. Verify the transmission fluid level. Add fluid
as necessary. 5. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9379
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair AS68RC Automatic Transmission
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission. 3.
Remove the wiring connector from the output speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the output
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the output speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Place a suitable fluid catch pan under the transmission.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9380
3. Remove the wiring connector from the input speed sensor. 4. Remove the bolt holding the input
speed sensor to the transmission case. 5. Remove the input speed sensor from the transmission
case.
Output Speed Sensor
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the output
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
wiring connector onto the output speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission fluid
level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF as necessary.
Input Speed Sensor
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
NOTE: Apply trans jell to all slide portions, rolling contacts surfaces, thrust surfaces etc. to prevent
burnout during initial operation. Lubricate O-rings and O-ring seals with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF.
Soak all friction disks in MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF for at least two hours before assembly of clutch
packs.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > 68RFE Automatic
Transmission > Page 9381
INPUT SPEED SENSOR
1. Lubricate the output speed sensor O-ring with MOPAR(R) AS68RC ATF. 2. Install the input
speed sensor into the transmission case. 3. Tighten the bolt to 8 Nm (70 in.lbs.). 4. Install the
electrical wiring connector onto the input speed sensor. 5. Lower vehicle. 6. Verify the transmission
fluid level. Add MOPAR(R) AS68RC as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9385
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9386
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 431
Component : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSMISSION TEMPERATURE
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (RC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TCC TEMPERATURE SIGNAL T819 20YL/VT
2 TEMPERATURE SENSOR GROUND T820 20YL/WT
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 9387
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - M/T > Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Clutch Pedal Position Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
SWITCH-CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION
1. Disconnect switch 2-wire connector (2) attached to pedal support bracket (1), under instrument
panel to left of clutch pedal. 2. Check switch continuity with an ohmmeter while operating clutch
pedal.
- Pedal Depressed - Continuity
- Pedal Released - No Continuity
3. If continuity is not present or always present, replace clutch master cylinder. Switch is not
serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
This Engine Control Module (ECM) input is used only on models equipped with aftermarket Power
Take Off (PTO) units.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Power Take-Off > Power Take-Off Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Description > Page 9397
Power Take-Off Switch: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
This input is used only to tell the ECM that the aftermarket PTO (Power Take Off) unit has been
engaged. The ECM will disable (temporarily shut down) certain OBD II diagnostic trouble codes
when the PTO unit is engaged.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9402
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9403
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9404
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9405
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9406
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9407
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 9408
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9411
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere, is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9412
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9413
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9414
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9415
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9416
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation >
NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9417
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9422
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9423
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9424
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9425
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9426
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9427
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9428
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9429
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations >
Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9430
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9433
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9434
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9435
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9436
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9437
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9438
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9439
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9440
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift
Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9441
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9444
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9445
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The FCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and monitor
the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is mechanically
linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode sensor draws less
than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Front Control Module (FCM) monitors the mode sensor
outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to for the relative angles of the transfer case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case
gear operating mode. Refer to for the sensor codes returned to the FCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angle Vs. Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9446
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9447
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV271 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case position sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the transfer case's current operating mode. The sensor consists of a five position, resistive
multiplexed circuit which returns a specific resistance value to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) for each transfer case operating mode. The sensor is located on the top of the transfer
case, just left of the transfer case centerline and rides against the sector plate roostercomb. The
PCM supplies 5VDC (+/- 0.5V) to the sensor and monitors the return voltage to determine the
sector plate, and therefore the transfer case, position.
Operation
OPERATION
Operating Mode Versus Resistance
Position Sensor Linear Movement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9448
During normal vehicle operation, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) monitors the transfer case
position sensor return voltage to determine the operating mode of the transfer case. Refer to the
Operating Mode Versus Resistance table for the correct resistance for each position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9449
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9450
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9451
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Description and Operation
> NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9452
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support the vehicle. 2. Disengage the transfer case position sensor connector from
the position sensor. 3. Remove the position sensor from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal > Page 9455
Gear Sensor/Switch: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Inspect the O-ring seal on the transfer case position sensor. Replace the O-ring if necessary. 2.
Install the transfer case position sensor into the transfer case. Torque the sensor to 27 Nm (20
ft.lbs.). 3. Engage the transfer case position sensor connector to the position sensor. 4. Lower
vehicle. 5. Verify proper sensor operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9460
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9461
Speed Sensor: Locations Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9462
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Front
Component ID: 420
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-FRONT
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) RETURN T71 20YL/OR
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 2 (N3) SIGNAL T340 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9465
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9466
Speed Sensor: Diagrams Sensor-Prop Shaft Speed-Rear
Component ID: 421
Component : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-PROP SHAFT SPEED-REAR
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) SIGNAL T70 20YL
2 INPUT SPEED SENSOR 1 (N2) RETURN T341 20DG/VT
Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Diagrams > Sensor-Prop Shaft
Speed-Front > Page 9467
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the front output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the front output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the front output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the front output shaft speed sensor. 3.
Lower the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Speed Sensor, Transfer Case > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Front > Page 9470
Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Sensor-Output Shaft Speed-Rear
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connector from the rear output
shaft speed sensor (1). 3. Remove the rear output shaft speed sensor from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the rear output shaft speed sensor (1) into the transfer case. Tighten the speed sensor to
17 Nm (12.5 ft.lbs.). 2. Engage the wiring connector to the rear output shaft speed sensor. 3. Lower
the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Transfer Case Actuator: Locations
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9476
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9477
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9478
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9479
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9480
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9481
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9482
Transfer Case Actuator: Diagrams
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9483
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9484
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9485
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9486
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9487
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9488
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9491
torque device. The output of the device is coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and
range forks that change the transfer case operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps
maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9492
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9493
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a high
speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is coupled
to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case operating
ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Front Control Module (FCM) commands to move the
transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case operating mode
indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9494
Transfer Case Actuator: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The shift motor (1) consists of a permanent magnet D.C. motor with gear reduction to convert a
high speed-low torque device into a low speed-high torque device. The output of the device is
coupled to a shaft which internally moves the mode and range forks that change the transfer case
operating ranges. The motor is rated at 25 amps maximum at 23° C (72° F) with 10 volts at the
motor leads.
Operation
OPERATION
The transfer case shift motor responds to the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) commands to
move the transfer case shift sector bi-directionally, as required, to obtain the transfer case
operating mode indicated by the instrument panel mounted selector switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV243 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9497
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9498
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV246 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Remove the front propeller shaft. 3. Disengage the
wiring connectors from the shift motor and mode sensor. 4. Remove the bolts (1) holding the shift
motor and mode sensor assembly (2) onto the transfer case.
5. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) from the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9499
6. Remove the shift motor isolator (1) from the transfer case (2).
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Install the shift motor isolator (1) onto the transfer case (2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9500
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Install the shift motor and mode sensor assembly (1) onto the transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9501
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Actuators and Solenoids - Transfer Case >
Transfer Case Actuator > Component Information > Service and Repair > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9502
Transfer Case Actuator: Service and Repair NV273 Transfer Case
Removal
REMOVAL
NOTE: New shift motor assemblies are shipped in the 2WD/AWD position. If a new shift motor
assembly will be installed, it will be necessary to shift the transfer case to the 2WD/AWD position
prior to motor removal.
1. Raise the vehicle on a suitable hoist. 2. Disengage the wiring connectors from the shift motor
and mode sensor. 3. Remove the bolts holding the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the
transfer case. 4. Separate the shift motor and mode sensor assembly from the transfer case.
Installation
INSTALLATION
1. Verify that the shift sector O-ring is clean and properly positioned over the shift sector and
against the transfer case.
NOTE: Verify that the shift motor position and sector shaft orientation are aligned. It may be
necessary to manually shift the transfer case if the shift motor and sector shaft are not aligned.
2. Position the shift motor and mode sensor assembly onto the transfer case. 3. Install the bolts to
hold the assembly onto the transfer case. Tighten the bolts to 16-24 Nm (12-18 ft.lbs.).
CAUTION: If the original shift motor and mode sensor assembly bolts are reused, be sure to use
Mopar(R) Lock & Seal or Loctite(TM) 242 to replenish the lock patch material originally found on the
bolts
4. Engage the wiring connectors to the shift motor and mode sensor. 5. Refill the transfer case as
necessary. 6. Lower vehicle and verify transfer case operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
Control Module: Locations
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9506
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9507
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9508
Control Module: Diagrams
Component ID: 204
Component : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Connector:
Name : MODULE-FINAL DRIVE CONTROL
Color : # of pins :
50
Qualifier : (POWER WAGON)
A-A1 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T521 20YL/BK
A2 LOCKER SWITCH SUPPLY T537 20YL/LG
A3 LOCKER SENSOR SUPPLY T523 20YL/BK
A4 - A5 - A6 CAN C BUS (+) D65 20WT/LG
A7 CAN C BUS (-) D64 20WT/LB
A8 REAR LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T527 20YL/TN
A9 FRONT LOCKER SENSOR SENSE T522 20YL/LB
A10 LOCKER SWITCH SENSE T535 20YL/BR
A11 - A12 - A13 - A14 - B FUSED B(+) A121 14RD/YL
B1 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F960 20PK/LG
B2 SWITCH SUPPLY T536 20YL/WT
B3 - B4 - B5 STABILIZER BAR SWITCH SENSE T531 20YL/TN
B6 LOCKER OPEN ILLUMINATION SENSE T532 20YL/GY
B7 LOCKER REAR ILLUMINATION SENSE T533 20YL/LB
B8 LOCKER FR/RR ILLUMINATION SENSE T534 20YL
B9 STABILIZER BAR DISENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T530 20YL/DG
B10 STABILIZER BAR ENGAGE ILLUMINATION SENSE T529 20YL/LG
B11 - B12 - B13 - B14 - C FRONT LOCKER SOURCE T520 16YL/OR
C1 - C2 - C3 - C4 - C5 - -
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9509
C6 - C7 - C8 - C9 - C10 - C11 - C12 - C13 - C14 - D REAR LOCKER SOURCE T526 16YL/WT
E GROUND Z935 16BK
F GROUND Z935 16BK
G FRONT LOCKER RETURN T524 16YL/LG
H REAR LOCKER RETURN T528 16YL/GY
Component Location - 29
Component Location - 28
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9510
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description
Control Module: Description and Operation Description
DESCRIPTION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality now resides in the Totally Integrated
Power Module (TIPM), refer to the TIPM information for location. The TIPM controls the 4X4
transfer case shift functions via the actuation of a shift motor and utilizing the feedback of a mode
sensor assembly. Communication is via the CAN bus. Inputs include user selectable 4X4 modes
that include 2WD, AWD, 4HI, 4LO, and Neutral (selections vary with the specific transfer case).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9513
Control Module: Description and Operation Operation
OPERATION
The Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) functionality in the Totally Integrated Power Module
(TIPM) utilizes the input from the transfer case mounted mode sensor, the instrument panel
mounted selector switch, and the following information from the vehicle's CAN bus to determine if a
shift is allowed.
- Engine RPM and Vehicle Speed
- Diagnostic Requests
- Manual Transmission and Brake Applied
- PRNDL
- Ignition Status
- ABS Messages
Once the TIP determines that a requested shift is allowed, it actuates the bi-directional shift motor
as necessary to achieve the desired transfer case operating mode. The TIPM also monitors the
mode sensor while controlling the shift motor to determine the status of the shift attempt.
Several items can cause the requested shift not to be completed. If the TIPM has recognized a
fault (DTC) of some variety, it will begin operation in one of four Functionality Levels. These levels
are:
- Level Zero - Normal Operation.
- Level One - Only Mode Shifts Are Allowed.
- Level Two - Only Mode Shifts and Shifts Into LOW Are Allowed (No Neutral Shifts Are Allowed).
- Level Three - No Shifts Are Allowed
The TIPM can also be operating in one of three possible power modes. These power modes are:
- Full Power Mode is the normal operational mode of the module. This mode is achieved by normal
CAN bus traffic being present and the ignition being in the RUN position.
Reduced Power Mode will be entered when the ignition has been powered off. In this state, the
module will shut down power supplied to external devices, and to electronic interface inputs and
outputs. From this state the module can enter either Sleep Mode or Full Power Mode. To enter this
mode, the module must receive an ignition message denoting that the ignition is off, or not receive
any messages for 5 ± 0.5 seconds. To exit this mode, the module must receive one ignition
message that denotes that the ignition is in the RUN position.
- Sleep Mode will be entered, from the Reduced Power Mode, when no CAN traffic has been
sensed for 20 ± 1 seconds. If during Sleep Mode the module detects CAN bus traffic, it will revert
to the Reduced Power mode while monitoring for ignition messages. It will remain in this state as
long as there is traffic other than run or start messages, and will return to Sleep mode if the bus
goes without traffic for 20 ± 1 seconds.
SHIFT REQUIREMENTS
If the TIPM is in full power mode and at functionality level zero, it uses the following criteria to
determine if a shift is allowed.
If any of the driver controllable conditions are not met once the shift request is recognized, the
TIPM will solidly illuminate the source position's LED and flash the desired position's LED for all
shifts except NEUTRAL. The NEUTRAL shift LED strategy will be discussed later.
Mode shifts will be allowed regardless of transmission gear or vehicle speed, whenever the
following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector switch state indicates that a mode shift has been requested.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
Range shifts will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- A change in the Selector Switch state indicating a range shift has been requested.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal must be recognized for at least 1.5 seconds ± 100 msec.
(Automatic transmissions only)
- Proper transmit/receive messages are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Clutch signal is recognized for 500 msec ± 50 msec (Manual transmissions only).
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9514
A shift into transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 4.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus. (Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position, engine off.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
A shift out of transfer case Neutral will be allowed only if all of the following conditions are met:
- Front and rear wheel speed are within 21 km/h (13 mph).
- The recessed Neutral Selection switch has been depressed continuously for 1.0 seconds ± 100
msec while all shift conditions have been continuously met.
- Transmission in NEUTRAL signal recognized from the bus.(Automatic transmissions only)
- Clutch signal is recognized from the bus (Manual transmissions only).
- Proper message transmissions/receptions are occurring on the CAN bus.
- Vehicle speed is less than or equal to 4.8 km/h (3 mph).
- Ignition key switch is in the RUN position.
- Foot Brake is applied.
- A valid mode sensor signal is being sensed by the TIPM.
SHIFT SEQUENCES
Once all the driver controllable conditions for the requested shift have been met, the TIPM begins a
shift timer with a maximum duration of 1 second per 'D' channel transition. If the shift timer expires
before the TIPM recognizes to correct mode sensor code, the shift is considered to have been
blocked. The blocked shift will increment the blocked shift counter by one. The TIPM strategy for
handling blocked shifts will be described later. The process the TIPM performs for the various shifts
will be described first.
RANGE AND MODE SHIFTS
The process for performing all the range and mode shifts are the same. The following steps
describe the process.
- Allow time for Selector Switch debounce; 250 msec ± 50 msec.
- Extinguish the source gear's LED while flashing desired transfer case position's LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel transition in the
destination gear's direction while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Solidly illuminate the selected gear's LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds ± 100 msec. per 'D'
channel. The TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired
position.
The exception to the preceding sequence is when a shift from 4L to 2WD/AWD is requested. If
2WD/AWD is requested from the 4L position, the transfer case is first driven to the 4H position. If
the 4H position is reached, the transfer case is then driven back to the 2WD/AWD position and the
shift is considered complete. If the transfer case does not reach any the 4H position, but is in the
2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the 2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the
shift is also considered complete.
SHIFT OUT OF NEUTRAL
The following steps describe the process for a shift out of NEUTRAL.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Engage the shift motor for a maximum of 1 second ± 100 msec toward the transfer case 4H mode
position while monitoring the mode sensor channel transitions.
- Disengage the shift motor when the correct mode sensor code is recognized.
- Extinguish the Neutral LED.
- Transmit a bus message that the transfer case shift is complete.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (ie. a blocked or other
condition exists), stop driving the motor and wait for 200 msec ± 50 msec. The shift motor is then
reversed in the direction back toward the source gear for up to 1.0 seconds 100 msec. The
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9515
TIPM waits for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeats the attempt to shift to the desired position.
- When the Neutral button is released, if the 4H position is the desired position, the shift is
complete. Illuminate the 4H LED.
- Otherwise when the Neutral button is released, if all of the shift requirements are being met then
engage the shift motor towards the desired position for 1 second ± 100 msec per 'D' channel. (if
requirements for shifting are not met, illuminate the 4H LED and flash the destination LED as an
indication to the driver that all of the driver controllable shift conditions are not being met). If this
requires another range or mode shift, begin the range/mode shift process.
- If the desired mode sensor code is not received after the shift timer expires (i.e. a blocked or other
condition exists), refer to Blocked Shift Strategy.
BLOCKED SHIFT STRATEGY
When a shift is commanded, the shift motor will be driven towards its destination position, except in
the case of shifting out of Neutral if 4L was selected (the transfer case will shift to the 4H position
first, before proceeding to 4L). If the shift is blocked on the way to the destination, the TIPM may
attempt to drive the motor back to the original position. This process will be allowed to occur 5
times. If the transfer case has reached a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel during the shift re-attempts,
the LED for the achieved gear position is illuminated and the shift attempts are stopped. To
re-attempt the desired shift, the selector switch will need to be rotated to the current position until
the switch debounce timer expires then a shift will need to be requested again.
At the end of the 5th blocked attempt, the shift motor is driven towards the last known 'D' channel
position. If this motor drive allows the transfer case to reach the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel, or the
2WD/AWD between gear position on the 4H side of 2WD/AWD, the shift is considered complete
and the shift attempts are ended.
If the mode sensor is in the NEUTRAL region at the expiration of the shift timer, the TIPM will
continue to make the shift attempts according to the blocked shift strategy independent of whether
or not the driver controlled conditions are met.
For shifts from NEUTRAL, if all 5 attempts fail to reach the desired position (which by default is
4H), the motor will be driven to stall in the direction of 4H or 4L, depending on the achieved
position. If the transfer case has reached the 2WD/AWD or 4L between gear position nearest the
NEUTRAL positions and the shift conditions are no longer being met, the transfer case will be
driven toward the corresponding 'D' channel. Otherwise, the transfer case will be driven in the
direction opposite the last attempt with the desired target being 4H or 4L.
If the transfer case reaches the 2WD/AWD 'D' channel when being driven in the 4H direction, then
one final 1.0 second drive toward 4H is attempted. If the transfer case then reaches any of the 4H
positions, the shift is considered complete and the 4H LED is illuminated. If the transfer case is still
the 2WD/AWD position, the shift is considered complete and the 2WD/AWD LED is illuminated.
NOTE: If after the 5th blocked shift and reversal attempt, if the transfer case position is in the
NEUTRAL region, shift attempts will continue until a non-NEUTRAL 'D' channel is reached.
SHIFT REVERSAL TARGETS
If the shift timer expires (1 second per 'D' channel) and the transfer case has not reached the
desired position, all shifts will attempt to return to their original position with the exceptions of:
- If the intended shift is going to the High rail from Low and can't make it, but it can make the
2WD/AWD position, the motor stops at that position. The TIPM will not attempt to cross back over
NEUTRAL if it does not have to. This means that there was a block on the first attempt to go to 4H
and the transfer case has made it through NEUTRAL to a known good position, then the motor will
go back only to the 2WD/4WD position and execute the remainder of the attempts from there.
- For shifts out of NEUTRAL, any time a shift is commanded out of NEUTRAL, the system needs to
get out. The TIPM should never go to NEUTRAL unless the driver is commanding it and all
required conditions are being met
ENCODER DRIFT CORRECTION
Whenever a shift is completed, the TIPM stores the position in memory as the transfer case's
intended position. The TIPM continuously monitors the mode sensor and if the mode sensor drifts
toward into a NEUTRAL region sensor position for 2.0 seconds, the TIPM will perform a motor
drive to correct the drift. The transfer case will be driven toward the intended position for 1.0
seconds ± 100 msec. The TIPM will wait for 2.0 seconds ± 50 msec. and repeat the attempt to shift
to the desired position. This will continue until the intended position is reached.
SHIFT MOTOR BRAKING
Two modes of shift motor braking are employed to improve shift performance, static and dynamic.
Static shift motor braking is utilized under the following conditions:
- Whenever the transfer case is in the 2WD/AWD or 4L 'D' channel position.
- Whenever an invalid mode sensor code is present.
Static motor braking is achieved by applying +12V on both shift motor wires.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9516
NOTE: Static Shift Motor Braking is independent of ignition key position.
SHIFT ATTEMPT LIMIT
To protect the transfer case system, the TIPM will impose a limit on the number of shifts that can
occur over a calibrated time period. The system will monitor the number of 'D' channel segment
transitions that occur in any 30 second time period. If the number of segment transitions is 30 or
greater, the system will go into a default mode. The default mode of operation for shifting is that the
number of allowed 'D' channel transitions permitted to occur will be 3 over each 15 second ± 100
msec calibrated window of time. After 5 minutes ± 100 msec, the motor can be assumed to have
cooled down and the system will revert to normal operation. The following rules also apply to the
shift limit:
- The attempt limit will not prevent shifts coming out of NEUTRAL, they will be allowed regardless
of the counter/timer.
- Any shift that is in progress when the counter reaches a maximum count in time will be allowed to
complete before the default mode is entered. D-channel transitions during this period will not be
counted towards the default mode limit.
- A block, regardless of the direction, whether towards destination or back towards reversal target
(shift timer expiring), will count as a value of 2 transitions towards the 30 segment transitions to go
into default mode as defined above. Current attempt limit values are 30 transitions in 30 seconds
and default mode values are 3 transitions every 15 seconds for 5 minutes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Differential, Transfer Case > Differential Fluid Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Differential Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing
Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Differential, Transfer Case > Differential Fluid Transfer Case > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page
9522
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
Fluid - Transfer Case: Technical Service Bulletins Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information
NUMBER: 26-001-09
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: September 24, 2009
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 26-003-07, DATED MARCH
30, 2007, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. THIS IS A COMPLETE
REVISION AND NO ASTERISKS HAVE BEEN USED TO HIGHLIGHT REVISIONS.
SUBJECT: Fluid Flushing Requirements
MODELS:
2005 - 2008 (CS) Pacifica
2006 - 2009 (D1) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2010 (D2) Ram Truck (3500 Pick Up)
2007 - 2010 (DC) Ram Truck (3500 Chassis Cab)
2005 - 2009 (DH) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2010 (DJ) Ram Truck (2500 Pick Up)
2005 - 2008 (DR) Ram Truck (1500/2500 Pick Up)
2009 - 2010 (DS) Ram Truck (1500)
2005 - 2009 (HB) Durango
2007 - 2009 (HG) Aspen
2009 - 2010 (JC) Journey
2007 - 2010 (JK) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (JR) Sebring Sedan & Convertible/Stratus Sedan
2007 - 2010 (JS) Avenger/Sebring
2008 - 2010 (KK) Liberty
2007 - 2010 (KA) Nitro
2005 - 2007 (KJ) Liberty
2009 - 2010 (LC) Challenger
2005 - 2010 (LE) 300C/300C Touring (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (LX) 300/Magnum/Charger
2007 - 2010 (MK) Compass/Patriot
2005 - 2010 (ND) Dakota
2005 - 2006 (PL) Neon
2007 - 2010 (PM) Caliber
2005 - 2010 (PT) Chrysler PT Cruiser
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Maintenance - Fluid Flushing Information > Page 9527
2005 - 2007 (RG) Chrysler Voyager (International Markets)
2005 - 2007 (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
2009 - 2010 (RT) Town & Country/Grand Caravan
2005 - 2006 (TJ) Wrangler
2005 - 2006 (VA) Sprinter
2007 - 2010 (VB) Sprinter
2005 - 2010 (WH) Grand Cherokee (International Markets)
2005 - 2010 (WK) Grand Cherokee
2006 - 2010 (XH) Commander (International Markets)
2006 - 2010 (XK) Commander
2005 - 2010 (ZB) Viper
2005 - 2007 (ZH) Crossfire
DISCUSSION:
Chrysler Group vehicle fluid systems do NOT require regular flushing. These systems include:
engine oil, transmission oil, axle lube, brake fluid, power steering fluid, and refrigerant. The only
exception to this requirement are published in the vehicle maintenance schedules, e.g. engine
coolant.
Exceptions to this recommendation include only those instances where a failure has occurred
and/or the system has become compromised, contaminated or overheated beyond the normal
operating range.
Chrysler Group does NOT recommend aftermarket chemicals to flush the engine, transmission,
brake or steering systems. Chemicals contained in these products can damage the system
elastomeric components, and contaminate the component fluid, leading to loss of
system/component durability and service life. When necessary, only the original approved system
fluid should be used to flush these components using teamPSE(R) approved equipment.
If the engine coolant contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with Mopar
Cooling System Flush, p/n 04856977, or equivalent. Follow with a thorough rinsing to remove all
deposits and chemicals. Refill with a minimum of a 50% mixture of the specified coolant and
distilled water.
POLICY: Information Only
Disclaimer:
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
NV241 GEN II ......................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 1.6 L 3.4 (pints) NV243 ................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 1.6 L (3.4
Pints) NV244 GEN II ............................................................................................................................
................................................................. 1.6 L (3.4 pints) NV246 ......................................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 1.9 9L
(4.0 pints) NV271 .................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... 1.89 L (4.0 pints) NV273 ..............................................
..........................................................................................................................................................
1.89 L (4.0 pints)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 9530
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
All Except NV246 Recommended lubricant for the NV241 GEN II, NV271, NV243, NV 244 GEN II,
and NV273 transfer cases is Mopar ATF +4 Automatic Transmission Fluid.
NV246 Recommended lubricant for the NV246 transfer case is Mopar NVG 246 Automatic
Transmission Fluid or equivalent.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV241 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9533
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV271 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (1) and drain (2) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9534
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV243 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9535
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair NV244 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
NOTE: The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain (3) and fill (2) plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug (3).
Tighten plug to 20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge
of fill plug opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill
plug (2) to 20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if
removed. 9. Wipe any excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9536
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
NV241 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV271 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (1) and drain (2) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9537
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV243 Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
The fill (2) and drain (3) plugs are both in the rear case.
1. Raise vehicle. 2. Position drain pan under transfer case.
NOTE: It may be necessary to remove the exhaust y-pipe at the exhaust manifold to properly
access the fill and drain plugs. Lowering the exhaust will allow the plugs to be accessed for
torquing during installation.
3. Remove drain and fill plugs and drain lubricant completely. 4. Install drain plug. Tighten plug to
20-34 Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 5. Remove drain pan. 6. Fill transfer case to bottom edge of fill plug
opening with Mopar(R) ATF +4, Automatic Transmission fluid. 7. Install and tighten fill plug to 20-34
Nm (15-25 ft. lbs.). 8. Install the exhaust y-pipe to the exhaust manifold, if removed. 9. Wipe any
excess fluid that may have spilled onto the exhaust.
10. Lower vehicle.
NV244 GENII Transfer Case
STANDARD PROCEDURE - FLUID DRAIN AND REFILL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9538
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component
Information > Service and Repair > NV241 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9539
ERROR: stackunderflow
OFFENDING COMMAND: ~
STACK:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Description
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
A 4WD auto indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD auto indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure gauge.
The 4WD auto indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD AUTO in the opaque layer
of the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from
being clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the
cutout in the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the
translucent outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is
soldered onto the instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD auto indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD auto indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9544
A 4WD indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with an optional four-wheel drive system, this indicator is electronically disabled. The
4WD indicator is located on the right side of the instrument cluster, to the right of the oil pressure
gauge.
The 4WD indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD in the opaque layer of the
instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD indicator is dimmable,
which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel lamps dimmer
thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
A 4WD low indicator is standard equipment on all instrument clusters. However, on vehicles not
equipped with the optional four-wheel drive system and electronically shifted transfer case, this
indicator is electronically disabled. The 4WD low indicator is located on the right side of the
instrument cluster, to the right of the coolant temperature gauge.
The 4WD low indicator consists of a stencil-like cutout of the text 4WD LOW in the opaque layer of
the instrument cluster overlay. The dark outer layer of the overlay prevents the indicator from being
clearly visible when it is not illuminated. An amber Light Emitting Diode (LED) behind the cutout in
the opaque layer of the overlay causes the indicator to appear in amber through the translucent
outer layer of the overlay when it is illuminated from behind by the LED, which is soldered onto the
instrument cluster electronic circuit board.
When the exterior lighting is turned ON, the illumination intensity of the 4WD low indicator is
dimmable, which is adjusted along with the cluster general illumination lighting using the panel
lamps dimmer thumbwheel on the headlamp switch.
The 4WD low indicator is serviced as a unit with the instrument cluster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9545
Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation Operation
4WD Auto Indicator
4WD AUTO INDICATOR
The 4WD auto indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer
case has been shifted into the 4WD auto mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD auto indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument
cluster receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit.
Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or
START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster
transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD auto indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Auto Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD auto
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD auto indicator will
be turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality
of the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD auto mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD auto indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD auto indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Indicator
4WD INDICATOR
The 4WD indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the transfer case has been
shifted into a 4WD mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the instrument cluster circuit
board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received by the cluster from the
Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network (CAN) data bus.
The 4WD indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument cluster
logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this indicator to operate when the instrument cluster
receives a battery current input on the fused ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the
LED will always be OFF when the ignition switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED
only illuminates when it is provided a path to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The
instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD indicator
lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the bulb check portion of the test to confirm the functionality of
the LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly or the manual transfer case through the transfer case switch to
determine when the 4WD mode is engaged. The TIPM then sends the proper lamp-ON or
lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster (EMIC). For further diagnosis of
the 4WD indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that controls the LED, refer to Instrument
Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the transfer case switch, the
TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD indicator
operation a diagnostic scan tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
4WD Low Indicator
4WD LOW INDICATOR
The 4WD low indicator gives an indication to the vehicle operator when the electronic transfer case
has been shifted into the 4WD low mode. This indicator is controlled by a transistor on the
instrument cluster circuit board based upon cluster programming and electronic messages received
by the cluster from the Totally Integrated Power Module (TIPM) over the Controller Area Network
(CAN) data bus.
The 4WD low indicator Light Emitting Diode (LED) is completely controlled by the instrument
cluster logic circuit, and that logic will only allow this
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Description > Page 9546
indicator to operate when the instrument cluster receives a battery current input on the fused
ignition switch output (run-start) circuit. Therefore, the LED will always be OFF when the ignition
switch is in any position except ON or START. The LED only illuminates when it is provided a path
to ground by the instrument cluster transistor. The instrument cluster will turn ON the 4WD low
indicator for the following reasons:
- 4WD Low Indicator Lamp-On Message - Each time the cluster receives an electronic 4WD low
indicator lamp-ON message from the TIPM, the indicator will be illuminated. The indicator remains
illuminated until the cluster receives a lamp-OFF message from the TIPM, or until the ignition
switch is turned to the OFF position, whichever occurs first.
- Actuator Test - Each time the cluster is put through the actuator test, the 4WD low indicator will be
turned ON, then OFF again during the LED portion of the test to confirm the functionality of the
LED and the cluster control circuitry.
The TIPM continually monitors the electronic transfer case through the transfer case shift
motor/mode sensor assembly to determine when the 4WD low mode is engaged. The TIPM then
sends the proper lamp-ON or lamp-OFF message to the ElectroMechanical Instrument Cluster
(EMIC). For further diagnosis of the 4WD low indicator or the instrument cluster circuitry that
controls the LED, refer to Instrument Cluster/Carrier Testing.
For proper diagnosis of the transfer case shift motor/mode sensor, the TIPM, the EMIC, the CAN
data bus or the electronic communication related to 4WD low indicator operation a diagnostic scan
tool is required. Refer to the appropriate diagnostic information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Locations
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9550
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9551
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9552
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9553
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
Component ID: 491
Component : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Connector:
Name : SWITCH-TRANSFER CASE SELECTOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 10
Qualifier : (ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 TRANSFER CASE POSITION SENSOR INPUT K77 20BR/WT
2-3 MODE SELECT K977 20BR/WT
4 PANEL LAMPS CONTROL E11 20OR/DB
5 GROUND Z905 20BK
6 NEUTRAL INDICATOR G95 20VT/BR
7 FUSED IGNITION SWITCH OUTPUT (RUN-START) F21 20PK/DG
8-9-10 - Component Location - 47
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9554
Component Location - 45
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9555
Component Location - 20
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9556
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9559
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere, is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9560
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9561
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9562
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case position
and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, AWD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for AWD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the AWD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9563
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and, T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9564
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The selector switch assembly is mounted in the left side of the vehicle's Instrument Panel (IP) and
consists of a rotary knob connected to a resistive network for the mode and range shift selections.
Also located in this assembly is a recessed, normally open momentary switch for making shifts into
and out of transfer case NEUTRAL. A pen, or similar instrument, is used to make a NEUTRAL shift
selection, thus reducing the likelihood of an inadvertent shift request.
The selector switch also contains four light emitting diode's (LED's) to indicate the transfer case
position and whether a shift is in progress.
Operation
OPERATION
As the position of the selector switch varies, the resistance between the Mode Sensor supply
voltage pin and the Mode Sensor output will vary. Hardware, software, and calibrations within the
Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) are provided that interpret the selector switch resistance as
given in the table below:
Selector Switch Interpretation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV243 Transfer Case > Page 9565
For resistances between the ranges B-E shown for each valid position (T-Case NEUTRAL, 4LO,
4HI, 2WD), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- either of the neighboring valid positions.
- as an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges E and F shown for 2WD and in-between positions, the TCCM
may interpret the resistance as:
- the 2WD position.
- an invalid fault position.
- a valid in-between position.
For resistances between the ranges F and G shown for in-between positions and fault condition
(open), the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- a valid in-between position.
- an invalid fault position.
For resistances between the ranges A and B shown for the fault condition (short) and T-Case
NEUTRAL, the TCCM may interpret the resistance as:
- the T-Case NEUTRAL position.
- an invalid fault position.
The LED's in the selector assembly are illuminated/flashed in the following manner to indicate a
particular condition or state.
- A solidly illuminated LED indicates a successfully completed shift and the current operating mode
of the transfer case. While a shift has been requested but not yet completed, the LED for the
desired transfer case position is flashed.
- A flashing operating mode LED for the desired gear indicates that a shift to that position has been
requested, but all of the driver controllable conditions have not been met. This is in an attempt to
notify the driver that the transmission needs to be put into NEUTRAL, the vehicle speed is too
great, or some other condition outlined (other than a diagnostic failure that would prevent this shift)
elsewhere is not met. Note that this flashing will continue indefinitely until the conditions are
eventually met, or the selector switch position is changed, or if diagnostic routines no longer allow
the requested shift.
- If the driver attempts to make a shift into transfer case NEUTRAL, and any of the driver
controllable conditions are not met, the request will be ignored until all of the conditions are met or
until the NEUTRAL select button is released. Additionally the neutral lamp will flash, or begin to
flash while the button is depressed and operator controllable conditions are not being met. All of
the LED's except the Neutral will flash if any of the operator controllable conditions for shifting are
not met while the Neutral button is depressed. This "toggle" type of feature is necessary because
the TCCM would interpret another request immediately after the shift into transfer case NEUTRAL
has completed.
- No LED's illuminated indicate a fault in the transfer case control system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9570
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9571
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9572
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9573
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9574
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9575
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9576
Gear Sensor/Switch: Locations Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9577
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Locations > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9578
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor
Component ID: 15
Component : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : BLACK
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE FULL TIME ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A940 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9581
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9582
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9583
Connector:
Name : ASSEMBLY-SHIFT MOTOR/MODE SENSOR
Color : DK. GRAY
# of pins : 8
Qualifier : (RFE PART TIME ETC/RE ETC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 5 VOLT SUPPLY T103 20YL/OR
2 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
3 SENSOR RETURN G180 20VT/YL
4 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL B T101 16DG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9584
5 SHIFT MOTOR CONTROL A T102 16YL
6 FUSED B(+) A918 20RD
7 T-CASE MOTOR BRAKE SIGNAL T300 20YL/GY
8-Component Location - 21
Component Location - 24
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9585
Component Location - 26
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9586
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9587
Gear Sensor/Switch: Diagrams Sensor-Transfer Case Position
Component ID: 429
Component : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Connector:
Name : SENSOR-TRANSFER CASE POSITION
Color : # of pins :
2
Qualifier : (MTC)
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 20WT/DG
Pin Description Circuit
1 MODE SENSOR A D201 18WT/DG
2 GROUND Z955 20BK
2 GROUND Z955 18BK
2 GROUND Z901 20BK
Component Location - 22
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9588
Component Location - 25
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Diagrams > Assembly-Shift Motor/Mode Sensor > Page 9589
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV244 GENII Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9592
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9593
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV246 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to indicate
the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall Effect
Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the motor
shaft position into a coded signal. The FCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and monitor
the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is mechanically
linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode sensor draws less
than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Front Control Module (FCM) monitors the mode sensor
outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to for the relative angles of the transfer case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case
gear operating mode. Refer to for the sensor codes returned to the FCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angle Vs. Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9594
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9595
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV271 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case position sensor is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the transfer case's current operating mode. The sensor consists of a five position, resistive
multiplexed circuit which returns a specific resistance value to the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) for each transfer case operating mode. The sensor is located on the top of the transfer
case, just left of the transfer case centerline and rides against the sector plate roostercomb. The
PCM supplies 5VDC (+/- 0.5V) to the sensor and monitors the return voltage to determine the
sector plate, and therefore the transfer case, position.
Operation
OPERATION
Operating Mode Versus Resistance
Position Sensor Linear Movement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9596
During normal vehicle operation, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) monitors the transfer case
position sensor return voltage to determine the operating mode of the transfer case. Refer to the
Operating Mode Versus Resistance table for the correct resistance for each position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9597
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV243 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9598
Mode Sensor Channel States
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9599
Gear Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation NV273 Transfer Case
Description
DESCRIPTION
The transfer case mode sensor (1) is an electronic device whose output can be interpreted to
indicate the shift motor shaft's rotary position. The sensor consists of a magnetic ring and four Hall
Effect Transistors to create a 4 channel digital device (non-contacting) whose output converts the
motor shaft position into a coded signal. The TCCM must supply 5VDC (+/- 0.5v) to the sensor and
monitor the shift motor position. The four channels are denoted A, B, C, and D. The sensor is
mechanically linked to the shaft of the cam which causes the transfer case shifting. The mode
sensor draws less than 53 mA.
Operation
OPERATION
During normal vehicle operation, the Transfer Case Control Module (TCCM) monitors the mode
sensor outputs at least every 250 (+/-50) milliseconds when the shift motor is stationary and 400
microseconds when the shift motor is active. A mode sensor signal between 3.8 Volts and 0.8 Volts
is considered to be undefined.
Refer to SECTOR ANGLES vs.TRANSFER CASE POSITION for the relative angles of the transfer
case shift sector versus the interpreted transfer case gear operating mode. Refer to MODE
SENSOR CHANNEL STATES for the sensor codes returned to the TCCM for each transfer case
mode sensor position. The various between gears positions can also be referred as the transfer
case's coarse position. These coarse positions come into play during shift attempts.
Sector Angles Verses Transfer Case Position
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-6.7L DSL Turbo VIN A (2007))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Gear Sensor/Switch, Transfer Case >
Component Information > Description and Operation > NV244 GENII Transfer Case > Page 9600
Mode Sensor Channel States